Samsung Téléphone Mobile Smartphones SGH-I320 - Mode d'emploi - Manuel de l'utilisateur - Manuels
Samsung Téléphone Mobile Smartphones SGH-I320 - Mode d'emploi - Manuel de l'utilisateur - Manuels
SAMSUNG sur FNAC.COM
- Liste des manuels utilisateur Samsung
- Revenir à l'accueil
ou juste avant la balise de fermeture -->
Description
|
Date de distribution
|
Langue
|
Fichier
|
Manuel de l'utilisateur |
2007.04.27 |
ANGLAIS |
3.7 MB |
Manuel de l'utilisateur |
2007.04.27 |
FRANÇAIS |
4.8 MB |
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-I320ZKAXEF-downloads
COMMANDER un produit SAMSUNG sur FNAC.COM
Liste des manuels APPLEListe des produits Sony Liste des produits Dell Liste des Manuels Samsung Listes des Manuels Konica Minolta
Manuels Utilisateurs Samsung :
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X1B-NP900X1B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0CFR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT50QMSW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46EH6030W-Manuels
Samsung-Home-Appliance-Side-by-Side-RSA1STMG-Arabe-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS59D6900DS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7C-NP700Z7C-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-Side-By-Side-RS6178UGDSR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-S730-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E590-Manuels
20ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6220FX-Samsung-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5100P-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF5FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C520-Hello-Kitty-Open-marketS-GH-C520-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-Player-mini-2GT-C3310-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A06FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5C-NP700Z5C-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-Z360-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A856-LE46A856S1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B620T2WXXC-LE40B620R3W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A568-LE40A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ18FAN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22D450G1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D6200TS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-NL22B-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A568-LE46A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE65ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-65-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE65ES8000S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-C6625-gris-Open-market-GT-C6625-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B8000WW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Corby-Pro-rouge-Open-market-GT-B5310-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-SBS-A-507-L-Blanc-RSA1TWP-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D430DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A626-LE40A626A3M-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-GT-C3310-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C3520-GT-C3520-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrig%C3%A9rateur-SBS-A-510-L-Inox-RSH5TERS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-mono-23L-SILVER-ME82V-Manuels*
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D503F7W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-RSA1DTMG-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-6900-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-C5530-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B300BL-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-D4200-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730C-NP-R730-JB03FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-R-mix-YP-R1JCP-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-P2470HD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J770-Open-market-SGH-J770-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Home-cinema-DVD-5.1-HT-D350WXZF-serie-3HT-D350-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-6200FX-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-Smart-Camera-WB850F-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A456-PS50A456P2D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6570WS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-22-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T22A300-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-S2-YP-S2QB-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-24ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-2580N-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-3710ND-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5003BW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P2500-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Definition-Standard-5-MP-Ecran-LCD-2.7-6.86-cm-Camescope-SD-Samsung-F700-SMX-F700BP-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R710-NP-R710-ASS1FR-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL101-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A566P1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46D550K1W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH026FWEA-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV07PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B850-PS50B850Y1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37D5000ZF-UE37D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH300WHXES-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40ES5700S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-60-UE60D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE60D8000YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D403E2W-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ST500-SAMSUNG-ST500-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5610-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-27-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T27A300-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1170-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40R86BD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C350-LE22C350D1W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J700-SGH-J700G-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-Gril-23L-SILVER-GS89F-1SPGS89F-1SP-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B5B-NP400B5B-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-12-5-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B2B-NP400B2B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-RC-RC730-NP-RC730-S05FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-3405W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-RC-RC530-NP-RC530-S03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5-ANP300E5A-S08FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-Lecteur-blu-ray-BD-D6900WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3DBD-D6900-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A568-LE37A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-24-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T24A350-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-G600-Open-market-SGH-G600-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-DA-E650-ZF-Double-Dock-Bluetooth-3.0-USB-AUXDA-E650-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-QF20BP-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-PL90-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C550-LE32C550J1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE23R86BD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A436T1D-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1151-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-P3YP-P3JCB-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique%20Multifonction-Monochrome-24ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4824FN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1A-3G-XE700T1A-H01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-F250-Open-market-SGH-F250-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730-NP-R730-JA05FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X3C-NP900X3C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4.0-Blanc-8GoYP-G1CW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D470DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-MM-D470D-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Solid-B2100-rouge-Open-market-GT-B2100-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U3B-NP530U3B-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Chat-335-gris-Open-market-GT-S3350-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-GT-S5690-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B530P7W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF0702NBE-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-Home-cinema-blu-ray-HT-D6750WWXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C7700-UE55C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-E8300-ZF-Enregistreur-Blu-Ray-320-Go-SMART-HUB-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-DVD-SH893-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Systeme-NX-NX100-14-6-MP-Ecran-7-6cm-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-365-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-305E5A-NP305E5A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-2-Gamme-Professionnelle-200A5B-NP200B5B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Samsung-Q3YP-Q3CB-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-B3310bleu-Open-market-GT-B3310-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600B-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E250-Open-market-SGH-E250-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B350H-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES7000S-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-NP900X4D-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7CH-NP700Z7C-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z3A-NP700Z3A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-SUR40-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6510WS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-300V3A-NP300V3A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-NC10-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2160-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R720E-NP-R720-JS03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT07FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R620E-NP-R620-JS02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D5720RS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP550P5C-NP550P5C-T04FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D8000YS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV515-NP-RV515-S04FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3DUE46ES6710S-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-2MP-Ecran-3-hVGA-Smart-Camera-Samsung-WB150F-SAMSUNG-WB150F-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG40EA590LS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-E8200-ZF-Barre-de-son-Blu-Ray-3D-Bluetooth-HT-E8200-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-CE117PPT-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-3D-TV-TV-UN50ES6350F-Coree-du-Sud-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-19ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4200-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-32-32ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-770ND-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-320-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9000-RW8-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-TC220W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9001-M8-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels-Mode-d-emploi
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-I9070P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE40C750-LE40C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-UE32ES5500W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A676-LE40A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5230-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40EH5300W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46B651-LE46B651T3W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5010NW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi%203.6-Noir-8GoYP-GS1CB-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5000-ZF-LED-32-FULL-HD-UE32EH5000W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-blanc-SFR-GT-N7000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7.0-Wi-FiGT-P3110-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7300-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-noir-SFRGT-N7000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6900S-ZF-Slim-LED-50-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D6500VS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A676-LE32A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE55D6200TS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6540S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6750WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C530-LE40C530F1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6750WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B6000-UE40B6000VW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A556P1F-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6710-UE46C6710US-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C530-PS50C530C1W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U4B-NP530U4B-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-DV90-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-460DR-2-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME32B-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Samsung-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT41MASW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P6800-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-C24B550U-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-Lave-linge-EcoBubble-12kg-1400tours-WF1124XBC-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Ampli-Tuner-AV-HW-E551-ZF-Barre-de-son-Format-46-Convertible-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Phone-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF2FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV24PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37B6000VW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A466-LE40A466C2M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A676-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXDUH112EE-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B651T3P-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-S5220GT-S5220-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59NBPN-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B750V-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME75B-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59PMSW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3Serie-9-900X3A-NP900X3A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME40B-Manuels
Samsung-SGH-D500-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels
Samsung-Table-induction-3-foyers-7-2-KW-CTN463NC01-CTN463NC01-XEF-Manuels
Samsung-RR92HAWW-Refrigerateur-une-porte-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-UE40D6510WS-Manuels
Samsung-ML-2160-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME46B-Manuels
Samsung-LE37A466-LE37A466C2M-Manuels
Samsung-UE32EH4003W-Manuels
Samsung-LE32D460C9H-Manuels
Samsung-LE40B551A6W-Manuels
Samsung-Zephyr-AQV09YWAN-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels
Samsung-S22B350B-Manuels
Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Note-II-GT-N7100-Manuels
Samsung-GT-I9300-Manuels
SAMSUNG/SAMSUNG-DV90-Manuels
Samsung-GT-N8000-Manuels
Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Pologne-Manuels
Samsung-ML-2165W-Roumanie-Manuels
Samsung-Notebook-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z5C-S01-NP700Z5C-S01DE-Manuels
Samsung-Player-One-noir-Open-market-GT-S5230-Manuels
Samsung-LE32E420E2W-Manuels
Samsung-910MP-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open-market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels
Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Pro-gris-Open-market-GT-B7510-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-noir-SFR-GT-S5660-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Spica-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5700-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7610-noir-Open-market-GT-B7610-Manuels
Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels
Samsung-LE32C650-LE32C650L1W-Manuels
Samsung-LE26D450G1W-Manuels
Samsung-N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels
Samsung-N150-NP-N150-Manuels
Samsung-NP20-NP20FK02BG-SEF-Manuels
Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110726_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.2_120725_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-LE32D400E1W-Manuels
Samsung-Gainable-Slim-MH026FEEA-Manuels
Samsung-CW21Z573N-Manuels
Samsung-40-UE40D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels
Samsung-UE32D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-UE46ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3D-UE46ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1-Manuels
Samsung-NS140SDXEA-Manuels
Samsung-MH050FXEA2B-Manuels
Samsung-UE75ES9000S-Slim-LED-75-SMART-Interaction-3D-Manuels
Samsung-RR92HAWW-Manuels
Samsung-GT-P6200-Manuels
Samsung-Refrigerateur-1porteA-350-L-Blanc-RR82FHSW-Manuels
Samsung-UE26EH4000-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4000W-Manuels
Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9DVBEU4E-ENG-Manuel
Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_111130_Screen-Manuel
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuel
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuels
Samsung-GT-S5360-Manuels
Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4-0-Blanc-8Go-YP-G1CW-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-551-noir-Open-marketGT-I5510-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Note-10-1-GT-N8000-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-LTE-SC-03D-JP-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-Note-SC-05D-JP-Manuels
Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R530-JA02FR-Manuels
Samsung-UE40C6000-UE40C6000RW-Manuels
Samsung-Congelateur-1porteA-277-L-Blanc-RZ80FHSW-Manuels
Samsung-GT-B5310-Manuels
Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-GT-B5310-Manuels
Samsung-32-LE32D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LCD-TV-Manuels
Samsung-46-UE46D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-UE55ES6560S-Manuels
Samsung-UE46ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES8000S-Manuels
Samsung-UE55ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-TV-3D-UE55ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-AQV18UGAX-Manuels
Samsung-UE50EH5300W-Manuels
Samsung-LE46A676-LE46A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-CW21Z503N-Manuels
Samsung-AQ18UGFN-Manuels
Samsung-Refrigerateur-DP-A275-L-Blanc-RT34GBSW-Manuels
Samsung-UE46ES6100W-Manuels
Samsung-RR92HASX-Manuels
Samsung-LE40S71B-Manuels
Samsung-UE32ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3DUE32ES6710S-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-GT-P1000-GT-P1000-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Lite-noir-Orange-GT-B7300-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT-I9100-Manuels
Samsung-Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFRGT-I8000-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFR-GT-I8000-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-7-noir-Open-market-GT-I8700-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-noir-Bouygues-GT-I7500-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-mini-gris-Open-market-GT-S5570-Manuels
Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1FR-Manuels
17,3" Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S01FR - Manuels
40", UE40D6500WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV - UE40D6500VS - Manuels
CLX-3185FW Manuels
Galaxy Ace GT-S5830
Galaxy S II GT-I9100
Galaxy Tab 8.9 GT-P7310/M16
Galaxy Tab 10.1 GT-P7500/M16
Galaxy YGT-S5360
LE32C350 LE32C350D1W
LE40C630 LE40C630K1W
MM-C330D
MM-D330D
Micro-chaîne, MM-D330DWXZF, série 3 - MM-D330 - Manuels
N145Plus - NP-N145P - Manuels
N150 - NP-N150 - Manuels
RSH5UEPN
SGH-F490
Samsung Galaxy Ace noir - Open market - GT-S5830 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S II noir - Open market - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S III - GT-I9300 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S noir - Open market - GT-I9000 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy NoteGT-N7000
Samsung Galaxy SGT-I9000
Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S03FR - Manuels
T23A550 T23A550
UE40D6500ZF UE40D6500VS
UE55ES8000/ZF, Slim LED 55", SMART INTERACTION, 3D - UE55ES8000S - Manuels
Wave 575 GT-S5750E
Wave II GT-S8530
16/4ppm Imprimante laser couleur CLP-310 Manuels
16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3170FN Manuels
16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3185FW Manuels Samsung
16/4ppm Multifonction laser couleur CLX-3185 Manuels Samsung
samsung-Wave-II-noir-Open-market-GT-S8530-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-578-noir-Open-market-GT-S5780-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-market-GT-S5330-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-3-noir-Open-market-GT-S8600-Manuels
Samsung-Player-HD-noir-Open-market-GT-I8910-Manuels
Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels
Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-W-noir-Open-market-GT-I8350-Manuels
PRODUITS SAMSUNG : |
Belkin Chargeur Secteur pour Samsung Galaxy S |
Belkin Coque pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire Translucide |
Belkin Etui cuir Verve Folio pour Samsung Galaxy S II |
Belkin Etui Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir |
Belkin Kit de Charge Secteur + Automobile pour Samsung Galaxy S |
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3 |
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Anti-reflets |
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Transparentes |
Belkin Micro-Chargeur allume-cigares pour Samsung Galaxy S |
Belkin Protection d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Confidentialité 360° |
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung |
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung |
Coque semi-rigide glossy noire pour Samsung Galaxy S II |
Déclencheur sans Fil Hahnel combi TF pour Canon/Pentax/Samsung |
Enceintes iLuv iSM524 noir pour Samsung Galaxy Tab |
Etui-Brassard Belkin DualFit pour Samsung Galaxy S II |
Etui Samsung CC9S70B noir |
Fnac chargeur secteur POWY pour Samsung SGH-D800 |
G-Mobility Pack confort pour Samsung Galaxy SII i9100 |
Imprimante Samsung CLX-3185FN - Ethernet |
Kensington Etui pliant pour Samsung Galaxy Tab |
Le Tanneur Etui cuir Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S11 I9100 - Noir |
Lunettes 3D actives Samsung SSG-4100GB |
Modelabs 2 protections écran pour Samsung Galaxy ACE S5830 |
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran One Touch pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Transparentes |
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Transparentes |
Muvit Adaptateur Jack 3,5 mm pour Samsung (ancienne connectique) |
Muvit Coque à rabat Agenda pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Noire |
Muvit Coque Doodle Coeur pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S |
Muvit Coque Doodle Extraterrestres pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S |
Muvit Coque Doodle Rose pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S |
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy Ace |
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire |
Muvit Etui Clapet pour Samsung I9100 - Noir |
Muvit Etui Slim Clapet pour Samsung Galaxy Note |
Muvit Housse Minigel pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire |
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung nexus S - 1 Miroir/1 Secret |
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung S5830 |
Muvit Pack Accessoires pour Samsung S5830 |
Muvit Sticker Carbone pour Samsung I9100 |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Ibiza |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love London |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love New-York |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Paris |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Tokyo |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - United Kingdom |
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - USA |
QDOS Coque Cubic pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 |
QDOS Coque Steel 4 pour Samsung Galaxy S II |
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED |
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste |
Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD |
Samsung B5722 Double SIM |
Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles |
Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310 |
Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB |
Samsung batterie IA-BP420E |
Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST |
Samsung batterie SLB-10A |
Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS |
Samsung BD-E5300 |
Samsung BD-E5500 3D |
Samsung BD-E6100 3D |
Samsung BD-E8300 3D |
Samsung BD-ES5000 |
Samsung BD-ES6000 3D |
Samsung C3050 Stratus |
Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1" |
Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung |
Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100 |
Samsung CB20A12 |
Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir |
Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB |
Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir |
Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB |
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir |
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir |
Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet |
Samsung CLP-C300A |
Samsung CLP-K300A |
Samsung CLP-M300A |
Samsung CLP-Y300A |
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi |
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0 |
Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet |
Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet |
Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet |
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Blanche |
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Noire |
Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go - 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 512 Go - 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go - 830 Series |
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series |
Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX |
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome |
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Sennheiser RS170 |
Samsung DP7000A3B-A01FR 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 |
Samsung DP700A3B-S02FR 23" LED Tactile |
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel |
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose |
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi |
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi + Etui |
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi |
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi + Etui |
Samsung E1150 - Silver |
Samsung ES90 Noir |
Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir |
Samsung Etui coque pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Noir |
Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir |
Samsung Etui rabat pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir |
Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S |
Samsung EX1 |
Samsung Flash SEF15A |
Samsung Flash SEF20A |
Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Android) |
Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android) |
Samsung Galaxy Note |
Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc |
Samsung Galaxy Note - Dark Blue |
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc |
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir |
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Blanc Marbre |
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Bleu Galet |
Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 16 Go |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi + HP Housse Mini Sleeve 10,2" pour Netbook et Tablette - Ocean Drive |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Noir Wifi |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Argent |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Blanc |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 7.0" LED 8 Go |
Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi |
Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Android) |
Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Android) |
Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir |
Samsung Graveur Externe BluRay SE-506AB |
Samsung HMX-F80 Noir |
Samsung HMX-Q20 Noir |
Samsung HMX-QF20 Noir |
Samsung HMX-W350 Noir (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go |
Samsung HMX-W350 Rouge (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go |
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1" |
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9" |
Samsung HT-D330 |
Samsung HT-D350 |
Samsung HT-D4500 |
Samsung HT-D5000 3D |
Samsung HT-E4200 3D |
Samsung HT-E4500 3D |
Samsung HT-E5200 3D |
Samsung HT-E5530 3D |
Samsung HT-ES4200 3D |
Samsung HT-ES6200 3D |
Samsung HT-ES8200 3D |
Samsung HW-E350 |
Samsung HW-E450 |
Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android) |
Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1" |
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX |
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220 |
Samsung kit HDMI |
Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm |
Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm |
Samsung LE32E420 |
Samsung LE40D503 |
Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500 |
Samsung ML-2010D3 |
Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome |
Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi |
Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome |
Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi |
Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet |
Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome |
Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi |
Samsung MLT-D1052S |
Samsung MLT-D1082S |
Samsung MLT-D1092S |
Samsung MM-D430D |
Samsung MM-E320 |
Samsung MV800 Noir |
Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir |
Samsung NP300E7A-S09FR 17,3" LED |
Samsung NP700Z5C 15.6" LED |
Samsung NP-RC730-S07FR 17.3"LED |
Samsung NX1000 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS |
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8 |
Samsung NX 50 - 200 mm f/4.0 - 5.6 ED OIS II i-Fonction; Dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides |
Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200 |
Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100 |
Samsung Pack HMX-F800 Noir : Caméscope HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go |
Samsung Pack HMX-Q200 Noir : Caméscope Full HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go |
Samsung PC portable NP300E5A-S0AFR 15.6"LED |
Samsung PL210 Noir |
Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go |
Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal |
Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante |
Samsung PS43E450 |
Samsung PS43E490 3D |
Samsung PS43E490 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go |
Samsung PS51E450 |
Samsung PS51E490 3D |
Samsung PS51E530 |
Samsung Q3 noir 4 Go |
Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go |
Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED |
Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes |
Samsung S19A100N Moniteur 18,5" - Flat Panel Display |
Samsung S22B150N 21,5" LED |
Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED |
Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D |
Samsung S23B350H 23" LED |
Samsung S23B550V Moniteur 23" LED |
Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED |
Samsung S27B350H 27" LED |
Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions |
Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet |
Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions |
Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi |
Samsung SCX-4200A |
Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet |
Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi |
Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet |
Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0 |
Samsung SE-218BB graveur DVD externe ultra slim USB 2.0 |
Samsung SLB07A pour ST50 |
Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000 |
Samsung ST200F Noir - WiFi |
Samsung ST200F Rouge - WiFi |
Samsung ST200F Violet - WiFi |
Samsung ST65 Noir |
Samsung ST65 Rouge |
Samsung ST66 Noir |
Samsung ST77 Blanc |
Samsung ST77 Noir |
Samsung ST77 Rouge |
Samsung ST77 Violet |
Samsung ST88 Noir |
Samsung station d'accueil |
Samsung station d'accueil HD2 |
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9" |
Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR |
Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED |
Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED |
Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D |
Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD |
Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX |
Samsung T22A300 21.5" Tuner TNT HD |
Samsung T22B300EW 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD |
Samsung T24B301 24" LED Tuner TNT HD |
Samsung T27A550 27" LED Tuner TNT HD |
Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir |
Samsung UE19ES4000 LED |
Samsung UE22ES5000 LED |
Samsung UE22ES5410 LED |
Samsung UE26EH4000 LED |
Samsung UE26EH4500 LED |
Samsung UE32EH4000 LED |
Samsung UE32EH5000 LED |
Samsung UE32ES5500 LED |
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D |
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go |
Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc |
Samsung UE37ES5500 LED |
Samsung UE40D5000 LED |
Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D |
Samsung UE40EH5000 LED |
Samsung UE40ES5500 LED |
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D |
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go |
Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D |
Samsung UE46EH5000 LED |
Samsung UE46ES5500 LED |
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D |
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go |
Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc |
Samsung UE46ES8000 LED 3D |
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D |
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go |
Samsung UE60ES6100 LED 3D |
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" - Aluminium + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil |
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium |
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium+ Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir |
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise |
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Marron |
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Rose |
Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10 |
Samsung Wave 575 |
Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi |
Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi |
Samsung WB690 Noir |
Samsung WB700 Noir |
Samsung WB850F Noir - WiFi - GPS |
Samsung WMN250M accroche murale |
Samsung XE700T1A-A02FR 11,6" 64 Go SSD |
Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go |
Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go |
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go |
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose |
Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go |
Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go |
Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go |
Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go |
Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go |
Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go |
Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go |
Samyang 14 mm f/2.8 Aspherical IF ED UMC; Monture Samsung NX |
Samyang 35 mm f/1.4 AS UMC; Monture Samsung NX |
Samyang Fish-eye 8 mm f/3.5 Aspherical IF MC; Monture Samsung Type NX |
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go |
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go + Casque weSC Conga Matte noir |
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 8 Go |
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 5" 8 Go |
T'nB Coque Clip On pour Samsung Galaxy SII - New York |
Toner Samsung CLT-C4072S - Cyan |
Toner Samsung CLT-C4092S Cyan |
Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S - Noir |
Toner Samsung CLT-K4092S Noir |
Toner Samsung CLT-M4072S - Magenta |
Toner Samsung CLT-M4092S Magenta |
Toner Samsung CLT-P4092C - Pack de 4 Toners |
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4072S - Jaune |
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4092S Jaune |
Toner Samsung MLT-D1042S - Noir |
We Digital by Samsung - Silver We 1 To USB 2.0 |
We Digital by Samsung - Silver WE 2 To USB 2.0 |
Xqisit Coque iPlate Glossy pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche |
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Blanche |
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Noire |
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche |
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire |
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanc |
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir |
Samsung - Aspirateur robot Navibot SR8845
Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86G0 gris foncé/fuchsia
Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac SC4780 noir
Samsung - Four micro-ondes MW73B - blanc
SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 36 L - Micro ondes 36 L - CP1395ES
SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 42 L - Micro ondes 42 L - CQ1570U
Samsung - Micro-ondes combiné CE117PT-B
SAMSUNG - Micro-ondes Grill simultané GS89F-1SP
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste
Samsung Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86H0 gris clair/bleu
Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD
Samsung B5722 Double SIM
Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles
Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310
Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB
Samsung batterie IA-BP420E
Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST
Samsung batterie SLB-10A
Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS
Samsung BD-E5300
Samsung BD-E5500 3D
Samsung BD-E8300 3D
Samsung C3050 Stratus
Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"
Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung
Samsung Caméra additionnelle de vidéosurveillance SEB-1015RWP EX
Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100
Samsung CB20A12
Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir
Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB
Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir
Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 WiFi
Samsung CLP-325 WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung CLP-C300A
Samsung CLP-K300A
Samsung CLP-M300A
Samsung CLP-Y300A
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet
Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung Coque silicone Croisillons pour nexus S
Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series
Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi
Samsung E1150 - Silver
Samsung E2550
Samsung EcoBlue SC61E0 bleu azur
Samsung ES30 Noir
Samsung ES30 Noir + Carte SD 2 Go
Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir
Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir
Samsung Etui flap en cuir pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - Noir
Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung Flash SEF15A
Samsung Flash SEF20A
Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Note
Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy Note - Rose
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir 16 Go 3G
Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Xcover s5690 (sous Androïd) - Smartphone Samsung Solide certifié IP67
Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung HT-D330
Samsung HT-D350
Samsung HT-D423
Samsung HT-D4500
Samsung HT-D5000 3D
Samsung HT-E4200 3D
Samsung HT-E4500 3D
Samsung HT-E5200 3D
Samsung HT-ES6200 3D WiFi
Samsung HW-E450
Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)
Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220
Samsung Kit Etui + Clavier Bluetooth pour Galaxy Tab 10,1" - Brun foncé
Samsung kit HDMI
Samsung kit HDMI
Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm
Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm
Samsung LE40D550
Samsung Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Galaxy S2 - Transparente/Miroir
Samsung Lot de 2 Protections d'écran pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung Lunettes 3D SSG-3050GB
SAMSUNG ME106V-SX
Samsung ME82V Micro-onde monofonction
SAMSUNG ME82V-SX
SAMSUNG Micro ondes MW87Y
SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE117APT B
SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE137NEMX
SAMSUNG Micro-ondes FW113T002
Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500
Samsung ML-2010D3
Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi
Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung MLT-D1052S
Samsung MLT-D1082S
Samsung MLT-D1092S
Samsung MM-D430D
Samsung MV800 Noir
Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir
Samsung NP300E7A-S03FR 17,3" LED
Samsung NP700Z5A-S02FR 15,6" LED
Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200
Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100
Samsung Pack étui cuir + chargeur + protection d'écran pour Galaxy S
Samsung PL170 Noir
Samsung PL210 Noir
Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go
Samsung PL90 Noir et Rouge
Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal
Samsung Player Mini C3300 - Noir
Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante
Samsung PS43D450
Samsung PS43E450
Samsung PS43E490 3D
Samsung PS51E450
Samsung PS51E490 3D
Samsung PS59D530
Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go
Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED
Samsung RC730-S06FR 17,3" LED
Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes
Samsung S22A300B 21,5" TFT
Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED
Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D
Samsung S23B350H 23" LED
Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED
Samsung S27B350H 27" LED
Samsung SC4340 noir ébène
Samsung SC4790 - Aspirateur sans sac - traineau - rouge
Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi
Samsung SCX-4200A
Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SE-084D graveur DVD externe slim USB 2.0
Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0
Samsung SLB07A pour ST50
Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000
Samsung ST65 Noir
Samsung ST65 Rouge
Samsung station d'accueil
Samsung station d'accueil HD2
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR
Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED
Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED
Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D
Samsung SyncMaster S24A350H 24" LED
Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX
Samsung T22A350 21,5" LED Tuner TNT
Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir
Samsung UE19D4010 LED
Samsung UE19ES4000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5410 LED
Samsung UE26EH4000 LED
Samsung UE26EH4500 LED
Samsung UE32D5000 LED
Samsung UE32EH4000 LED
Samsung UE32EH5000 LED
Samsung UE32ES5500 LED
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE40D5000 LED
Samsung UE40D5710 LED
Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D
Samsung UE40EH5000 LED
Samsung UE40ES5500 LED
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D
Samsung UE46EH5000 LED
Samsung UE46ES5500 LED
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir
Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil
Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0
Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise
Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir
Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10
Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi
Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi
Samsung WB700 Noir
Samsung WB750 Noir
Samsung WIS09ABGN LinkStick WLAN-Adapter
Samsung WMN250M accroche murale
Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go
Samsung YP-F3 noir 2 Go
Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose
Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP400B5B-S02FR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/BD-C8500/XEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201004/20100405125800515/01960B-BD-C8200_8500-XEF-FRA-0323.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/MM-D470D/ZF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120103150428464/AH68-02345F-MM-D470D-FRA-20120103.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP200B5B-A01FR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300V3A-A01FR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-N7000ZBESFR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120809172648710/GT-N7000_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120716_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120611165201603/GT-P3110_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120608_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-N7000RWASFR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201203/20120329200748757/GT-N7000_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.1_120126_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216180827802/GT-N7000_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.1_111104_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120809173956440/GT-P7510_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120809_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111205085630494/GT-P7510_UM_Orange_Honeycomb_Fre_Rev.1.0_111202_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120713085451049/GT-P7510_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-P7510FKAXEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120802111559199/GT-I9070P_UM_Orange_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120629_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120517111406195/GT-I9070P_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.0_120510_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120802111559199/GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120424154452484/GT-P3100_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120424_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201209/20120917105131603/GT-P3100_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120801_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-P5110TSAXEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120810190309322/GT-P5110_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120808_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120614144504602/GT-P5110_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120614_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I5800DKABOG-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201008/20100809184447671/GT-I5800_UM_Open_Fre_Rev.1.0_100722_cms.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201009/20100907222536765/GT-I5800_QSG_Open_Eng_Rev.1.1_100907a_cms.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110525183942011/GT-I5800_QSG_EU_Froyo_Eng_UK_Rev.1.1_110525_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110525175249448/GT-I5800_QSG_EU_Froyo_Eng_Rev.1.1_110525_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201105/20110530173657729/GT-I5800_UM_Open_Froyo_Fre_Rev.1.1_110527_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I9001HKDFTM-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111212155049797/GT-I9001_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.3_111212_Screen.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LF22TOWHBDN/EN-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201211/20121102145205481/BN68-03899A-04.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121108171138109/BN46-00315A-Fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121108171138109/BN46-00315A-Eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP550P5C-T04FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121113125618982/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121113125618982/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE32D5720RSXZF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110517143435031/[UD5700-XN]BN68-03506F-03L04-0427.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216084511364/Web_W_X6DVBEUA_Fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216084511364/Web_W_X6DVBEUA_Eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I9000RWYSFR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE55D8000YSXZF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128101809663/02_FRA_GPDVBEUA-0106.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128101809663/01_ENG_GPDVBEUA-0106.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120314192959318/[UD8000-XN]BN68-03442T-00L04-0804.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120405165711377/2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE46ES6710SXZF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120405165711377/2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121110095845360/02-XTDVBEUE-FRA-1109.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121110095845360/01-XTDVBEUE-ENG-1109.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120712095934377/2012_Skype_FRA-0424.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120712095934377/2012_Skype_ENG-0424.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-RV515-S04FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/CD/201104/20110408115840622/DoC160-RV515-RV415-Scala2-15-14-AMD.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026202221731/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026202221731/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP900X4D-A01FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP350E7C-S0BFR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121022141232121/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121022141232121/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120518170921365/EN/english.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/DR/201205/20120521130845677/FR/french.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/ML-2160/SEE-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120322160533913/BN68-03304C-00.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120622172918410/BN46-00030A-Fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120622172918410/BN46-00030A-Eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE55C7700WSXZF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502130400267/02230C-01-BD-E8900-ZF-0413.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502130543045/Smart_Hub-FRA-0309.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502133933796/AllShare-FRA-0221.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201004/20100426150918218/7Series_Power_consumption_LED_TV.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201005/20100529095515140/BN68-02590B-03L04-0518.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP700G7A-S01FR
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP305E5A-A01FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026193501356/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090428183905421/YPP3J-COMMON-ENGLISH3.0.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200904/20090407081834937/YPP3J-02154C-XEF-QG1.0-NOCD.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090428183905421/YPP3J-EUROPE-FRENCH3.0.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201005/20100504091945781/GT-E1151_UM_Open_Fre_Rev.1.0_100311.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100324124741578/BN68-02592F-01L04_0316.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200805/20080520175711468_BN68-01409H-01L02-0429.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200805/20080530182204609_Pearl-France-01409H-Eng-0530.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LT24A350EW/EN-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300E5A-S08FR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE22C350D1WXZF-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40R86BDX/XEC-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200703/20070322190622750_BN68-01169B-01L08-0313.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE40ES5700SXZF-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LT22A300EW/EN-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-U600HBAXEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200803/20080318192114953_SGH-U600_Eng.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200903/20090312154510796/SGH-U600_French_090311_Rev1.3.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090410095951906/SGH-U600_UG_090311_Rev1.3.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP305V5A-S02FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120420172612547/WB850F-CE_DoC_in_French.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/AQ18FAN-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200703/20070308174715062_FORTE_DB98-27531A_IB_F.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40B620R3WXXC-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200909/20090925093818484/BN68-02098D-01Eng-0909.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-Z360ZSAFTM-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200801/20080108134949406_SGH-Z360_UG_ORA_Fre_Rev.1.1_061123.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/EK-GC100ZWAXEF-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP900X4D-A02FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP700Z7C-S02FR-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-RC710-S02FR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-E590NSAXEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200706/20070627104827281_SGH-E590_UG_Eng_Rev.1.1_070622.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/RS6178UGDSR/EF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120316175747467/DA99-01779L.pdf
https://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300E7A-S0CFR-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/RT50QMSW1/XEF-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121119193716527/DA99-01906C_v0.6.pdf
http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE46EH6030WXZF-downloads
http://www.samsung.com/sg/support/model/GT-I9300RWDXSP-downloads
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121117090011154/GT-I9300_UM_EU_Jellybean_Eng_Rev.1.1_121113_Screen.pdf
http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121122102418917/GT-I9300_UM_SEA_Jellybean_Chi_Rev.1.1_121116_Screen.pdf
Smartphone
SGH-i320
User’s GuideTable of Contents
2
Table of Contents
Important safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
CHAPTER 1 Getting started
What’s in the box? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Getting to know your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Installing the SIM card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Installing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Charging your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Turning your phone on or off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
CHAPTER 2 The basics
Using the Home screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Start menu screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Entering text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Customising your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Locking the keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Using the Program Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Using an optional memory card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Adding and removing programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Managing certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Resetting your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Using online help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
SIM AT (SIM Application Toolkit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
CHAPTER 3 Synchronisation
Installing ActiveSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Customising connection settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Connecting your phone to a computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Synchronising information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Customising synchronisation settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47Table of Contents
3
CHAPTER 4 Call functions
Turning the phone functions on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Using the Dialling screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Advanced calling features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Answering or ignoring a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Options during a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Call-related features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Customising your phone functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
CHAPTER 5 Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Internet Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
WAP Browser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Pocket MSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
CHAPTER 6 Organiser
Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
D-Day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Voice Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
WorldClock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
CHAPTER 7 Multimedia
Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Windows Media Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Picture & Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122Table of Contents
4
CHAPTER 8 Extra programs
Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Smart Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
StopWatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Voice Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Picsel Viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
File Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
SIM Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Task Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
CHAPTER 9 Getting connected
Beaming with infrared connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Beaming with Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Modem link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Connecting to the Internet or your network . . . . . . . . . 148
CHAPTER 10 Troubleshooting
General problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Call problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Power and charging problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Application problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
CHAPTER 11 Regulatory notices
SAR certification information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
European union notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Important safety information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Safety precautions for power supply unit . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Care and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Microsoft End User License Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS
AND LIMITATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1735
Important safety precautions
Read these guidelines before using your wireless phone.
Failure to comply with them may be dangerous or illegal.
Drive safely at all times
Do not use a hand-held phone while driving. Park the
vehicle first.
Switch off the phone when refuelling
Do not use the phone at a refuelling point (service station)
or near fuels or chemicals.
Switch off in an aircraft
Wireless phones can cause interference. Using them in an
aircraft is both illegal and dangerous.
Switch off the phone near all medical equipment
Hospitals or health care facilities may be using equipment
that could be sensitive to external radio frequency energy.
Follow any regulations or rules in force.
Interference
All wireless phones may be subject to interference, which
could affect their performance.
Be aware of special regulations
Meet any special regulations in force in any area and
always switch off your phone whenever it is forbidden to
use it, or when it may cause interference or danger.
Water resistance
Your phone is not water-resistant. Keep it dry.
Sensible use
Use only in the normal position (held to the ear). Avoid
unnecessary contact with the antenna when the phone is
switched on.6
Emergency calls
Key in the emergency number for your present location,
then press .
Keep your phone away from small children
Keep the phone and all its parts, including accessories, out
of the reach of small children.
Accessories and batteries
Use only Samsung-approved accessories and batteries. Use
of any unauthorised accessories could damage your phone
and may be dangerous.
CAUTION:
• The phone could explode if the battery is replaced with an
incorrect type.
• Dispose of used batteries according to the manufacturer’s
instructions.
Qualified service
Only qualified service personnel may install or repair your
phone. Failure to do so may invalidate the warranty.
For more detailed safety information, see “Important safety
information” on page 166.
Note: Depending on your country, your phone and accessories
may appear different from the illustrations in this guide.
At very high volume, prolonged listening to a
headset can damage your hearing.1
7
Getting started
Congratulations on the purchase of your new Smartphone!
This chapter helps you set up your phone, charge the
phone’s batteries, and familiarise yourself with the different
components of your phone.
What’s in the box?
Your package contains the following items:
In addition, you can obtain the following accessories for
your phone from your local Samsung dealer:
Note: The items supplied with your phone and the accessories
available at your Samsung dealer may vary, depending
on your country or service provider.
Phone PC data cable Batteries
Travel charger CD-ROMs
*
* One contains Microsoft ActiveSync software, Add-on software and
programs, and the other contains User’s Guide in PDF format.
Quick reference guide
• Car charger/adapter • Battery holder
• Standard battery • Bluetooth hands-free car kit
• Travel charger • Straight headset
• PC data cable • Bluetooth USB dongle kit
• Bluetooth mono &
stereo headsetGetting started
8
Getting to know your phone
Front view
Volume keys
Send key
Left soft key
Infrared port
Home key
OK key
Microphone
Navigation (Up/Down/
Left/Right) keys
Earpiece
Right soft key
End/Power on
or off key
Display
Back/Clear key
Alphanumeric keys/
Special function keysGetting started
9
Rear view
Keys of your phone
Battery cover
Camera lens
Charger/PC data
cable jack
Quick List/
Key Lock key
Camera key
Camera flash
Headset jack
External speaker
Key Description
• Press to open the Quick List screen.
• Press and hold to lock the keys.
• Press to open the Voice Notes program.
• Press and hold to turn on the camera.Getting started
10
• Press to adjust the earpiece and speaker
volume.
• Press to mute the call ringer as a call comes
in. Press and hold to reject the call.
Press to perform the command shown on the
screen immediately above the key.
Press to switch to the Home screen from a
program.
• Press to return to the previous screen.
• Press to delete characters in a text input field.
• Press to scroll through a list.
• Press to move the cursor in a text input field.
• Press to confirm your selection or input.
• Press to open the Dialling screen.
• Press to make or answer a call.
• Press and hold to turn the phone on or off.
• Press to end a call.
~ Press to enter numbers and characters.
Press to switch between characters on the
upper half of the keys and characters on the
lower half in a text input filed.
Press to change case in a text input field.
Press to change the text input mode.
Key DescriptionGetting started
11
Installing the SIM card
When you subscribe to a cellular network, you are provided
with a plug-in SIM card loaded with your subscription
details, such as your PIN, any optional services available,
and many other details.
• Keep all miniature SIM cards out of the reach of small
children.
• The SIM card and its contacts can be easily damaged by
scratches or bending, so be careful when handling the
card.
• When installing the SIM card, always make sure that the
phone is switched off before you remove the battery.
Press and hold to activate or deactivate the
Silent profile from the Home screen.
Press to delete characters.
• Press to confirm your selection or input.
• Press to start a new line in a text input field.
Press to open the Messaging program.
Press to enter a comma in a text input field.
Key DescriptionGetting started
12
Inserting the SIM card
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Insert and slide the SIM card under the two tabs, as
shown, ensuring that the gold coloured contacts of the
card are face down into the phone.
Continue to install the battery. See the next page.
Removing the SIM card
To remove the SIM card, slide the card out of the holder, as
shown.Getting started
13
Installing the battery
Your phone is powered by a rechargeable Li-ion battery.
Use only approved batteries and chargers.
Installing the battery
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Insert the battery into the battery compartment, with
the gold-culoured contact toward the top of the phone.
3. Close the battery cover.Getting started
14
Removing the battery
1. If necessary, switch off the phone by pressing and
holding until the power-off image displays.
2. Remove the battery cover.
3. Lift the battery away from the phone.
Charging your phone
1. Plug the connector of the travel charger into the jack on
the right side of the phone.
2. Plug the travel charger into a standard AC wall outlet.
The LED on the charger will indicate the charging
progress by the following colours:
• Red: the phone is being charged.
• Green: the phone is fully charged.
• Orange: the travel charger is not plugged in correctly.
Check the phone and the charger.
3. When charging is finished, unplug the travel charger
from the power outlet. Getting started
15
4. Remove the travel charger from the phone by pressing
the buttons on both sides of the connector and pulling
the connector out.
Note: Do not remove batteries while charging. It may cause
malfunctions and may damage the device.
Low battery warning
Your phone displays the Battery Very Low icon ( ) and a
warning message when the battery gets very low. If this
happens, charge the battery.
Turning your phone on or off
Press and hold to turn on your phone. The phone is
logged into your home network and receives the signal
from the network. You can now make or answer a call
and use programs on the phone.
To turn off the phone, press and hold .2
16
The basics
This chapter explains basic information about using your
phone, such as customising your phone and using online
help.
Using the Home screen
When you turn on your phone, the Home screen, the
phone’s idle screen, appears. You can also access this
screen by pressing from any program.
On the Home screen, you can view important information
for the day or messages at a glance. You can also quickly
switch to the programs you recently accessed.
Press the left soft key to
open the Start menu and
switch to a program.
Press the right soft
key to open
Contacts.
Status icons indicates
your phone’s current
status. See the next
page.
Quick Launcher:
Select to view
appointments or
messages, or
change the profile
settings.The basics
17
Status bar
On the top line of the screen, the Status bar displays icons
to show your phone’s current status. Followings are some
of the status icons you may see:
Icon Description
Shows the strength of the signal.
You can also view the following service status:
• : You are out of a service area.
• : The phone functions are turned off.
Appears when a call is in progress.
Appears when a data call is in progress.
Appears when the current call is on hold.
Appears when a GPRS connection is available in
the network. When a GPRS connection is active,
appears.
Appears when you are roaming out of your home
service area and logged onto a different GPRS
network.
Shows the level of your battery power. The more
bars you see, the more power you have
remaining.
When the battery level is very low, appears.
Appears when the ring type has been set to Silent
in the current profile. For details, see page 25.The basics
18
Appears when the ring type has been set to
Vibrate in the current profile or the ring tone in
Sounds has been set to Vibrate. Also, appears
when the Silent profile is activated. For details,
see page 25.
Indicates that you can make calls using phone
line 1 or 2 only (network service).
Appears when you’re roaming outside of your
home area and logged onto a different network.
Appears when Bluetooth is activated. For details,
see page 144.
Appears when a text (SMS) or multimedia (MMS)
message has been received.
Appears that an instant message has been
received.
Appears when a new voicemail has been
received.
• : A new voicemail from line 1.
• : A new voicemail from line 2.
• : A new voicemail from both lines.
Appears when there is a call you have missed.
Appears when you have set incoming calls to be
diverted to another destination.
Icon DescriptionThe basics
19
Accessing information from the Home
screen
From the Home screen, you can:
• view upcoming appointments
• change the profile option
• view unread text (SMS) or multimedia (MMS) messages
To change information on each item:
1. On the Home screen, scroll to the item you want to
change by pressing the Navigation keys and press .
2. Access appointments or messages, or change the profile
setting.
For more information on changing these items, see
the appropriate instructions for each task in this
guide.
3. Press or to return to the Home screen.The basics
20
Customising the Home screen
You can customise the Home screen according to your
preferences.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Display → Home Screen.
3. Press the Up or Down key to scroll to an option and then
Left or Right key to change the setting.
The following options are available:
• Home screen layout: Select the layout to be used for
the Home screen.
• Colour scheme: Select the colour scheme to be used
for the Home screen.
• Background image: Select an image to use as a
background image on the Home screen.
• Time out: Specify the length of time the phone waits
before returning the display to the Home screen if the
phone is not used.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Start menu screen
On the Start menu, you can access all of the programs for
your phone. From the Home screen, press the Start soft
key to open the Start menu screen.
You can change the start menu type. Press the Start soft
key, and select Settings → Display → Start Menu Style.
Then select Grid or List .The basics
21
Opening programs or folders
Scroll to a progarm or a folder by pressing the Navigation
keys and press to open it. You can also press the
number key assigned to the program you want.
Switching between programs
Your phone is a multi-tasking product. You can run multiple
programs at the same time and switch from one program
to another. From any application, press or to swich
to the Home screen. Then access another one from the
Quick Launcher or Start menu.
Note: When you use a GPRS connection, pressing
terminates the connection. If you want the current
connection to continue, press , or as many
times as necessary, to switch to the Home screen.
Closing programs
Using Task Manager, you can end the programs which are
currently open.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then More soft key, press the
Task Manager.
3. Scroll to a program, press the Stop soft key. To close all
of the running programs, Press the Menu soft key and
select Stop All.The basics
22
Entering text
Your phone is equipped with a QWERTY keypad to support
easy and quick text input. You can enter text as you would
when using a computer’s keyboard.
The keys are labelled with alphabet on the lower half and
numbers and symbols on the upper half. Press the key
corresponding to the character you want to enter. To switch
between the upper characters and lower characters, press
.
You can move the cursor by pressing the Navigation keys.
To delete a character, press .
In addition, you can use the following function keys:
• : deletes characters.
• : starts a new line.
• : changes case or switches to Capital Lock mode.
• : changes the text input mode. You can switch between
ABC mode and T9 mode in which displays the word
choices for your key presses. 123 mode and Symbol
mode are also available for entering numbers and
symbols.
• : switches to 123 mode.The basics
23
Customising your phone
You can customise the phone settings to suit the way you
work.
Regional settings
Using Regional Settings, you can change number,
currency, and time and date formats appropriate to the
countries in question.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Regional
Settings.
3. Select the option you want in each field.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
5. If you changed the Language or Locale option, press
the OK soft key.
Then you need to turn the phone off and then back on to
make your changes take effect.
Time and date settings
The Date and Time setting enables you to set the date,
time, and time zone.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Clock & Alarm → Date and Time.
Note: By using Alarm on the Clock & Alarm screen, you can
set alarms to ring at a specified time. The basics
24
3. Set your time zone and the current date and time.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Note: You can change the time and date format to be
displayed in Regional Settings.
Power settings
You can conserve battery power by adjusting the time-out
settings for the display and the backlight of the keypad and
display or adjusting the display brightness.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Power Management.
3. Select the power settings:
• Main battery: You can check the remaining battery
power.
• Backlight time out: You can select the length of time
the backlight stays on. A backlight illuminates the
display and the keypad. When you press any key, the
backlight turns on and remains on for the backlight
time out period.
• Display time out: You can select the length of time
the display stays on. During standby, the phone goes
to Sleep mode after a specified period of time, so very
little power is being consumed.
• Display Brightness: You can adjust the brightness
for the display.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
25
Accessibility settings
You can configure the options to increase the accessibility
to your phone’s functions.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Accessibility.
3. Select the options you want.
• System font size: You can set the size of the font on
your screen.
• Confirmation time out: You can set the delay before
an unconfirmed action times out.
• In-call alert volume: You can set the volume of the
alert tone that sounds when you are on a call.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Sound settings
You can customise sound settings for various events
happening on the phone.
Setting sounds and notifications
Your phone reminds you in various ways when you have
something to do, receive a message, or press the keys on
the phone.
For example, if you have set up an appointment, you are
notified in any of the following ways:
• A sound, which you can specify, plays,
• The LED indicator flashes, or
• Your phone vibrates.
You can change phone sounds by choosing types or sounds
for each event.The basics
26
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Sounds.
3. Select the event for which to specify a sound.
4. Select the reminder type or ringtone.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Notes:
• You can connect to the Internet and then download ringtones
that are in a .wav or .mid format.
• To use an .mp3 or .wma file as your call ringtone, it must be
saved in a folder in Storage, Storage Card or My Documents.
Changing the sound profile
Using Profiles, you can adjust and customise the phone
tones for different events or environments and then apply
the settings as a group. The currently selected profile
displays on the Home screen.
To change profiles:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Profiles. The list of profiles opens.
3. Select the profile you want.
If you select Automatic, the profile will automatically
switch between Normal and Meeting according to your
calendar items.
Notes:
• You can quickly change the profile. Press and select the
profile you want from the Quick List.
• You can quickly activate or deactivate the Silent profile by
pressing and holding from the Home screen.The basics
27
To customise profiles:
1. On the Profiles screen, scroll to the profile you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit.
3. Change the settings in each field. Available options may
differ depending on the selected profile.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Notes:
• To change all profile settings to their factory default, press
the Menu soft key from the profile list and select Reset to
default.
• For the Headset profile, when you set the ring type to Silent
or Vibrate, you must manually answer calls even if the
Auto-answer in option is activated.
Owner information
Owner Information identifies the owner or user of the
phone. Set your contact information in case you have lost
the phone.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Owner
Information.
3. Fill in each input field.
To attach notes, enter notes in the Notes field.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
28
USB function setting
You can select how the phone functions when connected to
a computer via the USB port.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → USB.
3. Select one of the following functions for USB
connections:
• ActiveSync: Select this option if you want the phone
to communicate with ActiveSync.
• Mass Storage: The phone is perceived as an external
memory device.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Error reporting setting
Your phone has the Error Reporting function which informs
you of errors in a program that can give a crash to the
phone system. You can enable or disable this function.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Error
Reporting.
3. Select Enable or Disable and press the Done soft key.The basics
29
Security settings
With options in Security, you can protect your phone and
SIM card from unauthorised use.
Locking the phone
You can protect your phone using the Device Lock feature.
Once the feature is enabled, your phone is automatically
locked after the specified period of inactivity.
Note: Even if the phone is locked, you will be able to receive
calls.
To lock the phone:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Device Lock.
3. Select Prompt if device unused for and select a
length of time the phone waits for before locking itself
when it is not in use.
4. Scroll to the Password type field and select a password
type.
• Simple PIN: Use the PIN code supplied with the SIM
card.
• Strong alphanumeric: Use an alphanumeric
password. A password must be more than 7 characters
and contain at least 3 of uppercase and lowercase
letters, numbers, or punctuation marks.
5. Enter a password in the Password field.
6. Re-enter the same password in the Confirm password
field for confirmation. The basics
30
7. Press the Done soft key.
8. Press the Yes soft key.
Note: You can also manually lock the phone by pressing
and selecting Device lock from the Quick List.
To unlock your phone:
1. On the Home screen, press the Unlock soft key.
2. Enter the password and press the Done soft key.
Activating the SIM PIN
When SIM PIN is enabled, you must enter your PIN
supplied with your phone each time you turn the phone on
or insert the current SIM card into another device.
Consequently, any person who does not have your PIN
cannot use your phone without your approval.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Enable SIM
PIN.
3. Enter the PIN and press the Done soft key.
Locking the SIM card
When SIM Lock is enabled, your phone works only with the
current SIM card. To use another SIM card, you must enter
the SIM Lock password.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Enable SIM
Lock.The basics
31
3. Enter a password for your SIM card, and re-enter the
password for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Changing PIN2
A PIN 2 is used for certain functions supported by the SIM
card. You can change the PIN2 supplied with your SIM card
to a new one.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Change
PIN2.
3. Enter the current PIN2, then a new PIN2, and re-enter
the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Changing the call barring Password
You can change the default call barring password supplied
by your service provider.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Call Barring
Password.
3. Enter the current password, then a new password, and
re-enter the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.The basics
32
Menu shortcut settings
The number keys can be used as shortcut keys to directly
access specific programs that exist in the Start menu.
Note: You can also assign phone numbers, e-mail addresses,
or web pages in Contacts to the number keys as speed
dial entries. For details about setting the speed dial list,
see page 57.
Assigning a shortcut to a key
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Scroll to the program you want to assign to a key.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add Speed Dial.
4. If necessary, enter the name you want in the Name
field.
5. Select a location in the Keypad assignment field and
press the Done soft key.
Note: Up to 99 locations are available. Locations 0 and 1 are
reserved for the international call prefix “+” and the
voicemail centre number, respectively.
Accessing a menu using its shortcut
On the Home screen, use one of the following ways:
• For one-digit shourtcut keys, press and hold the number
key.
• For two-digit shortcut keys, press the first number key
and then press and hold the last number key.The basics
33
Note: To ensure that operations, such as moving or saving
files, proceed to completion, wait at least 50 seconds
before removing the battery.
Locking the keys
You can lock the keys on the phone to keep any accidental
key presses from causing a program’s launch or phone
switch on or off.
To lock the keypad, press and hold , or press and
select Key lock on the Quick List.
To unlock the keypad, press the Unlock soft key, and then
press .
Using the Program Launcher
Using the Program Launcher, you can view the programs in
the Start menu categorised by type, and quickly access
the program you want.
To open the Launcher:
Press and hold on the Home screen. You can also press
the Start soft key and then the More soft key, and select
Accessories → Program Launcher.
Opening a program
1. On the Launcher screen, press the Group soft key and
select the group you want.
2. Select the program you want.The basics
34
Moving a program within a group
1. On the Launcher screen, scroll to the program you want
to move.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Move.
3. When the selected program blinks, move the program to
the position you want by pressing the Up or Down key.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Managing groups
You can create new groups or delete the groups, or change
the order of the group list.
1. On the Launcher screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Group.
2. Press the Menu soft key to access the following options:
• New: allows you to add a new group.
• Delete: allows you to delete the selected group.
• Rename: allows you to change the name of the
group.
• Move: allows you to move the position of the group.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
35
Using an optional memory card
Your phone has an expansion slot compatible with micro SD
memory cards, which are primarily used to back up or
transfer files and data.
Note: Use only compatible memory cards with your phone.
Using incompatible memory cards, such as Secure
Digital (SD) cards, may damage the card, as well as the
phone, and data stored on the card.
Inserting the memory card
1. Turn off the phone and remove the battery cover and
the battery.
2. Push the memory card into the slot until it clicks into
place. The card is secure when it is not protruding from
the phone.
3. Install the battery into place and close the battery cover.The basics
36
Removing the memory card
To remove the card, push it in and release so that it is
disengaged from the slot. Then slide the card out.
Adding and removing programs
You can install any program created for your phone, as long
as the phone has enough memory. The most popular place
to find software for your phone is on the Microsoft web site
(http://www.microsoft.com/mobile/smartphone).
Adding programs using ActiveSync
You can install programs downloaded from the Internet or
included on the supplied software CD-ROM by performing
synchronisation between your phone and your computer.
First you need to determine what your phone and
processor type is so that you know which version of the
software to install.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Settings → More... → More... → About. Check the
version of your phone.The basics
37
2. Download a program to your computer from the
Internet or insert the CD-ROM that contains the
program into your computer.
Be sure to select the program designed for the phone
and your phone’s processor type.
3. Read any installation instructions, Read Me files, or
documentation that comes with the program.
4. Connect your phone to your computer and make sure
that the ActiveSync is activated.
For more information on ActiveSync, see page 42.
5. Double-click the *.exe file on the computer.
If the file is an installer, the installation wizard will
begin. Follow the instructions on the screen. Once the
software has been installed, the installer will
automatically transfer the software to your phone.
If the file is not an installer, you will see an error
message. You need to move this file to your phone by
using ActiveSync Explore to copy the program file to the
Start Menu folder on your phone.
Once installation is completed, you can view and open the
program by accessing the Start menu.
Adding a program directly from the
Internet
First, you need to determine what your phone and
processor type is so that you know which version of the
software to install.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Settings → More... → More... → About. Check the
version of your phone.The basics
38
2. Download the program to your phone straight from the
Internet using Internet Explorer.
Be sure to select the program designed for the phone
and your phone’s processor type.
3. Read any installation instructions, Read Me files, or
documentation that comes with the program.
4. Select the file, such as a *.xip or *.exe file. The
installation wizard will begin.
5. Follow the directions on the screen.
Once installation is completed, you can view and open the
program by accessing the Start menu.
Removing programs
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Remove Programs.
3. Select the program you want to delete.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Remove.
5. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
6. When you have finished, press the OK soft key.The basics
39
Managing certificates
On your phone you can add and delete public key
certificates. You can store the following two types of
certificates on your phone.
• Personal: help to establish your identity, when you log
on to a secured network, such as a corporate network.
• Root: help to establish the identity of servers with which
you connect. This helps to prevent unauthorised users
from accessing your phone and information.
Viewing certificates
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Certificates
→ a certificate type.
3. To view more details, select the certificate.
Deleting a certificate
1. Scroll to the certificate you want on the list.
2. Press the Menu soft key and then select Delete.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.The basics
40
Resetting your phone
You can reset your phone’s settings and clear all added
data from memory.
Resetting the phone
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → More... →
Hard reset. You can also turn on the phone with
pressing and holding .
3. Enter the initialisation password and press the Done
soft key. The default password is “1234.”
4. Press the Yes soft key to confirm.
The phone resets and reboots itself.
Changing the initialisation password
You can change the initialisation password to prevent the
phone from being reset by unauthorised people.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → More... →
Hard reset password.
3. Enter the old password, then a new password, and
re-enter the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.The basics
41
Using online help
Your phone is supported by additional information available
online, or on the CD-ROM that came with your phone.
SIM AT (SIM Application Toolkit)
This is available if you use a SIM AT card that provides the
SIM Application Toolkit menus and additional services, such
as news, weather, sports, entertainment, and location
services. Available services may vary, depending on your
service provider’s plans.
For details, see your SIM card instructions or contact your
service provider.
For information on: see:
additional programs
that can be installed on
your phone,
the supplied CD-ROM.
connecting to and
synchronising with a
PC,
Chapter 3 in this User’s Guide
or ActiveSync Help on your PC.
To view the ActiveSync help,
click the ActiveSync icon on the
Windows task bar.
up-to-date information
on your phone,
http://www.microsoft.com/
mobile/smartphone.3
42
Synchronisation
Using Microsoft®
ActiveSync®
, you can synchronise data on
your desktop computer with the data on your phone.
Synchronisation compares the data on your phone with
your desktop computer and updates both your phone and
computer with the latest data.
With ActiveSync, you can:
• Keep Contacts, Calendar, Tasks, or Inbox data up-to-date
by synchronising your phone with Microsoft Outlook data
on your desktop computer.
• Copy (rather than synchronise) files between your phone
and desktop computer.
• Control the moment when synchronisation occurs by
selecting a synchronisation mode.
• Select data types to be synchronised and control the
amount of synchronised data.
WARNING!
• ActiveSync synchronises two devices using the latest data.
Therefore, if you delete some specific data from the phone
after synchronisation, and then perform a synchronisation
again, the corresponding data on the computer will be
deleted. Be careful not to lose important data.
• If you turn off the phone after copying files to any folders,
except for the Storage folder, using ActiveSync, all files in
those folders will be deleted. Store important files in the
Storage folder to prevent from being deleted.Synchronisation
43
Installing ActiveSync
Before beginning synchronisation, you must install
ActiveSync on your desktop computer using the supplied
CD-ROM. You can also download the latest version of
ActiveSync from the Microsoft web site (http://
www.microsoft.com).
1. Insert the CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of your
desktop computer. Alternatively, double-click the
downloaded ActiveSync installer.
2. Follow the instructions on the screen for installing
Microsoft ActiveSync.
When installation is completed, the Synchronisation
Setup Wizard helps you to connect your phone to your
desktop computer, to set up a partnership.
3. Follow the instructions on the screen.
Note: See page 45 for more information on connecting the
phone and a computer.
Your first synchronisation process will automatically begin
when your phone is connected to the computer. After the
first synchronisation, take a look at Contacts, Calendar, and
Tasks on your phone. You will notice that your information
has been copied to the phone.Synchronisation
44
Customising connection settings
To establish a connection between your computer and the
phone, you must enable the connection(s) you want to use
in the ActiveSync program. By default, all connections are
enabled.
1. From the ActiveSync window on your computer, select
File → Connection Settings...
2. Change the connection settings.
3. Click OK.
If your phone is not
connected to the
computer, click this
button to establish
a connection.Synchronisation
45
Connecting your phone to a
computer
To connect the phone to your computer, you can use a PC
data cable or the infrared port.
Connecting with a PC data cable
Connect one end of the PC data cable to the charger/PC
data cable jack on the right of the phone and the other end
to the USB port on your computer.
Note: USB mode of your phone must be set for ActiveSync.
Press the Start soft key and select Settings →
More... → Connections → USB. Then change the
mode.
The connection is established and the Microsoft ActiveSync
window appears. The synchronisation automatically begins.
Note: When an error occurs in a USB connection, activate the
DHCP Client service, or deactivate the firewall or VPN
environment.
Connecting via the infrared port
1. Enable IR transmissions on your phone; Select Start →
Settings → More... → Connections → Beam →
Receive incoming beams.
2. Align the infrared ports on your phone and the
computer.
Note: To use the infrared port, the phone’s display must be
activated.
3. From the Connection Settings window of the Windows
ActiveSync, select Infrared Port (IR).Synchronisation
46
4. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key, and select ActiveSync.
5. Press the Menu soft key and select Connect via IR.
Once the connections is established, appears on the
Windows task bar.
Note: If your computer doesn’t have an infrared port, you can
purchase a USB-IrDA adapter.
Synchronising information
To start synchronisation, connect your phone to your
computer. For more information on connecting the phone
and the computer, see page 45. The ActiveSync screen on
your computer automatically appears and synchronisation
starts.
Once the synchronisation is completed, the phone stays
connected to the computer. If any change is made,
ActiveSync automatically will begin synchronisation. To
begin synchronisation, press the Sync soft key in
ActiveSync on your phone.
You can open the phone’s file directory by clicking Explore
from the Microsoft ActiveSync window. You can then copy
files quickly and easily from the phone to the computer or
vice versa.
Shows the
synchronisation
status.
Shows types of
information to be
synchronised.Synchronisation
47
Note: To synchronize Bluetooth devices with a compatible PC,
you need the Bluetooth stack for Windows XP Service
Pack 2 on your PC.
Customising synchronisation
settings
You can customise various setting options for
synchronisation with a computer and a server, and set the
synchronisation schedule.
First, you must break the connection between the phone
and computer. Disconnect the PC data cable or remove the
phone from the infrared range.
Changing PC Settings
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Options.
2. Highlight Window PC.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Settings.
4. Change the computer name, set how to handle a data
conflict between the phone and computer, or set a event
logging type and press the Done soft key.
5. Select data types to be synchronised under the selected
computer.
6. Press the Done soft key.
Note: For more information on the conditions that must be
met on the computer and how to change
synchronisation options, see ActiveSync Help.Synchronisation
48
Setting server synchronisation
You can synchronise information automatically as items
arrive only if your company is running Microsoft Exchange
Server with Exchange ActiveSync.
Configuring an Exchange Server connection
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Add Server Source.
2. Enter the server address and select This server
requires an encrypted (SSL) connection to use a
SSL protocol for server access.
3. Press the Next soft key.
4. Enter your Microsoft Exchange user name, password,
and domain name.
To save the password for subsequent accesses, select
Save password.
5. Press the Next soft key.
6. Select data types to be synchronised.
7. When you have finished, press the Finish soft key.
Changing the synchronisation schedule
You can schedule synchronisation with the Microsoft
Exchange Server on two separate times. Use the peak time
schedule to synchronise during working hours or other
times when you experience higher mail volumes. Use the
off-peak time schedule to synchronise during times when
you experience lower mail volumes.Synchronisation
49
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Schedule.
2. Set each option:
• To synchronise periodically during peak times, select a
frequency of synchronisation in the Peak times field.
• To synchronise periodically during off-peak times,
select a frequency of synchronisation in the Off-peak
times field.
• To use the peak time and off-peak time setting while
roaming, select Use above settings when roaming.
• To synchronise each time you send an e-mail, select
Send outgoing items immediately.
• To set the days and hours for peak times, press the
Menu soft key and select Peak Times.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.4
50
Call functions
This chapter explains all of the call- functions provided by
your phone.
Turning the phone functions on and
off
You can choose to turn off the phone functions and just use
the PDA functions at any time and then turn it back on
when you want.
Note: In many countries you may be required by law to turn
off the phone functions while on a flight. To turn off the
display of your phone does not actually turn off the
phone functions; you must turn off your wireless
connection to your operator’s network.
To turn off the phone functions, press and select
Wireless Manager. Then select Phone to set it to Off.
appears on the top right corner of the screen.
To turn back on the phone functions, select Phone to set it
to On from the Wireless Manager screen.Call functions
51
Using the Dialling screen
When you start entering a number or press , the Dialling
screen opens. You can view the most recent calls you have
dialled, received, and missed on the screen.
When you enter a digit, the Dialling screen lists all of the
numbers containing the entered digit in Contacts and Call
History, as well as the phone number assigned to the
corresponding Speed Dial key.
Making a call
You can make a phone call using the number keypad.
1. From the Home screen, enter a number including an
area code using the keypad.
2. Press to make a call.
When a call is connected, the call duration displays.
During a call, you can use several call options. For
details, see page 55.
To adjust the earpiece volume during a call, press
to increase or decrease the volume level.
3. To end the call, press .
Advanced calling features
You can make a call from Contacts, Speed Dial, and Call
History.Call functions
52
Making a call from Contacts
1. On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You
can also press the Start soft key and select Contacts.
2. Select a contact card from the contact list.
3. Scroll to the number you want and press .
Making a call from Speed Dial
Speed Dial is a list you can create of often-dialled numbers.
Information on adding a number to Speed Dial is detailed
on page 57.
By memorising the position on the Speed Dial list, you can
dial the number simply by entering that number of the
Speed Dial key. The phone number assigned to the key
appears on the Dialling screen.
Alternatively, if you do not remember the position of a
number, access the Speed Dial list:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Speed Dial.
3. Scroll to the number you want and press .Call functions
53
Making a call using name dialling
You can make a phone call by saying the name that has
been assigned to a contact card in Contacts or on the SIM
card. For details, see page 129.
Making a call from the Call History
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Call History. The recent call list appears.
Note: is for incoming calls, is for outgoing calls, and
is for missed calls.
To view the calls categorised by call type, press the
Menu soft key, select Filter, and select a category from
the pop-up list.
3. Scroll to the number you want and then press .
Making an international call
1. Press and hold until the + sign appears. The +
replaces the international access code.
2. Enter the full phone number you want to dial. It includes
the country code, the area code (without the leading
zero), and the phone number.
3. Press .
Note: You can set the country or are code to be added before
the number when dialling. See page 62.Call functions
54
Making an emergency call
Your phone provides the emergency number 112. This
number can normally be used to make an emergency call in
any country, with or without a SIM card inserted, if you are
within a mobile phone network’s service area.
Enter the emergency number 112 and press .
Notes:
• Some service providers may require a SIM card to be
inserted, and in some cases the PIN to be entered as well.
• In some cases, other emergency numbers may also be
accessed. Your service provider may save additional local
emergency numbers on the SIM card.
Answering or ignoring a call
When a call comes in and the phone rings or vibrates,
depending on the ringer setting:
• Press the Answer soft key or press to answer the
call.
• Press the Ignore soft key or press to reject the call.
You can also press and hold .
Note: If you reject a call, the busy tone is sent out.
Depending on your service provider, the caller may be
guided to your voicemail server.Call functions
55
Options during a call
Your phone provides a number of control functions that you
can use while a call is in progress.
Putting a call on hold
If a person is trying to call you when you are talking on the
phone, a notification window will pop out.
1. Press the Answer soft key to answer the second call
and put the first on hold.
2. To swap back and forth between the two callers, press
the Swap soft key.
3. To end the second call and go back to the first, press the
End soft key or press .
Setting up conference calling
Conference calling enables you to invite callers during a call
and have a conversation with up to 5 people at the same
time.
1. Put a call on hold, dial a second number, and wait for it
to be picked up. Alternatively, accept a second incoming
call when you already have one in progress.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Conference.
If the conference connection is successful, the word
“Conference” will appear at the top of the screen.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Hold to place the
conference call on hold and make a new call or
answer another incoming call. Call functions
56
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Conference to
join together all existing calls.
To talk privately to a person during a conference call, press
the Menu soft key and select Private. When the list of call
participants appears, select one.
Switching a call to a Speakerphone
During a call, you can switch to a speakerphone.
In Speakerphone mode, a noisy enviroment will make it
difficult to hear the person whom you are speaking with. In
a noisy environment, it is better to use the normal phone
mode for better audio performance.
• To activate a speakerphone, press and hold for about
1 seconds.
• To deactivate a speakerphone, press and hold the key
again for the same length of time.
Call-related features
Checking your voicemail
The first speed dial location is assigned to your voicemail
box by default. When you insert your SIM card into the
phone, it will automatically detect and set as default the
voicemail centre number of your mobile service provider.
To check your voicemail, press and hold from the
Dialling screen.
Note: You can check and change the voicemail centre number.
See page 62.Call functions
57
Managing the Speed Dial list
You can assign frequently-used phone numbers, e-mail
addresses, or web pages in Contacts to the speed dial
location 2 through 99. The location 0 and 1 on the Speed
Dial list is preset for the international call prefix + and the
voicemail centre number, respectively.
Note: You cannot create a speed dial for a phone number
stored on the SIM card.
Adding a contact to the Speed Dial list
1. On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You
can also press the Start soft key and select Contacts.
2. Select a contact from the list.
3. Scroll to a number, e-mail address, or web page
address.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Add to Speed Dial.
5. If necessary, enter the name you want.
6. In the Keypad assignment field, select a location.
7. Press the Done soft key.
Deleting Speed Dial assignments
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Speed Dial.
3. On the Speed Dial list, select a number.Call functions
58
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
5. When the confirmation message appears, press the Yes
soft key.
Managing your Call History
Call History details all incoming, outgoing, and missed
calls, and also provides a summary of total calls. It can also
tell you when a call was initiated and how long it lasted.
To open the Call History:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Call History. A list of all calls appears.
If necessary, select the category of the call history to be
displayed by pressing the Menu soft key and selecting
Filter.
Calls are categorised as below:
• No Filter: shows all calls made to and from the phone in
chronological order.
• Missed Calls: shows only calls that were not answered.
• Incoming Calls: shows only calls made to the phone.
• Outgoing Calls: shows only calls made from the phone.
Viewing details of calls
• To view the duration of a call and time and date you
received or made it, scroll to the call you want to view
and press .
• To view contact information, scroll to a contact, press the
Menu soft key, and select Find Contact.
• To send an SMS message, press the Menu soft key and
select Send SMS.Call functions
59
• To send an e-mail message using the e-mail address on
the call history, scroll to the contacts, press the Menu
soft key, and select Email.
• To delete individual calls, press the Menu soft key, and
then select Delete. To delete all calls, select Delete List.
• To save a phone number in a call to Contacts, scroll to
the call you want and press the Save soft key.
Viewing call timers
In Call History, you can view the duration of your calls. This
option is convenient for estimating your usage.
1. On the Call History screen, press the Menu soft key and
select View Timers.
You can view the total call time, the last call time, the
time of calls you received and made, and a lifetime
counter. You can also view the time you reset the call
time.
2. Press the Done soft key.
You can easily erase the call time records at any time,
except for Lifetime calls, by pressing the Menu soft key
and selecting Reset Timers.
Viewing call cost
This network feature lets you view the cost of calls. Viewing
call cost may not be available, depending on particular SIM
cards. For more information, contact your service provider.
1. On the Call History screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Call Cost.Call functions
60
2. Select the option you want.
• Last Call Cost: shows the cost of the last call you
made.
• Total Cost: shows the total cost of all calls made
since the cost counter was last reset. If the total cost
exceeds the maximum cost set in the Set Max Cost
option, you can no longer make any calls until you
reset the counter.
• Max Cost: shows the maximum cost set in the Set
Max Cost option.
• Reset Counters: allows you to reset the cost counter.
• Set Max Cost: allows you to enter the maximum cost
that you authorise for your calls. Calls can be made as
long as the preset max cost is not exceeded.
• Price/Unit: allows you to set the cost of one unit. This
price per unit is applied when calculating the cost of
your calls.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Customising your phone functions
You can personalise the settings of the phone functions, the
services you have, and the network to which you have
connected.
Accessing the Phone setting options
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Phone.
3. Select a setting menu, and then set each option.Call functions
61
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Available setting options
• Band Selection: This option allows you to select the
network band in which your phone will operate. Your
phone can operate in the GSM 900/1800 or PCS 1900
band.
• Call Barring: This network service allows you to restrict
your incoming or outgoing calls. To set up this service,
you need to enter the call barring password obtained
from your service provider.
All calls: No calls can be made or received.
When roaming: Calls cannot be received when you are
using your phone outside of your home service area.
Off: Call barring is deactivated; all calls can be made and
received normally.
Int's except home: When abroad, calls can be made
only to number within the current country and to your
home country.
Int'l calls: International calls cannot be made.
• Call Forwarding: This network service allows you to
forward your incoming calls to another phone number.
Unconditional: All calls are forwarded.
No Reply: Calls are forwarded when you do not answer.
Busy: Calls are forwarded when you are on the phone.
Unavailable: Calls are forwarded when your phone is
turned off or your phone is out of the service area.
Data Calls: All data calls are forward.Call functions
62
• Call Options: You can customise settings related to call
functions, such as an answering option, voicemail and
SMS access numbers, and auto dial codes.
Any key answer: When this option is activated, you can
answer incoming calls by pressing any key, except for ,
, , and .
Show SIM contacts: With this option is activated, the
contact cards stored on the SIM card display on the
contact list.
Phone number: Check your phone number.
Voice mail number/SMS service centre: When you
insert your SIM card into your phone, it automatically
detects and sets your voicemail and SMS access numbers
by default. If not, you can manually enter the numbers
obtained from your service provider.
Country code/Dialling code: You can enter a country
code or area code. The code will be automatically added
before a phone number when dialling.
• Call Waiting: This service allows you to receive another
call while you have a call in progress. Select Provided
call waiting call notifications to activate this service.
• Caller ID: When you place a call, your phone number
can be displayed to or hidden from the person to whom
you are calling. Using this option, you can enable or
disable the display of your caller identification.
For more detailed information , press the Start soft key
and then Select Settings → Phone → More....
• Channels: This option allows you to set the cell
broadcast (CB) message receipt and set up broadcast
channels from which you want to receive CB messages.
Enable channels: Select to enable the receipt of CB
messages.Call functions
63
Language: Select your preferred languages to display
CB messages.
To edit the channel list, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Channels. Then press the Menu soft key and
select the options for adding, editing or deleting
channels.
• Extra Tones: You can activate or deactivate the connect
tone, which alerts you when your call is connected to the
system, or the minute minder tone, which alerts you
every minute during a call.
• Fixed Dialling: When this option is activated, your
phone allows outgoing calls only to the limited set of
phone numbers. You can call only those numbers that are
included in the Fixed Dialling Number list or which begin
with the same digit(s) as a phone number on the list.
• Networks: You can set the phone to automatically select
a network when you are roaming out of your service
area, or find and select the network you want.
Press the Menu soft key to access the following options:
Find a New Network: Search for all available networks.
You can start searching when the phone is out of your
service area.
Select a Network: Select a network from the available
networks
Preferred Networks: Set up a list of your preferred
networks. You can set priority of the networks or add
networks manually by selecting them from the preset
network list or entering their service ID codes.64
5 Messaging, Internet, and
Messenger
Messaging
In Messaging, you can create, send, receive, view, edit, and
organise:
• Text messages (SMS)
• Multimedia message (MMS)
• E-mail messages
To open Messaging:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Messaging.
Working with SMS or MMS messages
You can write an SMS message of up to 160 characters.
When you enter more than 160 characters, your phone
handles the message as a multi-part message.
You can also send or receive multimedia messages (MMS).
In addition to the familiar text content of text messages,
multimedia messages can contain images, video clips,
audio clips, and combinations of these things in more than
one page.
MMS also supports e-mail addressing, so that messages
can be sent from phone to e-mail and vice versa.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
65
Creating and sending an SMS message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select SMS/MMS.
2. Press the New soft key and select SMS.
3. In the To field, enter the recipients’ phone numbers,
separating them with a semicolon.
You can retrieve numbers from the contact list by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Add
Recipient.
4. Press the Down key and compose your message.
To enter preset or frequently used messages, press the
Menu soft key, select My Text, and select a message.
5. Press the Send soft key when you’ve finished the
message.
Creating and sending an MMS message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select SMS/MMS.
2. Press the New soft key and select MMS.
3. In the To, Cc, or Bcc field, enter the recipients’
numbers or addresses, separating them with a
semicolon.
Note: The Cc or Bcc fields are above the To field.
You can also retrieve numbers or the addresses from the
contact list or the messages you have sent by pressing
the Menu soft key and selecting Add Recipients.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
66
4. Press the Down key to move to the Subject field and
enter the message subject.
5. Press the Down key and enter the message text.
6. Press the Menu soft key to access the following options
for composing a message:
• Preview: shows the multimedia message you
created.
• Add Recipients: allows you to add recipients
addresses.
• Edit Item: allows you to edit the selected item.
• Add: allows you to add a variety of contents, such as
data, media files and templates.
• Attach: allows you to attach a contact card or
calendar item as a digital file format, or a media file.
• Edit Page: allows you to add or delete pages, change
the text style, or set the page order or duration.
• Save to: allows you to save the message to Drafts or
as an MMS template.
• Cancel Message: cancels sending the message.
• MMS Options: allows you to change the message
options. See page 70.
7. When you have finished composing the message, press
the Send soft key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
67
Viewing SMS/MMS messages
When you receive a new SMS or MMS message, the New
Message icon ( ) displays on the top line of the screen
and a new message is stored in Inbox. Press the Message
soft key to open the message.
You can also view messages you received, sent, composed
but not sent by accessing the message folders.
To open the message folders:
On the SMS/MMS screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Folders. The following default folders display:
• Deleted Items: contains messages that have been
deleted on your phone.
• Drafts: stores draft messages that have not been sent.
• Inbox: contains received messages.
• Outbox: is a temporary storage place for messages
waiting to be sent.
• Sent Items: stores the messages that have been sent.
To view all message folder contents, press the Menu soft
key and select Show All Folders.
To clear the SMS/MMS messages in a specific folder, scroll
to the folder, press the Menu soft key, and select Clear
SMS/MMS.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
68
To view a received message:
1. On the SMS/MMS screen, open the message folder you
want.
The icons on the message list tells you the message
type.
• : SMS message
• : MMS message
Note: You can change the default settings for viewing an
SMS message. On a message list, press the Menu
soft key and select Options → Display.
2. Select the message you want to view.
If you open a push message from a WAP server, press
the Proceed soft key to access the URL specified in the
message.
To access message options:
While viewing a received or sent message, you can access
the following options by pressing the Menu soft key.
• Delete: deletes the message.
• Reply All (SMS): sends a reply to the sender and all
other recipients
• Reply (MMS) : sends a reply to the sender and/or all
other recipients, or forwards the message to other
people..
• Forward (SMS): forwards the message to other people.
• Move: allows you to move the message to other folders.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
69
• Mark as Unread/Mark as Read: allows you to mark the
message as unread or read. Unread messages are
boldfaced on the message list.
• Save to Contacts: allows you to save the sender’s
number or address.
• Save as MMS Template (MMS): saves the message as
an MMS template for reuse.
• Attached files (MMS): allows you to save attachments
of the message into the phone’s memory.
• MMS Options: allows you to change the MMS settings.
See below.
Viewing messages on the SIM card
Sometimes, text messages may be stored on the SIM card,
depending on their specifications. To view the messages
stored on the SIM card, you need to copy them to a folder
in your phone.
1. On a message list, press the Menu soft key and select
Options → Import SIM Messages.
2. Press the Done soft key.
The text messages are copied from the SIM card to
SMS/MMS Inbox.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
70
Configuring MMS settings
You can change the default MMS settings. From composing
or viewing an MMS message, press the Menu soft key and
select MMS Options. The following options are available:
• Sending Options: Allows you to change the settings for
sending MMS messages.
Priority: You can select the priority level of your
messages.
Validity Period: You can select the length of time your
messages are stored in the message centre after they
are sent.
Delivery Time: You can select the time delay before
messages are sent.
Creation Mode:Allows you to set the phone to allow the
MMS creation using unsupported files.
Size: You can select the message size.
Hide address: You can set your caller ID to be hidden
from outgoing messages.
Request delivery report: When this option is activated,
the network informs you whether or not your message
has been delivered.
Request read report: When this option is activated,
your phone sends a request for a reply along with your
message to the recipient.
• Receiving Options: Allows you to change the settings
for receiving MMS messages.
Home Network: Set how to retrieve new messages
from the server in your home network.
Roaming Network: Set how to retrieve new messages
from the server while roaming around another network.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
71
Reject Unknown Sender:reject messages from
unknown senders.
Report Allowed:send a delivery report from the
network to the sender.
Advertisement Allowed:accept advertisements.
Information Allowed:accept information messages.
• MMS Profiles: Allows you to set up and activate MMS
profiles which are sets of MMS parameters required to
send or receive MMS messages. To activate a profile,
select it from the profile list.
To edit a profile, press the Menu soft key and select Edit.
Change the following options:
Profile Name: Enter the profile name.
MMSC URL: Enter the URL address of the MMS centre.
Bearer: select the network bearer type.
Working with E-mail messages
You can send and receive e-mail messages in one of these
ways:
• Synchronise e-mail messages with Microsoft Exchange or
Microsoft Outlook on your PC.
• Send and receive e-mail messages by connecting directly
to an e-mail server through an Internet Service Provider
(ISP) or a network.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
72
Synchronising E-mail messages
Use the Outlook EMail account to send and receive
e-mail messages by synchronising e-mail messages with
Microsoft Exchange or Microsoft Outlook on your PC.
E-mail messages can be synchronised as part of the
general synchronisation process. You will need to enable
Inbox synchronisation in ActiveSync.
During synchronisation:
• Messages are copied from the mail folders of Exchange or
Outlook on your PC to the Outlook Email folders on your
phone.
• E-mail messages in Outbox on your phone are
transferred to Exchange or Outlook, and then sent from
those programs.
• E-mail messages in folders must be selected in
ActiveSync on your PC in order to be transferred.
Connecting directly to an E-mail server
You can send and receive e-mail messages by connecting
to an e-mail server. You’ll need to set up a remote
connection to a network or an ISP, and a connection to your
e-mail server.
When you connect to the e-mail server, new messages are
downloaded to the phone’s Inbox folder. Also messages in
the phone’s Outbox folder are sent, and messages that
have been deleted on the e-mail server are removed from
the phone’s message folders.
Folder behavior with a direct connection to an E-mail
server
The behavior of the folders you create depends on whether
you are using POP3 or IMAP4.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
73
• If you use POP3 and you move e-mail messages to a
folder you created, the link is broken between the
messages on the phone and their copies on the mail
server. The next time you connect, the mail server will
see that the messages are missing from the phone Inbox
and delete them. This prevents you from having
duplicate copies of a message, but it also means that you
will no longer have access to messages that you move to
folders created from anywhere except the phone.
• If you use IMAP4, the folders you created and the e-mail
messages you moved are mirrored on the server.
Therefore, messages are available to you anytime you
connect to your mail server. This synchronisation of
folders occurs whenever you connect to your mail server;
create new folders or rename/delete folders when
connected.
Creating an e-mail account
You need to create a new account to be used for retrieving
and sending e-mail messages.
To make a new account:
1. From any message folder, press the Menu soft key and
select Options → New Account.
2. Enter your display name and e-mail address, and press
the Next soft key.
If you want to set up your account automatically from
the Internet, select Attempt to obtain email settings
from the Internet.
3. Enter your user information, such as user name,
password, and domain name, press the Next soft key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
74
4. Select the e-mail server type, enter an account name,
and select a network type.
5. Press the Next soft key.
6. Enter the server names and press the Next soft key.
If you want to set up an outgoing server, select
Outgoing Server Settings.
7. Set the options for downloading e-mail messages and
press the Next soft key.
You can select the number of days for which you receive
e-mail messages and set the maximum data volume of
e-mail messages you want to download.
8. Select how often your phone automatically connects to
the server and checks for incoming e-mails, and press
the Next soft key.
9. Press the Finish soft key.
To edit an account:
1. From any message folder, press the Menu soft key and
select Options → Account Options.
2. Select the account you want.
3. Change the account settings as you would when
creating it.
For SMS/MMS, you can set to send a delivery report
request for outgoing messages or to use Unicode
encoding.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
75
Creating and sending an E-mail message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the e-mail
account with which you want to send.
2. Press the New soft key.
3. In the To, Cc, or Bcc field, enter the recipients’ e-mail
addresses, separating them with a semicolon.
Note: The Cc or Bcc fields are above the To field.
You can retrieve addresses from the contact list by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Add
Recipient.
4. Press the Down key to move to the Subject field and
enter the e-mail subject.
5. Compose your e-mail message.
To enter preset or frequently used sentences, press the
Menu soft key, select My Text, and select a sentence.
You can add a picture or voice note as an attachment by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Insert → a
item type.
6. Press the Send soft key when you have finished
composing the message.
7. Press the Menu soft key and select Send/Receive to
connect to the network and send the message.
Viewing e-mail messages
You can also view messages you received, sent, composed
but not sent by accessing the message folders.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
76
To open the message folders:
On the Messaging main screen, access the e-mail account
you want, press the Menu soft key, and select Folders.
The following default folders display:
• Deleted Items: contains messages that have been
deleted on your phone.
• Drafts: stores draft messages that have not been sent.
• Inbox: contains received messages.
• Outbox: is a temporary storage place for messages
waiting to be sent.
• Sent Items: stores the messages that have been sent.
Note: When you first have synchronised e-mail messages, the
Junk E-mail folder is copied from the Microsoft Outlook
on your PC to Outlook E-mail on your phone. The next
time you synchronise, the e-mail messages that appear
to be Junk e-mail are saved in that folder according to
the options you set in the Microsoft Outlook.
To view all message folder contents in the selected
account, press the Menu soft key and select Show All
Folders.
To view an e-mail message:
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the e-mail account
from which you want to receive e-mail messages.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Send/Receive.
The phone connects to your e-mail server and receives
incoming e-mail messages or sends e-mail messages in
Outbox.
3. Select the message you want to view.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
77
To access message options:
While viewing a received or sent e-mail, you can access the
following options by pressing the Menu soft key.
• Delete: deletes the message.
• Reply All: sends a reply to the senders and all other
recipients.
• Move: allows you to move message(s) to other folders.
• Mark as Unread/Mark as Read: allows you to mark the
message as unread or read. Unread messages are
boldfaced on the message list.
• Download Message: allows you to download the
complete contents of the e-mail from the e-mail server.
• Send/Receive: sends or receives the e-mail messages.
Setting downloading options
You can specify your downloading preferences when you
set up the account or select your synchronisation options.
You can change them at any time:
• Change options for Inbox synchronisation using
ActiveSync options. For more information, see
“ActiveSync Help.”
• Change options for direct e-mail server connections in
Inbox on your phone. Press the Menu soft key and
select Options → Account Options. Select the account
you want and change it.
Viewing e-mail attachments
To download an attachment, select the attachment
displayed as a list of hyperlinks in an open message. It will
be downloaded the next time you synchonise or connect to
your e-mail server and send or receive e-mail messages. To
view an attachment, select the attachment in an open
message.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
78
Switching beween message accounts
While working in an account, you can switch to another
message account any time you need.
1. Press the Menu soft key and select Switch Accounts.
2. Select the account to which you want to switch.
Inserting signatures into messages
You can specify a signature to be automatically inserted
into SMS, MMS or e-mail messages that you send.
To specify a signature:
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the message
account you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Options →
Signatures.
3. Select the account for which you want to specify from
the Select an account field.
4. Select Use signature with this account.
5. To insert a signature in every messages, including when
you reply or forward the message, select Include when
replying and forwarding.
6. Enter a signature to be inserted and press the Done soft
key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
79
Internet Explorer
Use Microsoft®
Pocket Internet Explorer to view Web HTML,
cHTML, and WAP pages. You can browse by connecting to
an Internet service provider (ISP) or network and browse
the Web. To do this, you’ll need to create the connection
first as described on page 148.
When connected to an ISP or network, you can also
download files and programs from the Internet.
To open Internet Explorer:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Internet → Internet Explorer.
Browsing the Internet
1. To connect and start browsing, do one of the following:
• Press the Menu soft key and select Address Bar.
Enter the web address you want to visit
• Press the Menu soft key and select History to open
the list of the pages you last accessed. Select a page
from the list.
• Scroll to the page you want to view from the
Favourites list.
2. Press the Go soft key on the browser to open the
associated web page.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
80
Navigating the Internet Explorer
The following table helps you browse the Internet easily:
Using the Favorites list
You can store your favourite link while using the Internet
Browser and then access them easily. Categorising them
enables you to find them more quickly.
Adding a web page to the Favorites list
1. Go to the page you want to add and press the Menu
soft key and select Add to Favourites.
To Press
scroll through browser
items
the Navigation keys.
select a browser item .
return to the previous page .
refresh the connection the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
To change the display
options
the Menu soft key, select
View, and select the
option you want.
To change the text and
image size
the Menu soft key, select
Zoom, and select the
option you want.
view information on the
web page
the Menu soft key and
select Tools →
Properties.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
81
2. Enter a name for the favourite link and the URL of the
link.
3. Select a category from the Folder field under which you
want to save the favourite link.
You can also create a new category. See page 84.
4. Press the Add soft key.
Opening a link through the Favourites list
1. On the Internet Explorer screen, press the Favourites
soft key.
2. Scroll to the link you want to access.
If the link you want is in the certain folder, open the
folder and scroll to the link.
3. Press the Go soft key.
Managing Favorites categories
You can create a new category for saving favourite web
pages and edit or delete the created categories.
1. On the Internet Explorer screen, press the Favourites
soft key.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Add Folder to
create a new category.
Alternatively, scroll to the category and press the Menu
soft key and select Edit or Delete to edit or delete the
selected category.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
82
Changing Explorer options
You can customise Web browsing options, change the
connection settings, and clear memory. On the Internet
Explorer screen, press the Menu soft key and select Tools
→ Options.
The following options are available:
• General: You can select whether or not to play sounds
on web pages, view the warnings when you move
from a secure web page to a non-secure one, or
enable or disable the receiving and sending of cookies.
You can also select the text encoding type to use.
• Connections: You can change the network setting to
connect to Internet Explorer. If you select Automatically
detect settings, your phone automatically detects
network settings from your service provider.
• Memory: You can check the amount of memory
currently being used for the Internet Explorer. To clear
the memory, scroll to a type of memory and press the
Clear soft key.
WAP Browser
Using Browser, you can browse the WAP service preset by
your service provider and other WAP (Wireless Application
Protocol) sites on your phone.
Connecting to a WAP site
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Internet → WAP Browser.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
83
3. To connect and start browsing, do one of the following:
• Press the Menu soft key and select Home to access
the homepage of your service provider.
• Press the Favourites soft key, select the category
which contains the WAP site you want, and then select
the WAP site.
• Press the Menu soft key and select Go To. Enter the
address of WAP site you want to visit and press the Go
soft key.
4. While navigating through WAP pages, you can use the
following options:
Using the Favourites list
You can store your favourite WAP sites and then access
them easily. Categorising them enables you to find them
more quickly.
Adding a URL to the Favourites list
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Add to Favourites.
To Press
go to the previous visited
page
.
go to the homepage the Menu soft key and
select Home.
refresh the current page the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
Open the list of the WAP
sites you have accessed
the Menu soft key and
select History.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
84
2. If there is no category created, enter a name for the
category and press the Save soft key.
3. Enter a name for the favourite site and the URL of the
site.
4. Select the category under which you want to save the
favourite site.
You can also create a new category by pressing the
Menu soft key and select New Category.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Opening a page through the Favourites list
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Scroll to a category from the list and press the Open
soft key.
3. Scroll to the WAP site you want and press the Go soft
key.
Managing Favourite categories
You can create a new category for saving favourite WAP
sites and edit or delete the created category.
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select New to create a
new category.
Or scroll to the category you want, press the Menu soft
key, and then select Rename or Delete to edit the
selected category.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
85
Deleting a favourite item
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Scroll to a category from the list and press the Open
soft key.
3. Scroll to the WAP site you want to delete and press the
Menu soft key and select Delete.
4. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
Setting the WAP options
You can access options for the WAP browser. Press the
Menu soft key and select Options.
• Settings: You can view the current connection settings
for WAP and set the selected profile as an active profile or
edit a selected profile. You can also set the WAP browser
to load the homepage when launching.
• Cache/Cookie: Viewed pages can be cached for faster
downloads and cookies are pieces of information related
to a session. You can select to enable or disable the
cache or cookies.
You can clear information stored in the cache and cookie
by pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Clear
Cache or Clear Cookie.
• Set as Home Page: You can change the startup
homepage of the WAP browser. Access the page you want
and select this option.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
86
Pocket MSN
Pocket MSN delivers an always-on experience that enables
you to remain available to other online users and always up
to date with e-mail, instant messaging (IM) and other
online services without maintaining a continuous network
connection to the phone.
The connection will be restored when a new message
arrives or when you needs the service. In addition,
subscribers will receive only updates or changes to their
contacts and Inbox rather than receiving entire lists
when they connect to the service.
You will have one-click access to MSN Hotmail®
and MSN
Messenger. In addition, Pocket MSN will allow you to
wirelessly browse online and receive other MSN services,
including MSN Alerts, which include news, sports and
weather updates.
In addition to always-on services, you can access, compose
and answer Hotmail messages offline, maximising their
time when mobile connections aren't available.
To access Pocket MSN:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Internet → Pocket MSN.
Signing In
To use the MSN Messenger or Hotmail service, you must
have a Microsoft Passport™ account or Hotmail account, or
a Microsoft Exchange e-mail account. If you have a
Hotmail®
or MSN account, you already have a Passport.
Once you have obtained either a Microsoft Passport or a
Microsoft Exchange account, you are ready to set up your
account.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
87
Note: Sign up for a Microsoft Passport account at http://
www.passport.com. Get a free Microsoft Hotmail e-mail
address at http://www.hotmail.com.
To sign into the MSN service:
1. On the Pocket MSN main screen, select MSN
Messenger, MSN Hotmail, or Compose Hotmail.
2. If you selected MSN Messenger, press the Sign In soft
key.
3. Enter the e-mail address and the password of your
Microsoft Passport and Hotmail account.
4. Press the Sign In soft key.
Using MSN Messenger
MSN®
Messenger on your phone is an instant messaging
program that lets you:
• see who is online.
• send and receive instant messages.
• have instant message conversations with groups of
contacts.
Working with contacts
The MSN Messenger screen shows all of your messenger
contacts at a glance, divided into Online and Not Online
categories. From this view, while connected, you can start
a chat.
• To see others who are online but not seen on the MSN
Messenger screen, press the Menu soft key and select
Chats.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
88
• To add a contact, press the Menu soft key and select
Add Contact.
• To delete a contact, press the Menu soft key and select
Delete Contact.
• To set the MSN Messenger to automatically update the
contacts’ status when it changes, press the Menu soft key
and select Auto update status.
• To view the properties of a contact, press the Menu soft
key and select Properties.
• To block a contact from chatting with you, press the
Menu soft key and select Block.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
89
Chatting with contacts
1. To open a chat window, scroll to the contact with whom
you want to chat.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Send Message.
3. Enter your message in the text entry area at the bottom
of the screen, or press the Menu soft key and select My
Text to enter a preset message.
To invite another contact to a multi user chat, press the
Menu soft key, select Invite, and select the contact you
want to invite.
To switch back to the main window, press the Menu soft
key and select My contacts. To revert back to your chat
window, press the Menu soft key, select Chats, and
select the person whom you were chatting with.
4. To end the chat, press the Menu soft key and select
End Chat.
Using the Hotmail service
You can send and read e-mail messages on the phone via
the Microsoft Hotmail service.
Composing and sending an e-mail
1. On the Pocket MSN screen, select Compose Hotmail.
2. Compose an e-mail as you would in the Messaging
program.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
90
Viewing e-mail messages
1. On the Pocket MSN screen, select MSN Hotmail.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Folders.
3. Select a message folder, and then select the message
you want to view.
Accessing the MSN Mobile Homepage
On the Pocket MSN screen, select MSN Mobile Home. You
can access various mail, information, entertainment
services provided by Microsoft.
Changing Pocket MSN setting options
From the Pocket MSN mail screen, press the Options soft
keys. The following options are available:
Note: To change the settings, you may need to sign in to the
MSN service.
• General: You can clear the saved password, if any, or set
Pocket MSN to be displayed on the Home screen.
• Hotmail: You can set filters to receive or block e-mails or
set Hotmail to automatically download new messages to
the phone.
• Messenger: You can change your display name in
Messenger or set Messenger to automatically update
your contacts’ presence information.
• SMS: You can set Pocket MSN to temporarily use SMS
when a data connection is unavailable.
• Switch User: You can reset user information to sign in
to the MSN service by another user account.6
91
Organiser
This chapter explains how to keep track of contacts and
appointments and make a list of tasks you need to do.
Contacts
Contacts maintains a list of your friends and colleagues so
that you can easily find the information you’re looking for,
whether you’re at home or on the road.
To open Contacts:
On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You can
also press the Start soft key and select Contacts. You can
view the list of contact cards that you have created.
Creating a contact card
You can save a new contact card in Contacts or on the SIM
card.
Creating a contact card in the phone’s memory
1. On the contact list, press the New soft key.
2. Enter a name and other contact information.
To assign the contact card to a category, scroll to the
Categories field and select a category.
You can add a personal ringtone to a contact card. Scroll
to the Custom ring tone field and select the ring
melody you want.
Select the Picture field to add an image for the caller ID
image.Organiser
92
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a contact card on the SIM card
1. On the contact list, press the Menu soft key and select
New SIM Contact.
2. Enter the name of the person you want to add.
3. Scroll to the Number field and enter the number you
want to store.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Creating a contact card from the Dialling screen
1. On the Home screen, enter the phone number and press
the Save soft key.
2. To create a new contact card, select .
To add the phone number to an existing contact card,
select the contact card.
3. Scroll to the location in which you want to save the
number and press the Insert soft key.
4. Fill in the other fields and press the Done soft key.Organiser
93
Viewing and editing a contact card
When you access Contacts, the contact list displays the
names of your contacts alphabetically, along with an
abbreviation for the primary contact number or
E-mail address, such as the person’s work phone number
(w) or mobile phone number (m).
The following table shows possible abbreviations that might
be displayed on the Contacts list and their meanings:
Abbreviation Meaning
w/w2 work phone/work phone 2
h/h2 home phone/home phone 2
m mobile phone
co company phone
pgr pager
car car phone
ast assistant phone
rdo radio phone number
e/e2/e3 e-mail/e-mail 2/e-mail 3
Indicates the type of
the default number or
e-mail address.
Indicates the contacts
stored on the SIM card.Organiser
94
Note: All of the contacts saved on the SIM card follow all of
the contacts saved in the phone’s memory.
To open a contact card:
1. On the contact list, select the contact’s name you want
to view.
If the contact card is assigned to a certain category,
press the Menu soft key and select Filter and then
select the category from the pop-up list.
2. Select the contact card you want.
A summary screen is displayed.
3. On the summary screen:
• To edit the contact information, press the Menu soft
key and select Edit.
• To send an SMS message to the contact card, scroll to
the available number and press the SMS soft key, or
press the Menu soft key and then select Send SMS.
• To dial a number, select the number or press the Call
soft key.
• To send an e-mail, select the e-mail address.
• To access a web page, select the web page.
im/im2/im3 IM/IM2/IM3
web web page
Abbreviation MeaningOrganiser
95
Adding a number or address to Speed Dial
You can assign a short cut number to a phone number for
speed dialling or to an e-mail or URL address for quick
access.
1. On the contact list, select the contact you want.
2. Scroll to the number or address.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add to Speed Dial.
4. If necessary, change the name and select a keypad
location.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Copying entries between the SIM Card and
Contacts
You can copy the contact card or all of contact entries in a
specific category to the SIM card or vice versa.
Copying from Contacts to the SIM card
1. On the contact list, select the contact card stored in the
phone’s memory.
2. Scroll to the phone number to be copied.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Save to SIM.
4. If necessary, change the contact name.
5. Press the Done soft key.Organiser
96
Copying from the SIM card to Contacts
1. On the contact list, select the contact card stored on the
SIM card.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Save to Contacts.
3. Select to create a new contact card and
add contact information.
Otherwise, select a contact card to which you want to
add the number, scroll to the number type, and press
the Insert soft key.
4. Press the Done soft key to save the change.
Beaming a contact card
You can send a contact card in Contacts to another phone
via an active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the contact list or on the summary screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Beam Contact .
2. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
3. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.Organiser
97
Deleting a contact card
1. On the contact list or on the summary screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Delete Contact or Delete.
2. Press the Yes soft key to permanently delete the
contact card.
Note: If you delete a contact card on your phone and
synchronise Contacts with your computer, the contact
card in Outlook on your computer will be deleted.
Calendar
Use Calendar to schedule appointments, including
meetings and other events. You can check your
appointments in one of several views (Agenda, Week, and
Month).
To open Calendar:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Calendar. You can view the lists of
appointments that you have created in the agenda view.Organiser
98
Creating an appointment
1. Press the Menu soft key and select New Appointment.
2. Fill in the fields.
• Subject: Enter a description of the appointment.
• Start date, Start time, End date, and End time: If
needed, change the date and time.
• All day event: If checked, the appointment lasts all
day.
• Location: Enter the place of the appointment.
• Reminder: Select a time setting for the alarm to
remind you of the appointment.
• Occurs: Select a repeat interval to set how often the
appointment repeats.
• Status: Select an appropriate status for the
appointment.
• Sensitivity: Select a sensitivity class by which
Microsoft Exchange Server handles the appointment.
• Notes: Add a note for the appointment.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.Organiser
99
Viewing and editing an appointment
On the Calendar screen, you can view and edit your
appointments using the different views: Agenda, Week, or
Month. By default, the Calendar first appears in the agenda
view, which provides the most detail information about
your appointment.
Switching the view mode
You can change the view mode of the calendar to cycle
through the agenda, week, and month view.
In each view, press the Week, Month, or Agenda soft
key.
• Week View: shows the calendar of your appointments.
• Month View: allows you to keep track of your monthly
schedule and shows which days have appointments
scheduled.
• Agenda View: shows you the appointments for the
selected day. The entries are grouped according to their
starting times.
Editing an appointment
1. Select the calendar view by pressing the Week, Month,
or Agenda soft key.Organiser
100
2. In each view, select the date of the appointment by
pressing the Navigation keys.
To go to today, press the Menu soft key and select Go
to Today.
To go to a certain date, press the Menu soft key and
select Go to Date. Enter the date and press the Done
soft key.
3. Select the appointment you want to view.
4. Press the Edit soft key.
5. If you are editing a repeating or continuous
appointment, decide whether to edit all appointments in
the series or just the current appointment by pressing
the No or Yes soft key.
6. Edit the appointment information and press the Done
soft key to save the changes to the appointment.
Beaming an appointment
You can send an appointment to another phone via an
active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the calendar screen, open the appointment you
want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam
Appointment.Organiser
101
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
Deleting an appointment
1. On the calendar screen, scroll to an appointment to
delete.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete
Appointment.
3. If you make deleting to a repeating or continuous
appointment, decide whether to delete all appointments
in the series or just the current appointment by pressing
the No or Yes soft key.
Or, press the Yes soft key to permanently delete the
appointment.
Changing calendar setting options
From any view, press the Menu soft key and select
Options. The following options are available:
• First day of week: You can select which day the
calendar starts with.
• Week view: You can select a week view type.
• Month view: You can set the Month view shows the
current week number.
• Set reminders: You can select default schedule alarm
time.Organiser
102
D-Day
In D-Day, you can calculate how many days are left before
or have passed since a specific event.
To open D-Day:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → D-Day.
Creating a D-Day counter
1. Press the New soft key.
2. Set options in each field.
• Date: Enter the date of the day you want to count to
or from.
• Title: Enter the counter title.
• Category: Select one of the preset categories. You
can filter counters by category from the counter list.
• Repeat every year: Select to set the D-day counter
to repeat every year.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
The counter is added to the list and shows how many
days are left or have passed.Organiser
103
Editing D-Day categories
You can change the name of D-Day categories.
1. From the counter list, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Category.
2. Scroll to the category you want.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Rename.
4. Enter a new name and press the Done soft key.
Deleting a D-Day counter
1. Scroll to the counter you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
Tasks
Tasks is a convenient place to create task reminders. You
can mark a task as completed or delete a task.
To open Tasks:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Tasks.
Creating a task note
1. Enter your task information in the Enter new task
here field.
2. When you have finished, press twice.
The task note is added to the task list.Organiser
104
Completing a task
When a task is complete, mark it to indicate that the task is
done. To mark, scroll to the completed task and press the
Complete soft key.
To unmark, press the Activate soft key.
Beaming a task note
You can send a task note to another phone via an active
infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the task list, scroll to the task you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam Task .
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
4. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.
Deleting a task
1. On the task list, scroll to the task.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete Task.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.Organiser
105
Voice Notes
In any program where you can write on the screen, you can
also quickly capture thoughts, reminders, and phone
numbers by recording a message. In Voice Notes, you can
create a recording.
To open Voice Notes:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Voice Notes.
Recording a voice note
1. Hold your phone’s microphone near your mouth or other
source of sound.
2. Press the Record soft key to make your recording.
The numbers on the centre of the screen indicate the
elapsed time.
3. Press the Stop soft key to stop recording.
Your phone automatically saves the voice note labelled
with the title and lists the notes on the All Notes screen.
Reviewing a voice note
1. On the All Notes list, select the note you want to review.
Recording is playing. During playback, you can adjust
the sound volume by pressing .
2. Press the Stop soft key to stop playing.Organiser
106
Setting a voice note as the ringtone
1. On the All Notes list, scroll to a voice note.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Set As Ringtone.
3. Press the OK soft key.
Alarm
You can use the alarm clock to set a wake-up alarm or set
an alarm to remind you of an appointment.
To open alarm:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Alarm.
Setting a wake-up alarm
1. On the Alarm screen, select Wake up alarm.
2. Select a check box, enter the time for the wake-up
alarm to sound, and select the days when the wake-up
alarm rings in the week viewer.
Use the Navigation keys to move through each field. You
can make up to 3 wake-up alarms.
3. Select a melody for the alarm in the Tone field.
4. Select a time interval to resume the alarm after the
alarm is stopped in the Snooze field.
5. Press the Done soft key. Organiser
107
Setting an alarm
1. On the Alarm screen, select one of Alarm 1 to Alarm 4.
2. Set each alarm option.
3. Press the Done soft key.
Stopping an alarm
• When an alarm rings, press the Dismiss soft key to stop
it, or press the Snooze soft key to set the alarm to ring
again after the specified snooze interval.
• To deactivate an alarm, access it from the Alarm screen
and remove the check marks for a wake-up alarm, or set
Off from the Alarm activation field for a normal alarm.
WorldClock
You can set up the world clock with the time zones you
want, and then check the current time of the city you need
at any time.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key
2. Select Organizer → WorldClock.
3. Select the clock you want.
4. Press the Left or Right key to move the time zone line.
To apply daylight savings to the currently selected time
zone, select Summer Time.
5. Press the Done soft key to save the selected time zone.
6. Repeat from step 3 to add time zones.7
108
Multimedia
Camera
With the built-in camera on your phone, you can take
photos or record videos of people or events while on the
move. Your phone produces JPEG photos and 3GP videos.
To open Camera:
Press the Start soft key , and select Camera.
Taking photos
1. When you access the Camera mode, the image to be
captured appears.
2. Adjust the image to be captured.
• Press the Up or Down key to zoom in or out.
• Press the Left or Right key to adjust the brightness of
the image.
• Press the Menu soft key to access the camera options.
See page 109.
• Use the number keypad to adjust the image quickly.
See page 109.
3. Press or to take a photo.
4. Press the Save soft key to save the photo.
The photo is saved to the location specified in the
Default Storage option. After saving the photo, the
camera automatically returns to Preview mode.Multimedia
109
Setting camera options
You can customise the camera settings. Once you set the
camera settings, the corresponding icons display at the top
of the Preview screen.
On the Preview screen, press the Menu soft key.
• Camcorder: switches to Camcorder mode.
• Shooting Mode: changes the camera shooting mode.
Single Shot: takes a normal single shot.
Multi Shot: takes a series of stills. You can select the
number of photos the camera will take.
Mosaic Shot: takes a series of stills and saves them in
one frame. You can select a layout.
• Flash On: turns the flash on or off.
• Timer: selects the length of time for the camera to delay
before taking a photo.
• Effects: selects a colour tone for photos.
• Frames: selects a decorative frame.
• Options: changes the default settings for Camera. See
page 112.
Using the keypad shortcuts
You can use the keypad to customise your camera settings
when you are in the preview screen.
• : switches to Camcorder mode.
• : changes the shooting mode by changing the number
of photos or the layout.
• : changes the image size.
• : changes the image quality.
• : changes the white balance.Multimedia
110
• : turns the flash on or off.
• : selects the length of delay time before taking a
photo.
• : changes the colour tone.
• : allows you to add a decorative frame to the photo.
• : allows you to select camera options.
Viewing photos
To view photos you have taken, press the Album soft key
in Camera mode. The list of the photos is stored in the
currently selected storage memory. For further details, see
page 122.
Recording video clips
1. From Camera mode, press to switch to Camcorder
mode. The image to be recorded appears.
2. Adjust the image to be recorded.
• Press the Up or Down key to zoom in or out on your
subject.
• Press the Left or Right key to adjust the brightness of
the image.
• Press the Menu soft key to access the camcorder
options. See page 111
• Use the number keypad to adjust the image quickly.
See page 111.
3. To start recording, press or . The timer on the top
left of the screen shows you the elapsed time.Multimedia
111
4. To stop recording, press the Stop soft key, , or .
5. Press the Save soft key to save the video.
The video clip is saved to the location specified in the
Default Storage option. After saving the video, the
camcorder automatically returns to Video Preview.
Setting camcorder options
You can customise the camcorder settings. Once you set
the video settings, the corresponding icons display at the
top of the Video Preview screen.
On the Video Preview screen, press the Menu soft key.
• Camera: switches to Camera mode.
• Recording Mode: select a video recording mode. Select
Limit for MMS to record a video suitable for an MMS or
e-mail message. Select Normal to record a video within
the limit of the currently available memory.
• Flash On: turns the flash on or off.
• Timer: selects the length of time for the phone to delay
before recording a video.
• Effects: selects a colour tone for the video.
• Audio Off: selects whether or not you record audio with
a video clip.
• Options: changes the default settings for Camera. See
page 112.
Using the keypad shortcuts
You can use the keypad to customise your video settings
when you are on the Video Preview screen.
• : switches to Camera mode.
• : changes the recording mode.Multimedia
112
• : changes the image size.
• : changes the image quality.
• : changes the white balance.
• : turns the flash on or off.
• : selects the length of delay time before starting
recording a video.
• : changes the colour tone.
• : mutes or unmutes audio.
• : allows you to select camera options.
Playing video clips
To view the video clips you have recorded, press the
Album soft key in Camcorder mode. The list of the video
clips is stored in the currently selected storage memory.
For further details, see page 122.
Changing the default camera settings
To customise the default camera settings, press the Menu
soft key and select Options.
The following options are available:
• General: You can customise the general settings for the
Camera program.
Auto Save: allows you to set whether the camera will
save the photo or video after taking or recording.
Default Storage: allows you to select where you want
to store your photos or video clips.
• Camera: You can customise the settings for Camera
mode.Multimedia
113
Photo Size: allows you to select an image size.
Photo Quality: allows you to select an image quality.
White Balance: allows you to select the white balance
mode to adjust the colour balance of photos.
Shutter Sound: allows you to select a sound for the
shutter release.
Default Name: allows you to change the default prefix
of photo names.
• Camcorder: You can customise the settings for
Camcorder mode
Video Size: allows you to select an video frame size.
Video Quality: allows you to select an image quality.
White Balance: allows you to select the white balance
mode to adjust the colour balance of videos.
Default Name: allows you to change the default prefix
of video names.
• Shortcuts: You can check view the functions assigned to
the keys in Camera mode or Camcorder mode.
• About: You can check the copyright information of the
Camera program.Multimedia
114
Windows Media Player
Your phone is equipped with Microsoft Windows Media
Player 10. With Windows Media Player, you can play
Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Video, and MP3
audio files that are stored on your phone, a memory card,
or on the Web.
To open Windows Media Player:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Windows Media.
Preparing media files
The Windows Media Player of your phone can play various
file formats, such as .asf, .wma, .wmv, and .mp3. You can
copy media files from your desktop computer to the phone
using the Windows Media Player or ActiveSync. You can
also copy media files using a memory card.
Note: If you have stored too many files in memory, the
operation speed of the system slows down. Using an
optional memory card helps you clear up this problem
and lets you enjoy more music files.
About DRM, licenses, and protected files
Some digital media files, such as songs downloaded from
online stores, are encrypted to prevent the files from being
unlawfully distributed or shared. Content providers use a
technology called Digital Rights Management (DRM), to
encrypt the files. During the encryption process, the
content provider creates a license which specifies how and
when the file can be used. Multimedia
115
For example, a content provider could create a license that
allows you to play a certain file on your computer, but not
on your phone. Or, a license that allows you to play a
certain file on your phone, but only for a month, or perhaps
only a certain number of times. Files that have licenses
associated with them are called protected files.
Copying media files using ActiveSync
1. Connect your phone to a computer and start
synchronisation by referring to page 42.
2. Open the file directory on the phone by clicking Explore
from the Microsoft ActiveSync window.
3. Drag the media files you want to copy and drop them
into a folder.
Windows Media Player automatically retrieves the media
files from the folder where the files are copied and you
can search them from the Library screen. If the media
files do not appear in Library, update the library by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Update
Library.
Copying media files using the desktop player
You can use the desktop player to copy media files. Using
the desktop player ensures that licenses are copied with
protected files.
Make sure that you have Windows Media Player 10 or later
versions on your desktop computer. Depending on the
version of your desktop player, the procedure to copy files
may vary.
1. Connect your phone to the desktop computer and start
synchronisation using a PC data cable.Multimedia
116
2. Open Windows Media Player on the desktop computer.
3. Click the Sync tab.
4. Click Edit Playlist.
5. Select the media files you want to synchronise from the
left pane of the window.
6. Click OK.
7. Select the saving location from the right pane.
8. Click to select the quality level you want and click
OK.
9. Click Start Sync.
The selected files are converted and copied to the
location you selected in step 7.Multimedia
117
Using libraries
A library is a file list provided by Windows Media Player to
retrieve media files in the phone’s memory.
The Library screen contains categories, such as My Music,
My Videos, My TV, and My Playlists. Using the Library
screen, you can sort your content by criteria, such as artist
name, album title, or genre.
On the Library screen, you can use the following options by
pressing the Menu soft key:
• Queue Up: adds the selected file to the end of the
current play list.
• Delete from Library: deletes the selected file from the
library.
• Now Playing: Open the current play list.
• Library: allows you to select the library you want to
view; for example, the library of files stored on your
phone or on the memory card.
• Update Library: adds new files to the library by
searching your phone or a memory card.
• Open File: allows you to find and play files that are
stored on your phone or a memory card, but those are
not in the library.
• Open URL: allows you to specify a URL address for a
streaming service.
• Properties: displays information about the selected file.
• Done: closes the Library screen and displays the player
screen.Multimedia
118
Playing music and video files
If you have copied media files to your phone’s memory or
memory card, you can play them from Media Player.
Playing media files from a library
1. On the Library screen, if necessary, press the Menu soft
key, select Library, and select the memory from which
you want to retrieve files.
2. When libraries have been updated, press the Done soft
key.
3. Select a category.
4. Scroll to the library you want to play and press the Play
soft key.
If the file does not appear in a library, on the Library
screen, press the Menu soft key and select Open File.
Then select the file you want to play.
The player screen appears and the selected file plays.
Use the following options during playback:
• To adjust the volume, press the Up or Down key. You can
view the volume level on the screen.
• To adjust the earpiece volume, press .
• To move backward in a file, press and hold the Left key.
• To move forward in a file, press and hold the Right key.
• To access the next file, press the Right key.
• To access the previous file, press the Left key.
• To pause or resume playback, press .
• To play the files in the play list randomly or repeatedly,
press the Menu soft key and select Shuffle/Repeat.
• To stop playback, press the Menu soft key and select
Stop.Multimedia
119
Notes:
• When a Bluetooth headset is connected to the phone, the
play/pause/stop button on the headset may not function
properly. To control the player from the headset, first play or
pause music from Media Player, and then use the button.
• While playback is in progress, the multi-function key on the
Bluetooth headset may not function.
Playing media files on a network
1. On the Library screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Open URL.
2. Enter a URL in the URL field, or scroll to one of URLs that
you have used from the History field.
3. Press the OK soft key.
Note: To play streaming media, you must be connected to a
network. For more information on creating a remote
connection between your phone and a network, see
page 148.
Setting up a play list
You can add media files on the Library screen to a
temporary play list. It lists the currently playing file, as well
as any files that have been queued up to play next.
Creating a play list
1. On the Library screen, select the category you want and
scroll to the file you want to play.
If the file does not appear on the list, press the Menu
soft key and select Update Library. You can also select
Open File to display the File System screen and search
the files you want.Multimedia
120
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Queue Up to add
the file to the play list.
3. Repeat from step 1 to add more files.
4. Press to return to the player screen.
5. Press to start playing the files.
Opening the play list
On the player screen, press the Now Playing soft key. You
can use various options by pressing the Menu soft key.
Editing the play list
• To change the play order, press the Menu soft key and
select Move Up or Move Down.
• To delete the selected files, press the Menu soft key and
select Delete from Playlist.
• To clear the play list, press the Menu soft key and select
Clear Now Playing.
Changing the Window Media Player
settings
You can customise the appearance and functionality of
Windows Media Player. On the player screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Options.
You can use the following options:
• Playback: Select the options for playback. You can
select the way time is displayed on the player screen, or
whether or not to pause playback when you launch
another program, and resume playback after a phone
call.Multimedia
121
• Video: Select the viewing options for playing videos,
such as shrinking oversized videos and playing videos on
a full screen.
Note: If there is a problem while playing MP4 files, deselect
the Scale to fit window option. The problem occurs
because the file has been resized.
• Network: Change the connections speed and protocol
for playing streaming content.
• Library: Select whether the player screen or the Library
screen is displayed when you open Windows Media
Player.
• Skins: Change the appearance of the player screen by
selecting a new skin.
• Buttons: Assign Windows Media Player functions to the
keys on your phone to quickly control playback without
having to use the menus.
Customising SRS WOW XT Settings
SRS WOW XT for Mobile is a suite of 3D audio, bass
enhancement, and mono and stereo speaker technologies
designed to improve the quality of mobile audio, e g
cellular phone sound quality.
To enjoy music with high audio quality, enable the WOW XT
feature before playing media files.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then the More soft key, and
press the WOW XT Settings.
3. On the SRS WOW XT screen, select On in the WOW XT
On/Off field.Multimedia
122
4. Select the type you want in the SRS EQ field, or adjust
the settings for each component.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Note:
• is a trademark of SRS Labs, Inc. WOW technology is
incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.
• When you use a headset, the WOW XT feature is enhanced
and provides a more powerful listening experience.
Picture & Videos
This program allows you to access all of your picture and
video files stored in your phone's directory or on a memory
card.
To open Pictures & Videos:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Pictures & Videos. The
thumbnails of the files display.
Viewing a photo
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, select a photo folder,
if necessary.
Note: Photos captured by the camera on the phone are stored
in the PIC-00 folder.
2. Scroll to the thumbnail image of the picture you want
and press the View soft key.
While viewing a photo, you can use the following options:Multimedia
123
• To zoom in or out, press or .
• To send the picture as part of an MMS or e-mail message,
press the Send soft key.
• To edit the picture, press the Menu soft key and select
Edit. You can then access the editing tool options by
pressing the Menu soft key.
• To set the picture as wallpaper for the Home screen,
press the Menu soft key and select Use as Home
Screen.
Viewing photos as a slide show
You can view all of your pictures as a slide show, a
sequential presentation of each image in the current
album.
Press the Menu soft key and select Play Slide Show. The
slide show begins on the full screen.
• To change the screen to the Landscape view or Portrait
view, press the Up or Down key.
• To manually scroll through the pictures, press the Left or
Right key.
• To stop the slide show and return to the Pictures & Videos
screen, press .
Playing a video
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, Press the Menu soft
key and select Folders → My Device → My Documents
→ My Videos.
2. Select a video folder, if necessary. Multimedia
124
Note: Videos captured by the camera on the phone are stored
in the Mov-00 folder.
3. Scroll to the thumbnail image of the video clip you want
and press the Play soft key.
Beaming a file
You can send a picture or video clip to another phone via an
active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. Open a folder, if necessary, and scroll to the file you
want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam....
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
4. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.
Switching to another folder
You can open files in any folder in the other directory of
your phone.
1. From Pictures & Videos screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Folders.
2. Select a folder. If necessary, repeat this step to open a
subfolder.Multimedia
125
Copying or moving files
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, open the folder you
want and scroll to the file you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit → Cut or Copy.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Folders → another
folder.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit → Paste.
Deleting a file
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, open the folder you
want and scroll to the file you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
Customising settings
From the Pictures & Videos screen, press the Menu soft
key and select Options to access the following options:
• General: allows you to select a maximum size of
pictures for sending via e-mail messages, or select a
rotating orientation.
• Slide Show: allows you to select an orientation of a slide
show or set whether or not the slide show plays as a
screen saver when the phone is connected to a computer
and in Idle mode.8
126
Extra programs
Games
Your phone includes fun games, such as Solitaire in Games.
You can also download and play new Java games.
To open Games:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key twice, and select Games.
Solitaire
The object of Solitaire is to use all the cards in the deck to
build up the four suit stacks in ascending order, beginning
with aces.
Playing a game
1. On the Start screen, select Solitaire.
2. Move any aces on the seven stacks to the four card
spaces at the top of the screen and then make any other
available plays.
To move cards, press the number or character of the
card to move and then press the number or character of
the stack to which you want to move the card.
Note: Pressing the Up key moves a card to one of the four
stacks in the upper right corner of the screen if it
belongs there.
3. When you have made all available plays, press the Draw
soft key to turn over cards.Extra programs
127
Funbox
Funbox is a folder where downloaded games are stored.
To download new games, press the Download soft key.
Your phone launches the WAP browser and loads the preset
website which provides you with the latest news and
information about games and game downloads.
To play a game, select one from the FunBox screen. How to
play may vary from game to game.
Calculator
The calculator allows you to perform general mathematical
functions, such as addition, subtraction, multiplication, and
division.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Calculator.
3. Enter the numbers and perform calculations by pressing
the Navigation keys (Up: +, Down: –, Left: /, Right: x).
4. To execute the calculation, press .Extra programs
128
Smart Converter
In Smart Converter, you can perform unit conversions.
1. On the Home Screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Smart Converter.
3. Select a converter type.
4. Select an original unit and enter the value to be
converted in the upper Unit field.
Note: Press to add a decimal point. In the temperature
converter, press to change the temperature to below
or above zero.
5. Select a target unit from the lower Unit field. The
equivalent value appears.
Notes:
• To reverse the unit fields for continuous conversions, press
the Menu soft key and select Reverse.
• For the currency converter, you may need to change
currency rates. Press the Menu soft key and Currency
rates.Extra programs
129
StopWatch
You can measure elapsed time interval.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then More soft key. Press
StopWatch.
3. Press the Start soft key to start the timer.
4. Press the Record soft key to check an interval.
You can do this step for a total of 99 intervals.
5. Press the Stop soft key to stop the stopwatch.
Voice Assist
Voice Assist is a speech recognition program that enables
you to launch programs or dial contacts by speaking an
associated command into the microphone.
Voice tips
• Speak clearly, naturally, and continuously.
• If you are in a very noisy environment, use the headset.
If you are not using the headset, address the internal
microphone at the bottom of the phone at a distance of
about 10 to 20 cm from your mouth.
• Speak when Voice Assist is ready to listen, as indicated
by the progress bar and after an audible beep.
• If Voice Assist does not clearly hear what you said, try
repeating your voice command.Extra programs
130
Using Voice Command functions
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key on the Home
screen and select More soft key and press Voice Assist.
Dialling a number
You can make a phone call by saying the name that has
been assigned to a contact in Contacts or the SIM card.
Note: To use the Name Dial feature, the name that you want
to dial must be in Contacts or the SIM card.
1. On the Voice Command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say “Name Dial”.
2. On the Name Dial screen, after a voice prompt followed
by a short beep, say a name in the following
manner:””
If Voice Assist does not hear anything until the progress
bar moves to the end, you will be asked to repeat the
command up to 3 times.
Note: You can say “Call” and then a person’s name stored in
Contacts or on the SIM card to make a call by voice
command.
3. Your phone recognises your commnad and displays a list
of one or more names in the confirmation screen.
4. Scroll to the item you want to open and press the Ok
soft key.Extra programs
131
5. If the selected name has more than one number, the
phone asks which number you want to dial.
6. If you press the Ok soft key or say nothing for 3
seconds, the phone dials the currently selected number.
Searching for contacts
You can retrieve contact information for any name in
Contacts or the SIM card by saying that name. Your phone
displays the information.
1. On the Voice command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say “Name Search”.
2. On the Name Search screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say a name in the following
manner:””
3. Your phone recognises your command and displays a list
of one or more names in the confirmation screen.
Opening programs by voice
You can use your voice to launch programs that exist in
Start menu.
1. On the Voice Command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say a program name in the
following manner:”Open ”.
2. Your phone recognises your command and displays a list
of one or more applications in the confirmation screen.
Note: If Quick Launch is checked at Settings, this
confirmation step will be skipped and the best
recoginition result wil be excuted immediately.Extra programs
132
Customising the Voice Command settings
You can customise the various settings for using Voice
Assist by pressing the Settings soft key on the Voice
Command screen.
• Timeout: Adjust the maximum time to listen to your
commands.
• Voice Guides:Check for more comprehensive voice
prompts and responses.
• Quick Launch: Check to skip the confirmation.
• Sensitivity: Ajust the sensitivity in which your phone
distinguishes the current voice and noise. Change the
setting if your phone has difficulty recognising your voice.
Picsel Viewer
Picsel Viewer allows you to view documents on your
phone without any file-conversion or loss of content.
To view a document, you must transfer documents from a
PC. If you have installed the memory card, you can view
the files stored in it.
By default, Picsel Viewer supports most common desktop
document formats, such as .doc, .xls, .ppt, .pdf and .wmf.
Note: Some document formats, such as .xls and .ppt, are not
transformed into their corresponding file types when
you copy them to your phone by using ActiveSync, so
that you cannot view the documents in the directory.
To avoid this case, change the conversion setting on the
ActiveSync screen on your computer.Extra programs
133
To open Picsel Viewer:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Picsel Viewer.
Viewing a document
On the Picsel Viewer screen, the file directory of the phone
is displayed.
1. Select the folder containing the document you want.
If you have installed a memory card, Storage Card
appears to allow you to access files on the memory
card.
2. Select the document you want to open.
Adobe PDF: , Microsoft World: , Microsoft Power
Point: , Microsoft Excel: , Plain Text: , JPEG/
BMP/GIF/PNG:
Go back to the
upper level
directory.Extra programs
134
Using options in a document view
From a document view, you can use the number keypad to
quickly perform an option. These are the keys you can use
and options assigned to each key.
• Panning: To pan to a different part of the document,
press the Navigation keys to move to the direction you
want. You can also press , , , , respectively.
• Zooming: To zoom in or out, press to switch to zoom
mode and then press the Navigation keys. You can also
press or .
• Fitting to width: To fit the width of the page on screen,
press the Menu soft key and select Page → Fit to width.
You can also press .
• Navigating: To navigate the pages, press the Menu soft
key and select Page → Next Page, Previous Page,
First page, or Last page. You can also press , , ,
or , respectively.
Viewing History
The history view shows you previously visited documents
as a small thumbnail-image of the document, and the
document’s name, location, and the date of your visiting.
To open the history view, press the Menu soft key and
select History.
To access any of the documents from the history view,
select the small picture of that page.
Note: Documents will remain on the history list until a certain
number of days have passed. You can control this
period in the option. See page 135.Extra programs
135
Viewing the Favourites list
For your favourite documents, you can keep a list in
Favourites. This looks similar to the history view but
includes only those pages you have explicitly added. Before
viewing the Favourites list, first you must add the pages to
the Favourites list.
To add the current page to the Favourites list:
1. Press the Menu soft key and select Favourites to
access the Favourites list.
2. Press the Add/Delete soft key and select Add.
3. Enter the name you want and then press the OK soft
key.
To open a favourite page:
Access the Favourites list and select the thumbnail of the
page you want.
Changing Picsel Viewer settings
On the Picsel Viewer screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Settings. The following options are available:
• Preferences: Set the period after which the thumbnail
pictures and descriptions of pages are removed from the
history memory. To clear the History list, select Clear
History.
• Files: Select the file types which can be displayed on the
Picsel Viewer screen. Select All to select all file formats.
• Help: Shows the Help screen for using Picsel Viewer.
• About: Shows information about the developers of Picsel
Viewer.Extra programs
136
File Manager
The File Manager program allows you to open an explorer
window similar to a desktop Windows based system. The
explorer window allows you to navigate through your
phone to locate the desired folders and files.
You can also quickly manage, delete, copy, or edit any files
and folders on your phone.
Note: If you turn off the phone after storing some files in any
folders, except for the Storage folder, using ActiveSync,
all of the files in those folders will be deleted. Store
important files in the Storage folder to prevent them
from being deleted.
Accessing files
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
2. Select File Manager.
The list of the folders in the phone’s memory displays.
3. Scroll to the folder that you want to view.
4. Select an item to open it. Extra programs
137
Using file management options
From the file directory, you can use the number keypad to
quickly perform an option. The options can be accessed by
pressing the Menu soft key. These are the keys you can
use and options assigned to each key.
• (Folder Tree): Returns to the folder tree screen
• (Favorites): Opens the favorite file list.
• (Properties): Shows the file properties.
• (Scroll to Top): Moves to the top of the file list.
• (Refresh): Updates the file directory.
• (Scroll up): Scrolls up by one page.
• (Scroll to End): Moves to the end of the file list.
• (Search): Allows you to search for a file by entering a
keyword. The phone will search for files under the
currently accessed folder.
• (Scroll down): Scrolls down by one page.
• (Select): Selects a file or folder.
• (Unselect All): Deselects all checked files.
• (Select All): Selects all files in the current folder.
In addition, you can access the following options:
• To use editing tools, press the Edit soft key.
• To create a new folder, press the Edit soft key and select
New Folder.
• To send a file, press the Menu soft key and select Send
→ a sending option.
• To change the order of files or folders, press the Menu
soft key and select View → a sort option.Extra programs
138
SIM Manager
The SIM Manager program enables you to view the contact
cards stored on the SIM card and to copy the contact(s)
from the SIM card to the contact list on your phone. You
can also create a new contact card on the SIM card, edit,
and delete the contact card.
Viewing SIM contacts
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → SIM Manager.
The contact list is displayed on the SIM Manager screen.
3. From the SIM contact list:
• To create a new entry, press the New soft key.
• To register the phone number and name as the own
number on the SIM card, press the Menu soft key and
select Own Number.
• To view the amount of the contacts, SMS messages,
and CB messages stored on the SIM card, press the
Menu soft key and select Memory Status.
• To refresh the SIM contacts, press the Menu soft key
and select Refresh.Extra programs
139
Copying contact cards to the Contacts
application
You can copy a contact or all contacts stored on the SIM
card to the Contacts program.
1. On the SIM Manager screen, select the check box next
to the contact name you want to copy to your phone.
If you want to copy all contacts, press the Menu soft
key and select Check → Check All #.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select SIM Tool → Copy
to Contacts.
3. To change the number category, press the Menu soft
key and select Change (M/H/W).
4. Press the Copy soft key.
5. Press the OK soft key.
Using the SIM Manager options
On the SIM Manager screen, press the Menu soft key and
select SIM Tool. The following options are available.
• View: shows the selected SIM entry.
• Edit: allows you to edit the selected entry.
• Delete Entries: allows you to delete the selected
entry(ies).
• Dial: dials the number in the selected entry.Extra programs
140
• Send SMS: sends the SMS message using the number in
the selected entry.
• Copy to Contacts: copies the selected entries to
Contacts.
• Beam: allows you to send the selected entry via an
infrared connection.
Using the SMS Tool options
Sometimes, text messages may be stored on the SIM card,
depending on their specifications. To view these messages,
press the Menu soft key and select SMS Tool. You can
view a list of the sender’s phone numbers of the received
SMS messages stored on the SIM card.
On the SIM SMS Tool screen, press the Menu soft key to
move SIM messages from the SIM card to the phone’s
memory and view or delete an SMS message.
To jump across your selection between the SIM list and the
PDA list, press the Change soft key.
Task Manager
Your phone is a multi-tasking device. It can run more than
one program at the same time. However, multi-tasking
may cause hang-ups, freezing, memory problems, and
additional power consumption. To avoid these problems,
end unnecessary programs using Task Manager.
To open Task Manager:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Accessories and then the More
soft key. Press Task Manager. The list of all the programs
currently running on your phone appears.Extra programs
141
Managing running programs
• To activate a program, press the Menu soft key and
select Activate.
• To close a program, press the Stop soft key. To close all
programs, press the Menu soft key and select Stop All.
• To refresh the program list, press the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
Checking the memory status
You can check the memory in use for running programs or
storing files and information. Press the Menu soft key and
select Memory.
Checking the storage memory
You can check the memory in use for storing files in each
storage device: Storage Card and Storage. On the Task
Manager screen, press the Menu soft key and select
Storage.
To format the memory card, press the Menu soft key and
select Format Storage Card.9
142
Getting connected
You can use your phone to exchange information with other
mobile devices as well as your desktop computer, a
network, or the Internet. You have the following connection
options:
• Use the infrared (IR) port on your device to send and
receive files between two devices.
• Exchange information between devices with Bluetooth
capabilities without a physical connection.
• Connect the phone to your computer using a USB or IrDA
connection to use the phone as a modem.
• Connect to your Internet service provider (ISP) or the
network at your company. Once connected, you can send
or receive e-mail and instant messages, and browse the
Internet or intranet.
Beaming with infrared connections
Your phone can send and receive files to and from other IR
devices. In most cases, you can also receive files from your
PC when it is equipped with an infrared port. The two
devices must be aimed at each other approximately 10
centimetres apart.Getting connected
143
If you have difficulty getting the two devices to send or
receive data, try the following:
• Make sure that the infrared port windows are clear
and free of any dirt or obstructions and that there are
no obstacles between the infrared port windows.
• Adjust the room lighting or move to another location.
Some types of lighting may interfere with
transmission.
Note: Your phone’s IrDA function is only compatible with
Microsoft Smart Phones and Windows 2000/XP
computers.
Activating or deactivating IrDA reception
You must activate the infrared port to let your phone to
detect incoming IR transmissions and receive data.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Beam.
3. Select Receive incoming beams.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Receiving data
1. Make sure that your phone’s display is activate and align
the infrared port on your phone with the one on another
device.
Note: The display on your phone must be active.
2. Have the other device send the data to your phone.
3. When prompted to receive an incoming data, press the
Yes soft key.Getting connected
144
Sending data
1. Open the item you want in a program.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam, followed by
the type of item, such as Contact or Appointment.
If you send an item in File Manager, press the Menu
soft key and select Send → via IR.
3. Align the infrared port on your phone with the one on
the other device.
The two devices starts an IrDA connection and the other
device name appears on your phone.
4. Press the Beam soft key.
Note: The display on your phone must be active.
Beaming with Bluetooth
Bluetooth is a short-range wireless communications
technology. Devices with Bluetooth capabilities can
exchange data over a distance of about 10 metres without
requiring a physical connection.
Unlike infrared, you do not need to line up the phone with
another device to beam information with Bluetooth.
Activating Bluetooth mode
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.Getting connected
145
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections →
Bluetooth → Bluetooth.
3. On the Bluetooth screen, select the operating mode you
want in the Bluetooth field.
You can use the following operating mode:
• On: The Bluetooth radio is turned on and you can use
Bluetooth features.
• Off: The Bluetooth radio is turned off. You can neither
send nor receive data by using Bluetooth.
• Discoverable: The Bluetooth radio is turned on, and
all of the other Bluetooth devices within range (about
10 meters) can detect your device and attempt to
beam data to your device, establish a bond, or use a
Bluetooth service.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Searching for and pairing with a Bluetooth
device
1. On the Bluetooth screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Devices.
2. To search for a new device, press the Menu soft key and
select New.
3. Wait for the phone to search for Bluetooth devices.
4. Select the device you want.
5. Enter a Bluetooth passkey and press the Next soft key.
This passkey is used just once and you do not need to
memorise it. Getting connected
146
When the owner of the other device enters the same
passkey, paring is finished.
Note: Some devices, especially headsets or hands-free car
kits, may have a fixed Bluetooth passkey, such as
0000. If the other device has one, you must enter the
passkey.
6. Enter a display name for the other device and press the
Next soft key.
7. Press the OK soft key.
Using the device options
When you press the Menu soft key from the device list,
you can access the following options:
• New: allows you to search for any devices.
• Edit: allows you to change the name of the connectable
device.
• Delete: allows you to delete the device.
• Set as Hands-free: allows you to use the connectable
device as a hands-free kit. You can converse with the
other person on the phone without holding the phone to
your ear during a call.
• Set as wireless Stereo: allows you to play the audio
files.Getting connected
147
Receiving data with Bluetooth
1. When a notification that a remote device is trying to
connect to your phone, press the Bluetooth passkey
entered from the device and press the Next soft key.
2. When prompted to receive an incoming data, press the
Yes soft key.
Modem link
Using Modem Link, you can set your phone to be used as
an external modem for another device or computer when
connected via the USB port or infrared port.
1. Make sure that your phone is not connected with
another device.
2. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
3. Select Accessories → Modem Link.
4. If you first access this program, press the Done soft
key.
5. Select the type of connection, baud rate, and access
point name.
6. Press the Activate soft key to activate Modem Link.
7. Press the Done soft key.
Note:
• When Modem Link is activated, you cannot use ActiveSync.
• When Windows Service Pack 2 is used, Internet access using
Modem Link is more stable.Getting connected
148
Connecting to the Internet or your
network
You can use the Connections settings to create dial-up,
Virtual Private Network (VPN), GPRS, and proxy
connections so that you can connect to the Internet or your
corporate network. By using a data connection, you can
browse the Internet, download e-mails, chat by using
MSN®
Messenger, or synchronise remotely with an
Exchange Server. Check with your service provider to see if
a data connection has already been set up for you, and if
over-the-air configuration is supported.
Creating a dial-up connection
You can create a dial-up connection to connect remotely to
the Internet, a Wireless Application Protocol (WAP)
network, or your corporate network. Then, when you open
a program that is configured to use this connection, the
phone uses it to automatically connect to the network.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Dial up.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects to: Select a type of network for which the
connection will be used.
• Phone number: Enter the dial-up number you use to
connect to the network.
• User name: Enter your network user name.Getting connected
149
• Password: Enter your password.
• Domain: Enter the domain name, if required.
Notes:
• If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask your
service provider.
• If you subscribe to General Packet Radio Service (GPRS),
you can set up a GPRS connection to access your corporate
network or the Internet, which is faster than a dial-up
connection. For details, see “Creating a GPRS connection.”
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a GPRS connection
If you subscribe to General Packet Radio Services (GPRS),
you can set up a GPRS connection to gain access to your
corporate network or the Internet. This is faster than a
dial-up connection.
You can also use your phone as a GPRS modem for a
desktop computer.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → GPRS.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects to: Select a network type for which the
connection will be used.Getting connected
150
• Access point: Enter the information provided by your
system administrator.
• User name: Enter your user name for the GPRS
network.
• Password: Enter your password.
• Primary DNS: Enter the primary domain naming
system (DNS) address.
• Secondary DNS: Enter the secondary DNS address.
• IP address: Enter the Internet Protocol (IP) address.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your network administrator.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a proxy connection
You can use a proxy connection to gain access to the
Internet over an existing connection to your corporate
network.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Proxy.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects from: Select the type of network from
which you will connect.
• Connects to: Select the type of network to which you
will connect.Getting connected
151
• Proxy (name:port): Enter the proxy server name
and port number in the form.
• Type: Select a network type for which proxy
connection will be used.
• User name: Enter your user name for the network to
which you will connect.
• Password: Enter your password.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your service provider.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a VPN connection
If your company has set up a virtual private network
(VPN), you can create a VPN connection to gain access to
your corporate network over an Internet connection.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → More...
→ VPN.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• VPN type: Select the type of VPN.
• Server: Enter the VPN server name.
• Connects from: Select the type of network from
which you will connect to VPN (typically The
Internet).Getting connected
152
• Connects to: Select the type of network to which you
will connect (typically Work).
• User name: Enter your user name for the VPN.
• Password: Enter your password.
• Domain: Enter the domain name, if required.
• IPSec authentication: If you selected IPSec/L2TP
for VPN type, select the type of authentication.
• IPSec Pre-shared key: If you selected Pre-Shared
Key for IPSec authentication, enter the shared key.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your network administrator.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Setting up data connections
After creating connection profiles, you can assign a profile
to each network type.
1. On the Connections screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Advanced.
2. Select a connection profile in each network.
3. Press the Done soft key.Getting connected
153
Adding a URL exception
Some URLs for Web pages on your company intranet may
use periods, for example: intranet.companyname.com. To
view these pages in Internet Explorer, you must create a
URL exception.
Note: You do not need to create URL exceptions for Internet
URLs.
1. On the Connections screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Advanced.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Work URL
Exceptions.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the URL and press the Done soft key. Separate
multiple URLs with a semicolon.
Changing the data connection options
On the Advanced screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Options to access the following options:
• Redial attempts: Select the redial attempt to connect
the Internet or your network after an unsuccessful
connection.
• Idle disconnect after: Select the length of time your
phone waits for connecting to the Internet or your
network after the specified period, your phone will
disconnect from the Internet or your network.
• My desktop connects to: Select the type of network to
which your desktop computer will connect.10
154
Troubleshooting
General problems
Problem Description & Solution
“Invalid or
missing SIM card.
You can still make
emergency calls if
your service
provider supports
it” displays
Check that the SIM card has been
correctly installed.
“No network
coverage,” “Error
unable to connect.
No network
coverage.” or
“Message sending
failed” displays
• The network connection has been lost.
You may be in a weak signal area (in a
tunnel or surrounded by buildings).
Move and try again.
• You are trying to access an option for
which you have not taken out a
subscription with your service provider.
Contact the service provider for further
details.
The bars next to
disappear
• If you have just turned on your phone,
wait about 2 minutes, until your phone
finds the network and receives a signal
from the network.
• If you are in a tunnel or in an elevator,
the phone may not be able to receive
the network signal properly. Move to
an open place.
• This may appear when you move
between different service areas. It is
normal.
The display is not
clear
In direct sunlight, you may not see the
display clearly. Moving to a place with
different lighting should solve this
problem.Troubleshooting
155
White lines
appear on the
display
This may happen if you turn on the
phone after a long period of disuse, or
after removing the battery without
turning off the phone. This is not related
to the phone’s life or performance. The
display should correct itself shortly.
“PIN code”
appears
• You are using your phone for the first
time. You must enter the Personal
Identification Number (PIN) supplied
with the SIM card.
• The PIN check feature has been
enabled. Each time the phone is
switched on, the PIN has to be
entered. To disable this feature, press
the Start soft key and select Settings
→ More... → Security → Disable SIM
PIN, and enter the PIN.
“PUK Required”
appears
The PIN code was entered incorrectly
three times in succession and the SIM
card is now blocked. Enter the PUK
supplied by your service provider.
I forgot the lock,
PIN, initialisation,
or PUK codes
If you forget or lose the lock code,
contact your phone dealer. If you forget
or lose a PIN or PUK code, or if you have
not received such a code, contact your
network provider. For information about
passwords, contact your access point
provider, for example, a commercial
Internet Service Provider (ISP), service
provider, or network operator.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
156
Call problems
Problem Description & Solution
I have entered a
number but it was
not dialled
• Be sure that you have pressed
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
network is unobstructed.
• You may have set an outgoing call
barring option.
My correspondent
cannot reach me
• Be sure that your phone is switched on
( pressed for more than one second)
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
network is unobstructed.
• You may have set an incoming call
barring option.
My correspondent
cannot hear me
speaking
• Be sure that you have switched on the
microphone
• Make sure that the phone is close
enough to your mouth The microphone
is located at the bottom of the phone.
The audio quality
of the call is poor
• Adjust the voice volume by pressing
.
• Check the signal strength indicator on
the display ( ); the number of bars
indicates the signal strength, from
strong to weak.
• Try moving the phone slightly or
moving closer to a window if you are in
a building.Troubleshooting
157
Power and charging problems
Calls to and from
the phone are not
connected
properly, and are
easily
disconnected
• Signals from the network are weak.
Move to another area.
• Touching the antenna area on the top
of the phone may lower the call quality.
Be careful not to touch the antenna
area while using the phone.
Problem Description & Solution
While charging,
the LED on the
travel charger
blinks
• Disconnect the phone from the travel
charger, remove the battery, and then
replace it. Try charging again.
• If the problem persists, clean the
metal contacts on the battery and the
phone.
• If the actions above do not clear the
problem, contact a Samsung service
representative.
The phone
malfunctions or
does not function
Remove the battery and then replace it.
Turn on the phone. Or press the hole on
the bottom of the phone to perform a
soft reset. If the problem persists,
contact a Samsung service
representative.
The LED on the
travel charger
turns to yellow
The travel charger is overheated.
Disconnect the charger from the phone
or unplug it from the power outlet. Wait
until the charger cools down and then
recharge the phone.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
158
The battery’s
standby time is
shorter than
expected
• Batteries are subject to wear and tear.
Standby time may grow shorter as
time passes.
• Leaving the fully charged battery in a
cold or hot place for a long period of
time may reduce battery life.
• Standby time depends on where you
use the phone. The actual time may
differ from the battery’s specifications.
Is it OK if I leave
the phone
connected to the
power outlet after
it is fully charged
(indicated by the
green LED on the
charger is on)
We recommend that you disconnect the
phone from the charger or unplug the
charger from the power outlet.
The phone
becomes hot
This may happen when you are on the
phone or when you use programs, such
as games, the Internet, or the camera,
because the phone needs more power at
those times. This does not affect the
phone’s life and performance.
The battery level
seem sufficient,
but the phone
does not turn on
• Remove the battery from the phone
and reinstall it. Then turn on the
phone.
• Clean the metal contacts both on the
battery and on the phone. Reinstall the
battery and turn on the phone.
The phone turns
off when the
charger is
connected
Some dust on the contacts may cause
unexpected power-off or charging
problems. Clean the metal contacts both
on the battery and on the phone.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
159
Application problems
Problem Description & Solution
“Not enough
memory to
perform
operation. Delete
some data first.”
or “Memory low.
Delete some
data.” displays
To view what kind of data you have and
how much memory the different data
groups consume, press the Start soft
key and then the More soft key, and
select Accessories and then the More
soft key , and press Task Manager.
Press the Menu soft key and select
Memory. Delete old items from
programs. If necessary, make a backup
copy of your data using ActiveSync or
the memory card.
Browser
“Unable to
connect. Verify
your Dial-up or
proxy settings are
correct, and try
again.” displays
Insert proper browser settings. Contact
your service provider for instructions.
The phone is
unable to connect
to the Internet
• Check if you have set up and are
connected to an Internet service
provider.
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
GPRS network is not obstructed.
• Verify with your service provider that
your user name and password are
correct.
• Verify with your Internet service
provider that the network you are
trying to connect is available, or try to
connect it from another PC.Troubleshooting
160
Camera
Images seem
smudged
Check that the camera lens protection
window is clean.
Contacts
No number is
dialled when you
recall a contact
card
• Check that a number has been stored
in the contact card.
• Re-store the number, if necessary.
Infrared
Data does not
transfer via an
infrared
connection
• Line up the infrared ports of two
devices so that they are unobstructed
and within close range.
• Make sure that nothing is between the
two infrared ports.
• Adjust the room lighting. Some types
of light interfere with infrared
connections. Try moving to a different
location or turning off some lights.
Bluetooth
I cannot end a
Bluetooth
connection
If another device is connected to your
phone, you can either end the
connection using the other device or by
deactivating Bluetooth. Go to Bluetooth
and select Bluetooth → Off.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
161
I cannot find my
friend’s
Bluetoothenabled device
• Check that both have activated
Bluetooth.
• Check that the distance between the
two devices is not over 10 metres or
that there are no walls or other
obstructions between the devices.
• Check that the other device is not in
Hidden mode.
• Check that both devices are
compatible.
I cannot discover
the remote
Bluetooth stereo
headset
• Check if the Bluetooth functionality on
the phone is turned on.
• Check if the remote Bluetooth stereo
headset is in the discoverable mode.
• Check if the remote Bluetooth device
has the capability to act as a stereo
headset.
I cannot connect
to the remote
Bluetooth stereo
headset
Ensure that the correct passkey was
entered on the phone during the
connection with the headset. Most
Bluetooth headsets have a fixed passkey
that would be mentioned in their user’s
guide. You would need to enter the
passkey when establishing a connection
with the headset.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
162
I cannot listen to
music on the
remote Bluetooth
stereo headset
• Ensure that you are connected to the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Ensure that the song that you are
playing is one of the supported
formats.
• Check the battery levels on the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Ensure that the phone and headset are
within range of each other. The
maximum distance between the two
should not be more than 10 metres.
There are breaks
in the music being
played on the
remote Bluetooth
stereo headset
• You may observe breaks if there are
walls that separate the phone and the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Be sure that the Bluetooth
functionality on the phone is turned on
and you have set the phone to be
detected by other devices.
Call history
The call history
appears empty
You may have activated a filter, and no
communication events fitting that filter
have been logged. To see all events,
press the Start soft key and select Call
History. Press the Menu soft key and
select Filter → No Filter.
Messaging
I cannot select a
contact card when
creating a
message
If the contact card does not have a
phone number or e-mail address, you
cannot select it. Add the missing
information to the contact card in
Contacts.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
163
If the above guidelines do not help you to solve the
problem, take note of:
• the model and serial numbers of your phone
• your warranty details
• a clear description of the problem
Then contact your local dealer or Samsung after-sales
service.
PC connectivity
Problems occur
when connecting
the phone to a PC
Make sure that ActiveSync is installed
and running on your PC. See the user’s
guide for ActiveSync on the CD-ROM.
For further information on how to use
ActiveSync, see the help function on
ActiveSync or visit www.microsoft.com.
Problem Description & Solution11
164
Regulatory notices
SAR certification information
This phone meets European Union (EU) requirements
concerning exposure to radio waves.
Your mobile phone is a radio transmitter and receiver. It is
designed and manufactured so as not to exceed the limits
for exposure to radio-frequency (RF) energy, as
recommended by the EU Council. These limits are part of
comprehensive guidelines and establish permitted levels of
RF energy for the general population. The guidelines were
developed by independent scientific organisations through
the periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies.
The limits include a substantial safety margin designed to
ensure the safety of all persons, regardless of age and
health.
The exposure standard for mobile phones employs a unit of
measurement known as SAR (Specific Absorption Rate).
The SAR limit recommended by the EU Council is 2.0W/Kg.
*
The highest SAR value for this model phone was 0.774 w/
Kg.
* The SAR limit for mobile phones used by the public is 2.0 watts/kilogram (W/
kg) averaged over ten grams of body tissue. The limit incorporates a
substantial margin of safety to give additional protection for the public and to
account for any variations in measurements. The SAR values may vary
depending on national reporting requirements and the network band.Regulatory notices
165
SAR tests are conducted using standard operating positions
with the phone transmitting at its highest certified power
level in all tested frequency bands. Although the SAR is
determined at the highest certified power level, the actual
SAR level of the phone while operating can be well below
the maximum value. This is because the phone is designed
to operate at multiple power levels so as to use only the
power required to reach the network. In general, the closer
you are to a base station, the lower the power output of the
phone.
Before a new model phone is made available for sale to the
public, compliance with the European R&TTE Directive must
be shown. This directive includes as one of its essential
requirements the protection of the health and safety of the
user and any other person.
European union notice
Products with CE marking comply with the R&TTE Directive
(99/5/EC), the EMC Directive (89/336/EEC) and the Low
Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC) issued by the Commission of
the European Community.
Compliance with these directives implies conformity to the
following European Norms (in brackets are the equivalent
international standards):
• EN 60950 (IEC 60950) - Safety of Information
Technology Equipment
• ETS 300 342-1 (June 1997) - Electromagnetic
compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM);
ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC) for European digital
cellular telecommunications system (GSM 900MHz, GSM
1800MHz, and GSM 1900MHz); Part 1: Mobile and
portable radio and ancillary equipmentRegulatory notices
166
• GSM11.10
• ANSI/IEEE C.95.1-1992- specific absorption rate in
mobile phone emission condition for body health
• FCC part 15 and part24
• prENV50166-2, 1995 for SAR
• SAR: 0.774mW/10g
Important safety information
Retain and follow all product safety and operating
instructions. Observe all warnings on the product and in
the operating instructions.
To reduce the risk of bodily injury, electric shock, fire, and/
or damage to the equipment, observe the following
precautions:
General precautions
Heed service markings: Except as explained elsewhere
in the Operating or Service documentation, do not service
any product yourself. Service needed on components inside
these compartments should be done by an authorised
service technician or provider.
Damage requiring service: Unplug the product from the
electrical outlet and refer servicing to an authorised service
technician or provider under the following conditions:
• Liquid has been spilled or an object has fallen into the
product.
• The product has been exposed to rain or water.Regulatory notices
167
• The product has been dropped or damaged.
• There are noticeable signs of overheating.
• The product does not operate normally when you follow
the operating instructions.
Avoid hot areas: The product should be placed away from
heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or
other products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
Avoid wet areas: Never use the product in a wet location.
Avoid pushing objects into product: Never push objects
of any kind into cabinet slots or other openings in the
product. Slots and openings are provided for ventilation.
These openings must not be blocked or covered.
Mounting Accessories: Do not use the product on an
unstable table, cart, stand, tripod, or bracket. Any
mounting of the product should follow the manufacturer’s
instructions, and should use a mounting accessory
recommended by the manufacturer.
Avoid unstable mounting: Do not place the product with
an unstable base.
Use product with approved equipment: This product
should be used only with personal computers and options
identified as suitable for use with your equipment.
Adjust the volume: Turn down the volume before using
headphones or other audio devices.
Cleaning: Unplug the product from the wall outlet before
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
Use a damp cloth for cleaning, but NEVER use water to
clean an LCD screen.Regulatory notices
168
Safety precautions for power supply
unit
Use the correct external power source: A product should be
operated only from the type of power source indicated on
the electrical ratings label. If you are not sure of the type of
power source required, consult your authorised service
provider or local power company. For a product that
operates from battery power or other sources, refer to the
operating instructions that are included with the product.
Handle battery packs carefully: This product contains a
Lithium Polymer battery.
There is a risk of fire and burns if the battery pack is
handled improperly. Do not attempt to open or service the
battery pack. Do not disassemble, crush, puncture, short
external contacts or circuits, dispose of in fire or water, or
expose a battery pack to temperatures of higher than 60°C
(140°F).
Note: Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with specified batteries. Dispose of used
batteries according to the local regulations or reference
guide supplied with your product.Regulatory notices
169
Care and maintenance
Your phone is a product of superior design and
craftsmanship and should be treated with care. The
suggestions below will help you fulfill any warranty
obligations and allow you to enjoy this product for many
years.
• Keep the phone and all its parts and accessories out of
the reach of small children and pets. They may
inadvertently damage these things or choke on small
parts.
• Keep the phone dry. Precipitation, humidity and liquids
contain minerals that corrode electronic circuits.
• Do not use the phone with a wet hand. Doing so may
cause an electric shock to you or damage to the phone.
• Do not use or store the phone in dusty, dirty areas, as its
moving parts may be damaged.
• Do not store the phone in hot areas. High temperatures
can shorten the life of electronic devices, damage
batteries, and warp or melt certain plastics.
• Do not store the phone in cold areas. When the phone
warms up to its normal operating temperature, moisture
can form inside the phone, which may damage the
phone’s electronic circuit boards.
• Do not drop, knock or shake the phone. Rough handling
can break internal circuit boards.
• Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents or strong
detergents to clean the phone. Wipe it with a soft cloth
slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-water solution.Regulatory notices
170
• Do not paint the phone. Paint can clog the device’s
moving parts and prevent proper operation.
• Do not put the phone in or on heating devices, such as a
microwave oven, a stove or a radiator. The phone may
explode when overheated.
• When the phone or battery gets wet, the label indicating
water damage inside the phone changes colour. In this
case, phone repairs are no longer guaranteed by the
manufacturer's warranty, even if the warranty for your
phone has not expired.
• If your phone has a flash or light, do not use it too close
to the eyes of people or animals. This may cause damage
to their eyes.
• Use only the supplied or an approved replacement
antenna. Unauthorised antennas or modified accessories
may damage the phone and violate regulations governing
radio devices.
• If the phone, battery, charger or any accessory is not
working properly, take it to your nearest qualified service
facility. The personnel there will assist you, and if
necessary, arrange for service.Regulatory notices
171
Microsoft End User License
Agreement
• You have acquired a device (“DEVICE”) that includes
software licensed by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. from
an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation (“MS”), for use in
connection with wireless network services provided under
separate agreement between you and a wireless
telecommunications provider (“Mobile Operator”). Those
installed software products of MS origin, as well as
associated media, printed materials, and “online” or
electronic documentation (“SOFTWARE”) are protected
by international intellectual property laws and treaties.
The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved.
• IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE
AGREEMENT (“EULA”), DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR
COPY THE SOFTWARE. INSTEAD, PROMPTLY CONTACT
SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO., LTD. FOR INSTRUCTIONS
ON RETURN OF THE UNUSED DEVICE(S) FOR A REFUND.
ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO USE ON THE DEVICE, WILL
CONSTITUTE YOUR AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA (OR
RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CONSENT).
• SOFTWARE includes software already installed on the
DEVICE (“DEVICE Software”) and MS software
contained on the CD-ROM disk (“Companion CD”).Regulatory notices
172
GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE
This EULA grants you the following license:
DEVICE Software. You may use the DEVICE Software as
installed on the DEVICE. All or certain portions of the
DEVICE Software may be inoperable if you do not have and
maintain a service account with an appropriate Mobile
Operator, or if the Mobile Operator's network facilities are
not operating or configured to operate with the DEVICE
software.
COMPANION CD. Additional software for your personal
computer is included with your DEVICE, and you may
install and use the Microsoft® ActiveSync® component on
one (1) or more computers to exchange information with
one (1) or more computing devices that contain a
compatible version of the Microsoft® phone 2003
Software. For other software component(s) contained in
the Companion CD, you may install and use such
components only in accordance with the terms of the
printed or online end user license agreement(s) provided
with such component(s). In the absence of an end user
license agreement for particular component(s) of the
Companion CD, you may install and use only one (1) copy
of such component(s) on the DEVICE or a single computer
with which you use the DEVICE.
Microsoft® Outlook® 2002. If Microsoft Outlook 2002 is
included with your Device, the following terms apply to
your use of Microsoft Outlook 2002: (i) regardless of the
information contained in “Software Installation and Use”
section of the online EULA you may install one (1) copy of
Microsoft Outlook 2002 on one (1) computer to use,
exchange data, share data, access and interact with the
DEVICE, and (ii) the EULA for Microsoft Outlook 2002 is
between the Company and the end user - not between the
PC manufacturer and end user.Regulatory notices
173
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS
AND LIMITATIONS
• Speech/Handwriting Recognition. If the SOFTWARE
includes speech and/or handwriting recognition
component(s), you should understand that speech and
handwriting recognition are inherently statistical
processes; that recognition errors are inherent in the
processes; and that errors can occur in the component's
recognition of your handwriting, and the final conversion
into text. Neither Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. nor its
suppliers shall be liable for any damages arising out of
errors in the speech and handwriting recognition
processes.
• Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation
and Disassembly. You may not reverse engineer,
decompile, or disassemble the SOFTWARE, except and
only to the extent that such activity is expressly
permitted by applicable law notwithstanding this
limitation.
• Single DEVICE. The DEVICE Software is licensed with
the DEVICE as a single integrated product. The DEVICE
Software installed in read only memory (“ROM”) of the
DEVICE may only be used as part of the DEVICE.
• Single EULA. The package for the DEVICE may contain
multiple versions of this EULA, such as multiple
translations and/or multiple media versions (e.g., in the
user documentation and in the software). Even if you
receive multiple versions of the EULA, you are licensed to
use only one (1) copy of the DEVICE Software. Regulatory notices
174
• NOTICE REGARDING THE MPEG-4 VISUAL
STANDARD. The SOFTWARE may include MPEG-4 visual
decoding technology. MPEG LA, L.L.C. requires the
following notice:
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE IN ANY MANNER THAT
COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG 4 VISUAL STANDARD IS
PROHIBITED, EXCEPT FOR USE DIRECTLY RELATED TO
(A) DATA OR INFORMATION (i) GENERATED BY AND
OBTAINED WITHOUT CHARGE FROM A CONSUMER NOT
THEREBY ENGAGED IN A BUSINESS ENTERPRISE, AND
(ii) FOR PERSONAL USE ONLY; AND (B) OTHER USES
SPECIFICALLY AND SEPARATELY LICENSED BY MPEG LA,
L.L.C.
If you have questions regarding this Notice, please
contact MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250 Steele Street, Suite 300,
Denver, Colorado 80206; Telephone 303 331.1880; FAX
303 331.1879
• Rental. You may not rent or lease the SOFTWARE.
• Software Transfer. You may not permanently transfer
any of your rights under this EULA with regard to the
DEVICE Software or Companion CD, except as permitted
by the applicable Mobile Operator. In the event that the
Mobile Operator permits such transfer, you may
permanently transfer all of your rights under this EULA
only as part of a sale or transfer of the DEVICE, provided
you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE
(including all component parts, the media and printed
materials, any upgrades, this EULA and, if applicable, the
Certificate(s) of Authenticity), and the recipient agrees to
the terms of this EULA. If the SOFTWARE is an upgrade,
any transfer must include all prior versions of the
SOFTWARE.Regulatory notices
175
• Termination. Without prejudice to any other rights,
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. or MS may terminate this
EULA if you fail to comply with the terms and conditions
of this EULA. In such event, you must destroy all copies
of the SOFTWARE and all of its component parts.
• Security Updates. The SOFTWARE may include digital
rights management technology. If SOFTWARE does
contain digital rights management technology, content
providers are using the digital rights management
technology (“Microsoft DRM”) contained in the
SOFTWARE to protect the integrity of their content
(“Secure Content”) so that their intellectual property,
including copyright, in such content is not
misappropriated. Owners of such Secure Content
(“Secure Content Owners”) may, from time to time,
request MS, Microsoft Corporation or their subsidiaries to
provide security related updates to the Microsoft DRM
components of the SOFTWARE (“Security Updates”) that
may affect your ability to copy, display and/or play
Secure Content through Microsoft software or third party
applications that utilize Microsoft DRM. You therefore
agree that, if you elect to download a license from the
Internet which enables your use of Secure Content, MS,
Microsoft Corporation or their subsidiaries may, in
conjunction with such license, also download onto your
DEVICE such Security Updates that a Secure Content
Owner has requested that MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their subsidiaries distribute. MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their subsidiaries will not retrieve any personally
identifiable information, or any other information, from
your DEVICE by downloading such Security Updates. Regulatory notices
176
• Consent to Use of Data. You agree that MS, Microsoft
Corporation and their affiliates may collect and use
technical information gathered in any manner as part of
product support services related to the SOFTWARE. MS,
Microsoft Corporation and their affiliates may use this
information solely to improve their products or to provide
customized services or technologies to you. MS, Microsoft
Corporation and their affiliates may disclose this
information to others, but not in a form that personally
identifies you.
• Internet Gaming/Update Features. If the SOFTWARE
provides, and you choose to utilize, the Internet gaming
or update features within the SOFTWARE, it is necessary
to use certain computer system, hardware, and software
information to implement the features. By using these
features, you explicitly authorize MS, Microsoft
Corporation and/or their designated agent to use this
information solely to improve their products or to provide
customized services or technologies to you. MS or
Microsoft Corporation may disclose this information to
others, but not in a form that personally identifies you.
• Internet-Based Services Components. The
SOFTWARE may contain components that enable and
facilitate the use of certain Internet-based services. You
acknowledge and agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their affiliates may automatically check the version of the
SOFTWARE and/or its components that you are utilizing
and may provide upgrades or supplements to the
SOFTWARE that may be automatically downloaded to
your Device.Regulatory notices
177
• Links to Third Party Sites. The SOFTWARE may
provide you with the ability to link to third party sites
through the use of the SOFTWARE. The third party sites
are not under the control of MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their affiliates. Neither MS nor Microsoft Corporation nor
their affiliates are responsible for (i) the contents of any
third party sites, any links contained in third party sites,
or any changes or updates to third party sites, or (ii)
webcasting or any other form of transmission received
from any third party sites. If the SOFTWARE provides
links to third party sites, those links are provided to you
only as a convenience, and the inclusion of any link does
not imply an endorsement of the third party site by MS,
Microsoft Corporation or their affiliates.
• Additional Software/Services. The SOFTWARE may
permit Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd., MS, Microsoft
Corporation or their affiliates to provide or make
available to you SOFTWARE updates, supplements, addon components, or Internet-based services components
of the SOFTWARE after the date you obtain your initial
copy of the SOFTWARE (“Supplemental Components”).
• If Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. provides or makes
available to you Supplemental Components and no other
EULA terms are provided along with the Supplemental
Components, then the terms of this EULA shall apply.
• If MS, Microsoft Corporation or their affiliates make
available Supplemental Components, and no other EULA
terms are provided, then the terms of this EULA shall
apply, except that the MS, Microsoft Corporation or
affiliate entity providing the Supplemental Component(s)
shall be the licensor of the Supplemental Component(s). Regulatory notices
178
• Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd., MS, Microsoft Corporation
and their affiliates reserve the right to discontinue any
Internet-based services provided to you or made
available to you through the use of the SOFTWARE.
UPGRADES AND RECOVERY MEDIA
• DEVICE Software. If the DEVICE Software is provided
by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. separate from the
DEVICE on media such as a ROM chip, CD ROM disk(s) or
via web download or other means, and is labeled “For
Upgrade Purposes Only”, you may install one copy of
such DEVICE Software onto the DEVICE as a replacement
copy for the existing DEVICE Software and use it in
accordance with this EULA, including any additional EULA
terms accompanying the upgrade DEVICE Software.
• COMPANION CD. If any Companion CD component(s) is
provided by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. separate from
the DEVICE on CD ROM disk(s) or via web download or
other means, and labeled “For Upgrade Purposes Only”,
you may (i) install and use one copy of such
component(s) on the computer(s) you use to exchange
data with the DEVICE as a replacement copy for the
existing Companion CD component(s). Regulatory notices
179
COPYRIGHT
All title and intellectual property rights in and to the
SOFTWARE (including but not limited to any images,
photographs, animations, video, audio, music, text and
“applets,” incorporated into the SOFTWARE), the
accompanying printed materials, and any copies of the
SOFTWARE, are owned by MS or its suppliers (including
Microsoft Corporation). You may not copy the printed
materials accompanying the SOFTWARE. All title and
intellectual property rights in and to the content which may
be accessed through use of the SOFTWARE is the property
of the respective content owner and may be protected by
applicable copyright or other intellectual property laws and
treaties. This EULA grants you no rights to use such
content. All rights not specifically granted under this EULA
are reserved by MS and its suppliers (including Microsoft
Corporation).
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS
You acknowledge that SOFTWARE is subject to U.S. export
jurisdiction. You agree to comply with all applicable
international and national laws that apply to the
SOFTWARE, including the U.S. Export Administration
Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use and destination
restrictions issued by U.S. and other governments. For
additional information, see http://www.microsoft.com/
exporting/.Regulatory notices
180
PRODUCT SUPPORT
Product support for the SOFTWARE is not provided by MS,
its parent corporation, Microsoft Corporation, or their
affiliates or subsidiaries. For product support, please refer
to Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. support number provided
in the documentation for the DEVICE. Should you have any
questions concerning this EULA, or if you desire to contact
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. for any other reason, please
refer to the address provided in the documentation for the
DEVICE.
NO LIABILITY FOR CERTAIN DAMAGES
EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY LAW, MS SHALL HAVE NO
LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL
OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING FROM OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THE
SOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATION SHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANY
REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
FOR APPLICABLE LIMITED WARRANTIES AND SPECIAL
PROVISIONS PERTAINING TO YOUR PARTICULAR
JURISDICTION, PLEASE REFER TO YOUR WARRANTY
BOOKLET INCLUDED WITH THIS PACKAGE OR PROVIDED
WITH THE SOFTWARE PRINTED MATERIALS.Declaration of Conformity (R&TTE)
For the following product:
GSM900/GSM1800/GSM1900 with Bluetooth
Portable Cellular Telephone
(Product description)
SGH-i320
(Model name)
Manufactured at:
- Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd, 94-1 Imsoo-Dong, Gumi City, Kyung Buk, Korea 730-350*
(factory name, address)
to which this declaration relates, is in conformity with the following standards and/or other normative
documents.
Safety : EN 60950-1:2001
EMC : EN 301 489-01 v1.4.1 (08-2002)
EN 301 489-07 v1.2.1 (08-2002)
SAR : EN 50360:2001
EN 50361:2001
Network : EN 301 511 v9.0.2 (03-2003)
EN 300 328 v1.6.1 (11-2004)
We hereby declare that [all essential radio test suites have been carried out and that] the above named
product is in conformity to all the essential requirements of Directive 1999/5/EC.
The conformity assessment procedure referred to in Article 10 and detailed in Annex[IV] of Directive 1999/5/
EC has been followed with the involvement of the following Notified Body(ies):
BABT, Balfour House, Churchfield Road,
Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK
Identification mark: 168
The technical documentation kept at:
Samsung Electronics QA Lab.
which will be made available upon request.
(Representative in the EU)
Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab.
Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way,
Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK
2006. 04. 28 Yong-Sang Park / S. Manager
(place and date of issue) (name and signature of authorised person)
* It is not the address of the Samsung Service Centre. For the address or the phone number of Samsung Service Centre, see the
warranty card or contact the retailer where you purchased your phone.World wide Web
http://www.samsungmobile.com English. 02/2006. Rev. 1.0
* Depending on the software installed or your service provider or country,
some of the descriptions in this guide may not match your phone exactly.
Smartphone
SGH-i320
User’s GuideTable of Contents
2
Table of Contents
Important safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
CHAPTER 1 Getting started
What’s in the box? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Getting to know your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Installing the SIM card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Installing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Charging your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Turning your phone on or off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
CHAPTER 2 The basics
Using the Home screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Start menu screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Entering text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Customising your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Locking the keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Using the Program Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Using an optional memory card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Adding and removing programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Managing certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Resetting your phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Using online help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
SIM AT (SIM Application Toolkit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
CHAPTER 3 Synchronisation
Installing ActiveSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Customising connection settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Connecting your phone to a computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Synchronising information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Customising synchronisation settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47Table of Contents
3
CHAPTER 4 Call functions
Turning the phone functions on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Using the Dialling screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Advanced calling features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Answering or ignoring a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Options during a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Call-related features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Customising your phone functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
CHAPTER 5 Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Internet Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
WAP Browser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Pocket MSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
CHAPTER 6 Organiser
Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
D-Day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Voice Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
WorldClock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
CHAPTER 7 Multimedia
Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Windows Media Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Picture & Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122Table of Contents
4
CHAPTER 8 Extra programs
Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Smart Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
StopWatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Voice Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Picsel Viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
File Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
SIM Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Task Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
CHAPTER 9 Getting connected
Beaming with infrared connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Beaming with Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Modem link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Connecting to the Internet or your network . . . . . . . . . 148
CHAPTER 10 Troubleshooting
General problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Call problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Power and charging problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Application problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
CHAPTER 11 Regulatory notices
SAR certification information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
European union notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Important safety information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Safety precautions for power supply unit . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Care and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Microsoft End User License Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS
AND LIMITATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1735
Important safety precautions
Read these guidelines before using your wireless phone.
Failure to comply with them may be dangerous or illegal.
Drive safely at all times
Do not use a hand-held phone while driving. Park the
vehicle first.
Switch off the phone when refuelling
Do not use the phone at a refuelling point (service station)
or near fuels or chemicals.
Switch off in an aircraft
Wireless phones can cause interference. Using them in an
aircraft is both illegal and dangerous.
Switch off the phone near all medical equipment
Hospitals or health care facilities may be using equipment
that could be sensitive to external radio frequency energy.
Follow any regulations or rules in force.
Interference
All wireless phones may be subject to interference, which
could affect their performance.
Be aware of special regulations
Meet any special regulations in force in any area and
always switch off your phone whenever it is forbidden to
use it, or when it may cause interference or danger.
Water resistance
Your phone is not water-resistant. Keep it dry.
Sensible use
Use only in the normal position (held to the ear). Avoid
unnecessary contact with the antenna when the phone is
switched on.6
Emergency calls
Key in the emergency number for your present location,
then press .
Keep your phone away from small children
Keep the phone and all its parts, including accessories, out
of the reach of small children.
Accessories and batteries
Use only Samsung-approved accessories and batteries. Use
of any unauthorised accessories could damage your phone
and may be dangerous.
CAUTION:
• The phone could explode if the battery is replaced with an
incorrect type.
• Dispose of used batteries according to the manufacturer’s
instructions.
Qualified service
Only qualified service personnel may install or repair your
phone. Failure to do so may invalidate the warranty.
For more detailed safety information, see “Important safety
information” on page 166.
Note: Depending on your country, your phone and accessories
may appear different from the illustrations in this guide.
At very high volume, prolonged listening to a
headset can damage your hearing.1
7
Getting started
Congratulations on the purchase of your new Smartphone!
This chapter helps you set up your phone, charge the
phone’s batteries, and familiarise yourself with the different
components of your phone.
What’s in the box?
Your package contains the following items:
In addition, you can obtain the following accessories for
your phone from your local Samsung dealer:
Note: The items supplied with your phone and the accessories
available at your Samsung dealer may vary, depending
on your country or service provider.
Phone PC data cable Batteries
Travel charger CD-ROMs
*
* One contains Microsoft ActiveSync software, Add-on software and
programs, and the other contains User’s Guide in PDF format.
Quick reference guide
• Car charger/adapter • Battery holder
• Standard battery • Bluetooth hands-free car kit
• Travel charger • Straight headset
• PC data cable • Bluetooth USB dongle kit
• Bluetooth mono &
stereo headsetGetting started
8
Getting to know your phone
Front view
Volume keys
Send key
Left soft key
Infrared port
Home key
OK key
Microphone
Navigation (Up/Down/
Left/Right) keys
Earpiece
Right soft key
End/Power on
or off key
Display
Back/Clear key
Alphanumeric keys/
Special function keysGetting started
9
Rear view
Keys of your phone
Battery cover
Camera lens
Charger/PC data
cable jack
Quick List/
Key Lock key
Camera key
Camera flash
Headset jack
External speaker
Key Description
• Press to open the Quick List screen.
• Press and hold to lock the keys.
• Press to open the Voice Notes program.
• Press and hold to turn on the camera.Getting started
10
• Press to adjust the earpiece and speaker
volume.
• Press to mute the call ringer as a call comes
in. Press and hold to reject the call.
Press to perform the command shown on the
screen immediately above the key.
Press to switch to the Home screen from a
program.
• Press to return to the previous screen.
• Press to delete characters in a text input field.
• Press to scroll through a list.
• Press to move the cursor in a text input field.
• Press to confirm your selection or input.
• Press to open the Dialling screen.
• Press to make or answer a call.
• Press and hold to turn the phone on or off.
• Press to end a call.
~ Press to enter numbers and characters.
Press to switch between characters on the
upper half of the keys and characters on the
lower half in a text input filed.
Press to change case in a text input field.
Press to change the text input mode.
Key DescriptionGetting started
11
Installing the SIM card
When you subscribe to a cellular network, you are provided
with a plug-in SIM card loaded with your subscription
details, such as your PIN, any optional services available,
and many other details.
• Keep all miniature SIM cards out of the reach of small
children.
• The SIM card and its contacts can be easily damaged by
scratches or bending, so be careful when handling the
card.
• When installing the SIM card, always make sure that the
phone is switched off before you remove the battery.
Press and hold to activate or deactivate the
Silent profile from the Home screen.
Press to delete characters.
• Press to confirm your selection or input.
• Press to start a new line in a text input field.
Press to open the Messaging program.
Press to enter a comma in a text input field.
Key DescriptionGetting started
12
Inserting the SIM card
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Insert and slide the SIM card under the two tabs, as
shown, ensuring that the gold coloured contacts of the
card are face down into the phone.
Continue to install the battery. See the next page.
Removing the SIM card
To remove the SIM card, slide the card out of the holder, as
shown.Getting started
13
Installing the battery
Your phone is powered by a rechargeable Li-ion battery.
Use only approved batteries and chargers.
Installing the battery
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Insert the battery into the battery compartment, with
the gold-culoured contact toward the top of the phone.
3. Close the battery cover.Getting started
14
Removing the battery
1. If necessary, switch off the phone by pressing and
holding until the power-off image displays.
2. Remove the battery cover.
3. Lift the battery away from the phone.
Charging your phone
1. Plug the connector of the travel charger into the jack on
the right side of the phone.
2. Plug the travel charger into a standard AC wall outlet.
The LED on the charger will indicate the charging
progress by the following colours:
• Red: the phone is being charged.
• Green: the phone is fully charged.
• Orange: the travel charger is not plugged in correctly.
Check the phone and the charger.
3. When charging is finished, unplug the travel charger
from the power outlet. Getting started
15
4. Remove the travel charger from the phone by pressing
the buttons on both sides of the connector and pulling
the connector out.
Note: Do not remove batteries while charging. It may cause
malfunctions and may damage the device.
Low battery warning
Your phone displays the Battery Very Low icon ( ) and a
warning message when the battery gets very low. If this
happens, charge the battery.
Turning your phone on or off
Press and hold to turn on your phone. The phone is
logged into your home network and receives the signal
from the network. You can now make or answer a call
and use programs on the phone.
To turn off the phone, press and hold .2
16
The basics
This chapter explains basic information about using your
phone, such as customising your phone and using online
help.
Using the Home screen
When you turn on your phone, the Home screen, the
phone’s idle screen, appears. You can also access this
screen by pressing from any program.
On the Home screen, you can view important information
for the day or messages at a glance. You can also quickly
switch to the programs you recently accessed.
Press the left soft key to
open the Start menu and
switch to a program.
Press the right soft
key to open
Contacts.
Status icons indicates
your phone’s current
status. See the next
page.
Quick Launcher:
Select to view
appointments or
messages, or
change the profile
settings.The basics
17
Status bar
On the top line of the screen, the Status bar displays icons
to show your phone’s current status. Followings are some
of the status icons you may see:
Icon Description
Shows the strength of the signal.
You can also view the following service status:
• : You are out of a service area.
• : The phone functions are turned off.
Appears when a call is in progress.
Appears when a data call is in progress.
Appears when the current call is on hold.
Appears when a GPRS connection is available in
the network. When a GPRS connection is active,
appears.
Appears when you are roaming out of your home
service area and logged onto a different GPRS
network.
Shows the level of your battery power. The more
bars you see, the more power you have
remaining.
When the battery level is very low, appears.
Appears when the ring type has been set to Silent
in the current profile. For details, see page 25.The basics
18
Appears when the ring type has been set to
Vibrate in the current profile or the ring tone in
Sounds has been set to Vibrate. Also, appears
when the Silent profile is activated. For details,
see page 25.
Indicates that you can make calls using phone
line 1 or 2 only (network service).
Appears when you’re roaming outside of your
home area and logged onto a different network.
Appears when Bluetooth is activated. For details,
see page 144.
Appears when a text (SMS) or multimedia (MMS)
message has been received.
Appears that an instant message has been
received.
Appears when a new voicemail has been
received.
• : A new voicemail from line 1.
• : A new voicemail from line 2.
• : A new voicemail from both lines.
Appears when there is a call you have missed.
Appears when you have set incoming calls to be
diverted to another destination.
Icon DescriptionThe basics
19
Accessing information from the Home
screen
From the Home screen, you can:
• view upcoming appointments
• change the profile option
• view unread text (SMS) or multimedia (MMS) messages
To change information on each item:
1. On the Home screen, scroll to the item you want to
change by pressing the Navigation keys and press .
2. Access appointments or messages, or change the profile
setting.
For more information on changing these items, see
the appropriate instructions for each task in this
guide.
3. Press or to return to the Home screen.The basics
20
Customising the Home screen
You can customise the Home screen according to your
preferences.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Display → Home Screen.
3. Press the Up or Down key to scroll to an option and then
Left or Right key to change the setting.
The following options are available:
• Home screen layout: Select the layout to be used for
the Home screen.
• Colour scheme: Select the colour scheme to be used
for the Home screen.
• Background image: Select an image to use as a
background image on the Home screen.
• Time out: Specify the length of time the phone waits
before returning the display to the Home screen if the
phone is not used.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Start menu screen
On the Start menu, you can access all of the programs for
your phone. From the Home screen, press the Start soft
key to open the Start menu screen.
You can change the start menu type. Press the Start soft
key, and select Settings → Display → Start Menu Style.
Then select Grid or List .The basics
21
Opening programs or folders
Scroll to a progarm or a folder by pressing the Navigation
keys and press to open it. You can also press the
number key assigned to the program you want.
Switching between programs
Your phone is a multi-tasking product. You can run multiple
programs at the same time and switch from one program
to another. From any application, press or to swich
to the Home screen. Then access another one from the
Quick Launcher or Start menu.
Note: When you use a GPRS connection, pressing
terminates the connection. If you want the current
connection to continue, press , or as many
times as necessary, to switch to the Home screen.
Closing programs
Using Task Manager, you can end the programs which are
currently open.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then More soft key, press the
Task Manager.
3. Scroll to a program, press the Stop soft key. To close all
of the running programs, Press the Menu soft key and
select Stop All.The basics
22
Entering text
Your phone is equipped with a QWERTY keypad to support
easy and quick text input. You can enter text as you would
when using a computer’s keyboard.
The keys are labelled with alphabet on the lower half and
numbers and symbols on the upper half. Press the key
corresponding to the character you want to enter. To switch
between the upper characters and lower characters, press
.
You can move the cursor by pressing the Navigation keys.
To delete a character, press .
In addition, you can use the following function keys:
• : deletes characters.
• : starts a new line.
• : changes case or switches to Capital Lock mode.
• : changes the text input mode. You can switch between
ABC mode and T9 mode in which displays the word
choices for your key presses. 123 mode and Symbol
mode are also available for entering numbers and
symbols.
• : switches to 123 mode.The basics
23
Customising your phone
You can customise the phone settings to suit the way you
work.
Regional settings
Using Regional Settings, you can change number,
currency, and time and date formats appropriate to the
countries in question.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Regional
Settings.
3. Select the option you want in each field.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
5. If you changed the Language or Locale option, press
the OK soft key.
Then you need to turn the phone off and then back on to
make your changes take effect.
Time and date settings
The Date and Time setting enables you to set the date,
time, and time zone.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Clock & Alarm → Date and Time.
Note: By using Alarm on the Clock & Alarm screen, you can
set alarms to ring at a specified time. The basics
24
3. Set your time zone and the current date and time.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Note: You can change the time and date format to be
displayed in Regional Settings.
Power settings
You can conserve battery power by adjusting the time-out
settings for the display and the backlight of the keypad and
display or adjusting the display brightness.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Power Management.
3. Select the power settings:
• Main battery: You can check the remaining battery
power.
• Backlight time out: You can select the length of time
the backlight stays on. A backlight illuminates the
display and the keypad. When you press any key, the
backlight turns on and remains on for the backlight
time out period.
• Display time out: You can select the length of time
the display stays on. During standby, the phone goes
to Sleep mode after a specified period of time, so very
little power is being consumed.
• Display Brightness: You can adjust the brightness
for the display.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
25
Accessibility settings
You can configure the options to increase the accessibility
to your phone’s functions.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Accessibility.
3. Select the options you want.
• System font size: You can set the size of the font on
your screen.
• Confirmation time out: You can set the delay before
an unconfirmed action times out.
• In-call alert volume: You can set the volume of the
alert tone that sounds when you are on a call.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Sound settings
You can customise sound settings for various events
happening on the phone.
Setting sounds and notifications
Your phone reminds you in various ways when you have
something to do, receive a message, or press the keys on
the phone.
For example, if you have set up an appointment, you are
notified in any of the following ways:
• A sound, which you can specify, plays,
• The LED indicator flashes, or
• Your phone vibrates.
You can change phone sounds by choosing types or sounds
for each event.The basics
26
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Sounds.
3. Select the event for which to specify a sound.
4. Select the reminder type or ringtone.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Notes:
• You can connect to the Internet and then download ringtones
that are in a .wav or .mid format.
• To use an .mp3 or .wma file as your call ringtone, it must be
saved in a folder in Storage, Storage Card or My Documents.
Changing the sound profile
Using Profiles, you can adjust and customise the phone
tones for different events or environments and then apply
the settings as a group. The currently selected profile
displays on the Home screen.
To change profiles:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Profiles. The list of profiles opens.
3. Select the profile you want.
If you select Automatic, the profile will automatically
switch between Normal and Meeting according to your
calendar items.
Notes:
• You can quickly change the profile. Press and select the
profile you want from the Quick List.
• You can quickly activate or deactivate the Silent profile by
pressing and holding from the Home screen.The basics
27
To customise profiles:
1. On the Profiles screen, scroll to the profile you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit.
3. Change the settings in each field. Available options may
differ depending on the selected profile.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Notes:
• To change all profile settings to their factory default, press
the Menu soft key from the profile list and select Reset to
default.
• For the Headset profile, when you set the ring type to Silent
or Vibrate, you must manually answer calls even if the
Auto-answer in option is activated.
Owner information
Owner Information identifies the owner or user of the
phone. Set your contact information in case you have lost
the phone.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Owner
Information.
3. Fill in each input field.
To attach notes, enter notes in the Notes field.
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
28
USB function setting
You can select how the phone functions when connected to
a computer via the USB port.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → USB.
3. Select one of the following functions for USB
connections:
• ActiveSync: Select this option if you want the phone
to communicate with ActiveSync.
• Mass Storage: The phone is perceived as an external
memory device.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Error reporting setting
Your phone has the Error Reporting function which informs
you of errors in a program that can give a crash to the
phone system. You can enable or disable this function.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → More... → Error
Reporting.
3. Select Enable or Disable and press the Done soft key.The basics
29
Security settings
With options in Security, you can protect your phone and
SIM card from unauthorised use.
Locking the phone
You can protect your phone using the Device Lock feature.
Once the feature is enabled, your phone is automatically
locked after the specified period of inactivity.
Note: Even if the phone is locked, you will be able to receive
calls.
To lock the phone:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Device Lock.
3. Select Prompt if device unused for and select a
length of time the phone waits for before locking itself
when it is not in use.
4. Scroll to the Password type field and select a password
type.
• Simple PIN: Use the PIN code supplied with the SIM
card.
• Strong alphanumeric: Use an alphanumeric
password. A password must be more than 7 characters
and contain at least 3 of uppercase and lowercase
letters, numbers, or punctuation marks.
5. Enter a password in the Password field.
6. Re-enter the same password in the Confirm password
field for confirmation. The basics
30
7. Press the Done soft key.
8. Press the Yes soft key.
Note: You can also manually lock the phone by pressing
and selecting Device lock from the Quick List.
To unlock your phone:
1. On the Home screen, press the Unlock soft key.
2. Enter the password and press the Done soft key.
Activating the SIM PIN
When SIM PIN is enabled, you must enter your PIN
supplied with your phone each time you turn the phone on
or insert the current SIM card into another device.
Consequently, any person who does not have your PIN
cannot use your phone without your approval.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Enable SIM
PIN.
3. Enter the PIN and press the Done soft key.
Locking the SIM card
When SIM Lock is enabled, your phone works only with the
current SIM card. To use another SIM card, you must enter
the SIM Lock password.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Enable SIM
Lock.The basics
31
3. Enter a password for your SIM card, and re-enter the
password for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Changing PIN2
A PIN 2 is used for certain functions supported by the SIM
card. You can change the PIN2 supplied with your SIM card
to a new one.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Change
PIN2.
3. Enter the current PIN2, then a new PIN2, and re-enter
the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Changing the call barring Password
You can change the default call barring password supplied
by your service provider.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Call Barring
Password.
3. Enter the current password, then a new password, and
re-enter the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.The basics
32
Menu shortcut settings
The number keys can be used as shortcut keys to directly
access specific programs that exist in the Start menu.
Note: You can also assign phone numbers, e-mail addresses,
or web pages in Contacts to the number keys as speed
dial entries. For details about setting the speed dial list,
see page 57.
Assigning a shortcut to a key
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Scroll to the program you want to assign to a key.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add Speed Dial.
4. If necessary, enter the name you want in the Name
field.
5. Select a location in the Keypad assignment field and
press the Done soft key.
Note: Up to 99 locations are available. Locations 0 and 1 are
reserved for the international call prefix “+” and the
voicemail centre number, respectively.
Accessing a menu using its shortcut
On the Home screen, use one of the following ways:
• For one-digit shourtcut keys, press and hold the number
key.
• For two-digit shortcut keys, press the first number key
and then press and hold the last number key.The basics
33
Note: To ensure that operations, such as moving or saving
files, proceed to completion, wait at least 50 seconds
before removing the battery.
Locking the keys
You can lock the keys on the phone to keep any accidental
key presses from causing a program’s launch or phone
switch on or off.
To lock the keypad, press and hold , or press and
select Key lock on the Quick List.
To unlock the keypad, press the Unlock soft key, and then
press .
Using the Program Launcher
Using the Program Launcher, you can view the programs in
the Start menu categorised by type, and quickly access
the program you want.
To open the Launcher:
Press and hold on the Home screen. You can also press
the Start soft key and then the More soft key, and select
Accessories → Program Launcher.
Opening a program
1. On the Launcher screen, press the Group soft key and
select the group you want.
2. Select the program you want.The basics
34
Moving a program within a group
1. On the Launcher screen, scroll to the program you want
to move.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Move.
3. When the selected program blinks, move the program to
the position you want by pressing the Up or Down key.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Managing groups
You can create new groups or delete the groups, or change
the order of the group list.
1. On the Launcher screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Group.
2. Press the Menu soft key to access the following options:
• New: allows you to add a new group.
• Delete: allows you to delete the selected group.
• Rename: allows you to change the name of the
group.
• Move: allows you to move the position of the group.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.The basics
35
Using an optional memory card
Your phone has an expansion slot compatible with micro SD
memory cards, which are primarily used to back up or
transfer files and data.
Note: Use only compatible memory cards with your phone.
Using incompatible memory cards, such as Secure
Digital (SD) cards, may damage the card, as well as the
phone, and data stored on the card.
Inserting the memory card
1. Turn off the phone and remove the battery cover and
the battery.
2. Push the memory card into the slot until it clicks into
place. The card is secure when it is not protruding from
the phone.
3. Install the battery into place and close the battery cover.The basics
36
Removing the memory card
To remove the card, push it in and release so that it is
disengaged from the slot. Then slide the card out.
Adding and removing programs
You can install any program created for your phone, as long
as the phone has enough memory. The most popular place
to find software for your phone is on the Microsoft web site
(http://www.microsoft.com/mobile/smartphone).
Adding programs using ActiveSync
You can install programs downloaded from the Internet or
included on the supplied software CD-ROM by performing
synchronisation between your phone and your computer.
First you need to determine what your phone and
processor type is so that you know which version of the
software to install.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Settings → More... → More... → About. Check the
version of your phone.The basics
37
2. Download a program to your computer from the
Internet or insert the CD-ROM that contains the
program into your computer.
Be sure to select the program designed for the phone
and your phone’s processor type.
3. Read any installation instructions, Read Me files, or
documentation that comes with the program.
4. Connect your phone to your computer and make sure
that the ActiveSync is activated.
For more information on ActiveSync, see page 42.
5. Double-click the *.exe file on the computer.
If the file is an installer, the installation wizard will
begin. Follow the instructions on the screen. Once the
software has been installed, the installer will
automatically transfer the software to your phone.
If the file is not an installer, you will see an error
message. You need to move this file to your phone by
using ActiveSync Explore to copy the program file to the
Start Menu folder on your phone.
Once installation is completed, you can view and open the
program by accessing the Start menu.
Adding a program directly from the
Internet
First, you need to determine what your phone and
processor type is so that you know which version of the
software to install.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Settings → More... → More... → About. Check the
version of your phone.The basics
38
2. Download the program to your phone straight from the
Internet using Internet Explorer.
Be sure to select the program designed for the phone
and your phone’s processor type.
3. Read any installation instructions, Read Me files, or
documentation that comes with the program.
4. Select the file, such as a *.xip or *.exe file. The
installation wizard will begin.
5. Follow the directions on the screen.
Once installation is completed, you can view and open the
program by accessing the Start menu.
Removing programs
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Remove Programs.
3. Select the program you want to delete.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Remove.
5. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
6. When you have finished, press the OK soft key.The basics
39
Managing certificates
On your phone you can add and delete public key
certificates. You can store the following two types of
certificates on your phone.
• Personal: help to establish your identity, when you log
on to a secured network, such as a corporate network.
• Root: help to establish the identity of servers with which
you connect. This helps to prevent unauthorised users
from accessing your phone and information.
Viewing certificates
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → Certificates
→ a certificate type.
3. To view more details, select the certificate.
Deleting a certificate
1. Scroll to the certificate you want on the list.
2. Press the Menu soft key and then select Delete.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.The basics
40
Resetting your phone
You can reset your phone’s settings and clear all added
data from memory.
Resetting the phone
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → More... →
Hard reset. You can also turn on the phone with
pressing and holding .
3. Enter the initialisation password and press the Done
soft key. The default password is “1234.”
4. Press the Yes soft key to confirm.
The phone resets and reboots itself.
Changing the initialisation password
You can change the initialisation password to prevent the
phone from being reset by unauthorised people.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Security → More... →
Hard reset password.
3. Enter the old password, then a new password, and
re-enter the new one for confirmation.
4. Press the Done soft key.The basics
41
Using online help
Your phone is supported by additional information available
online, or on the CD-ROM that came with your phone.
SIM AT (SIM Application Toolkit)
This is available if you use a SIM AT card that provides the
SIM Application Toolkit menus and additional services, such
as news, weather, sports, entertainment, and location
services. Available services may vary, depending on your
service provider’s plans.
For details, see your SIM card instructions or contact your
service provider.
For information on: see:
additional programs
that can be installed on
your phone,
the supplied CD-ROM.
connecting to and
synchronising with a
PC,
Chapter 3 in this User’s Guide
or ActiveSync Help on your PC.
To view the ActiveSync help,
click the ActiveSync icon on the
Windows task bar.
up-to-date information
on your phone,
http://www.microsoft.com/
mobile/smartphone.3
42
Synchronisation
Using Microsoft®
ActiveSync®
, you can synchronise data on
your desktop computer with the data on your phone.
Synchronisation compares the data on your phone with
your desktop computer and updates both your phone and
computer with the latest data.
With ActiveSync, you can:
• Keep Contacts, Calendar, Tasks, or Inbox data up-to-date
by synchronising your phone with Microsoft Outlook data
on your desktop computer.
• Copy (rather than synchronise) files between your phone
and desktop computer.
• Control the moment when synchronisation occurs by
selecting a synchronisation mode.
• Select data types to be synchronised and control the
amount of synchronised data.
WARNING!
• ActiveSync synchronises two devices using the latest data.
Therefore, if you delete some specific data from the phone
after synchronisation, and then perform a synchronisation
again, the corresponding data on the computer will be
deleted. Be careful not to lose important data.
• If you turn off the phone after copying files to any folders,
except for the Storage folder, using ActiveSync, all files in
those folders will be deleted. Store important files in the
Storage folder to prevent from being deleted.Synchronisation
43
Installing ActiveSync
Before beginning synchronisation, you must install
ActiveSync on your desktop computer using the supplied
CD-ROM. You can also download the latest version of
ActiveSync from the Microsoft web site (http://
www.microsoft.com).
1. Insert the CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of your
desktop computer. Alternatively, double-click the
downloaded ActiveSync installer.
2. Follow the instructions on the screen for installing
Microsoft ActiveSync.
When installation is completed, the Synchronisation
Setup Wizard helps you to connect your phone to your
desktop computer, to set up a partnership.
3. Follow the instructions on the screen.
Note: See page 45 for more information on connecting the
phone and a computer.
Your first synchronisation process will automatically begin
when your phone is connected to the computer. After the
first synchronisation, take a look at Contacts, Calendar, and
Tasks on your phone. You will notice that your information
has been copied to the phone.Synchronisation
44
Customising connection settings
To establish a connection between your computer and the
phone, you must enable the connection(s) you want to use
in the ActiveSync program. By default, all connections are
enabled.
1. From the ActiveSync window on your computer, select
File → Connection Settings...
2. Change the connection settings.
3. Click OK.
If your phone is not
connected to the
computer, click this
button to establish
a connection.Synchronisation
45
Connecting your phone to a
computer
To connect the phone to your computer, you can use a PC
data cable or the infrared port.
Connecting with a PC data cable
Connect one end of the PC data cable to the charger/PC
data cable jack on the right of the phone and the other end
to the USB port on your computer.
Note: USB mode of your phone must be set for ActiveSync.
Press the Start soft key and select Settings →
More... → Connections → USB. Then change the
mode.
The connection is established and the Microsoft ActiveSync
window appears. The synchronisation automatically begins.
Note: When an error occurs in a USB connection, activate the
DHCP Client service, or deactivate the firewall or VPN
environment.
Connecting via the infrared port
1. Enable IR transmissions on your phone; Select Start →
Settings → More... → Connections → Beam →
Receive incoming beams.
2. Align the infrared ports on your phone and the
computer.
Note: To use the infrared port, the phone’s display must be
activated.
3. From the Connection Settings window of the Windows
ActiveSync, select Infrared Port (IR).Synchronisation
46
4. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key, and select ActiveSync.
5. Press the Menu soft key and select Connect via IR.
Once the connections is established, appears on the
Windows task bar.
Note: If your computer doesn’t have an infrared port, you can
purchase a USB-IrDA adapter.
Synchronising information
To start synchronisation, connect your phone to your
computer. For more information on connecting the phone
and the computer, see page 45. The ActiveSync screen on
your computer automatically appears and synchronisation
starts.
Once the synchronisation is completed, the phone stays
connected to the computer. If any change is made,
ActiveSync automatically will begin synchronisation. To
begin synchronisation, press the Sync soft key in
ActiveSync on your phone.
You can open the phone’s file directory by clicking Explore
from the Microsoft ActiveSync window. You can then copy
files quickly and easily from the phone to the computer or
vice versa.
Shows the
synchronisation
status.
Shows types of
information to be
synchronised.Synchronisation
47
Note: To synchronize Bluetooth devices with a compatible PC,
you need the Bluetooth stack for Windows XP Service
Pack 2 on your PC.
Customising synchronisation
settings
You can customise various setting options for
synchronisation with a computer and a server, and set the
synchronisation schedule.
First, you must break the connection between the phone
and computer. Disconnect the PC data cable or remove the
phone from the infrared range.
Changing PC Settings
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Options.
2. Highlight Window PC.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Settings.
4. Change the computer name, set how to handle a data
conflict between the phone and computer, or set a event
logging type and press the Done soft key.
5. Select data types to be synchronised under the selected
computer.
6. Press the Done soft key.
Note: For more information on the conditions that must be
met on the computer and how to change
synchronisation options, see ActiveSync Help.Synchronisation
48
Setting server synchronisation
You can synchronise information automatically as items
arrive only if your company is running Microsoft Exchange
Server with Exchange ActiveSync.
Configuring an Exchange Server connection
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Add Server Source.
2. Enter the server address and select This server
requires an encrypted (SSL) connection to use a
SSL protocol for server access.
3. Press the Next soft key.
4. Enter your Microsoft Exchange user name, password,
and domain name.
To save the password for subsequent accesses, select
Save password.
5. Press the Next soft key.
6. Select data types to be synchronised.
7. When you have finished, press the Finish soft key.
Changing the synchronisation schedule
You can schedule synchronisation with the Microsoft
Exchange Server on two separate times. Use the peak time
schedule to synchronise during working hours or other
times when you experience higher mail volumes. Use the
off-peak time schedule to synchronise during times when
you experience lower mail volumes.Synchronisation
49
1. In ActiveSync on your phone, press the Menu soft key
and select Schedule.
2. Set each option:
• To synchronise periodically during peak times, select a
frequency of synchronisation in the Peak times field.
• To synchronise periodically during off-peak times,
select a frequency of synchronisation in the Off-peak
times field.
• To use the peak time and off-peak time setting while
roaming, select Use above settings when roaming.
• To synchronise each time you send an e-mail, select
Send outgoing items immediately.
• To set the days and hours for peak times, press the
Menu soft key and select Peak Times.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.4
50
Call functions
This chapter explains all of the call- functions provided by
your phone.
Turning the phone functions on and
off
You can choose to turn off the phone functions and just use
the PDA functions at any time and then turn it back on
when you want.
Note: In many countries you may be required by law to turn
off the phone functions while on a flight. To turn off the
display of your phone does not actually turn off the
phone functions; you must turn off your wireless
connection to your operator’s network.
To turn off the phone functions, press and select
Wireless Manager. Then select Phone to set it to Off.
appears on the top right corner of the screen.
To turn back on the phone functions, select Phone to set it
to On from the Wireless Manager screen.Call functions
51
Using the Dialling screen
When you start entering a number or press , the Dialling
screen opens. You can view the most recent calls you have
dialled, received, and missed on the screen.
When you enter a digit, the Dialling screen lists all of the
numbers containing the entered digit in Contacts and Call
History, as well as the phone number assigned to the
corresponding Speed Dial key.
Making a call
You can make a phone call using the number keypad.
1. From the Home screen, enter a number including an
area code using the keypad.
2. Press to make a call.
When a call is connected, the call duration displays.
During a call, you can use several call options. For
details, see page 55.
To adjust the earpiece volume during a call, press
to increase or decrease the volume level.
3. To end the call, press .
Advanced calling features
You can make a call from Contacts, Speed Dial, and Call
History.Call functions
52
Making a call from Contacts
1. On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You
can also press the Start soft key and select Contacts.
2. Select a contact card from the contact list.
3. Scroll to the number you want and press .
Making a call from Speed Dial
Speed Dial is a list you can create of often-dialled numbers.
Information on adding a number to Speed Dial is detailed
on page 57.
By memorising the position on the Speed Dial list, you can
dial the number simply by entering that number of the
Speed Dial key. The phone number assigned to the key
appears on the Dialling screen.
Alternatively, if you do not remember the position of a
number, access the Speed Dial list:
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Speed Dial.
3. Scroll to the number you want and press .Call functions
53
Making a call using name dialling
You can make a phone call by saying the name that has
been assigned to a contact card in Contacts or on the SIM
card. For details, see page 129.
Making a call from the Call History
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Call History. The recent call list appears.
Note: is for incoming calls, is for outgoing calls, and
is for missed calls.
To view the calls categorised by call type, press the
Menu soft key, select Filter, and select a category from
the pop-up list.
3. Scroll to the number you want and then press .
Making an international call
1. Press and hold until the + sign appears. The +
replaces the international access code.
2. Enter the full phone number you want to dial. It includes
the country code, the area code (without the leading
zero), and the phone number.
3. Press .
Note: You can set the country or are code to be added before
the number when dialling. See page 62.Call functions
54
Making an emergency call
Your phone provides the emergency number 112. This
number can normally be used to make an emergency call in
any country, with or without a SIM card inserted, if you are
within a mobile phone network’s service area.
Enter the emergency number 112 and press .
Notes:
• Some service providers may require a SIM card to be
inserted, and in some cases the PIN to be entered as well.
• In some cases, other emergency numbers may also be
accessed. Your service provider may save additional local
emergency numbers on the SIM card.
Answering or ignoring a call
When a call comes in and the phone rings or vibrates,
depending on the ringer setting:
• Press the Answer soft key or press to answer the
call.
• Press the Ignore soft key or press to reject the call.
You can also press and hold .
Note: If you reject a call, the busy tone is sent out.
Depending on your service provider, the caller may be
guided to your voicemail server.Call functions
55
Options during a call
Your phone provides a number of control functions that you
can use while a call is in progress.
Putting a call on hold
If a person is trying to call you when you are talking on the
phone, a notification window will pop out.
1. Press the Answer soft key to answer the second call
and put the first on hold.
2. To swap back and forth between the two callers, press
the Swap soft key.
3. To end the second call and go back to the first, press the
End soft key or press .
Setting up conference calling
Conference calling enables you to invite callers during a call
and have a conversation with up to 5 people at the same
time.
1. Put a call on hold, dial a second number, and wait for it
to be picked up. Alternatively, accept a second incoming
call when you already have one in progress.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Conference.
If the conference connection is successful, the word
“Conference” will appear at the top of the screen.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Hold to place the
conference call on hold and make a new call or
answer another incoming call. Call functions
56
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Conference to
join together all existing calls.
To talk privately to a person during a conference call, press
the Menu soft key and select Private. When the list of call
participants appears, select one.
Switching a call to a Speakerphone
During a call, you can switch to a speakerphone.
In Speakerphone mode, a noisy enviroment will make it
difficult to hear the person whom you are speaking with. In
a noisy environment, it is better to use the normal phone
mode for better audio performance.
• To activate a speakerphone, press and hold for about
1 seconds.
• To deactivate a speakerphone, press and hold the key
again for the same length of time.
Call-related features
Checking your voicemail
The first speed dial location is assigned to your voicemail
box by default. When you insert your SIM card into the
phone, it will automatically detect and set as default the
voicemail centre number of your mobile service provider.
To check your voicemail, press and hold from the
Dialling screen.
Note: You can check and change the voicemail centre number.
See page 62.Call functions
57
Managing the Speed Dial list
You can assign frequently-used phone numbers, e-mail
addresses, or web pages in Contacts to the speed dial
location 2 through 99. The location 0 and 1 on the Speed
Dial list is preset for the international call prefix + and the
voicemail centre number, respectively.
Note: You cannot create a speed dial for a phone number
stored on the SIM card.
Adding a contact to the Speed Dial list
1. On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You
can also press the Start soft key and select Contacts.
2. Select a contact from the list.
3. Scroll to a number, e-mail address, or web page
address.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Add to Speed Dial.
5. If necessary, enter the name you want.
6. In the Keypad assignment field, select a location.
7. Press the Done soft key.
Deleting Speed Dial assignments
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Speed Dial.
3. On the Speed Dial list, select a number.Call functions
58
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
5. When the confirmation message appears, press the Yes
soft key.
Managing your Call History
Call History details all incoming, outgoing, and missed
calls, and also provides a summary of total calls. It can also
tell you when a call was initiated and how long it lasted.
To open the Call History:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Call History. A list of all calls appears.
If necessary, select the category of the call history to be
displayed by pressing the Menu soft key and selecting
Filter.
Calls are categorised as below:
• No Filter: shows all calls made to and from the phone in
chronological order.
• Missed Calls: shows only calls that were not answered.
• Incoming Calls: shows only calls made to the phone.
• Outgoing Calls: shows only calls made from the phone.
Viewing details of calls
• To view the duration of a call and time and date you
received or made it, scroll to the call you want to view
and press .
• To view contact information, scroll to a contact, press the
Menu soft key, and select Find Contact.
• To send an SMS message, press the Menu soft key and
select Send SMS.Call functions
59
• To send an e-mail message using the e-mail address on
the call history, scroll to the contacts, press the Menu
soft key, and select Email.
• To delete individual calls, press the Menu soft key, and
then select Delete. To delete all calls, select Delete List.
• To save a phone number in a call to Contacts, scroll to
the call you want and press the Save soft key.
Viewing call timers
In Call History, you can view the duration of your calls. This
option is convenient for estimating your usage.
1. On the Call History screen, press the Menu soft key and
select View Timers.
You can view the total call time, the last call time, the
time of calls you received and made, and a lifetime
counter. You can also view the time you reset the call
time.
2. Press the Done soft key.
You can easily erase the call time records at any time,
except for Lifetime calls, by pressing the Menu soft key
and selecting Reset Timers.
Viewing call cost
This network feature lets you view the cost of calls. Viewing
call cost may not be available, depending on particular SIM
cards. For more information, contact your service provider.
1. On the Call History screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Call Cost.Call functions
60
2. Select the option you want.
• Last Call Cost: shows the cost of the last call you
made.
• Total Cost: shows the total cost of all calls made
since the cost counter was last reset. If the total cost
exceeds the maximum cost set in the Set Max Cost
option, you can no longer make any calls until you
reset the counter.
• Max Cost: shows the maximum cost set in the Set
Max Cost option.
• Reset Counters: allows you to reset the cost counter.
• Set Max Cost: allows you to enter the maximum cost
that you authorise for your calls. Calls can be made as
long as the preset max cost is not exceeded.
• Price/Unit: allows you to set the cost of one unit. This
price per unit is applied when calculating the cost of
your calls.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Customising your phone functions
You can personalise the settings of the phone functions, the
services you have, and the network to which you have
connected.
Accessing the Phone setting options
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → Phone.
3. Select a setting menu, and then set each option.Call functions
61
4. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Available setting options
• Band Selection: This option allows you to select the
network band in which your phone will operate. Your
phone can operate in the GSM 900/1800 or PCS 1900
band.
• Call Barring: This network service allows you to restrict
your incoming or outgoing calls. To set up this service,
you need to enter the call barring password obtained
from your service provider.
All calls: No calls can be made or received.
When roaming: Calls cannot be received when you are
using your phone outside of your home service area.
Off: Call barring is deactivated; all calls can be made and
received normally.
Int's except home: When abroad, calls can be made
only to number within the current country and to your
home country.
Int'l calls: International calls cannot be made.
• Call Forwarding: This network service allows you to
forward your incoming calls to another phone number.
Unconditional: All calls are forwarded.
No Reply: Calls are forwarded when you do not answer.
Busy: Calls are forwarded when you are on the phone.
Unavailable: Calls are forwarded when your phone is
turned off or your phone is out of the service area.
Data Calls: All data calls are forward.Call functions
62
• Call Options: You can customise settings related to call
functions, such as an answering option, voicemail and
SMS access numbers, and auto dial codes.
Any key answer: When this option is activated, you can
answer incoming calls by pressing any key, except for ,
, , and .
Show SIM contacts: With this option is activated, the
contact cards stored on the SIM card display on the
contact list.
Phone number: Check your phone number.
Voice mail number/SMS service centre: When you
insert your SIM card into your phone, it automatically
detects and sets your voicemail and SMS access numbers
by default. If not, you can manually enter the numbers
obtained from your service provider.
Country code/Dialling code: You can enter a country
code or area code. The code will be automatically added
before a phone number when dialling.
• Call Waiting: This service allows you to receive another
call while you have a call in progress. Select Provided
call waiting call notifications to activate this service.
• Caller ID: When you place a call, your phone number
can be displayed to or hidden from the person to whom
you are calling. Using this option, you can enable or
disable the display of your caller identification.
For more detailed information , press the Start soft key
and then Select Settings → Phone → More....
• Channels: This option allows you to set the cell
broadcast (CB) message receipt and set up broadcast
channels from which you want to receive CB messages.
Enable channels: Select to enable the receipt of CB
messages.Call functions
63
Language: Select your preferred languages to display
CB messages.
To edit the channel list, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Channels. Then press the Menu soft key and
select the options for adding, editing or deleting
channels.
• Extra Tones: You can activate or deactivate the connect
tone, which alerts you when your call is connected to the
system, or the minute minder tone, which alerts you
every minute during a call.
• Fixed Dialling: When this option is activated, your
phone allows outgoing calls only to the limited set of
phone numbers. You can call only those numbers that are
included in the Fixed Dialling Number list or which begin
with the same digit(s) as a phone number on the list.
• Networks: You can set the phone to automatically select
a network when you are roaming out of your service
area, or find and select the network you want.
Press the Menu soft key to access the following options:
Find a New Network: Search for all available networks.
You can start searching when the phone is out of your
service area.
Select a Network: Select a network from the available
networks
Preferred Networks: Set up a list of your preferred
networks. You can set priority of the networks or add
networks manually by selecting them from the preset
network list or entering their service ID codes.64
5 Messaging, Internet, and
Messenger
Messaging
In Messaging, you can create, send, receive, view, edit, and
organise:
• Text messages (SMS)
• Multimedia message (MMS)
• E-mail messages
To open Messaging:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Messaging.
Working with SMS or MMS messages
You can write an SMS message of up to 160 characters.
When you enter more than 160 characters, your phone
handles the message as a multi-part message.
You can also send or receive multimedia messages (MMS).
In addition to the familiar text content of text messages,
multimedia messages can contain images, video clips,
audio clips, and combinations of these things in more than
one page.
MMS also supports e-mail addressing, so that messages
can be sent from phone to e-mail and vice versa.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
65
Creating and sending an SMS message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select SMS/MMS.
2. Press the New soft key and select SMS.
3. In the To field, enter the recipients’ phone numbers,
separating them with a semicolon.
You can retrieve numbers from the contact list by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Add
Recipient.
4. Press the Down key and compose your message.
To enter preset or frequently used messages, press the
Menu soft key, select My Text, and select a message.
5. Press the Send soft key when you’ve finished the
message.
Creating and sending an MMS message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select SMS/MMS.
2. Press the New soft key and select MMS.
3. In the To, Cc, or Bcc field, enter the recipients’
numbers or addresses, separating them with a
semicolon.
Note: The Cc or Bcc fields are above the To field.
You can also retrieve numbers or the addresses from the
contact list or the messages you have sent by pressing
the Menu soft key and selecting Add Recipients.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
66
4. Press the Down key to move to the Subject field and
enter the message subject.
5. Press the Down key and enter the message text.
6. Press the Menu soft key to access the following options
for composing a message:
• Preview: shows the multimedia message you
created.
• Add Recipients: allows you to add recipients
addresses.
• Edit Item: allows you to edit the selected item.
• Add: allows you to add a variety of contents, such as
data, media files and templates.
• Attach: allows you to attach a contact card or
calendar item as a digital file format, or a media file.
• Edit Page: allows you to add or delete pages, change
the text style, or set the page order or duration.
• Save to: allows you to save the message to Drafts or
as an MMS template.
• Cancel Message: cancels sending the message.
• MMS Options: allows you to change the message
options. See page 70.
7. When you have finished composing the message, press
the Send soft key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
67
Viewing SMS/MMS messages
When you receive a new SMS or MMS message, the New
Message icon ( ) displays on the top line of the screen
and a new message is stored in Inbox. Press the Message
soft key to open the message.
You can also view messages you received, sent, composed
but not sent by accessing the message folders.
To open the message folders:
On the SMS/MMS screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Folders. The following default folders display:
• Deleted Items: contains messages that have been
deleted on your phone.
• Drafts: stores draft messages that have not been sent.
• Inbox: contains received messages.
• Outbox: is a temporary storage place for messages
waiting to be sent.
• Sent Items: stores the messages that have been sent.
To view all message folder contents, press the Menu soft
key and select Show All Folders.
To clear the SMS/MMS messages in a specific folder, scroll
to the folder, press the Menu soft key, and select Clear
SMS/MMS.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
68
To view a received message:
1. On the SMS/MMS screen, open the message folder you
want.
The icons on the message list tells you the message
type.
• : SMS message
• : MMS message
Note: You can change the default settings for viewing an
SMS message. On a message list, press the Menu
soft key and select Options → Display.
2. Select the message you want to view.
If you open a push message from a WAP server, press
the Proceed soft key to access the URL specified in the
message.
To access message options:
While viewing a received or sent message, you can access
the following options by pressing the Menu soft key.
• Delete: deletes the message.
• Reply All (SMS): sends a reply to the sender and all
other recipients
• Reply (MMS) : sends a reply to the sender and/or all
other recipients, or forwards the message to other
people..
• Forward (SMS): forwards the message to other people.
• Move: allows you to move the message to other folders.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
69
• Mark as Unread/Mark as Read: allows you to mark the
message as unread or read. Unread messages are
boldfaced on the message list.
• Save to Contacts: allows you to save the sender’s
number or address.
• Save as MMS Template (MMS): saves the message as
an MMS template for reuse.
• Attached files (MMS): allows you to save attachments
of the message into the phone’s memory.
• MMS Options: allows you to change the MMS settings.
See below.
Viewing messages on the SIM card
Sometimes, text messages may be stored on the SIM card,
depending on their specifications. To view the messages
stored on the SIM card, you need to copy them to a folder
in your phone.
1. On a message list, press the Menu soft key and select
Options → Import SIM Messages.
2. Press the Done soft key.
The text messages are copied from the SIM card to
SMS/MMS Inbox.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
70
Configuring MMS settings
You can change the default MMS settings. From composing
or viewing an MMS message, press the Menu soft key and
select MMS Options. The following options are available:
• Sending Options: Allows you to change the settings for
sending MMS messages.
Priority: You can select the priority level of your
messages.
Validity Period: You can select the length of time your
messages are stored in the message centre after they
are sent.
Delivery Time: You can select the time delay before
messages are sent.
Creation Mode:Allows you to set the phone to allow the
MMS creation using unsupported files.
Size: You can select the message size.
Hide address: You can set your caller ID to be hidden
from outgoing messages.
Request delivery report: When this option is activated,
the network informs you whether or not your message
has been delivered.
Request read report: When this option is activated,
your phone sends a request for a reply along with your
message to the recipient.
• Receiving Options: Allows you to change the settings
for receiving MMS messages.
Home Network: Set how to retrieve new messages
from the server in your home network.
Roaming Network: Set how to retrieve new messages
from the server while roaming around another network.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
71
Reject Unknown Sender:reject messages from
unknown senders.
Report Allowed:send a delivery report from the
network to the sender.
Advertisement Allowed:accept advertisements.
Information Allowed:accept information messages.
• MMS Profiles: Allows you to set up and activate MMS
profiles which are sets of MMS parameters required to
send or receive MMS messages. To activate a profile,
select it from the profile list.
To edit a profile, press the Menu soft key and select Edit.
Change the following options:
Profile Name: Enter the profile name.
MMSC URL: Enter the URL address of the MMS centre.
Bearer: select the network bearer type.
Working with E-mail messages
You can send and receive e-mail messages in one of these
ways:
• Synchronise e-mail messages with Microsoft Exchange or
Microsoft Outlook on your PC.
• Send and receive e-mail messages by connecting directly
to an e-mail server through an Internet Service Provider
(ISP) or a network.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
72
Synchronising E-mail messages
Use the Outlook EMail account to send and receive
e-mail messages by synchronising e-mail messages with
Microsoft Exchange or Microsoft Outlook on your PC.
E-mail messages can be synchronised as part of the
general synchronisation process. You will need to enable
Inbox synchronisation in ActiveSync.
During synchronisation:
• Messages are copied from the mail folders of Exchange or
Outlook on your PC to the Outlook Email folders on your
phone.
• E-mail messages in Outbox on your phone are
transferred to Exchange or Outlook, and then sent from
those programs.
• E-mail messages in folders must be selected in
ActiveSync on your PC in order to be transferred.
Connecting directly to an E-mail server
You can send and receive e-mail messages by connecting
to an e-mail server. You’ll need to set up a remote
connection to a network or an ISP, and a connection to your
e-mail server.
When you connect to the e-mail server, new messages are
downloaded to the phone’s Inbox folder. Also messages in
the phone’s Outbox folder are sent, and messages that
have been deleted on the e-mail server are removed from
the phone’s message folders.
Folder behavior with a direct connection to an E-mail
server
The behavior of the folders you create depends on whether
you are using POP3 or IMAP4.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
73
• If you use POP3 and you move e-mail messages to a
folder you created, the link is broken between the
messages on the phone and their copies on the mail
server. The next time you connect, the mail server will
see that the messages are missing from the phone Inbox
and delete them. This prevents you from having
duplicate copies of a message, but it also means that you
will no longer have access to messages that you move to
folders created from anywhere except the phone.
• If you use IMAP4, the folders you created and the e-mail
messages you moved are mirrored on the server.
Therefore, messages are available to you anytime you
connect to your mail server. This synchronisation of
folders occurs whenever you connect to your mail server;
create new folders or rename/delete folders when
connected.
Creating an e-mail account
You need to create a new account to be used for retrieving
and sending e-mail messages.
To make a new account:
1. From any message folder, press the Menu soft key and
select Options → New Account.
2. Enter your display name and e-mail address, and press
the Next soft key.
If you want to set up your account automatically from
the Internet, select Attempt to obtain email settings
from the Internet.
3. Enter your user information, such as user name,
password, and domain name, press the Next soft key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
74
4. Select the e-mail server type, enter an account name,
and select a network type.
5. Press the Next soft key.
6. Enter the server names and press the Next soft key.
If you want to set up an outgoing server, select
Outgoing Server Settings.
7. Set the options for downloading e-mail messages and
press the Next soft key.
You can select the number of days for which you receive
e-mail messages and set the maximum data volume of
e-mail messages you want to download.
8. Select how often your phone automatically connects to
the server and checks for incoming e-mails, and press
the Next soft key.
9. Press the Finish soft key.
To edit an account:
1. From any message folder, press the Menu soft key and
select Options → Account Options.
2. Select the account you want.
3. Change the account settings as you would when
creating it.
For SMS/MMS, you can set to send a delivery report
request for outgoing messages or to use Unicode
encoding.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
75
Creating and sending an E-mail message
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the e-mail
account with which you want to send.
2. Press the New soft key.
3. In the To, Cc, or Bcc field, enter the recipients’ e-mail
addresses, separating them with a semicolon.
Note: The Cc or Bcc fields are above the To field.
You can retrieve addresses from the contact list by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Add
Recipient.
4. Press the Down key to move to the Subject field and
enter the e-mail subject.
5. Compose your e-mail message.
To enter preset or frequently used sentences, press the
Menu soft key, select My Text, and select a sentence.
You can add a picture or voice note as an attachment by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Insert → a
item type.
6. Press the Send soft key when you have finished
composing the message.
7. Press the Menu soft key and select Send/Receive to
connect to the network and send the message.
Viewing e-mail messages
You can also view messages you received, sent, composed
but not sent by accessing the message folders.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
76
To open the message folders:
On the Messaging main screen, access the e-mail account
you want, press the Menu soft key, and select Folders.
The following default folders display:
• Deleted Items: contains messages that have been
deleted on your phone.
• Drafts: stores draft messages that have not been sent.
• Inbox: contains received messages.
• Outbox: is a temporary storage place for messages
waiting to be sent.
• Sent Items: stores the messages that have been sent.
Note: When you first have synchronised e-mail messages, the
Junk E-mail folder is copied from the Microsoft Outlook
on your PC to Outlook E-mail on your phone. The next
time you synchronise, the e-mail messages that appear
to be Junk e-mail are saved in that folder according to
the options you set in the Microsoft Outlook.
To view all message folder contents in the selected
account, press the Menu soft key and select Show All
Folders.
To view an e-mail message:
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the e-mail account
from which you want to receive e-mail messages.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Send/Receive.
The phone connects to your e-mail server and receives
incoming e-mail messages or sends e-mail messages in
Outbox.
3. Select the message you want to view.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
77
To access message options:
While viewing a received or sent e-mail, you can access the
following options by pressing the Menu soft key.
• Delete: deletes the message.
• Reply All: sends a reply to the senders and all other
recipients.
• Move: allows you to move message(s) to other folders.
• Mark as Unread/Mark as Read: allows you to mark the
message as unread or read. Unread messages are
boldfaced on the message list.
• Download Message: allows you to download the
complete contents of the e-mail from the e-mail server.
• Send/Receive: sends or receives the e-mail messages.
Setting downloading options
You can specify your downloading preferences when you
set up the account or select your synchronisation options.
You can change them at any time:
• Change options for Inbox synchronisation using
ActiveSync options. For more information, see
“ActiveSync Help.”
• Change options for direct e-mail server connections in
Inbox on your phone. Press the Menu soft key and
select Options → Account Options. Select the account
you want and change it.
Viewing e-mail attachments
To download an attachment, select the attachment
displayed as a list of hyperlinks in an open message. It will
be downloaded the next time you synchonise or connect to
your e-mail server and send or receive e-mail messages. To
view an attachment, select the attachment in an open
message.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
78
Switching beween message accounts
While working in an account, you can switch to another
message account any time you need.
1. Press the Menu soft key and select Switch Accounts.
2. Select the account to which you want to switch.
Inserting signatures into messages
You can specify a signature to be automatically inserted
into SMS, MMS or e-mail messages that you send.
To specify a signature:
1. On the Messaging main screen, select the message
account you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Options →
Signatures.
3. Select the account for which you want to specify from
the Select an account field.
4. Select Use signature with this account.
5. To insert a signature in every messages, including when
you reply or forward the message, select Include when
replying and forwarding.
6. Enter a signature to be inserted and press the Done soft
key.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
79
Internet Explorer
Use Microsoft®
Pocket Internet Explorer to view Web HTML,
cHTML, and WAP pages. You can browse by connecting to
an Internet service provider (ISP) or network and browse
the Web. To do this, you’ll need to create the connection
first as described on page 148.
When connected to an ISP or network, you can also
download files and programs from the Internet.
To open Internet Explorer:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Internet → Internet Explorer.
Browsing the Internet
1. To connect and start browsing, do one of the following:
• Press the Menu soft key and select Address Bar.
Enter the web address you want to visit
• Press the Menu soft key and select History to open
the list of the pages you last accessed. Select a page
from the list.
• Scroll to the page you want to view from the
Favourites list.
2. Press the Go soft key on the browser to open the
associated web page.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
80
Navigating the Internet Explorer
The following table helps you browse the Internet easily:
Using the Favorites list
You can store your favourite link while using the Internet
Browser and then access them easily. Categorising them
enables you to find them more quickly.
Adding a web page to the Favorites list
1. Go to the page you want to add and press the Menu
soft key and select Add to Favourites.
To Press
scroll through browser
items
the Navigation keys.
select a browser item .
return to the previous page .
refresh the connection the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
To change the display
options
the Menu soft key, select
View, and select the
option you want.
To change the text and
image size
the Menu soft key, select
Zoom, and select the
option you want.
view information on the
web page
the Menu soft key and
select Tools →
Properties.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
81
2. Enter a name for the favourite link and the URL of the
link.
3. Select a category from the Folder field under which you
want to save the favourite link.
You can also create a new category. See page 84.
4. Press the Add soft key.
Opening a link through the Favourites list
1. On the Internet Explorer screen, press the Favourites
soft key.
2. Scroll to the link you want to access.
If the link you want is in the certain folder, open the
folder and scroll to the link.
3. Press the Go soft key.
Managing Favorites categories
You can create a new category for saving favourite web
pages and edit or delete the created categories.
1. On the Internet Explorer screen, press the Favourites
soft key.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Add Folder to
create a new category.
Alternatively, scroll to the category and press the Menu
soft key and select Edit or Delete to edit or delete the
selected category.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
82
Changing Explorer options
You can customise Web browsing options, change the
connection settings, and clear memory. On the Internet
Explorer screen, press the Menu soft key and select Tools
→ Options.
The following options are available:
• General: You can select whether or not to play sounds
on web pages, view the warnings when you move
from a secure web page to a non-secure one, or
enable or disable the receiving and sending of cookies.
You can also select the text encoding type to use.
• Connections: You can change the network setting to
connect to Internet Explorer. If you select Automatically
detect settings, your phone automatically detects
network settings from your service provider.
• Memory: You can check the amount of memory
currently being used for the Internet Explorer. To clear
the memory, scroll to a type of memory and press the
Clear soft key.
WAP Browser
Using Browser, you can browse the WAP service preset by
your service provider and other WAP (Wireless Application
Protocol) sites on your phone.
Connecting to a WAP site
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Internet → WAP Browser.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
83
3. To connect and start browsing, do one of the following:
• Press the Menu soft key and select Home to access
the homepage of your service provider.
• Press the Favourites soft key, select the category
which contains the WAP site you want, and then select
the WAP site.
• Press the Menu soft key and select Go To. Enter the
address of WAP site you want to visit and press the Go
soft key.
4. While navigating through WAP pages, you can use the
following options:
Using the Favourites list
You can store your favourite WAP sites and then access
them easily. Categorising them enables you to find them
more quickly.
Adding a URL to the Favourites list
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Add to Favourites.
To Press
go to the previous visited
page
.
go to the homepage the Menu soft key and
select Home.
refresh the current page the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
Open the list of the WAP
sites you have accessed
the Menu soft key and
select History.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
84
2. If there is no category created, enter a name for the
category and press the Save soft key.
3. Enter a name for the favourite site and the URL of the
site.
4. Select the category under which you want to save the
favourite site.
You can also create a new category by pressing the
Menu soft key and select New Category.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Opening a page through the Favourites list
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Scroll to a category from the list and press the Open
soft key.
3. Scroll to the WAP site you want and press the Go soft
key.
Managing Favourite categories
You can create a new category for saving favourite WAP
sites and edit or delete the created category.
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select New to create a
new category.
Or scroll to the category you want, press the Menu soft
key, and then select Rename or Delete to edit the
selected category.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
85
Deleting a favourite item
1. On the WAP Browser screen, press the Favourites soft
key.
2. Scroll to a category from the list and press the Open
soft key.
3. Scroll to the WAP site you want to delete and press the
Menu soft key and select Delete.
4. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
Setting the WAP options
You can access options for the WAP browser. Press the
Menu soft key and select Options.
• Settings: You can view the current connection settings
for WAP and set the selected profile as an active profile or
edit a selected profile. You can also set the WAP browser
to load the homepage when launching.
• Cache/Cookie: Viewed pages can be cached for faster
downloads and cookies are pieces of information related
to a session. You can select to enable or disable the
cache or cookies.
You can clear information stored in the cache and cookie
by pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Clear
Cache or Clear Cookie.
• Set as Home Page: You can change the startup
homepage of the WAP browser. Access the page you want
and select this option.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
86
Pocket MSN
Pocket MSN delivers an always-on experience that enables
you to remain available to other online users and always up
to date with e-mail, instant messaging (IM) and other
online services without maintaining a continuous network
connection to the phone.
The connection will be restored when a new message
arrives or when you needs the service. In addition,
subscribers will receive only updates or changes to their
contacts and Inbox rather than receiving entire lists
when they connect to the service.
You will have one-click access to MSN Hotmail®
and MSN
Messenger. In addition, Pocket MSN will allow you to
wirelessly browse online and receive other MSN services,
including MSN Alerts, which include news, sports and
weather updates.
In addition to always-on services, you can access, compose
and answer Hotmail messages offline, maximising their
time when mobile connections aren't available.
To access Pocket MSN:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Internet → Pocket MSN.
Signing In
To use the MSN Messenger or Hotmail service, you must
have a Microsoft Passport™ account or Hotmail account, or
a Microsoft Exchange e-mail account. If you have a
Hotmail®
or MSN account, you already have a Passport.
Once you have obtained either a Microsoft Passport or a
Microsoft Exchange account, you are ready to set up your
account.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
87
Note: Sign up for a Microsoft Passport account at http://
www.passport.com. Get a free Microsoft Hotmail e-mail
address at http://www.hotmail.com.
To sign into the MSN service:
1. On the Pocket MSN main screen, select MSN
Messenger, MSN Hotmail, or Compose Hotmail.
2. If you selected MSN Messenger, press the Sign In soft
key.
3. Enter the e-mail address and the password of your
Microsoft Passport and Hotmail account.
4. Press the Sign In soft key.
Using MSN Messenger
MSN®
Messenger on your phone is an instant messaging
program that lets you:
• see who is online.
• send and receive instant messages.
• have instant message conversations with groups of
contacts.
Working with contacts
The MSN Messenger screen shows all of your messenger
contacts at a glance, divided into Online and Not Online
categories. From this view, while connected, you can start
a chat.
• To see others who are online but not seen on the MSN
Messenger screen, press the Menu soft key and select
Chats.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
88
• To add a contact, press the Menu soft key and select
Add Contact.
• To delete a contact, press the Menu soft key and select
Delete Contact.
• To set the MSN Messenger to automatically update the
contacts’ status when it changes, press the Menu soft key
and select Auto update status.
• To view the properties of a contact, press the Menu soft
key and select Properties.
• To block a contact from chatting with you, press the
Menu soft key and select Block.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
89
Chatting with contacts
1. To open a chat window, scroll to the contact with whom
you want to chat.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Send Message.
3. Enter your message in the text entry area at the bottom
of the screen, or press the Menu soft key and select My
Text to enter a preset message.
To invite another contact to a multi user chat, press the
Menu soft key, select Invite, and select the contact you
want to invite.
To switch back to the main window, press the Menu soft
key and select My contacts. To revert back to your chat
window, press the Menu soft key, select Chats, and
select the person whom you were chatting with.
4. To end the chat, press the Menu soft key and select
End Chat.
Using the Hotmail service
You can send and read e-mail messages on the phone via
the Microsoft Hotmail service.
Composing and sending an e-mail
1. On the Pocket MSN screen, select Compose Hotmail.
2. Compose an e-mail as you would in the Messaging
program.Messaging, Internet, and Messenger
90
Viewing e-mail messages
1. On the Pocket MSN screen, select MSN Hotmail.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Folders.
3. Select a message folder, and then select the message
you want to view.
Accessing the MSN Mobile Homepage
On the Pocket MSN screen, select MSN Mobile Home. You
can access various mail, information, entertainment
services provided by Microsoft.
Changing Pocket MSN setting options
From the Pocket MSN mail screen, press the Options soft
keys. The following options are available:
Note: To change the settings, you may need to sign in to the
MSN service.
• General: You can clear the saved password, if any, or set
Pocket MSN to be displayed on the Home screen.
• Hotmail: You can set filters to receive or block e-mails or
set Hotmail to automatically download new messages to
the phone.
• Messenger: You can change your display name in
Messenger or set Messenger to automatically update
your contacts’ presence information.
• SMS: You can set Pocket MSN to temporarily use SMS
when a data connection is unavailable.
• Switch User: You can reset user information to sign in
to the MSN service by another user account.6
91
Organiser
This chapter explains how to keep track of contacts and
appointments and make a list of tasks you need to do.
Contacts
Contacts maintains a list of your friends and colleagues so
that you can easily find the information you’re looking for,
whether you’re at home or on the road.
To open Contacts:
On the Home screen, press the Contacts soft key. You can
also press the Start soft key and select Contacts. You can
view the list of contact cards that you have created.
Creating a contact card
You can save a new contact card in Contacts or on the SIM
card.
Creating a contact card in the phone’s memory
1. On the contact list, press the New soft key.
2. Enter a name and other contact information.
To assign the contact card to a category, scroll to the
Categories field and select a category.
You can add a personal ringtone to a contact card. Scroll
to the Custom ring tone field and select the ring
melody you want.
Select the Picture field to add an image for the caller ID
image.Organiser
92
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a contact card on the SIM card
1. On the contact list, press the Menu soft key and select
New SIM Contact.
2. Enter the name of the person you want to add.
3. Scroll to the Number field and enter the number you
want to store.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Creating a contact card from the Dialling screen
1. On the Home screen, enter the phone number and press
the Save soft key.
2. To create a new contact card, select .
To add the phone number to an existing contact card,
select the contact card.
3. Scroll to the location in which you want to save the
number and press the Insert soft key.
4. Fill in the other fields and press the Done soft key.Organiser
93
Viewing and editing a contact card
When you access Contacts, the contact list displays the
names of your contacts alphabetically, along with an
abbreviation for the primary contact number or
E-mail address, such as the person’s work phone number
(w) or mobile phone number (m).
The following table shows possible abbreviations that might
be displayed on the Contacts list and their meanings:
Abbreviation Meaning
w/w2 work phone/work phone 2
h/h2 home phone/home phone 2
m mobile phone
co company phone
pgr pager
car car phone
ast assistant phone
rdo radio phone number
e/e2/e3 e-mail/e-mail 2/e-mail 3
Indicates the type of
the default number or
e-mail address.
Indicates the contacts
stored on the SIM card.Organiser
94
Note: All of the contacts saved on the SIM card follow all of
the contacts saved in the phone’s memory.
To open a contact card:
1. On the contact list, select the contact’s name you want
to view.
If the contact card is assigned to a certain category,
press the Menu soft key and select Filter and then
select the category from the pop-up list.
2. Select the contact card you want.
A summary screen is displayed.
3. On the summary screen:
• To edit the contact information, press the Menu soft
key and select Edit.
• To send an SMS message to the contact card, scroll to
the available number and press the SMS soft key, or
press the Menu soft key and then select Send SMS.
• To dial a number, select the number or press the Call
soft key.
• To send an e-mail, select the e-mail address.
• To access a web page, select the web page.
im/im2/im3 IM/IM2/IM3
web web page
Abbreviation MeaningOrganiser
95
Adding a number or address to Speed Dial
You can assign a short cut number to a phone number for
speed dialling or to an e-mail or URL address for quick
access.
1. On the contact list, select the contact you want.
2. Scroll to the number or address.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add to Speed Dial.
4. If necessary, change the name and select a keypad
location.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Copying entries between the SIM Card and
Contacts
You can copy the contact card or all of contact entries in a
specific category to the SIM card or vice versa.
Copying from Contacts to the SIM card
1. On the contact list, select the contact card stored in the
phone’s memory.
2. Scroll to the phone number to be copied.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Save to SIM.
4. If necessary, change the contact name.
5. Press the Done soft key.Organiser
96
Copying from the SIM card to Contacts
1. On the contact list, select the contact card stored on the
SIM card.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Save to Contacts.
3. Select to create a new contact card and
add contact information.
Otherwise, select a contact card to which you want to
add the number, scroll to the number type, and press
the Insert soft key.
4. Press the Done soft key to save the change.
Beaming a contact card
You can send a contact card in Contacts to another phone
via an active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the contact list or on the summary screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Beam Contact .
2. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
3. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.Organiser
97
Deleting a contact card
1. On the contact list or on the summary screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Delete Contact or Delete.
2. Press the Yes soft key to permanently delete the
contact card.
Note: If you delete a contact card on your phone and
synchronise Contacts with your computer, the contact
card in Outlook on your computer will be deleted.
Calendar
Use Calendar to schedule appointments, including
meetings and other events. You can check your
appointments in one of several views (Agenda, Week, and
Month).
To open Calendar:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Calendar. You can view the lists of
appointments that you have created in the agenda view.Organiser
98
Creating an appointment
1. Press the Menu soft key and select New Appointment.
2. Fill in the fields.
• Subject: Enter a description of the appointment.
• Start date, Start time, End date, and End time: If
needed, change the date and time.
• All day event: If checked, the appointment lasts all
day.
• Location: Enter the place of the appointment.
• Reminder: Select a time setting for the alarm to
remind you of the appointment.
• Occurs: Select a repeat interval to set how often the
appointment repeats.
• Status: Select an appropriate status for the
appointment.
• Sensitivity: Select a sensitivity class by which
Microsoft Exchange Server handles the appointment.
• Notes: Add a note for the appointment.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.Organiser
99
Viewing and editing an appointment
On the Calendar screen, you can view and edit your
appointments using the different views: Agenda, Week, or
Month. By default, the Calendar first appears in the agenda
view, which provides the most detail information about
your appointment.
Switching the view mode
You can change the view mode of the calendar to cycle
through the agenda, week, and month view.
In each view, press the Week, Month, or Agenda soft
key.
• Week View: shows the calendar of your appointments.
• Month View: allows you to keep track of your monthly
schedule and shows which days have appointments
scheduled.
• Agenda View: shows you the appointments for the
selected day. The entries are grouped according to their
starting times.
Editing an appointment
1. Select the calendar view by pressing the Week, Month,
or Agenda soft key.Organiser
100
2. In each view, select the date of the appointment by
pressing the Navigation keys.
To go to today, press the Menu soft key and select Go
to Today.
To go to a certain date, press the Menu soft key and
select Go to Date. Enter the date and press the Done
soft key.
3. Select the appointment you want to view.
4. Press the Edit soft key.
5. If you are editing a repeating or continuous
appointment, decide whether to edit all appointments in
the series or just the current appointment by pressing
the No or Yes soft key.
6. Edit the appointment information and press the Done
soft key to save the changes to the appointment.
Beaming an appointment
You can send an appointment to another phone via an
active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the calendar screen, open the appointment you
want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam
Appointment.Organiser
101
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
Deleting an appointment
1. On the calendar screen, scroll to an appointment to
delete.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete
Appointment.
3. If you make deleting to a repeating or continuous
appointment, decide whether to delete all appointments
in the series or just the current appointment by pressing
the No or Yes soft key.
Or, press the Yes soft key to permanently delete the
appointment.
Changing calendar setting options
From any view, press the Menu soft key and select
Options. The following options are available:
• First day of week: You can select which day the
calendar starts with.
• Week view: You can select a week view type.
• Month view: You can set the Month view shows the
current week number.
• Set reminders: You can select default schedule alarm
time.Organiser
102
D-Day
In D-Day, you can calculate how many days are left before
or have passed since a specific event.
To open D-Day:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → D-Day.
Creating a D-Day counter
1. Press the New soft key.
2. Set options in each field.
• Date: Enter the date of the day you want to count to
or from.
• Title: Enter the counter title.
• Category: Select one of the preset categories. You
can filter counters by category from the counter list.
• Repeat every year: Select to set the D-day counter
to repeat every year.
3. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
The counter is added to the list and shows how many
days are left or have passed.Organiser
103
Editing D-Day categories
You can change the name of D-Day categories.
1. From the counter list, press the Menu soft key and
select Edit Category.
2. Scroll to the category you want.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Rename.
4. Enter a new name and press the Done soft key.
Deleting a D-Day counter
1. Scroll to the counter you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
Tasks
Tasks is a convenient place to create task reminders. You
can mark a task as completed or delete a task.
To open Tasks:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Tasks.
Creating a task note
1. Enter your task information in the Enter new task
here field.
2. When you have finished, press twice.
The task note is added to the task list.Organiser
104
Completing a task
When a task is complete, mark it to indicate that the task is
done. To mark, scroll to the completed task and press the
Complete soft key.
To unmark, press the Activate soft key.
Beaming a task note
You can send a task note to another phone via an active
infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. On the task list, scroll to the task you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam Task .
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
4. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.
Deleting a task
1. On the task list, scroll to the task.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete Task.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.Organiser
105
Voice Notes
In any program where you can write on the screen, you can
also quickly capture thoughts, reminders, and phone
numbers by recording a message. In Voice Notes, you can
create a recording.
To open Voice Notes:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Voice Notes.
Recording a voice note
1. Hold your phone’s microphone near your mouth or other
source of sound.
2. Press the Record soft key to make your recording.
The numbers on the centre of the screen indicate the
elapsed time.
3. Press the Stop soft key to stop recording.
Your phone automatically saves the voice note labelled
with the title and lists the notes on the All Notes screen.
Reviewing a voice note
1. On the All Notes list, select the note you want to review.
Recording is playing. During playback, you can adjust
the sound volume by pressing .
2. Press the Stop soft key to stop playing.Organiser
106
Setting a voice note as the ringtone
1. On the All Notes list, scroll to a voice note.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Set As Ringtone.
3. Press the OK soft key.
Alarm
You can use the alarm clock to set a wake-up alarm or set
an alarm to remind you of an appointment.
To open alarm:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and select
Organizer → Alarm.
Setting a wake-up alarm
1. On the Alarm screen, select Wake up alarm.
2. Select a check box, enter the time for the wake-up
alarm to sound, and select the days when the wake-up
alarm rings in the week viewer.
Use the Navigation keys to move through each field. You
can make up to 3 wake-up alarms.
3. Select a melody for the alarm in the Tone field.
4. Select a time interval to resume the alarm after the
alarm is stopped in the Snooze field.
5. Press the Done soft key. Organiser
107
Setting an alarm
1. On the Alarm screen, select one of Alarm 1 to Alarm 4.
2. Set each alarm option.
3. Press the Done soft key.
Stopping an alarm
• When an alarm rings, press the Dismiss soft key to stop
it, or press the Snooze soft key to set the alarm to ring
again after the specified snooze interval.
• To deactivate an alarm, access it from the Alarm screen
and remove the check marks for a wake-up alarm, or set
Off from the Alarm activation field for a normal alarm.
WorldClock
You can set up the world clock with the time zones you
want, and then check the current time of the city you need
at any time.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key
2. Select Organizer → WorldClock.
3. Select the clock you want.
4. Press the Left or Right key to move the time zone line.
To apply daylight savings to the currently selected time
zone, select Summer Time.
5. Press the Done soft key to save the selected time zone.
6. Repeat from step 3 to add time zones.7
108
Multimedia
Camera
With the built-in camera on your phone, you can take
photos or record videos of people or events while on the
move. Your phone produces JPEG photos and 3GP videos.
To open Camera:
Press the Start soft key , and select Camera.
Taking photos
1. When you access the Camera mode, the image to be
captured appears.
2. Adjust the image to be captured.
• Press the Up or Down key to zoom in or out.
• Press the Left or Right key to adjust the brightness of
the image.
• Press the Menu soft key to access the camera options.
See page 109.
• Use the number keypad to adjust the image quickly.
See page 109.
3. Press or to take a photo.
4. Press the Save soft key to save the photo.
The photo is saved to the location specified in the
Default Storage option. After saving the photo, the
camera automatically returns to Preview mode.Multimedia
109
Setting camera options
You can customise the camera settings. Once you set the
camera settings, the corresponding icons display at the top
of the Preview screen.
On the Preview screen, press the Menu soft key.
• Camcorder: switches to Camcorder mode.
• Shooting Mode: changes the camera shooting mode.
Single Shot: takes a normal single shot.
Multi Shot: takes a series of stills. You can select the
number of photos the camera will take.
Mosaic Shot: takes a series of stills and saves them in
one frame. You can select a layout.
• Flash On: turns the flash on or off.
• Timer: selects the length of time for the camera to delay
before taking a photo.
• Effects: selects a colour tone for photos.
• Frames: selects a decorative frame.
• Options: changes the default settings for Camera. See
page 112.
Using the keypad shortcuts
You can use the keypad to customise your camera settings
when you are in the preview screen.
• : switches to Camcorder mode.
• : changes the shooting mode by changing the number
of photos or the layout.
• : changes the image size.
• : changes the image quality.
• : changes the white balance.Multimedia
110
• : turns the flash on or off.
• : selects the length of delay time before taking a
photo.
• : changes the colour tone.
• : allows you to add a decorative frame to the photo.
• : allows you to select camera options.
Viewing photos
To view photos you have taken, press the Album soft key
in Camera mode. The list of the photos is stored in the
currently selected storage memory. For further details, see
page 122.
Recording video clips
1. From Camera mode, press to switch to Camcorder
mode. The image to be recorded appears.
2. Adjust the image to be recorded.
• Press the Up or Down key to zoom in or out on your
subject.
• Press the Left or Right key to adjust the brightness of
the image.
• Press the Menu soft key to access the camcorder
options. See page 111
• Use the number keypad to adjust the image quickly.
See page 111.
3. To start recording, press or . The timer on the top
left of the screen shows you the elapsed time.Multimedia
111
4. To stop recording, press the Stop soft key, , or .
5. Press the Save soft key to save the video.
The video clip is saved to the location specified in the
Default Storage option. After saving the video, the
camcorder automatically returns to Video Preview.
Setting camcorder options
You can customise the camcorder settings. Once you set
the video settings, the corresponding icons display at the
top of the Video Preview screen.
On the Video Preview screen, press the Menu soft key.
• Camera: switches to Camera mode.
• Recording Mode: select a video recording mode. Select
Limit for MMS to record a video suitable for an MMS or
e-mail message. Select Normal to record a video within
the limit of the currently available memory.
• Flash On: turns the flash on or off.
• Timer: selects the length of time for the phone to delay
before recording a video.
• Effects: selects a colour tone for the video.
• Audio Off: selects whether or not you record audio with
a video clip.
• Options: changes the default settings for Camera. See
page 112.
Using the keypad shortcuts
You can use the keypad to customise your video settings
when you are on the Video Preview screen.
• : switches to Camera mode.
• : changes the recording mode.Multimedia
112
• : changes the image size.
• : changes the image quality.
• : changes the white balance.
• : turns the flash on or off.
• : selects the length of delay time before starting
recording a video.
• : changes the colour tone.
• : mutes or unmutes audio.
• : allows you to select camera options.
Playing video clips
To view the video clips you have recorded, press the
Album soft key in Camcorder mode. The list of the video
clips is stored in the currently selected storage memory.
For further details, see page 122.
Changing the default camera settings
To customise the default camera settings, press the Menu
soft key and select Options.
The following options are available:
• General: You can customise the general settings for the
Camera program.
Auto Save: allows you to set whether the camera will
save the photo or video after taking or recording.
Default Storage: allows you to select where you want
to store your photos or video clips.
• Camera: You can customise the settings for Camera
mode.Multimedia
113
Photo Size: allows you to select an image size.
Photo Quality: allows you to select an image quality.
White Balance: allows you to select the white balance
mode to adjust the colour balance of photos.
Shutter Sound: allows you to select a sound for the
shutter release.
Default Name: allows you to change the default prefix
of photo names.
• Camcorder: You can customise the settings for
Camcorder mode
Video Size: allows you to select an video frame size.
Video Quality: allows you to select an image quality.
White Balance: allows you to select the white balance
mode to adjust the colour balance of videos.
Default Name: allows you to change the default prefix
of video names.
• Shortcuts: You can check view the functions assigned to
the keys in Camera mode or Camcorder mode.
• About: You can check the copyright information of the
Camera program.Multimedia
114
Windows Media Player
Your phone is equipped with Microsoft Windows Media
Player 10. With Windows Media Player, you can play
Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Video, and MP3
audio files that are stored on your phone, a memory card,
or on the Web.
To open Windows Media Player:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Windows Media.
Preparing media files
The Windows Media Player of your phone can play various
file formats, such as .asf, .wma, .wmv, and .mp3. You can
copy media files from your desktop computer to the phone
using the Windows Media Player or ActiveSync. You can
also copy media files using a memory card.
Note: If you have stored too many files in memory, the
operation speed of the system slows down. Using an
optional memory card helps you clear up this problem
and lets you enjoy more music files.
About DRM, licenses, and protected files
Some digital media files, such as songs downloaded from
online stores, are encrypted to prevent the files from being
unlawfully distributed or shared. Content providers use a
technology called Digital Rights Management (DRM), to
encrypt the files. During the encryption process, the
content provider creates a license which specifies how and
when the file can be used. Multimedia
115
For example, a content provider could create a license that
allows you to play a certain file on your computer, but not
on your phone. Or, a license that allows you to play a
certain file on your phone, but only for a month, or perhaps
only a certain number of times. Files that have licenses
associated with them are called protected files.
Copying media files using ActiveSync
1. Connect your phone to a computer and start
synchronisation by referring to page 42.
2. Open the file directory on the phone by clicking Explore
from the Microsoft ActiveSync window.
3. Drag the media files you want to copy and drop them
into a folder.
Windows Media Player automatically retrieves the media
files from the folder where the files are copied and you
can search them from the Library screen. If the media
files do not appear in Library, update the library by
pressing the Menu soft key and selecting Update
Library.
Copying media files using the desktop player
You can use the desktop player to copy media files. Using
the desktop player ensures that licenses are copied with
protected files.
Make sure that you have Windows Media Player 10 or later
versions on your desktop computer. Depending on the
version of your desktop player, the procedure to copy files
may vary.
1. Connect your phone to the desktop computer and start
synchronisation using a PC data cable.Multimedia
116
2. Open Windows Media Player on the desktop computer.
3. Click the Sync tab.
4. Click Edit Playlist.
5. Select the media files you want to synchronise from the
left pane of the window.
6. Click OK.
7. Select the saving location from the right pane.
8. Click to select the quality level you want and click
OK.
9. Click Start Sync.
The selected files are converted and copied to the
location you selected in step 7.Multimedia
117
Using libraries
A library is a file list provided by Windows Media Player to
retrieve media files in the phone’s memory.
The Library screen contains categories, such as My Music,
My Videos, My TV, and My Playlists. Using the Library
screen, you can sort your content by criteria, such as artist
name, album title, or genre.
On the Library screen, you can use the following options by
pressing the Menu soft key:
• Queue Up: adds the selected file to the end of the
current play list.
• Delete from Library: deletes the selected file from the
library.
• Now Playing: Open the current play list.
• Library: allows you to select the library you want to
view; for example, the library of files stored on your
phone or on the memory card.
• Update Library: adds new files to the library by
searching your phone or a memory card.
• Open File: allows you to find and play files that are
stored on your phone or a memory card, but those are
not in the library.
• Open URL: allows you to specify a URL address for a
streaming service.
• Properties: displays information about the selected file.
• Done: closes the Library screen and displays the player
screen.Multimedia
118
Playing music and video files
If you have copied media files to your phone’s memory or
memory card, you can play them from Media Player.
Playing media files from a library
1. On the Library screen, if necessary, press the Menu soft
key, select Library, and select the memory from which
you want to retrieve files.
2. When libraries have been updated, press the Done soft
key.
3. Select a category.
4. Scroll to the library you want to play and press the Play
soft key.
If the file does not appear in a library, on the Library
screen, press the Menu soft key and select Open File.
Then select the file you want to play.
The player screen appears and the selected file plays.
Use the following options during playback:
• To adjust the volume, press the Up or Down key. You can
view the volume level on the screen.
• To adjust the earpiece volume, press .
• To move backward in a file, press and hold the Left key.
• To move forward in a file, press and hold the Right key.
• To access the next file, press the Right key.
• To access the previous file, press the Left key.
• To pause or resume playback, press .
• To play the files in the play list randomly or repeatedly,
press the Menu soft key and select Shuffle/Repeat.
• To stop playback, press the Menu soft key and select
Stop.Multimedia
119
Notes:
• When a Bluetooth headset is connected to the phone, the
play/pause/stop button on the headset may not function
properly. To control the player from the headset, first play or
pause music from Media Player, and then use the button.
• While playback is in progress, the multi-function key on the
Bluetooth headset may not function.
Playing media files on a network
1. On the Library screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Open URL.
2. Enter a URL in the URL field, or scroll to one of URLs that
you have used from the History field.
3. Press the OK soft key.
Note: To play streaming media, you must be connected to a
network. For more information on creating a remote
connection between your phone and a network, see
page 148.
Setting up a play list
You can add media files on the Library screen to a
temporary play list. It lists the currently playing file, as well
as any files that have been queued up to play next.
Creating a play list
1. On the Library screen, select the category you want and
scroll to the file you want to play.
If the file does not appear on the list, press the Menu
soft key and select Update Library. You can also select
Open File to display the File System screen and search
the files you want.Multimedia
120
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Queue Up to add
the file to the play list.
3. Repeat from step 1 to add more files.
4. Press to return to the player screen.
5. Press to start playing the files.
Opening the play list
On the player screen, press the Now Playing soft key. You
can use various options by pressing the Menu soft key.
Editing the play list
• To change the play order, press the Menu soft key and
select Move Up or Move Down.
• To delete the selected files, press the Menu soft key and
select Delete from Playlist.
• To clear the play list, press the Menu soft key and select
Clear Now Playing.
Changing the Window Media Player
settings
You can customise the appearance and functionality of
Windows Media Player. On the player screen, press the
Menu soft key and select Options.
You can use the following options:
• Playback: Select the options for playback. You can
select the way time is displayed on the player screen, or
whether or not to pause playback when you launch
another program, and resume playback after a phone
call.Multimedia
121
• Video: Select the viewing options for playing videos,
such as shrinking oversized videos and playing videos on
a full screen.
Note: If there is a problem while playing MP4 files, deselect
the Scale to fit window option. The problem occurs
because the file has been resized.
• Network: Change the connections speed and protocol
for playing streaming content.
• Library: Select whether the player screen or the Library
screen is displayed when you open Windows Media
Player.
• Skins: Change the appearance of the player screen by
selecting a new skin.
• Buttons: Assign Windows Media Player functions to the
keys on your phone to quickly control playback without
having to use the menus.
Customising SRS WOW XT Settings
SRS WOW XT for Mobile is a suite of 3D audio, bass
enhancement, and mono and stereo speaker technologies
designed to improve the quality of mobile audio, e g
cellular phone sound quality.
To enjoy music with high audio quality, enable the WOW XT
feature before playing media files.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then the More soft key, and
press the WOW XT Settings.
3. On the SRS WOW XT screen, select On in the WOW XT
On/Off field.Multimedia
122
4. Select the type you want in the SRS EQ field, or adjust
the settings for each component.
5. Press the Done soft key.
Note:
• is a trademark of SRS Labs, Inc. WOW technology is
incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.
• When you use a headset, the WOW XT feature is enhanced
and provides a more powerful listening experience.
Picture & Videos
This program allows you to access all of your picture and
video files stored in your phone's directory or on a memory
card.
To open Pictures & Videos:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Pictures & Videos. The
thumbnails of the files display.
Viewing a photo
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, select a photo folder,
if necessary.
Note: Photos captured by the camera on the phone are stored
in the PIC-00 folder.
2. Scroll to the thumbnail image of the picture you want
and press the View soft key.
While viewing a photo, you can use the following options:Multimedia
123
• To zoom in or out, press or .
• To send the picture as part of an MMS or e-mail message,
press the Send soft key.
• To edit the picture, press the Menu soft key and select
Edit. You can then access the editing tool options by
pressing the Menu soft key.
• To set the picture as wallpaper for the Home screen,
press the Menu soft key and select Use as Home
Screen.
Viewing photos as a slide show
You can view all of your pictures as a slide show, a
sequential presentation of each image in the current
album.
Press the Menu soft key and select Play Slide Show. The
slide show begins on the full screen.
• To change the screen to the Landscape view or Portrait
view, press the Up or Down key.
• To manually scroll through the pictures, press the Left or
Right key.
• To stop the slide show and return to the Pictures & Videos
screen, press .
Playing a video
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, Press the Menu soft
key and select Folders → My Device → My Documents
→ My Videos.
2. Select a video folder, if necessary. Multimedia
124
Note: Videos captured by the camera on the phone are stored
in the Mov-00 folder.
3. Scroll to the thumbnail image of the video clip you want
and press the Play soft key.
Beaming a file
You can send a picture or video clip to another phone via an
active infrared or Bluetooth connection.
For an Bluetooth connection, make sure that the Bluetooth
feature is active.
1. Open a folder, if necessary, and scroll to the file you
want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam....
3. For an IrDA connection, align the infrared ports on the
devices so that they are unobstructed and within a close
range.
Wait for the phone to search for available devices.
4. Scroll to a device and press the Beam soft key.
Switching to another folder
You can open files in any folder in the other directory of
your phone.
1. From Pictures & Videos screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Folders.
2. Select a folder. If necessary, repeat this step to open a
subfolder.Multimedia
125
Copying or moving files
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, open the folder you
want and scroll to the file you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit → Cut or Copy.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Folders → another
folder.
4. Press the Menu soft key and select Edit → Paste.
Deleting a file
1. From the Pictures & Videos screen, open the folder you
want and scroll to the file you want.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Delete.
3. Press the Yes soft key to confirm the deletion.
Customising settings
From the Pictures & Videos screen, press the Menu soft
key and select Options to access the following options:
• General: allows you to select a maximum size of
pictures for sending via e-mail messages, or select a
rotating orientation.
• Slide Show: allows you to select an orientation of a slide
show or set whether or not the slide show plays as a
screen saver when the phone is connected to a computer
and in Idle mode.8
126
Extra programs
Games
Your phone includes fun games, such as Solitaire in Games.
You can also download and play new Java games.
To open Games:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key twice, and select Games.
Solitaire
The object of Solitaire is to use all the cards in the deck to
build up the four suit stacks in ascending order, beginning
with aces.
Playing a game
1. On the Start screen, select Solitaire.
2. Move any aces on the seven stacks to the four card
spaces at the top of the screen and then make any other
available plays.
To move cards, press the number or character of the
card to move and then press the number or character of
the stack to which you want to move the card.
Note: Pressing the Up key moves a card to one of the four
stacks in the upper right corner of the screen if it
belongs there.
3. When you have made all available plays, press the Draw
soft key to turn over cards.Extra programs
127
Funbox
Funbox is a folder where downloaded games are stored.
To download new games, press the Download soft key.
Your phone launches the WAP browser and loads the preset
website which provides you with the latest news and
information about games and game downloads.
To play a game, select one from the FunBox screen. How to
play may vary from game to game.
Calculator
The calculator allows you to perform general mathematical
functions, such as addition, subtraction, multiplication, and
division.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Calculator.
3. Enter the numbers and perform calculations by pressing
the Navigation keys (Up: +, Down: –, Left: /, Right: x).
4. To execute the calculation, press .Extra programs
128
Smart Converter
In Smart Converter, you can perform unit conversions.
1. On the Home Screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → Smart Converter.
3. Select a converter type.
4. Select an original unit and enter the value to be
converted in the upper Unit field.
Note: Press to add a decimal point. In the temperature
converter, press to change the temperature to below
or above zero.
5. Select a target unit from the lower Unit field. The
equivalent value appears.
Notes:
• To reverse the unit fields for continuous conversions, press
the Menu soft key and select Reverse.
• For the currency converter, you may need to change
currency rates. Press the Menu soft key and Currency
rates.Extra programs
129
StopWatch
You can measure elapsed time interval.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then
the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories and then More soft key. Press
StopWatch.
3. Press the Start soft key to start the timer.
4. Press the Record soft key to check an interval.
You can do this step for a total of 99 intervals.
5. Press the Stop soft key to stop the stopwatch.
Voice Assist
Voice Assist is a speech recognition program that enables
you to launch programs or dial contacts by speaking an
associated command into the microphone.
Voice tips
• Speak clearly, naturally, and continuously.
• If you are in a very noisy environment, use the headset.
If you are not using the headset, address the internal
microphone at the bottom of the phone at a distance of
about 10 to 20 cm from your mouth.
• Speak when Voice Assist is ready to listen, as indicated
by the progress bar and after an audible beep.
• If Voice Assist does not clearly hear what you said, try
repeating your voice command.Extra programs
130
Using Voice Command functions
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key on the Home
screen and select More soft key and press Voice Assist.
Dialling a number
You can make a phone call by saying the name that has
been assigned to a contact in Contacts or the SIM card.
Note: To use the Name Dial feature, the name that you want
to dial must be in Contacts or the SIM card.
1. On the Voice Command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say “Name Dial”.
2. On the Name Dial screen, after a voice prompt followed
by a short beep, say a name in the following
manner:””
If Voice Assist does not hear anything until the progress
bar moves to the end, you will be asked to repeat the
command up to 3 times.
Note: You can say “Call” and then a person’s name stored in
Contacts or on the SIM card to make a call by voice
command.
3. Your phone recognises your commnad and displays a list
of one or more names in the confirmation screen.
4. Scroll to the item you want to open and press the Ok
soft key.Extra programs
131
5. If the selected name has more than one number, the
phone asks which number you want to dial.
6. If you press the Ok soft key or say nothing for 3
seconds, the phone dials the currently selected number.
Searching for contacts
You can retrieve contact information for any name in
Contacts or the SIM card by saying that name. Your phone
displays the information.
1. On the Voice command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say “Name Search”.
2. On the Name Search screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say a name in the following
manner:””
3. Your phone recognises your command and displays a list
of one or more names in the confirmation screen.
Opening programs by voice
You can use your voice to launch programs that exist in
Start menu.
1. On the Voice Command screen, after a voice prompt
followed by a short beep, say a program name in the
following manner:”Open ”.
2. Your phone recognises your command and displays a list
of one or more applications in the confirmation screen.
Note: If Quick Launch is checked at Settings, this
confirmation step will be skipped and the best
recoginition result wil be excuted immediately.Extra programs
132
Customising the Voice Command settings
You can customise the various settings for using Voice
Assist by pressing the Settings soft key on the Voice
Command screen.
• Timeout: Adjust the maximum time to listen to your
commands.
• Voice Guides:Check for more comprehensive voice
prompts and responses.
• Quick Launch: Check to skip the confirmation.
• Sensitivity: Ajust the sensitivity in which your phone
distinguishes the current voice and noise. Change the
setting if your phone has difficulty recognising your voice.
Picsel Viewer
Picsel Viewer allows you to view documents on your
phone without any file-conversion or loss of content.
To view a document, you must transfer documents from a
PC. If you have installed the memory card, you can view
the files stored in it.
By default, Picsel Viewer supports most common desktop
document formats, such as .doc, .xls, .ppt, .pdf and .wmf.
Note: Some document formats, such as .xls and .ppt, are not
transformed into their corresponding file types when
you copy them to your phone by using ActiveSync, so
that you cannot view the documents in the directory.
To avoid this case, change the conversion setting on the
ActiveSync screen on your computer.Extra programs
133
To open Picsel Viewer:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Picsel Viewer.
Viewing a document
On the Picsel Viewer screen, the file directory of the phone
is displayed.
1. Select the folder containing the document you want.
If you have installed a memory card, Storage Card
appears to allow you to access files on the memory
card.
2. Select the document you want to open.
Adobe PDF: , Microsoft World: , Microsoft Power
Point: , Microsoft Excel: , Plain Text: , JPEG/
BMP/GIF/PNG:
Go back to the
upper level
directory.Extra programs
134
Using options in a document view
From a document view, you can use the number keypad to
quickly perform an option. These are the keys you can use
and options assigned to each key.
• Panning: To pan to a different part of the document,
press the Navigation keys to move to the direction you
want. You can also press , , , , respectively.
• Zooming: To zoom in or out, press to switch to zoom
mode and then press the Navigation keys. You can also
press or .
• Fitting to width: To fit the width of the page on screen,
press the Menu soft key and select Page → Fit to width.
You can also press .
• Navigating: To navigate the pages, press the Menu soft
key and select Page → Next Page, Previous Page,
First page, or Last page. You can also press , , ,
or , respectively.
Viewing History
The history view shows you previously visited documents
as a small thumbnail-image of the document, and the
document’s name, location, and the date of your visiting.
To open the history view, press the Menu soft key and
select History.
To access any of the documents from the history view,
select the small picture of that page.
Note: Documents will remain on the history list until a certain
number of days have passed. You can control this
period in the option. See page 135.Extra programs
135
Viewing the Favourites list
For your favourite documents, you can keep a list in
Favourites. This looks similar to the history view but
includes only those pages you have explicitly added. Before
viewing the Favourites list, first you must add the pages to
the Favourites list.
To add the current page to the Favourites list:
1. Press the Menu soft key and select Favourites to
access the Favourites list.
2. Press the Add/Delete soft key and select Add.
3. Enter the name you want and then press the OK soft
key.
To open a favourite page:
Access the Favourites list and select the thumbnail of the
page you want.
Changing Picsel Viewer settings
On the Picsel Viewer screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Settings. The following options are available:
• Preferences: Set the period after which the thumbnail
pictures and descriptions of pages are removed from the
history memory. To clear the History list, select Clear
History.
• Files: Select the file types which can be displayed on the
Picsel Viewer screen. Select All to select all file formats.
• Help: Shows the Help screen for using Picsel Viewer.
• About: Shows information about the developers of Picsel
Viewer.Extra programs
136
File Manager
The File Manager program allows you to open an explorer
window similar to a desktop Windows based system. The
explorer window allows you to navigate through your
phone to locate the desired folders and files.
You can also quickly manage, delete, copy, or edit any files
and folders on your phone.
Note: If you turn off the phone after storing some files in any
folders, except for the Storage folder, using ActiveSync,
all of the files in those folders will be deleted. Store
important files in the Storage folder to prevent them
from being deleted.
Accessing files
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
2. Select File Manager.
The list of the folders in the phone’s memory displays.
3. Scroll to the folder that you want to view.
4. Select an item to open it. Extra programs
137
Using file management options
From the file directory, you can use the number keypad to
quickly perform an option. The options can be accessed by
pressing the Menu soft key. These are the keys you can
use and options assigned to each key.
• (Folder Tree): Returns to the folder tree screen
• (Favorites): Opens the favorite file list.
• (Properties): Shows the file properties.
• (Scroll to Top): Moves to the top of the file list.
• (Refresh): Updates the file directory.
• (Scroll up): Scrolls up by one page.
• (Scroll to End): Moves to the end of the file list.
• (Search): Allows you to search for a file by entering a
keyword. The phone will search for files under the
currently accessed folder.
• (Scroll down): Scrolls down by one page.
• (Select): Selects a file or folder.
• (Unselect All): Deselects all checked files.
• (Select All): Selects all files in the current folder.
In addition, you can access the following options:
• To use editing tools, press the Edit soft key.
• To create a new folder, press the Edit soft key and select
New Folder.
• To send a file, press the Menu soft key and select Send
→ a sending option.
• To change the order of files or folders, press the Menu
soft key and select View → a sort option.Extra programs
138
SIM Manager
The SIM Manager program enables you to view the contact
cards stored on the SIM card and to copy the contact(s)
from the SIM card to the contact list on your phone. You
can also create a new contact card on the SIM card, edit,
and delete the contact card.
Viewing SIM contacts
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
2. Select Accessories → SIM Manager.
The contact list is displayed on the SIM Manager screen.
3. From the SIM contact list:
• To create a new entry, press the New soft key.
• To register the phone number and name as the own
number on the SIM card, press the Menu soft key and
select Own Number.
• To view the amount of the contacts, SMS messages,
and CB messages stored on the SIM card, press the
Menu soft key and select Memory Status.
• To refresh the SIM contacts, press the Menu soft key
and select Refresh.Extra programs
139
Copying contact cards to the Contacts
application
You can copy a contact or all contacts stored on the SIM
card to the Contacts program.
1. On the SIM Manager screen, select the check box next
to the contact name you want to copy to your phone.
If you want to copy all contacts, press the Menu soft
key and select Check → Check All #.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select SIM Tool → Copy
to Contacts.
3. To change the number category, press the Menu soft
key and select Change (M/H/W).
4. Press the Copy soft key.
5. Press the OK soft key.
Using the SIM Manager options
On the SIM Manager screen, press the Menu soft key and
select SIM Tool. The following options are available.
• View: shows the selected SIM entry.
• Edit: allows you to edit the selected entry.
• Delete Entries: allows you to delete the selected
entry(ies).
• Dial: dials the number in the selected entry.Extra programs
140
• Send SMS: sends the SMS message using the number in
the selected entry.
• Copy to Contacts: copies the selected entries to
Contacts.
• Beam: allows you to send the selected entry via an
infrared connection.
Using the SMS Tool options
Sometimes, text messages may be stored on the SIM card,
depending on their specifications. To view these messages,
press the Menu soft key and select SMS Tool. You can
view a list of the sender’s phone numbers of the received
SMS messages stored on the SIM card.
On the SIM SMS Tool screen, press the Menu soft key to
move SIM messages from the SIM card to the phone’s
memory and view or delete an SMS message.
To jump across your selection between the SIM list and the
PDA list, press the Change soft key.
Task Manager
Your phone is a multi-tasking device. It can run more than
one program at the same time. However, multi-tasking
may cause hang-ups, freezing, memory problems, and
additional power consumption. To avoid these problems,
end unnecessary programs using Task Manager.
To open Task Manager:
On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and then the
More soft key, and select Accessories and then the More
soft key. Press Task Manager. The list of all the programs
currently running on your phone appears.Extra programs
141
Managing running programs
• To activate a program, press the Menu soft key and
select Activate.
• To close a program, press the Stop soft key. To close all
programs, press the Menu soft key and select Stop All.
• To refresh the program list, press the Menu soft key and
select Refresh.
Checking the memory status
You can check the memory in use for running programs or
storing files and information. Press the Menu soft key and
select Memory.
Checking the storage memory
You can check the memory in use for storing files in each
storage device: Storage Card and Storage. On the Task
Manager screen, press the Menu soft key and select
Storage.
To format the memory card, press the Menu soft key and
select Format Storage Card.9
142
Getting connected
You can use your phone to exchange information with other
mobile devices as well as your desktop computer, a
network, or the Internet. You have the following connection
options:
• Use the infrared (IR) port on your device to send and
receive files between two devices.
• Exchange information between devices with Bluetooth
capabilities without a physical connection.
• Connect the phone to your computer using a USB or IrDA
connection to use the phone as a modem.
• Connect to your Internet service provider (ISP) or the
network at your company. Once connected, you can send
or receive e-mail and instant messages, and browse the
Internet or intranet.
Beaming with infrared connections
Your phone can send and receive files to and from other IR
devices. In most cases, you can also receive files from your
PC when it is equipped with an infrared port. The two
devices must be aimed at each other approximately 10
centimetres apart.Getting connected
143
If you have difficulty getting the two devices to send or
receive data, try the following:
• Make sure that the infrared port windows are clear
and free of any dirt or obstructions and that there are
no obstacles between the infrared port windows.
• Adjust the room lighting or move to another location.
Some types of lighting may interfere with
transmission.
Note: Your phone’s IrDA function is only compatible with
Microsoft Smart Phones and Windows 2000/XP
computers.
Activating or deactivating IrDA reception
You must activate the infrared port to let your phone to
detect incoming IR transmissions and receive data.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Beam.
3. Select Receive incoming beams.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Receiving data
1. Make sure that your phone’s display is activate and align
the infrared port on your phone with the one on another
device.
Note: The display on your phone must be active.
2. Have the other device send the data to your phone.
3. When prompted to receive an incoming data, press the
Yes soft key.Getting connected
144
Sending data
1. Open the item you want in a program.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Beam, followed by
the type of item, such as Contact or Appointment.
If you send an item in File Manager, press the Menu
soft key and select Send → via IR.
3. Align the infrared port on your phone with the one on
the other device.
The two devices starts an IrDA connection and the other
device name appears on your phone.
4. Press the Beam soft key.
Note: The display on your phone must be active.
Beaming with Bluetooth
Bluetooth is a short-range wireless communications
technology. Devices with Bluetooth capabilities can
exchange data over a distance of about 10 metres without
requiring a physical connection.
Unlike infrared, you do not need to line up the phone with
another device to beam information with Bluetooth.
Activating Bluetooth mode
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.Getting connected
145
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections →
Bluetooth → Bluetooth.
3. On the Bluetooth screen, select the operating mode you
want in the Bluetooth field.
You can use the following operating mode:
• On: The Bluetooth radio is turned on and you can use
Bluetooth features.
• Off: The Bluetooth radio is turned off. You can neither
send nor receive data by using Bluetooth.
• Discoverable: The Bluetooth radio is turned on, and
all of the other Bluetooth devices within range (about
10 meters) can detect your device and attempt to
beam data to your device, establish a bond, or use a
Bluetooth service.
4. Press the Done soft key.
Searching for and pairing with a Bluetooth
device
1. On the Bluetooth screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Devices.
2. To search for a new device, press the Menu soft key and
select New.
3. Wait for the phone to search for Bluetooth devices.
4. Select the device you want.
5. Enter a Bluetooth passkey and press the Next soft key.
This passkey is used just once and you do not need to
memorise it. Getting connected
146
When the owner of the other device enters the same
passkey, paring is finished.
Note: Some devices, especially headsets or hands-free car
kits, may have a fixed Bluetooth passkey, such as
0000. If the other device has one, you must enter the
passkey.
6. Enter a display name for the other device and press the
Next soft key.
7. Press the OK soft key.
Using the device options
When you press the Menu soft key from the device list,
you can access the following options:
• New: allows you to search for any devices.
• Edit: allows you to change the name of the connectable
device.
• Delete: allows you to delete the device.
• Set as Hands-free: allows you to use the connectable
device as a hands-free kit. You can converse with the
other person on the phone without holding the phone to
your ear during a call.
• Set as wireless Stereo: allows you to play the audio
files.Getting connected
147
Receiving data with Bluetooth
1. When a notification that a remote device is trying to
connect to your phone, press the Bluetooth passkey
entered from the device and press the Next soft key.
2. When prompted to receive an incoming data, press the
Yes soft key.
Modem link
Using Modem Link, you can set your phone to be used as
an external modem for another device or computer when
connected via the USB port or infrared port.
1. Make sure that your phone is not connected with
another device.
2. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key and
then the More soft key.
3. Select Accessories → Modem Link.
4. If you first access this program, press the Done soft
key.
5. Select the type of connection, baud rate, and access
point name.
6. Press the Activate soft key to activate Modem Link.
7. Press the Done soft key.
Note:
• When Modem Link is activated, you cannot use ActiveSync.
• When Windows Service Pack 2 is used, Internet access using
Modem Link is more stable.Getting connected
148
Connecting to the Internet or your
network
You can use the Connections settings to create dial-up,
Virtual Private Network (VPN), GPRS, and proxy
connections so that you can connect to the Internet or your
corporate network. By using a data connection, you can
browse the Internet, download e-mails, chat by using
MSN®
Messenger, or synchronise remotely with an
Exchange Server. Check with your service provider to see if
a data connection has already been set up for you, and if
over-the-air configuration is supported.
Creating a dial-up connection
You can create a dial-up connection to connect remotely to
the Internet, a Wireless Application Protocol (WAP)
network, or your corporate network. Then, when you open
a program that is configured to use this connection, the
phone uses it to automatically connect to the network.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Dial up.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects to: Select a type of network for which the
connection will be used.
• Phone number: Enter the dial-up number you use to
connect to the network.
• User name: Enter your network user name.Getting connected
149
• Password: Enter your password.
• Domain: Enter the domain name, if required.
Notes:
• If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask your
service provider.
• If you subscribe to General Packet Radio Service (GPRS),
you can set up a GPRS connection to access your corporate
network or the Internet, which is faster than a dial-up
connection. For details, see “Creating a GPRS connection.”
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a GPRS connection
If you subscribe to General Packet Radio Services (GPRS),
you can set up a GPRS connection to gain access to your
corporate network or the Internet. This is faster than a
dial-up connection.
You can also use your phone as a GPRS modem for a
desktop computer.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → GPRS.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects to: Select a network type for which the
connection will be used.Getting connected
150
• Access point: Enter the information provided by your
system administrator.
• User name: Enter your user name for the GPRS
network.
• Password: Enter your password.
• Primary DNS: Enter the primary domain naming
system (DNS) address.
• Secondary DNS: Enter the secondary DNS address.
• IP address: Enter the Internet Protocol (IP) address.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your network administrator.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a proxy connection
You can use a proxy connection to gain access to the
Internet over an existing connection to your corporate
network.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → Proxy.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• Connects from: Select the type of network from
which you will connect.
• Connects to: Select the type of network to which you
will connect.Getting connected
151
• Proxy (name:port): Enter the proxy server name
and port number in the form.
• Type: Select a network type for which proxy
connection will be used.
• User name: Enter your user name for the network to
which you will connect.
• Password: Enter your password.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your service provider.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Creating a VPN connection
If your company has set up a virtual private network
(VPN), you can create a VPN connection to gain access to
your corporate network over an Internet connection.
1. On the Home screen, press the Start soft key.
2. Select Settings → More... → Connections → More...
→ VPN.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the requested information.
• Description: Enter a name for the connection.
• VPN type: Select the type of VPN.
• Server: Enter the VPN server name.
• Connects from: Select the type of network from
which you will connect to VPN (typically The
Internet).Getting connected
152
• Connects to: Select the type of network to which you
will connect (typically Work).
• User name: Enter your user name for the VPN.
• Password: Enter your password.
• Domain: Enter the domain name, if required.
• IPSec authentication: If you selected IPSec/L2TP
for VPN type, select the type of authentication.
• IPSec Pre-shared key: If you selected Pre-Shared
Key for IPSec authentication, enter the shared key.
Note: If you are not sure about the information to enter, ask
your network administrator.
5. When you have finished, press the Done soft key.
Setting up data connections
After creating connection profiles, you can assign a profile
to each network type.
1. On the Connections screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Advanced.
2. Select a connection profile in each network.
3. Press the Done soft key.Getting connected
153
Adding a URL exception
Some URLs for Web pages on your company intranet may
use periods, for example: intranet.companyname.com. To
view these pages in Internet Explorer, you must create a
URL exception.
Note: You do not need to create URL exceptions for Internet
URLs.
1. On the Connections screen, press the Menu soft key
and select Advanced.
2. Press the Menu soft key and select Work URL
Exceptions.
3. Press the Menu soft key and select Add.
4. Enter the URL and press the Done soft key. Separate
multiple URLs with a semicolon.
Changing the data connection options
On the Advanced screen, press the Menu soft key and
select Options to access the following options:
• Redial attempts: Select the redial attempt to connect
the Internet or your network after an unsuccessful
connection.
• Idle disconnect after: Select the length of time your
phone waits for connecting to the Internet or your
network after the specified period, your phone will
disconnect from the Internet or your network.
• My desktop connects to: Select the type of network to
which your desktop computer will connect.10
154
Troubleshooting
General problems
Problem Description & Solution
“Invalid or
missing SIM card.
You can still make
emergency calls if
your service
provider supports
it” displays
Check that the SIM card has been
correctly installed.
“No network
coverage,” “Error
unable to connect.
No network
coverage.” or
“Message sending
failed” displays
• The network connection has been lost.
You may be in a weak signal area (in a
tunnel or surrounded by buildings).
Move and try again.
• You are trying to access an option for
which you have not taken out a
subscription with your service provider.
Contact the service provider for further
details.
The bars next to
disappear
• If you have just turned on your phone,
wait about 2 minutes, until your phone
finds the network and receives a signal
from the network.
• If you are in a tunnel or in an elevator,
the phone may not be able to receive
the network signal properly. Move to
an open place.
• This may appear when you move
between different service areas. It is
normal.
The display is not
clear
In direct sunlight, you may not see the
display clearly. Moving to a place with
different lighting should solve this
problem.Troubleshooting
155
White lines
appear on the
display
This may happen if you turn on the
phone after a long period of disuse, or
after removing the battery without
turning off the phone. This is not related
to the phone’s life or performance. The
display should correct itself shortly.
“PIN code”
appears
• You are using your phone for the first
time. You must enter the Personal
Identification Number (PIN) supplied
with the SIM card.
• The PIN check feature has been
enabled. Each time the phone is
switched on, the PIN has to be
entered. To disable this feature, press
the Start soft key and select Settings
→ More... → Security → Disable SIM
PIN, and enter the PIN.
“PUK Required”
appears
The PIN code was entered incorrectly
three times in succession and the SIM
card is now blocked. Enter the PUK
supplied by your service provider.
I forgot the lock,
PIN, initialisation,
or PUK codes
If you forget or lose the lock code,
contact your phone dealer. If you forget
or lose a PIN or PUK code, or if you have
not received such a code, contact your
network provider. For information about
passwords, contact your access point
provider, for example, a commercial
Internet Service Provider (ISP), service
provider, or network operator.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
156
Call problems
Problem Description & Solution
I have entered a
number but it was
not dialled
• Be sure that you have pressed
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
network is unobstructed.
• You may have set an outgoing call
barring option.
My correspondent
cannot reach me
• Be sure that your phone is switched on
( pressed for more than one second)
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
network is unobstructed.
• You may have set an incoming call
barring option.
My correspondent
cannot hear me
speaking
• Be sure that you have switched on the
microphone
• Make sure that the phone is close
enough to your mouth The microphone
is located at the bottom of the phone.
The audio quality
of the call is poor
• Adjust the voice volume by pressing
.
• Check the signal strength indicator on
the display ( ); the number of bars
indicates the signal strength, from
strong to weak.
• Try moving the phone slightly or
moving closer to a window if you are in
a building.Troubleshooting
157
Power and charging problems
Calls to and from
the phone are not
connected
properly, and are
easily
disconnected
• Signals from the network are weak.
Move to another area.
• Touching the antenna area on the top
of the phone may lower the call quality.
Be careful not to touch the antenna
area while using the phone.
Problem Description & Solution
While charging,
the LED on the
travel charger
blinks
• Disconnect the phone from the travel
charger, remove the battery, and then
replace it. Try charging again.
• If the problem persists, clean the
metal contacts on the battery and the
phone.
• If the actions above do not clear the
problem, contact a Samsung service
representative.
The phone
malfunctions or
does not function
Remove the battery and then replace it.
Turn on the phone. Or press the hole on
the bottom of the phone to perform a
soft reset. If the problem persists,
contact a Samsung service
representative.
The LED on the
travel charger
turns to yellow
The travel charger is overheated.
Disconnect the charger from the phone
or unplug it from the power outlet. Wait
until the charger cools down and then
recharge the phone.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
158
The battery’s
standby time is
shorter than
expected
• Batteries are subject to wear and tear.
Standby time may grow shorter as
time passes.
• Leaving the fully charged battery in a
cold or hot place for a long period of
time may reduce battery life.
• Standby time depends on where you
use the phone. The actual time may
differ from the battery’s specifications.
Is it OK if I leave
the phone
connected to the
power outlet after
it is fully charged
(indicated by the
green LED on the
charger is on)
We recommend that you disconnect the
phone from the charger or unplug the
charger from the power outlet.
The phone
becomes hot
This may happen when you are on the
phone or when you use programs, such
as games, the Internet, or the camera,
because the phone needs more power at
those times. This does not affect the
phone’s life and performance.
The battery level
seem sufficient,
but the phone
does not turn on
• Remove the battery from the phone
and reinstall it. Then turn on the
phone.
• Clean the metal contacts both on the
battery and on the phone. Reinstall the
battery and turn on the phone.
The phone turns
off when the
charger is
connected
Some dust on the contacts may cause
unexpected power-off or charging
problems. Clean the metal contacts both
on the battery and on the phone.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
159
Application problems
Problem Description & Solution
“Not enough
memory to
perform
operation. Delete
some data first.”
or “Memory low.
Delete some
data.” displays
To view what kind of data you have and
how much memory the different data
groups consume, press the Start soft
key and then the More soft key, and
select Accessories and then the More
soft key , and press Task Manager.
Press the Menu soft key and select
Memory. Delete old items from
programs. If necessary, make a backup
copy of your data using ActiveSync or
the memory card.
Browser
“Unable to
connect. Verify
your Dial-up or
proxy settings are
correct, and try
again.” displays
Insert proper browser settings. Contact
your service provider for instructions.
The phone is
unable to connect
to the Internet
• Check if you have set up and are
connected to an Internet service
provider.
• Check if your wireless connection to
your mobile service provider is
switched on and the signal from the
GPRS network is not obstructed.
• Verify with your service provider that
your user name and password are
correct.
• Verify with your Internet service
provider that the network you are
trying to connect is available, or try to
connect it from another PC.Troubleshooting
160
Camera
Images seem
smudged
Check that the camera lens protection
window is clean.
Contacts
No number is
dialled when you
recall a contact
card
• Check that a number has been stored
in the contact card.
• Re-store the number, if necessary.
Infrared
Data does not
transfer via an
infrared
connection
• Line up the infrared ports of two
devices so that they are unobstructed
and within close range.
• Make sure that nothing is between the
two infrared ports.
• Adjust the room lighting. Some types
of light interfere with infrared
connections. Try moving to a different
location or turning off some lights.
Bluetooth
I cannot end a
Bluetooth
connection
If another device is connected to your
phone, you can either end the
connection using the other device or by
deactivating Bluetooth. Go to Bluetooth
and select Bluetooth → Off.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
161
I cannot find my
friend’s
Bluetoothenabled device
• Check that both have activated
Bluetooth.
• Check that the distance between the
two devices is not over 10 metres or
that there are no walls or other
obstructions between the devices.
• Check that the other device is not in
Hidden mode.
• Check that both devices are
compatible.
I cannot discover
the remote
Bluetooth stereo
headset
• Check if the Bluetooth functionality on
the phone is turned on.
• Check if the remote Bluetooth stereo
headset is in the discoverable mode.
• Check if the remote Bluetooth device
has the capability to act as a stereo
headset.
I cannot connect
to the remote
Bluetooth stereo
headset
Ensure that the correct passkey was
entered on the phone during the
connection with the headset. Most
Bluetooth headsets have a fixed passkey
that would be mentioned in their user’s
guide. You would need to enter the
passkey when establishing a connection
with the headset.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
162
I cannot listen to
music on the
remote Bluetooth
stereo headset
• Ensure that you are connected to the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Ensure that the song that you are
playing is one of the supported
formats.
• Check the battery levels on the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Ensure that the phone and headset are
within range of each other. The
maximum distance between the two
should not be more than 10 metres.
There are breaks
in the music being
played on the
remote Bluetooth
stereo headset
• You may observe breaks if there are
walls that separate the phone and the
Bluetooth stereo headset.
• Be sure that the Bluetooth
functionality on the phone is turned on
and you have set the phone to be
detected by other devices.
Call history
The call history
appears empty
You may have activated a filter, and no
communication events fitting that filter
have been logged. To see all events,
press the Start soft key and select Call
History. Press the Menu soft key and
select Filter → No Filter.
Messaging
I cannot select a
contact card when
creating a
message
If the contact card does not have a
phone number or e-mail address, you
cannot select it. Add the missing
information to the contact card in
Contacts.
Problem Description & SolutionTroubleshooting
163
If the above guidelines do not help you to solve the
problem, take note of:
• the model and serial numbers of your phone
• your warranty details
• a clear description of the problem
Then contact your local dealer or Samsung after-sales
service.
PC connectivity
Problems occur
when connecting
the phone to a PC
Make sure that ActiveSync is installed
and running on your PC. See the user’s
guide for ActiveSync on the CD-ROM.
For further information on how to use
ActiveSync, see the help function on
ActiveSync or visit www.microsoft.com.
Problem Description & Solution11
164
Regulatory notices
SAR certification information
This phone meets European Union (EU) requirements
concerning exposure to radio waves.
Your mobile phone is a radio transmitter and receiver. It is
designed and manufactured so as not to exceed the limits
for exposure to radio-frequency (RF) energy, as
recommended by the EU Council. These limits are part of
comprehensive guidelines and establish permitted levels of
RF energy for the general population. The guidelines were
developed by independent scientific organisations through
the periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies.
The limits include a substantial safety margin designed to
ensure the safety of all persons, regardless of age and
health.
The exposure standard for mobile phones employs a unit of
measurement known as SAR (Specific Absorption Rate).
The SAR limit recommended by the EU Council is 2.0W/Kg.
*
The highest SAR value for this model phone was 0.774 w/
Kg.
* The SAR limit for mobile phones used by the public is 2.0 watts/kilogram (W/
kg) averaged over ten grams of body tissue. The limit incorporates a
substantial margin of safety to give additional protection for the public and to
account for any variations in measurements. The SAR values may vary
depending on national reporting requirements and the network band.Regulatory notices
165
SAR tests are conducted using standard operating positions
with the phone transmitting at its highest certified power
level in all tested frequency bands. Although the SAR is
determined at the highest certified power level, the actual
SAR level of the phone while operating can be well below
the maximum value. This is because the phone is designed
to operate at multiple power levels so as to use only the
power required to reach the network. In general, the closer
you are to a base station, the lower the power output of the
phone.
Before a new model phone is made available for sale to the
public, compliance with the European R&TTE Directive must
be shown. This directive includes as one of its essential
requirements the protection of the health and safety of the
user and any other person.
European union notice
Products with CE marking comply with the R&TTE Directive
(99/5/EC), the EMC Directive (89/336/EEC) and the Low
Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC) issued by the Commission of
the European Community.
Compliance with these directives implies conformity to the
following European Norms (in brackets are the equivalent
international standards):
• EN 60950 (IEC 60950) - Safety of Information
Technology Equipment
• ETS 300 342-1 (June 1997) - Electromagnetic
compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM);
ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC) for European digital
cellular telecommunications system (GSM 900MHz, GSM
1800MHz, and GSM 1900MHz); Part 1: Mobile and
portable radio and ancillary equipmentRegulatory notices
166
• GSM11.10
• ANSI/IEEE C.95.1-1992- specific absorption rate in
mobile phone emission condition for body health
• FCC part 15 and part24
• prENV50166-2, 1995 for SAR
• SAR: 0.774mW/10g
Important safety information
Retain and follow all product safety and operating
instructions. Observe all warnings on the product and in
the operating instructions.
To reduce the risk of bodily injury, electric shock, fire, and/
or damage to the equipment, observe the following
precautions:
General precautions
Heed service markings: Except as explained elsewhere
in the Operating or Service documentation, do not service
any product yourself. Service needed on components inside
these compartments should be done by an authorised
service technician or provider.
Damage requiring service: Unplug the product from the
electrical outlet and refer servicing to an authorised service
technician or provider under the following conditions:
• Liquid has been spilled or an object has fallen into the
product.
• The product has been exposed to rain or water.Regulatory notices
167
• The product has been dropped or damaged.
• There are noticeable signs of overheating.
• The product does not operate normally when you follow
the operating instructions.
Avoid hot areas: The product should be placed away from
heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or
other products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
Avoid wet areas: Never use the product in a wet location.
Avoid pushing objects into product: Never push objects
of any kind into cabinet slots or other openings in the
product. Slots and openings are provided for ventilation.
These openings must not be blocked or covered.
Mounting Accessories: Do not use the product on an
unstable table, cart, stand, tripod, or bracket. Any
mounting of the product should follow the manufacturer’s
instructions, and should use a mounting accessory
recommended by the manufacturer.
Avoid unstable mounting: Do not place the product with
an unstable base.
Use product with approved equipment: This product
should be used only with personal computers and options
identified as suitable for use with your equipment.
Adjust the volume: Turn down the volume before using
headphones or other audio devices.
Cleaning: Unplug the product from the wall outlet before
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
Use a damp cloth for cleaning, but NEVER use water to
clean an LCD screen.Regulatory notices
168
Safety precautions for power supply
unit
Use the correct external power source: A product should be
operated only from the type of power source indicated on
the electrical ratings label. If you are not sure of the type of
power source required, consult your authorised service
provider or local power company. For a product that
operates from battery power or other sources, refer to the
operating instructions that are included with the product.
Handle battery packs carefully: This product contains a
Lithium Polymer battery.
There is a risk of fire and burns if the battery pack is
handled improperly. Do not attempt to open or service the
battery pack. Do not disassemble, crush, puncture, short
external contacts or circuits, dispose of in fire or water, or
expose a battery pack to temperatures of higher than 60°C
(140°F).
Note: Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with specified batteries. Dispose of used
batteries according to the local regulations or reference
guide supplied with your product.Regulatory notices
169
Care and maintenance
Your phone is a product of superior design and
craftsmanship and should be treated with care. The
suggestions below will help you fulfill any warranty
obligations and allow you to enjoy this product for many
years.
• Keep the phone and all its parts and accessories out of
the reach of small children and pets. They may
inadvertently damage these things or choke on small
parts.
• Keep the phone dry. Precipitation, humidity and liquids
contain minerals that corrode electronic circuits.
• Do not use the phone with a wet hand. Doing so may
cause an electric shock to you or damage to the phone.
• Do not use or store the phone in dusty, dirty areas, as its
moving parts may be damaged.
• Do not store the phone in hot areas. High temperatures
can shorten the life of electronic devices, damage
batteries, and warp or melt certain plastics.
• Do not store the phone in cold areas. When the phone
warms up to its normal operating temperature, moisture
can form inside the phone, which may damage the
phone’s electronic circuit boards.
• Do not drop, knock or shake the phone. Rough handling
can break internal circuit boards.
• Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents or strong
detergents to clean the phone. Wipe it with a soft cloth
slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-water solution.Regulatory notices
170
• Do not paint the phone. Paint can clog the device’s
moving parts and prevent proper operation.
• Do not put the phone in or on heating devices, such as a
microwave oven, a stove or a radiator. The phone may
explode when overheated.
• When the phone or battery gets wet, the label indicating
water damage inside the phone changes colour. In this
case, phone repairs are no longer guaranteed by the
manufacturer's warranty, even if the warranty for your
phone has not expired.
• If your phone has a flash or light, do not use it too close
to the eyes of people or animals. This may cause damage
to their eyes.
• Use only the supplied or an approved replacement
antenna. Unauthorised antennas or modified accessories
may damage the phone and violate regulations governing
radio devices.
• If the phone, battery, charger or any accessory is not
working properly, take it to your nearest qualified service
facility. The personnel there will assist you, and if
necessary, arrange for service.Regulatory notices
171
Microsoft End User License
Agreement
• You have acquired a device (“DEVICE”) that includes
software licensed by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. from
an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation (“MS”), for use in
connection with wireless network services provided under
separate agreement between you and a wireless
telecommunications provider (“Mobile Operator”). Those
installed software products of MS origin, as well as
associated media, printed materials, and “online” or
electronic documentation (“SOFTWARE”) are protected
by international intellectual property laws and treaties.
The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved.
• IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE
AGREEMENT (“EULA”), DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR
COPY THE SOFTWARE. INSTEAD, PROMPTLY CONTACT
SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO., LTD. FOR INSTRUCTIONS
ON RETURN OF THE UNUSED DEVICE(S) FOR A REFUND.
ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO USE ON THE DEVICE, WILL
CONSTITUTE YOUR AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA (OR
RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CONSENT).
• SOFTWARE includes software already installed on the
DEVICE (“DEVICE Software”) and MS software
contained on the CD-ROM disk (“Companion CD”).Regulatory notices
172
GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE
This EULA grants you the following license:
DEVICE Software. You may use the DEVICE Software as
installed on the DEVICE. All or certain portions of the
DEVICE Software may be inoperable if you do not have and
maintain a service account with an appropriate Mobile
Operator, or if the Mobile Operator's network facilities are
not operating or configured to operate with the DEVICE
software.
COMPANION CD. Additional software for your personal
computer is included with your DEVICE, and you may
install and use the Microsoft® ActiveSync® component on
one (1) or more computers to exchange information with
one (1) or more computing devices that contain a
compatible version of the Microsoft® phone 2003
Software. For other software component(s) contained in
the Companion CD, you may install and use such
components only in accordance with the terms of the
printed or online end user license agreement(s) provided
with such component(s). In the absence of an end user
license agreement for particular component(s) of the
Companion CD, you may install and use only one (1) copy
of such component(s) on the DEVICE or a single computer
with which you use the DEVICE.
Microsoft® Outlook® 2002. If Microsoft Outlook 2002 is
included with your Device, the following terms apply to
your use of Microsoft Outlook 2002: (i) regardless of the
information contained in “Software Installation and Use”
section of the online EULA you may install one (1) copy of
Microsoft Outlook 2002 on one (1) computer to use,
exchange data, share data, access and interact with the
DEVICE, and (ii) the EULA for Microsoft Outlook 2002 is
between the Company and the end user - not between the
PC manufacturer and end user.Regulatory notices
173
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS
AND LIMITATIONS
• Speech/Handwriting Recognition. If the SOFTWARE
includes speech and/or handwriting recognition
component(s), you should understand that speech and
handwriting recognition are inherently statistical
processes; that recognition errors are inherent in the
processes; and that errors can occur in the component's
recognition of your handwriting, and the final conversion
into text. Neither Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. nor its
suppliers shall be liable for any damages arising out of
errors in the speech and handwriting recognition
processes.
• Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation
and Disassembly. You may not reverse engineer,
decompile, or disassemble the SOFTWARE, except and
only to the extent that such activity is expressly
permitted by applicable law notwithstanding this
limitation.
• Single DEVICE. The DEVICE Software is licensed with
the DEVICE as a single integrated product. The DEVICE
Software installed in read only memory (“ROM”) of the
DEVICE may only be used as part of the DEVICE.
• Single EULA. The package for the DEVICE may contain
multiple versions of this EULA, such as multiple
translations and/or multiple media versions (e.g., in the
user documentation and in the software). Even if you
receive multiple versions of the EULA, you are licensed to
use only one (1) copy of the DEVICE Software. Regulatory notices
174
• NOTICE REGARDING THE MPEG-4 VISUAL
STANDARD. The SOFTWARE may include MPEG-4 visual
decoding technology. MPEG LA, L.L.C. requires the
following notice:
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE IN ANY MANNER THAT
COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG 4 VISUAL STANDARD IS
PROHIBITED, EXCEPT FOR USE DIRECTLY RELATED TO
(A) DATA OR INFORMATION (i) GENERATED BY AND
OBTAINED WITHOUT CHARGE FROM A CONSUMER NOT
THEREBY ENGAGED IN A BUSINESS ENTERPRISE, AND
(ii) FOR PERSONAL USE ONLY; AND (B) OTHER USES
SPECIFICALLY AND SEPARATELY LICENSED BY MPEG LA,
L.L.C.
If you have questions regarding this Notice, please
contact MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250 Steele Street, Suite 300,
Denver, Colorado 80206; Telephone 303 331.1880; FAX
303 331.1879
• Rental. You may not rent or lease the SOFTWARE.
• Software Transfer. You may not permanently transfer
any of your rights under this EULA with regard to the
DEVICE Software or Companion CD, except as permitted
by the applicable Mobile Operator. In the event that the
Mobile Operator permits such transfer, you may
permanently transfer all of your rights under this EULA
only as part of a sale or transfer of the DEVICE, provided
you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE
(including all component parts, the media and printed
materials, any upgrades, this EULA and, if applicable, the
Certificate(s) of Authenticity), and the recipient agrees to
the terms of this EULA. If the SOFTWARE is an upgrade,
any transfer must include all prior versions of the
SOFTWARE.Regulatory notices
175
• Termination. Without prejudice to any other rights,
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. or MS may terminate this
EULA if you fail to comply with the terms and conditions
of this EULA. In such event, you must destroy all copies
of the SOFTWARE and all of its component parts.
• Security Updates. The SOFTWARE may include digital
rights management technology. If SOFTWARE does
contain digital rights management technology, content
providers are using the digital rights management
technology (“Microsoft DRM”) contained in the
SOFTWARE to protect the integrity of their content
(“Secure Content”) so that their intellectual property,
including copyright, in such content is not
misappropriated. Owners of such Secure Content
(“Secure Content Owners”) may, from time to time,
request MS, Microsoft Corporation or their subsidiaries to
provide security related updates to the Microsoft DRM
components of the SOFTWARE (“Security Updates”) that
may affect your ability to copy, display and/or play
Secure Content through Microsoft software or third party
applications that utilize Microsoft DRM. You therefore
agree that, if you elect to download a license from the
Internet which enables your use of Secure Content, MS,
Microsoft Corporation or their subsidiaries may, in
conjunction with such license, also download onto your
DEVICE such Security Updates that a Secure Content
Owner has requested that MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their subsidiaries distribute. MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their subsidiaries will not retrieve any personally
identifiable information, or any other information, from
your DEVICE by downloading such Security Updates. Regulatory notices
176
• Consent to Use of Data. You agree that MS, Microsoft
Corporation and their affiliates may collect and use
technical information gathered in any manner as part of
product support services related to the SOFTWARE. MS,
Microsoft Corporation and their affiliates may use this
information solely to improve their products or to provide
customized services or technologies to you. MS, Microsoft
Corporation and their affiliates may disclose this
information to others, but not in a form that personally
identifies you.
• Internet Gaming/Update Features. If the SOFTWARE
provides, and you choose to utilize, the Internet gaming
or update features within the SOFTWARE, it is necessary
to use certain computer system, hardware, and software
information to implement the features. By using these
features, you explicitly authorize MS, Microsoft
Corporation and/or their designated agent to use this
information solely to improve their products or to provide
customized services or technologies to you. MS or
Microsoft Corporation may disclose this information to
others, but not in a form that personally identifies you.
• Internet-Based Services Components. The
SOFTWARE may contain components that enable and
facilitate the use of certain Internet-based services. You
acknowledge and agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their affiliates may automatically check the version of the
SOFTWARE and/or its components that you are utilizing
and may provide upgrades or supplements to the
SOFTWARE that may be automatically downloaded to
your Device.Regulatory notices
177
• Links to Third Party Sites. The SOFTWARE may
provide you with the ability to link to third party sites
through the use of the SOFTWARE. The third party sites
are not under the control of MS, Microsoft Corporation or
their affiliates. Neither MS nor Microsoft Corporation nor
their affiliates are responsible for (i) the contents of any
third party sites, any links contained in third party sites,
or any changes or updates to third party sites, or (ii)
webcasting or any other form of transmission received
from any third party sites. If the SOFTWARE provides
links to third party sites, those links are provided to you
only as a convenience, and the inclusion of any link does
not imply an endorsement of the third party site by MS,
Microsoft Corporation or their affiliates.
• Additional Software/Services. The SOFTWARE may
permit Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd., MS, Microsoft
Corporation or their affiliates to provide or make
available to you SOFTWARE updates, supplements, addon components, or Internet-based services components
of the SOFTWARE after the date you obtain your initial
copy of the SOFTWARE (“Supplemental Components”).
• If Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. provides or makes
available to you Supplemental Components and no other
EULA terms are provided along with the Supplemental
Components, then the terms of this EULA shall apply.
• If MS, Microsoft Corporation or their affiliates make
available Supplemental Components, and no other EULA
terms are provided, then the terms of this EULA shall
apply, except that the MS, Microsoft Corporation or
affiliate entity providing the Supplemental Component(s)
shall be the licensor of the Supplemental Component(s). Regulatory notices
178
• Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd., MS, Microsoft Corporation
and their affiliates reserve the right to discontinue any
Internet-based services provided to you or made
available to you through the use of the SOFTWARE.
UPGRADES AND RECOVERY MEDIA
• DEVICE Software. If the DEVICE Software is provided
by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. separate from the
DEVICE on media such as a ROM chip, CD ROM disk(s) or
via web download or other means, and is labeled “For
Upgrade Purposes Only”, you may install one copy of
such DEVICE Software onto the DEVICE as a replacement
copy for the existing DEVICE Software and use it in
accordance with this EULA, including any additional EULA
terms accompanying the upgrade DEVICE Software.
• COMPANION CD. If any Companion CD component(s) is
provided by Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. separate from
the DEVICE on CD ROM disk(s) or via web download or
other means, and labeled “For Upgrade Purposes Only”,
you may (i) install and use one copy of such
component(s) on the computer(s) you use to exchange
data with the DEVICE as a replacement copy for the
existing Companion CD component(s). Regulatory notices
179
COPYRIGHT
All title and intellectual property rights in and to the
SOFTWARE (including but not limited to any images,
photographs, animations, video, audio, music, text and
“applets,” incorporated into the SOFTWARE), the
accompanying printed materials, and any copies of the
SOFTWARE, are owned by MS or its suppliers (including
Microsoft Corporation). You may not copy the printed
materials accompanying the SOFTWARE. All title and
intellectual property rights in and to the content which may
be accessed through use of the SOFTWARE is the property
of the respective content owner and may be protected by
applicable copyright or other intellectual property laws and
treaties. This EULA grants you no rights to use such
content. All rights not specifically granted under this EULA
are reserved by MS and its suppliers (including Microsoft
Corporation).
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS
You acknowledge that SOFTWARE is subject to U.S. export
jurisdiction. You agree to comply with all applicable
international and national laws that apply to the
SOFTWARE, including the U.S. Export Administration
Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use and destination
restrictions issued by U.S. and other governments. For
additional information, see http://www.microsoft.com/
exporting/.Regulatory notices
180
PRODUCT SUPPORT
Product support for the SOFTWARE is not provided by MS,
its parent corporation, Microsoft Corporation, or their
affiliates or subsidiaries. For product support, please refer
to Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. support number provided
in the documentation for the DEVICE. Should you have any
questions concerning this EULA, or if you desire to contact
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. for any other reason, please
refer to the address provided in the documentation for the
DEVICE.
NO LIABILITY FOR CERTAIN DAMAGES
EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY LAW, MS SHALL HAVE NO
LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL
OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING FROM OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THE
SOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATION SHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANY
REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
FOR APPLICABLE LIMITED WARRANTIES AND SPECIAL
PROVISIONS PERTAINING TO YOUR PARTICULAR
JURISDICTION, PLEASE REFER TO YOUR WARRANTY
BOOKLET INCLUDED WITH THIS PACKAGE OR PROVIDED
WITH THE SOFTWARE PRINTED MATERIALS.Declaration of Conformity (R&TTE)
For the following product:
GSM900/GSM1800/GSM1900 with Bluetooth
Portable Cellular Telephone
(Product description)
SGH-i320
(Model name)
Manufactured at:
- Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd, 94-1 Imsoo-Dong, Gumi City, Kyung Buk, Korea 730-350*
(factory name, address)
to which this declaration relates, is in conformity with the following standards and/or other normative
documents.
Safety : EN 60950-1:2001
EMC : EN 301 489-01 v1.4.1 (08-2002)
EN 301 489-07 v1.2.1 (08-2002)
SAR : EN 50360:2001
EN 50361:2001
Network : EN 301 511 v9.0.2 (03-2003)
EN 300 328 v1.6.1 (11-2004)
We hereby declare that [all essential radio test suites have been carried out and that] the above named
product is in conformity to all the essential requirements of Directive 1999/5/EC.
The conformity assessment procedure referred to in Article 10 and detailed in Annex[IV] of Directive 1999/5/
EC has been followed with the involvement of the following Notified Body(ies):
BABT, Balfour House, Churchfield Road,
Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK
Identification mark: 168
The technical documentation kept at:
Samsung Electronics QA Lab.
which will be made available upon request.
(Representative in the EU)
Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab.
Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way,
Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK
2006. 04. 28 Yong-Sang Park / S. Manager
(place and date of issue) (name and signature of authorised person)
* It is not the address of the Samsung Service Centre. For the address or the phone number of Samsung Service Centre, see the
warranty card or contact the retailer where you purchased your phone.World wide Web
http://www.samsungmobile.com English. 02/2006. Rev. 1.0
* Depending on the software installed or your service provider or country,
some of the descriptions in this guide may not match your phone exactly.
基本
用户指南
SCX-340x/340xW Series
SCX-340xF/340xFW Series
SCX-340xFH/340xHW Series
基本
用户指南
本指南提供 Windows 上的安装、基本操作和故障排除相关信息。
高级
本指南介绍不同操作系统环境中的安装、高级配置、操作和故障排除相关信息。
根据机型或国家/地区的不同,可能不提供某些功能。2
基本
1. 简介
主要优点 5
不同型号的功能 7
实用须知 13
关于本用户指南 14
安全信息 15
机器概览 20
控制面板概览 24
开机 29
本地安装驱动程序 30
重新安装驱动程序 31
2. 菜单概述和基本设置
菜单概述 33
机器的基本设置 38
介质与纸盘 40
基本打印 52
基本复印 57
基本扫描 61
基本传真 62
3. 维护
订购耗材和配件 67
可用耗材 68
可用维护零件 69
存放墨粉盒 70
摇匀墨粉 71
更换墨粉盒 73
监控耗材寿命 75
设置墨粉不足警报 76
清洁机器 77
机器搬运与存放方法提示 83
4. 故障排除
避免卡纸的提示 85
清除原件卡纸 86
清除卡纸 91
了解状态 LED 95
了解显示屏消息 973
基本
5. 附录
规格 103
法规信息 113
版权所有 1251. 简介
本章提供在使用本机之前需要了解的信息。
• 主要优点 5
• 不同型号的功能 7
• 实用须知 13
• 关于本用户指南 14
• 安全信息 15
• 机器概览 20
• 控制面板概览 24
• 开机 29
• 本地安装驱动程序 30
• 重新安装驱动程序 31主要优点
环保
• 为节省墨粉和纸张,本机支持环保功能(请参见第 54 页上的“环保打
印”)。
• 为节省纸张,可以在一张纸上打印多页(请参见第 218 页上的“使用高
级打印功能”)。
• 为节省纸张,您可以在纸张的两面进行打印(双面打印,手动)(请参
见第 218 页上的“使用高级打印功能”)。
• 为了省电,在不使用时,本机可以大幅降低耗电量,自动节能。
快速高分辨率打印
• 您能够以最高为 1,200 x 1,200 dpi 的有效输出分辨率进行打印。
• 快速、随需打印。
- 对于单面打印,20 ppm (A4) 或 21 ppm (Letter)。
便捷性
• Easy Capture Manager 允许您使用键盘上的打印屏幕键轻松编辑和打
印捕获的任何内容(请参见第 254 页上的“Easy Capture Manager”)。
• Samsung Easy Printer Manager和打印状态(或Smart Panel)是一些
程序,它们监视并通知您机器状态,允许您自定义机器设置(请参见第
263 页上的“使用 Samsung 打印机状态” 或 第 265 页上的“使用Smart
Panel”)。
• 与使用普通程序相比,AnyWeb Print 可帮助您更轻松地捕捉、预览、
处理和打印 Windows Internet Explorer 的屏幕(请参见第 255 页上的
“Samsung AnyWeb Print”)。
• 智能更新允许您在打印机驱动程序安装过程中检查最新软件并安装最
新版本。此功能仅适用于 Windows。
• 如果您能访问 Internet,就可以通过 Samsung 网站
www.samsung.com > 查找产品 > 支持或下载获得帮助、支持应用程
序、机器驱动程序、手册和订购信息。主要优点
各种功能和应用程序支持
• 支持各种纸张大小(请参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。
• 打印水印:您可以用文字(如“机密”)来自定义文档(请参见第 218 页
上的“使用高级打印功能”)。
• 打印海报:文档每页的文本和图片都可以放大,并且可以跨多张纸打
印,然后可将其拼成一张海报(请参见第 218 页上的“使用高级打印功
能”)。
• 可以在各种操作系统中打印(请参见第 109 页上的“系统要求”)。
• 您的机器配有一个 USB 接口和/或一个网络接口。
支持各种无线网络设置方法
• 使用 WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup™) 按钮
- 您可以使用机器上的 WPS 按钮和接入点(无线路由器)轻松连接
到无线网络。
• 使用 USB 电缆或网络电缆
- 您可以使用 USB 电缆或网络电缆连接并配置各种无线网络设置。
• 使用无线直连
- 借助无线或无线直连功能,您可以从移动设备轻松实现打印。
请参见第 152 页上的“介绍无线网络设置方法”。不同型号的功能
视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用。
操作系统
(●:包含,空白:不提供)
软件
操作系统
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series
Windows ● ●
Macintosh ● ●
Linux ● ●
Unix
软件
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series
SPL 打印机驱动程序 ● ●
PCL 打印机驱动程序不同型号的功能
PS 打印机驱动程序
XPS 打印机驱动程序a ● ●
直接打印实用程序
Samsung Easy Printer
Manager
扫描至 PC 设置 ● ●
传真至 PC 设置 ●
设备设置 ● ●
Samsung 打印机状态 ● ●
Smart Panel ● ●
AnyWeb Print ● ●
SyncThru™ Web Service ●
(仅限 SCX-340xW Series)
●
(仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW
Series)
SyncThru Admin Web Service ●
(仅限 SCX-340xW Series)
●
(仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW
Series)
Easy Eco Driver ● ●
软件
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series不同型号的功能
(●:包含,空白:不提供)
传真 Samsung Network PC Fax ●
扫描 Twain 扫描驱动程序 ● ●
WIA 扫描驱动程序 ● ●
Samsung 扫描助手 ● ●
SmarThru 4
SmarThru Office ● ●
a. 对于 XPS 驱动程序,只通过 Samsung 网站 (www.samsung.com) 支持 Windows。
软件
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series不同型号的功能
多种功能
功能
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series
高速 USB 2.0 ● ●
网络接口以太网 10/100 Base TX 有线 LAN ●
(仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX340xHW Series)
网络接口 802.11b/g/n 无线局域网a ●
(仅限 SCX-340xW Series)
●
(仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX340xHW Series)
环保打印(控制面板) ● ●
双面打印(手动)b ● ●
USB 内存接口
内存模块
大容量存储设备 (HDD)
双面自动进稿器 (DADF)
自动进稿器(ADF) ●
话筒 ●
(仅限 SCX-340xFH/SCX-340xHW Series)不同型号的功能
传真 多方发送 ●
延迟发送 ●
优先发送 ●
双面发送
安全接收 ●
双面打印
发送/接收转发-传真 ●
发送/接收转发-电子邮件
发送/接收转发-服务器
扫描 扫描至电子邮件
扫描到 SMB 服务器
扫描 FTP 服务器
双面扫描
扫描至 PC ● ●
功能
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series不同型号的功能
(●:包含,空白:不提供)
复印 身份证件复印 ● ●
缩小或放大的复印 ●
分页 ●
海报 ●
克隆 ●
书本
2 页/4 页缩印 ●
调整背景 ● ●
页边距移位
除边
灰度增强
双面复印
a. 根据您所在国家或地区的不同,可能会购买不到无线局域网卡。对于某些国家/地区,只有 802.11 b/g 适用。请与向您出售机器的本地 Samsung 经销商或零售商联系。
b. 仅限 Windows。
功能
SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xHW Series
SCX-340xFH Series实用须知
机器不能打印
• 打开打印队列列表,从中除去文档(请参见第 53 页上的“
取消打印作业”)。
• 卸载驱动程序并重新安装它(请参见第 30 页上的“本地安
装驱动程序”)。
• 在 Windows 中将您的机器选作默认打印机(请参见第 217
页上的“将机器设置为默认机器”)。
哪里可以买到附件或耗材?
• 请咨询 Samsung 经销商或零售商。
• 请访问 www.samsung.com/supplies。选择您的国家/地
区,以查看产品服务信息。
状态 LED 指示灯闪烁或常亮。
• 关闭产品电源,然后重新打开。
• 检查本手册中的 LED 指示含义并进行相应的故障排除
(请参见第 95 页上的“了解状态 LED”)。
发生卡纸现象。
• 打开和关闭扫描装置(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 检查本手册中的清除卡纸说明并进行相应的故障排除(请
参见第 91 页上的“清除卡纸”)。
打印输出模糊不清。
• 墨粉存量可能不足或不均匀。摇动墨粉盒(请参见第 71 页
上的“摇匀墨粉”)。
• 尝试其他打印分辨率设置(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印
首选项”)。
• 更换墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
哪里可以下载机器驱动程序?
• 您可以通过 Samsung 网站 www.samsung.com > 查找产品
> 支持或下载获得帮助、支持应用程序、机器驱动程序、手
册和订购信息。1. 简介 14
关于本用户指南
本用户指南提供信息帮助您基本了解本机,并详细介绍了使用过程中的每
一步操作。
• 请在使用机器之前阅读安全信息。
• 如果您在使用本机时遇到问题,请参阅“故障排除"一章。
• 本用户指南中所使用的术语在“术语表”一章中进行解释。
• 根据所购机器的选件或型号,本用户指南中的所有图示可能与您的机
器不同。
• 根据机器的固件/驱动程序版本,本管理员指南中的屏幕截图可能与您
的机器不同。
• 本用户指南中的步骤主要基于 Windows7。
1
约定
本指南中的某些术语可交替使用,如下所示:
• 文档与原件同义。
• 纸张与介质或打印介质同义。
• 机器指打印机或 MFP。
2
常见图标
图标 文字 描述
注意
为用户提供信息,以免机器出现机械损坏或故障。
备注
提供有关机器功能与特性的附加信息或详细规
格。1. 简介 15
安全信息
附带提供这些警告和警示的目的是为了防止伤及您和他人,并防止对您的
机器造成任何可能的损坏。在使用机器前,请务必阅读并理解所有这些说
明。阅读完本部分后,请将其保存于安全之处,以便日后参考。
3
重要的安全符号
本章使用的所有图标和符号的解释
4
操作环境
警告
警告
可能导致严重人身伤害或死亡的危险情况或危险操
作。
注意
可能导致轻微人身伤害或财产损失的危险情况或危
险操作。
请勿尝试。
如果电源线已损坏或者电源插座未接地,请勿使用。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
请勿将任何物体放置于机器顶部(水、小块金属或重物、蜡烛、
点燃的香烟等)。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
• 如果机器过热,则其会冒烟,发出异响或有异味生成,此时
应立即关闭电源开关并拔下机器的电流插头。
• 如果出现需要用户拔出插头的情况,用户应当能操作电源
插座。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
请勿弯曲电源线或将重物放置于电源线上。
踩踏电源线或者使电源线受重物挤压可能导致触电或者火灾。
请勿拉拽电线以拔下插头;请勿用湿手接触插头。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。安全信息
1. 简介 16
注意
5
操作方法
注意
雷暴期间或者长时间不使用时,请从电源插座中拔下插头。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
小心,出纸区很热。
可能导致烫伤。
如果机器掉落,或者机壳损坏,请从所有接口连接上拔下线
缆,然后向胜任的服务人员请求协助。
否则,可能导致触电或者火灾。
如果在遵循这些说明的情况下机器仍不能正常运行,请拔下
机器的所有接口连接线缆,然后向胜任的服务人员请求协
助。
否则,可能导致触电或者火灾。
如果插头不能轻松地插入电源插座,请勿尝试强行插入。
请联系电工以更换电源插座,否则,可能导致触电。
请勿让宠物撕咬交流电源线、电话线或 PC 接口连接线。
这样可能导致触电或引发火灾,并/或伤害您的宠物。
请勿在打印过程中强行将纸拉出。
可能会对打印机造成损坏。
小心,请勿将手放在机器和托纸盘之间。
可能会导致您受伤。
换纸或移除卡住的纸时,请小心操作。
新纸的边缘比较锋利,可能导致割伤。
大量打印时,出纸区的底部可能变热。请勿让儿童触摸。
可能导致烫伤。
移除卡住的纸时,请勿使用镊子或锋利的金属物体。
否则可能损坏机器。
请勿让过多纸张堆积在出纸盘。
否则可能损坏机器。安全信息
1. 简介 17
6
安装/移动
警告
请勿堵塞或将物体推入通风口。 注意
这样可能导致部件温度升高,从而造成损坏或者火灾。
使用此处规定之外的控制、调整或执行步骤可能会造成危险的
辐射情况。
本机器的电源获取设备是电源线。
要关闭电源,请从电源插座上拔下电源线。
请勿将机器放在有灰尘,潮湿或漏水的环境中。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
移动机器前,请关闭电源并拔下所有线缆。以下信息只是基
于单位重量的建议值。如果您的身体状况不适合抬起物体,
请不要抬起机器。请寻求帮助,并且为了安全抬起机器,请始
终确保使用相应数量的搬运人员。
然后抬起机器:
• 重量小于 20 千克的机器需要 1 个人抬。
• 重量在 20 - 40 千克之间的机器需要 2 个人抬。
• 重量大于 40 千克的机器至少需要 4 个人抬。
机器可能掉落,从而导致人员受伤或机器损坏。
请勿将机器放置于不稳定的台面上。
机器可能掉落,从而导致人员受伤或机器损坏。
仅使用 No.26 AWG
a 或者线规更大的电话线(如有必要)。
否则,可能会对打印机造成损坏。
确保将电源线插到接地的电源插座。
否则,可能导致触电或者火灾。
使用机器附带的电源线可实现安全运行。如果 110V 机器使用
的电线长于 2 米,则线规应为 16 AWG 或更大。
否则,将损坏机器,并且可能导致触电或者火灾。
请勿在机器上放置盖板或者将其放在密闭场所,如柜子。
如果机器通风不畅,则可能导致火灾。安全信息
1. 简介 18
7
维护/检查
注意
8
耗材使用
注意
请勿使壁式插座和加长电线超负荷。
这样可能减损性能,并导致触电或者火灾。
机器应连接至标签上规定的功率级。
如果您不确定并希望检查正在使用的功率级,请联系电力公
司。
a. AWG:American Wire Gauge(美国线规)
清洁机器内部前,请从壁式插座中拔下插头。请勿使用苯、
涂料稀释剂或酒精来清洁机器;请勿直接向机器洒水。
这样可能会导致触电或者火灾。
人员在机器内部更换耗材或清洁内部时,请勿操作机器。
您可能会受伤。
保持耗材清洁,勿让儿童接触。
儿童可能会受伤。
请勿自行拆卸,维修或重新组装机器。
否则可能损坏机器。机器需要维修时,请联系持证技术人
员。
要清洁并操作机器,请严格遵循机器附带的用户指南。
否则可能损坏机器。
请勿让电源电缆和插头接触面有灰尘或水。
否则,可能导致触电或者火灾。
• 请勿取下用螺丝固定的任何盖板或防护装置。
• 定影器装置只能由经过认证的技术服务人员维修。未经
认证的技术人员进行维修可能导致火灾或电击。
• 机器应仅由 Samsung 的技术服务人员维修。
请勿拆卸墨粉盒。
墨粉粉尘如被吸入或吞下,可能带来危险。安全信息
1. 简介 19
请勿点燃墨粉盒或定影器装置等任何耗材。
这样可能导致爆炸或火灾。
存放墨粉盒等耗材时,请勿让儿童接触。
墨粉粉尘如被吸入或吞下,可能带来危险。
使用墨粉等回收的耗材可能会对打印机造成损坏。
如果因使用回收耗材而导致损坏,则将收取服务费。
如果墨粉撒到衣服上,请勿使用热水清洗。
热水会使墨粉渗入到衣服纤维中。请使用冷水洗涤。
更改墨粉盒或移除卡住的纸时,应小心以避免墨粉粉尘接触
您的身体或衣服。
墨粉粉尘如被吸入或吞下,可能带来危险。1. 简介 20
机器概览
9
附件
电源线 快速安装指南
软件 CD
a
a. 软件 CD 包含打印驱动程序、用户指南和软件应用程序。
话筒b
b. 仅限话筒机型(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
其他附件c
c. 机器随附的其他附件可能因购买所在国家/地区及具体机型不同而异。机器概览
1. 简介 21
10
正视图
• 根据机器的型号,此图可能与您的机器不同。有不同类型的机器。
• 视型号或者国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参
见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
类型 A
1 扫描仪盖 7 出纸盘
7
6
1
2
5
4
8
9
10
11
3
2 控制面板 8 扫描仪玻璃板
3 手柄 9 扫描装置a b
4 纸盘 10 内盖
5 纸盒手柄 11 墨粉盒
6 输出支架
a. 打开扫描装置前,请合上扫描仪盖。
b. 小心不要夹到手指。机器概览
1. 简介 22
类型 B
3
10
9
1 2
5
8
7
6
4
12
13 14
11
15
16
17
18
19
1 进稿器盖 11 扫描仪盖
2 进稿器导板盖 12 扫描仪玻璃板
3 进纸器出纸盘 13 进稿器上的纸张宽度导板
4 进稿器输出支架 14 进稿器输入支架
5 控制面板 15 进纸器输入纸盘
6 手柄 16 话筒a
a. 仅限话筒机型(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
7 送纸器 17 扫描装置b c
b. 打开扫描装置前,请合上扫描仪盖。
c. 小心不要夹到手指。
8 纸盒手柄 18 内盖
9 输出支架 19 墨粉盒
10 出纸盘机器概览
1. 简介 23
11
后视图
• 根据机器的型号,此图可能与您的机器不同。有不同类型的机器。
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
类型 A
类型 B
1 USB 端口 2 电源插口
1
2
1 USB 端口
2 网络端口a
a. 仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW Series。
3 电话分机插槽 (EXT.)
4 电话线插槽 (LINE)
5 电源插口
1
3
4
2
51. 简介 24
控制面板概览
• 根据机器的型号,此控制面板可能与本机不同。控制面板有许多类
型。
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
12
类型 A
12
13
1
环保
进入环保模式以降低 PC 打印时的墨粉和纸张使
用量(请参见第 54 页上的“环保打印”)。
2
WPS
a
无需计算机即可轻松配置无线网络连接(请参见第
154 页上的“使用 WPS 按钮”)。
打印屏幕
按下此按钮,状态 LED 将开始闪烁。如果只要打印
活动屏幕,请在 状态 LED 停止闪烁时放开此按
钮。如果要打印整个屏幕,请在它闪烁时放开此按
钮。
• 打印屏幕只能在 Windows 和 Macintosh
操作系统中使用。
• 只能在通过 USB 连接的机器上使用此功
能。
• 当使用“打印”按钮打印活动中的窗口/全
显示器屏幕时,打印机可能会耗用更多
的碳粉,其取决于要打印的内容。
• 仅当已安装机器的 Samsung Easy
Printer Manager 程序时才能使用此功
能。如果使用 Macintosh 操作系统,您需
要通过 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
启用打印屏幕设置才能使用打印屏幕功
能。
3
扫描到
发送已扫描的数据(请参见第 61 页上的“基本扫描
”)。控制面板概览
1. 简介 25
4
ID 复印
允许您将身份证件(如驾驶执照)的两面复印到纸
张的单面(请参见第 59 页上的“身份证件复印”)。
5
电源
打开或关闭电源,或从节能模式中唤醒机器。如果
需要关闭机器,请按住此按钮超过 3 秒钟。
6
正面 LED
LED 灯亮起时,将身份证的正面向下放在扫描仪
的玻璃板上(请参见第 59 页上的“身份证件复印
”)。
7
反面 LED
LED 灯亮起时,将身份证的背面向下放在扫描仪
的玻璃板上(请参见第 59 页上的“身份证件复印
”)。
8
停止/清除
随时停止操作,此外还有更多功能。
• 取消当前作业。
• 打印配置报告: 按住此按钮约 2 秒钟,直至状态
指示灯慢速闪烁为止,然后松开。
• 耗材信息报告: 按住此按钮约 6 秒钟,然后松
开。
• 网络配置报告a
: 按住此按钮约 4 秒钟,直至状
态指示灯快速闪烁为止,然后松开。
9
+/- 按钮
允许您增加/减少要复印的页数。可通过按 +/- 按钮
确定要复印的份数(最多 99 份)。默认值为 1。
• 如果按 +/- 按钮,份数会以 1 为单位增加/减少。
• 如果按住 +/- 按钮,份数会以 10 为单位增加/减
少。
10
开始
开始作业。
11
状态 LED
表明机器的状态(请参见第 95 页上的“了解状态
LED”)。
12
墨粉 LED
显示墨粉状态(请参见第 95 页上的“了解状态
LED”)。
13 显示屏 显示要复印的页数。
a. 仅限 SCX-340xW Series。控制面板概览
1. 简介 26
13
类型 B
1
环保
进入环保模式以降低 PC 打印和复印时的墨粉和
纸张使用量(请参见第 54 页上的“环保打印”)。
2
WPS
a 无需计算机即可轻松配置无线网络连接(请参见
第 154 页上的“使用 WPS 按钮”)。
打印屏幕
按此按钮,显示将在显示屏上打印银幕?。如果只
要打印活动屏幕,请选择活动。如果要打印整个屏
幕,请选择完全。
• 打印屏幕只能在 Windows 和 Macintosh
操作系统中使用。
• 只能在通过 USB 连接的机器上使用此
功能。
• 当使用“打印”按钮打印活动中的窗口/全
显示器屏幕时,打印机可能会耗用更多
的碳粉,其取决于要打印的内容。
• 仅当已安装机器的 Samsung Easy
Printer Manager 程序时才能使用此功
能。如果使用 Macintosh 操作系统,您
需要通过 Samsung Easy Printer
Manager 启用打印屏幕设置才能使用打
印屏幕功能。
3
ID 复印
允许您将身份证件(如驾驶执照)的两面复印到纸
张的单面(请参见第 59 页上的“身份证件复印”)。
4
电源
打开或关闭电源,或从节能模式中唤醒机器。如果
需要关闭机器,请按住此按钮超过 3 秒钟。控制面板概览
1. 简介 27
5
传真
切换到“传真”模式。
6
复印
切换到“复印”模式。
7
扫描
切换到“扫描”模式。
8
菜单
打开“菜单”模式,并在可用菜单间滚动(请参见第
33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
9
左/右箭头
在选定菜单的可用选项间滚动,以及增大或减小
值。
10 OK 确认屏幕上的选择。
11
反面
返回上一级菜单。
12
开始
开始作业。
13
停止/清除
随时停止操作。
14
状态 LED
表明机器的状态(请参见第 95 页上的“了解状态
LED”)。
15
数字键盘
拨号或输入字母数字字符(请参见第 212 页上的“
键盘字母和数字”)。
16
免提拨号
按下该按钮时,可以听到拨号音。然后输入传真号
码。它的使用方法与扬声器电话相似(请参见第
247 页上的“在电话模式中手动接收”)。
17
重拨/暂停
在就绪模式下重拨上次发送传真的号码或接收的
呼叫者 ID,或在编辑模式下在传真号码间插入暂
停(-)(请参见第 241 页上的“重拨传真号码”)。
18 地址簿 用于存储常用传真号码,或者搜索已存储的传真
号码(请参见第 210 页上的“存储电子邮件地址”或
第 213 页上的“设置传真地址簿”)。
19 显示屏 显示当前状态,并在操作过程中显示提示。
a. 仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW Series。控制面板概览
1. 简介 28
14
调节控制面板
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。1. 简介 29
开机
1 首先将机器连接到电源。
如果机器有电源开关,将它打开。
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
2 自动打开电源。
对于 SCX-340x/SCX-340xW Series,按控制面板上的 (电源)
按钮。
如果要关闭电源,请按住 (电源)按钮约 3 秒钟。1. 简介 30
本地安装驱动程序
本地连接的打印机是使用线缆与您的计算机直接连接的机器。如果您的打
印机已联网,则跳过以下步骤,继续安装联网打印机的驱动程序(请参见
第 140 页上的“通过网络安装驱动程序”)。
• 如果您使用 Macintosh 或 Linux 操作系统,请参阅第 130 页上的
“Macintosh 安装”或第 132 页上的“Linux 安装”。
• 根据使用的机器和界面的不同,此用户指南中的安装窗口可能会有
所差异。
• 选择自定义安装可让您选择要安装的程序。
• 仅使用长度不超过 3 米的 USB 电缆。
15
Windows
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
如果安装过程中出现“找到新硬件向导”窗口,请单击取消关闭该窗口。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
如果不显示安装窗口,单击开始 > 所有程序 > 附件 > 运行。
X:\Setup.exe,用代表您的 CD-ROM 驱动器的字母替换“X”,然后单
击确定。
3 选择立即安装。
4 阅读许可协议,然后选择我接受许可协议的条款。然后单击 下一
步。
5 按照安装窗口内的说明进行操作。1. 简介 31
重新安装驱动程序
如果打印机驱动程序不能正常工作,请执行下列步骤重新安装驱动程序。
16
Windows
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 从开始菜单选择程序或所有程序 > Samsung Printers > 打印机驱
动程序名称 > 卸载。
3 按照安装窗口内的说明进行操作。
4 将软件 CD 放入 CD-ROM 驱动器中,再次安装驱动程序(请参见第
30 页上的“本地安装驱动程序”)。2. 菜单概述和基本设置
本章介绍整体菜单结构和基本设置选项的相关信息。
• 菜单概述 33
• 机器的基本设置 38
• 介质与纸盘 40
• 基本打印 52
• 基本复印 57
• 基本扫描 61
• 基本传真 622. 菜单概述和基本设置 33
菜单概述
使用控制面板可进入不同菜单,从而设置机器或使用机器的功能。
• SCX-340x/SCX-340xW Series 不支持此功能(请参见第 24 页上的“
控制面板概览”)。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此
功能不适用于您的机器。
• 根据机器的选件或机型,某些菜单的名称可能与您的机器不同。
• 高级指南中描述这些菜单(请参见第 181 页上的“实用设置菜单”)。
1
访问菜单
1 根据要使用的功能,从控制面板中选择“传真”、“复印”或“扫描”按
钮。
2 选择 (菜单),直至您需要的菜单出现在显示屏的最后一行,然
后按OK。
3 按箭头,直到出现需要的菜单项,然后按OK。
4 如果设置项有子菜单,则重复步骤 3。
5 按OK保存所作的选择。
6 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
项目 选项
传真功能 暗度 正常
深+1-深+5
浅+5-浅+1
对比度 正常
深+1-深+5
浅+5-浅+1
分辨率 标准
精细
超精细
照片传真
颜色传真
扫描范围
多方发送
延迟发送菜单概述
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 34
传真功能(续) 优先发送
转发 传真
PC
安全接收 关闭
打开
打印
添加页面
取消作业
传真设置 发送 重拨次数
重拨期限
拨号前缀
ECM 模式
发送报告
图像 TCR
拨号模式a
项目 选项
传真设置(续) 接收 接收模式
响铃应答
接收署名盖章
接收开始代码
自动缩小
废弃尺寸
垃圾传真设置
DRPD模式a
更改默认设置 分辨率
暗度
对比度
扫描范围
自动报告 打开
关闭
复印功能 扫描范围
缩小/放大
暗度 正常
深+1-深+5
浅+5-浅+1
项目 选项菜单概述
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 35
复印功能
(续)
对比度 正常
深+1-深+5
浅+5-浅+1
原稿类型 文本
文本/ 照片
照片
版式 正常
2页缩印
单面4页
ID 复印
海报复印
克隆复印
调节背景 关闭
自动
增强级别 1
增强级别 2
清除级别 1-清除级别 4
项目 选项
复印设置 更改默认设置 扫描范围
份数
复印分页
缩小/放大
暗度
对比度
原稿类型
调节背景
项目 选项菜单概述
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 36
系统设置 设备设置 设备 ID
传真号码
日期和时间
时钟模式
语言
节能
叫醒事件
系统超时
高度调整
自动继续b
纸张不匹配
纸张更换b
节省炭粉
环保设置
纸张设置 纸张大小
纸张类型
边距
项目 选项
系统设置(续) 声音/音量 按键声音
警报声音
喇叭
振铃音
报告 所有报告
配置
耗材信息
位置簿
发送传真
发送的传真
接收到的传真
计划作业
垃圾传真
网路配置c
使用计数器
传真选项
维护 清除已空消息d
耗材寿命
序列号
墨粉不足警报
项目 选项菜单概述
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 37
系统设置(续) 清除设置 所有设置
传真设置
复印设置
系统设置
网路设置c
位置簿
发送的传真
接收到的传真
网路 c
TCP/IP (IPv4) DHCP
BOOTP
静态
TCP/IP (IPv6) 激活 IPv6
配置 DHCPv6
Ethernet 速度 立即
10Mbps 半双工
10Mbps 全双工
100Mbps 半双工
100Mbps 全双工
项目 选项
网路 c(续) 无线 Wi-Fi 开/ 关
Wi-Fi Direct
WPS 设置
WLAN 设置
WLAN 默认设置
WLAN 信号
清除设置
网路配置
a. 该选项是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区。
b. 仅当启用纸张不匹配时,显示该选项。
c. 仅限 SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW Series。
d. 仅当墨盒中剩余少量墨粉时,显示该选项。
项目 选项2. 菜单概述和基本设置 38
机器的基本设置
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板
概览”):
您可以在 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机
设置工具程序中的 Machine 部分配置机器的设置。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
完成安装后,可能需要设置机器的默认设置。
要更改机器的默认设置,请按照以下步骤操作:
对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
1 选择控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮。
2 按系统设置 > 设备设置。
3 选择所需选项,然后按 OK。
• 语言: 更改控制面板上显示的语言。
• 日期和时间: 当您设置时间与日期时,时间与日期在延迟传真与
延迟打印中使用。时间与日期将被打印在报告上。但是,如果日
期和时间不正确,则需要将其更改为正确的时间。
使用箭头或数字键盘输入正确的时间和日期(请参见第 212 页上的“键
盘字母和数字”)。
• 月 = 01 到 12
• 日 = 01 到 31
• 年 = 需要四位数
• 小时 = 01 到 12
• 分 = 00 到 59
• 时钟模式: 您可以将机器设置为以 12 小时或 24 小时格式显示
当前时间。
• 节省炭粉: 墨粉节省模式可使您的机器使用较少的墨粉打印每
页。与普通模式相比,激活此模式可以延长墨粉盒的使用寿命,
但是会降低打印质量。
进行 PC 打印时,也可在打印机属性中打开或关闭墨粉节省模式。
• 节能: 如果您长时间不使用机器,请使用此功能节能。机器的基本设置
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 39
• 按电源按钮时开始打印,或收到传真,将从节能模式中唤醒本产
品。
• 依次按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 设备设置 > 叫醒事件
> 按钮 > 打开。按下除电源按钮以外的任何按钮,将从节能模式中
唤醒机器。
• 高度调整: 打印质量会受大气压影响,大气压取决于机器在海平
面以上的高度。在您设置海拔值之前,请确定所在地的海拔(请
参见第 209 页上的“海拔调整”)。
4 选择所需选项,然后按 OK。
5 按OK保存所作的选择。
6 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
要配置通过本机实现的其他实用设置,请参阅以下链接。
• 请参见第 212 页上的“输入不同的字符”。
• 请参见第 212 页上的“键盘字母和数字”。
• 请参见第 46 页上的“设置纸张大小和类型”。
• 请参见第 213 页上的“设置传真地址簿”。2. 菜单概述和基本设置 40
介质与纸盘
本章将介绍将打印介质装入机器的方法。
• 使用不符合这些规格要求的打印介质可能会引起各种问题,或导致
需要维修。此类维修不在 Samsung 的保修或服务协议之列。
• 切勿将喷墨照片纸与此机器配合使用。这样做可能会对打印机造成
损坏。
• 使用易燃的打印介质可能会引起火灾。
• 请使用指定的打印介质(请参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。
使用易燃的介质或将异物留在打印机中可能会导致设备过热,在少数
情况下可能会引起火灾。
2
纸盘概述
要更改大小,需要调节纸张导板。
1 纸张宽度导板
2 送纸器
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
如果不调节导板,它可能导致纸张套准、图像歪斜或卡纸。
1
2介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 41
3
在纸盘中装纸
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
1 打开纸盘。然后,按照装入的介质大小调节纸盘大小(请参见第 40
页上的“纸盘概述”)。
2 请在装入纸张之前将纸摞边弯折或成扇形展开,使纸张分离。
3 将纸张打印面朝上放置。
1
2介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 42
• 请勿过度推动纸张宽度导板,否则会导致介质变形。
• 不要使用先进入打印机一端卷曲的纸张,它可能导致卡纸或纸张褶
皱。
• 如果不调节纸张宽度导板,则会导致卡纸。
4 捏住纸张宽度导板,滑动它,使其触及纸叠的边缘但又不致让纸叠
打弯。
5 打印文档时,请为纸盘设置纸张类型和大小(请参见第 46 页上的“
设置纸张大小和类型”)。
从打印机驱动程序进行的设置将覆盖控制面板上的设置。
a 如想在应用程序中打印,请开启应用程序,然后打开打印菜单。
b 打开打印首选项(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
c 按打印首选项中的纸张选项卡,然后选择一种适合的纸张类型。
例如,如果您希望使用标签,请将纸张类型设置为标签。
d 在纸张来源中选择自动选择(或手动进纸器),然后按确定。
e 开始在应用程序中打印。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 43
4
纸盘手动进纸
纸盘可放置特殊大小和类型的打印介质,如明信片、便笺卡片和信封(请
参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。
要在纸盘中手动进纸,请单击以下项:
请参见第 41 页上的“在纸盘中装纸”。
纸盘手动进纸的使用提示
• 如果从打印机驱动程序中选择纸张 > 来源 > 手动进纸器,则每打印
一页都需要按OK。
• 在纸盘中每次只放一种类型、大小和重量的打印介质。
• 为了防止在打印时卡纸,在纸盘中还有纸张时请不要加纸。
• 打印介质应打印面朝上放入纸盘之中,顶边应先进入纸盘,同时介
质应放在纸盘的中央。
• 为了确保打印质量和避免卡纸,仅装入可用纸张(请参见第 106 页
上的“打印介质规格”)。
• 在将明信片、信封和标签装入纸盘前,请先将其压平。
• 打印特殊介质时,必须遵循装纸准则(请参见第 43 页上的“在特殊
介质上打印”)。
5
在特殊介质上打印
下表所示为纸盘可用的特殊介质。
打印首选项中还显示介质。要获得最高打印质量,从打印首选项窗口 > 纸
张选项卡 > 纸张类型中选择正确的介质类型(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打
印首选项”)。
例如,如果要在标签上打印,为纸张类型选择标签。
• 当使用特殊介质时,我们建议您一次仅进一张纸(请参见第 106 页
上的“打印介质规格”)。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不
同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
有关每张纸的重量,请参阅第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”。
类型 纸盘a
普通纸 ●
厚纸 ●
薄纸 ●
证券纸 ●
彩色 ●介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 44
(●:包含,空白:不提供)
信封
能否在信封上成功打印取决于信封的质量。
要打印信封,如下图所示放置信封。
• 选择信封时,请考虑以下因素:
- 重量: 不应超过 90 g/m2,否则会卡纸。
- 构造: 应将信封先放平,卷曲度应小于 6 毫米,且信封内不能有空
气。
- 状况: 不应有褶皱、缺口或其他损坏。
- 温度: 操作过程中应当能经受机器热量和压力。
• 只使用结构合理、折叠平整的信封。
• 请勿使用贴有邮票的信封。
• 请勿使用带有夹子、咬合装置、窗口、涂层内衬、自粘性封条或其他合
成材料的信封。
• 请勿使用已破损或劣质信封。
卡片纸 ●
标签 ●
信封 ●
预印纸 ●
棉质纸 ●
再生纸 ●
存档纸 ●
a. 纸盘中可用于手动进纸的纸张类型。
类型 纸盘a介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 45
• 确保信封两端的密封边一直延伸到信封角。
1 适宜
2 不适宜
• 已揭开粘合条的信封或者用多个封口叠在一起进行封合的信封必须使
用符合机器熔融温度的粘合剂,该温度为 0.1 秒内约为 170°C。额外的
信舌和封条会导致信封出现褶皱、折痕或卡纸现象,甚至可能损坏定
影器。
• 为获得最佳打印质量,页边距与信封边缘的距离不得小于 15 毫米。
• 避免在信封接缝重叠的区域打印。
标签纸
请仅使用专为激光打印机设计的标签,以免损坏机器。
• 选择标签时,请考虑以下因素:
- 粘合材料: 应当能在机器的热熔温度下保持稳定(约 170°C)。
- 布局: 只使用彼此之间没有露出衬纸的标签。标签间的空隙会让标
签脱离衬纸,从而导致严重卡纸。
- 卷曲: 必须放平,在各个方向上的卷曲度都不能超过 13 毫米。
- 状况: 请勿使用起皱、发泡或有分离迹象的标签。
• 确保标签之间没有裸露的粘合材料。裸露区域可使标签在打印期间脱
离,从而导致卡纸。暴露的粘合材料还会损坏机器组件。
• 请勿在机器上多次运行一张由多个标签组成的纸张。背胶只能通过机
器一次。
• 请勿使用与衬纸分离的标签,以及起皱、起泡或损坏的标签。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 46
卡片纸/自定义大小的纸张
• 在软件应用程序中,介质页边距应至少设置为 6.4 毫米。
预印纸
当装入预印纸时,打印过的一面应朝上,并且让未卷曲边位于前部。如遇
到进纸问题,请将纸张翻转。请注意,这种情况下无法保证打印质量。
• 必须使用耐热墨水打印,在机器的热熔温度下(约 170 °C),这种墨水
在 0.1 秒内不会融化、蒸发或释放出有害气体。
• 预印纸油墨必须具有非易燃性,不得对机器辊产生不利影响。
• 在装入预印纸之前,请确认纸上的油墨已干。在定影过程中,湿油墨可
能会从预印纸上脱落,从而降低打印质量。
6
设置纸张大小和类型
在纸盘中装入纸张后,使用控制面板按钮设置纸张大小和类型。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 47
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板
概览”):
您可以在 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机
设置工具程序中的 Machine 部分配置机器的设置。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
1 选择控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮。
2 按系统设置 > 纸张设置 > 纸张大小或纸张类型。
3 选择纸盘和所需选项。
4 按 OK 按钮保存所作的选择。
5 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
• 从打印机驱动程序进行的设置将覆盖控制面板上的设置。
a 如果要从应用程序打印,请打开应用程序,然后打开打印菜单。
b 打开打印首选项(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
c 按纸张选项卡并选择适当的纸张。
• 如果要使用帐单纸等特殊大小的纸张,请在打印首选项中依次选择
纸张选项卡 > 尺寸 > 编辑...并设置自定义纸张尺寸设置(请参见第
53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 48
7
使用输出支架
如果一次打印份数较多,出纸盘的表面可能会发烫。请勿触摸表面,且
不要让儿童靠近。
打印页堆叠在输出支架上,输出支架可帮助对齐打印页。默认情况下,打
印机将输出件送到出纸盘。
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
8
准备原件
• 请勿装入小于 142 × 148 毫米或大于 216 × 356 毫米的纸张。
• 为了避免卡纸、打印质量不佳以及机器受损的情况出现,不得试图装
入下列类型纸张。
- 复写纸或背面可复写的纸张
- 涂层纸
- 葱皮纸或薄纸
- 起皱或有折痕的纸
- 卷曲或光泽纸
- 撕裂的纸张
• 装入前请取下所有订书钉和回形针。
• 装入前请确保纸张上的胶水、油墨或修正液完全变干。
• 请勿装入纸张大小或重量不同的原件。
• 请勿装入书册、小册子、透明胶片或其他特殊性质的文档。
9
装入原件
您可以使用扫描仪玻璃板或进稿器装入原件,以进行复印、扫描和发送传
真。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 49
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。
查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
在扫描仪玻璃板上
使用扫描仪玻璃板,可以复印或扫描原件。可以获得最佳扫描质量,尤其
是对于彩色或灰度图像。确保进纸器中无任何原件。如果在进纸器中检测
到原件,则其优先级会高于扫描仪玻璃板上的原件。
1 提起并打开扫描仪盖。
2 将原件正面朝下放置在扫描仪玻璃板上。将其与玻璃板左上角的定
位指示对齐。
3 合上扫描仪盖。
• 复印时如果让扫描仪盖保持打开状态,则会影响复印质量,且会增
加墨粉用量。
• 扫描仪玻璃板上如有灰尘,可能会使打印件出现黑点。请务必使其
保持清洁(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
• 如果是复印书籍或杂志中的某页,请提起扫描仪盖,直到其转轴与
挡块相触,然后合上扫描仪盖。如果书籍或杂志厚度超过 30 毫米,
则应打开扫描仪盖开始复印。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 50
• 请注意不要打破扫描仪玻璃板。可能会导致您受伤。
• 关闭扫描仪盖时不要将手放进扫描仪。扫描仪盖会掉在您的手上,
导致受伤。
• 在复印或扫描过程中,请不要注视从扫描仪内部发出的强光。此光
会对眼睛有害。
在进纸器中
使用进稿器时,一次作业最多可以装入 40 张纸 (80 g/m2
)。
1 打开进稿器导板盖。
2 请在装入原件之前将纸摞边弯折或成扇形展开,使纸张分离。
3 将原件正面朝上装入进稿器输入纸盘。确保原件纸叠底端与进纸纸
盘上标记的纸张大小相符。介质与纸盘
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 51
4 按照纸张大小调节进纸器宽度导板。
如果进纸器玻璃板上积有灰尘,则会使导致印件上出现黑线。必须始
终保持玻璃板清洁(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。2. 菜单概述和基本设置 52
基本打印
有关特殊打印功能,请参阅《高级指南》(请参见第 218 页上的“使用高
级打印功能”)。
10
打印
如果您使用 Macintosh 或 Linux 操作系统,请参阅高级指南(请参见第
226 页上的“Macintosh 打印”或第 227 页上的“Linux 打印”)。
以下打印首选项窗口适用于 Windows 7 中的记事本。
1 打开要打印的文档。
2 从文件菜单中选择打印。
3 从选择打印机列表中选择机器。
4 份数与打印范围等基本打印设置可在打印窗口中选择。
要充分利用高级打印功能,请在单击打印窗口中单击属性或首选项
(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
5 要开始打印作业,请在打印窗口中单击打印或确定。基本打印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 53
11
取消打印作业
如果打印作业在打印队列或打印假脱机服务中等候,请如下取消作业:
• 您只需双击 Windows 任务栏中的机器图标( )即可访问此窗口。
• 也可以按控制面板中的 (停止/清除)取消当前作业。
12
打开打印首选项
• 在本用户指南中出现的打印首选项窗口会因所使用的机器不同而
有所差异。
• 当您在打印首选项中选择一个选项时,您会看到一个警示标记
或 。 号表示您可以选择该选项,但不建议作出如此选择,
号表示鉴于机器的设置或环境,您不可选择该选项。
1 打开要打印的文档。
2 从文件菜单中选择打印。将显示打印窗口。
3 从选择打印机中选择机器。
4 单击属性或首选项。
可按打印机状态按钮检查机器的当前状态(请参见第 263 页上的“使用
Samsung 打印机状态”)。
使用偏好设置
借助各个首选项选项卡上的 预设 选项(只有 Samsung 选项卡上没有该选
项),可以保存当前的首选项设置供日后使用。基本打印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 54
要保存预设项,请执行以下步骤:
1 按需更改各选项卡上的设置。
2 在预设输入框中输入项目名称。
3 单击 (添加)。当保存预设时,当前所有驱动程序设置会随之保
存。
选择多个选项,然后单击 (更新),设置将添加到您所做的预设中。
要使用已保存的设置,请从预设下拉列表中进行选择。此时机器设置
为根据您选择的设置进行打印。要删除已保存的设置,请从预设下拉
列表中选择它并单击 (删除)。
还可以从 预设 下拉列表中选择 默认预设值,从而恢复打印机驱动程
序的默认设置。
13
使用帮助
在打印首选项窗口中单击要查看的选项,然后按键盘上的 F1 键。
14
环保打印
环保 功能可减少墨粉消耗和纸张用量。环保 功能可以帮助您节省打印资
源并实现环保打印。
在控制面板中按 Eco 按钮将启用环保模式。环保模式的默认设置为每面多
页 (2) 以及省墨。
在控制面板上设置环保模式
如果机器的控制面板上有 +/- 按钮或机器不是受支持的网络(请参见
第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”):
您可以在 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机
设置工具程序中的 Machine 部分配置机器的设置。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。基本打印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 55
• 从打印机驱动程序进行的设置将覆盖控制面板上的设置。
• 访问菜单可能因型号不同而异(请参见第 33 页上的“访问菜单”)。
• 对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
1 从控制面板中依次选择 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 设备设置 > 环保设
置。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
• 默认模式: 选择它可打开或关闭环保模式。(省墨/2 页缩印)
- 关闭:将环保模式设置为关闭。
- 打开:将环保模式设置为打开。
如果通过 SyncThru™ Web Service(设置选项卡 > 机器设置 > 系统 >
环保 > 设置)或 Samsung Easy Printer Manager(设备设置 > 环保)为
环保模式设置密码,将显示强制消息。必须输入密码才能更改环保模
式状态。
• 选择模板:: 按照 Syncthru™ Web Service 或 Samsung Easy
Printer Manager 的设置操作。选择该项之前,您必须通过
SyncThru™ Web Service(设置选项卡 > 机器设置 > 系统 > 环
保 > 设置)或 Samsung Easy Printer Manager(设备设置 > 环
保)设置环保功能。
- 默认 Eco:机器设置为默认 Eco 模式。
- 自定义 Eco:更改任何必要值。
3 按 OK 按钮保存所作的选择。
选择驱动程序的环保模式
打开 Eco 选项卡进行环保模式设置。如果看到环保图像 ( ),表明当前
已启用环保模式。
环保选项
• 打印机默认值: 遵循机器控制面板中的设置。
• 无: 禁用环保模式。
• 环保打印: 启用环保模式。激活要使用的各种环保项。
• 密码: 如果管理员启用环保模式,您必须输入该密码才能更改状态。
结果模拟器
结果模拟器显示根据所选设置二氧化碳排放、使用电量的减少情况和纸张
节省情况。
• 结果计算以禁用环保模式时完整打印一百张纸(无空白页)为基础。
• 请参阅 IEA、日本总务省指数以及 www.remanufacturing.org.uk 的二氧
化碳、能源和纸张计算系数。每个模型的指数不同。
• 打印模式下的耗电量是指此机器的平均打印耗电量。基本打印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 56
• 实际显示的量只是一个估算值,因为实际量可能因使用的操作系统、
计算性能、应用程序软件、连接方法、介质类型[厚度]、介质尺寸、作业
复杂性等不同而异。2. 菜单概述和基本设置 57
基本复印
有关特殊打印功能,请参阅《高级指南》(请参见第 184 页上的“复印菜
单”)。
15
基本复印
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板
概览”):
a 将单页原件正面朝下放在扫描仪玻璃板上。
b 如果要自定义包括暗度、原稿类型等在内的复印设置,您可以使用
Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机设置工
具程序中的 Machine 部分。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
c 依需要使用 +/- 按钮输入复印份数。
d 按 (开始)。
1 选择控制面板上的 (复印)。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 如果需要自定义包括缩小/放大、暗度、对比度和原稿类型等在内的
复印设置,请使用控制面板按钮(请参见第 57 页上的“更改每次复
印的设置”)。
4 如果需要,使用箭头或数字键盘输入复印份数。
5 按 (开始)。
如果需要在操作期间取消复印作业,按 (停止/清除),复印将停
止。
16
更改每次复印的设置
本机提供复印的默认设置,使您可以快速,轻松地进行复印。基本复印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 58
• 如果在设置复印选项时按 (停止/清除)按钮两次,则为当前复
印作业设置的所有选项都将取消并恢复默认状态。或者,它们将在
完成正在进行的复印后自动恢复默认状态。
• 访问菜单可能因型号不同而异(请参见第 33 页上的“访问菜单”)。
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮:
您可以使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打
印机设置工具程序中的 Machine 部分自定义暗度、原稿类型等复印
设置。
- Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
- Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
• 对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
明暗度
如果原件包含模糊标记和深色图像,您可以调节亮度,使复印件易于阅
读。
1 从控制面板中选择 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能 > 暗度。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
例如,浅+5为最浅,而深+5为最深。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
暗度
对比度菜单允许您增加或降低图像明暗区域之间的差异。
1 从控制面板中选择 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能 > 对比
度。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
选择深色增加对比度,或选择浅色降低对比度。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
原始
通过为当前复印作业选择文档类型,进行原始设置,从而提高复印质量。
1 从控制面板中选择 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能 > 原稿类
型。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
• 文本:适用于内容主要是文本的原件。
• 文本/ 照片:适用于带有文本和照片的原件。
如果打印输出中的文本模糊不清,请选择文本以打印出清晰的文本。
• 照片:适用于原件是照片的情况。基本复印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 59
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
缩小或放大的复印件
您可以通过进稿器或扫描仪玻璃板将复印图像的大小缩放 25% 到 400%。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种
功能”)。
• 如果机器设置为环保模式,则缩小和放大功能不可用。
从预定义的复印尺寸中选择
1 从控制面板中选择 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能 > 缩小/放
大。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
通过直接输入缩放比例来缩放复印件
1 从控制面板中选择 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能 > 缩小/放
大 > 自定义。
2 使用数字键盘输入所需的复印大小。
3 按 OK 按钮保存所作的选择。
4 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
进行缩小复印时,复印件底部可能会出现黑线。
17
身份证件复印
本机可以在一页纸上打印双面的原件。
机器将在纸张的上半部分打印原件的其中一面,在下半部分打印另一面,
而不会缩小原件的尺寸。对于小尺寸文档的复印(如名片),此功能非常有
用。
• 要使用此功能,原件必须放置在扫描仪玻璃板上。
• 如果机器设置为环保模式,则此功能不可用。
操作程序可能因型号而异。基本复印
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 60
1 按控制面板上的 ID 复印。
2 将原稿正面朝下放在扫描仪玻璃上带有箭头指示的地方(如图所
示)。然后,合上扫描仪盖。
3 放入文档前端再按[开始] 出现在显示屏上。
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮,控制面板上的“正面 LED”
会点亮。
4 按 (开始)。
机器将开始扫描正面,并显示放入文档后端再按[开始]。
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮,控制面板上的“背面 LED”
会点亮。
5 翻转原件,并根据扫描仪玻璃板上所示的箭头将其放在扫描仪玻璃
板上。然后,合上扫描仪盖。
6 按 (开始)按钮。
• 如果不按 (开始)按钮,将只复印正面。
• 如果原件大于可复印区域,则部分内容可能无法打印。2. 菜单概述和基本设置 61
基本扫描
有关特殊扫描功能,请参阅《高级指南》(请参见第 231 页上的“扫描功
能”)。
18
基本扫描
这是扫描原件的常规过程。
对于用 USB 方式连接的机器来说,这是一种基本扫描方法。
• 对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
• 如果要使用网络扫描,请参阅高级指南(请参见第 232 页上的“从联
网机器扫描”)。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)> 扫描到PC。
或者
按控制面板上的扫描到。
如果看到不可用消息,请检查端口连接或选择从设备面板启用扫描
(依次选择 Samsung Easy Printer Manager > 切换到高级模式 >
扫描至 PC 设置。
3 选择所需的扫描目标并按OK。
默认设置为我的文档。
• 您可以创建并将常用设置另存为配置文件列表。还可以添加和删除
配置文件,将每个配置文件保存到不同的路径。
• 要更改 Samsung Easy Printer Manager > 切换到高级模式 >
扫描至 PC 设置。
4 选择所需选项并按OK。
5 扫描即会开始。
扫描图像保存在计算机的 C:\用户\users name\我的文档。保存文件夹
可能会因您所使用的操作系统或应用程序的不同而有所差异。2. 菜单概述和基本设置 62
基本传真
• SCX-340x/SCX-340xW Series 不支持此功能(请参见第 24 页上的“
控制面板概览”)。
• 有关特殊传真功能,请参阅《高级指南》(请参见第 241 页上的“传
真功能”)。
• 不能使用此机器通过 Internet 电话发送传真。有关更多信息,请咨
询您的 Internet 服务提供商。
• 在为了使用传真机而连接电话线时,建议使用传统模拟电话服务
(PSTN:公用电话交换网)。如果使用其他 Internet 服务(DSL,
ISDN, VolP),可以使用微过滤器提高连接质量。微过滤器可以消
除不必要的噪音信号,提高连接质量或 Internet 质量。由于 DSL 微
过滤器不随机提供,因此请联系 Internet 服务提供商,以了解使用
DSL 微过滤器的事宜。
1 电话线端口
2 微过滤器
3 DSL 调制解调器 / 电话线
(请参见第 23 页上的“后视图”)。
19
准备发送传真
在发送或接收传真前,需将随机提供的线缆连接到墙壁上的电话插座中
(请参见第 23 页上的“后视图”)。有关连接方法,请参考快速安装指南。在
不同的国家和地区,电话连接的方法可能不同。
20
发送传真
当您放置原件时,可使用进纸器或扫描仪玻璃板。如果将原件同时放
置在进纸器和扫描仪玻璃板上,则机器将先读取位于进纸器(其扫描
优先级更高)上的原件。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (传真)。
3 根据您的传真需要调整分辨率和黑度(请参见第 64 页上的“调整文
档设置”)。
4 输入目标传真号码(请参见第 212 页上的“键盘字母和数字”)。
5 按控制面板上的 (开始)。机器将开始扫描并将传真发送到目
标。基本传真
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 63
• 如果希望直接从计算机上发送传真,请使用 Samsung Network PC
Fax(请参见第 242 页上的“发送计算机中的传真”)。
• 如果要取消传真作业,请在机器开始传送前按 (停止/清除)。
• 如果使用扫描仪玻璃板,则机器将显示要求您放置另一页的消息。
手动发送传真
执行以下操作,使用控制面板上的 (免提拨号)发送传真。
如果您的机器是话筒型号,可使用话筒发送传真(请参见第 10 页上的
“多种功能”)。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (传真)。
3 根据您的传真需要调整分辨率和黑度(请参见第 64 页上的“调整文
档设置”)。
4 按控制面板上的 (免提拨号)或拿起话筒。
5 使用控制面板上的数字键盘输入传真号码。
6 在听到远程传真机发出高音调的传真信号时,按控制面板中的
(开始)。
将传真发送至多个目标
您可以使用多路发送功能,将一个传真发送到多个位置。原件会自动存储
在内存之中,然后发送到远程站点。发送之后,原件会自动从内存中清除。
如果选择超精细作为选项或者传真为彩色,则无法使用此功能发送传
真。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (传真)。
3 根据您的传真需要调整分辨率和黑度(请参见第 64 页上的“调整文
档设置”)。
4 从控制面板中选择 (菜单)> 传真功能 > 多方发送。
5 输入首台接收传真机的号码,然后按OK。
您可以按速拨号码或使用 (地址簿)按钮选择组拨号码。
6 输入第二个传真号码,然后按OK。
显示屏要求输入发送文档的另一个传真号码。基本传真
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 64
7 要输入更多传真号码,在显示是时按OK,然后重复步骤 5 和 6。
• 最多可以输入 10 个目标。
• 输入一个组拨号码后,就不能再输入其他组拨号码了。
8 输入完传真号码后,按左/右箭头在另一编号?提示下选择否,然后
按OK。
机器开始按输入顺序将传真发送到输入的号码。
发送传真后将打印多方发送报告。
21
接收传真
本机器出厂时被预设为传真模式。在接收传真时,机器以指定的响铃次数
应答来电,并自动接收传真。
22
调整文档设置
在开始传真之前,根据原件的状态更改下列设置后,以获得最佳质量。
对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
分辨率
使用基于文本的典型原件时,默认文档设置可以产生良好的传真效果。但
在发送质量低劣的或含有照片的原件时,可以调整分辨率以获得更高质量
的传真效果。
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 分辨率。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
• 标准:字符为正常大小的原件。
• 精细:含有小字符或细线的原件,或使用点阵式打印机打印的原
件。
• 超精细:含有非常精细内容的原件。仅当与您通信的机器也支持“
超精细”分辨率的情况下,才能启用超精细模式。
• 对于内存传输而言,超精细模式不可用。分辨率设置被自动更改为
精细。
• 如果将机器分辨率设置为超精细,而与您通信的传真机不支持超精
细分辨率,则机器将使用对方传真机支持的最高分辨率模式传送。
• 照片传真:含有灰色阴影或照片的原件。
• 颜色传真:带有颜色的原件。基本传真
2. 菜单概述和基本设置 65
• 此模式下,内存传输不可用。
• 发送彩色传真的两个必备条件是:对方传真机支持彩色传真接收,
您手动发送传真。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
暗度
可以选择原稿的暗度等级。
黑度设置适用于当前传真作业。要更改默认设置(请参见第 190 页上
的“传真菜单”)。
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 暗度。
2 选择所需的暗度。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。3. 维护
本章介绍有关订购机器的可用耗材、配件和维护零件的信息。
• 订购耗材和配件 67
• 可用耗材 68
• 可用维护零件 69
• 存放墨粉盒 70
• 摇匀墨粉 71
• 更换墨粉盒 73
• 监控耗材寿命 75
• 设置墨粉不足警报 76
• 清洁机器 77
• 机器搬运与存放方法提示 833. 维护 67
订购耗材和配件
不同国家/地区的可用配件不同。要获得可供应的耗材和维护部件的清单,请与您的销售代表联系。
如想订购由 Samsung 授权的耗材,配件与维护零件,请联系购买机器所在地的 Samsung 经销商或零售商。您还可访问 www.samsung.com/supplies,
然后选择您所在国家/地区,从而了解服务联系信息。3. 维护 68
可用耗材
当耗材使用寿命结束时,您可以为您的机器订购以下耗材:
根据选项、图像区域的百分比以及所使用的作业模式,墨粉盒的使用寿命可能不同。
购买新的墨粉盒或其他耗材时,只能在您使用机器的国家/地区购买。否则新墨粉盒和其他耗材可能无法兼容您的机器,因为这些会因国家/地区不同而
存在差异。
Samsung 推荐不要使用非原装 Samsung 墨粉盒,例如重新装填或改装的墨粉盒。Samsung 不能保证非原装 Samsung 墨粉盒的质量。机器保修不涵盖
由于使用非原装 Samsung 墨粉盒而需要的服务或维修。
类型 平均打印页数a
a. 额定打印量符合 ISO/IEC 19752 标准。页数会受操作环境、打印间隔、图形、介质类型和介质大小的影响。
零件名称
墨粉盒 约 1,500 页 MLT-D101S3. 维护 69
可用维护零件
如想购买维护零件,请联系您购买机器的经销商。只能售予您机器的授权服务供应商、经销商或零售商更换维护零件。保修范围不包括更换任何已达到“
平均打印量”的维护零件。
为避免零件磨损而导致打印质量和进纸问题,请定期更换维护零件(参见下表)。此举的目的是为了使打印机始终维持在最佳工作状态。对于下列维护零
件,应该在达到使用寿命时进行更换。
零件 平均打印页数a
a. 打印速度受所用操作系统、计算性能、应用软件、连接方式、介质类型、介质大小和作业复杂度影响。
传墨辊 约 30,000 页
定影器装置 约 30,000 页
拾取辊 约 30,000 页
进纸辊 约 30,000 页
ADF 进纸辊b
b. 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。
约 20,000 页
ADF 橡胶垫b 约 20,000 页3. 维护 70
存放墨粉盒
墨粉盒包含光、温度和湿度敏感组件。Samsung 建议用户遵循这些建议使
用新的 Samsung 墨粉盒来确保最佳性能、最高质量及最长寿命。
请将此墨粉盒存放在与要使用打印机的环境相同的环境中。该环境应处于
受控制的温度和湿度条件下。墨粉盒在安装前不应该揭开原始包装-如果
无原始包装,请用纸盖住墨粉盒的顶部开口处,然后将墨粉盒存放在阴暗
机柜中。
揭开墨粉盒包装而不使用墨粉盒会显著缩短墨粉盒的使用寿命。不要将墨
粉盒放在地板上。如果从打印机上取下墨粉盒,请按下述说明正确存放墨
粉盒。
• 将墨粉盒存放在随原始包装提供的保护袋中。
• 存放时,应水平而不是垂直放置,并且与安装在机器中时具有相同朝
上面。
• 切勿将耗材存放在任何以下环境中:
- 温度超过 40 °C。
- 湿度范围小于 20% 或大于 80%。
- 湿度或温度急剧变化的环境。
- 阳光或室内灯光直射。
- 积满灰尘的位置。
- 不要在汽车中存放太长时间。
- 存在腐蚀性气体的环境。
- 存在盐雾的环境。
1
处理说明
• 切勿接触硒鼓中感光鼓的表面。
• 切勿使墨粉盒受到不必要的震动或冲击。
• 切勿手动旋转感光鼓,尤其是反向旋转;否则会导致内部损坏和墨粉
溢出。
2
墨粉盒使用
Samsung Electronics 不建议,也不批准在本打印机中使用非 Samsung 品
牌墨粉盒,包括一般、商店品牌、重新装填或改装的墨粉盒。
Samsung 的打印机保修不涵盖由于使用重新装填、改装或非
Samsung 品牌墨粉盒而导致的机器损坏。
3
预计墨粉盒寿命
预计墨粉盒寿命(墨粉盒的打印时间)依赖于打印作业所需的墨粉量。实
际打印量可能不同,具体取决于所打印页面的打印密度、操作环境、图像
区域百分比、打印间隔、介质类型和/或介质尺寸。例如,如果您打印大量
图形,则将使用较多的墨粉,因此您可能需要较频繁地更换硒鼓。3. 维护 71
摇匀墨粉
当墨粉盒即将达到使用寿命时:
• 出现白色条纹或字迹变淡和/或两侧密度不同。
• 状态 LED 呈红色闪烁。对于带有墨粉 LED 的机器,它会闪烁橙色。
此时通过摇匀墨粉盒内剩余的墨粉,可暂时改进打印质量。在某些情况下,即使摇匀墨粉之后仍然会出现白色条纹或字迹变淡的现象。
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 为了避免对墨粉盒造成损坏,切勿将其暴露在光线下超过数分钟。如果需要,请用纸将其遮盖。
• 请勿接触墨粉盒的绿色区域。请使用墨粉盒上的手柄,以免触及此区域。
• 请勿用刀子或剪子等锋利的物体来打开墨粉盒包装。这些器具可能会划伤墨粉盒的感光鼓。
• 如果不慎将墨粉沾到衣物上,请用干布擦拭并用冷水清洗。热水会使墨粉渗入到衣服纤维中。
• 打开扫描装置,将进稿器和扫描装置一起握住。摇匀墨粉
3. 维护 72
1
23. 维护 73
更换墨粉盒
• 充分摇匀墨粉盒,这可以提高初期打印质量。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 为了避免对墨粉盒造成损坏,切勿将其暴露在光线下超过数分钟。如果需要,请用纸将其遮盖。
• 请勿接触墨粉盒的绿色区域。请使用墨粉盒上的手柄,以免触及此区域。
• 请勿用刀子或剪子等锋利的物体来打开墨粉盒包装。这些器具可能会划伤墨粉盒的感光鼓。
• 如果不慎将墨粉沾到衣物上,请用干布擦拭并用冷水清洗。热水会使墨粉渗入到衣服纤维中。
• 打开扫描装置,将进稿器和扫描装置一起握住。
墨粉盒使用寿命结束时,机器将停止打印。更换墨粉盒
3. 维护 743. 维护 75
监控耗材寿命
如果经常发生卡纸或打印问题,请检查您的机器已经打印或扫描的页数。如有必要,更换相应零件。
• 如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”):
在就绪模式下,按住 (停止/清除)按钮约 6 秒钟,然后松开。将打印一份耗材信息报告。
• 对于某些型号,可能需要按OK才能导航到下层菜单。
1 从控制面板中依次选择 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 维护 > 耗材寿命。
2 选择所需选项并按OK。
• 总寿命:显示打印的总页数。
• ADF 扫描:显示使用进稿器打印的页面的数量。
• 平板扫描:显示使用扫描仪玻璃板扫描的页面的数量。
• 耗材信息:打印耗材信息页。
3 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。3. 维护 76
设置墨粉不足警报
墨盒中的墨粉量较小时,会通过消息或 LED 指示灯通知用户更换墨粉盒。可设置此选项,以决定是否使用此消息或 LED 指示灯。
如果您的机器在控制面板上有 +/- 按钮(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”):
您可以在 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机设置工具程序中的 Machine 部分配置机器的设置。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
1 从控制面板中依次选择 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 维护 > 墨粉不足警报。
2 选择所需选项。
3 按 OK 按钮保存所作的选择。3. 维护 77
清洁机器
如果出现打印质量问题,或者您是在多尘的环境中使用您的机器,则您需要定期清洁您的机器,从而确保最佳的打印状况以及延长机器的使用寿命。
• 如果使用含有大量酒精,溶剂或其他烈性物质的清洁剂清洁机壳会造成外壳褪色或变形。
• 如果您的机器或其周边区域粘上墨粉,则我们建议您使用蘸水的布或绵纸擦拭。如果使用吸尘器,则墨粉会被吹进空气中,这会对您的身体有害。
4
清洁外部
用无绒软布清洁机壳。可用水稍微蘸湿软布,但注意不要让水滴到机器上或滴入机器。清洁机器
3. 维护 78
5
清洁内部
在打印过程中,纸屑、墨粉和灰尘颗粒会堆积在机器内部。这样会导致产生打印质量问题,例如:出现墨粉斑点或污点。清洁机器内部能够清除或减少这
些问题。
• 为了避免对墨粉盒造成损坏,切勿将其暴露在光线下超过数分钟。如果需要,请用纸将其遮盖。
• 请勿接触墨粉盒的绿色区域。请使用墨粉盒上的手柄,以免触及此区域。
• 清洁机器内部时请使用干燥、无绒抹布,小心不要损坏传墨辊或其他任何内部零件。不得使用苯或稀释剂等溶剂。可能会出现打印质量问题,并且会
导致机器损坏。
• 使用干燥的无绒抹布清洁机器。
• 关闭机器,拔掉电源线。请等待机器冷却。如果机器有电源开关,请在清洁机器前关闭电源。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 打开扫描装置,将进稿器和扫描装置一起握住。清洁机器
3. 维护 79
1
2清洁机器
3. 维护 80
6
清洁搓纸轮
• 关闭机器,拔掉电源线。请等待机器冷却。如果机器有电源开关,请在清洁机器前关闭电源。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。清洁机器
3. 维护 81
7
清洁扫描装置
保持扫描装置清洁有助于获得质量最佳的复印件。我们建议您在每天开始工作时清洁扫描装置,如果需要,也可以在工作期间清洁。
• 关闭机器,拔掉电源线。请等待机器冷却。如果机器有电源开关,请在清洁机器前关闭电源。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
1 将无绒软布或纸巾用水稍微蘸湿。
2 提起并打开扫描仪盖。清洁机器
3. 维护 82
3 擦拭扫描仪表面,直至洁净干燥。
1 扫描仪盖
2 扫描仪玻璃板
3 进纸器玻璃板
4 白杆
4 合上扫描仪盖。
1
2
4
33. 维护 83
机器搬运与存放方法提示
• 搬运机器时,切勿倾斜或使其倒立。否则,机器内部可能会沾上墨粉,从而导致机器受损或降低打印质量。
• 搬运机器时,确保至少有两人牢固手扶机器。4. 故障排除
本章介绍有关如何排除故障的帮助信息。
• 避免卡纸的提示 85
• 清除原件卡纸 86
• 清除卡纸 91
• 了解状态 LED 95
• 了解显示屏消息 97
本章介绍有关如何排除故障的帮助信息。如果机器有显示屏,请首先检查显示屏上的消
息解决故障。如果在本章中找不到解决问题的方法,请参见高级指南中的故障排除章节
(请参见第 270 页上的“故障排除”)。如果在用户指南中找不到解决方法或是问题依然存
在,请拨打服务电话。4. 故障排除 85
避免卡纸的提示
选择正确的介质类型可以避免大多数卡纸情况。为了避免卡纸,请参考以下准则:
• 确保可调导板位于正确的位置(请参见第 40 页上的“纸盘概述”)。
• 请勿在打印过程中从纸盘取出纸张。
• 装纸前请弯折、呈扇形散开并拢齐纸张。
• 请勿使用起皱、潮湿或过度卷曲的纸张。
• 请勿在纸盘中混装不同纸张。
• 请仅使用推荐的打印介质(请参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。4. 故障排除 86
清除原件卡纸
如果原件在进稿器中被卡住,在显示屏上将出现警告消息。
为避免撕破文档,请仔细地将卡纸取出。
为避免出现卡纸,请将厚、薄或混合纸型原件放到扫描仪玻璃板上。清除原件卡纸
4. 故障排除 87
1
扫描仪前端的原稿卡纸
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 视型号或可选商品,故障排除可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。清除原件卡纸
4. 故障排除 88
2
扫描仪内部的原稿卡纸
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 视型号或可选商品,故障排除可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。清除原件卡纸
4. 故障排除 89清除原件卡纸
4. 故障排除 90
3
扫描仪出纸区域的原稿卡纸
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
• 视型号或可选商品,故障排除可能不可用(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。
1 从进纸器中取出所有剩余纸张。
2 轻轻地从进稿器中取出卡纸。4. 故障排除 91
清除卡纸
为避免撕破纸张,请轻缓地将卡纸抽出。
4
在纸盘中
根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。清除卡纸
4. 故障排除 92
5
在机器内部
• 定影器区域温度很高。从机器中取纸时请务必小心。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的图示可能与您的机器不同。查看您的机器类型(请参见第 21 页上的“正视图”)。清除卡纸
4. 故障排除 93
1
2清除卡纸
4. 故障排除 94
如果在该区域看不到纸张,请停止并转至下一步:4. 故障排除 95
了解状态 LED
LED 的颜色指示机器的当前状态。
• 根据机型或国家/地区的不同,可能不提供某些 LED 指示灯(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”)。
• 要解决错误,请查找错误消息及其在故障排除部分中的说明(请参见第 97 页上的“了解显示屏消息”)。
• 也可以借助计算机 Samsung 打印机状态或Smart Panel程序窗口中的准则解决错误(请参见第 263 页上的“使用 Samsung 打印机状态”或第 265 页上
的“使用Smart Panel”)。
• 如果问题仍然存在,请与服务代表联系。
发光二极管
(LED)
状态 描述
状态
熄灭 机器处于脱机状态。
绿色
闪烁 当背光灯闪烁时,表明机器正在接收或打印数据。
点亮 • 机器已联机,可以使用。
红色
闪烁
• 发生小错误,机器正在等候清除错误。请检查显示消息。当问题解决时,机器会继续运行。
• 墨粉盒中残留墨粉。预计墨粉盒寿命a
将要结束。请准备新墨粉盒以备更换。可通过摇匀墨粉来暂时提高打印质量
(请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”)。b
点亮
• 墨粉盒已经达到其预计寿命 a
。建议更换墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
• 盖板处于打开状态。合上盖板。
• 接受或打印数据时纸盘中没有纸。在纸盘中装入纸张。
• 由于出现严重错误,机器已经停止运行。请检查显示消息(请参见第 97 页上的“了解显示屏消息”)。
• 发生卡纸现象(请参见第 91 页上的“清除卡纸”)。了解状态 LED
4. 故障排除 96
( )
WPS
b
蓝色
闪烁 机器正在连接无线网络。
开 机器连接到无线网络(请参见第 151 页上的“无线网络设置”)。
关 机器与无线网络断开连接。
( ) 电源 蓝色
点亮 机器处于节能模式。
熄灭 机器处于就绪模式或电源已关闭。
环保 绿色
点亮 环保模式已开启。
环保模式的默认设置为 2 页缩印和省墨。
熄灭 环保模式已关闭。
墨粉b 橙色
闪烁
墨粉盒中残留墨粉。墨粉盒中的墨粉a
预计将用完。请准备新墨粉盒以备更换。可通过摇匀墨粉来暂时提高打印质量
(请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”)。
点亮 墨粉盒已经达到其预计寿命 a
。建议更换墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
熄灭 所有墨粉盒容量正常。
a. 预计墨粉盒寿命是指墨粉盒的预期或预计寿命,根据 ISO/IEC 19752 设计,表示平均打印输出能力。打印页数可能会受操作环境、图像区域百分比、打印间隔、图形、介质和介质尺
寸影响。即使红色 LED 亮起且打印机停止打印,墨粉盒中仍可能残留墨粉。
b. 根据机型或国家/地区的不同,可能不提供某些 LED 指示灯(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”)。
发光二极管
(LED)
状态 描述4. 故障排除 97
了解显示屏消息
控制面板显示屏上出现指示机器状态或故障的信息。如果需要,请参照下表了解信息及其含义并解决问题。
• SCX-340x/SCX-340xW Series 不支持此功能。可以借助计算机的 打印状态或Smart Panel程序窗口中的准则解决错误(请参见第 263 页上的“使用
Samsung 打印机状态”或第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”)。
• 如果表中没有消息,请重新启动,然后重新尝试打印。如果问题仍然存在,请与服务代表联系。
• 拨打服务电话时,将显示屏上的消息内容提供给服务代表。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些消息可能不会显示。
• [错误号码] 表示错误号码。
6
卡纸相关消息
消息 含义 建议的解决方法
文档卡纸
取出卡纸
装入的原稿卡在进稿器中。 清除卡纸(请参见第 86 页上的“清除原件卡纸”)。
卡纸或缺纸
开门/关门
• 进纸区发生卡纸。
• 纸盘中无纸。
• 清除卡纸(请参见第 91 页上的“在纸盘中”)。
• 在纸盘中装入纸张(请参见第 41 页上的“在纸盘中装纸”)。
机器内部
卡纸
机器内部卡纸。 清除卡纸(请参见第 92 页上的“在机器内部”)。了解显示屏消息
4. 故障排除 98
7
墨粉相关消息
消息 含义 建议的解决方法
安装墨粉
盒
未安装墨粉盒。 安装墨粉盒。
不兼容
墨粉盒
安装的墨粉盒不适用于您的机器。 安装适用于本机的 Samsung 原装墨粉盒。
准备新的墨粉盒 指示的墨盒中有少量残留墨粉。墨粉盒中的墨粉预计将用
完。
请准备新墨盒以备更换。可通过摇匀墨粉来暂时提高打印质量
(请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”)。了解显示屏消息
4. 故障排除 99
更换新的墨粉盒 指示的墨粉盒几乎已达到其预计的墨盒寿命。
墨粉盒预计寿命表示期望或估计的墨粉盒寿命,指
示平均输出份数,依照 ISO/IEC 19752 进行设计(请
参见第 68 页上的“可用耗材”)。页数可能会受到操
作环境、图像区域百分比、打印间隔、介质和介质尺
寸的影响。即使显示“更换新墨粉盒”且机器停止打
印,硒鼓中仍可能残留墨粉。
• 您可以选择控制面板上显示的停止或继续。如果选择停止,则
打印机将停止打印,并且如果您不更换墨盒,则无法继续打
印。如果选择继续,则打印机会保持继续打印,但无法保证打
印质量。
• 显示此消息时,请更换墨粉盒以获得最佳打印质量。如果在显
示此消息后仍不更换墨粉盒,则会导致打印质量问题(请参见
第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
Samsung 不推荐使用非原装 Samsung 墨粉盒,例如重
新装填或改装的墨粉盒。Samsung 不能保证非原装
Samsung 墨粉盒的质量。机器保修不包括由于使用非原
装 Samsung 墨粉盒而需要的服务或维修。
指示的墨粉盒已经达到其预计的墨粉盒寿命。打印机可能
会停止打印。
更换墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
消息 含义 建议的解决方法了解显示屏消息
4. 故障排除 100
8
纸盘相关消息
9
网络相关消息
消息 含义 建议的解决方法
卡纸或缺纸
开门/ 关门
• 进纸区发生卡纸。
• 纸盘中无纸。
• 清除卡纸(请参见第 91 页上的“在纸盘中”)。
• 在纸盘中装入纸张(请参见第 41 页上的“在纸盘中装纸”)。
消息 含义 建议的解决方法
网路问题:
IP冲突
您设置的网络 IP 地址已被他人使用。 检查 IP 地址,如果必要,请重设(请参见第 137 页上的“打印网络
配置报告”)。
无线
网络错误
未安装无线模块。 请拨打服务电话。了解显示屏消息
4. 故障排除 101
10
其他消息
消息 含义 建议的解决方法
门未关
请将其关闭
盖板未关紧。 关闭盖板,直到锁定到位。
扫描仪的门已打开。 进稿器盖未关紧。 关闭盖板,直到锁定到位。
错误[错误号码]
关闭然后再打开
无法控制机器单元。 重新启动电源,然后重新尝试打印。如果问题仍然存在,请拨
打服务电话。
错误[错误号码]
请致电以申请维修
扫描仪锁定 扫描仪已锁定。 重新启动。如果问题仍然存在,请拨打服务电话。5. 附录
本章介绍产品规格以及适用法规的相关信息。
• 规格 103
• 法规信息 113
• 版权所有 1255. 附录 103
规格
1
总规格
规格值列出如下,如有变更,恕不另行通知。有关可能发生的信息变更,请访问 www.samsung.com。
项目 描述
尺寸 宽度 x 长度 x 高度 SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
389 x 274 x 249 mm
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
402 x 293 x 296 mm
SCX-340xFH/SCX-340xHW Series
a 407 x 293 x 296 mm
重量 机器包括耗材 SCX-340x Series
SCX-340xW Series
6.65 Kg
SCX-340xF Series
SCX-340xFW Series
SCX-340xFH/SCX-340xHW Series
a
8 Kg规格
5. 附录 104
噪声水平b 就绪模式 低于 26 dB(A)
打印模式 低于 50 dB(A)
复印模式 扫描仪玻璃板 低于 50 dB(A)
进纸器 低于 52 dB (A)
扫描模式 扫描仪玻璃板 低于 52 dB(A)
进纸器 低于 54 dB(A)
温度 操作 10 到 32 °C
存储器(已打包) -20 到 40 °C
湿度 操作 20 到 80% 相对湿度
存储器(已打包) 10 到 90% 相对湿度
额定电源c
110 伏型号 交流电 110 – 127 V
220 伏型号 交流电 220 – 240 V
项目 描述规格
5. 附录 105
功耗 平均运行模式 小于 310 W
就绪模式 小于 30 W
节能模式 • SCX-340x Series: 小于 1.2 W
• SCX-340xW Series: 小于 1.6 W
• SCX-340xF/SCX-340xFH Series: 小于 1.7 W
• SCX-340xFW/SCX-340xHW Series: 小于 2.1 W
电源关闭模式 小于 0.45 W
无线d 模块 T77H262/SPW-B4319S
a. 进行尺寸和重量测量(不含话筒)。
b. 声压级,ISO 7779。已测试配置:基本机器安装,A4 纸,单面打印。
c. 有关机器的正确电压(V)、频率(赫兹)和电流(A),请参见机器上的铭牌。
d. 仅限无线型号(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
项目 描述规格
5. 附录 106
2
打印介质规格
类型 大小 尺寸
打印介质重量/容量a
纸盘 在纸盘中手动进纸b
普通纸
Letter 216 x 279 mm 71 到 85 g/m2
• 150 张 80 g/m2
71 到 85 g/m2
Legal 216 x 356 mm • 1 张
US Folio 216 x 330 mm
A4 210 x 297 mm
Oficio 216 x 343 mm
JIS B5 182 x 257 mm
ISO B5 176 x 250 mm
Executive 184 x 267 mm
A5 148 x 210 mm
信封
Monarch 信封 98 x 191 mm 75 到 90 g/m2
• 10 张
75 到 90 g/m2
10 号信封 105 x 241 mm • 1 张
DL 信封 110 x 220 mm
C5 信封 162 x 229 mm规格
5. 附录 107
厚纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 86 到 120 g/m2
• 50 张 120 g/m2
86 到 120 g/m2
• 1 张
薄纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 60 到 70 g/m2
• 160 张 60 g/m2
60 到 70 g/m2
• 1 张
棉纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 75 到 90 g/m2
• 150 张 80 g/m2
75 到 90 g/m2
• 1 张
彩色纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 75 到 90 g/m2
• 150 张 80 g/m2
75 到 90 g/m2
• 1 张
预印纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 75 到 90 g/m2
• 150 张 80 g/m2
75 到 90 g/m2
• 1 张
再生纸 请参见普通纸部分
请参见普通纸部分 60 到 90 g/m2
• 150 张 80 g/m2
60 到 90 g/m2
• 1 张
标签c
Letter、Legal、US
Folio、A4、JIS B5、
ISO B5、
Executive、A5
请参见普通纸部分 120 到 150 g/m2
• 10 张
120 到 150 g/m2
• 1 张
类型 大小 尺寸
打印介质重量/容量a
纸盘 在纸盘中手动进纸b规格
5. 附录 108
卡片纸
Letter、Legal、US
Folio、A4、JIS B5、
ISO B5、
Executive、A5、
Postcard 4x6
请参见普通纸部分 121 到 163 g/m2
• 10 张
121 到 163 g/m2
• 1 张
证券纸 请参见普通纸部分 请参见普通纸部分 • 10 张 • 1 张
存档纸 请参见普通纸部分 请参见普通纸部分 • 100 张 • 1 张
最小尺寸(自定义) 76 x 127 mm 60 到 163 g/m2
最大尺寸(自定义) 216 x 356 mm
a. 最大容量取决于介质重量、厚度和环境因素。
b. 1 张,适用于手动进纸。
c. 本机器所使用标签的平滑度为 100 至 250 (Sheffield)。这表示平滑度的数量级别。
类型 大小 尺寸
打印介质重量/容量a
纸盘 在纸盘中手动进纸b规格
5. 附录 109
3
系统要求
Microsoft® Windows®
• 对于所有的 Windows 操作系统,最低要求为 Internet Explorer 6.0 或更高版本。
• 具有管理员权限的用户可以安装该软件。
• Windows Terminal Services 与该机器兼容。
• Windows 2000 需要 Service Pack 4 或更高版本。
操作系统
要求(推荐)
CPU RAM 可用硬盘空间
Windows® 2000 Intel® Pentium® II 400 MHz (Pentium III 933 MHz) 64 MB(128 MB) 600 MB
Windows® XP Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB(256 MB) 1.5 GB
Windows Server® 2003 Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (512 MB) 1.25 GB 到 2 GB
Windows Server® 2008 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz) 512 MB(2 GB) 10 GB
Windows Vista® Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz 512 MB(1 GB) 15 GB
Windows® 7 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32 位或 64 位处理器或更高配置 1 GB(2 GB) 16 GB
• 支持使用 128 MB 内存的 DirectX® 9 图形(用于启用 Aero 主题)。
• DVD-R/W 光驱
Windows Server® 2008 R2 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (x86) 或 1.4 GHz (x64) 处理器(2 GHz 或更快) 512 MB(2 GB) 10 GB规格
5. 附录 110
Macintosh
操作系统
要求(推荐)
CPU RAM 可用硬盘空间
Mac OS X 10.4 • Intel® 处理器
• PowerPC G4/G5
• 基于 PowerPC 的 Mac(512 MB)需要 128 MB
• 基于 Intel 的 Mac(1 GB)需要 512 MB
1 GB
Mac OS X 10.5 • Intel® 处理器
• 867 MHz 或更快速的 Power PC G4/G5
512 MB(1 GB) 1 GB
Mac OS X 10.6 • Intel® 处理器 1 GB(2 GB) 1 GB
Mac OS X 10.7 • Intel® 处理器 2 GB 4 GB规格
5. 附录 111
Linux
项目 要求
操作系统 Redhat® Enterprise Linux WS 4、5(32/64 位)
Fedora 5~13(32/64 位)
SuSE Linux 10.1(32 位)
OpenSuSE® 10.2、10.3、11.0、11.1、11.2(32/64 位)
Mandriva 2007、2008、2009、2009.1、2010(32/64 位)
Ubuntu 6.06、6.10、7.04、7.10、8.04、8.10、9.04、9.10、10.04(32/64 位)
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10、11(32/64 位)
Debian 4.0、5.0(32/64 位)
CPU Pentium IV 2.4GHz(Intel Core™2)
RAM 512 MB(1 GB)
可用硬盘空间 1 GB(2 GB)规格
5. 附录 112
4
网络环境
仅限网络和无线机型(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
您需要在打印机上设置网络协议方可将其用作网络打印机。下表显示了机器所支持的网络环境。
项目 规格
网络接口 • 以太网 10/100 Base-TX 有线局域网
• 802.11b/g/n 无线局域网
网络操作系统 • Windows 2000/Server 2003/Server 2008/XP/Vista/7/Server 2008 R2
• 各种 Linux 操作系统
• Mac OS X 10.4 ~ 10.7
网络协议 • TCP/IPv4
• DHCP,BOOTP
• DNS,WINS,Bonjour,SLP,UPnP
• 标准 TCP/IP 打印(RAW),LPR,IPP,WSD
• SNMPv 1/2/3,HTTP,IPSec
• TCP/IPv6(DHCP,DNS,RAW,LPR,SNMPv 1/2/3,HTTP,IPSec)
无线安全 • 验证:开放系统,共享密钥,WPA 个人,WPA2 个人(PSK)
• 加密:WEP64,WEP128,TKIP 和 AES5. 附录 113
法规信息
本机器专为通常的工作环境设计,并通过多项强制性标准认证。
5
激光安全声明
本打印机在美国已通过认证,符合 DHHS 21 CFR 的第 1 章,第 J 节关于 I
(1)类激光产品的要求,在其它国家/地区已通过 I 类激光产品认证,符合
IEC 60825-1:2007 的要求。
I 类激光产品被视为非危害性产品。激光系统和打印机的设计原则是在日
常操作、用户维护或指定维修条件下,所受的激光辐射不超过 I 类级别规
定的标准。
警告
请勿在激光/扫描仪组件的保护盖拆掉的情况下操作或维修。虽然反射的
光束不可见,但却能损伤您的眼睛。
使用本产品时,请务必遵循这些基本安全预防措施,以减少火灾、电击和
人身伤害的危险:法规信息
5. 附录 114
6
臭氧安全
7
汞安全性
8
节能
9
回收
本产品的臭氧排放率低于 0.1 ppm。因为臭氧比空气重,所
以请将本产品放置在通风良好处。
含有汞,请按照联邦、洲或地方法规(仅限美国)要求处理。
本打印机采用先进的节能技术,可降低打印机处于非活动状态
时的功耗。
如果长时间不接收数据,打印机会自动降低功耗。
ENERGY STAR 和 ENERGY STAR 商标为美国注册商标。
要获得有关 ENERGY STAR 程序的更多信息,请查看 http://
www.energystar.gov
对于 ENERGY STAR 认证型号,机器上贴有 ENERGY STAR 标
签。检查您的机器是否经过 ENERGY STAR 认证。
请本着对环境负责的态度回收或处理本产品的包装材料。法规信息
5. 附录 115
10
仅限中国
11
正确处理本产品(废弃的电气和电子设备)
(适用于欧盟及单独施行收集体系的其他欧洲国家/
地区)
(仅限美国)
通过获得批准的回收机构处理废弃的电子设备。要找到最近的回收地点,
请访问我们的网站:www.samsung.com/recyclingdirect 或致电 (877) 278 -
0799
产品、配件或资料文献上的这个标记指示产品及其电子配件(例如
充电器、耳机和 USB 电缆)在报废时不应该与其他生活废品一同
处置。为了防止非受控的废品处置导致对环境或人类健康造成损
害,请将这些元件与其他类型的废品隔开,并负责回收这些元件以
促进物质资源的可持续重复利用。
家庭用户应该联系销售此产品的零售商或当地的政府机构,以了解
有关在何处及如何处置这些元件以进行环保回收的详细信息。
企业用户应该联系供应商,并参阅有关购买合同的条款和条件。不
应该将此产品及电子配件与其他商业废品一并处置。法规信息
5. 附录 116
12
仅限台湾地区
13
射频发射
为用户提供的 FCC 信息
本设备符合 FCC 规则中的第 15 条。其操作受下列两种条件制约:
• 本设备不会导致有害干扰
• 本设备必须耐受受到的任何干扰,包括可能造成不正常运行的干扰。
本设备已经过检验,证明符合 FCC 规章第 15 条有关 B 类数字设备的限
制。这些限制旨在对住宅安装时出现的有害干扰提供合理保护。本设备会
产生、使用和辐射射频能量,如果未按照说明安装和使用,可能会对无线
电通信产生有害干扰。但我们不保证在特定安装情况下不会产生干扰。如
果此设备对无线电和电视接收产生有害干扰(可通过开关设备来确定),
则建议用户通过采取以下一项或多项措施来尽量消除干扰:
• 接收天线重新定向或重新安置。
• 增加设备与接收器之间的距离。
• 将设备连接到电路上的插座中,该插座应当与接收器所连接的插座不
同。
• 咨询经销商和专业广播电视技术人员寻求帮助。
任何未经负责产品合格性制造商明确认可的更改或修改,均有可能导
致用户对本设备的操作授权失效。
加拿大无线电干扰规章
本数字设备符合加拿大工业和科学部颁布的 ICES-003 “数字设备” 干扰标
准中数字设备无线电噪音排放 B 类限制条件。
Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques
applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe B prescrites dans la
norme sur le matériel brouilleur:« Appareils Numériques », ICES-003
édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada.法规信息
5. 附录 117
14
美国
联邦通信委员会(FCC)
受 FCC 第 15 节制约的意图发射器
本款打印机系统中可能内置有以 2.4 GHz/5 GHz 波段运行的低耗电、无线
电局域网设备(射频 [RF] 无线通信设备)。本部分说明只在具备此类设备
的情况下才适用。请查看系统标签,核对是否装有无线设备。
只有当系统标签上标有 FCC ID 号码时,系统中的无线设备才允许在美国
使用。
在人体(不包括四肢)附近使用无线设备时,FCC 制定了一个基本准则,
要求设备和人体要保持 20 厘米的距离。无线设备处于打开状态时,应在距
人体 20 厘米以外的地方使用此设备。内置于打印机中的无线设备功率输
出远低于 FCC 规定的射频暴露限值。
此发射器不得与其他任何天线或发射器一起配置或操作。
此设备的运行必须符合下列两个条件:(1)此设备不会产生有害的干扰,
(2)此设备可以承受任何干扰,包括可能引起此设备不正常运行的干扰。
用户不可以维修无线设备。请勿以任何方式进行改动。改动无线设备
将使您丧失使用此设备的授权。维修时,请与制造商联系。
FCC 关于使用无线局域网的声明
在同时安装和运行此种发射器和天线时,天线安装位置附近可能会有
超过 1m W/cm2 的无线电频率暴露限值。因此,用户必须始终与天线
保持至少 20 厘米的距离。不可以把此种设备与其他发射器和发射天线
安装在同一个地方。
15
仅限俄罗斯法规信息
5. 附录 118
16
仅限德国
17
仅限土耳其
18
仅限加拿大
本产品符合加拿大工业部的相关技术要求。/ Le present materiel est
conforme aux specifications techniques applicables d’Industrie Canada.
振铃等效值 (REN) 用于确定一个电话接口所能连接的设备数量。接口上的
终端可以是任意设备的组合,只要所有设备的 REN 总和不超过 5 即可。/
L’indice d’equivalence de la sonnerie (IES) sert a indiquer le nombre
maximal de terminaux qui peuvent etre raccordes a une interface
telephonique.La terminaison d’une interface peut consister en une
combinaison quelconque de dispositifs, a la seule condition que la somme
d’indices d’equivalence de la sonnerie de tous les dispositifs n’excede pas
cinq.
19
传真标志
按照 1991 年颁布实施的“电信业消费者保护法案”规定,任何人使用计算
机或其他电子设备通过电话传真机发送消息时,必须在发送的每一页的顶
端或底部的页边空白处,或者在发送的第一页中明确地包含以下信息,否
则将视为非法:
1 发送日期和时间
2 标明是企业、企业实体或个人发送的信息;以及
3 传真机、企业、企业实体或个人的电话号码。
电话公司可以对其通讯设施、设备运行或程序进行改造,这些改造是其公
司运作合理需要的,而且不违反 FCC 第 68 条的管制条款。如果可以预期
到这些改造会使任何客户终端设备与电话公司的通讯设施不兼容,或需要
修改或变更这些终端设备,或者在整体上会影响到其使用性能,则电话公
司应提前书面通知客户,使客户有足够的时间来保证服务不中断。法规信息
5. 附录 119
20
振铃等效数
本机器的振铃等效数和 FCC 注册号可以在机器底部或后面的标签上找
到。在某些情况下,您需要将此号码提供给电话公司。
振铃等效数(REN)用于衡量电话线路上的电负荷,可用于确定线路是否
出现“超载”情况。在相同电话线路上安装多种设备可能会引起拨打和接听
电话问题,尤其是当您的线路被叫时响铃的情况。电话线路上设备的振铃
等效数总和不能超过 5,以确保电话公司提供的服务正常运行。在某些情
况下,总和为 5 时线路将无法使用。如果您的任何电话设备不能正常运
行,应立即将其从线路中拆除,因为此设备可能会对电话网络造成损坏。
本设备符合 ACTA 采纳的 FCC 68 条的规定和要求。本机背面的标签上标
有产品的识别号码 US:AAAEQ##TXXXX。如有要求,该号码须提供给电话
公司。
FCC 规章声明,任何未经制造商明确许可的变更或修改,均有可能导
致用户对操作本设备的授权无效。在终端设备对电话网络造成损坏的
情况下,电话公司应提前告知用户服务有可能被终止。然而,如果无法
事先通知,公司可以将服务暂停,但前提是电话公司:
a 立即通知客户。
b 为客户提供更正设备问题的机会。
c 告知客户具有依照 FCC 规则和规章第 68 条 E 子部分中规定的步骤
向联邦通信委员会申诉的权利。
您还应了解:
• 本机器不适合与数字专用分组交换机系统连接。
• 如果您有意要在与机器相连的同一条线路上使用计算机调制解调器或
传真调制解调器,则所有设备都可能出现传输和接收问题。建议在与
机器相连的线路上不要共享其他设备,常规电话除外。
• 如果您处在闪电或电涌多发地区,建议您在电源和电话线路上安装电
涌保护装置。电涌保护装置可以从经销商处购买,也可通过电话和从
电子专卖店购买。
• 在设置紧急电话号码和/或向紧急电话号码拨打测试电话时,请使用非
紧急电话号码通知紧急服务调度员。调度员会给您进一步的说明,告
知您如何实际测试紧急电话号码。
• 此机器不能在投币电话或合用线路上使用。
• 此机器提供助听器的磁耦合。
您可以通过标准组合插口 USOC RJ-11C 将此设备安全连接到电话网络
上。法规信息
5. 附录 120
21
更换原配插头(仅限英国)
重要的
本机器的电源线带有标准的(BS 1363)13 安培插头及 13 安培的保险丝。
更换或检查保险丝时,您必须重装合适的 13 安培保险丝,然后需要更换保
险丝盖。如果不慎丢失了保险丝盖,在找到新的保险丝盖之前不要使用此
插头。
请联系此机器的销售人员。
在英国,13 安培的插头是最常用的类型,因而应该适用。但是,有些建筑
(主要是老式建筑)没有配置常用的 13 安培插座。您需要购买合适的插头
转接器。请勿拆卸模压插头。
如果模压插头处断线,请立即丢弃。切勿重新接线,以免插入插座时遭
受电击。
重要警告
如果电源线导线颜色与插头颜色不匹配,请执行如下操作:
必须将黄绿色导线与标有字母“E”或标有安全“地线符号”或颜色为黄绿色
或绿色的针脚相连。
必须将蓝色导线与标有字母“N”或颜色为黑色的针脚相连。
必须将棕色导线与标有字母“L”或颜色为红色的针脚相连。
在插头、转接器或配电箱内必须安装 13 安培的保险丝。
必须将此机器接地。
电源线导线色码如下:
• 黄绿色: 地线
• 蓝色: 零线
• 棕色: 火线法规信息
5. 附录 121
22
符合性声明(欧洲国家)
认可和认证
1995 年 1 月 1 日:委员会指令 2006/95/EC 统一成员国有关低电压设备的
法律。
1996 年 1 月 1 日:委员会指令 2004/108/EC,统一成员国有关电磁兼容性
的法律。
1999 年 3 月 9 日:委员会指令 1999/5/EC 关于无线电设备和电信终端设备
及相互认可一致性的规定。您可以从 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. 代表
处获取完整的声明,该声明定义了相关的指令和参考标准。
EC 认证
通过 1999/5/EC 无线电设备和无线电通讯终端设备指令(FAX)认证
Samsung 依据 1999/5/EC 指令自行证明本款 Samsung 产品适用于泛欧洲
模拟公共交换电话网(PSTN)的单终端连接。此产品设计用于欧洲国家/
地区的 PSTN 并与 PBX 兼容:
出现问题时,应先与 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. 的欧洲质量保证实验
室联系。
产品已依照 TBR21 进行测试。为协助使用符合本标准的终端设备,欧洲电
信标准协会(ETSI)已发布咨询文件(EG 201 121),其中包括确保
TBR21 终端具有网络兼容性的注意事项及附加要求。本产品已根据此文
档中的所有相关指令说明设计,并完全符合这些要求。
欧洲无线认证信息(适用于配备欧盟认证的无线电
设备的产品)
以 2.4 GHz/5 GHz 波段运行的低功率、无线局域网类型设备(射频无线通
信设备),可以置于(内置)家用或办公打印机系统之内。本部分说明只在
具备此类设备的情况下才适用。请查看系统标签,核对是否装有无线设
备。
Samsung Electronics 特此声明,该 [SCX-340x Series] 符合低电
压指令 (2006/95/EC) 和 EMC 指令 (2004/108/EC) 的基本要求和
其他相关规定。
Samsung Electronics 在此声明,本 [SCX-340xW Series/SCX-
340xF Series/SCX-340xFH Series/SCX-340xFW Series/SCX-
340xHW Series] 符合 R&TTE 指令 1999/5/EC 的关键要求和其他
相关规定。
有关此一致性声明,可到 www.samsung.com 查询,请访问“支
持”>“下载中心”,然后输入您的打印机 (MFP) 名称即可浏览
EuDoC。
系统中的无线设备只授权在欧盟地区使用和相关地区使用
(如果系统标签上有指定机构注册号和警告符号的 CE 标
志)。法规信息
5. 附录 122
打印机中内置的无线设备的输出功率远低于欧盟委员会 R&TTE 指令所设
定的射频暴露限值。
可用无线装置的欧洲国家/地区:
欧盟国家
有使用限制的欧洲国家/地区:
欧盟
在法国,超过 10 mW 传输功率的无线设备,其频率范围被限制为 2454-
2483.5 兆赫
EEA/EFTA 国家/地区
此时无任何限制
23
仅限以色列
24
法规符合性声明
无线准则
本款打印机系统中可能内置有以 2.4 GHz/5 GHz 波段运行的低耗电、无线
电局域网设备(射频 [RF] 无线通信设备)。以下部分概述了操作无线设备
的注意事项。
特定国家/地区的附加限制,注意事项和相关事项在特定国家/地区部分
(或国家/地区分组部分)列出。本系统中的无线设备只允许在系统额定标
签上的无线电认证标志所标识的国家/地区内使用。如果系统标签上未列
出您要使用无线设备的国家/地区,请与您当地无线电认证机构联系,了解
具体要求。无线设备受到严格管制,可能不允许使用。
内置于打印机中的无线设备的功率输出远低于当前的射频暴露限值。由于
无线设备(可能内置于打印机之中)所发射的能量低于射频安全标准和建
议的限度,因此制造商确信这些设备可安全使用。不管功率级如何,在正
常操作时都应注意尽量减少人体接触。
作为一般准则,在人体(不包括四肢)附近使用无线设备时,无线设备和人
体之间通常应保持 20 厘米间隔。当无线设备打开和发送时,设备与人体之
间的间隔应大于 20 厘米。
此发射器不得与其他任何天线或发射器一起配置或操作。
某些环境要求限制无线设备的使用。下面列举常见的限制例子:法规信息
5. 附录 123
射频无线通信会对商用飞机上的设备产生干扰。目前的航空规定
要求在乘坐飞机旅行时关闭无线设备。例如,IEEE 802.11(也称
为无线以太网)和蓝牙通信设备都是提供无线通信的设备。
在对其他设备或服务的干扰是有害的或被认为是有害的环境中,
可能会限制或禁止使用无线设备。例如,在机场,医院和存放有
氧气或易燃气体的环境中,可能会限制或禁止使用无线设备。当
您处在无法确定是否允许使用无线设备的环境中时,在使用和打
开无线设备之前请咨询有关部门。
每个国家/地区对无线设备的使用限制不同。由于系统配有无线设
备,在携带此系统进行跨国旅行之前,请向目的地国家的无线认
证机构咨询目的地国家对使用无线设备的限制。
如果系统配有内置的无线设备,则除非所有的护盖和护罩都在原
位且系统装配完整,否则不得操作无线设备。
用户不可以维修无线设备。请勿以任何方式进行改动。改动无线
设备将使您丧失使用此设备的授权。维修时,请与制造商联系。
只在允许使用此设备的国家/地区内使用驱动程序。请参见制造商
的系统恢复套件,或与制造商的技术支持部门联系,获取详细信
息。法规信息
5. 附录 124
25
仅限中国5. 附录 125
版权所有
© 2011 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. 保留所有权利。
本用户指南仅供参考。用户指南中的任何信息如有变更,恕不另行通知。
Samsung Electronics 对由于使用本用户指南引起的或与使用本用户指南相关的任何直接或间接损坏不承担任何责任。
• Samsung 和 Samsung 徽标是 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. 的商标。
• Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7 和 Windows Server 2008 R2 是 Microsoft Corporation 的注册商标或商标。
• True、LaserWriter 和 Macintosh 是 Apple Computer, Inc. 的商标。
• 所有其他品牌或产品名称为其各自公司或组织的商标。
请参阅所提供 CD-ROM 中的“LICENSE.txt”文件,以取得有关开放源代码的许可信息。
REV. 1.00高级
用户指南
SCX-340x/340xW Series
SCX-340xF/340xFW Series
SCX-340xFH/340xHW Series
高级
用户指南
本指南介绍不同操作系统环境中的安装、高级配置、操作和故障排除相
关信息。
根据机型或国家/地区的不同,可能不提供某些功能。
基本
本指南提供 Windows 上的安装、基本操作和故障排除相关信息。127
高级
1. 软件安装
Macintosh 安装 130
Macintosh 重新安装 131
Linux 安装 132
Linux 重新安装 134
2. 使用联网机器
实用网络程序 136
有线网络设置 137
通过网络安装驱动程序 140
IPv6 配置 148
无线网络设置 151
Samsung MobilePrint 180
3. 实用设置菜单
开始阅读章节前 182
打印菜单 183
复印菜单 184
传真菜单 190
扫描菜单 193
系统设置 195
管理员设置 206
自定义设置 207
4. 特殊功能
海拔调整 209
存储电子邮件地址 210
输入不同的字符 212
设置传真地址簿 213
注册授权用户 216
打印功能 217
扫描功能 231
传真功能 241
使用共享文件夹功能 251
使用内存/硬盘驱动器功能 252
5. 实用管理工具
Easy Capture Manager 254
Samsung AnyWeb Print 255
Easy Eco Driver 256128
高级
使用 SyncThru™ Web Service 257
使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 260
使用 Samsung 打印机状态 263
使用Smart Panel 265
使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator 266
6. 故障排除
进纸问题 271
电源和电缆连接问题 272
打印问题 273
打印质量问题 276
复印问题 283
扫描问题 284
传真问题 285
操作系统问题 2871. 软件安装
本章介绍安装基本及实用软件的说明,它们用于机器通过电缆连接的环境中。本地连接的打印机是使用线缆与
您的计算机直接连接的机器。如果您的打印机已联网,则跳过以下步骤,继续安装联网打印机的驱动程序(请
参见第 140 页上的“通过网络安装驱动程序”)。
• Macintosh 安装 130
• Macintosh 重新安装 131
• Linux 安装 132
• Linux 重新安装 134
• 如果您使用 Windows 操作系统,请参阅基本指南了解如何安装机器的驱动程序(请
参见第 30 页上的“本地安装驱动程序”)。
• 仅使用长度不超过 3 米的 USB 电缆。1. 软件安装 130
Macintosh 安装
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
4 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Installer OS X 图标。
5 单击继续。
6 阅读许可协议,然后单击继续。
7 单击同意接受许可协议。
8 当屏幕上出现关于计算机上的所有应用程序将被关闭的警告消息
时,请单击继续。
9 在用户选项窗格中单击继续。
10 单击安装。将安装打印机运行所需的所有组件。
如果单击自定义,则可以选择要安装的各个组件。
11 输入密码并单击确定。
12 安装软件需要重新启动计算机。单击继续安装。
13 安装完成后,请单击退出或重新启动。
14 打开应用程序文件夹 > 实用工具 > 打印设置实用程序。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,打开应用程序文件夹 > 系统预置并
单击打印与传真。
15 在添加上单击打印机列表。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,请单击“+”文件夹图标,随即会弹出
显示窗口。
16 单击预设浏览器并找到 USB 连接。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,请单击默认并找到 USB 连接。
17 若是 Mac OS X 10.4,如果“自动选择”无法正常运行,请在
Samsung 中选择 打印使用,并在型号中选择您的机器名称。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,如果“自动选择”无法正常运行,请在
选择要使用的驱动程序中选择打印使用和您的机器名称。
打印机将显示在打印机列表中并被设置为默认机器。
18 单击添加。
要安装传真驱动程序:
a 打开应用程序文件夹 > Samsung > 传真队列创建器。
b 您的机器会显示在打印机列表中
c 选择要使用的机器,然后单击创建按钮1. 软件安装 131
Macintosh 重新安装
如果打印机驱动程序无法正常运行,请先将其卸载,然后重新安装。
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
4 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Uninstaller OS X 图标。
5 输入密码并单击确定。
6 卸载完毕后,请单击确定。
如果已添加机器,请从打印设置实用程序或打印与传真中删除它。1. 软件安装 132
Linux 安装
您需要从 Samsung 网站下载 Linux 软件包来安装打印机软件(http://
www.samsung.com > 查找产品 > 支持或下载)。
1
安装 Unified Linux Driver
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 出现 Administrator Login 窗口时,在 Login 字段中键入“root”,并
输入系统密码。
必须以超级用户(root)身份登录才能安装机器软件。如果不是超级用
户,请咨询系统管理员。
3 从 Samsung 网站下载 Unified Linux Driver 程序包至您的计算机。
4 右键单击 Unified Linux Driver 程序包,然后解压缩该程序包。
5 双击 cdroot > autorun。
6 显示欢迎屏幕时,请单击 Next。
7 安装完成后,单击 Finish。
为了使用方便,安装程序已将 Unified Driver Configurator 桌面图标和
Unified Driver 组添加到系统菜单中。如果有问题,请通过您的系统菜单或
驱动程序包 Windows 应用程序(比如 Unified Driver Configurator 或
Image Manager)查询屏幕帮助。
2
安装智能面板
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 出现 Administrator Login 窗口时,在 Login 字段中键入 root,并
输入系统密码。
必须以超级用户(root)身份登录才能安装机器软件。如果不是超级用
户,请咨询系统管理员。
3 从 Samsung 网站,下载 Smart Panel 软件包至您的计算机上。
4 右键单击智能面板程序包,然后解压缩该程序包。
5 双击 cdroot > Linux > smartpanel > install.sh。Linux 安装
1. 软件安装 133
3
安装 Printer Settings Utility
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 出现 Administrator Login 窗口时,在 Login 字段中键入“root”,并
输入系统密码。
必须以超级用户(root)身份登录才能安装机器软件。如果不是超级用
户,请咨询系统管理员。
3 从 Samsung 网站下载打印机设置实用程序程序包至计算机。
4 右键单击 Printer Settings Utility 程序包,然后解压缩该程序包。
5 双击 cdroot > Linux > psu > install.sh。1. 软件安装 134
Linux 重新安装
如果打印机驱动程序无法正常运行,请先将其卸载,然后重新安装。
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 出现 Administrator Login 窗口时,在 Login 字段中键入“root”,并
输入系统密码。
您必须以超级用户(root)身份登录才能卸载打印机驱动程序。如果
不是超级用户,请咨询系统管理员。
3 单击桌面底部的图标。出现“终端”屏幕时,键入下列内容。
[root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/
[root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh
4 单击 Uninstall。
5 单击 Next。
6 单击 Finish。2. 使用联网机器
本章将分步向您介绍安装联网机器与软件的步骤。
• 实用网络程序 136
• 有线网络设置 137
• 通过网络安装驱动程序 140
• IPv6 配置 148
• 无线网络设置 151
• Samsung MobilePrint 180
受支持的可选设备和功能可能因型号不同而异(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。2. 使用联网机器 136
实用网络程序
提供多种便于在网络环境中设置网络设置的程序。尤其是对于网络管理员
而言,可实现通过网络对多台打印机进行管理。
• 在使用下列程序之前,请先设置 IP 地址。
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
1
SyncThru™ Web Service
内嵌在网络机器上的 Web 服务器,借助它可执行下述任务(请参见第 257
页上的“使用 SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
• 检查耗材信息和状态。
• 自定义机器设置。
• 设置电子邮件通知选项。设置该选项时,机器状态(墨粉盒墨粉不足或
机器错误)将自动发送到指定人员的电子邮件。
• 配置将打印机连接到不同网络环境所必需的网络参数。
2
SyncThru™ Web Admin Service
供网络管理员使用的基于 Web 的机器管理解决方案。SyncThru™ Web
Admin Service 提供了一种管理网络设备的有效方法,您可以从具有公司
Internet 访问权限的任何站点远程监控网络打印机并排除故障。
• 从 http://solution.samsungprinter.com 中下载该程序。
3
SetIP 有线网络设置
这种实用程序可用于选择网络接口以及搭配 TCP/IP 协议使用的 IP 地址。
• 请参见第 137 页上的“使用 SetIP(Windows)进行 IPv4 配置”。
• 请参见第 138 页上的“使用 SetIP 进行 IPv4 配置(Macintosh)”。
• 请参见第 139 页上的“使用 SetIP (Linux) 进行 IPv4 配置”。
• 不支持网络端口的机器无法使用此功能(请参见第 23 页上的“后视
图”)。
• 此程序不支持 TCP/IPv6。2. 使用联网机器 137
有线网络设置
4
打印网络配置报告
您可以从机器的控制面板打印一份网络配置报告,其中将显示当前机器的
网络设置。这将有助于您设置网络。
• 机器有显示屏: 按控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮,选择网路 > 网路配
置(网络配置)。
• 机器有触摸屏: 从主屏幕 > 网络 > 下步 > 网络配置中按设置。
• 机器没有显示屏: 按控制面板上的 (取消或停止/清除)按钮超过
4~5 秒。
您可使用这份网络配置报告找到您的机器 MAC 地址与 IP 地址。
例如:
• MAC 地址:00:15:99:41:A2:78
• IP 地址: 169.254.192.192
5
设置 IP 地址
• 机器不支持网络接口,它无法使用此功能(请参见第 23 页上的“后
视图”)。
• 此程序不支持 TCP/IPv6。
首先,必须设置用于网络打印与管理的 IP 地址。在大多数情况下,新的 IP
地址将由位于网络上的 DHCP(动态主机配置协议)服务器自动分配。
使用 SetIP(Windows)进行 IPv4 配置
使用 SetIP 程序之前,请从控制面板 > 安全中心 > Windows 防火墙禁用计
算机防火墙。
1 从提供的 CD-ROM 双击 Application > SetIP > Setup.exe 安装该
程序。
2 按照安装窗口内的说明进行操作。
3 使用网线将打印机联网。
4 打开打印机。
5 在 Windows 开始菜单中选择所有程序 > Samsung Printers >
SetIP > SetIP。有线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 138
6 在 SetIP 窗口中单击 图标(左起第三个)打开“TCP/IP 配置”窗
口。
7 按以下说明将机器的新信息输入配置窗口。在公司局域网中,可能
需要首先由网络管理者分配此信息,然后才能继续下一步。
从网络配置报告中找到机器的 MAC 地址(请参见第 137 页上的“打印
网络配置报告”),然后输入(去掉冒号)。例如:00:15:99:29:51:A8 变
为 0015992951A8。
8 单击应用,然后单击确定。打印机将自动打印网络配置报告。确认
所有设置均正确无误。
使用 SetIP 进行 IPv4 配置(Macintosh)
使用 SetIP 程序之前,请从系统偏好设置 > 安全 > 防火墙禁用计算机防火
墙。
下列说明可能会因您机型的不同而有所差异。
1 使用网线将打印机联网。
2 插入安装光盘,然后打开光盘窗口,选择 MAC_Installer >
MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPapplet.html。
3 双击文件后,Safari 将自动打开,然后选择信任。浏览器将打开显
示打印机名称与 IP 地址信息的 SetIPapplet.html 页。
4 在 SetIP 窗口中单击 图标(左起第三个)打开“TCP/IP 配置”窗
口。
5 将机器的新信息输入配置窗口。在公司局域网中,可能需要首先由
网络管理者分配此信息,然后才能继续下一步。
从网络配置报告中找到机器的 MAC 地址(请参见第 137 页上的“打印
网络配置报告”),然后输入(去掉冒号)。例如:00:15:99:29:51:A8 变
为 0015992951A8。
6 选择 Apply 后选择 OK,然后再次选择 OK。有线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 139
7 退出 Safari。
使用 SetIP (Linux) 进行 IPv4 配置
使用 SetIP 程序之前,请从 System Preferences 或 Administrator 禁用计
算机防火墙。
下列说明可能会因您机型或操作系统的不同而有所差异。
1 打开 /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/。
2 双击 SetIPApplet.html 文件。
3 单击以打开 TCP/IP 配置窗口。
4 将机器的新信息输入配置窗口。在公司局域网中,可能需要首先由
网络管理者分配此信息,然后才能继续下一步。
从网络配置报告中找到机器的 MAC 地址(请参见第 137 页上的“打印
网络配置报告”),然后输入(去掉冒号)。例如:00:15:99:29:51:A8 变
为 0015992951A8。
5 打印机将自动打印网络配置报告。2. 使用联网机器 140
通过网络安装驱动程序
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
• 机器不支持网络接口,它无法使用此功能(请参见第 23 页上的“后
视图”)。
6
Windows
1 确保打印机与网络连接,并打开电源。此外,打印机的 IP 地址也应
设置完毕(请参见第 137 页上的“设置 IP 地址”)。
如果安装过程中出现“找到新硬件向导”窗口,请单击取消关闭该窗口。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 选择立即安装。
自定义安装可用于选择机器的连接并选择要安装的单个组件。按照窗
口上的说明进行操作。
4 阅读许可协议,然后选择我接受许可协议的条款。然后单击下一
步。
此程序可以搜索整个机器。通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 141
如果在网络中或在本地找不到机器,则会显示错误消息。选择您想需
选项,然后点击下一步。
5 搜索到的机器将显示在屏幕上。选择想要使用的打印机,然后单击
确定。
如果驱动程序只搜索到一台机器,则会出现确认窗口。
6 按照安装窗口内的说明进行操作。
无提示安装模式
无提示安装模式是一种不需要用户进行任何干预的安装方法。一旦启动安
装后,打印机驱动程序和软件将自动安装在您的计算机上。您可以通过在
命令窗口中键入 /s 或 /S 来启动无提示安装。
命令行参数
下表列出了命令窗口中可以使用的命令。
当命令与 /s 或 /S 一起使用时,以下命令行很有效并且可运行。但 /h、
/H 或 /? 是可以单独运行的例外命令。
命令行 定义 描述
/s 或 /S 启动无提示安装。 安装打印机驱动程序的过
程中不提示任何 UI 或进
行用户干预。
/p“<端口名称>”或 /
P“<端口名称>”
指定打印机端口。
网络端口将通过使
用标准 TCP/IP 端
口监控器来创建。
对于本地端口,此
端口必须在通过命
令指定前存在于系
统中。
可以将打印机端口名称指
定为 IP 地址、主机名、
USB 本地端口名称或
IEEE1284 端口名称。
例如:
• /p“xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”,其
中“xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”表
示网络打印机的 IP 地
址。/p“USB001”、/
P“LPT1:”、/
p“hostname”
• 在使用韩语无提示安装
驱动程序时,键入
Setup.exe /s /
L"0x0012" 或
Setup.exe /s。
/a“<目标_路径>”或
/A“<目标_路径>”
指定安装的目标路径。
目标路径应为完全
限定的路径。
由于打印机驱动程序应安
装在操作系统的特定位
置,因而此命令仅适用于
应用软件。通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 142
/i“<脚本文件名>”或
/I“<脚本文件名>”
指定用于自定义运行的自
定义安装脚本文件。
脚本文件名应为完
全限定的文件名。
可以分配用于自定义无提
示安装的自定义脚本文
件。可以通过随附的安装
程序自定义实用程序或文
本编辑器来创建或修改此
脚本文件。
此自定义脚本文件
先于安装包中的默
认安装程序设置,
但并不先于命令行
参数。
/n“<打印机名称>”
或 /N“<打印机名称
>”
指定打印机名称。打印机
实例将创建为指定的打印
机名称形式。
通过此参数,您可以根据
需要添加打印机实例。
命令行 定义 描述
/nd 或 /ND 命令未将安装的驱动程序
设置为默认打印机驱动程
序。
它表示如果安装了一个或
多个打印机驱动程序,则
安装的打印机驱动程序将
不会成为系统中的默认打
印机驱动程序。如果您的
系统中没有安装打印机驱
动程序,则此选项将不适
用,原因是 Windows 操作
系统会将安装的打印机驱
动程序设置为默认打印机
驱动程序。
/x 或 /X 使用现有打印机驱动程序
文件来创建打印机实例
(如果打印机已安装)。
此命令提供一种安装打印
机实例的方法,该方法使
用安装的打印机驱动程序
文件而不安装其他驱动程
序。
/up”<打印机名称>”
或 /UP”<打印机名
称>”
仅删除指定的打印机实
例,而不删除驱动程序文
件。
此命令提供从系统中仅删
除指定的打印机实例而不
影响其他打印机驱动程序
的方法。它不会删除您系
统中的打印机驱动程序文
件。
/d 或 /D 从系统中卸载全部设备驱
动程序和应用程序。
此命令将从系统中删除安
装的所有设备驱动程序和
应用软件。
命令行 定义 描述通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 143
7
Macintosh
1 确保打印机与网络连接,并打开电源。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
4 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Installer OS X 图标。
5 单击继续。
6 阅读许可协议,然后单击继续。
7 单击同意接受许可协议。
8 当屏幕上出现关于计算机中的所有应用程序将被关闭的警告消息
时,请单击继续。
9 在用户选项窗格中单击继续。
如果尚未设置 IP 地址,请单击“设置 IP 地址”并参阅第 138 页上的“使
用 SetIP 进行 IPv4 配置(Macintosh)”。如果要设置无线设置,请参阅
第 165 页上的“使用 Macintosh 设置”。
10 单击安装。将安装打印机运行所需的所有组件。
如果单击自定义,则可以选择要安装的各个组件。
11 输入密码并单击确定。
12 安装软件需要重新启动计算机。单击继续安装。
13 安装完成后,请单击退出或重新启动。
/v“<共享名称>”或 /
V“<共享名称>”
共享安装的打印机,并添
加针对“指向并打印”的其
他可用平台驱动程序。
它将受支持的 Windows
操作系统平台的所有打印
机驱动程序都安装到系统
中,然后通过指定的 <共
享名称> 来共享它以实现“
指向并打印”。
/o 或 /O 完成安装后,打开打印机
和传真文件夹。
完成无提示安装后,此命
令将打开打印机和传真文
件夹。
/f“<日志文件名>”或
/F“<日志文件名>”
指定日志文件名。如果未
指定默认日志文件,则在
系统临时文件中进行创
建。
它会将日志文件创建到指
定的文件夹。
/h、/H 或 /? 显示命令行用法。
命令行 定义 描述通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 144
14 打开应用程序文件夹 > 实用工具 > 打印设置实用程序。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,打开应用程序文件夹 > 系统偏好设
置并单击打印与传真。
15 在添加上单击打印机列表。
• 对于 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,单击“+”图标。随即将弹出一个显示
窗口。
16 若是 Mac OS 10.4,请单击 IP 打印机。
• 若是 Mac OS X 10.5-10.7,请单击 IP。
17 在协议中选择 HP Jetdirect - Socket。
当打印包含多页的文档时,可通过为 Socket 选项选择打印机类型提
高打印性能。
18 在地址输入字段中输入机器的 IP 地址。
19 在 队列 输入字段内输入队列名称。如果无法确定打印机服务器的
队列名称,请首先尝试使用默认队列。
20 若是 Mac OS X 10.4,如果“自动选择”无法正常运行,请在
Samsung 中选择 打印使用,并在型号中选择您的机器名称。
• 若是 Mac OS 10.5-10.7,如果“自动选择”无法正常运行,请在选
择打印机软件中选择打印使用和您的机器名称。
21 单击添加。
打印机将显示在打印机列表中并被设置为默认机器。
要安装传真驱动程序:
a 打开应用程序文件夹 > Samsung > 传真队列创建器。
b 您的机器会显示在打印机列表中。
c 选择要使用的机器,然后单击创建按钮。
8
Linux
您需要从 Samsung 网站下载 Linux 软件包来安装打印机软件(http://
www.samsung.com > 查找产品 > 支持或下载)。
安装其他软件:
• 请参见第 132 页上的“安装智能面板”。
• 请参见第 133 页上的“安装 Printer Settings Utility”。通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 145
安装 Linux 驱动程序并添加网络打印机
1 确保打印机与网络连接,并打开电源。此外,机器的 IP 地址也应设
置完毕。
2 从 Samsung 网站下载 Unified Linux Driver 包。
3 解压缩 UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz 文件并打开新目录。
4 双击 Linux 文件夹 > install.sh 图标。
5 Samsung 安装程序窗口将会打开。单击 Continue。
6
“add printer wizard” 窗口会打开。单击 Next。
7 选择网络打印机,然后单击 Search 按钮。
8 机器的 IP 地址与型号名称显示在列表字段上。
9 选择机器并单击 Next。
10 输入打印机描述,然后单击 Next。
11 添加机器后,单击 Finish。
12 安装完成后,单击 Finish。
添加网络打印机
1 双击 Unified Driver Configurator。
2 单击 Add Printer.。
3 Add printer wizard 窗口打开。单击 Next。
4 选择 Network printer,然后单击 Search 按钮。
5 打印机的 IP 地址与型号显示在列表字段上。
6 选择机器并单击 Next。
7 输入打印机描述,然后单击 Next。
8 添加机器后,单击 Finish。
9
UNIX
• 确保机器支持 UNIX 操作系统,然后安装 UNIX 打印机驱动程序(请
参见第 7 页上的“操作系统”)。
• 命令以双引号标出,但是键入命令时,切勿键入双引号。
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“操作系统”)。通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 146
要使用 UNIX 打印机驱动程序,您必须首先安装 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包,
然后设置打印机。您需要从 Samsung 网站下载 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包
(http://www.samsung.com > 查找产品 > 支持或下载)。
安装 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包
安装步骤对于提及的所有 UNIX 操作系统变体都通用。
1 从 Samsung 网站,下载 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包并解压到您的计算
机上。
2 获取 root 权限。
“su -”
3 将相应的驱动程序压缩包复制到目标 UNIX 计算机。
有关详细信息,请参见 UNIX 操作系统的管理指南。
4 打开 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包。
例如,在 IBM AIX 上,使用下列命令。
“gzip -d < 输入包名称 | tar xf -”
5 转到解压缩的目录。
6 运行安装脚本。
“./install”
install 是用于安装或卸载 UNIX 打印机驱动程序包的安装程序脚本
文件。
使用“chmod 755 install”命令提供安装程序脚本的许可。
7 执行 “./install –c”命令以验证安装结果。
8 从命令行运行“installprinter”。这将打开“Add Printer Wizard”窗
口。请根据以下步骤在此窗口中设置打印机:
在某些 UNIX 操作系统(如 Solaris 10)中,刚添加的打印机可能未启
用和/或可能不接受作业。在这种情况下,在 root 终端上运行以下两个
命令:
“accept ”
“enable ”通过网络安装驱动程序
2. 使用联网机器 147
卸载打印机驱动程序包
应使用实用程序来删除系统中安装的打印机。
a 从终端运行“uninstallprinter”命令。
这将打开 Uninstall Printer Wizard。
已安装的打印机将会在下拉列表中列出。
b 选择要删除的打印机。
c 单击 Delete 将该打印机从系统中删除。
d 执行 “./install –d”命令卸载整个包。
e 要验证卸载结果,请执行“./install –c”命令。
要重新安装它,使用命令“./install”重新安装二进制文件。
设置打印机
要将打印机添加到您的 UNIX 系统,请从命令行运行“installprinter”。这将
打开“Add Printer Wizard”窗口。请根据以下步骤在此窗口中设置打印机:
1 键入打印机的名称。
2 从型号列表中选择相应的打印机型号。
3 在 Type 字段中输入与打印机类型对应的任何描述。这是可选的。
4 在 Description 字段中,指定任何打印机描述。这是可选的。
5 在 Location 字段中,指定打印机的位置。
6 在联网打印机对应的 Device 文本框中,键入打印机的 IP 地址或
DNS 名称。jetdirect Queue type 的 IBM AIX 上只允许使用 DNS 名
称,而不允许使用数字 IP 地址。
7 Queue type 以 lpd 或 jetdirect 的形式在相应的列表框中显示连
接。此外,Sun Solaris 操作系统中也可以使用 usb 类型。
8 选择 Copies 以设置份数。
9 选中 Collate 选项以接收已排序的副本。
10 选中 Reverse Order 选项以反序接收副本。
11 选中 Make Default 选项以将此打印机设为默认打印机。
12 单击 OK 以添加打印机。2. 使用联网机器 148
IPv6 配置
仅 Windows Vista 或更高版本可以正确支持 IPv6。
• 视型号或国家/地区而定,部分功能和可选商品可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”或第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 如果 IPv6 网络似乎未正常工作,则将所有网络设置均设为出厂默
认值,然后使用清除设置重试。
在 IPv6 网络环境中,请按照下列步骤使用 IPv6 地址。
10
使用控制面板
1 使用网线将打印机联网。
2 打开打印机。
3 打印网络配置报告,它将检查 IPv6 地址(请参见第 137 页上的“打
印网络配置报告”)。
4 选择开始 > 控制面板 > 打印机和传真。
5 单击打印机和传真窗口的左窗格中的添加打印机。
6 在添加打印机窗口中单击添加本地打印机。
7 将显示添加打印机向导窗口。按照窗口中的说明进行操作。
如果打印机无法在网络环境中运行,则激活 IPv6。请参阅下一节。
激活 IPv6
1 按控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮。
2 按网路 > TCP/IP (IPv6) > 激活 IPv6。
3 选择打开并按OK。
4 关闭打印机,然后重新打开。
5 重新安装您的打印机驱动程序。
设置 IPv6 地址
机器支持使用下列 IPv6 地址进行网络打印和管理。
• Link-local Address:自行配置的本地 IPv6 地址(以 FE80 开头的地
址)。
• Stateless Address:网络路由器自动配置的 IPv6 地址。
• Stateful Address:DHCPv6 服务器配置的 IPv6 地址。IPv6 配置
2. 使用联网机器 149
• Manual Address:用户手动配置的 IPv6 地址。
DHCPv6 地址配置(有状态)
如果您的网络上有 DHCPv6 服务器,则可以设置下列任何一个选项作为默
认的动态主机配置。
1 按控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮。
2 按网路 > TCP/IP (IPv6) > 配置 DHCPv6。
3 按 OK 选择所需值。
• DHCPv6 地址:不管路由器是否请求,始终使用 DHCPv6。
• 关闭 DHCPv6:不管路由器是否请求,从不使用 DHCPv6。
• 路由器:路由器请求时仅使用 DHCPv6。
11
从 SyncThru™ Web Service
对于控制面板上没有显示屏的机型,您需要使用 IPv4 地址首先访问
SyncThru™ Web Service 并按照以下步骤操作才能使用 IPv6。
1 从 Windows 访问 web 浏览器,如 Internet Explorer。在地址字段中
输入机器的 IP 地址(http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx),然后按“回车”键或单
击执行。
2 如果是首次登录 SyncThru™ Web Service,您需要以管理员身份
登录。键入以下默认 ID 和密码。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
3 当 SyncThru™ Web Service 窗口打开时,将鼠标光标移到顶部菜
单栏的设置上,然后单击网络设置。
4 单击网站左窗格上的 TCP/IPv6。
5 选中 IPv6 协议复选框以激活 IPv6。
6 选中手册地址复选框。地址/前缀文本框随即被激活。
7 输入地址的其余部分(例如:3FFE:10:88:194::AAAA。“A”为十六进
制 0 到 9,A 到 F)。
8 选择 DHCPv6 配置。
9 单击应用按钮。IPv6 配置
2. 使用联网机器 150
使用 SyncThru™ Web Service
1 启动 Internet Explorer 等 Web 浏览器,该浏览器必须支持将 IPv6
寻址为 URL。
2 从网络配置报告中选择一个 IPv6 地址(Link-local Address、
Stateless Address、Stateful Address、Manual Address)(请参
见第 137 页上的“打印网络配置报告”)。
3 输入 IPv6 地址(例如:http://[FE80::215:99FF:FE66:7701])。
地址必须括在“[ ]”括号中间。2. 使用联网机器 151
无线网络设置
• 确保机器支持无线联网。根据型号,无线联网可能不可用(请参见
第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
• 如果 IPv6 网络似乎无法正常工作,则将所有网络设置设置为出厂
默认值,然后使用清除设置重试。
12
入门
理解您的网络类型
通常,计算机和打印机之间每次只能有一个连接。
无线网络名称和网络密钥
无线网络对安全性要求较高,因此在首次设置接入点时,要为网络创建网
络名称(SSID),所用安全级别类型和网络密钥。在继续机器安装之前,向
网络管理员咨询此信息。
基础结构模式
这种环境通常用于家庭和 SOHO(小型办公室/家庭办公
室)。该模式使用接入点与无线设备通信。
特别模式
该模式不使用接入点。无线计算机和无线设备直接通信。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 152
13
介绍无线网络设置方法
您可以从机器或计算机配置无线设置。从下表选择设置方法。
视型号或国家/地区而定,部分无线网络安装类型可能不可用。
设置方法 连接方法 描述与参考
从机器的控制面板
使用 WPS(推荐)
( )
• 请参见第 155 页上的“有显示屏的机器”。
• 请参见第 156 页上的“没有显示屏的机器”。
使用菜单按钮
( )
• 请参见第 157 页上的“使用菜单按钮”。
从计算机安装
接入点(通过 USB 电缆,推荐)
( )
• Windows 用户,请参见第 158 页上的“接入点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
• Macintosh 用户,请参见第 166 页上的“接入点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
接入点(通过 WPS 按钮,无 USB 电缆连接)
( , )
• Windows 用户,请参见第 161 页上的“接入点(通过 WPS 按钮,无 USB 电缆连
接)”。
• Macintosh 用户,请参见第 169 页上的“使用 WPS 按钮设置接入点”。
点对点(通过 USB 电缆)
( )
• Windows 用户,请参见第 163 页上的“点对点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
• Macintosh 用户,请参见第 170 页上的“点对点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
使用网络电缆 • 请参见第 173 页上的“使用网络电缆”。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 153
如果在无线设置或驱动程序安装过程中发生问题,请参阅故障排除章节(请参见第 177 页上的“故障排除”)。
其他设置方法 为移动打印设置无线直连 • 请参见第 176 页上的“设置无线直连”。
设置方法 连接方法 描述与参考无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 154
14
使用 WPS 按钮
如果打印机和接入点(或无线路由器)支持 WPS (Wi-Fi Protected
Setup™),则可以在没有计算机的情况下,通过按控制面板上的 (WPS)
按钮,轻松配置无线网络设置。
• 如果要使用基础结构模式的无线网络,请确保网线已从打印机断
开。使用 WPS (PBC) 按钮还是从计算机输入 PIN 连接到接入点(或
无线路由器)因使用的接入点(或无线路由器)不同而异。请参考所
用接入点(或无线路由器)的用户指南。
• 使用 WPS 按钮设置无线网络时,安全设置可能改变。为了防止这
种情况,请为当前无限安全设置锁定 WPS 选项。选项名称可能因
所使用的接入点(或无线路由器)不同而异。
准备事项
• 检查接入点(或无线路由器)是否支持 Wi-Fi Protected Setup™
(WPS)。
• 检查打印机是否支持 Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS)。
• 联网计算机(仅限 PIN 模式)
选择类型
可以通过两种方法,使用控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮将机器连接到无线
网络。
按钮配置 (PBC) 法–用户可分别按下机器控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮和
支持 Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS) 的接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS
(PBC) 按钮,从而将机器连接到无线网络。
个人识别码 (PIN) 法 - 用户可在启用 WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup™) 的接
入点(或无线路由器)上输入所提供的 PIN 信息,从而将打印机连接到无
线网络。
打印机的出厂默认设置为 PBC 模式,该模式推荐用于典型无线网络环境。
您可以在控制面板中更改 WPS 模式( (菜单) > 网路 > 无线 > OK >
WPS 设置。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 155
有显示屏的机器
以 PBC 模式连接
1 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮超过 2 秒钟。
机器启动并最多等待两分钟,在此期间,请按接入点(或无线路由
器)上的 WPS(PBC)按钮。
2 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
消息按以下顺序出现在显示屏上:
a 正在连接: 打印机正在连接接入点(或无线路由器)。
b 连接: 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持点
亮状态。
c SSID 类型: 完成无线网络连接过程后,在显示屏上会显示接入
点的 SSID 信息。
以 PIN 模式连接
1 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮超过 2 秒钟。
2 随即在显示屏上显示八位数的 PIN。
您需要在两分钟内在连接到接入点(或无线路由器)的计算机上输
入八位 PIN。
消息按以下顺序出现在显示屏上:
a 正在连接: 机器连接至无线网络。
b 连接: 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持点
亮状态。
c SSID 类型: 完成无线网络连接过程后,LCD 显示屏上会显示接
入点的 SSID 信息。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 156
没有显示屏的机器
以 PBC 模式连接
1 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮约 2 到 4 秒钟,直至状态 LED 快
速闪烁。
机器开始连接无线网络。LED 在按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的
PBC 按钮前最多缓慢闪烁两分钟。
2 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
a WPS LED 的灯光快速闪烁。打印机正在连接接入点(或无线路
由器)。
b 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持点亮状
态。
以 PIN 模式连接
1 必须打印包含 PIN 的网络配置报告(请参见第 137 页上的“打印网
络配置报告”)。
在就绪模式下,按住控制面板上的 (取消或停止/清除)按钮约 5
秒钟。可以找到机器的 PIN。
2 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮超过 4 秒钟,直至状态 LED 点
亮。
机器开始连接接入点(或无线路由器)。
3 您需要在两分钟内在连接到接入点(或无线路由器)的计算机上输
入八位 PIN。
LED 将缓慢闪烁(最多两分钟),直到您输入八位 PIN。
WPS LED 按以下顺序闪烁:
a WPS LED 的灯光快速闪烁。打印机正在连接接入点(或无线路
由器)。
b 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持点亮状
态。
重新连接到网络
当无线功能关闭后,本机将使用先前的无线连接设置和地址自动尝试重新
连接接入点(或无线路由器)。
在以下情形中,本机会自动重新连接无线网络:
• 关闭机器后又重新打开时。
• 关闭接入点(或无线路由器)后又重新打开时。
取消连接进程
要在打印机连接无线网络时取消无线网络连接,请按下并松开控制面板上
的 (取消或停止/清除)。需要等待 2 分钟才能重新连接无线网络。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 157
从网络断开连接
要断开无线网络连接,请按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮超过 2 秒钟。
• Wi-Fi 网络处于空闲模式时: 机器立即断开无线网络连接,并且 WPS
LED 熄灭。
• 正在使用 Wi-Fi 网络时: 当打印机在等待当前作业完成时,WPS LED
的灯光将会快速闪烁。随后自动断开无线网络连接,并且 WPS LED 熄
灭。
15
使用菜单按钮
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
开始之前,您需要了解您无线网络的网络名称(SSID),如果经过加密,则
还需要了解网络密钥。当安装接入点(或无线路由器)后设置该信息。如果
不了解无线网络,请咨询网络的设置人员。
完成无线网络连接后,需要安装打印机驱动程序才能从应用程序进行
打印(请参见第 140 页上的“通过网络安装驱动程序”)。
1 按控制面板上的 (菜单)按钮。
2 按网路 > 无线 > WLAN 设置。
3 按 OK 选择所需的设置方法。
• 向导(推荐): 此模式中,设置是自动的。机器将显示可供选择
的网络列表。选择一个网络后,打印机将提示您输入相应的安
全密钥。
• 自定义: 在该模式中,用户可以手动提供或编辑自己的 SSID 或
选择具体的安全选项。
16
使用 Windows 设置
无线设置程序的快捷方式(没有 CD):如果安装过一次打印机驱动程
序,则无需 CD 即可访问无线设置程序。从“开始”菜单中选择程序或所
有程序 > Samsung Printers > 您的打印机驱动程序名称 > 无线设置程
序。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 158
接入点(通过 USB 电缆)
准备事项
• 接入点
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
• USB 线
创建基础结构网络
1 检查 USB 线是否连接到打印机。
2 打开计算机,接入点和打印机。
3 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
4 选择无线设置和安装选项。
5 阅读许可协议,然后选择我接受许可协议的条款。然后单击下一
步。
6 软件会搜索无线网络。
如果软件无法搜索到网络,请检查计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线
连接是否正确,并遵照屏幕上的说明操作。
• 如果之前配置过无线网络设置,将显示无线网络设置信息窗口。
如果要重置无线设置,请选中复选框并单击下一步。
• 要查看支持 WPS 按钮(不使用 USB 电缆连接)的型号,将显示以
下窗口。
- 使用 USB 线缆:连接 USB 电缆并单击“下一步”,然后转到步骤
7。
- 使用 WPS 按钮:请参见第 161 页上的“接入点(通过 WPS 按钮,
无 USB 电缆连接)”。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 159
7 从无线设置方法窗口中选择要使用的方法。
• 手动配置无线设置。:转到步骤 8。
• 通过按下接入点的 WPS 按钮配置无线设置。:通过按接入点
(或无线路由器)上的 WPS 按钮连接到无线网络。
- 按照窗口中的说明进行操作。配置完无线网络设置后,转到
步骤 11。
8 搜索后,窗口中会显示无线网络设备。选择正在使用的接入点名称
(SSID),然后单击下一步。
如果找不到希望选择的网络名称,或者希望手动设置无线配置,请单
击高级设置。
• 输入无线网络名称: 输入接入点的 SSID(SSID 区分大小写)。
• 操作模式: 选择基础结构。
• 验证: 选择验证类型。
开放系统: 不使用验证,并且是否采用加密,视数据安全的需要而
定。
共享密钥: 使用验证。只有拥有正确 WEP 密钥的设备才可访问网
络。
WPA Personal 或 WPA2 Personal: 选择该选项,根据“WPA 预共
享密钥”验证打印服务器。此验证使用在接入点及其每个客户端上
手动配置的共享密钥(通常称为预共享密钥口令)。
• 加密: 选择加密(无,WEP64,WEP128,TKIP,AES,TKIP AES)。
• 网络密钥: 输入加密网络密钥值。
• 确认网络密钥: 确认加密网络密钥值。
• WEP 密钥索引: 如果使用 WEP 加密,请选择相应的 WEP 密钥索
引。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 160
当接入点有安全设置时,会显示无线网络安全窗口。
出现无线网络安全窗口。该窗口可能会根据安全模式的不同而异:
WEP 或 WPA。
• 有线等效加密(WEP)
验证方法选择开放系统或共享密钥,然后输入 WEP 安全密钥。单
击下一步。
WEP(有线等效保密)是一种防止非法访问无线网络的安全协议。
WEP 使用 64 位或 128 位 WEP 加密密钥,对在无线网络上交换的
每个数据包的数据部分进行加密。
• Wi-Fi 保护访问(WPA)
输入 WPA 共享密钥,然后单击下一步。
WPA 根据定期自动变更的密钥对用户授权和识别用户。WPA 还使
用 TKIP(暂时密钥完整性协议)和 AES(高级加密标准)进行数据
加密。
9 该窗口会显示无线网络设置并检查设置是否正确。单击下一步。
• 对于 DHCP 方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为 DHCP,检查窗口中是否显示 DHCP。
如果显示为静态,则单击更改 TCP/IP 将分配方法更改为
DHCP。
• 对于静态方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为静态,则检查“静态”是否显示在窗口
中。如果显示 DHCP,请单击更改 TCP/IP 以输入打印机的 IP 地
址和其他网络配置值。在输入打印机的 IP 地址之前,必须了解
计算机的网络配置信息。如果计算机设置为 DHCP,则必须联
系网络管理员以获取静态 IP 地址。
例如:
如果计算机的网络信息如下所示,
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.42
- 子网掩码: 255.255.0.0
则打印机的网络信息应如下:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.43
- 子网掩码:255.255.0.0(使用计算机的子网掩码)
- 网关: 169.254.133.1
10 当告诉您网络电缆连接已确认的窗口显示时,断开网络电缆连接并
单击下一步。
如果接上网络电缆,它在配置无线网络时可能较难找到机器。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 161
11 无线网络设置完成。要从支持无线直连的移动设备进行打印,请设
置无线直连选项(请参见第 176 页上的“设置无线直连”)。
Wi-Fi Direct 选项:
• 无线直连选项仅在打印机支持此功能时显示在屏幕上。
• 可以通过 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 开始构建无线直连(请参
见第 176 页上的“设置无线直连”)。
• 网络名称 (SSID):默认网络名称是型号名,最大长度为 22 个字符
(不包括“Direct-xx-”)。
• 网络密钥是一个数字字符串,大小为 8~64 个字符。
12 无线网络设置完成后,断开计算机与打印机之间的 USB 电缆连接。
单击下一步。
13 当出现确认打印机连接窗口时,单击下一步。
14 选择要安装的组件。单击下一步。
15 选择组件后,还可以更改打印机的名称,设置要在网络上共享的打
印机,将打印机设置为默认打印机以及更改每台打印机的端口名
称。单击下一步。
16 完成安装后,将出现一个窗口,询问您是否打印测试页。如果要打
印测试页,请单击打印测试页。
否则,只需单击下一步,然后转到步骤 18。
17 如果测试页打印正确,请单击是。
否则,请单击否重新打印。
18 如果要在 Samsung 网站上注册您的打印机并接收实用信息,请单
击在线注册。否则单击完成。
接入点(通过 WPS 按钮,无 USB 电缆连接)
对于带 WPS 按钮的型号,您可以使用 WPS 按钮(不使用 USB 连接)和接
入点(或路由器)WPS 按钮设置无线网络。
准备事项
• 接入点(或无线路由器)
• 已连接网络的计算机无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 162
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的打印机
创建基础结构网络
1 打开计算机、接入点和机器。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 选择无线设置和安装选项。
4 阅读许可协议,然后选择我接受许可协议的条款。然后单击下一
步。
5 选择使用 WPS 按钮选项并单击下一步。
• 对于支持 WPS 按钮的型号,将显示以上窗口。
• 如果机器通过 USB 电缆连接,则不显示以上窗口。如果要使用
WPS 按钮设置无线网络,请断开 USB 电缆的连接。
• 如果要使用 USB 电缆设置无线网络,请参阅第 158 页上的“接入点
(通过 USB 电缆)”。
6 下一个窗口将要求您检查接入点(或无线路由器)是否支持 WPS。
如果接入点或(无线路由器)有 WPS 按钮,请选择是并单击下一
步。
7 按照窗口中的说明设置无线网络。
• 对于带显示屏的型号,请按照以下步骤操作。
a 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮约 2-4 秒钟。
机器最长会等待 2 分钟,在此期间您必须按下接入点(或路
由器)上的 WPS 按钮。
b 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
消息按以下顺序出现在显示屏上:
- 正在连接: 打印机正在连接接入点(或无线路由器)。
- 连接: 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将
保持点亮状态。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 163
- SSID 类型: 完成无线网络连接过程后,在显示屏上会显
示接入点的 SSID 信息。
• 对于不带显示屏的型号,请按照以下步骤操作。
a 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮约 2 到 4 秒钟,直至状态
LED 快速闪烁。
机器开始连接无线网络。LED 在按下接入点(或无线路由
器)上的 PBC 按钮前最多缓慢闪烁两分钟。
b 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
- 连接到接入点(或无线路由器)时,WPS LED 会快速闪
烁。
- 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持
点亮状态。
8 将显示无线网络设置完成窗口。单击下一步。
9 当出现确认打印机连接窗口时,单击下一步。
10 选择要安装的组件。单击下一步。
11 选择组件后,还可以更改打印机的名称,设置要在网络上共享的打
印机,将打印机设置为默认打印机以及更改每台打印机的端口名
称。单击下一步。
12 完成安装后,将出现一个窗口,询问您是否打印测试页。如果要打
印测试页,请单击打印测试页。
否则,只需单击下一步,然后转至步骤 14。
13 如果测试页打印正确,请单击是。
否则,请单击否重新打印。
14 如果要在 Samsung 网站上注册您的打印机并接收实用信息,请单
击在线注册。否则单击完成。
点对点(通过 USB 电缆)
如果没有接入点(AP),通过执行下面的简单步骤设置点对点无线网络,
仍可将机器无线连接到计算机。
准备事项
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
• USB 线
在 Windows 中创建点对点网络
1 检查 USB 线是否连接到打印机。
2 打开计算机和无线网络打印机。
3 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 164
4 选择无线设置和安装选项。
5 阅读许可协议,然后选择我接受许可协议的条款。然后单击下一
步。
6 软件会搜索无线网络。
如果软件无法搜索到网络,请检查计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线连接
是否正确,并遵照屏幕上的说明操作。
7 搜索无线网络之后,将会显示打印机所搜索到的无线网络列表。
如要使用 Samsung 默认点对点设置,请选择列表中的最后一个无
线网络,即网络名称 (SSID) 为 Portthru,信号为打印机自我网络。
然后单击下一步。
如要使用其他点对点设置,请从列表中选择其他无线网络。
如果要更改点对点设置,请单击高级设置按钮。
• 输入无线网络名称: 输入所需 SSID 名称(SSID 区分大小写)。
• 操作模式: 选择“点对点”。
• 通道: 选择通道。(自动设置或 2412 MHz 到 2467 MHz)。
• 验证: 选择验证类型。
开放系统: 不使用验证,并且是否采用加密,视数据安全的需要而
定。
共享密钥: 使用验证。只有拥有正确 WEP 密钥的设备才可访问网
络。
• 加密: 选择加密(无,WEP64,WEP128)。
• 网络密钥: 输入加密网络密钥值。
• 确认网络密钥: 确认加密网络密钥值。
• WEP 密钥索引: 如果使用 WEP 加密,请选择相应的 WEP 密钥索
引。
当点对点网络启用安全性时,会出现无线网络安全窗口。
验证方法选择开放系统或共享密钥,然后单击下一步。
• WEP(有线等效保密)是一种防止非法访问无线网络的安全协议。
WEP 使用 64 位或 128 位 WEP 加密密钥,对在无线网络上交换的
每个数据包的数据部分进行加密。
8 出现显示无线网络设置的窗口。检查设置,然后单击下一步。
在输入打印机的 IP 地址之前,必须了解计算机的网络配置信息。如果
将计算机的网络配置设置为 DHCP,则无线网络设置也应为 DHCP。
同样,如果将计算机的网络配置设置为静态,则无线网络设置也应为
静态。
如果计算机设置为 DHCP,但用户想要使用“静态”无线网络设置,则必
须联系网络管理员以获取静态 IP 地址。
• 对于 DHCP 方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为 DHCP,请检查 DHCP 是否显示在无线网
络设置确认窗口中。如果显示为静态,则单击更改 TCP/IP 将分配方
法更改为自动接收 IP 地址 (DHCP)。
• 对于静态方法无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 165
如果 IP 地址分配方法“静态”,请检查无线网络设置确认窗口中是否
显示“静态”。如果显示 DHCP,请单击更改 TCP/IP 以输入打印机的
IP 地址和其他网络配置值。
例如:
如果计算机的网络信息如下所示:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.42
- 子网掩码: 255.255.0.0
则打印机的网络信息应如下:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.43
- 子网掩码:255.255.0.0(使用计算机的子网掩码)
- 网关: 169.254.133.1
9 将显示无线网络设置完成窗口。单击下一步。
10 无线网络设置完成后,断开计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线连接。单
击下一步。
如果出现更改 PC 网络设置窗口,请按照窗口上的步骤进行操作。
完成计算机的无线网络设置后,请单击下一步。
如果将计算机的无线网络设置为 DHCP,则需要几分钟才能接收到 IP
地址。
11 当出现 确认打印机连接 窗口时,单击下一步。
12 选择要安装的组件。单击下一步。
13 选择组件后,还可以更改打印机的名称,设置要在网络上共享的打
印机,将打印机设置为默认打印机以及更改每台打印机的端口名
称。单击下一步。
14 完成安装后,将出现一个窗口,询问您是否打印测试页。如果要打
印测试页,请单击打印测试页。
否则,只需单击下一步,然后转至步骤 16。
15 如果测试页打印正确,请单击是。
否则,请单击否重新打印。
16 如果要在 Samsung 网站上注册您的打印机并接收实用信息,请单
击在线注册。否则单击完成。
17
使用 Macintosh 设置
准备事项
• 接入点
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
• USB 线无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 166
接入点(通过 USB 电缆)
1 检查 USB 线是否连接到打印机。
2 打开计算机,接入点和打印机。
3 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
4 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
5 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Installer OS X 图标。
6 单击继续。
7 阅读许可协议,然后单击继续。
8 单击同意接受许可协议。
9 当屏幕上出现关于计算机上的所有应用程序将被关闭的警告消息
时,请单击继续。
10 在用户选项窗格中单击无线网络设置。
11 软件会搜索无线网络。
如果软件无法搜索到网络,请检查计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线
连接是否正确,并遵照屏幕上的说明操作。
• 如果之前配置过无线网络设置,将显示无线网络设置信息窗口。
如果要重置无线设置,请选中复选框并单击下一步。
• 要查看支持 WPS 按钮(不使用 USB 电缆连接)的型号,将显示以
下窗口。
- 使用 USB 线缆:连接 USB 电缆并单击“下一步”,然后转到步骤
7。
- 使用 WPS 按钮:请参见第 161 页上的“接入点(通过 WPS 按钮,
无 USB 电缆连接)”。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 167
12 从无线设置方法窗口中选择要使用的方法。
• 手动配置无线设置。:转到步骤 13。
• 通过按下接入点的 WPS 按钮配置无线设置。:通过按接入点
(或无线路由器)上的 WPS 按钮连接到无线网络。
- 按照窗口中的说明进行操作。配置完无线网络设置后,转到
步骤 16。
13 搜索后,窗口中会显示无线网络设备。选择正在使用的接入点名称
(SSID),然后单击下一步。
如果手动设置无线配置,则单击高级设置。
• 输入无线网络名称: 输入接入点的 SSID(SSID 区分大小写)。
• 操作模式: 选择基础结构。
• 验证: 选择验证类型。
开放系统: 不使用验证,并且是否采用加密,视数据安全的需要而
定。
共享密钥: 使用验证。只有拥有正确 WEP 密钥的设备才可访问网
络。
WPA Personal 或 WPA2 Personal: 选择该选项,以根据“WPA 预
共享密钥”验证打印服务器。此验证使用在接入点及其每个客户端
上手动配置的共享密钥(通常称为预共享密钥口令)。
• 加密: 选择加密(无、WEP64、WEP128、TKIP、AES、TKIP、AES)
• 网络密钥: 输入加密网络密钥值。
• 确认网络密钥: 确认加密网络密钥值。
• WEP 密钥索引: 如果使用 WEP 加密,请选择相应的 WEP 密钥索
引。
当接入点启用安全性时,会显示无线网络安全窗口。
出现无线网络安全窗口。该窗口可能会根据安全模式的不同而异:
WEP 或 WPA。
• WEP
针对验证选择开放系统或共享密钥,然后输入 WEP 安全密钥。单
击下一步。
WEP(有线等效保密)是一种防止非法访问无线网络的安全协议。
WEP 使用 64 位或 128 位 WEP 加密密钥,对在无线网络上交换的
每个数据包的数据部分进行加密。
• WPA
输入 WPA 共享密钥,然后单击下一步。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 168
WPA 根据定期自动变更的密钥对用户授权和识别用户。WPA 还使
用 TKIP(暂时密钥完整性协议)和 AES(高级加密标准)进行数据
加密。
14 该窗口会显示无线网络设置并检查设置是否正确。单击下一步。
• 对于 DHCP 方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为 DHCP,检查窗口中是否显示 DHCP。
如果显示为静态,则单击更改 TCP/IP 将分配方法更改为
DHCP。
• 对于静态方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为静态,则检查“静态”是否显示在窗口
中。如果显示 DHCP,请单击更改 TCP/IP 以输入打印机的 IP 地
址和其他网络配置值。在输入打印机的 IP 地址之前,必须了解
计算机的网络配置信息。如果计算机设置为 DHCP,则必须联
系网络管理员以获取静态 IP 地址。
例如:
如果计算机的网络信息如下所示:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.42
- 子网掩码: 255.255.0.0
则机器的网络信息应如下:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.43
- 子网掩码:255.255.0.0(使用计算机的子网掩码)
- 网关: 169.254.133.1
15 当告诉您网络电缆连接已确认的窗口显示时,断开网络电缆连接并
单击下一步。
如果接上网络电缆,它在配置无线网络时可能较难找到机器。
16 无线网络设置完成。要从支持无线直连的移动设备进行打印,请设
置无线直连选项(请参见第 176 页上的“设置无线直连”)。
Wi-Fi Direct 选项:
• 无线直连选项仅在打印机支持此功能时显示在屏幕上。
• 可以通过 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 开始构建无线直连(请参见第
176 页上的“设置无线直连”)。
• 网络名称 (SSID):默认网络名称是型号名,最大长度为 22 个字符(不包括
“Direct-xx-”)。
• 网络密钥是一个数字字符串,大小为 8~64 个字符。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 169
17 无线网络设置完成后,断开计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线连接。
18 无线网络设置完成。安装完成后,请单击退出。
完成无线网络连接后,需要安装打印机驱动程序才能从应用程序进行
打印(请参见第 130 页上的“Macintosh 安装”)。
使用 WPS 按钮设置接入点
对于带 WPS 按钮的型号,您可以使用 WPS 按钮(不使用 USB 连接)和接
入点(或路由器)WPS 按钮设置无线网络。
准备事项
• 接入点(或无线路由器)
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
创建基础结构网络
1 打开计算机、接入点和机器。
2 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
3 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
4 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Installer OS X 图标。
5 单击继续。
6 阅读许可协议,然后单击继续。
7 单击同意接受许可协议。
8 当屏幕上出现关于计算机上的所有应用程序将被关闭的警告消息
时,请单击继续。
9 在用户选项窗格中单击无线网络设置。
10 选择使用 WPS 按钮选项并单击下一步。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 170
• 对于支持 WPS 按钮的型号,将显示以上窗口。
• 如果机器通过 USB 电缆连接,则不显示以上窗口。如果要使用
WPS 按钮设置无线网络,请断开 USB 电缆的连接。
• 如果要使用 USB 电缆设置无线网络,请参阅第 166 页上的“接入点
(通过 USB 电缆)”。
11 下一个窗口将要求您检查接入点(或无线路由器)是否支持 WPS。
如果接入点或(无线路由器)有 WPS 按钮,请选择是并单击下一
步。
12 按照窗口中的说明设置无线网络。
• 对于带显示屏的型号,请按照以下步骤操作:
a 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮约 2-4 秒钟。
机器最长会等待 2 分钟,在此期间您必须按下接入点(或路
由器)上的 WPS 按钮。
b 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
消息按以下顺序出现在显示屏上:
- 正在连接: 打印机正在连接接入点(或无线路由器)。
- 连接: 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将
保持点亮状态。
- SSID 类型: 完成无线网络连接过程后,在显示屏上会显
示接入点的 SSID 信息。
• 对于不带显示屏的型号,请按照以下步骤操作:
a 按住控制面板上的 (WPS) 按钮约 2 到 4 秒钟,直至状态
LED 快速闪烁。
机器开始连接无线网络。LED 在按下接入点(或无线路由
器)上的 PBC 按钮前最多缓慢闪烁两分钟。
b 按下接入点(或无线路由器)上的 WPS (PBC) 按钮。
- WPS LED 的灯光快速闪烁。打印机正在连接接入点(或
无线路由器)。
- 当打印机成功连接到无线网络时,WPS LED 灯将保持
点亮状态。
13 无线网络设置完成。安装完成后,请单击退出。
完成无线网络连接后,需要安装打印机驱动程序才能从应用程序进行
打印(请参见第 130 页上的“Macintosh 安装”)。
点对点(通过 USB 电缆)
如果没有接入点(AP),通过执行下面的简单说明设置点对点无线网络,
仍可将机器无线连接到计算机。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 171
准备事项
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
• USB 线
在 Macintosh 中创建点对点网络
1 检查 USB 线是否连接到打印机。
2 打开计算机和无线网络打印机。
3 在 CD-ROM 驱动器中插入随附的软件光盘。
4 双击在您 Macintosh 桌面上出现的光盘图标。
5 双击 MAC_Installer 文件夹 > Installer OS X 图标。
6 单击继续。
7 阅读许可协议,然后单击继续。
8 单击同意接受许可协议。
9 当屏幕上出现关于计算机上的所有应用程序将被关闭的警告消息
时,请单击继续。
10 在用户选项窗格中单击无线网络设置。
11 软件会搜索无线网络设备。
如果搜索失败,可检查计算机和打印机之间的 USB 线连接是否正确,
然后遵照窗口中的说明进行操作。
12 搜索无线网络之后,将会显示打印机所搜索到的无线网络列表。
如要使用 Samsung 默认点对点设置,请选择列表中最后一个无线
网络,即网络名称 (SSID) 为 Portthru,信号为打印机自我网络。
然后单击下一步。
如要使用其他点对点设置,请从列表中选择其他无线网络。
如要更改点对点设置,请单击高级设置按钮。
• 输入无线网络名称: 输入 SSID 名称(SSID 区分大小写)。
• 操作模式: 选择“点对点”。
• 通道: 选择通道(自动设置或 2412 MHz - 2467 MHz)。
• 验证: 选择验证类型。
开放系统: 不使用验证,并且是否采用加密,视数据安全的需要而
定。
共享密钥: 使用验证。只有拥有正确 WEP 密钥的设备才可访问网
络。
• 加密: 选择加密(无,WEP64,WEP128)。
• 网络密钥: 输入加密网络密钥值。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 172
• 确认网络密钥: 确认加密网络密钥值。
• WEP 密钥索引: 如果使用 WEP 加密,请选择相应的 WEP 密钥索
引。
当点对点网络拥有安全设置时,会出现无线网络安全窗口。
验证方法选择开放系统或共享密钥,然后单击下一步。
• WEP(有线等效保密)是一种防止非法访问无线网络的安全协议。
WEP 使用 64 位或 128 位 WEP 加密密钥,对在无线网络上交换的
每个数据包的数据部分进行加密。
13 出现显示无线网络设置的窗口。检查设置,然后单击下一步。
在输入打印机的 IP 地址之前,必须了解计算机的网络配置信息。如果
将计算机的网络配置设置为 DHCP,则无线网络设置也应为 DHCP。
同样,如果将计算机的网络配置设置为静态,则无线网络设置也应为
静态。
如果计算机设置为 DHCP,却要使用静态无线网络设置,则必须联系
网络管理员以获取静态 IP 地址。
• 对于 DHCP 方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法为 DHCP,请检查 DHCP 是否显示在无线网
络设置确认窗口中。如果显示为静态,则单击更改 TCP/IP 将分配方
法更改为自动接收 IP 地址 (DHCP)。
• 对于静态方法
如果 IP 地址分配方法“静态”,请检查无线网络设置确认窗口中是否
显示“静态”。如果显示 DHCP,请单击更改 TCP/IP 以输入打印机的
IP 地址和其他网络配置值。
例如:
如果计算机的网络信息如下所示:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.42
- 子网掩码: 255.255.0.0
则机器的网络信息应如下:
- IP 地址: 169.254.133.43
- 子网掩码:255.255.0.0(使用计算机的子网掩码)
- 网关: 169.254.133.1无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 173
14 当告诉您网络电缆连接已确认的窗口显示时,断开网络电缆连接并
单击下一步。
如果接上网络电缆,它在配置无线网络时可能较难找到机器。
15 无线网络根据网络配置进行连接。
16 无线网络设置完成。安装完成后,请单击退出。
完成无线网络连接后,需要安装打印机驱动程序才能从应用程序进行
打印(请参见第 130 页上的“Macintosh 安装”)。
18
使用网络电缆
不支持网络端口的机器无法使用此功能(请参见第 23 页上的“后视图
”)。
本产品是一款网络兼容打印机。要使机器能够联网使用,需要执行一些配
置步骤。
• 完成无线网络连接后,需要安装打印机驱动程序才能从应用程序进
行打印(请参见第 140 页上的“通过网络安装驱动程序”)。
• 有关网络配置的信息,请询问网络管理员或无线网络的安装人员。
准备事项
• 接入点
• 已连接网络的计算机
• 本机随附软件光盘
• 装有无线网络接口的机器
• 网线
打印网络配置报告
可以通过打印网络配置报告来确认打印机的网络设置。
请参见第 137 页上的“打印网络配置报告”。
使用 SetIP 程序(Windows)进行 IP 设置
该程序用于使用打印机的 MAC 地址手动设置网络 IP 地址,以便与打印机
通信。MAC 地址是网络接口的硬件序列号,可在网络配置报告中找到。
请参见第 137 页上的“设置 IP 地址”。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 174
配置机器的无线网络
开始之前,需要了解无线网络的网络名称(SSID),如果经过加密,则还需
要了解网络密钥。当安装接入点(或无线路由器)后设置该信息。如果不了
解无线网络,请咨询网络的设置人员。
要配置无线参数,可以使用 SyncThru™ Web Service。
使用 SyncThru™ Web Service
在开始配置无线参数之前,先检查线缆连接状态。
1 检查打印机是否连接网线。如果未连接,请为打印机连接标准网
线。
2 启动 Internet Explorer,Safari 或 Firefox 等 Web 浏览器,并在机器
窗口中输入打印机的新 IP 地址。
例如:
3 单击 SyncThru™ Web Service 网站右上角的 登录。
4 键入 ID 和 密码,然后单击登录。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
5 当 SyncThru™ Web Service 窗口打开时,单击网络设置。
6 单击无线 > 向导。
向导将帮助您设置无线网络配置。然而,如果您希望直接设置无线网
络,请选择自定义。
7 在列表中选择一个网络名称 (SSID)。
• SSID:SSID(服务集标识符)是标识无线网络的名称。接入点和
试图连接至特定无线网络的无线设备必须使用相同的 SSID。
SSID 区分大小写。
• 操作模式:操作模式是指无线连接的类型(请参见第 151 页上的“
无线网络名称和网络密钥”)。
- 点对点:允许无线设备在对等环境中彼此直接进行通信。
- 基础结构:允许无线设备通过接入点彼此进行通信。
如果网络的操作模式为基础结构,请选择接入点的 SSID。如果操作模
式为点对点,请选择机器的 SSID。请注意,“portthru”为机器的默认
SSID。
8 单击下一步。
如果出现无线安全设置窗口,请输入注册的密码(网络密钥),然后
单击下一步。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 175
9 确认窗口出现后,请检查无线设置。如果设置正确,则单击应用。
断开网线连接(标准或网络)。打印机然后将开始与网络进行无线通
信。在点对点模式下,您可以同步使用无线 LAN 和有线 LAN。
19
开关 Wi-Fi 网络
如果机器带显示屏,您也可以从机器的控制面板中通过网络菜单打开/
关闭无线。
1 检查网线是否连接到打印机。如果未连接,请为打印机连接标准网
线。
2 启动 Internet Explorer,Safari 或 Firefox 等 Web 浏览器,并在机器
窗口中输入打印机的新 IP 地址。
例如:
3 单击 SyncThru™ Web Service 网站右上角的 登录。
4 键入 ID 和密码,然后单击登录。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
5 当 SyncThru™ Web Service 窗口打开时,单击网络设置。
6 单击无线 > 自定义。
也可开关 Wi-Fi 网络。
20
为移动打印设置无线直连
无线直连是打印机和移动设备之间的一种简单易用的对等连接方法,它提
供安全连接并且吞吐量优于点对点模式。
借助无线直连,您可以将打印机连接到无线直连网络,同时连接的接入
点。您还可以同时使用有线网络和无线直连网络,这样多个用户可以通过
无线直连和有线网络访问和打印文档。
• 无法通过打印机的无线直连连接到 Internet。
• 支持的协议列表可能因型号不同而异,无线直连网络不支持 IPv6、
网络过滤、IPSec、WINS 和 SLP 服务。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 176
设置无线直连
您可以通过以下方法之一启用无线直连功能。
从 USB 电缆连接的计算机(推荐)
• 通过提供的软件 CD 设置时,您将看到通过 USB 电缆的接入点。
- Windows 用户,请参见第 158 页上的“接入点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
- Macintosh 用户,请参见第 166 页上的“接入点(通过 USB 电缆)”。
• 完成驱动程序安装后,可以设置 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 并在
无线直连中做出更改。
Samsung Easy Printer Manager 只适用于 Windows 和 Macintosh OS
用户。
- 从开始菜单中,选择程序或所有程序 > Samsung Printers >
Samsung Easy Printer Manager > 设备设置 > 网络。
▪ Wi-Fi Direct 打开/关闭:选择开启用它。
▪ 设备名称:输入打印机的名称,在无线网络上搜索您的打印机。
默认情况下,设备名称是型号名称。
▪ IP 地址:输入打印机的 IP 地址。这个 IP 地址只适用于本地网
络,不适用于基础设施有限或无线网络。我们推荐使用默认的
本地 IP 地址(打印机无线直连的默认本地 IP 地址是
192.168.3.1)
▪ 组所有者:激活此选项,将打印机分配到无线直连组的所有人。
组所有者类似于无线接入点。我们推荐激活此选项。
▪ 网络密钥:如果您的打印机是组所有者,则其他移动设备连接
到您的打印机就需要网络密钥。您可以自己配置网络密钥,或
是记住默认情况下随机生成的给定网络密钥。
从机器(带显示屏的机器)
• 从控制面板中选择网路 > 无线 > 无线直连。
• 启用无线直连。
从连接到网络的计算机
如果打印机使用网络电缆或无线接入点,您可以从 SyncThru™ Web
Service 启用和配置无线直连。
• 访问 SyncThru™ Web Service,选择设置 > 网络设置 > 无线 > 无线直
连。
• 启用或禁用无线直连并设置其他选项。
• 对于 Linux OS 用户,
- 打印 IP 网络配置报告可检查输出(请参见第 137 页上的“打印网
络配置报告”)。
- 访问 SyncThru Web 服务,选择设置 > 网络设置 > 无线 > Wi-Fi
Direct。
- 启用或禁用Wi-Fi Direct。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 177
设置移动设备
• 从打印机设置无线直连后,请参阅使用的移动设备的用户手册设置它
的无线直连。
• 设置无线直连后,您需要下载移动打印应用程序(例如:Samsung
Mobile 打印机)以便从智能手机上进行打印。
• 当找到要连接到移动设备的打印机时,选择打印机,打印机的 LED
会闪烁。按打印机上的 WPS 按钮,它将连接到您的移动设备。
• 如果移动设备不支持 WPS,您需要输入打印机的网络密钥而不是
按 WPS 按钮。
21
故障排除
设置或安装驱动程序时的问题
未找到打印机
• 可能未打开打印机。打开计算机和打印机。
• 计算机和打印机之间未连接 USB 线。使用 USB 电缆将打印机连接到
计算机。
• 打印机不支持无线联网。查看本机随附软件光盘中的用户指南,并准
备好无线网络机器。
连接失败 - 找不到 SSID
• 打印机找不到您选择或输入的网络名称 (SSID)。检查接入点上的网络
名称(SSID)并尝试重新连接。
• 接入点可能未打开。打开接入点。
连接失败 - 无效的安全性
• 未正确配置安全性。检查接入点和打印机的安全性配置。
连接失败 - 一般连接错误
• 计算机无法从机器收到信号。检查 USB 线以及打印机电源。
连接失败 - 已连接有线网络
• 打印机已连接有线网线。请从打印机上拔下有线网线。
PC 连接错误
• 配置的网络地址无法在计算机和打印机之间建立连接。
- 对于 DHCP 网络环境
如果计算机配置为采用 DHCP,则会自动接收 IP 地址(DHCP)。
- 对于静态网络环境
如果计算机配置为采用静态地址,则打印机使用静态地址。
例如:
如果计算机的网络信息如下所示:无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 178
▪ IP 地址: 169.254.133.42
▪ 子网掩码: 255.255.0.0
则打印机的网络信息应如下:
▪ IP 地址: 169.254.133.43
▪ 子网掩码:255.255.0.0(使用计算机的子网掩码)
▪ 网关: 169.254.133.1
其他问题
如果在网络中使用打印机时出现问题,请检查以下几方面:
有关接入点(或无线路由器)的信息,请参阅其用户指南。
• 计算机,接入点(或无线路由器)或打印机可能未开启。
• 检查打印机周围的无线接收。如果路由器远离打印机或中间有障碍,
就可能给信号接收带来困难。
• 关闭接入点(或无线路由器),打印机和计算机的电源,然后再重新启
动。有时重新启动会恢复网络通信。
• 检查防火墙软件(V3 或 Norton)是否封锁通信。
如果计算机和打印机连接在同一网络中却搜索不到,可能是因为防火
墙软件封锁了通信。请参阅防火墙软件的用户指南,将防火墙关闭,然
后重新尝试搜索打印机。
• 检查打印机 IP 地址的分配是否正确。可打印网络配置报告来检查 IP
地址。
• 检查接入点(或无线路由器)是否配置了安全性(密码)。如果有密码,
请询问接入点(或无线路由器)的管理员。
• 检查打印机的 IP 地址。重新安装打印机驱动程序并更改设置,以连接
到网络中的打印机。鉴于 DHCP 的特性,如果机器长时间不使用,或者
接入点被重置,则分配的 IP 地址可能会变化。
在接入点(或无线路由器)上配置 DHCP 服务器时,请注册产品的
MAC 地址。然后就始终可以使用根据 MAC 地址设置的 IP 地址。可以
通过打印网络配置报告识别打印机的 Mac 地址(请参见第 137 页上的
“打印网络配置报告”)。
• 检查无线环境。您可能无法在基础结构环境下连接网络,在该环境下
连接到接入点(或无线路由器)之前,需要输入用户信息。
• 此机器仅支持 IEEE 802.11 b/g/n 和 Wi-Fi。不支持其他无线通信类型
(如,蓝牙)。
• 在 Windows Vista 等操作系统下,使用点对点模式时,每次使用无线打
印机都需要设置无线连接设置。
• Samsung 无线网络打印机不能同时使用基础结构模式和点对点模式。
• 机器位于无线网络的范围内。
• 应让机器避开那些可能阻碍无线信号的障碍。
移除接入点(或无线路由器)同机器之间的任何大型金属物体。
确保机器和无线接入点(或无线路由器)没有被含有金属或水泥的立
柱、墙面或支柱隔开。无线网络设置
2. 使用联网机器 179
• 应让机器避开其他可能干扰无线信号的电子设备。
许多设备会干扰无线信号,包括微波炉和一些蓝牙设备。
• 每当接入点(或无线路由器)的配置发生变化时,您必须重新设置产品
的无线网络。2. 使用联网机器 180
Samsung MobilePrint
22
什么是 Samsung MobilePrint?
Samsung MobilePrint 是一款免费应用程序,它允许用户从智能手机或
Tablet 直接打印照片、文档和网页。Samsung MobilePrint 不仅与您的
Android、Windows 及 iOS 智能手机兼容,还与 iPod Touch 及 Tablet PC 兼
容。它将您的移动设备连接到联网的 Samsung 打印机,或通过 Wi-Fi 接入
点连接到无线打印机。无需安装新的驱动程序或配置网络设置-只需安装
Samsung MobilePrint 应用程序,它将自动检测兼容的 Samsung 打印
机。除了打印照片、网页和 PDF,还支持扫描。如果您有 Samsung 多功能
打印机,将任何文档扫描为 JPG、PDF 或 PNG 格式即可在移动设备上实
现快速、轻松的查看。
23
下载 Samsung MobilePrint
要下载 Samsung MobilePrint,通过移动设备访问应用程序商店并搜索
“Samsung MobilePrint”。也可以通过计算机访问 iTunes(Apple 设备)或
Marketplace(Windows 设备)。
24
支持的移动操作系统
• Android OS 2.1 或更高版本
• iOS 4.0 或更高版本
• Windows Phone 7 或更高版本
25
支持的设备
• iOS 4.0 或更高版本: iPod Touch、iPhone、iPad
• Android 2.1 或更高版本: Galxy S、Galaxy S2、Galaxy Tab 和 Android
移动设备
• Windows Phone 7 或更高版本: Samsung Windows Phone(Focus、
Omnia7 和 OmniaW)3. 实用设置菜单
本章介绍如何浏览机器的当前状态,以及对高级机器设置进行配置的方法。
• 开始阅读章节前 182
• 打印菜单 183
• 复印菜单 184
• 传真菜单 190
• 扫描菜单 193
• 系统设置 195
• 管理员设置 206
• 自定义设置 2073. 实用设置菜单 182
开始阅读章节前
本章解释这一系列型号提供的所有功能,帮助用户轻松理解这些功能。您可以通过基本指南(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)检查各个型号提供的功
能。以下是使用本章的一些提示
• 使用控制面板可进入不同菜单,从而设置机器或使用机器的功能。按 (菜单)可以访问这些菜单。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能不适用于您的机器。
• 对于控制面板没有 (菜单)的型号,此功能不适用(请参见第 24 页上的“控制面板概览”)。
• 根据机器的选件或机型,某些菜单的名称可能与您的机器不同。3. 实用设置菜单 183
打印菜单
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 打印设置。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 打印设置。
项目 描述
方向 选择在页面上打印信息的方向。
份数 您可以使用数字键盘输入复印份数。
分辨率
指定每英寸的打印点数 (dpi)。分辨率设置越高,打印
的字符和图形就越清晰。
暗度
减淡或加深页面上的打印内容。正常设置通常可以获
得最佳效果。使用浅色墨粉密度可以节省墨粉。
加黑文本 打印文本时使其颜色比正常文档更深。
模拟 设置模拟类型和选项。3. 实用设置菜单 184
复印菜单
1
复印功能
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印功能。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 复印默认值。
• 或按触摸屏上的复印 > 选择所需菜单项。
项目 描述
• 扫描范围
• 原始尺寸
设置图像大小。
份数 您可以使用数字键盘输入复印份数。
缩小/放大
缩小或放大复印图像的尺寸(请参见第 59 页上的“
缩小或放大的复印件”)。
如果机器设置为环保模式,则缩小和放大功
能不可用。
暗度
当原件包含模糊标记和深色图像时,可以调整亮度
使复印件清晰易读(请参见第 58 页上的“明暗度
”)。
对比度
当原稿包含的内容太浅或太深时,可以调整对比度
等级,使原稿更容易读取(请参见第 58 页上的“暗
度”)。
原稿类型
通过为当前复印作业选择文档类型,从而提高复印
质量(请参见第 58 页上的“原始”)。
方向 设置原件图像的方向。
版式
调整海报、克隆、ID 复印、2/4 页缩印、小册子等版
式格式。
项目 描述复印菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 185
• 复印分页
• 校对副本
设置机器,对复印作业进行排序。例如,如果复印 2
份 3 页的原件,一份完整的 3 页文档复印完毕后,
才会开始复印第二份完整的文档。
• 打开: 以成套方式打印输出,以符合原件的顺序。
• 关闭: 将打印输出按页分摞。
• 2页缩印或 单面4页
• N 份副本
缩小原始图像的尺寸,并在一张纸上打印 2 页或 4
页。
只有当您将原件装入进稿器时,才能使用这
个复印功能。
项目 描述
1 2
1 2
3 4
海报复印
将单页文档打印到 4(海报 2x2)、9(海报 3x3)或
16(海报 4x4)页纸上,这样可以将纸张粘贴到一起
形成海报大小的文档。
• 只有当您将原件放在扫描仪玻璃板上时,
才可以使用此复印功能。
• 原件分为 9 部分。每一部分按以下顺序逐
份扫描并打印:
项目 描述复印菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 186
克隆复印
在一页上打印多个原始图像。图像数量根据原件图
像和纸张大小自动确定。
• 只有当您将原件放在扫描仪玻璃板上时,
才可以使用此复印功能。
• 不能使用缩小/放大功能的克隆复印调节
复印尺寸。
项目 描述
书本复印
书籍复印功能允许您复印整本书籍。如果书籍过
厚,请抬起盖板,直到转轴与挡块相触,然后合上扫
描仪盖。如果书籍或杂志厚度超过 30 毫米,则应打
开盖板复印。
• 关闭: 不使用此功能。
• 左页: 使用此选项打印书籍的左页。
• 右页: 使用此选项打印书籍的右页。
• 底页: 使用此选项打印书籍的左右页。
只有当您将原件放在扫描仪玻璃板上时,才
可以使用此复印功能。
项目 描述复印菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 187
书册
机器将自动进行单面或双面打印,然后折叠制作成
所有页面按正确顺序排列的书册。
机器将缩小图像并正确调整每个图像的位置,以便
适应选定的纸张。
调节背景
打印图像(但不打印背景)。此复印功能可以去掉背
景色,在复印带有彩色背景的原件(如报纸或编录)
时很有帮助。
• 关闭: 不使用此功能。
• 自动: 优化背景。
• 增强级别 1~2: 数字越大,背景越鲜艳。
• 清除级别 1~4: 数字越大,背景越亮。
项目 描述
页边距移位复印
允许您为文档创建装订边。可将图像在页面上进行
上下和(或)左右移动。
• 关闭: 不使用此功能。
• 自动居中: 自动复印到纸张中心。只有将原件放
在扫描仪玻璃板上时,才能使用此功能。
• 自定义页边距: 使用数字键盘输入左、右、上、下
边距。
项目 描述复印菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 188
除边复印
允许您擦除文档四边中任意一边的斑点、孔、折痕
和装订印记。
• 关闭: 不使用此功能。
• 较小原稿: 如果原稿较小,则擦除边缘。只有将原
件放在扫描仪玻璃板上时,才能使用此功能。
• 打孔: 擦除书籍装订孔印记。
• 书册居中: 复印书籍时,擦除纸张中间的黑色水
平痕迹。只有将原件放在扫描仪玻璃板上时,才
能使用此功能。
• 去除边界: 使用数字键盘输入左、右、上、下边
距。
灰度增强复印
进行灰度复印时,使用该功能可获得质量更好的复
印件。
水印复印
水印选项可允许在已有文档上打印文字。例如,如
果您希望有大的灰色字母“草稿”或“机密”在文档的
第一页或所有页上对角打印,则可以使用此功能。
项目 描述
双面
您可以设置机器以便在纸张的双面打印文档。
• 关闭: 正常模式打印。
• 1->2 面短边
• 1->2 面长边
双面(续)
• 2->1 面
• 2->2 面
• 2->1 面旋转 2
项目 描述
2
5
3复印菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 189
2
复印设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
按控制面板上的 (复印)> (菜单)> 复印设置。
项目 描述
更改默认设置 将值或设置重置为打印机的开箱状态。3. 实用设置菜单 190
传真菜单
3
传真功能
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 传真默认值。
• 或按触摸屏上的传真 > 选择所需菜单项。
项目 描述
• 扫描范围
• 原始尺寸
设置图像大小。
对比度
当原稿包含的内容太浅或太深时,可以调整对比度
等级,使原稿更容易读取。
暗度
当原稿包含模糊标记和深色图像时,可以调整亮
度,使原稿更容易读取(请参见第 65 页上的“暗度
”)。
分辨率
使用基于文本的典型原件时,默认文档设置可以产
生良好的传真效果。但在发送质量低劣的或含有照
片的原件时,可以调整分辨率以获得更高质量的传
真效果(请参见第 64 页上的“分辨率”)。
双面 在一张纸的两面打印接收的传真。
多方发送
将一份传真发送到多个目标(请参见第 63 页上的“
将传真发送至多个目标”)。
不能使用此功能发送彩色传真。
延迟发送
可以将机器设置为在您离开后发送传真(请参见第
243 页上的“延迟传真传送”)。
不能使用此功能发送彩色传真。
优先发送
将原件扫描到内存中,并在当前操作结束时立即传
送。在站点之间(例如,向站点 A 的传送结束之后,
在向站点 B 传送开始之前)或在重拨操作之间,优
先级传送将中断向多个目标发送(请参见第 244 页
上的“发送优先传真”)。
项目 描述传真菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 191
4
发送设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 发送。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 传真默认值。
转发
将收到或发出的传真通过传真或 PC 转发到其他目
标。如果不在办公室但必须接收传真,则该功能可
能会有用。
• 请参见第 244 页上的“将已发传真转发到另一个
目标”。
• 请参见第 245 页上的“转发已接收的传真”。
安全接收
将收到的传真存储在内存中,并且不打印出来。要
打印收到的文档,您需要输入密码。您可以防止未
经授权的人员查看收到的传真(请参见第 249 页上
的“以安全接收模式接收”)。
添加页面
将其他文档添加到预定的延迟传真作业(请参见第
243 页上的“在预定传真中添加文档”)。
取消作业
取消保存在内存中的延迟传真作业(请参见第 244
页上的“取消预定传真作业”)。
项目 描述
项目 描述
重拨次数
设置重拨尝试次数。如果您输入 0,则机器将不会重
拨。
重拨期限 设置自动重拨前的时间间隔。
拨号前缀
最多可以设置 5 位数的前缀。在自动拨号之前,系
统先拨打此号码。这用于接入 PABX 交换系统。
ECM 模式
使用错误校正模式 (ECM) 发送传真,确保传真顺利
发出。它所用的时间可能更长。
发送报告
将机器设置为无论成功发送与否,都打印报告。如
果选择打开-错误,则机器只在传输不成功时打印报
告。
图像 TCR
打印传送报告,其中包含已发送的第一页传真的最
小化图像。
拨号模式
将拨号模式设置为音调或脉冲。该设置是否可用取
决于您所在的国家/地区。
节省话费
在预设的廉价通话时间发送传真,从而节省电话
费。该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区。传真菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 192
5
接收设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 接收。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 传真默认值。
安装向导
使您能轻松配置必要的传真选项,如设备 ID、传真
号码等。
项目 描述
接收模式 选择默认传真接收模式。
响铃应答 指定应答来电之前机器响铃的次数。
接收署名盖章
在接收的每页传真的底部自动打印页码、接收日期
和时间。
项目 描述
接收开始代码
从插入机器背部 EXT(分机)插槽的电话分机上接
收传真。如果拿起电话分机并听到传真音,请输入
此代码。出厂时此代码预设为 *9*。
自动缩小
自动缩小收到的传真页,使它适合装入机器中的纸
张大小。
废弃尺寸 废弃收到的传真末尾的特定长度。
垃圾传真设置
屏蔽作为垃圾传真号存储在内存中的任何不想接收
的传真。该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地
区。
DRPD模式
允许用户使用一条线路应答多个不同的电话号码。
您可以将机器设置为可识别各个号码的不同响铃模
式。该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区(请
参见第 248 页上的“使用 DRPD 模式接收传真”)。
双面打印 双面打印接收到的传真数据。这样可以节省用纸。
• 文档箱保存
• 文档框保存
将收到的传真存储在公共箱中。仅当已安装可选的
大容量存储设备 (HDD) 驱动器时显示此菜单(请参
见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。
项目 描述3. 实用设置菜单 193
扫描菜单
6
扫描功能
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (扫描)> (菜单)> 扫描功能。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 扫描默认值。
• 或按触摸屏上的扫描 > 选择所需菜单项。
7
扫描设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
项目 描述
• USB 默认值
• USB
将扫描目标设置为 USB。扫描原件并将扫描的图像
保存到 USB 设备。
• 电子邮件默认
• 发送电子邮件
• 自定义电子邮件
将扫描目标设置为电子邮件。扫描原件并将扫描的
图像通过电子邮件发送到目标(请参见第 233 页上
的“扫描至电子邮件”)。
• FTP 默认值
• FTP
将扫描目标设置为 FTP 服务器。扫描原件并将扫描
的图像发送到 FTP 服务器(请参见第 234 页上的“
扫描至 FTP/SMB 服务器”)。
• SMB 默认值
• SMB
将扫描目标设置为 SMB 服务器。扫描原件并将扫
描的图像发送到 SMB 服务器(请参见第 234 页上
的“扫描至 FTP/SMB 服务器”)。
发送报告 打印确认报告,表明已扫描图像的发送是否成功。
本地 PC
将扫描目标设置为通过 USB 连接的计算机。扫描原
稿并将扫描出的图像保存到我的文档等目录(请参
见第 61 页上的“基本扫描”)。
网络 PC
将扫描目标设置为通过网络连接的计算机。扫描原
稿并将扫描出的图像保存到我的文档等目录(请参
见第 232 页上的“从联网机器扫描”)。
文档框
将扫描目标设置为文档框。扫描原稿并将扫描出的
图像发送到机器中名为文档框的存储位置。
共享框
将扫描目标设置为一个共享文件夹。您可以创建并
使用共享文件夹(请参见第 251 页上的“使用共享文
件夹功能”)。
项目 描述扫描菜单
3. 实用设置菜单 194
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板上的 (扫描)> (菜单)> 扫描设置。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 默认设置 > 扫描默认值。
项目 描述
• 扫描范围
• 原始尺寸
设置图像大小。
原稿类型 设置原件文档的类型。
分辨率 设置图像分辨率。
颜色模式 设置颜色模式。
文件格式
设置要保存图像的文件格式。如果选择 BMP、
JPEG、TIFF 或 PDF,您可以选择扫描多页。
暗度 调整扫描的亮度等级。
对比度 调整对比度等级,使扫描件比原件略浅或略深。3. 实用设置菜单 195
系统设置
8
机器设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 设备设置 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 初始设置。
项目 描述
设备 ID 设置机器 ID,将在发送的每个传真页顶部打印它。
传真号码 设置传真号码,将在发送的每个传真页顶部打印它。
日期和时间 设置日期和时间。
时钟模式 在 12 小时制和 24 小时制之间选择时间显示格式。
表单菜单
• 关闭: 正常模式打印。
• 单表单: 使用第一个表单打印所有页。
• 双表单: 使用第一个表单打印封面,使用第二个表
单打印封底。
选择表单
表单叠加是指以特殊文件格式存储在打印机大容量
存储设备 (HDD) 中的图像,可以在任何文档的层中打
印它们。
HDD 假脱机
如果是打开,则将文档存储在大容量存储设备 (HDD)
中进行网络打印。
语言 设置控制面板显示屏上出现的文本所使用的语言。
默认模式
将机器的默认模式设置为传真模式、复印模式或扫描
模式。
默认纸张尺寸 您可以设置要使用的默认纸张大小。
节能
设置机器在进入节能模式之前需要等待的时间。
机器在一定时间内不接收数据时,耗电量会自动降
低。
扫描节能
设置机器的扫描仪部件在进入省电模式之前等待的
时间。
如果扫描仪长时间不接收数据,将自动降低功耗。
系统超时
设置机器记住之前所用的复印设置的时间。超时后,
机器将恢复默认复印设置。
作业超时
设置在打印机未以打印最后一页作为命令结束打印
作业时,打印机等待打印该页面的时间。
项目 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 196
叫醒事件
您可以设置从节能模式唤醒机器的条件。将该项设置
为开。
• 按钮: 按下除电源按钮以外的任何按钮,将从节能
模式中唤醒机器。
• 扫描仪: 将纸张放入进稿器时,将从节能模式中唤
醒机器。
• 打印机: 打开或关闭纸盘时,将从节能模式中唤醒
机器。
自动继续
决定机器在检测到纸张与纸张设置不匹配时是否继
续打印。
• 关闭: 如果纸张不匹配,机器将等待直至放入正确
的纸张。
• 打开: 如果纸张不匹配,将显示错误消息。机器将
等待约 30 秒,然后自动清除消息并继续打印。
• 高度调整
• 高度调整
根据机器海拔优化打印质量。
自动归位
允许您在每次换行后添加必要的回车,这对 Unix 用
户或 DOS 用户很有用。
固件版本 显示产品的固件版本。
自动完成
当您键入电子邮件地址或传真号码时提供建议。您无
需完全键入数据,就可以找到并选择它。
项目 描述
• 自动更换纸盘
• 自动纸盘开关
决定机器在检测到纸张不匹配时是否继续打印。例
如,如果纸盘 1 和纸盘 2 都装有相同大小的纸张,机
器在纸盘 1 中的纸张用完后将自动从纸盘 2 打印。
如果从打印机驱动程序为纸张来源选择自动,
则不显示该选项。
纸张更换
纸张更换
自动代替打印机驱动程序的纸张大小,防止 Letter 与
A4 之间的纸张不匹配。例如,如果纸盘中为 A4 纸
张,但您在打印机驱动程序中将纸张大小设置为
Letter,机器将在 A4 纸张上打印,反之亦然。
纸张不匹配
决定是否忽略纸张不匹配错误。如果选择关闭,即使
纸张不匹配,机器仍将打印。
打印空白页
打印机检测计算机发出的打印数据,判断是否为空白
页。您可以将它设置为打印或跳过空白页。
多槽
• 模式: 选择要使用的多槽模式。
• 默认纸槽: 选择要作为默认纸槽的纸槽。
默认来源 选择要作为默认纸盒的纸盒。
通讯簿 查看或打印电话簿或电子邮件地址列表。
项目 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 197
9
纸张设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 纸张设置 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 纸张设置。
维护
• 清洁感光鼓: 通过打印一页,清洁炭粉盒的 OPC
硒鼓。
• 清洁定影器: 通过打印一页,清洁定影器。
• 清除已空消息: 仅当墨粉盒为空时出现此选项。
• 耗材信息: 允许您检查已经打印的页数以及墨粉盒
内剩余的墨粉数量。
• “墨粉不足”警报: 如果墨粉盒中的墨粉已用完,会
显示一则提示用户更换墨粉盒的消息。可设置此
选项,以选择是否显示此消息。
• 纸张堆放: 如果您在潮湿地区使用机器,或者使用
由于湿度高而受潮的打印介质,则出纸盘上的打
印件可能会卷曲并且不能正确堆叠。在这种情况
下,可以将机器设置为使用功能,以便使打印件能
够紧密地堆叠。但是,使用此功能会降低打印速
度。
导入设置 将 USB 记忆棒中存储的数据导入机器。
导出设置 将 USB 记忆棒中存储的数据导出到机器。
节省炭粉
激活此模式可以延长墨粉盒的寿命并降低每页的成
本(与普通模式相比),但打印质量也会降低。
静音模式
开启此菜单可降低打印噪声。但打印速度和质量可能
下降。
项目 描述
环保设置
允许您节省打印资源并实现环保打印。
• 默认模式: 选择是否开启 Eco 模式。
强制(打开-强制):将 Eco 模式设置为使用密
码。如果用户要开启/关闭 Eco 模式,则必须输
入密码。
• 选择模板(选择模板): 从 SyncThru™ Web
Service 中选择环保模板集。
清除设置 恢复机器的出厂默认设置。
项目 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 198
10
声音/音量
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 声音/音量 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 初始设置 > 声音/音量。
项目 描述
纸张大小
根据您的需要将纸张大小设置为 A4、Letter 或其他纸
张大小。
纸张类型 为每个纸盘选择纸张类型。
纸张来源 选择使用哪个纸盘中的纸张。
边距 设置文档页边距。
纸盘确认
激活纸盘确认消息。如果打开或关闭某个纸盘,会显
示一个窗口询问您是否为刚才打开的纸盘设置纸张
大小和类型。
项目 描述
按键声音
打开或关闭按键声音。如果此选项设置为“开”,则每
次按键时都会发出提示音。
警报声音
打开或关闭警报音。如果此选项设置为“开”,每当发
生错误或传真通讯结束时就会发出警告音。
喇叭
打开或关闭电话线中通过扬声器发出的声音,如拨号
音或传真音。如果此选项设置为通信,则意味着扬声
器将一直处于打开状态,直至远程机器应答。
您可以使用免提拨号调节音量。只有在已连接
电话线的情况下才可以调节扬声器的音量。
a 按控制面板上的 (传真)。
b 按免提拨号。扬声器即发出拨号音。
c 按箭头,直到听到所需的音量。
d 按免提拨号保存更改并返回就绪模式。
振铃音
调节振铃音量。对于振铃音量,您可以选择关、低、中
和高。系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 199
11
报告
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 报告 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 报告。
项目 描述
菜单图 打印显示本机器布局和当前设置的菜单图。
所有报告 打印此机器提供的各种报告。
配置 打印有关机器全面配置的报告。
• 耗材信息
• 耗材信息
打印耗材信息页。
位置簿
打印当前存储在机器内存中的所有电子邮件
地址。
演示页 打印演示页,检查机器打印是否正常。
发送传真
打印传送报告,它包含传真作业的传真号码、
页数、作业用时、通信模式与通信结果。您可
以将机器设置为在每个传真作业之后自动打
印传送确认报告。
发送的传真 打印您最近发送的传真的相关信息。
接收到的传真 打印您最近收到的传真的相关信息。
发送电子邮件 打印您最近发送的电子邮件的相关信息。
• 计划作业
• 传真计划作业
打印当前为延迟传真存储的文档的列表,以
及每次操作的开始时间和类型。
垃圾传真 打印指定为垃圾传真号码的传真号码。
• 网路配置
• 网络配置
打印机器网络连接和配置的相关信息。
• 用户验证
• 本地用户身份验证
打印可以使用电子邮件功能的授权用户。
PCL 字体 打印 PCL 字体列表。
• PS 字体
• PS3字体列表
打印 PS/PS3 字体列表。
EPSON 字体 打印 EPSON 字体列表。
KSC5843 字体 打印 KSC5843 字体列表。
KSC5895 字体 打印 KSC5895 字体列表。
项目 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 200
12
维护
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 维护 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 初始设置。
KSSM 字体列表 打印 KSSM 字体列表。
• 网路用户验证
• 网络用户身份验证
打印域中的已登录用户及其 ID。
使用计数器 打印使用页。使用页包括打印的总页数。
传真选项 打印传真报告的信息。
• 已存储的作业
• 存储的作业
打印可选内存或大容量存储设备 (HDD) 中目
前存储的作业。
• 已完成的作业
• 已完成的作业
打印已完成作业的列表。
统计报告
仅当从 SyncThru™ Web Admin Service 启用
作业统计时可以使用它。可以为每个用户打
印打印输出计数报告。
项目 描述
项目 描述
清除已空消息 墨粉盒用尽时显示该选项。可清除空消息。
忽略炭粉
您可以将机器设置为忽略墨粉用尽消息,并继续打印
除即将进入的传真以外的内容。
耗材寿命
显示耗材寿命指示器(请参见第 75 页上的“监控耗材
寿命”)。
“墨粉不足”警报
自定义发出墨粉不足或墨粉用尽警报的余量(请参见
第 76 页上的“设置墨粉不足警报”)。
• 序列号
• 序列号
显示机器的序列号。拨打服务电话或在 Samsung 网
站上作为用户进行注册时,可以找到它。
纸张堆放
启用纸盘的自动链接功能。当一个纸盘因纸张用尽或
不匹配而无法使用时,该选项允许打印机从另一个可
用纸盘进纸。
彩色纸
允许您调整颜色设置,如对比度等级、校色、色密度
等。
Ram 磁盘
将部分 ram 磁盘设置为作业存储区域。使用存储区域
激活作业管理菜单(请参见第 201 页上的“作业管理
”)。这样,数据可以从计算机发送到 ram 磁盘的打印
队列。系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 201
13
清除设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 清除设置 。
• 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 恢复选项。
14
作业管理
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
项目 描述
所有设置
清除存储在内存中的全部数据,并将所有设置
重置为出厂默认值。
打印机设置 将所有打印机选项恢复为出厂默认值。
纸张设置 将所有纸张选项恢复为出厂默认值。
• 传真设置
• 传真默认值
将所有传真选项恢复为出厂默认值。
• 复印设置
• 复印默认值
将所有复印选项恢复为出厂默认值。
• 扫描设置
• 扫描默认值
将所有扫描选项恢复为出厂默认值。
系统设置 将所有系统选项恢复为出厂默认值。
网路设置
将所有网络选项恢复为出厂默认值(需要重新
引导)。
位置簿 清除存储在内存中的所有电子邮件。
• 发送的传真
• 发送的报告
清除所有已发送传真的记录。
发送电子邮件 清除所有已发送电子邮件的记录。
• 传真已接收
• 传真接收报告
• 接收的报告
清除所有已接收传真记录。
项目 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 202
要更改菜单选项:
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 作业管理 。
15
图像覆盖
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 图像覆盖。
16
USB 设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按触摸屏上的 USB。
项目 描述
当前作业 显示等待打印的打印作业列表。
存储作业 显示磁盘中存储的打印作业列表。
文件策略
如果在输入新文件名时,内存中已存在相同的文件
名,则可以重命名或覆盖该文件。
项目 描述
手动
您可以覆盖内嵌 USB 内存,以清除其中存储的所有
数据。
选项 描述
打印来源 从文件导航查看文件列表。选择要打印的文件。
扫描到USB
将扫描目标设置为 USB。扫描原件并将扫描的图像
保存到 USB 设备。
文件管理 从文件导航查看文件列表。选择要删除的文件。您可
以格式化 USB 设备。
显示空间 显示剩余空间。系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 203
17
模拟设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 打印设置 > 模拟。
18
电子邮件设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 电子邮件设置。
19
地址簿设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 通讯簿。
项目 描述
模拟类型 机器语言定义了计算机与机器的通信方式。
设置 为选定的模拟类型设置具体设置。
选项 描述
SMTP 服务器 设置 SMTP 服务器配置。
发送到自身
设置为将邮件发给自己,以便备份电子邮件或
将它用来提醒自己。
默认为地址 将某个电子邮件目标地址设置为默认地址。
默认来源
将某个发件人的电子邮件地址设置为默认地
址。
默认主题 将某个电子邮件的主题设置为默认主题。
选项 描述
电话簿
添加、查看、打印或删除电话簿列表。您还可以创建
组。
电子邮件
添加、查看、打印或删除电子邮件列表。您还可以创
建组。
选项 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 204
20
文档框设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
文档邮箱功能
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 文档邮箱 > 文档邮箱功能。
文档箱设置
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 文档邮箱 > 文档邮箱设置。
21
网络设置
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 网路。
选项 描述 • 或按触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 网络设置。
从扫描添加 将已扫描的文档存储在箱中。存储的文件将自动命名
为“yearmonthdayhourminutesecond”。
任务发件人邮箱 打印箱中的文档。
选项 描述
从扫描添加 设置将文档存储到箱中的默认设置。
任务发件人邮箱 设置打印箱中文档的默认设置。
选项 描述
TCP/IP (IPv4)
选择适当的协议并配置参数以使用网络环境。
有许多参数可供设置。如果您不确定,请保留
原始设置,或者咨询网络管理员。
TCP/IP (IPv6)
选择此选项以通过 IPv6 使用网络环境(请参见第 148
页上的“IPv6 配置”)。
Ethernet 速度 配置网络传输速度。
选项 描述系统设置
3. 实用设置菜单 205
802.1x
您可以为网络通信选择用户身份验证。有关详细信
息,请咨询网络管理员。
无线 要使用无线网络,请选择此选项。
清除设置 将网络设置恢复为默认值(需要重新引导)。
• 网路配置
• 网络配置
此列表显示有关机器网络连接和配置的信息。
网络激活 您可以设置是否使用以太网。
Http 激活 您可以设置是否使用 SyncThru™ Web Service。
选项 描述3. 实用设置菜单 206
管理员设置
项目 描述
密码保护
设置用于访问管理员设置菜单的密码。选择打开可使用
该选项并输入密码。
更改密码 更改用于访问管理员设置的机器密码。
维护
• 清洁定影器: 通过打印一页,清洁定影器。打印出的
纸上有墨粉碎屑。
• 清除已空消息: 避免墨粉不足警报消息出现在显示屏
上。
• 耗材信息: 允许您检查已经打印的页数以及墨粉盒内
剩余的墨粉数量。
• 墨粉不足警报: 如果墨粉盒中的墨粉已用完,会显示
一则提示用户更换墨粉盒的消息。可设置此选项,以
选择是否显示此消息。
• Ram 磁盘: 启用/禁用 RAM 磁盘管理作业。根据安装
的可选内存的大小,可以将 RAM 磁盘大小设置为 32
到 64 MB。如果已安装大容量存储设备 (HDD),则不
显示此选项。3. 实用设置菜单 207
自定义设置
仅当安装 XOA (eXtensible Open Architecture) web 应用程序时,显示此菜
单。要使用此菜单,请与管理员联系。
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器(请参见第 33 页上的“菜单概述”)。
• 按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 自定义。4. 特殊功能
本章说明特殊的复印、扫描、传真和打印功能。
• 海拔调整 209
• 存储电子邮件地址 210
• 输入不同的字符 212
• 设置传真地址簿 213
• 注册授权用户 216
• 打印功能 217
• 扫描功能 231
• 传真功能 241
• 使用共享文件夹功能 251
• 使用内存/硬盘驱动器功能 252
• 本章中的程序主要基于 Windows 7。
• 对于某些型号,可能需要按确定才能导航到下层菜单。4. 特殊功能 209
海拔调整
打印质量会受大气压影响,而大气压取决于机器在海平面以上的高度。下
列信息将指导您如何设置机器以获得最佳打印质量。
在您设置海拔值之前,请确定所在地的海拔。
1 高 3
2 高 2
3 高 1
4 正常
您可以在 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 程序中的设备设置或打印机设
置工具程序中的 Machine 部分设置海拔值。
• Windows 和 Macintosh 用户请参见第 261 页上的“设备设置”。
• Linux 用户请参见第 265 页上的“使用Smart Panel”。
• 如果机器连接到网络,则可以通过 SyncThru™ Web Service 设置海
拔值(请参见第 257 页上的“使用 SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
• 也可以在机器显示屏上的系统设置选项中设置海拔(请参见第 38
页上的“机器的基本设置”)。
0
4,000 m
(13,123 ft)
3,000 m
(9,842 ft)
2,000 m
(6,561 ft)
1,000 m
(3,280 ft)
4
3
2
14. 特殊功能 210
存储电子邮件地址
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
通过 SyncThru™ Web Service,您可以用常用电子邮件地址创建地址簿,
然后通过输入在地址簿中为它们分配的位置号来轻松快捷地输入电子邮
件地址。
1
在您的机器上存储
要扫描图像并将其作为电子邮件附件发送,您需要使用 SyncThru™ Web
Service 设置电子邮件地址。
1 访问 SyncThru™ Web Service(请参见第 257 页上的“使用
SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
2 单击 SyncThru™ Web Service 网站右上角的 登录。
3 键入 ID 和 密码,然后单击登录。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
4 单击地址簿 > 单人 > 添加。
5 选择快速拨号号码并输入电子邮件地址和传真号码。
如果需要设置 SMB 或 FTP 服务器信息,请选中 SMB 或 FTP 并设置
信息。
6 单击应用。
7 如果创建一个组,请单击地址簿 > 电子邮件组 > 添加组。
8 选择快速拨号号码并输入组名。
如果为在创建此组后添加单人选择是,则可以轻松添加单人地址。
9 单击应用。
2
搜索电子邮件地址
按顺序搜索内存
1 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)> (地址簿)> 查找和发送 > 选
择地址组 > 所有。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 通讯簿 > 电子邮件 >
查看列表 > 个人或群组。
2 按照索引(数字)顺序搜索整个内存,选择所需的名称和地址。存储电子邮件地址
4. 特殊功能 211
用特定首字母搜索
1 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)。
2 按控制面板中的 (地址簿)> 查找和发送 > 选择地址组 > ID。
3 输入您需要名称的前几个字母。
4 按箭头,直到出现所需的名称和号码。4. 特殊功能 212
输入不同的字符
执行某些任务时,可能需要输入姓名和号码。例如,在设置机器时输入您
的姓名(或公司名称)和传真号码。在内存中存储传真号码或电子邮件地
址时,也可输入相应名称。
3
输入字母数字字符
按此按钮,直到显示屏上显示正确的字母。例如,要输入字母 O,请按标有
“MNO”的 6 按钮。每次按 6 按钮,显示屏就会显示不同的字母,依次是 M、
N、O、m、n、o 和 6。要找到想输入的字母,请参见第 212 页上的“键盘字
母和数字”。
• 按两次 1 可输入一个空格。
• 要删除最后一个数字或字符,请按向左/向右或向上/向下箭头按钮。
4
键盘字母和数字
• 根据机器的选件或机型,特殊字符集可能与您的机器不同。
• 以下部分键值可能不出现,这取决于您正在执行的作业。
按键 指定数字、字母或字符
1 @ / . ’ 1
2 A B C a b c 2
3 D E F d e f 3
4 G H I g h i 4
5 J K L j k l 5
6 M N O m n o 6
7 P Q R S p q r s 7
8 T U V t u v 8
9 W X Y Z w x y z 9
0 & + - , 0
* * % _ ~ ! # $ ( ) [ ]
(当您键入网络验证时,这些符号可用)
# # = | ? " : { } < > ;
(当您键入网络验证时,这些符号可用)4. 特殊功能 213
设置传真地址簿
通过 SyncThru™ Web Service,您可以用常用传真号码创建快速拨号号
码,然后通过输入地址簿中为它们分配的位置编号轻松快捷地输入传真号
码。
5
登记快速拨号号码
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (地址簿) > 新建和编辑 > 快
速拨号。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下一步> 通讯簿 > 电话簿 > 查
看列表 > 个人> (选项)> 添加。
2 输入快速拨号号码,然后按OK。
如果选择的号码中已经存储了条目,则显示屏会显示该信息,以便进
行更改。要使用另一个快速拨号号码重新开始,请按 (反面)。
3 输入您需要的名称,然后按OK。
4 输入您需要的传真号码,然后按OK。
5 按 (取消或停止/清除)按钮返回就绪模式。
6
使用速拨号码
发送传真时,如果提示您输入目标号码,请输入存储所需号码的速拨号
码。
• 对于一位数(0-9)的速拨号码,请按住数字键盘上相应的数字按钮
超过 2 秒。
• 对于两位数或三位数的速拨号码,则按首位按钮,然后按住末位按
钮超过 2 秒。
• 可以通过选择 (传真)> (地址簿)> 打印打印地址簿列
表。
7
编辑速拨号码
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (地址簿) > 新建和编辑 > 快
速拨号。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 通讯簿 > 电话簿 > 查
看列表 > 个人。
2 输入要编辑的速拨号码,然后按OK。
3 更改名称,然后按 OK。设置传真地址簿
4. 特殊功能 214
4 更改传真号码,然后按OK。
5 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
8
登记组拨号码
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (地址簿) > 新建和编辑 > 群
组拨号。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下一步 > 通讯簿 > 电话簿 > 查
看列表 > 群组 > (选项)> 添加。
2 输入群组拨号号码,然后按OK。
如果选择的号码中已经存储了条目,则显示屏会显示该信息,以便进
行更改。要使用另一个快速拨号号码重新开始,请按 (反面)。
3 通过输入要放入组中的快速拨号名称的前几个字母进行搜索。
4 选择所需的名称和号码,然后按OK。
5 出现添加?时,选择是。
6 重复步骤 3 将其他速拨号码纳入组中。
7 完成后,在出现另一编号?时选择否并按OK。
8 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
9
编辑组拨号码
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (地址簿) > 新建和编辑 > 群
组拨号。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 通讯簿 > 电话簿 > 查
看列表 > 群组。
2 输入需要编辑的组拨号码,然后按OK。
3 输入要添加的新速拨号码并按OK,然后会出现添加?。
输入存储在组中的速拨号码并按OK,则将出现删除?。
4 按 OK 添加或删除号码。
5 重复第 3 步,添加或删除更多号码。
6 出现另一编号?时选择否,然后按OK。
7 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。设置传真地址簿
4. 特殊功能 215
10
在地址薄中搜索条目
搜索内存中的号码可采用两种方法。可以依次从 A 扫描到 Z,也可以通过
输入与号码相关名称的前几个字母进行搜索。
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (地址簿) > 查找和拨号 > 快
速拨号或群组拨号。
2 输入所有或 ID并按OK。
3 按标有要查找的字母的名称和号码或键盘按钮。
例如,如果想要找到“MOBILE”这个名字,按 6 按钮,此按钮上标有
“MNO”。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
11
打印地址簿
您可以通过打印列表来查看 (地址簿)设置。
1 选择控制面板上的 (传真)> (地址簿)> 打印。
2 按 OK。
机器开始打印。4. 特殊功能 216
注册授权用户
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
如果您已将机器联网,并且正确地设置了网络参数,则您可扫描并通过网
络扫描图像。要通过电子邮件或通过网络服务器安全发送扫描图像,则您
必须使用 SyncThru™ Web Service 向您的本地机器注册授权用户的帐户
信息。
1 访问 SyncThru™ Web Service(请参见第 257 页上的“使用
SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
2 单击 SyncThru™ Web Service 网站右上角的 登录。
3 键入 ID 和 密码,然后单击登录。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
4 单击安全 > 用户访问控制 > 验证。
5 从验证方法中选择本地验证,然后单击应用。
6 在确认弹出窗口中单击确定。
7 单击用户配置文件 > 添加。
8 输入用户名、登录 ID、密码、确认密码、电子邮件地址和传真号码。
如果为在创建此组后添加单人选择是,则可以轻松添加单人地址。
9 单击应用。4. 特殊功能 217
打印功能
• 有关基本打印功能,请参阅基本指南(请参见第 52 页上的“基本打
印”)。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
12
更改默认打印设置
1 单击 Windows 开始 菜单。
2 选择控制面板 > 设备与打印机。
3 右键单击机器。
4 选择打印首选项。
如果打印首选项有 ► 标记,则您可以选择与所选打印机连接的其他打
印机驱动程序。
5 更改每个选项卡上的设置。
6 单击确定。
如果您希望更改各打印作业的设置,请在打印首选项中进行更改。
13
将机器设置为默认机器
1 单击 Windows 开始 菜单。
2 选择控制面板 > 设备与打印机。
3 选择机器。
4 右键单击您的机器,然后选择设置为默认打印机。
如果打印首选项有 ► 标记,则您可以选择与所选打印机连接的其他打
印机驱动程序。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 218
14
使用高级打印功能
XPS 打印机驱动程序:用于打印 XPS 文件格式。
• 请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”。
• XPS 打印机驱动程序只能安装在 Windows Vista 操作系统或更高版
本上。
• 当无法打印 XPS 作业时,表明打印机内存不足,请安装可选内存。
• 对于软件 CD 提供 XPS 驱动程序的型号:
- 将软件 CD 插入 CD-ROM 驱动器时,可安装 XPS 打印机驱动程
序。安装窗口打开时,选择高级安装 > 自定义安装。可在选择要
安装的软件和实用程序窗口中选择 XPS 打印机驱动程序。
• 对于通过 Samsung 网站提供 XPS 驱动程序的型号,
www.samsung.com > 查找产品> 支持或下载。
打印到文件(PRN)
有时需要将打印数据保存为文件。
1 在打印到文件窗口选中打印框。
2 单击打印。
3 键入目标路径和文件名,然后单击确定。
例如,c:\Temp\file name。
如果您仅键入文件名,则文件将自动保存在我的文档、Documents
and Settings 或 用户 中。保存文件夹可能会因您所使用的操作系统或
应用程序的不同而有所差异。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 219
理解特殊打印功能
使用机器时可以使用其高级打印功能。
要充分利用打印机驱动程序提供的打印机功能,请在应用程序的打印窗口中单击属性或首选项更改打印设置。打印机属性窗口中显示的打印机名称可能
因所用的机器而有差异。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,可能不会显示某些菜单。这种情况下,此功能不适用于您的机器。
• 选择帮助菜单或单击窗口中的 按钮或按键盘上的 F1 键并单击要了解的任何选项(请参见第 54 页上的“使用帮助”)。
项目 描述
每面多页 选择要在一张纸上打印的页数。要在一张纸上打印多页,这些页面将会缩小并按指定的顺序排列。一张纸上最多可打印 16 页。
海报打印 将单页文档打印到 4(海报 2x2)、9(海报 3x3)或 16(海报 4x4)页纸上,这样可以将纸张粘贴到一起形成海报大小的文档。
选择海报重叠值。选择基本选项卡右上方的单选按钮以毫米或英寸为单位指定海报重叠,以便于将各页粘贴在一起。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 220
书册打印a
在一张纸的两面打印您的文档,并对页面进行排序,以便在打印之后将纸张对折,从而生成一本小册子。
• 如果您想要制作一本小册子,您需要在 Letter、Legal、A4、US Folio 或 Oficio 大小的打印介质上打印。
• 书册打印选项对于所有纸张大小均不可用。从纸张选项卡中选择可用纸张尺寸选项,了解可以使用哪些纸张大小。
• 如果您选择的是一种不可用的纸张大小,则该选项可自动删除。仅选择可用纸张(无 或 标记的纸张)。
• 双面打印
• 双面打印(手动)a
在一张纸的两面打印(双面打印)。打印之前,请决定文档的打印方向。
• 您可以将 Letter、Legal、A4、US Folio 或 Oficio 大小的纸张与此功能配合使用。
• 如果您的机器不具有双面打印单元,则应手动完成打印作业。机器首先打印文档的每一张其他页面。之后,计算机上将显示
一条信息。
• 跳过空白页功能在您选择双面选项时不可用。
项目 描述
8
9打印功能
4. 特殊功能 221
• 双面打印
• 双面打印(手动)a
• 打印机默认值: 如果选择此选项,则此功能由您在机器控制面板上所进行的设置来决定。此选项仅在使用 PCL/XPS 打印机驱动程
序时可用。
• 无: 禁用此功能。
• 长边: 此选项为装订中所使用的常规布局。
• 短边: 此选项为日历中所使用的常规布局。
• 反转双面打印: 选择此选项在双面打印时逆序打印。当您使用D双面打印(手动)时,此选项不可用。
纸张选项 输入放大或缩小文档的百分比可以更改文档在打印页面上的显示大小。
水印 水印选项可允许在已有文档上打印文字。例如,如果您希望在文档的第一页或所有页上对角打印大写的灰色字母“DRAFT”或
“CONFIDENTIAL”,则可以使用此功能。
项目 描述打印功能
4. 特殊功能 222
水印
(创建水印)
a 要从软件应用程序更改打印设置,请访问打印首选项。
b 单击高级选项卡,在水印下拉列表中选择编辑。将显示编辑水印窗口。
c 在水印消息框中输入文字信息。
最多可输入 256 个字符。此信息会在预览窗口中显示。
水印
(编辑水印)
a 要从软件应用程序更改打印设置,请访问打印首选项。
b 单击高级选项卡,在水印下拉列表中选择编辑。将显示编辑水印窗口。
c 在当前水印列表中选择想要编辑的水印,然后更改水印信息和选项。
d 单击更新,保存更改内容。
e 单击确定或打印,直到退出打印窗口。
水印
(删除水印)
a 要从软件应用程序更改打印设置,请访问打印首选项。
b 单击高级选项卡,在水印下拉列表中选择编辑。将显示编辑水印窗口。
c 从当前水印列表中选择想要删除的水印,然后单击删除。
d 单击确定或打印,直到退出打印窗口。
覆盖页a
此选项仅在使用 PCL/SPL 打印机驱动程序时可用(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
叠加是指作为一种特殊文件格式存储在计算机硬盘驱动器(HDD)中的文字和/或图像,可以打印在任何文档上。叠加常用于替换信头
纸。可以不使用预印的信头纸,而是创建一个包含与目前信头完全相同信息的叠加。要打印一封带有您的公司信头的信,不需要在打
印机中放置预打印的信头纸:只需在文档中打印信头叠加。
要使用页面叠加,必须创建包含徽标或图像的新页叠加。
• 叠加文档大小必须与使用叠加打印的文档大小相同。不要创建带水印的叠加。
• 叠加文档的分辨率必须与使用叠加所打印文档的分辨率相同。
项目 描述打印功能
4. 特殊功能 223
覆盖页a
(创建新页叠加)
a 要将文档保存为叠加,请访问打印首选项。
b 单击高级选项卡,在文本下拉列表中选择编辑。将显示 编辑覆盖页窗口。
c 在编辑覆盖页窗口中单击创建。
d 在另存为窗口中的文件名框中键入名称(最多包含 8 个字符)。如果需要,请选择目标路径(默认路径为 C:\Formover)。
e 单击保存。该名称出现在覆盖页目录上。
f 单击确定或打印,直到退出打印窗口。
不打印文件。而是将其储存在计算机的硬盘驱动器上。
覆盖页a
(使用页面叠加)
a 单击高级选项卡。
b 从文本下拉列表框中选择所需的叠加。
c 如果您希望的叠加文件未在文本下拉列表中出现,请从列表中选择编辑...,然后单击加载。选择希望使用的叠加文件。
如果您已将希望使用的叠加文件存储在外部,您也可在访问打开窗口时加载此文件。
选择文件之后,单击打开。该文件会出现在覆盖页目录框中以供进行打印。从覆盖页目录框中选择叠加。
d 如有必要,请选中打印时确认覆盖页框。如果该框被选中,则您每次提交文档进行打印时都会出现一个信息窗口,要求您确认是否
要在文档上打印叠加。
如果未选中此框,但又选择了叠加,则将会在文档上自动打印叠加。
e 单击确定或打印,直到退出打印窗口。
覆盖页a
(删除页面叠加)
a 在打印首选项窗口中单击高级选项卡。
b 在文本下拉列表中选择编辑。
c 从覆盖页目录框中选择要删除的叠加。
d 单击删除。
e 出现确认消息窗口时,请单击是。
f 单击确定或打印,直到退出打印窗口。可以删除不再使用的页面叠加。
项目 描述打印功能
4. 特殊功能 224
打印模式
• 仅当您安装可选内存或大容量存储设备 (HDD) 时可使用该功能(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能不适用于您的机器。
• 打印模式: 打印模式 默认为 正常,在该模式下打印时不会将打印文件保存到内存中。
- 正常: 此模式下进行打印时不会将您的文档存储在选装内存中。
- 校样: 在进行多份打印时,此模式将非常有用。您可以先打印一份进行检查,然后再打印其余份数。
- 机密: 此模式用于打印机密文档。您需要输入密码才能进行打印。
- 存储: 选择此设置在大容量存储设备 (HDD) 中保存文档而不打印。
- 存储并打印: 同时打印和存储文档时使用此模式。
- 缓冲: 处理大量数据时,该选项可能较实用。如果选择该设置,打印机将文档放入大容量存储设备 (HDD) 中,然后从大容量存储
设备 (HDD) 队列打印它,从而降低了计算机的工作负荷。
- 打印计划: 选择此设置在指定时间打印文档。
• 用户 ID: 在需要使用控制面板查找保存的文件时,要用到此选项。
• 作业名称: 在需要使用控制面板查找保存的文件时,要用到此选项。
作业加密
首先加密打印数据,然后将它传送到机器。即使数据在网络中被截获,该功能也可以保护打印信息。
仅当安装大容量存储设备 (HDD) 时,启用作业加密功能。大容量存储设备 (HDD) 用于解密打印数据(请参见第 10 页上的“多种
功能”)。
a. 当您使用 XPS 驱动程序时,此选项不可用。
项目 描述打印功能
4. 特殊功能 225
15
使用直接打印实用程序
• 视型号或可选商品,直接打印实用程序可能不可用(请参见第 7 页
上的“软件”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 操作系统用户。
什么是直接打印实用程序?
直接打印实用程序是在无需打开 PDF 文件的情况下,直接将文件发送到
机器打印的实用程序。
要安装本程序,应在安装打印机驱动程序时,选择高级安装 > 自定义安装
并在本程序中放置复选标记。
• 大容量存储设备 (HDD) 应安装在机器上,以使用此程序打印文件。(请
参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。
• 无法打印受限 PDF 文件。解除打印限制功能,然后重试打印。
• 无法打印密码限制的 PDF 文件。解除密码保护功能,然后重试打印。
• 能否使用直接打印实用程序打印 PDF 文件取决于创建 PDF 的方式。
• 直接打印实用程序支持 PDF 版本 1.7 和更低版本。对于更高版本,
您必须打开文件进行打印。
打印
使用直接打印实用程序进行打印的方法有以下几种。
1 从开始菜单中选择程序或所有程序 > Samsung Printers > 直接打
印实用程序 > 直接打印实用程序。
直接打印实用程序窗口将出现。
2 从选择打印机下拉列表选择您的机器并单击浏览。
3 选择要打印的文件并单击打开。
文件将添加到选择文件部分中。
4 根据需要设定打印机设置。
5 单击打印。所选的 PDF 文件将发送到打印机。
使用右键快捷菜单
1 右键单击要打印的 PDF 文件,然后选择直接打印。
直接打印实用程序窗口将出现,其中显示添加的 PDF 文件。
2 选择要使用的机器。
3 自定义机器设置。
4 单击打印。所选的 PDF 文件将发送到打印机。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 226
16
Macintosh 打印
根据机型或选项不同,可能不提供某些功能。它表示不支持这些功能。
打印文档
当使用 Macintosh 打印时,需要检查所用每个应用程序中的打印机驱动程
序设置。按以下步骤从 Macintosh 进行打印:
1 打开要打印的文档。
2 打开文件菜单并单击页面设置(某些应用程序为文档设置)。
3 选择纸张大小、方向、缩放比例及其他选项,并确保已选择机器。单
击确定。
4 打开文件菜单并单击打印。
5 选择打印份数,并指示要打印哪些页。
6 单击打印。
更改打印机设置
使用机器时可以使用其高级打印功能。
打开应用程序,在文件菜单选择打印。打印机属性窗口中显示的打印机名
称可能因所用的机器而有差异。除名称之外,打印机属性窗口的构成与下
列构成基本相同。
在一张纸上打印多页
可以在一张纸上打印多页。通过此功能打印草稿,可以节省成本。
1 打开应用程序,在文件菜单中选择打印。
2 在打印方向下方的下拉列表中选择布局。在每张页数下拉列表中选
择要在一张纸上打印的页数。
3 选择要使用的其他选项。
4 单击打印。
机器在一张纸上打印选定的页数。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 227
双面打印
根据机型或选项不同,可能不提供某些功能。它表示不支持这些功能
(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功能”)。
在进行双面打印之前,请先确定打印后文档的装订边。装订选项如下:
• 长边装订: 此选项为装订中所使用的常规布局。
• 短边装订: 该选项为日历常用的类型。
1 在 Macintosh 应用程序中,从文件菜单选择打印。
2 在打印方向下方的下拉列表中选择布局。
3 从双面选项中选择装订方向。
4 选择要使用的其他选项。
5 单击打印,机器会进行双面打印。
如果您打印 2 份以上文件,第一份与第二份可在同一张纸上打印。当
您打印一份以上文件时,请避免双面打印。
使用帮助
从窗口的左下角单击问号,然后单击希望了解的主题。将显示一个弹出窗
口,上面显示有关驱动程序所提供选项功能的信息。
17
Linux 打印
根据机型或选项不同,可能不提供某些功能。它表示不支持这些功能。
从应用程序打印
有许多可使您使用“通用 UNIX 打印系统”(CUPS)进行打印的 Linux 应用
程序。可利用任何此类应用程序在机器上进行打印。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 228
1 打开应用程序,从 File 菜单选择 Print
2 直接使用选择 Print。
3 在 LPR GUI 窗口中,从打印机列表中选择打印机的型号名称,然后
单击 Properties。
4 使用在窗口顶部显示的下列四个选项卡更改打印任务属性。
• General: 更改纸张大小、纸张类型和文档打印方向。可实现双
面打印、添加启动与结束图标以及更改每张纸的打印页数。
某些型号可能不提供自动/手动双面打印。您可以使用 lpr 打印系统或
其他应用程序进行奇偶页打印。
• Text: 指定页边距和设置文本选项,如间隔或栏数。
• Graphics: 设置打印图像文件时使用的图像选项,如:颜色选
项、图像大小或图像位置。
• Advanced: 设置打印分辨率、纸张来源和目标。
5 单击 Apply 应用更改,然后关闭 Properties 窗口。
6 单击 LPR GUI 窗口中的 OK 开始打印。
7 会出现 “Printing” 窗口,您可在此监控打印作业的状态。
要放弃当前作业,请单击 Cancel。
打印文件
利用标准的 CUPS,您可以在机器上直接从命令行接口打印许多不同类型
的文件。CUPS lpr 实用程序允许您这样做,但驱动程序包会将标准 lpr 工
具替换为一个更友好的 LPR GUI 程序。
如要打印任何文档,请执行以下步骤:
1 在 Linux shell 命令行中输入 lpr ,然后按 Enter 键。将显
示 LPR GUI 窗口。
如果仅键入 lpr 并按 Enter 键,则会首先出现 Select file(s) to print
窗口。仅选择您要打印的文件,然后单击 Open。
2 在 LPR GUI 窗口,从列表中选择您的机器,然后更改打印作业属
性。
3 单击 OK 开始打印。
配置打印机属性
使用 Printer Properties 所提供的 Printers configuration 窗口而更改您
打印机的各种属性。
1 打开 Unified Driver Configurator。
如有必要,请切换到 Printers configuration。
2 请在可用打印机列表中选择您的机器,然后单击 Properties。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 229
3 Printer Properties 窗口出现。
窗口顶部会显示以下五个选项卡:
• General: 更改打印机位置和名称。在此选项卡输入的名称会显
示在 Printers configuration 的打印机列表中。
• Connection: 查看或选择其他端口。如果在使用中将机器端口
从 USB 改为并行或从并行改为 USB,则必须在此选项卡重新配
置机器端口。
• Driver: 查看或选择其他机器驱动程序。通过单击 Options,您
可以设置默认设备选项。
• Jobs: 显示打印作业列表。单击 Cancel job 取消选定工作,选
择 Show completed jobs 复选框在作业列表上查看以往作业。
• Classes: 显示机器所属的类别。单击 Add to Class 将您的机器
添加到指定类别中,或单击 Remove from Class 从选定类别中
删除机器。
4 单击 OK 应用更改,然后关闭 Printer Properties 窗口。
18
Unix 打印
根据机型或选项不同,可能不提供某些功能。它表示不支持这些功能
(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
继续打印作业
安装打印机后,请选择要打印的任何图像、文本、PS 或 HPGL 文件。
1 执行 “printui ” 命令。
例如,如果要打印“document1”
printui document1
此操作将打开 UNIX 打印机驱动程序 Print Job Manager,用户可
以从中选择各种打印选项。
2 选择已添加的打印机。
3 从窗口中选择打印选项,如 Page Selection。
4 在 Number of Copies 中,选择所需的份数。
要利用打印机驱动程序提供的打印机功能,请按 Properties。
5 按 OK 启动打印作业。
更改机器设置
通过 UNIX 打印机驱动程序 Print Job Manager,用户可以在打印机
Properties 中选择各种打印选项。打印功能
4. 特殊功能 230
也可以使用以下热键:“H” 代表 Help,“O” 代表 OK,“A” 代表 Apply,并且
“C” 代表 Cancel。
General 选项卡
• Paper Size: 根据您的需要将纸张大小设置为 A4、Letter 或其他纸张大
小。
• Paper Type: 选择纸张类型。列表框中的可用选项有 Printer Default、
Plain 和 Thick。
• Paper Source: 选择使用哪个纸盘中的纸张。默认情况下为 Auto
Selection。
• Orientation: 选择在页面上打印信息的方向。
• Duplex: 进行双面打印可以节省纸张。
某些型号可能不提供自动/手动双面打印。您可以使用 lpr 打印系统或
其他应用程序进行奇偶页打印。
• Multiple pages: 在纸的一面打印多页。
• Page Border: 选择任何边框样式(如,Single-line hairline,Doubleline hairline)
Image 选项卡
在此选项卡中,可以更改文档的亮度、分辨率或图像位置。
Text 选项卡
设置实际打印输出的字符边距、行距或栏数。
HPGL/2 选项卡
• Use only black pen: 以黑色打印所有图形。
• Fit plot to page: 调整整个图形以适合单页大小。
Margins 选项卡
• Use Margins: 设置文档的边距。默认情况下,不启用边距。用户可以
通过在各自的字段中更改值来更改边距设置。默认情况下,根据所选
页面大小设置这些值。
• Unit: 将单位改为磅、英寸或厘米。
Printer-Specific Settings 选项卡
在 JCL 和 General 框中,选择各种选项来自定义各种设置。这些选项特定
于打印机并取决于 PPD 文件。4. 特殊功能 231
扫描功能
• 有关基本扫描功能,请参阅基本指南(请参见第 61 页上的“基本扫
描”)。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 可达到的最大分辨率取决于多种因素,包括计算机的运行速度、可
用磁盘空间、内存、扫描图像的大小以及位深度设置。因此,根据系
统和扫描的对象,可能无法以特定分辨率进行扫描,尤其是在使用
增强 dpi 时。
19
基本扫描方法
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种功
能”)。
可通过 USB 电缆或网络来使用机器扫描原件。可通过以下方法扫描文档:
• 扫描到PC: 从控制面板扫描原件。然后,扫描的数据将存储在已连接的
计算机我的文档文件夹中(请参见第 61 页上的“基本扫描”)。
• TWAIN: TWAIN 是一种预设的成像应用程序。图像扫描作业会启动选
定的应用程序,从而控制扫描过程。可通过本地连接或网络连接使用
该功能(请参见第 235 页上的“从图像编辑程序扫描”)。
• Samsung 扫描助手/SmarThru 4/SmarThru Office: 可使用该程序扫
描图像或文档。
- 请参见第 235 页上的“使用 Samsung 扫描助手扫描”。
- 请参见第 236 页上的“使用 SmarThru 4 扫描”
- 请参见第 237 页上的“使用 SmarThru Office 扫描”
• Windows 图像采集(WIA): WIA 为 Windows Images Acquisition
(Windows 图像采集)的缩写。要使用该功能,计算机必须通过一条
USB 电缆直接与您的机器相连(请参见第 235 页上的“使用 WIA 驱动
程序扫描”)。
• USB 内存: 您可以扫描文档,并将扫描的图像保存至 USB 内存设备。
• 电子邮件: 您可以将扫描图像作为电子邮件附件发送(请参见第 233 页
上的“扫描至电子邮件”)。
• FTP/SMB: 您可以扫描图像,然后将它上传到 FTP/SMB 服务器(请参
见第 234 页上的“扫描至 FTP/SMB 服务器”)。
20
配置计算机中的扫描设置
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 232
1 打开 Samsung Easy Printer Manager(请参阅第 260 页上的“使用
Samsung Easy Printer Manager”)。
2 从打印机列表中选择相应的机器。
3 选择扫描至 PC 设置菜单。
4 选择所需选项。
• 扫描启动: 决定是否在设备上启用扫描。
• 基本选项卡: 包含普通扫描的相关设置和设备设置。
• 图像选项卡: 包含图像更改的相关设置。
5 按保存 > 确定。
21
从联网机器扫描
机器不支持网络接口,它无法使用此功能(请参见第 23 页上的“后视
图”)。
务必借助软件光盘将打印机驱动程序安装到您的计算机上,因为打印机驱
动程序中包含扫描程序(请参见第 30 页上的“本地安装驱动程序”)。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)> 扫描到PC > 网路PC。
或从触摸屏上选择扫描 > 网络 PC。
如果您看到不可用消息,请检查端口连接。
3 选择注册的计算机 ID,必要时输入密码。
• ID 与 Samsung Easy Printer Manager > 切换到高级模式 > 扫
描至 PC 设置的注册扫描 ID 相同。
• 密码是 Samsung Easy Printer Manager > 切换到高级模式 >
扫描至 PC 设置的 4 位注册密码。
4 选择所需选项并按OK。
5 扫描即会开始。
扫描图像保存在计算机的 C:\用户\users name\我的文档。保存文件夹
可能会因您所使用的操作系统或应用程序的不同而有所差异。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 233
22
扫描至电子邮件
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
设置电子邮件帐户
1 访问 SyncThru™ Web Service(请参见第 257 页上的“使用
SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
2 选择设置 > 网络设置和邮件发送服务器(SMTP)。
3 以十进制点符号输入 IP 地址或作为主机名输入。
4 输入服务器端口号(从 1 至 65535)。
5 若需要验证,请勾选SMTP 要求验证框。
6 输入 SMTP 服务器登录名和密码。
7 按应用。
• 如果 SMTP 服务器的验证方法是 POP3 before SMTP,则应选中
SMTP 在进行 SMTP 验证前需要 POP。
• 输入 IP 地址和端口号。
扫描和发送电子邮件
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
2 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)> 扫描电子邮件。
或从触摸屏上选择扫描 > 发送电子邮件。
3 如果已配置 SyncThru™ Web Service,请输入登录名和密码(请参
见第 257 页上的“使用 SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
4 输入发件人和收件人的电子邮件地址。
通过 SyncThru™ Web Service 的设置 > 扫描 > 扫描到电子邮件激活自
动发送给本人选项,可以将电子邮件发送给自己。
5 输入电子邮件主题,然后按OK。
6 选择要扫描的文件格式,然后按OK。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 234
7 输入 SMTP 服务器登录名和密码。
8 机器开始扫描,然后发送电子邮件。
23
扫描至 FTP/SMB 服务器
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
设置 FTP/SMB 服务器
1 访问 SyncThru™ Web Service(请参见第 257 页上的“使用
SyncThru™ Web Service”)。
2 选择地址簿 > 单人 > 添加。
3 选中添加 FTP 或添加 SMB 旁的框。
4 以十进制点符号输入 IP 地址或作为主机名输入。
5 输入服务器端口号(从 1 至 65535)。
6 选中匿名旁的复选框,此时服务器允许未经授权者访问。
7 输入登录名和密码。
8 如果服务器连到特定域,请输入域名,否则只需输入向 SMB 服务器
注册的计算机名。
9 输入用于保存扫描图像的路径。
• 用于保存扫描图像的文件夹必须在根中。
• 需要将文件夹属性设置为共享。
• 您的用户名应当可以读写该文件夹。
10 按应用。
扫描和发送至 FTP/SMB 服务器
1 确保您的机器已联网。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 从控制面板中选择 (扫描)> 扫描到SMB或扫描到FTP。
或从触摸屏上选择扫描 > SMB 或 FTP。
4 选择所需的服务器和扫描格式。
5 机器开始扫描,然后将扫描图像发送到指定的服务器。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 235
24
从图像编辑程序扫描
您可以在 Adobe Photoshop 等图像编辑软件(如果该软件兼容 TWAIN)中
扫描和导入文档。使用与 TWAIN 兼容的软件扫描,请执行下列步骤:
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 打开应用程序(如:Adobe Photoshop)。
4 单击文件 > 导入,然后选择扫描仪设备。
5 设置扫描选项。
6 扫描并保存扫描图像。
25
使用 WIA 驱动程序扫描
您的机器支持使用 Windows 图像采集 (WIA) 驱动程序扫描图像。WIA 是
Microsoft Windows 7 提供的一种标准组件,可以与数码相机和扫描仪一起
工作。与 TWAIN 驱动程序不同,WIA 驱动程序无需使用其他软件即可扫
描和轻松调节图像:
WIA 驱动程序只能用于带 USB 端口的 Windows 操作系统(Windows
2000 不支持)。
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 单击开始 > 控制面板 > 硬件与声音 > 设备与打印机。
4 右键单击打印机和传真 > 开始扫描中的设备驱动程序图标。
5 将出现新的扫描应用程序。
6 选择扫描首选项并单击预览查看首选项对图片的作用效果。
7 扫描并保存扫描图像。
26
使用 Samsung 扫描助手扫描
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 可使用 Samsung 扫描助手程序的 OCR(光学字符识别)功能。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 236
1 确保机器与您的计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 单击开始 > 所有程序 > Samsung 打印机,然后启动 Samsung 扫
描助手。
选择帮助菜单或单击窗口中的 按钮,单击要了解的任何选项。
4 设置扫描选项。
5 单击扫描。
27
使用 SmarThru 4 扫描
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 可使用 SmarThru 4 程序的 OCR(光学字符识别)功能。
1 确保机器与您的计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 双击 SmarThru 4图标。
4 将显示 SmarThru。
• 扫描至: 您可以扫描图像并将其保存到应用程序或文件夹、用电
子邮件发送或在网站上发布。
• 图像: 您可以编辑图像并将其发送到选定应用程序或文件夹、用
电子邮件发送或在网站上发布。
• 打印: 您可以打印已保存的图像。
选择帮助菜单或单击窗口中的 按钮,单击要了解的任何选项。
5 单击扫描至。
6 从应用程序、电子邮件、文件夹、OCR 或 Web 中选择目标。
7 如果需要,可单击设置自定义设置。
8 单击扫描。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 237
28
使用 SmarThru Office 扫描
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 要使用 SmarThru Office,您必须从提供的 CD 手动安装该程序。选
择高级安装 > 自定义安装,然后选择安装 SmarThru Office。
• 可使用 SmarThru Office 程序的 OCR(光学字符识别)功能。
1 确保机器与您的计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 双击 SmarThru Office 图标。
4 将显示 SmarThru Office。
单击帮助或窗口中的 按钮,单击要了解的任何选项。
5 单击 Windows 任务栏托盘区中的 SmarThru Office 图标 ( ) 以激
活 SmarThru Office 启动程序。
6 单击扫描图标 ( ) 以打开扫描窗口。
7 扫描设置窗口会打开。
8 设置扫描设置,然后单击扫描。
29
Macintosh 扫描
从通过 USB 连接的机器扫描
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 启动应用程序并单击图像捕捉。
如果未连接图像捕捉设备信息出现,请断开 USB 电缆连接,然后重新
连接。如果此问题继续出现,请参阅图像捕捉帮助信息。
4 选择所需选项。
5 扫描并保存扫描图像。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 238
如果图像捕捉中无法运行扫描,请将 Mac OS 更新至最新版本。图像
捕捉在 Mac OS X 10.4.7 或更高版本中可正常操作。
从联网机器扫描
仅限网络或无线型号(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号的功能”)。
1 确保您的机器已联网。
2 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
3 启动应用程序并单击图像捕捉。
4 根据操作系统,按照以下步骤操作。
• 对于 10.4
- 单击菜单栏中的设备 > 浏览设备。
- 在 Twain 设备选项中选择您的机器。确保选中使用 TWAIN
软件复选框。
- 单击连接。
如果出现警告消息,单击更改端口..选择端口,如果显示
TWAIN UI,则单击首选项选项卡中的更改端口.. 并选择一
个新端口。
• 对于 10.5
- 单击菜单栏中的设备 > 浏览设备。
- 确保选中 Bonjour 设备中机器旁的已连接复选框。
- 如果要使用 TWAIN 进行扫描,请参考上述 Mac OS X10.4
步骤。
• 对于 10.6 -10.7,在共享下面选择设备。
5 在此程序中设置扫描选项。
6 扫描并保存扫描图像。
• 如果“图像捕捉”中无法运行扫描,请将 Mac OS 更新至最新版本。图
像捕捉在 Mac OS X 10.4.7 或更高版本中可正常操作。
• 有关更多信息,请参阅图像捕捉的帮助。
• 还可使用与 TWAIN 兼容的软件(如:Adobe Photoshop)扫描。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 239
30
Linux 扫描
扫描
1 确保机器与计算机连接,并打开电源。
2 双击桌面上的 Unified Driver Configurator。
3 单击 按钮,切换到 Scanners Configuration。
4 从列表中选择扫描仪。
5 单击 Properties。
6 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
7 从 Scanner Properties 窗口中,单击 Preview。
8 扫描文档,然后在 Preview Pane 中显示图像预览。
9 拖动指针,设置要在 Preview Pane 中扫描的图像区域。
10 选择所需选项。
11 扫描并保存扫描图像。扫描功能
4. 特殊功能 240
为了方便今后使用,可以保存为扫描设置并将它添加到 Job Type 下
拉列表中。
使用 Image Manager 编辑图像
Image Manager 应用程序提供用于编辑扫描图像的菜单命令和工具。4. 特殊功能 241
传真功能
• 有关基本传真功能,请参阅基本指南(请参见第 62 页上的“基本传
真”)。
• SCX-340x/SCX-340xW Series 不支持此功能(请参见第 24 页上的“
控制面板概览”)。
31
自动重拨
如果您所拨打的号码在发送传真时正忙或无响应,机器会自动重拨该号
码。重拨时间取决于国家/地区的出厂默认设置。
当显示屏显示尝试重拨?时,按 (开始)按钮可重拨该号码,并且无需
等待。要取消自动重拨,请按 (取消或停止/清除)。
要更改两次重拨之间的时间间隔和重拨次数。
1 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 发送。
2 选择所需的重拨次数或重拨期限。
3 选择所需选项。
32
重拨传真号码
1 按控制面板上的 (重拨/暂停)按钮。
2 选择所需传真号码。
将显示最近发送的十个传真号码和十个已接收的呼叫者 ID。
3 当将原件装入进纸器时,机器将自动开始发送。
如果将原件放置在扫描仪玻璃板上,请选择是添加另一页。装入另
一原件,然后按 确定。完成后在出现另一页?时选择否。
33
确认发送
成功发送完原件的最后一页之后,机器会发出蜂鸣音,然后返回就绪模
式。
如果在发送传真的过程中出错,则显示屏上会显示错误消息。如果您收到
错误消息,可按 (取消或停止/清除)清除该消息,然后再次尝试发送
传真。
可以将机器设置为在每次完成发送传真时自动打印确认报告。按控制
面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 发送 > 发送报告。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 242
34
发送计算机中的传真
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
可以从计算机中发送传真,无需走到传真机旁。
若要从计算机发送传真,则必须安装 Samsung Network PC Fax 程序。安
装打印机驱动程序后会安装此程序。
1 打开要发送的文档。
2 从打印菜单中选择文件。
将显示打印窗口。外观可能会因应用程序的不同而略微有所差异。
3 从打印窗口中选择 Samsung Network PC Fax。
4 单击打印或确定。
5 输入收件人的号码并选择选项
选择帮助菜单或单击窗口中的 按钮,单击要了解的任何选项。
6 单击 发送。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 243
35
延迟传真传送
当您不在场时,可以将机器设置为稍后发送传真。不能使用此功能发送彩
色传真。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板上的 (传真)。
3 调整分辨率和暗度,使之满足您的传真需要。
4 按控制面板中的 (菜单)> 传真功能 > 延迟发送。
或从触摸屏上选择传真 > 延迟发送 > 收件人。
5 输入接收传真机的号码,然后按OK。
6 显示屏要求输入发送文档的另一个传真号码。
7 要输入更多传真号码,当突出显示是时按确定并重复步骤 5。
• 最多可以输入 10 个目标。
• 输入组拨号码之后,就不能再输入其他组拨号码了。
8 输入作业名称和时间。
如果设定的时间早于当前时间,机器会在第二天的该时间发送传真。
9 在发送之前,原件会被扫描到内存中。
机器返回就绪模式。显示屏提醒您现在处于就绪模式,以及已设置
延迟传真。
可以检查已延迟传真作业列表。
按控制面板上的 (菜单)> 系统设置 > 报告 > 计划作业。
在预定传真中添加文档
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板中的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 添加页面。
3 选择传真作业并按OK。
完成后在显示另一页?时选择否。机器将原件扫描到内存中。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 244
取消预定传真作业
1 按控制面板中的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 取消作业。
2 选择所需传真作业并按OK。
3 当是突出显示时请按OK。
选定的传真已从内存中删除。
4 按 (停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
36
发送优先传真
当需要在预定操作之前发送高优先级的传真时,使用此功能。在当前操作
结束时,原件会扫描到内存中并立即传送。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 优先发送。
或从触摸屏上选择传真 > 优先发送 > 收件人。
3 输入目标传真号码并按OK。
4 输入作业名称,然后按OK。
5 如果原件放置在扫描仪玻璃板上,请选择是以添加其他页。装入另
一原件,然后按确定。
完成后在显示另一页?时选择否。
机器将开始扫描并将传真发送到目标。
37
将已发传真转发到另一个目标
可以将机器设置为通过传真、电子邮件或服务器将已收或已发传真转发到
其他目标。如果不在办公室但必须接收传真,则该功能可能会有用。
• 通过电子邮件转发传真时,首先必须在 SyncThru™ Web Service 中
设置邮件服务器和 IP 地址(请参见第 257 页上的“使用 SyncThru™
Web Service”)。
• 虽然已发送或接收彩色传真,但转发的数据为灰度。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 转发 > 传真
> 发送转发 > 打开。
或选择触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 传真设置 > 转发 > 传真、电子
邮件或服务器 > 发送转发 > 开。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 245
视型号或可选商品,转发选项可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多种
功能”)。
3 输入目标传真号码、电子邮件或服务器地址,然后按OK。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
随后发送的传真将转发至指定传真机。
38
转发已接收的传真
可以将机器设置为通过传真、电子邮件或服务器将已收或已发传真转发到
其他目标。如果不在办公室但必须接收传真,则该功能可能会有用。
虽然已发送或接收彩色传真,但转发的数据为灰度。
1 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 转发 > 传
真、电子邮件或服务器 > 接收转发或 接收转发 > 转发。
或选择触摸屏上的安装 > 机器设置 > 传真设置 > 转发 > 传真、电子
邮件或服务器 > 接收转发或 接收转发 > 开。
• 视型号或可选商品,转发选项可能不可用(请参见第 10 页上的“多
种功能”)。
• 要将机器设置为在转发完传真后打印出该传真,请选择转发并打
印。
2 输入目标传真号码、电子邮件或服务器地址,然后按OK。
3 输入开始时间和结束时间,然后按OK。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
随后发送的传真将转发至指定传真机。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 246
39
通过纸的两面发送传真
• 仅当您将原稿装入进稿器时可使用此功能。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此
功能不适用于您的机器。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板上的 (传真)> 双面。
或从触摸屏上选择传真 > 选择所需菜单 > 从子菜单中选择双面打
印。
• 关闭: 以正常模式发送传真。
• 2面: 通过原件的两面发送传真。
• 2->1面旋转2: 通过原件的两面发送传真,并分别在单独的纸张
上打印,但打印输出背面的信息旋转 180°。
3 按 OK。
40
接收计算机中的传真
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 要使用此功能,请通过控制面板设置选项:
按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 转发 > PC
> 打开。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 传真设置 > 转发 > 计
算机 > 开。
1 打开 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
2 从打印机列表中选择相应的机器。
3 选择传真至 PC 设置菜单。
4 使用启用从设备接收传真更改传真设置。
• 图像类型: 将接收的传真转换为 PDF 或 TIFF。
• 保存位置: 选择用于保存转换后传真的位置。
• 前缀: 选择前缀。
• 打印已接收传真: 接收传真之后,为已接收的传真设置打印信
息。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 247
• 完成时通知我: 设置为通过显示弹出窗口通知传真接收。
• 使用默认应用程序打开: 接收传真后,使用默认应用程序打开
它。
• 无: 接收传真后,机器不通知用户或打开应用程序。
5 按保存 > 确定。
41
更改接收模式
1 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单) > 传真设置 > 接收 > 接收
模式。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 默认设置 > 传真默认值
> 通用 > 接收模式。
2 选择所需选项。
• 传真: 应答传真来电,并立即进入传真接收模式。
• 电话: 依次按 (免提拨号)和 (开始)按钮接收传真。
• 应答/传真: 在应答机连接到您的机器时使用。机器将应答来电,
呼叫者可以在应答机上留言。如果传真机在线检测到传真音,
则机器将自动切换为传真模式以接收传真。
要使用 应答/传真 模式,必须将应答机连接到您的机器背面的 EXT(分
机)插槽。
• DRPD: 可以采用“特色振铃模式检测”(DRPD)功能来接收通
话。特色振铃是一种电话公司服务,通过该服务用户能够使用
一条电话线接听来自于几个不同电话号码的来电。有关详细信
息,请参见第 248 页上的“使用 DRPD 模式接收传真”。
该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区。
3 按 确定。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
42
在电话模式中手动接收
在听到传真音后,您可以按 (免提拨号)按钮,然后再按 (开始)接
收传真呼叫。如果机器有话筒,则可以使用话筒接听通话(请参见第 7 页
上的“不同型号的功能”)。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 248
43
以应答机/传真模式接收
要使用此模式,必须将应答机连接到本机背面的 EXT(分机)插槽。如果呼
叫者留言,则应答机会存储该信息。如果机器在线检测到传真音,则自动
开始接收传真。
• 如果已将机器设置为此模式,并且应答机关闭或机器的 EXT(分
机)插槽中未连接任何应答机,则机器将在预定响铃次数后自动转
入传真模式。
• 如果应答机有一个用户可选响铃计数器,则应将机器设置为响铃 1
次即应答来电。
• 如果机器处于电话模式,请将应答机与传真机断开连接或关闭应答
机。否则,应答机的输出信息会干扰电话通话。
44
使用电话分机接收传真
使用连接到 EXT 插口的电话分机时,无需转到传真机就可以从分机上通
话的一方那里接收传真。
在分机上接到呼叫并听到传真音时,请在分机上按 *9* 键。机器即开始接
收传真。
*9* 为出厂预设的远程接收代码。第一个星号和最后一个星号是固定的,
但您可以任意更改中间的号码。
通过连接到 EXT 插口的电话分机通话时,复印和扫描功能不可用。
45
使用 DRPD 模式接收传真
该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区。特色振铃是一种电话公司服
务,通过该服务用户能够使用一条电话线接听来自于几个不同电话号码的
来电。此功能通常由提供应答服务的工作人员使用,他们负责接听多个不
同客户的电话,并且需要知道呼叫者拨打的号码,以便恰当地接听电话。
该设置是否可用取决于您所在的国家/地区。
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 接收 >
DRPD模式 > 等待振铃。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 默认设置 > 传真默认值
> 通用 > 接收模式 > DRPD。
2 从另一部电话拨打传真号。
3 当传真机开始响铃时,不要应答呼叫。传真机需要多次响铃才能识
别该模式。
当机器完成识别过程后,显示屏将显示已完成 DRPD 设置。如果
DRPD 设置失败,将显示错误 DRPD 振铃。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 249
4 出现 DRPD 时,按 OK,然后从步骤 2 开始。
• 如果重新分配传真号码,或者将机器连接到另一条电话线上,则必
须重新设置 DRPD。
• DRPD 设置完成后,再次拨打传真号码,以验证机器是否以传真音
应答。然后拨打分配到同一条线上的另一号码,确保通话转至电话
分机或插入 EXT(分机)插槽内的应答机。
46
以安全接收模式接收
视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型号
的功能”)。
可能需要防止未经授权的人员查看接收的传真。打开安全接收模式,接入
的所有传真均将存储到内存中。输入密码即可打印接入的传真。
要使用安全接收模式,可通过控制面板中的 (传真)> (菜单
> 传真功能 > 安全接收激活菜单。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 传真设置 > 安全接收。
打印已接收的传真
1 从控制面板中选择 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真功能 > 安全接
收 > 打印。
或从触摸屏上选择安装 > 机器设置 > 下步 > 传真设置 > 安全接收 >
打印。
2 输入四位数的密码,然后按OK。
3 机器打印存储在内存中的所有传真。
47
双面打印传真
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此
功能不适用于您的机器。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。传真功能
4. 特殊功能 250
1 将单页文档正面朝下放在文档玻璃板上,或者将文档正面朝上装入
进稿器中。
2 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单) > 传真设置 > 接收 > 双面
打印。
• 关闭: 以正常模式打印。
• 长边: 将页面打印为书本形式。
• 短边: 将页面打印为记事本形式。
3 按 OK。
4 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
48
把传真接收到内存中
由于机器是一种多任务设备,因此可以在复印或打印的同时接收传真。如
果在复印或打印时接收到传真,则机器会将收到的传真存储在其内存中。
然后,在完成复印或打印后,机器会立即自动打印传真。
如果接收并打印传真,则无法同时处理其他复印和打印作业。
49
自动打印已发送传真报告
可以设置机器,使其打印一份有关前 50 次通信操作的详细报告,其中包括
时间和日期。
1 按控制面板上的 (传真)> (菜单)> 传真设置 > 自动报告 >
打开。
2 按 (取消或停止/清除)返回就绪模式。
2
5
34. 特殊功能 251
使用共享文件夹功能
此功能允许您将机器内存用作共享文件夹。它的优势在于,您可以通过计
算机窗口便捷地使用共享文件夹。
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“不同型
号的功能”)。
• 配备大容量存储设备的机型上可使用此功能(请参见第 10 页上的“
多种功能”)。
• 管理员可以通过设置 ID 和密码来限制用户访问,并设置同时使用
它的最大用户数。
50
创建共享文件夹
1 从计算机打开 Windows 资源管理器窗口。
2 在地址栏中输入打印机的 \\[IP 地址](例如:\\169.254.133.42),然
后按 Enter 键或单击执行。
3 在 nfsroot 目录下新建一个文件夹。
51
使用共享文件夹
您可以像普通计算机上那样使用共享文件夹。像普通 Windows 文件夹那
样创建、编辑和删除文件夹或文件。还可以将扫描的数据存储在共享文件
夹中。您可以直接打印存储在共享文件夹中的文件。可以打印的文件包括
TIFF、BMP、JPEG 和 PRN。4. 特殊功能 252
使用内存/硬盘驱动器功能
配备大容量存储设备 (HDD) 或内存的机型上可使用此功能(请参见第
10 页上的“多种功能”)。
52
设置可选内存
从打印机驱动程序
安装可选内存后,您可以使用高级打印功能,如检验作业以及在打印窗口
中指定打印专用作业。选择属性或首选项,并配置打印模式。
使用控制面板
如果机器有可选内存或可选硬盘驱动器,可以从 (菜单)按钮 > 系统设
置 > 作业管理使用这些功能。
• 当前作业: 所有等待打印的打印作业都以您发送的顺序列在“活动的作
业队列”中。您可以在打印之前从该队列中删除某项作业,或者将某项
作业往前移以便更快打印。
• 文件策略: 在通过可选内存继续进行打印作业之前,您可以选择生成文
件名的文件策略。如果在输入新文件名时,可选内存中已存在相同的
文件名,则可以重命名或覆盖该文件。
• 已存储的作业: 可打印或删除已存储的作业。
• 根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此
功能不适用于您的机器。
• 安装硬盘驱动器后,您还可以从 (菜单)按钮 > 系统设置 > 表单
菜单打印预定义的文档模板。5. 实用管理工具
本章将介绍提供给您的管理工具,可帮助您充分利用机器。
• Easy Capture Manager 254
• Samsung AnyWeb Print 255
• Easy Eco Driver 256
• 使用 SyncThru™ Web Service 257
• 使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager 260
• 使用 Samsung 打印机状态 263
• 使用Smart Panel 265
• 使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator 2665. 实用管理工具 254
Easy Capture Manager
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
只需按打印屏幕键即可捕捉屏幕并启动 Easy Capture Manager。此时您可以轻松地按捕捉或编辑状态打印捕捉到的屏幕。5. 实用管理工具 255
Samsung AnyWeb Print
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 和 Macintosh 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
与使用普通程序相比,此工具可帮助您更轻松地捕捉、预览、处理和打印 Windows Internet Explorer 页面。单击开始 > 所有程序 > Samsung Printers >
Samsung AnyWeb Print > Download the latest version 以链接至可下载该工具的网站。5. 实用管理工具 256
Easy Eco Driver
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
使用 Easy Eco Driver,您可以应用 Eco 功能在打印前节省纸张和墨粉。要使用此应用程序,应选中打印机属性中的在打印作业前启动 Easy Eco Driver
复选框。
Easy Eco Driver 还允许您执行简单编辑,如删除图像和文本、更改字体等。您可以将常用设置保存为预设。
使用方法:
1 打开要打印的文档。
2 打印文档。
将显示一个预览窗口。
3 选择要应用于文档的选项。
您可以看到已应用功能的预览。
4 单击打印。5. 实用管理工具 257
使用 SyncThru™ Web Service
• 对于 SyncThru™ Web Service,至少要求 Internet Explorer 6.0 或更
高版本。
• 根据机器的选项或型号,本用户指南中的 SyncThru™ Web Service
解释可能与您的机器不同。
• 仅限网络型号(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
1
访问 SyncThru™ Web Service
1 从 Windows 访问 Web 浏览器,如 Internet Explorer。
在地址字段中输入打印机的 IP 地址(http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx),然后
按 Enter 键或单击执行。
2 机器的内嵌网站将打开。
登录 SyncThru™ Web Service。
配置 SyncThru™ Web Service 中的选项之前,首先必须以管理员身份登
录。在不登录的情况下仍可以使用 SyncThru™ Web Service,但您将无法
访问设置选项卡和安全选项卡。
1 单击 SyncThru™ Web Service 网站右上角的登录。
2 键入 ID 和密码,然后单击登录。
• ID: admin
• 密码: sec00000
2
SyncThru™ Web Service 概述
视打印机型号而定,某些选项卡可能不会出现。
信息选项卡
此选项卡为您提供有关机器的一般信息。您可以检查诸如墨粉剩余量等信
息。此外,您还可打印错误报告等报告。
• 活动警报: 显示机器中已出现的警报及其严重性。
• 耗材: 显示已打印的页数以及墨粉盒中的剩余墨粉量。
• 使用计数器: 按打印类型显示使用次数:单面和双面。
• 当前设置: 显示机器信息和网络信息。使用 SyncThru™ Web Service
5. 实用管理工具 258
• 打印信息: 打印系统相关报告、电子邮件地址和字体报告等报告。
设置选项卡
此选项卡可用于设置打印机提供的配置和网络。需要作为管理员登录才能
查看此选项卡。
• 机器设置选项卡: 设置机器提供的选项。
• 网络设置 选项卡: 显示网络环境选项。设置 TCP/IP 和网络协议等选
项。
安全选项卡
此选项卡可用于设置系统和网络安全信息。需要作为管理员登录才能查看
此选项卡。
• 系统安全: 设置系统管理员信息,也可以启用或禁用机器功能。
• 网络安全: 设置 HTTPs,IPSec,IPv4/IPv6 过滤,802.1x 和验证服务器
的设置。
• 用户访问控制: 根据每个用户的角色,将用户分为几组。每个用户的授
权、认证和统计将由相应组的角色定义控制。
维护 选项卡
此选项卡可用于通过升级固件以及设置用来发送电子邮件的联系信息来
维护打印机。您还可以通过选择 链接 菜单来连接到 Samsung 网站或下载
驱动程序。
• 固件升级: 升级机器固件。
• 联系信息: 显示联系人信息。
• 链接: 显示可下载或检查信息的实用网站的链接。
3
电子邮件通知设置
您可通过设置该选项接收有关机器状态的电子邮件。通过设置包括 IP 地
址、主机名称、电子邮件地址与 SMTP 服务器信息等在内的信息,将自动
向某人的电子邮箱发送机器状态(墨粉不足或机器故障)。该选项可由机
器管理员更加频繁地使用。
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器。使用 SyncThru™ Web Service
5. 实用管理工具 259
1 从 Windows 启动 web 浏览器,如 Internet Explorer。
在地址字段中输入机器的 IP 地址(http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx),然后按“
回车”键或单击执行。
2 机器的内嵌网站将打开。
3 在设置选项卡中,依次选择机器设置 > 电子邮件通知。
如果您尚未配置发送服务器环境,请进入设置 > 网络设置 > 邮件发送
服务器(SMTP),在设置电子邮件通知之前先配置网络环境。
4 选中启用复选框,以便使用电子邮件通知。
5 单击添加按钮添加电子邮件通知用户。
为您希望收到其警告的收件人姓名和电子邮件地址设置通知项。
6 单击应用。
如果防火墙已激活,则可能无法成功发送电子邮件。在这种情况下,请
联系网络管理员。
4
设置系统管理员信息
此设置是使用电子邮件通知选项所必需的。
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器。
1 从 Windows 启动 web 浏览器,如 Internet Explorer。
在地址字段中输入机器的 IP 地址(http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx),然后按“
回车”键或单击执行。
2 机器的内嵌网站将打开。
3 在安全选项卡中,依次选择系统安全 > 系统管理员。
4 输入管理员的姓名,电话号码,地点和电子邮件地址。
5 单击应用。5. 实用管理工具 260
使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
• 视型号或可选商品,此功能可能不可用(请参见第 7 页上的“软件
”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 和 Macintosh 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的
“软件”)。
• 对于 Windows,Samsung Easy Printer Manager 至少需要 Internet
Explorer 6.0 或更高版本。
Samsung Easy Printer Manager 是一个将 Samsung 机器设置集中到一个
位置的应用程序。Samsung Easy Printer Manager 结合了设备设置以及打
印环境、设置/操作和启动。所有这些功能提供了一个轻松使用 Samsung
机器的途径。Samsung Easy Printer Manager 提供两个不同的用户界面供
用户选择:基本用户界面和高级用户界面。在两个界面之间切换很简单:单
击按钮即可。
5
理解 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
要打开程序:
对于 Windows,
选择开始 > 程序或所有程序 > Samsung Printers > Samsung Easy
Printer Manager > Samsung Easy Printer Manager。
对于 Macintosh,
打开应用程序文件夹 > Samsung 文件夹 > Samsung Easy Printer
Manager。
Samsung Easy Printer Manager 界面包含几个不同的基本部分,如下表所
述:
屏幕截图可能因操作系统不同而异。
1
打印机列表 打印机列表显示计算机上已安装的打印机以及网络发
现添加的网络打印机(仅限 Windows)。使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
5. 实用管理工具 261
选择帮助菜单或单击窗口中的 按钮,单击要了解的任何选项。
6
高级设置用户界面概述
高级用户界面适用于负责管理网络和机器的人员。
根据选项或型号的不同,某些菜单可能不会显示。这种情况下,此功能
不适用于您的机器。
设备设置
您可以配置各种机器设置,如机器设置、纸张、布局、模拟、网络和打印信
息。
2
打印机信息 该区域为您提供有关机器的总体信息。您可以检查信
息,如机器的机型名称、IP 地址(或端口名称)以及机
器状态。
您可以查看联机用户指南。
故障排除按钮: 当出现错误时,此按钮可用于
打开故障排除指南。可以直接打开用户指南中
的必要部分。
3
应用程序信息 包含用于更改为高级设置、首选项、帮助和关于的链
接。
按钮可用于将用户界面更改为高级设置用
户界面(请参见第 261 页上的“高级设置用户界
面概述”)。
4
快速链接 显示特定机器功能的快速链接。本部分还包含指向高
级设置中的应用程序的链接。
如果将机器连接到网络,将启用 SyncThru™
Web Service 图标。
5
内容区域 显示选定机器、剩余墨粉量和纸张的相关信息。此信息
因选定机器不同而异。一些机器不具备此功能。
6
订购耗材 在“订购耗材”窗口中单击订购按钮。您可以在线订购备
换墨粉盒。使用 Samsung Easy Printer Manager
5. 实用管理工具 262
扫描至 PC 设置
该菜单包含创建或删除扫描至 PC 配置文件的设置。
• 扫描启动: 决定是否在设备上启用扫描。
• 基本选项卡: 包含普通扫描的相关设置和设备设置。
• 图像选项卡: 包含图像更改的相关设置。
传真至 PC 设置
该菜单包含选定设备的基本传真功能的相关设置。
• 禁用: 如果禁用为开,该设备不会接收进入传真。
• 启用从设备接收传真: 启用设备上的传真,还可以设置更多选项。
警报设置(仅限 Windows)
此菜单包含错误警报的相关设置。
• 打印机警报: 提供何时收到警报的相关设置。
• 电子邮件提醒: 提供通过电子邮件接收警报的相关选项。
• 警报历史记录: 提供设备历史和墨粉相关警报。
作业统计
提供指定作业统计用户的配额信息查询。可以使用 SyncThru™ 或
CounThru™ 管理软件等作业统计软件创建这一配额信息并应用到设备。5. 实用管理工具 263
使用 Samsung 打印机状态
Samsung 打印机状态是一个监视和通知机器状态的程序。
• 根据使用的机器或操作系统的不同,本“用户指南”中所示的
Samsung 打印机状态窗口及其内容可能会有所不同。
• 检查操作系统是否和您的机器兼容(请参见第 103 页上的“规格”)。
• 只适用于 Windows 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的“软件”)。
7
Samsung 打印机状态概述
如果在操作过程中出现错误,可以从 Samsung 打印机状态检查错误。安装
机器的软件时将自动安装 Samsung 打印机状态。
还可手动启动 Samsung 打印机状态。转至打印首选项,单击基本选项卡 >
打印机状态按钮。
这些图标出现在 Windows 任务栏中:
图标 含义 描述
正常 机器处于就绪模式并且未出现错误或警告。
警告 机器处于可能会在以后发生错误的状态。例如,设备
可能处于墨粉不足的状态,该状态可能会使设备到
达墨粉用尽的状态。
错误 机器至少出现一个错误。
1
碳粉量 您可以查看每个墨粉盒中的剩余碳粉量。根据所
使用的机器不同,上方窗口中所示的机器和墨粉
盒数量可能不同。一些打印机不具有此功能。
2 选项 您可以设置打印作业警报的相关设置。
3 订购耗材 您可以在线订购备换墨粉盒。使用 Samsung 打印机状态
5. 实用管理工具 264
4
User’s Guide 您可以查看联机用户指南。
当出现错误时,此按钮可用于打开
Troubleshooting Guide。可以直接打开“
用户指南”中的“故障排除”章节。
5 关闭 关闭窗口。5. 实用管理工具 265
使用Smart Panel
智能面板是一种监视和通知机器的状态,并且允许您自定义机器设置的程
序。您可以从 Samsung 网站下载智能面板(请参见第 132 页上的“安装智
能面板”)。
• 根据使用的机器或操作系统的不同,本“用户指南”中所示的Smart
Panel窗口及其内容可能有所不同。
• 检查操作系统是否和您的机器兼容(请参见第 103 页上的“规格”)。
• Smart Panel仅适用于 Linux 操作系统用户(请参见第 7 页上的“软
件”)。
8
Smart Panel概述
如果在操作过程中出现错误,可以从Smart Panel检查错误。还可手动启动
Smart Panel。
双击通知区域中的智能面板图标( )。
9
更改Smart Panel的设置
右键单击Smart Panel图标,然后选择 Configure smart panel。从
Configure smart panel 窗口选择所需的设置。
1
碳粉量 您可以查看每个墨粉盒中的剩余碳粉量。根据所使
用的机器不同,上方窗口中所示的机器和墨粉盒数
量可能不同。如果您看不到此功能,表明它不适用
于您的机器。
2 Buy Now 您可以在线订购备换墨粉盒。
3
User’s Guide 您可以查看联机用户指南。
当出现错误时,此按钮可用于打开
Troubleshooting Guide。可以直接打开“用
户指南”中的“故障排除”章节。
4
Printer Setting 您可以在打印机设置工具窗口中配置各项机器设
置。一些打印机不具有此功能。
如果您的机器已联网,则会显示
SyncThru™ Web Service 窗口,而不是打印
机设置工具。5. 实用管理工具 266
使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator
Unified Driver Configurator 是一种主要用于配置打印机设备的工具。需要
安装 Unified Linux Driver 才能使用 Unified Driver Configurator(请参见第
132 页上的“Linux 安装”)。
在将驱动程序安装在您的 Linux 系统上之后,将在您的桌面上自动创建
Unified Driver Configurator 图标。
10
打开 Unified Driver Configurator
1 双击桌面上的 Unified Driver Configurator。
也可以单击 Startup 菜单图标,然后选择 Samsung Unified Driver
> Unified Driver Configurator。
2 单击左侧各个按钮可切换到相应的配置窗口。
1 Printer Configuration
2 Port Configuration使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator
5. 实用管理工具 267
要使用屏幕帮助,请单击窗口中的 Help 或 按钮。
3 更改配置之后,单击 Exit 关闭 Unified Driver Configurator。
11
打印机配置
Printers configuration 有两个选项卡:Printers 和 Classes。
Printers 选项卡
单击 Unified Driver Configurator 窗口左侧的机器图标按钮,查看当前系
统的打印机配置。
1 切换到 Printers configuration。
2 显示已安装的所有机器。
3 显示机器的状态、型号名称和 URI。使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator
5. 实用管理工具 268
打印机控制按钮如下:
• Refresh: 更新可用打印机列表。
• Add Printer: 允许您添加新机器。
• Remove Printer: 删除选定机器。
• Set as Default: 将当前的选定机器设置为默认机器。
• Stop/Start: 停止/启动机器。
• Test: 允许您打印测试页,以确保机器工作正常。
• Properties: 允许您查看并更改打印机属性。
Classes 选项卡
Classes 选项卡显示可用机器类别列表。
• Refresh: 更新类别列表。
• Add Class: 允许您添加新的机器类别。
• Remove Class: 删除选定机器类别。
1 显示所有打印机类别。
2 显示类别状态和该类别中的所有打印机数量。使用 Linux Unified Driver Configurator
5. 实用管理工具 269
12
Ports configuration
在此窗口中,您可以查看可用端口的列表、检查每个端口的状态,以及释
放在所有者因任何缘由终止作业时释放因繁忙状态而搁置的端口。
• Refresh: 更新可用端口列表。
• Release port: 释放选定端口。
1 切换到 Ports configuration。
2 显示所有的可用端口。
3 显示端口类型,连接到端口的设备和状态。6. 故障排除
本章介绍有关如何排除故障的帮助信息。
• 进纸问题 271
• 电源和电缆连接问题 272
• 打印问题 273
• 打印质量问题 276
• 复印问题 283
• 扫描问题 284
• 传真问题 285
• 操作系统问题 2876. 故障排除 271
进纸问题
状况 建议的解决方法
打印过程中出现卡纸 清除卡纸。
纸张粘连在一起 • 检查纸盘的最大纸张容量。
• 确保使用的纸张类型正确。
• 将纸张从纸盘中取出,然后弯折或呈扇形散开。
• 潮湿的环境会使一些纸张粘连在一起。
不得送入多张纸 纸盘中可能叠放有不同类型的纸张。请只装入同一类型、大小和重量的纸张。
机器不进纸 • 清除机器内的所有阻碍物。
• 未正确装纸。从纸盘中取出纸张,然后按正确方法将其重新装入。
• 纸盘中的纸张过多。从纸盘中取出多余的纸张。
• 纸张过厚。仅使用符合机器规格要求的纸张。
不断地卡纸 • 纸盘中的纸张过多。从纸盘中取出多余的纸张。如果在特殊材料上打印,请使用纸盒手动进纸。
• 使用了错误的纸张类型。仅使用符合机器规格要求的纸张。
• 机器内可能有碎屑。打开前盖,清除任何碎屑。
信封歪斜或不能正确进纸 确保纸张导板紧贴信封两侧。6. 故障排除 272
电源和电缆连接问题
状况 建议的解决方法
机器未通电,
或者计算机和机器间的连接线缆未正确连接
• 首先将机器连接到电源。如果机器的控制面板上有 (电源)按钮,请按下它。
• 断开机器的电缆连接,然后重新连接。6. 故障排除 273
打印问题
状况 可能的原因 建议的解决方法
机器不能打印 机器未通电。 首先将机器连接到电源。如果机器的控制面板上有 (电源)按钮,请按下它。
未将机器设为默认机器。 在 Windows 中将您的机器选作默认打印机。
检查机器是否出现以下情况:
• 盖板没有关闭。合上盖板。
• 卡纸。清除卡纸(请参见第 91 页上的“清除卡纸”)。
• 未装纸。装纸(参见第 41 页上的“在纸盘中装纸”)。
• 未安装墨粉盒。安装墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
• 确保拆掉墨粉盒上的保护套(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
如果出现系统故障,请联系服务代表。
计算机和机器间的连接线缆未正确连接。 断开机器电缆连接,然后重新连接(请参见第 23 页上的“后视图”)。
计算机和机器间的连接线缆有问题。 如有可能,将线缆连接到另一台正常工作的计算机上,然后进行打印作业。还可
尝试使用一根不同的机器线缆。
端口设置错误。 检查 Windows 打印机设置,确保打印作业发送到正确的端口。如果计算机有多个
端口,请确认机器连接到正确的端口。打印问题
6. 故障排除 274
机器不能打印 机器可能配置不正确。 检查打印首选项确保所有打印设置均正确无误。
打印机驱动程序可能安装不正确。 卸载然后重新安装机器的驱动程序。
机器出现故障。 检查控制面板上的显示信息,查看机器是否提示系统故障。请与服务代表联系。
文档太大,计算机没有足够的硬盘空间可供访
问该打印作业。
请留出更多硬盘空间,然后再次打印该文档。
出纸盘已满。 从出纸盘中取走纸张后,机器将继续打印。
机器从错误的纸张来源选
择了打印材料
在打印首选项中选择的纸张选项可能不正确。 对于许多应用程序而言,纸张来源选项位于打印首选项中的纸张选项卡下方(请
参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。选择正确的纸张来源。请参见打印机驱动
程序的帮助屏幕(请参见第 54 页上的“使用帮助”)。
打印作业极为缓慢 作业可能过于复杂。 降低页面的复杂程度,或尝试调整打印质量设置。
页面的一半为空白 页面方向设置可能错误。 在应用程序中更改页面方向(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。请参见打
印机驱动程序的帮助屏幕(请参见第 54 页上的“使用帮助”)。
纸张大小与纸张大小设置不一致。 请确保打印机驱动程序设置中的纸张大小与纸盘中的纸张匹配。或者确保打印机
驱动程序设置中的纸张大小与您使用的软件应用程序设置中的纸张选择匹配(请
参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
机器可以打印,但出现了
文本错误,乱码或不完整
情况。
机器线缆松动或有故障。 断开机器线缆连接,然后重新连接。尝试打印一份曾经成功打印过的作业。如果
可以,将线缆与机器连接到另一台运行有效的计算机上,然后尝试打印。最后,尝
试更换新的机器线缆。
选择的是错误的打印机驱动程序。 检查应用程序的打印机选择菜单,确保选择了您的机器。
软件应用程序存在故障。 尝试从另一个应用程序打印作业。
操作系统存在故障。 退出 Windows,然后重新启动计算机。关闭机器电源,然后再次重新打开。
状况 可能的原因 建议的解决方法打印问题
6. 故障排除 275
打印页面,但全部为空白 墨粉盒有问题或墨粉已用完。 如果需要,请重新摇匀墨粉。如果需要,更换墨粉盒。
• 请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”。
• 请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”。
文件中可能有空白页。 检查文件,确保文件中没有空白页。
某些零件(如控制器或控制板)可能存在故
障。
请与服务代表联系。
机器无法正确打印 PDF
文件。遗漏了图片、文字
或示意图的某些部分
PDF 文件与 Acrobat 产品不兼容。 将 PDF 文件作为图像打印会使文件被打印。启动 Acrobat 打印选项中的 打印为图
像。
将 PDF 文件作为图像打印时将需要较长的时间。
照片的打印质量欠佳、图
像不清楚
照片的分辨率太低。 请减小照片尺寸。如果在软件应用程序中增大照片尺寸,分辨率将会降低。
打印前机器出纸盘附近会
散发出蒸汽
使用潮湿的纸张会导致打印时产生蒸汽。 这并不是故障。请继续打印。
该机器不能打印特殊尺寸
的纸张,例如:账单纸
纸张大小与纸张大小设置不符。 在打印首选项的纸张选项卡的自定义中设置正确的纸张大小(请参见第 53 页上
的“打开打印首选项”)。
账单纸在打印后卷曲。 纸张类型设置不符。 更改打印机选项,然后再试。转至打印首选项,单击纸张选项卡,然后将类型设置
为厚纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
状况 可能的原因 建议的解决方法6. 故障排除 276
打印质量问题
如果机器内部变脏或装纸不当,则可能会降低打印质量。请参见下表解决
问题。
状况 建议的解决方法
打印件颜色浅或褪色 • 如果页面上出现白色竖条或褪色区,则表示墨粉量不足。安装新的墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
• 纸张可能不符合规格;例如,纸张过于潮湿或粗糙。
• 如果整个页面的颜色都很浅,则说明打印分辨率的设置过低或启用了“省墨”模式。请调整打印分辨率并关闭“省墨”模式。
请参见打印机驱动程序的帮助屏幕。
• 褪色和污迹同时出现说明墨粉盒需要清洁。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
• 机器内 LSU 零件的表面可能较脏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。如果这些步骤仍不能解决问题,请与
服务代表联系。
纸张上半部打印颜色与纸张其
余部分相比较浅
墨粉可能无法有效粘附在这种纸上。
• 更改打印机选项,然后再试。转至打印首选项,单击纸张选项卡,然后将纸张类型设置为再生纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打
开打印首选项”)。
墨粉斑点 • 纸张可能不符合规格;例如,纸张过于潮湿或粗糙。
• 传墨辊可能较脏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
• 送纸路径可能需要清洁。请联系服务代表(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
A aB bC c
A aB bC c
A aB bC c
A aB bC c
A aB bC c打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 277
褪字 如果页面上偶尔出现褪色区(通常为圆形):
• 单张纸可能有问题。请尝试重新打印作业。
• 纸张湿度不均匀或纸的表面有湿斑。请尝试一种不同品牌的纸张。
• 这批纸张有质量问题。造纸工艺会导致某些区域不吸墨。请尝试使用一种不同品牌的纸张。
• 更改打印机选项,然后再试。转至打印首选项,单击纸张选项卡,然后将类型设置为厚纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印
首选项”)。
如果这些步骤仍不能解决问题,请与服务代表联系。
白点 如果页面上出现白点:
• 纸张过于粗糙且纸张上的大量灰尘落至机器内部组件,因而传墨辊可能较脏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机
器”)。
• 送纸路径可能需要清洁。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
如果这些步骤仍不能解决问题,请与服务代表联系。
竖条 如果页面上出现黑色竖条:
• 机器内的墨粉盒表面(磁鼓部分)可能刮损。拆下墨粉盒,安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
如果页面上出现白色竖条:
• 机器内 LSU 零件的表面可能较脏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。如果这些步骤仍不能解决问题,请与
服务代表联系。
状况 建议的解决方法
A a B b C
A a B b C
A a B b C
A a B b C
A a B b C打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 278
黑色或彩色背景 如果背景渲染程度不足:
• 更换一种较轻的纸张。
• 检查环境条件:过于干燥或潮湿(相对湿度超过 80%)的条件会增加背景渲染程度。
• 取出旧墨粉盒,然后安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
• 摇匀墨粉(请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”)。
墨粉拖尾 • 清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
• 检查纸张类型和质量。
• 拆下墨粉盒,安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
反复出现垂直瑕疵 如果打印面上重复出现间距均匀的印痕:
• 墨粉盒可能已损坏。如果相同问题仍然出现,可取下该墨粉盒,然后安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒
”)。
• 机器零件上可能沾有墨粉。如果缺陷出现在打印页背面,则再打印几张纸后问题可能会自行解决。
• 定影组件可能已损坏。请与服务代表联系。
状况 建议的解决方法打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 279
背景散射 背景散射是因随机分布在打印页上的少量墨粉所产生的。
• 纸张可能过于潮湿。尝试换用另一批纸张进行打印。不需要时请勿打开纸张的包装,以免纸张吸收空气中的湿气。
• 如果在信封上出现背景散射情况,请更改打印布局,以避免打印在背面重叠接缝区域内。在接缝上打印可导致问题出现。
或从打印首选项窗口中选择厚纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打开打印首选项”)。
• 如果整个打印页都出现了背景墨粉扩散现象,请通过您的软件应用程序或在打印首选项中调整打印分辨率(请参见第 53
页上的“打开打印首选项”)。确保选择正确的纸张类型。例如:如果选择特厚纸,而实际使用的是普通纸,可能出现导致复
印质量问题的用墨过量情况。
• 如果使用新的墨粉盒,请首先摇匀墨粉(请参见第 71 页上的“摇匀墨粉”)。
墨粉颗粒围绕在粗体字符或图
片周围。
墨粉可能无法有效粘附在这种纸上。
• 更改打印机选项,然后再试。转至打印首选项,单击纸张选项卡,然后将纸张类型设置为再生纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打
开打印首选项”)。
• 确保选择正确的纸张类型。例如:如果选择特厚纸,而实际使用的是普通纸,可能出现导致复印质量问题的用墨过量情
况。
字符扭曲 • 如果字符扭曲且出现中空图像,可能是因为纸面过于光滑。试用另一种纸张。
状况 建议的解决方法
A打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 280
页面歪斜 • 确保正确装入纸张。
• 检查纸张类型和质量。
• 确保导板顶靠纸叠不过紧或过松。
卷曲或波纹 • 确保正确装入纸张。
• 检查纸张类型和质量。高温和高湿度都会导致纸张卷曲。
• 将纸盘内的纸摞翻转过来。此外,请尝试将纸张在纸盘中旋转 180°。
起皱或折叠 • 确保正确装入纸张。
• 检查纸张类型和质量。
• 将纸盘内的纸摞翻转过来。此外,请尝试将纸张在纸盘中旋转 180°。
状况 建议的解决方法
A a B b C
A a B b C
C
C c
A a B b C c打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 281
打印件背面不干净 • 检查墨粉是否泄漏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
页面全彩色或全黑 • 可能是墨粉盒安装不正确。取出墨盒,然后将其重新插入。
• 墨粉盒可能有问题。拆下墨粉盒,安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
• 机器可能需要维修。请与服务代表联系。
墨粉晕开 • 清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
• 检查纸张类型和质量。
• 取出旧墨粉盒,然后安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
如果问题仍然存在,则打印机可能需要维修。请与服务代表联系。
状况 建议的解决方法
A打印质量问题
6. 故障排除 282
字符脱墨 字符脱墨是指应该为纯黑的字符部分内出现白色区域:
• 可能打印在纸张的非打印面上。请取出纸张,并将其翻转。
• 纸张可能不符合纸张规格。
水平条纹 如果出现水平排列的黑色条纹或污点:
• 墨粉盒安装可能不正确。取出墨盒,然后将其重新插入。
• 墨粉盒可能有问题。拆下墨粉盒,安装一个新墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
如果问题仍然存在,机器可能需要维修。请与服务代表联系。
卷曲 如果打印出来的纸张卷曲或纸张无法进入机器:
• 将纸盘内的纸摞翻转过来。此外,请尝试将纸张在纸盘中旋转 180°。
• 更改打印机的纸张选项,然后重试。转至打印首选项,单击纸张选项卡,然后将类型设置为薄纸(请参见第 53 页上的“打
开打印首选项”)。
• 连续在几张纸上反复出现未
知图像
• 墨粉晕开
• 打印颜色过浅或污渍现象
机器可能在 1,000 米或以上的海拔高度使用。高海拔会影响打印质量,如:墨粉松散或图像色浅。更改机器的海拔设置(请参
见第 209 页上的“海拔调整”)。
状况 建议的解决方法
A6. 故障排除 283
复印问题
状况 建议的解决方法
复印件过亮或过暗。 使用复印功能中的黑度使复印件的背景变浅或变深(请参见第 57 页上的“更改每次复印的设置”)。
复印件上出现污迹,线条,墨痕
或污点。
• 如果是原稿的问题,使用复印功能中的黑度将复印件的背景变浅。
• 如果原件没有问题,请清洁扫描装置(请参见第 81 页上的“清洁扫描装置”)。
复印的图像歪斜。 • 确保原件与定位指示对齐。
• 传墨辊可能较脏。清洁机器内部(请参见第 77 页上的“清洁机器”)。
打印出空白复印件。 确保原件正面朝下放在扫描仪玻璃板上,或者是正面朝上放入进纸器。
如果这些步骤仍不能解决问题,请与服务代表联系。
复印件上的图像易被擦除。 • 将纸盘中的纸张更换为新包装中的纸。
• 在湿度高的地区,请勿将纸张长时间搁置在机器中。
复印时经常出现卡纸。 • 将纸呈扇形散开,翻转后放入纸盘。将纸盘中的纸张更换为新纸。如果需要,请检查/调整纸张导板。
• 确保纸张的类型和重量合适(请参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。
• 清除卡纸后,请检查机器中是否剩有复印纸。
墨粉盒用尽之前,墨粉盒的打
印量少于预期值。
• 原件可能包含图片,实线或粗线条。例如,原件可能是表格,新闻稿,书籍或使用较多墨粉的其他文档。
• 复印时,扫描仪盖可能一直开着。
• 关闭机器电源,然后重新打开。6. 故障排除 284
扫描问题
状况 建议的解决方法
扫描仪不工作。 • 确保要扫描的原件正面朝下放在扫描仪玻璃板上,或者是正面朝上放在进纸器中(请参见第 48 页上的“装入原件”)。
• 可能没有足够的可用内存空间来保存要扫描的文档。尝试使用“预扫描”功能,检查其是否正常工作。尝试降低扫描分辨
率。
• 检查打印机电缆是否连接正确。
• 确保打印机电缆没有问题。请使用确认完好的打印机电缆。如有必要,更换打印机电缆。
• 检查扫描仪配置是否正确。在 SmarThru Office 或要使用的应用程序中检查扫描设置,以确保扫描仪作业发送至正确的端
口(例如:USB001)。
装置扫描速度缓慢。 • 检查机器是否在打印接收到的数据。如果是,请打印完接收的数据后再扫描文档。
• 图形的扫描速度要比文本慢得多。
• 使用扫描模式时通信速度会很慢,因为分析并再现扫描的图像时需要大量的内存。通过 BIOS 设置将计算机设置为 ECP
打印机模式。这将有助于提高速度。有关如何设置 BIOS 的详细信息,请参见您计算机的用户指南。
计算机屏幕上出现以下信息:
• 设备无法设置为您需要的 H/
W 模式。
• 其他程序正在使用该端口。
• 端口已禁用。
• 扫描仪正忙于接收或打印数
据。请在当前作业完成后再
试。
• 无效句柄
• 扫描失败
• 可能正在复印或打印作业。作业完成时,请尝试重新复印或打印作业。
• 所选端口当前正被占用。重新启动计算机并重试。
• 打印机电缆可能连接不当或电源被关闭。
• 未安装扫描仪驱动程序或工作环境设置不当。
• 确保机器连接正确并通电,然后重新启动计算机。
• USB 线可能连接不当或电源关闭。6. 故障排除 285
传真问题
状况 建议的解决方法
机器不工作,没有任何显示并且按钮不起
作用。
• 拔下电源线,然后将其重新插入。
• 确保电源插座通电。
• 确保电源已打开。
无拨号音。 • 检查电话线是否正确连接(请参见第 23 页上的“后视图”)。
• 将另一个电话机插入墙上的电话插孔,检查插孔是否正常工作。
内存中存储的号码无法正确拨号。 确保内存中存储的号码准确无误。要进行检查,请打印一份地址簿列表。
原件未能送入机器。 • 确保纸张没有褶皱,且插入方法正确。检查原件的大小是否合适,不要太厚,也不要太薄。
• 确保进纸器牢牢地合上。
• 可能需要更换进纸器橡胶垫。请联系服务代表(请参见第 69 页上的“可用维护零件”)。
无法自动接收传真。 • 接收模式应该设为传真(请参见第 247 页上的“更改接收模式”)。
• 确保纸盒中有纸(请参见第 106 页上的“打印介质规格”)。
• 查看显示屏是否显示有任何错误信息。如果有,请解决该问题。
机器不发送。 • 确保将原件装入进纸器或者扫描仪玻璃板上。
• 检查目标传真机是否能接收传真。
收到的传真中有空白,或者质量欠佳。 • 发送传真的传真机可能有故障。
• 电话线噪音可能导致线路故障。
• 通过复印检查机器。
• 墨粉盒已经达到其预计的墨粉盒寿命。更换墨粉盒(请参见第 73 页上的“更换墨粉盒”)。
收到的传真上某些文字变宽。 发送传真的传真机可能暂时出现文档卡纸故障。
您发送的原件上有线条 检查扫描单元上面是否有痕迹,然后进行清洁(请参见第 81 页上的“清洁扫描装置”)。传真问题
6. 故障排除 286
机器拨号,但无法与对方传真机建立连接。 对方传真机可能已关闭、缺纸或无法应答来电。与对方机器操作员通话,请求对方解决该问题。
传真未存储在内存中。 可能内存空间不足,无法存储传真。如果显示内存状态的显示屏出现,请将任何不再需要的传真从内存中删
除,然后再次尝试存储该传真。请拨打服务电话。
每页底部或其他页上出现空白区,并且顶
部出现一小条文字。
可能在用户选项设置中选择了错误的纸张设置。检查纸张大小并重新键入。
状况 建议的解决方法6. 故障排除 287
操作系统问题
1
常见 Windows 问题
有关 Windows 错误消息的详细信息,请参阅计算机随附的 Microsoft Windows 用户指南。
状况 建议的解决方法
安装过程中出现“文件正在使用
”消息。
退出所有软件应用程序。从启动组中删除所有软件,然后重新启动 Windows。重新安装打印机驱动程序。
出现“一般保护故障”、“异常
OE”、“假脱机 32”或“非法操作
”等消息。
关闭所有其他应用程序,重新启动 Windows,然后重新打印。
出现“无法打印”、“发生打印机
超时错误”等消息。
打印时可能出现这些信息。仅需等待直至机器完成打印。如果在就绪模式下或打印完成后出现此类消息,请检查连接,查看
是否发生错误。操作系统问题
6. 故障排除 288
2
常见 Macintosh 问题
有关 Macintosh 错误消息的详细信息,请参阅您计算机随附的 Macintosh 用户指南。
状况 建议的解决方法
机器无法正确打印 PDF 文件。遗漏了图片、
文字或示意图的某些部分
将 PDF 文件作为图像打印会使文件被打印。启动 Acrobat 打印选项中的 打印为图像。
将 PDF 文件作为图像打印时将需要较长的时间。
某些信纸在进行封面打印时无法正确显示。 在打印封面时,Mac 操作系统无法创建字体。英文字母和数字在封面上显示正常。
当在 Macintosh 中使用 Acrobat
Reader 6.0 或更高版本打印文档时,打印颜
色不正确。
确保机器驱动程序中的分辨率设置与 Acrobat Reader 中的分辨率设置匹配。操作系统问题
6. 故障排除 289
3
常见 Linux 问题
状况 建议的解决方法
机器不能打印 • 检查系统中是否安装了打印机驱动程序。打开 Unified Driver Configurator 并切换至 Printers configuration 窗口中
的 Printers 选项卡查看可用打印机列表。确保机器显示在列表中。如果未在列表中,请打开 Add new printer
wizard 设置您的设备。
• 检查机器是否已启动。打开 Printers configuration,并从打印机列表中选择您的机器。查看 Selected printer 窗格
中的说明。如果状态包含 Stopped,请按 Start 按钮。之后,即可恢复机器的正常操作。当打印过程中出现某些问
题时,可激活“stopped”状态。
• 检查应用程序是否有特殊打印选项,例如“-oraw”。如果在命令行参数中指定有 “-oraw”,则需要将其删除方可正常
打印。对于 Gimp 前端,选择 “print” -> “Setup printer”,然后在命令项中编辑命令行参数。
有些彩色图像打印出来都是黑色的。 这是 Ghostscript(直到 GNU Ghostscript 7.05 版)中的已知错误,其原因是文档的基本颜色空间是编有索引的颜色空
间,它是通过 CIE 颜色空间转换而来的。由于 Postscript 将 CIE 颜色空间用于颜色匹配系统,因此您应将系统上的
Ghostscript 升级为至少 GNU Ghostscript 7.06 或更高版本。您可以在 www.ghostscript.com 上找到最新的 Ghostscript
版本。
有些彩色图像的输出结果严重失真。 这是 Ghostscript(GNU Ghostscript 7.xx 版以前的版本)中的已知错误,其中文档的基本颜色空间是编有索引的 RGB
颜色空间,通过 CIE 颜色空间转换。由于 Postscript 将 CIE 颜色空间用于颜色匹配系统,因此您应将系统上的
Ghostscript 升级为 GNU Ghostscript 8.xx 或更高版本。您可以在 www.ghostscript.com 上找到最新的 Ghostscript 版
本。
机器无法打印整页内容,只能打印半
张页面
这是在 Ghostscript 8.51 或更早版本以及 64 位 Linux 操作系统上使用彩色打印机时出现的已知问题。此问题已作为在
Ghostscript Bug 688252 报告至 bugs.ghostscript.com。此问题在 AFPL Ghostscript 8.52 或更高版本上得到解决。从
http://sourceforge.net/projects/ghostscript/ 中下载并安装 AFPL Ghostscript 的最新版本可解决此问题。操作系统问题
6. 故障排除 290
有关 Linux 错误消息的详细信息,请参阅您计算机随附的 Linux 用户指南。
无法通过 Gimp Front-end 进行扫描。 检查 Gimp 前端的“Acquire”菜单上是否包含“Xsane:Device dialog”。如果没有,应为计算机上的 Gimp 安装 Xsane 插
件。可以在 Linux 发行光盘或 Gimp 主页上可以找到用于 Gimp 的 Xsane 插件包。有关详细信息,请参阅 Linux 发行光
盘或 Gimp Front-end 应用程序的帮助信息。
如果您希望使用其他类型的扫描应用程序,请参阅应用程序帮助信息。
打印文档时,出现 “Cannot open port
device file” 错误消息。
请避免在进行打印作业时更改打印作业参数(如通过 LPR GUI)。只要打印选项发生更改,则已知版本的 CUPS 服务
器就会中止打印作业,然后从头重新开始打印作业。由于在打印过程中 Unified Linux Driver 将端口锁定,而驱动程序
的突然中止会保持端口处于锁定状态,从而不能用于随后的打印作业。如果出现这种情况,请尝试在 Port
configuration 窗口中选择 Release port 释放端口。
机器未出现在扫描仪列表中。 • 确保机器通过 USB 端口正确连接至计算机,然后将其打开。
• 确保系统中已安装机器的扫描仪驱动程序。打开 Unified Linux Driver Configurator,切换到扫描仪配置,然后按
“Drivers”。确保名称与机器名称对应的驱动程序在窗口中列出。
• 确保端口未被占用。由于打印机的功能组件(打印机与扫描仪)共用同一 I/O 接口(端口),因此可能会出现不同用
户应用程序同时访问同一端口的情况。为避免可能的冲突,每次只允许其中一个对设备进行控制。其他用户会收到
“设备忙”的应答。这种情况通常在开始扫描程序时出现。会出现一个相应的信息窗口。
要找出问题源,请打开“Ports configuration”,然后选择向您扫描仪分配的端口,端口符号 /dev/mfp0 与显示在扫描
仪选项中的 LP:0 标识对应,/dev/mfp1 与 LP:1 相关,依此类推。USB 端口始于 /dev/mfp4,因此 USB:0 上的扫描仪
分别与 /dev/mfp4 相关,依此类推。在“Selected port”窗格中,您可查看该端口是否已被另一个应用程序占用。在这
种情况下,应等待当前作业完成,或者按 Release port 按钮(如果能确定当前端口应用程序运行不正常)。
机器不能扫描。 • 确保将文档装入机器中,确保机器与计算机连接。
• 如果在扫描过程中出现输入/输出错误。
状况 建议的解决方法操作系统问题
6. 故障排除 291
4
常见 PostScript 问题
下列情况与 PS 语言相关,可能会在使用多种打印机语言时出现。
问题 可能的原因 解决方法
无法打印 PostScript 文件 PostScript 驱动程序可能安装不正确。 • 安装 PostScript 驱动程序(请参见第 129 页上的“软件安装”)。
• 打印配置页并验证是否存在用于打印的 PS 版本。
• 如果问题仍然存在,请联系服务代表。
打印限制检查错误报告 打印作业过于复杂。 您可能需要降低页面的复杂性或者安装更多内存。
打印一张 PostScript 错误页 打印作业可能不属于 PostScript 类型。 确保打印作业属于 PostScript 类型。检查软件应用程序是否需要设置将
要发送至机器的 PostScript 页眉文件。
在驱动程序中没有选择选装纸盘 尚未对打印机驱动程序进行配置,使其识别选
装纸盘。
打开 PostScript 驱动程序属性,选择设备选项选项卡,然后设置纸盘选
项。
当在 Macintosh 中使用 Acrobat
Reader 6.0 或更高版本打印文档
时,打印颜色不正确
打印机驱动程序中的分辨率设置可能和
Acrobat Reader 中的分辨率设置不匹配。
确保您打印机驱动程序中的分辨率设置与 Acrobat Reader 中的分辨率
设置匹配。 Contact SAMSUNG worldwide 292
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
If you have any comments or questions regarding Samsung products,
contact the Samsung customer care center.
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web Site
ALBANIA 42 27 5755 www.samsung.com
ARGENTINE 0800-333-3733 www.samsung.com
ARMENIA 0-800-05-555 www.samsung.com
AUSTRALIA 1300 362 603 www.samsung.com
AUSTRIA
0810-SAMSUNG (7267864, €
0.07/min)
www.samsung.com
AZERBAIJAN 088-55-55-555 www.samsung.com
BAHRAIN 8000-4726 www.samsung.com
BELARUS 810-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com
BELGIUM
02-201-24-18 www.samsung.com/
be (Dutch)
www.samsung.com/
be_fr (French)
BOLIVIA 800-10-7260 www.samsung.com
BOSNIA 05 133 1999 www.samsung.com
BRAZIL
0800-124-421
4004-0000
www.samsung.com
BULGARIA 07001 33 11 www.samsung.com
CAMEROON 7095-0077 www.samsung.com
CANADA
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/
ca
www.samsung.com/
ca_fr (French)
CHILE
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
From mobile 02-482 82 00
www.samsung.com
CHINA 400-810-5858 www.samsung.com
COLOMBIA 01-8000112112 www.samsung.com
COSTA RICA 0-800-507-7267 www.samsung.com
COTE D’LVOIRE 8000 0077 www.samsung.com
CROATIA
062 SAMSUNG (062 726
7864)
www.samsung.com
CYPRUS 8009 4000 only from landline www.samsung.com
CZECH
REPUBLIC
800-SAMSUNG (800-726786) www.samsung.com
Samsung Electronics Czech and Slovak, s.r.o., Oasis
Florenc, Sokolovská 394/17, 180 00, Praha 8
DENMARK 70 70 19 70 www.samsung.com
DOMINICA 1-800-751-2676 www.samsung.com
ECUADOR 1-800-10-7267 www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web SiteContact SAMSUNG worldwide
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide 293
EGYPT 08000-726786 www.samsung.com
EIRE 0818 717100 www.samsung.com
EL SALVADOR 800-6225 www.samsung.com
ESTONIA 800-7267 www.samsung.com
FINLAND 030-6227 515 www.samsung.com
FRANCE 01 48 63 00 00 www.samsung.com
GERMANY
01805 - SAMSUNG (726-7864
€ 0,14/min)
www.samsung.com
GEORGIA 8-800-555-555 www.samsung.com
GHANA
0800-10077
0302-200077
www.samsung.com
GREECE
80111-SAMSUNG (80111 726
7864) only from land line(+30)
210 6897691 from mobile and
land line
www.samsung.com
GUATEMALA 1-800-299-0013 www.samsung.com
HONDURAS 800-27919267 www.samsung.com
HONG KONG
(852) 3698-4698 www.samsung.com/
hk
www.samsung.com/
hk_en/
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web Site
HUNGARY 06-80-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
INDIA
1800 1100 11
3030 8282
1800 3000 8282
1800 266 8282
www.samsung.com
INDONESIA
0800-112-8888
021-5699-7777
www.samsung.com
IRAN 021-8255 www.samsung.com
ITALY 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
JAMAICA 1-800-234-7267 www.samsung.com
JAPAN 0120-327-527 www.samsung.com
JORDAN 800-22273 www.samsung.com
KAZAKHSTAN
8-10-800-500-55-500
(GSM:7799)
www.samsung.com
KENYA 0800 724 000 www.samsung.com
KOSOVO +381 0113216899 www.samsung.com
KUWAIT 183-2255 www.samsung.com
KYRGYZSTAN 00-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com
LATVIA 8000-7267 www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web SiteContact SAMSUNG worldwide
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide 294
LITHUANIA 8-800-77777 www.samsung.com
LUXEMBURG 261 03 710 www.samsung.com
MALAYSIA 1800-88-9999 www.samsung.com
MACEDONIA 023 207 777 www.samsung.com
MEXICO 01-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
MOLDOVA 00-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com
MONGOLIA www.samsung.com
MONTENEGRO 020 405 888 www.samsung.com
MOROCCO 080 100 2255 www.samsung.com
NIGERIA 0800-726-7864 www.samsung.com
NETHERLANDS
0900-SAMSUNG (0900-
7267864) (€ 0,10/min)
www.samsung.com
NEW ZEALAND
0800 SAMSUNG (0800 726
786)
www.samsung.com
NICARAGUA 00-1800-5077267 www.samsung.com
NORWAY 815-56 480 www.samsung.com
OMAN 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
PANAMA 800-7267 www.samsung.com
PERU 0-800-777-08 www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web Site
PHILIPPINES
1-800-10-SAMSUNG(726-
7864) for PLDT
1-800-3-SAMSUNG(726-
7864) for Digitel
1-800-8-SAMSUNG(726-
7864) for Globe
02-5805777
www.samsung.com
POLAND
0 801-1 SAMSUNG (172-678)
+48 22 607-93-33
www.samsung.com
PORTUGAL
808 20-SAMSUNG (808 20
7267)
www.samsung.com
PUERTO RICO 1-800-682-3180 www.samsung.com
ROMANIA
08010 SAMSUNG (08010 726
7864) only from landline(+40)
21 206 01 10 from mobile and
land line
www.samsung.com
RUSSIA 8-800-555-55-55 www.samsung.com
SAUDI ARABIA 9200-21230 www.samsung.com
SENEGAL 800-00-0077 www.samsung.com
SERBIA
0700 SAMSUNG (0700 726
7864)
www.samsung.com
SINGAPORE 1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web SiteContact SAMSUNG worldwide
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide 295
SLOVAKIA
0800-SAMSUNG (0800-726-
7864)
www.samsung.com
SOUTH AFRICA 0860-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
SPAIN
902-1-SAMSUNG(902 172
678)
www.samsung.com
SWEDEN 0771 726 7864 (SAMSUNG) www.samsung.com
SWITZERLAND
0848-SAMSUNG (7267864,
CHF 0.08/min)
www.samsung.com/
ch
www.samsung.com/
ch_fr(French)
TADJIKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com
TAIWAN
0800-329-999
0266-026-066
www.samsung.com
TANZANIA 0685 88 99 00 www.samsung.com
THAILAND
1800-29-3232
02-689-3232
www.samsung.com
TRINIDAD &
TOBAGO
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
TURKEY 444 77 11 www.samsung.com
U.A.E 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web Site
UGANDA 0800-300 300 www.samsung.com
U.K 0330 SAMSUNG (7267864) www.samsung.com
U.S.A 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
UKRAINE
0-800-502-000 www.samsung.com/
ua
www.samsung.com/
ua_ru
UZBEKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com
VENEZUELA 0-800-100-5303 www.samsung.com
VIETNAM 1 800 588 889 www.samsung.com
Country/Region Customer Care Center Web Site术语表 296
术语表
以下术语表介绍了与打印相关的常用术语以及本用户指南中提及的术
语,有助于您熟悉本产品。
802.11
802.11 是一套无线局域网 (WLAN) 通信标准,由 IEEE LAN/MAN 标准委员
会 (IEEE 802) 制定。
802.11b/g/n
802.11b/g/n 可共享相同的硬件并使用 2.4 GHz 带宽。802.11b 支持高达
11 Mbps 的带宽,802.11n 支持高达 150 Mbps 的带宽。802.11b/g/n 设备
有时候可能会受到微波炉,无绳电话和蓝牙设备的干扰。
接入点
接入点或无线接入点(AP 或 WAP)是将无线局域网 (WLAN) 中的无线通
信设备连接到一起的设备,是 WLAN 无线电信号的中央传送器和接收器。
ADF
自动进纸器 (ADF) 是一种可以自动送入纸张原件的扫描装置,它可使机器
一次扫描一定数量的纸张。
AppleTalk
AppleTalk 是由 Apple, Inc 开发的专用于计算机网络的一套协议。此协议包
含在最早的 Macintosh (1984) 中,现在由 Apple 将其中关于 TCP/IP 网络
的部分进行了修改。
位深度
这是一个计算机图形术语,描述在位图图像中表现单一像素颜色所使用的
位数。较高的颜色深度使得颜色的范围较宽。随着位数的增加,彩色图上
可能出现的颜色数量会变得很大。1 位颜色通常被称为单色或黑白。
BMP
这是 Microsoft Windows 图形子系统 (GDI) 内部使用的一种位图图形格
式,常用作该平台的简易图形文件格式。
BOOTP
引导程序协议。这是网络客户端用来自动获取其 IP 地址的网络协议。通常
是在计算机或计算机上运行的操作系统的引导过程中完成的。BOOTP 服
务器将地址池中的 IP 地址指定给每个客户端。BOOTP 可使“无盘工作站”
计算机在加载高级操作系统前获取 IP 地址。术语表
术语表 297
CCD
电荷耦合器件 (CCD) 是用来启用扫描作业的硬件。CCD 锁定机制还用于
固定 CCD 模块,以防在机器移动过程中造成损坏。
分页
逐份复印是成套打印多拷贝作业的过程。当选择逐份复印时,设备将在打
印另一份作业前打印出整套作业。
控制面板
控制面板是可以显示控制或监控仪器的平面区域(通常为垂直)。它们通
常位于机器的前端。
覆盖率
这是一个用于衡量打印时墨粉使用量的打印术语。例如,5% 的覆盖率表
示在 A4 尺寸的纸张上,图像或文字的覆盖率为 5%。因此,如果纸张或者
原件上有复杂的图片或很多文字,覆盖率将会更高,这时墨粉使用量将同
覆盖率相同。
CSV
逗号分隔值 (CSV)。CSV 是一种文件格式类型,用于交换不同应用程序之
间的数据。此文件格式用于 Microsoft Excel,已成为整个行业的事实标准,
即使在非 Microsoft 平台中也是如此。
DADF
双面自动进纸器 (DADF) 是一种可自动进纸并将原件翻面的扫描装置,从
而使机器可对纸张两面都进行扫描。
默认
改变打印机状态,重置或初始化时所生效的值或设置。
DHCP
动态主机配置协议 (DHCP) 是客户端与服务器之间的一种网络协议。
DHCP 服务器提供特定于 DHCP 客户端主机请求的配置参数,一般是客户
端主机参与某个 IP 网络所需的信息。DHCP 还提供用于将 IP 地址分配给
客户端主机的机制。
DIMM
双列直插式内存模块 (DIMM),一个承载内存的小电路板。DIMM 存储机器
上的所有数据,例如打印数据,收到的传真数据。
DLNA
数字生活网络联盟 (DLNA) 是一种用于家庭网络设备通过网络互相共享信
息的标准。术语表
术语表 298
DNS
域名服务器 (DNS) 是一个存储网络分布式数据库中的域名相关信息的系
统,例如 Internet。
点阵式打印机
点阵式打印机是指一种计算机打印机,其打印头在页面来回运行并通过碰
撞,击打用墨浸过的布带而打印,非常像打字机。
DPI
每英寸点数 (DPI) 用于衡量打印和扫描的分辨率。一般而言,如果 DPI 越
高,则分辨率就越高,图片就越细腻,文件也就越大。
特色振铃模式
特色振铃模式检测。“特色振铃”是电话公司的一项服务,通过该服务用户
能够使用一条电话线接听几个不同的电话号码。
双面
这是自动将纸张翻面,使机器可以在纸张的两面进行打印(或扫描)的机
制。配有双面打印单元的打印机可以在一个打印周期中在纸张的两面进行
打印。
工作负载
工作负载是在不影响打印机性能的情况下每月的打印页数。一般而言,打
印机都存在使用寿命限制,如每年的打印页数。使用寿命就是平均打印能
力,通常在保修期内。例如,如果工作负载为每月 48,000 页,假定每月工
作 20 天,那么每天的打印机限制为 2,400 页。
ECM
错误修正模式 (ECM) 是建于 1 类传真模式或传真调制解调器中的可选发
送模式。可自动检测或修正传真发送过程中的错误,这些错误有时因电话
线噪音而导致。
模拟
仿真是一种获取与其他设备相同结果的技术。
仿真就是在一个系统上复制另一个系统的功能,使此系统与另一系统执行
相同的操作。仿真重在内部动作的准确复制,而与模拟不同,后者关注的
是被模拟的系统中的摘要模型,通常会考虑其内部状态。
以太网
以太网是适用于局域网 (LAN) 的一种基于帧的计算机网络技术。它定义
OSI 模型物理层的配线与信令,以及介质访问控制 (MAC)/数据链路层的帧
格式和协议。以太网通常以 IEEE 802.3 为标准。从二十世纪九十年代投入
应用至今,它已成为最常用的 LAN 技术。术语表
术语表 299
EtherTalk
这是由 Apple 公司开发的关于计算机网络的一套协议。此协议包含在最早
的 Macintosh (1984) 中,现在由 Apple 将其中关于 TCP/IP 网络的部分进
行了修改。
FDI
外部设备接口 (FDI) 是安装于机器内部的卡,通过它可以使用第三方设
备,如投币启动的设备或读卡器。这些设备可以让您使用机器上的按打印
页数付费服务。
FTP
文件传输协议 (FTP) 是通常用于在任一支持 TCP/IP 协议的网络(例如
Internet 或 Intranet)上交换文件的协议。
定影器装置
激光打印机的一部分,可以将墨粉融入打印介质。由一个热辊和一个压紧
辊组成。墨粉传送到纸张之后,定影器装置会进行加热并施加压力,将墨
粉永久固定在纸上,这就是从激光打印机出来的纸都很热的原因。
网关
这是计算机网络之间或计算机网络与电话线之间的连接。网关非常流行,
因为它是允许访问另一个计算机或网络的计算机或网络。
灰度
这是指当彩色图像转换为灰度图像时,用来表示该图像明暗部分的灰阶;
而色彩正是由不同的灰阶所表示的。
半色调
这是一种通过改变点数来模拟灰度的图像类型。深色区域由很多的点组
成,而浅色区域则由较少的点组成。
大容量存储设备 (HDD)
大容量存储设备 (HDD),通常又称作硬盘驱动器或硬盘,是在快速旋转母
盘的磁性表面上存储数字编码数据的非易失性存储设备。
IEEE
美国电气电子工程师学会 (IEEE) 是一个非营利性的国际专业组织,主要
致力于电子电气技术的发展。
IEEE 1284
1284 并行端口标准是由美国电气电子工程师学会 (IEEE) 制定的。“1284-
B”是指连接至外围设备的并行电缆末端的特定连接器类型(例如打印
机)。术语表
术语表 300
Intranet
这是一个专用网络,它使用 Internet 协议,网络连接和可能的公共通信系
统确保与公司员工安全共享组织的信息或操作。有时此术语仅指最明显的
服务,即内部网站。
IP 地址
Internet 协议 (IP) 地址是指在利用 Internet 协议标准的网络上,供设备识别
其他设备并相互通信的唯一数字。
IPM
每分钟图像数 (IPM) 是测量打印速度的一种方式。IPM 速率说明了每分钟
打印机可完成的单面打印的纸张数量。
IPP
Internet 打印协议 (IPP) 定义了有关打印,管理打印作业,介质大小和分辨
率等等的标准协议。IPP 可以本地使用,或者通过 Internet 发送至更多打印
机,还支持访问控制,验证和加密,使其打印功能更加实用和安全。
IPX/SPX
IPX/SPX 表示 Internet 数据交换/顺序包交换。这是 Novell NetWare 操作系
统使用的网络协议。IPX 和 SPX 均提供了类似 TCP/IP 的连接服务,类似
IP 的 IPX 协议和类似 TCP 的 SPX。IPX/SPX 主要为局域网 (LAN) 而设
计,是针对此目的非常高效的协议(通常,其性能超过 LAN 上的 TCP/
IP)。
ISO
国际标准化组织 (ISO) 是一个国际标准制定团体,由来自不同国家的标准
团体代表组成。它可以制定世界范围内的工商业标准。
ITU-T
国际电信联盟是致力于标准化和管理国际无线电与电信而建立的国际组
织。主要使命包括制定标准,分配无线电频谱和组织不同国家/地区之间的
互联方案以便接打国际电话。ITU-T 中的 -T 表示电信。
ITU-T 表 1
由 ITU-T 发布用于文档传真发送的标准测试表。术语表
术语表 301
JBIG
联合二值图像专家组 (JBIG) 是精度和质量都无损的图像压缩标准,专为二
元图像(特别是传真)的压缩而设计,但也可用于其他图像。
JPEG
联合图像专家组 (JPEG) 是最常用的图形图像有损压缩的标准方法。是用
于在万维网上存储和传输照片的格式。
LDAP
轻型目录访问协议 (LDAP) 是查询和修改运行于 TCP/IP 上的目录服务的
网络协议。
LED
发光二极管 (LED) 是一种可以指示机器状态的半导体设备。
MAC 地址
媒体访问控制 (MAC) 地址是唯一与网络适配器相关的标识符。MAC 地址
是唯一的 48 位标识符,通常两个一组写作 12 个十六进制字符(例如,00-
00-0c-34-11-4e)。此地址通常由制造商直接写入网卡 (NIC) 中,并作为路
由器的辅助程序以尝试查找大型网络中的机器位置。
MFP
多功能外围设备 (MFP) 是在一个物理实体中具有打印机,复印机,传真机
和扫描仪的功能的办公设备。
MH
改进的霍夫曼 (MH) 是一种压缩方法,用于减少需要在传真机之间传输的
数据量,以传送 ITU-T T.4 推荐的图像。MH 是一种基于密码本的行程编码
体系,针对高效地压缩空白区域而优化。由于大多传真都包含较多空白区
域,因此这样做可以减少此类传真的时间。
MMR
改进的二维压缩编码 (MMR) 是由 ITU-T T.6 推荐的压缩方法。
调制解调器
这是调节载波信号以编码数字信息,并解调此类载波信号以解码传送信息
的设备。
MR
改进的像素相对地址指定码 (MR) 是由 ITU-T T.4 推荐的压缩方法。MR 使
用 MH 对扫描的第一行进行编码。第二行与第一行相比较,所得出的差异
结果被编码并发送。术语表
术语表 302
NetWare
这是由 Novell, Inc 开发的网络操作系统。最初它用共同多任务处理在 PC
上运行不同的服务,网络协议源于原型的 Xerox XNS 协议栈。目前
NetWare 同时支持 TCP/IP 和 IPX/SPX。
OPC
有机光导体 (OPC) 是一种可生成虚拟图像,并供激光打印机发出的激光束
打印的机械装置,通常为绿色或红棕色的柱状体。
包含硒鼓的成像装置在打印机中使用的过程中会使硒鼓表面逐渐磨损,由
于其与墨粉盒显影刷,清洁装置及纸张相接触,故应适当地进行更换。
原件
即第一个样本,例如文档,照片或文本等,用于复印或转成其他的样本,但
其本身并非从其他样本复制或转变过来。
OSI
开放系统互联 (OSI) 是由国际标准化组织 (ISO) 开发的通信模型。OSI 提
供了标准的网络设计模块方法,可以将所需的一套复杂功能分成可管理的
独立功能层。这些层从上往下依次是应用层,表示层,会话层,传输层,网
络层,数据链路层和物理层。
PABX
专用自动交换分机 (PABX) 是私人企业内部的电话自动切换系统。
PCL
打印机命令语言 (PCL) 是由 HP 开发的作为打印机协议的页面描述语言
(PDL),已成为业界标准。PCL 最初是为喷墨打印机所开发的,后来又发布
了用于热敏打印机,点阵打印机和激光打印机等不同打印机的 PCL。
PDF
便携式文档格式 (PDF) 是一种由 Adobe Systems 开发的专用文档格式,它
通过与设备和分辨率无关的格式表示二维文档。
PostScript
PostScript (PS) 是一种页面描述语言和编程语言,主要用于电子和桌面排
版领域。- 在解码器中运行以生成图像。
打印机驱动程序
用于从计算机发送命令并传输数据到打印机的程序。术语表
术语表 303
打印介质
可在打印机,扫描仪,传真机或复印机上使用的纸张,信封,标签以及透明
胶片等介质。
PPM
每分钟页数 (PPM) 是衡量打印机打印速度的方法,表示打印机每分钟打印
的页数。
PRN 文件
设备驱动程序接口,可以通过标准的输入/输出系统请求,使软件与设备驱
动程序进行交互,使许多任务得以简化。
Protocol
这是在两个计算端点之间控制或实现连接,通信和数据传输的惯例或标
准。
PS
请参见 PostScript。
PSTN
公共交换电话网 (PSTN) 是基于行业前提的全球公共电路交换电话网的网
络,常通过配电板进行发送。
RADIUS
远程认证拨号用户服务 (RADIUS) 是用于远程用户认证和记费的协议。
RADIUS 允许对身份验证数据进行集中式管理,如使用 AAA(认证,授权
和计费)概念来管理网络访问的用户名和密码。
分辨率
图片的清晰度,以每英寸点数 (DPI) 计量。dpi 越大,分辨率就越高。
SMB
服务器信息块 (SMB) 是主要应用于网络节点之间的共享文件,打印机,串
行端口和混合通信的网络协议。还提供经过验证的相互处理的通信机制。
SMTP
简单邮件传输协议 (SMTP) 是 Internet 上的电子邮件发送标准。SMTP 是
一种相对简单的文本协议,它指定了一个或多个信息接收人,然后将此信
息文本发送出去。它是一个客户端到服务器的协议,可以将邮件信息从客
户端发送至服务器。术语表
术语表 304
SSID
服务集标识符 (SSID) 是无线局域网 (WLAN) 的名称。WLAN 中的所有无线
设备均使用同一 SSID,以便相互通信。SSID 区分大小写,最大长度为 32
个字符。
Subnet Mask
子网掩码用于网络地址的联合,以决定该地址的哪一部分是网络地址,哪
一部分是主机地址。
TCP/IP
传输控制协议 (TCP) 和 Internet 协议 (IP) 是实现运行 Internet 和大多数商
业网络的协议堆栈的一组通信协议。
TCR
传送确认报告 (TCR) 提供了每次传送的详细信息,如任务状态,传送结果
和发送页数。此报告可以设置为在每次任务后打印或者仅在失败的传送后
打印。
TIFF
标签图像文件格式 (TIFF) 是分辨率可变的位图图像格式。TIFF 通常描述
来自扫描仪的图像数据。TIFF 图像利用标签,关键字来定义包含在文件中
的图像的性质。这种灵活的,不依靠平台的格式可用于由不同的图像处理
应用程序制成的图片。
墨粉盒
它是机器(如打印机)中使用的一种装有墨粉的瓶子或容器。墨粉是激光
打印机和复印机中使用的一种粉末,可以在打印纸张上形成文字与图像。
墨粉可以在定影器的热量/压力的作用下融化,与纸张纤维紧密融合。
TWAIN
是用于扫描仪及其软件的行业标准。通过使用与 TWAIN 兼容的扫描仪和
程序,可以由程序内开始扫描。它是一种适用于 Microsoft Windows 和
Apple Macintosh 操作系统的图像捕捉 API。
UNC 路径
统一命名协定 (UNC) 是在 Window NT 和其他 Microsoft 产品中访问网络共
享的标准方法。UNC 路径的格式是:\\<服务器名称>\<共享名称>\<其他目
录>术语表
术语表 305
URL
统一资源定位符 (URL) 是 Internet 上文档与资源的全局地址。地址的首部
分指示使用的协议类型,第二部分指定了资源所处的 IP 地址或域名。
USB
通用串行总线 (USB) 是一种由 USB Implementers Forum, Inc. 开发的标
准,用于连接计算机与外围设备。与并行端口不同,USB 的设计目的是将
一台计算机同时与多台外围设备相连接。
水印
水印是纸张上可识别的图像和模式,在发送光下观察时颜色较淡。水印于
1282 年在意大利的博洛尼亚首次推出,由造纸者用于标识他们的产品,还
可用于邮票,货币和其他政府文档以防伪造。
WEP
有线等效加密 (WEP) 是 IEEE 802.11 中指定的安全协议,以提供与有线
LAN 相同等级的安全。WEP 通过加密无线电数据实现安全性,以使端点
间传输的数据受到保护。
WIA
Windows 图像结构 (WIA) 最初是附带在 Windows Me 和 Windows XP 中推
出的图像结构。可以在这些操作系统中使用与 WIA 兼容的扫描仪进行扫
描。
WPA
Wi-Fi 保护访问 (WPA) 是保护无线 (Wi-Fi) 计算机网络的一类系统,旨在提
高 WEP 的安全特性。
WPA-PSK
WPA-PSK(WPA 预共享密钥)是面向小型企业或家庭用户的 WPA 特殊
模式。在无线接入点 (WAP) 以及任何无线便携式或台式设备中配置共享
密钥或密码。WPA-PSK 为无线客户端与关联的 WAP 之间的每个会话生
成唯一密钥,以实现更高级的安全性。
WPS
Wi-Fi 保护设置 (WPS) 是一种用于建立无线家庭网络的标准。如果您的无
线接入点支持 WPS,您就可以在不使用计算机的情况下轻松配置无线网
络连接。术语表
术语表 306
XPS
XML Paper Specification (XPS) 由 Microsoft 公司开发,不仅是一种页面描
述语言 (PDL) 规范,同时也是一种新的文档格式,对便携式文档和电子文
档大有裨益。XPS 是基于 XML 的规范,基于新的打印路径,同时也是基于
向量且与设备无关的文档格式。索引 307
索引
A
AnyWeb Print 255
安放机器
调整海拔 209
按钮
打印屏幕 24
环保 24, 26
扫描至 24
身份证件复印 25, 26
数字键盘 27
wps 24, 26
安全
符号 15
信息 15
B
报告
机器信息 184, 190, 191, 192, 194, 195,
196, 199
C
菜单概述 33
常见图标 14
存储电子邮件地址 210
错误消息 97
D
打印
打印到文件 218
打印文档
Windows 52
更改默认打印设置 217
Linux 227
Macintosh 226
mobileprint 180
设置为默认机器 217
使用直接打印实用程序 225
双面打印
Macintosh 227
特殊打印机功能 219
UNIX 229
一般设置 183
移动操作系统 180
在一张纸上打印多页
Macintosh 226
打印菜单 183
打印功能 217
打印机设置
机器状态 184, 189, 190, 193, 199
打印机首选项
Linux 228
打印机状态
一般信息 263, 265
打印介质
标签纸 45
卡片纸 46
设置纸张大小 46
设置纸张类型 46
输出支架 106
特殊介质 43
信封 44
预印纸 46
打印偏好设置 53
打印文档
Linux 227
Macintosh 226
UNIX 229
地址簿
编辑 213
使用 213
一般设置 203
注册 213索引
索引 308
组编辑 214
组登记 214
地址簿设置 213
电子邮件
一般设置 203
电子邮件地址 210
存放 210
搜索 210
叠加打印
创建 223
打印 223
删除 223
多用途纸盘
使用特殊介质 43
使用提示 43
F
法规信息 113
分辨率
传真 64
复印
基本复印 57
缩小或放大复印件 59
一般设置 184
G
功能 5
打印介质功能 106
机器功能 181
管理员设置 206
规格 103
打印介质 106
H
耗材
订购 68
更换墨粉盒 73
监控耗材寿命 75
可用耗材 68
预计墨粉盒寿命 70
后视图 23
环保打印 54
J
机器信息 184, 189, 190, 193, 199
K
可选内存
设置可选内存 252
控制面板 24
L
LCD 显示屏
浏览机器状态 184, 189, 190, 193, 199
Linux
常见 Linux 问题 289
打印 227
打印机属性 228
连接 USB 线缆的驱动程序安装 132
连接 USB 线缆的驱动程序重新安装 134
扫描 239
使用 SetIP 139
unifled driver configurator 266
为已连接网络安装驱动程序 144
Linux 扫描 239
了解状态 LED 95
M
Macintosh
常见 Macintosh 问题 288
打印 226
连接 USB 线缆的驱动程序安装 130
连接 USB 线缆的驱动程序重新安装 131索引
索引 309
扫描 237
使用 SetIP 138
为已连接网络安装驱动程序 143
系统要求 110
Macintosh 扫描 237
墨粉盒
处理说明 70
存放 70
非 Samsung 和重新装填的 70
更换墨粉盒 73
摇匀墨粉 71
预计寿命 70
模拟
一般设置 203
模拟设置 203
默认设置
纸盘设置 46
N
N 页缩印打印
Macintosh 226
内存硬盘驱动器功能 251, 252
P
postScript 驱动程序
故障排除 291
print resolution set
Linux 228
Q
卡纸
避免卡纸的提示 85
清除原件 86
清除纸张 91
清洁
搓纸轮 80
内部 78
扫描装置 81
外部 77
清洁机器 77
驱动程序安装
Unix 145
S
Samsung 打印机状态 263
service contact numbers 292
SetIP 程序 137, 173
SmarThru 4 236
SmarThru Office 237
SyncThru Web Service 257
一般信息 257
扫描
从联网机器扫描 232
从图像编辑程序扫描 235
基本信息 231
Linux 扫描 239
Macintosh 扫描 237
扫描至 FTPSMB 服务器 234
扫描至电子邮件 233
使用 Samsung 扫描助手扫描 235
使用 SmarThru 4 扫描 236
使用 SmarThru Office 扫描 237
使用 WIA 驱动程序扫描 235
一般设置 193
扫描功能 231
扫描助手 235
身份证件复印 59
使用帮助 54, 227
手动进纸
装入 43
授权用户索引
索引 310
注册 216
输出支架 48
输入字符 212
水印
编辑 222
创建 222
删除 222
T
特殊功能 208
W
Windows
常见 Windows 问题 287
连接 USB 线缆的驱动程序安装 30, 31
使用 SetIP 137, 173
为已连接网络安装驱动程序 140
系统要求 109
UNIX
打印 229
为已连接网络安装驱动程序 145
Unix
系统要求 111
usb 202
一般 setupusb 202
USB 线
驱动程序安装 30, 31, 130, 132
驱动程序重新安装 131, 134
网络
安装环境 112
IPv6 配置 148
驱动程序安装
Linux 144
Macintosh 143
Windows 140
UNIX 145
SetIP 程序 137, 138, 139, 173
网络程序介绍 136
无线网络设置 151
一般设置 204
有线网络设置 137
维护零件 69
文档框 204
一般设置 204
问题
操作系统问题 287
打印问题 273
打印质量问题 276
电源问题 272
复印问题 283
进纸问题 271
扫描问题 284
传真问题 285
无线
基础结构模式 151
特别模式 151
WPS
断开连接 155
WPS(机器没有显示屏)
PBC 156
PIN 156
USB 线 158, 161, 169
无线网络
网络电缆 173
Y
一般设置 195
约定 14
Z
正视图 21
直接打印实用程序 225索引
索引 311
纸盘
调整宽度和长度 40
更改纸盘大小 40
设置纸张大小和类型 46
手动进纸 43
术语表 296
传真
调节分辨率 64
调节黑度 65
发送计算机中的传真 242
发送优先传真 244
更改接收模式 247
将收到的传真转发到其他目标 245
将已发传真转发到另一个目标 244
将传真接收到内存中 250
接收计算机中的传真 246
取消预定传真作业 244
使用电话分机接收 248
双面打印传真 249
通过纸的两面发送传真 246
延迟传真传送 243
以 DRPD 模式接收 248
以 Tel(电话)模式接收 247
以安全模式接收 249
一般设置 190
以应答机模式接收 248
在预定传真中添加文档 243
在传真模式下接收 64, 248
重拨最后一个号码 241
准备发送传真 62
自动打印已发送传真报告 250
自动重拨 241
传真发送
多路发送 63
传真功能 241
装入
特殊介质 43
纸盘 1 中的纸张 41
装入原件 48
状态 25, 27
准备原稿类型 48
自定义设置 207
www.samsung.com
You can access the full user manual for more
information. To learn to access the user manual, see
“Viewing the user manual” in this quick start guide.
Quick Start Guide
GT-S60102
www.sar-tick.com
This product meets applicable
national SAR limits of 2.0 W/kg. The
specific maximum SAR values can
be found in the SAR information
section of this guide.
When carrying the product or
using it while worn on your body,
maintain a distance of 1.5 cm from
the body to ensure compliance with
RF exposure requirements.
This device provides high quality mobile
communication and entertainment using Samsung’s
high standards and technological expertise.
• Content may differ from the final product, or from
software provided by service providers or carriers,
and is subject to change without prior notice.
• The items supplied with the device and any
available accessories may vary depending on the
region or service provider.
• The supplied items are designed only for this
device and may not be compatible with other
devices.3
• You can purchase additional accessories from
your local Samsung retailer. Make sure they are
compatible with the device before purchase.
• Other accessories may not be compatible with your
device.
• Samsung is not liable for performance issues or
incompatibilities caused by edited registry settings
or modified operating system software. Attempting
to customise the operating system may cause your
device or applications to work improperly.
Instructional icons
Warning: situations that could cause injury
to yourself or others
Caution: situations that could cause damage
to your device or other equipment
Note: notes, usage tips, or additional
information4
Copyright
Copyright © 2012 Samsung Electronics
This guide is protected under international copyright
laws.
No part of this guide may be reproduced,
distributed, translated, or transmitted in any
form or by any means, electronic or mechanical,
including photocopying, recording, or storing in any
information storage and retrieval system, without the
prior written permission of Samsung Electronics.
Trademarks
• SAMSUNG and the SAMSUNG logo are registered
trademarks of Samsung Electronics.
• The Android logo, Google™, Google Maps™,
Google Mail™, YouTube™, Google Play™ Store,
and Google Talk™ are trademarks of Google, Inc.
• and are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc.
CS Headphone and WOW HDx technologies are
incorporated under licence from SRS Labs, Inc.
• Bluetooth® is a registered trademark of Bluetooth
SIG, Inc. worldwide.5
• Windows Media Player
® is a registered trademark
of Microsoft Corporation.
• Wi-Fi
®, Wi-Fi Protected Setup™, Wi-Fi Direct™,
Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™, and the Wi-Fi logo are registered
trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
• All other trademarks and copyrights are the
property of their respective owners.6
Getting started
Device layout
Back button
Microphone
Speaker/Earpiece
Speaker
Proximity sensor
Menu button
Power button
Music button
Home button
Touch screen7
Getting started
Headset jack
Rear camera
GPS antenna
Main antenna
Multipurpose jack
Volume button
Back cover
Memory card slot
Do not cover the antenna area with your
hands or other objects. This may cause
connectivity problems or drain the battery.8
Getting started
Buttons
Button Function
Power
• Press and hold to turn the device
on or off.
• Press and hold for 8-10 seconds to
reset the device if it has fatal errors
or hang-ups, or freezes.
• Press to lock or unlock the device.
The device goes into lock mode
when the touch screen turns off.
Menu
• Tap to open a list of options
available for the current screen.
• Tap and hold on the Home screen
to launch Google search.
Home
• Press to return to the Home screen.
• Press and hold to open the list of
recent applications.9
Getting started
Button Function
Back
• Tap to return to the previous
screen.
Volume
• Press to adjust the device volume.
Music
• Press to pause and resume
playback.
• Press and hold to view the music
player screen.
• Press twice to skip to the next
song.10
Getting started
Installing the SIM or USIM card
and battery
Insert the SIM or USIM card provided by the mobile
telephone service provider, and the included battery.
1 Remove the back cover.
Be careful not to damage your fingernails
when you remove the back cover.11
Getting started
2 Insert the SIM or USIM card with the goldcoloured contacts facing downwards.
The SIM card slot of your device is only suited
for standard SIM cards. Inserting a microSIM
card or a microSIM card with an unauthorised
holder may cause damage to the SIM card
slot of your device.12
Getting started
3 Insert the battery.
2
1
4 Replace the back cover.13
Getting started
Charging the battery
Before using the device for the first time or when the
battery has been unused for extended periods, you
must charge the battery.
Use only Samsung-approved chargers,
batteries, and cables. Unapproved chargers
or cables can cause the battery to explode or
damage the device.
Plug the small end of the charger into the
multipurpose jack of the device, and plug the large
end of the charger into an electric socket.
Connecting the charger improperly may
cause serious damage to the device. Any
damage caused by misuse is not covered by
the warranty.14
Getting started
After fully charging, disconnect the device from the
charger. First unplug the charger from the device, and
then unplug it from the electric socket.
Do not remove the battery before removing
the charger. This may damage the device.
To save energy, unplug the charger when not
in use. The charger does not have a power
switch, so you must unplug the charger from
the electric socket when not in use to avoid
wasting power. The device should remain
close to the electric socket while charging.
Checking the battery charge
status
When you charge the battery while the device is off,
the following icons will show the current battery
charge status:
Charging Fully charged15
Getting started
Turning the device on and off
When turning on the device for the first time, follow
the on-screen instructions to set up your device.
Press and hold the Power button for a few seconds to
turn the device on and off.16
Basics
Notifications
Notification icons appear on the status bar to report
missed calls, new messages, calendar events, device
status, and more. Open the notifications panel,
and then view your device’s current status and use
available options.
Drag down from the status bar to open the
notifications panel. To close the notifications panel,
drag up the bar that is on the bottom of the screen.
The available options may vary depending
on the region or service provider.17
Basics
Making or answering a call
Use call functions, such as making and answering
calls, using options available during a call, or
customising and using call-related features.
Making a call
Enter the number using the keypad, and then tap .
Answering a call
When a call comes in, drag outside the circle.
Managing contacts
Manage contacts, including phone numbers, email
addresses, and others. You can group contacts to
make them easier to search for and send contacts to
others or share them.18
Basics
Sending messages
Send text messages, or multimedia messages by
attaching images or videos.
You may incur additional charges for sending
or receiving messages while you are outside
your home service area. For details, contact
your service provider.
Using applications
The Applications screen displays icons for all
applications, including any new applications
installed.
Open the Applications screen and select an
application icon to open it. Tap to close
applications.19
Basics
Connecting to the Internet
Connect to the Internet by using the Wi-Fi feature or
cellular data network. Open the Internet application
and browse webpages.
You may incur additional charges for
accessing the Internet and downloading
media files. For details, contact your service
provider.
Viewing the user manual
The user manual provides complete information
about operating your device.
You may incur additional charges for
accessing the Internet and downloading
media files. For details, contact your service
provider.20
Basics
From your device
1 Open the Internet application.
2 Tap to open the bookmarks list.
3 Select the bookmark for the user manual.
To access the user manual more easily, place a
shortcut or widget for the user manual on the Home
screen.
The user manual may not be available
depending on the web browser or service
provider.
From your computer
Access www.samsung.com and then search for the
user manual by the model name of your device.21
Safety information
This safety information contains content for mobile devices.
Some content may be not applicable to your device. To
prevent injury to yourself and others or damage to your
device, read the safety information about your device before
using the device.
Warning: Prevent electric shock, fire, and
explosion
Do not use damaged power cords or plugs, or loose electrical
sockets
Do not touch the power cord with wet hands or disconnect the
charger by pulling the cord
Do not bend or damage the power cord
Do not use your device while it is charging or touch your
device with wet hands
Do not short-circuit the charger or the device
Do not drop or cause an impact to the charger or the device
Do not charge the battery with the charger that is not
approved by the manufacturer
Do not use your device during a thunderstorm
Your device may malfunction and your risk of electric shock is
increased.22
Safety information
Do not handle a damaged or leaking Lithium Ion (Li-Ion)
battery
For safe disposal of your Li-Ion battery, contact your nearest
authorised service centre.
Handle and dispose of the device and charger with care
• Use only Samsung-approved battery and charger specifically
designed for your device. Incompatible battery and charger can
cause serious injuries or damage to your device.
• Never dispose of the battery or device in a fire. Follow all local
regulations when disposing of used battery or device.
• Never place the battery or device on or in heating devices,
such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. The device may
explode when overheated.
• Never crush or puncture the device. Avoid exposing the device
to high external pressure, which can lead to an internal short
circuit and overheating.
Protect the device, battery and charger from damage
• Avoid exposing your device and battery to very cold or very hot
temperatures.
• Extreme temperatures can damage the device and reduce the
charging capacity and life of your device and battery.
• Prevent the battery from coming into contact with metal
objects, as this can create a connection between the + and –
terminals of your battery and lead to temporary or permanent
battery damage.
• Never use a damaged charger or battery.23
Safety information
Caution: Follow all safety warnings and
regulations when using your device in
restricted areas
Do not use your device near other electronic devices
Most electronic devices use radio frequency signals. Your device
may interfere with other electronic devices.
Do not use your device near a pacemaker
• Avoid using your device within a 15 cm range of a pacemaker, if
possible, as your device can interfere with the pacemaker.
• To minimise possible interference with a pacemaker, use
your device only on the side of your body that is opposite the
pacemaker.
Do not use your device in a hospital or near medical
equipment that can be interfered with by radio frequency
If you use medical equipment, contact the equipment
manufacturer before using your device to determine whether or
not the equipment will be affected by radio frequencies emitted
by the device.
If you use a hearing aid, contact the manufacturer for
information about radio interference
The radio frequency emitted by your device may interfere
with some hearing aids. Before using your device, contact the
manufacturer to determine whether or not your hearing aid will be
affected by radio frequencies emitted by the device.
Turn off the device in potentially explosive environments
• Turn off your device in potentially explosive environments
instead of removing the battery.24
Safety information
• Always comply with regulations, instructions and signs in
potentially explosive environments.
• Do not use your device at refuelling points (petrol stations), near
fuels or chemicals, or in blasting areas.
• Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or explosive
materials in the same compartment as the device, its parts, or
accessories.
Turn off your device when on an aircraft
Your device may interfere with the aircraft’s electronic navigation
instruments.
Your device may interfere with automotive equipment
Electronic devices in your car may malfunction, due to radio
interference from your device. Contact the manufacturer for more
information.
Comply with all safety warnings and
regulations regarding mobile device usage
while operating a vehicle
While driving, safely operating the vehicle is your first
responsibility. Never use your mobile device while driving, if it is
prohibited by law. For your safety and the safety of others, use your
common sense and remember the following tips:
• Get to know your device and its convenience features, such as
speed dial and redial. These features help you reduce the time
needed to place or receive calls on your mobile device.
• Position your device within easy reach. Make sure you can access
your wireless device without taking your eyes off the road. If
you receive an incoming call at an inconvenient time, let your
voicemail answer it for you.25
Safety information
• Suspend calls in heavy traffic or hazardous weather conditions.
Rain, sleet, snow, ice, and heavy traffic can be hazardous.
• Do not take notes or look up phone numbers. Jotting down a
“to do” list or flipping through your address book takes attention
away from your primary responsibility of driving safely.
• Dial sensibly and assess the traffic. Place calls when you are not
moving or before pulling into traffic. Try to plan calls when your
car will be stationary.
• Do not engage in stressful or emotional conversations that
may be distracting. Make the person you are talking to aware
that you are driving and suspend conversations that could
potentially divert your attention from the road.
• Use your device to call for help. Dial a local emergency number
in the case of fire, traffic accidents, or medical emergencies.
• Use your device to help others in emergencies. If you see a car
accident, a crime in progress, or a serious emergency where lives
are in danger, call a local emergency number.
• Call roadside assistance or a special, non-emergency assistance
number when necessary. If you see a broken-down vehicle
posing no serious hazard, a broken traffic signal, a minor traffic
accident where no one appears injured, or a vehicle that you
know to be stolen, call a number that is designated for reporting
these types of situations.
Proper care and use of your mobile device
Keep your device dry
• Humidity and liquids may damage the parts or electronic
circuits in your device.
• Do not turn on your device if it is wet. If your device is already
on, turn it off and remove the battery immediately (if the device
will not turn off or you cannot remove the battery, leave it as-is).
Then, dry the device with a towel and take it to a service centre.26
Safety information
• Liquids will change the colour of the label that indicates water
damage inside the device. Water damage to your device can
void your manufacturer’s warranty.
Do not use or store your device in areas with high
concentrations of dust or airborne materials
Dust or foreign materials can cause your device to malfunction and
may result in fire or electric shock.
Store your device only on flat surfaces
If your device falls, it may be damaged.
Do not store your device in very hot or very cold areas. It is
recommended to use your device at temperatures from 5 °C
to 35 °C
• Your device can explode if left inside a closed vehicle, as the
internal temperature can reach up to 80 °C.
• Do not expose your device to direct sunlight for extended
periods of time (on the dashboard of a car, for example).
• Store the battery at temperatures from 0 °C to 45 °C.
Do not store your device with metal objects, such as coins,
keys, and necklaces
• Your device may be scratched or may malfunction.
• If the battery terminals come into contact with metal objects,
this may cause a fire.
Do not store your device near magnetic fields
• Your device may malfunction or the battery may discharge from
exposure to magnetic fields.
• Magnetic stripe cards, including credit cards, phone cards,
passbooks, and boarding passes, may be damaged by magnetic
fields.27
Safety information
• Do not use carrying cases or accessories with magnetic closures
or allow your device to come into contact with magnetic fields
for extended periods of time.
Do not store your device near or in heaters, microwaves, hot
cooking equipment, or high pressure containers
• The battery may leak.
• Your device may overheat and cause a fire.
Do not drop your device or cause impacts to your device
• The screen of your device may be damaged.
• If bent or deformed, your device may be damaged or parts may
malfunction.
Do not use your device or applications for a while if the device
is overheated
Prolonged exposure of your skin to an overheated device may
cause low temperature burn symptoms, such as red spots and
pigmentation.
If your device has a camera flash or light, do not use it close to
the eyes of people or pets
Using a flash close to the eyes may cause temporary loss of vision
or damage to the eyes.
Use caution when exposed to flashing lights
• While using your device, leave some lights on in the room and
do not hold the screen too close to your eyes.
• Seizures or blackouts can occur when you are exposed to
flashing lights while watching videos or playing Flash-based
games for extended periods. If you feel any discomfort, stop
using the device immediately.28
Safety information
Reduce the risk of repetitive motion injuries
When you repetitively perform actions, such as pressing keys,
drawing characters on a touch screen with your fingers, or playing
games, you may experience occasional discomfort in your hands,
neck, shoulders, or other parts of your body. When using your
device for extended periods, hold the device with a relaxed grip,
press the keys lightly, and take frequent breaks. If you continue to
have discomfort during or after such use, stop using the device
and consult a physician.
Ensure maximum battery and charger life
• Avoid charging your device for more than a week, as
overcharging may shorten battery life.
• Over time, unused device will discharge and must be recharged
before use.
• Disconnect the charger from power sources when not in use.
• Use the battery only for their intended purposes.
Use manufacturer-approved batteries, chargers, accessories,
and supplies
• Using generic battery or charger may shorten the life of your
device or cause the device to malfunction.
• Samsung cannot be responsible for the user’s safety when using
accessories or supplies that are not approved by Samsung.
Do not bite or suck the device or the battery
• Doing so may damage the device or cause an explosion.
• If children use the device, make sure that they use the device
properly.
Do not insert the device or supplied accessories into the eyes,
ears, or mouth
Doing so may cause suffocation or serious injuries.29
Safety information
When using the device:
• Hold the device upright, as you would with a traditional phone.
• Speak directly into the microphone.
• Do not touch the device’s internal antenna. Doing so may result
in reduced call quality or cause the device to emit unintended
levels of radio frequency (RF) energy.
Protect your hearing and ears when using a headset
• Excessive exposure to loud sounds can cause hearing damage.
• Exposure to loud sounds while driving may distract your
attention and cause an accident.
• Always turn the volume down before plugging the earphones
into an audio source and use only the minimum volume setting
necessary to hear your conversation or music.
• In dry environments, static electricity can build up in the
headset. Avoid using headsets in dry environments or touch a
metal object to discharge static electricity before connecting a
headset to the device.
Use caution when using the device while walking or moving
• Always be aware of your surroundings to avoid injury to yourself
or others.
• Make sure the headset cable does not become entangled in
your arms or on nearby objects.
Do not carry your device in your back pockets or around your
waist
You could be injured or damage the device if you fall.30
Safety information
Do not disassemble, modify, or repair your device
• Any changes or modifications to your device can void your
manufacturer’s warranty. If your device needs servicing, take
your device to a Samsung Service Centre.
• Do not disassemble or puncture the battery, as this can cause
explosion or fire.
Do not paint or put stickers on your device
Paint and stickers can clog moving parts and prevent proper
operation. If you are allergic to paint or metal parts of the device,
you may experience itching, eczema, or swelling of the skin. When
this happens, stop using the device and consult your physician.
When cleaning your device:
• Wipe your device or charger with a towel or an eraser.
• Clean the battery terminals with a cotton ball or a towel.
• Do not use chemicals or detergents.
Do not use the device if the screen is cracked or broken
Broken glass or acrylic could cause injury to your hands and face.
Take the device to a Samsung Service Centre to have it repaired.
Do not use the device for anything other than its intended use
Avoid disturbing others when using the device in public
Do not allow children to use your device
Your device is not a toy. Do not allow children to play with it as they
could hurt themselves and others or damage the device.
Install mobile devices and equipment with caution
• Ensure that any mobile devices or related equipment installed in
your vehicle are securely mounted.31
Safety information
• Avoid placing your device and accessories near or in an airbag
deployment area. Improperly installed wireless equipment can
cause serious injury when airbags inflate rapidly.
Allow only qualified personnel to service your device
Allowing unqualified personnel to service your device may result in
damage to your device and will void your manufacturer’s warranty.
Handle SIM cards or memory cards with care
• Do not remove a card while the device is transferring or
accessing information, as this could result in loss of data and/or
damage to the card or device.
• Protect cards from strong shocks, static electricity, and electrical
noise from other devices.
• Do not touch gold-coloured contacts or terminals with your
fingers or metal objects. If dirty, wipe the card with a soft cloth.
Ensure access to emergency services
Emergency calls from your device may not be possible in some
areas or circumstances. Before travelling in remote or undeveloped
areas, plan an alternative method of contacting emergency
services personnel.
Keep your personal and important data safe
• While using your device, be sure to back up important data.
Samsung is not responsible for the loss of any data.
• When disposing of your device, back up all data and then reset
your device to prevent misuse of your personal information.
• Carefully read the permissions screen when downloading
applications. Be particularly cautious with applications that have
access to many functions or to a significant amount of your
personal information.32
Safety information
• Check your accounts regularly for unapproved or suspicious
use. If you find any sign of misuse of your personal information,
contact your service provider to delete or change your account
information.
• In the event your device is lost or stolen, change the passwords
on your accounts to protect your personal information.
• Avoid using applications from unknown sources and lock your
device with a pattern, password, or PIN.
Do not distribute copyright-protected material
Do not distribute copyright-protected material without the
permission of the content owners. Doing this may violate
copyright laws. The manufacturer is not liable for any legal issues
caused by the user’s illegal use of copyrighted material.
Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) certification
information
THIS DEVICE MEETS INTERNATIONAL GUIDELINES FOR
EXPOSURE TO RADIO WAVES
Your mobile device is a radio transmitter and receiver. It is designed
not to exceed the limits for exposure to radio waves (radio
frequency electromagnetic fields) recommended by international
guidelines. The guidelines were developed by an independent
scientific organisation (ICNIRP) and include a substantial safety
margin designed to assure the safety of all persons, regardless of
age and health.33
Safety information
The radio wave exposure guidelines use a unit of measurement
known as the Specific Absorption Rate, or SAR. The SAR limit for
mobile devices is 2.0 W/kg. Tests for SAR are conducted using
standard operating positions with the device transmitting at its
highest certified power level in all tested frequency bands. The
highest SAR values under the ICNIRP guidelines for this device
model are:
Maximum SAR for this model and conditions under which it
was recorded
Head SAR 0.645 W/kg
Body-worn SAR 0.394 W/kg
During use, the actual SAR values for this device are usually well
below the values stated above. This is because, for purposes of
system efficiency and to minimise interference on the network, the
operating power of your mobile device is automatically decreased
when full power is not needed for the call. The lower the power
output of the device, the lower its SAR value.
A body-worn SAR test has been performed on this device at a
separation distance of 1.5 cm. To meet RF exposure guidelines
during body-worn operation, the device must be positioned at
least 1.5 cm away from the body.
Organisations such as the World Health Organisation and the
US Food and Drug Administration have suggested that if people
are concerned and want to reduce their exposure, they could
use a hands-free accessory to keep the wireless device away
from the head and body during use, or reduce the amount
of time spent using the device. For more information, visit
www.samsung.com/sar and search for your device with the model
number.34
Safety information
Correct disposal of this product
(Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment)
(Applicable in countries with separate collection systems)
This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that
the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset,
USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste.
To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health
from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items
from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to
promote the sustainable reuse of material resources.
Household users should contact either the retailer where they
purchased this product, or their local government office, for details
of where and how they can take these items for environmentally
safe recycling.
Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms
and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its
electronic accessories should not be mixed with other commercial
wastes for disposal.
This EEE is compliant with RoHS.35
Safety information
Correct disposal of batteries in this product
(Applicable in countries with separate collection systems)
This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that
the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other
household waste. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or
Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium or lead
above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are
not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to
human health or the environment.
To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please
separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them
through your local, free battery return system.36
Safety information
Disclaimer
Some content and services accessible through this device belong
to third parties and are protected by copyright, patent, trademark
and/or other intellectual property laws. Such content and services
are provided solely for your personal non-commercial use.
You may not use any content or services in a manner that has
not been authorised by the content owner or service provider.
Without limiting the foregoing, unless expressly authorised by the
applicable content owner or service provider, you may not modify,
copy, republish, upload, post, transmit, translate, sell, create
derivative works, exploit, or distribute in any manner or medium
any content or services displayed through this device.
“THIRD PARTY CONTENT AND SERVICES ARE PROVIDED “AS
IS.” SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT CONTENT OR SERVICES
SO PROVIDED, EITHER EXPRESSLY OR IMPLIEDLY, FOR ANY
PURPOSE. SAMSUNG EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
SAMSUNG DOES NOT GUARANTEE THE ACCURACY, VALIDITY,
TIMELINESS, LEGALITY, OR COMPLETENESS OF ANY CONTENT
OR SERVICE MADE AVAILABLE THROUGH THIS DEVICE AND
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES, INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE, SHALL
SAMSUNG BE LIABLE, WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR TORT, FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, ATTORNEY FEES, EXPENSES, OR ANY OTHER DAMAGES
ARISING OUT OF, OR IN CONNECTION WITH, ANY INFORMATION
CONTAINED IN, OR AS A RESULT OF THE USE OF ANY CONTENT OR
SERVICE BY YOU OR ANY THIRD PARTY, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.”37
Safety information
Third party services may be terminated or interrupted at any
time, and Samsung makes no representation or warranty that
any content or service will remain available for any period of time.
Content and services are transmitted by third parties by means
of networks and transmission facilities over which Samsung has
no control. Without limiting the generality of this disclaimer,
Samsung expressly disclaims any responsibility or liability for
any interruption or suspension of any content or service made
available through this device. Samsung is neither responsible nor
liable for customer service related to the content and services. Any
question or request for service relating to the content or services
should be made directly to the respective content and service
providers.Declaration of Conformity
Product details
For the following
Product : GSM WCDMA BT/WiFi Mobile Phone
Model(s) : GT-S6010
Declaration & Applicable standards
We hereby declare, that the product above is in compliance with essential requirements
of the R&TTE Directive (1999/5/EC) by application of:
SAFETY EN 60950-1 : 2006 + A12 : 2011
SAR EN 50360 : 2001 / AC 2006
EN 62479 : 2010
EN 62311 : 2008
EN 62209 - 1 : 2006
EN 62209 - 2 : 2010
EMC EN 301 489-01 V1.9.2 (09-2011)
EN 301 489-07 V1.3.1 (11-2005)
EN 301 489-24 V1.5.1 (10-2010)
EN 301 489-17 V2.1.1 (05-2009)
RADIO EN 301 511 V9.0.2 (03-2003)
EN 301 908-2 V5.2.1 (07-2011)
EN 301 908-1 V5.2.1 (05-2011)
EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (10-2006)
and the Directive (2011/65/EU) on the restriction of the use of certain hazardous
substances in electrical and electronic equipment.
The conformity assessment procedure referred to in Article 10 and detailed in Annex[IV]
of Directive 1999/5/EC has been followed with the involvement of the following Notified
Body(ies):
BABT, Forsyth House, Churchfield Road, Walton-on-Thames,
Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK*
Identification mark: 0168
Representative in the EU
Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab.
Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way,
Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK*
2012.09.27 Joong-Hoon Choi / Lab Manager
(Place and date of issue) (Name and signature of authorized person)
* This is not the address of Samsung Service Centre. For the address or the phone number of
Samsung Service Centre, see the warranty card or contact the retailer where you purchased your
product.Some content may differ from your device
depending on the region or service provider.
Printed in Korea
GH68-37662A
English (EU). 09/2012. Rev. 1.0
About the Samsung Kies
Samsung Kies is a computer application that
manages and syncs media libraries and contacts
with Samsung devices.
Download the latest version of Samsung Kies
from the Samsung website (www.samsung.
com/kies) and install it on your computer.
www.samsung.com
User Manual
GT-S60102
About this manual
This device provides high quality mobile communication and entertainment using Samsung’s
high standards and technological expertise. This user manual is specially designed to detail
the device’s functions and features.
• Please read this manual before using the device to ensure safe and proper use.
• Descriptions are based on the device’s default settings.
• Images and screenshots may differ in appearance from the actual product.
• Content may differ from the final product, or from software provided by service providers
or carriers, and is subject to change without prior notice. For the latest version of the
manual, refer to the Samsung website, www.samsung.com.
• Available features and additional services may vary by device, software, or service
provider.
• Applications and their functions may vary by country, region, or hardware specifications.
Samsung is not liable for performance issues caused by applications from any provider
other than Samsung.
• Samsung is not liable for performance issues or incompatibilities caused by edited
registry settings or modified operating system software. Attempting to customise the
operating system may cause the device or applications to work improperly.
• Software, sound sources, wallpapers, images, and other media provided with this device
are licensed for limited use. Extracting and using these materials for commercial or other
purposes is an infringement of copyright laws. Users are entirely responsible for illegal
use of media.
• You may incur additional charges for data services, such as messaging, uploading and
downloading, auto-syncing, or using location services. To avoid additional charges, select
an appropriate data tariff plan. For details, contact your service provider.
• Default applications that come with the device are subject to updates and may no longer
be supported without prior notice. If you have questions about an application provided
with the device, contact a Samsung Service Centre. For user-installed applications,
contact service providers.
• Modifying the device’s operating system or installing softwares from unofficial sources
may result in device malfunctions and data corruption or loss. These actions are violations
of your Samsung licence agreement and will void your warranty.About this manual
3
Instructional icons
Warning: situations that could cause injury to yourself or others
Caution: situations that could cause damage to your device or other equipment
Note: notes, usage tips, or additional information
Copyright
Copyright © 2012 Samsung Electronics
This guide is protected under international copyright laws.
No part of this guide may be reproduced, distributed, translated, or transmitted in any form or
by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or storing in any
information storage and retrieval system, without the prior written permission of Samsung
Electronics.
Trademarks
• SAMSUNG and the SAMSUNG logo are registered trademarks of Samsung Electronics.
• The Android logo, Google™, Google Maps™, Google Mail™, YouTube™, Google Play™
Store, and Google Talk™ are trademarks of Google, Inc.
• and are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc. CS Headphone and WOW HDx
technologies are incorporated under licence from SRS Labs, Inc.
• Bluetooth® is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc. worldwide.
• Windows Media Player
® is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
• Wi-Fi
®, Wi-Fi Protected Setup™, Wi-Fi Direct™, Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™, and the Wi-Fi logo are
registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
• All other trademarks and copyrights are the property of their respective owners.4
Table of Contents
Getting started
6 Device layout
7 Buttons
8 Package contents
9 Installing the SIM or USIM card and
battery
12 Charging the battery
14 Inserting a memory card
16 Turning the device on and off
16 Holding the device
17 Locking and unlocking the device
17 Adjusting the volume
17 Switching to silent mode
Basics
18 Indicator icons
19 Using the touch screen
22 Control motions
24 Notifications
25 Home screen
27 Using applications
27 Applications screen
29 Entering text
30 Connecting to a Wi-Fi network
31 Setting up accounts
32 Transferring files
33 Securing the device
34 Upgrading the device
Communication
35 Phone
39 Contacts
42 Messaging
43 Email
44 Google Mail
46 Talk
47 Google+
47 Messenger
47 ChatON
Web & network
48 Internet
49 BluetoothTable of Contents
5
Settings
78 About Settings
78 Wi-Fi
78 Bluetooth
78 Data usage
79 More settings
80 Sound
81 Display
81 Wallpaper
81 Motion
82 Storage
82 Battery
82 Applications manager
82 Accounts and sync
82 Location services
83 Security
85 Language and input
87 Back up and reset
87 Date and time
88 Accessibility
89 Developer options
89 About device
Troubleshooting
Media
51 Music Player
52 Camera
57 Gallery
59 Video Player
60 YouTube
61 FM Radio
Application & media stores
63 Play Store
64 Samsung Apps
64 Game Hub
65 Music Hub
65 Play Books
Utilities
66 Memo
67 S Planner
69 Quickoffice
69 Clock
71 Calculator
72 Voice Recorder
73 Search
74 My Files
74 Downloads
Travel & local
75 Maps
76 Local
77 Latitude
77 Navigation6
Getting started
Device layout
Back button
Microphone
Speaker/Earpiece
Speaker
Proximity sensor
Menu button
Power button
Music button
Home button
Touch screen
Headset jack
Rear camera
GPS antenna
Main antenna
Multipurpose jack
Volume button
Back cover
Memory card slotGetting started
7
• Do not cover the antenna area with your hands or other objects. This may cause
connectivity problems or drain the battery.
• Do not use a screen protector. This causes sensor malfunctions.
• Do not allow water to contact the touch screen. The touch screen may malfunction
in humid conditions or when exposed to water.
Buttons
Button Function
Power
• Press and hold to turn the device on or off.
• Press and hold for 8-10 seconds to reset the device if it has
fatal errors or hang-ups, or freezes.
• Press to lock or unlock the device. The device goes into lock
mode when the touch screen turns off.
Menu
• Tap to open a list of options available for the current screen.
• Tap and hold on the Home screen to launch Google search.
Home
• Press to return to the Home screen.
• Press and hold to open the list of recent applications.
Back • Tap to return to the previous screen.
Volume • Press to adjust the device volume.
Music
• Press to pause and resume playback.
• Press and hold to view the music player screen.
• Press twice to skip to the next song.Getting started
8
Package contents
Check the product box for the following items:
• Device
• Battery
• Quick start guide
Use only Samsung-approved software. Pirated or illegal software may cause damage
or malfunctions, which are not covered by the warranty.
• The items supplied with the device and any available accessories may vary
depending on the region or service provider.
• The supplied items are designed only for this device and may not be compatible
with other devices.
• Appearances and specifications are subject to change without prior notice.
• You can purchase additional accessories from your local Samsung retailer. Make
sure they are compatible with the device before purchase.
• Other accessories may not be compatible with your device.
• Use only Samsung-approved accessories. Malfunctions caused by using
unapproved accessories are not covered by the warranty service.
• Availability of all accessories is subject to change depending entirely on
manufacturing companies. For more information about available accessories, refer
to the Samsung website.Getting started
9
Installing the SIM or USIM card and battery
Insert the SIM or USIM card provided by the mobile telephone service provider, and the
included battery.
1 Remove the back cover.
• Be careful not to damage your fingernails when you remove the back cover.
• Do not bend or twist the back cover excessively. Doing so may damage the cover.
2 Insert the SIM or USIM card with the gold-coloured contacts facing downwards.Getting started
10
• Do not remove the protective tape covering the antenna, as this can damage the
antenna.
• The SIM card slot of your device is only suited for standard SIM cards. Inserting a
microSIM card or a microSIM card with an unauthorised holder may cause damage
to the SIM card slot of your device.
• Use caution not to lose or let others use the SIM or USIM card. Samsung is not
responsible for any damages or inconveniences caused by lost or stolen cards.
3 Insert the battery.
2
1
4 Replace the back cover.Getting started
11
Removing the SIM or USIM card and battery
1 Remove the back cover.
2 Pull out the battery.
3 Pull out the SIM or USIM card.Getting started
12
Charging the battery
Charge the battery before using it for the first time. Use the charger to charge the battery. A
computer can be also used to charge the device by connecting them via the USB cable.
Use only Samsung-approved chargers, batteries, and cables. Unapproved chargers or
cables can cause the battery to explode or damage the device.
• When the battery power is low, the device emits a warning tone and displays a low
battery power message.
• If the battery is completely discharged, the device cannot be turned on
immediately when the charger is connected. Allow a depleted battery to charge for
a few minutes before turning on the device.
Charging with the charger
Plug the small end of the charger into the multipurpose jack of the device, and plug the large
end of the charger into an electric socket.Getting started
13
Connecting the charger improperly may cause serious damage to the device. Any
damage caused by misuse is not covered by the warranty.
• The device can be used while it is charging, but it may take longer to fully charge
the battery.
• If the device receives an unstable power supply while charging, the touch screen
may not function. If this happens, unplug the charger from the device.
• While charging, the device may heat up. This is normal and should not affect the
device’s lifespan or performance. If the battery gets hotter than usual, the charger
may stop charging.
• If the device is not charging properly, take the device and the charger to a
Samsung Service Centre.
After fully charging, disconnect the device from the charger. First unplug the charger from the
device, and then unplug it from the electric socket.
Do not remove the battery before removing the charger. This may damage the
device.
To save energy, unplug the charger when not in use. The charger does not have a
power switch, so you must unplug the charger from the electric socket when not in
use to avoid wasting power. The device should remain close to the electric socket
while charging.
Checking the battery charge status
When you charge the battery while the device is off, the following icons will show the current
battery charge status:
Charging Fully chargedGetting started
14
Reducing the battery consumption
Your device provides options that help you save battery power. By customising these options
and deactivating features in the background, you can use the device longer between charges:
• When you are not using the device, switch to sleep mode by pressing the Power button.
• Close unnecessary applications with the task manager.
• Deactivate the Bluetooth feature.
• Deactivate the Wi-Fi feature.
• Deactivate auto-syncing of applications.
• Decrease the backlight time.
• Decrease the brightness of the display.
Inserting a memory card
Your device accepts memory cards with maximum capacities of 32 GB. Depending on the
memory card manufacturer and type, some memory cards may not be compatible with your
device.
• Some memory cards may not be fully compatible with the device. Using an
incompatible card may damage the device or the memory card, or corrupt the data
stored in it.
• Use caution to insert the memory card right-side up.
• The device supports only the FAT file system for memory cards. When inserting a
card formatted in a different file system, the device asks to reformat the memory
card.
• Frequent writing and erasing of data shortens the lifespan of memory cards.
• When inserting a memory card into the device, the memory card’s file directory
appears in the extSdCard folder under the internal memory.Getting started
15
1 Insert a memory card with the gold-coloured contacts facing downwards.
2 Push the memory card into the slot until it locks in place.
Removing the memory card
Before removing the memory card, first unmount it for safe removal. On the Home screen, tap
→Settings→Storage→Unmount SD card→OK.
Push the memory card until it disengages from the device, and then pull it out.
Do not remove the memory card while the device is transferring or accessing
information. Doing so can cause data to be lost or corrupted or damage to the
memory card or device. Samsung is not responsible for losses that result from the
misuse of damaged memory cards, including the loss of data.
Formatting the memory card
A memory card formatted on a computer may not be compatible with the device. Format the
memory card on the device.
On the Home screen, tap →Settings→Storage→Format SD card→Format SD card
→Erase everything.
Before formatting the memory card, remember to make backup copies of all
important data stored on the device. The manufacturer’s warranty does not cover loss
of data resulting from user actions.Getting started
16
Turning the device on and off
When turning on the device for the first time, follow the on-screen instructions to set up your
device.
Press and hold the Power button for a few seconds to turn on the device.
• Follow all posted warnings and directions from authorised personnel in areas
where the use of wireless devices is restricted, such as aeroplanes and hospitals.
• Press and hold the Power button and tap Flight mode to disable the wireless
features.
To turn off the device, press and hold the Power button, and then tap Power off.
Holding the device
Do not cover the antenna area with your hands or other objects. This may cause connectivity
problems or drain the battery.Getting started
17
Locking and unlocking the device
When not in use, lock the device to prevent unwanted operation. Pressing the Power button
turns off the screen and puts the device into lock mode. The device automatically gets locked
if it is not used for a specified period.
To unlock the device, press the Power button or the Home button when the touch screen is
turned off, and then tap anywhere on the screen, and then flick your finger in any direction.
Adjusting the volume
Press the Volume button up or down to adjust the ringtone volume, or to adjust the sound
volume when playing music or video.
Switching to silent mode
Use one of the following methods:
• Press and hold the Volume button down until it switches to silent mode.
• Press and hold the Power button, and then tap .
• Open the notifications panel at the top of the screen, and then tap Sound.
Set the device to alert you to various events in silent mode. On the Home screen, tap →
Settings→Sound→Sound profiles→Vibrate. You can also press and hold the Power
button, and then tap .18
Basics
Indicator icons
The icons displayed at the top of the screen provide information about the status of the
device. The icons listed in the table below are most common.
Icon Meaning
No signal
Signal strength
Roaming (outside of normal service area)
GPRS network connected
EDGE network connected
UMTS network connected
HSDPA network connected
Wi-Fi connected
Bluetooth feature activated
GPS activated
Call in progress
Missed call
Synced with the web
Connected to computer
No SIM or USIM card
New text or multimedia message
Alarm activated
Silent mode activated
Vibration mode activated
Flight mode activated
Error occurred or caution required
Battery power levelBasics
19
Using the touch screen
Use only fingers to use the touch screen.
• Do not allow the touch screen to come into contact with other electrical devices.
Electrostatic discharges can cause the touch screen to malfunction.
• Do not allow the touch screen to contact water. The touch screen may malfunction
in humid conditions or when exposed to water.
• To avoid damaging the touch screen, do not tap it with anything sharp or do not
apply excessive pressure to it with your fingertips.
• Leaving the touch screen idle for extended periods may result in afterimages
(screen burn-in) or ghosting. Turn off the touch screen when you do not use the
device.
Finger gestures
Tapping
To open an application, to select a menu item, to press an on-screen button, or to enter a
character using the on-screen keyboard, tap it with a finger.Basics
20
Dragging
To move an icon, thumbnail, or preview to a new location, tap and hold it and drag it to the
target position.
Double-tapping
Double-tap on a webpage, map, or image to zoom in a part. Double-tap again to return.Basics
21
Flicking
Flick left or right on the Home screen or the Applications screen to see another panel. Flick up
or down to scroll through a webpage or a list, such as contacts.
Pinching
Spread two fingers apart on a webpage, map, or image to zoom in a part. Pinch to zoom out.Basics
22
Control motions
Simple motions allow easy control of the device.
Before using motions, make sure the motion feature is activated. On the Home screen, tap
→Settings→Motion, and then drag the Motion switch to the right.
Rotating the screen
Many applications allow display in either portrait or landscape orientation. Rotating the
device causes the display to automatically adjust to fit the new screen orientation.
To prevent the display from rotating automatically, open the notifications panel and deselect
Screen rotation.
• Some applications do not allow screen rotation.
• Some applications display a different screen depending on the orientation. The
calculator turns into a scientific calculator when rotated to landscape.Basics
23
Turning over
Turn over the device to mute ringtone, pause media playback, or mute the FM radio.
Shaking
Shake the device to search for Bluetooth devices.Basics
24
Notifications
Notification icons appear on the status bar at the top of the screen to report missed calls, new
messages, calendar events, device status, and more. Drag down from the status bar to open
the notifications panel. Scroll the list to see additional alerts. To close the notifications panel,
drag up the bar that is at the bottom of the screen.
From the notifications panel, you can view your device’s current status and use the following
options:
• Wi-Fi: Activate or deactivate the Wi-Fi feature.
• GPS: Activate or deactivate the GPS feature.
• Sound: Activate or deactivate silent mode. You can vibrate or mute your device in silent
mode.
• Screen rotation: Allow or prevent the interface from rotating when you rotate the device.
• Notification: Hide or show notification icons.
• Mobile data: Activate or deactivate the data connection.
• Bluetooth: Activate or deactivate the Bluetooth feature.
• Sync: Activate or deactivate auto-sync of applications.
The available options may vary depending on the region or service provider.Basics
25
Home screen
The Home screen is the starting point to access all of the device’s features. It displays indicator
icons, widgets, shortcuts to applications, and others.
The Home screen can have multiple panels. To view other panels, scroll left or right.
Rearranging items
Adding an application icon
On the Home screen, tap , tap and hold an application icon, and then drag it into a panel
preview.
Adding an item
Customise the Home screen by adding widgets or folders, or rearranging panels.
Tap and hold the empty area on the Home screen, and then select one of the following
categories:
• Apps and widgets: Add widgets or applications to the Home screen.
• Folder: Create a new folder.
• Page: Rearrange panels on the Home screen.
Moving an item
Tap and hold an item and drag it to a new location. To move it to another panel, drag it to the
side of the screen.
Removing an item
Tap and hold an item, and drag it to the rubbish bin that appears at the bottom of the Home
screen. When the item turns red, release it.Basics
26
Rearranging panels
Adding a new panel
Tap →Edit page→ .
Moving a panel
Tap →Edit page, tap and hold a panel preview, and then drag it to a new location.
Removing a panel
Tap →Edit page, tap and hold a panel preview, and then drag it to the rubbish bin at the
bottom of the screen.
Setting wallpaper
Set an image or photo stored in the device as wallpaper for the Home screen.
On the Home screen, tap and hold the empty area, tap Set wallpaper for→Home screen,
and then select one of the following:
• Gallery: See photos taken by the device’s camera or images downloaded from the
Internet.
• Live wallpapers: See animated images.
• Wallpapers: See wallpaper images.
Then, select an image and tap Set wallpaper. Or, select an image, resize it by dragging the
frame, and then tap Done.Basics
27
Using applications
This device can run many different types of applications, ranging from media to Internet
applications.
Opening an application
On the Home screen or the Applications screen, select an application icon to open it.
Opening from recently-used applications
Press and hold the Home button to open the list of recently-used applications.
Select an application icon to open.
Closing an application
Close applications not in use to save battery power and maintain device performance.
Press and hold the Home button, tap Task manager, and then tap End next to an application
to close it. To close all running applications, tap End all.
Applications screen
The Applications screen displays icons for all applications, including any new applications
installed.
On the Home screen, tap to open the Applications screen.
To view other panels, scroll left or right.
Rearranging applications
Tap →Edit, tap and hold an application, and then drag it to a new location. To move it to
another panel, drag it to the side of the screen.Basics
28
Organising with folders
Put related applications together in a folder for convenience.
Tap →Edit, tap and hold an application icon, and then drag it to . Tap the folder →
Unnamed folder, enter a folder name, and then tap Done. Put applications into the new
folder by dragging, and then tap Save to save the arrangement.
Rearranging panels
Pinch on the screen, tap and hold a panel preview, and then drag it to a new location.
Installing applications
Use application stores, such as Samsung Apps, to download and install applications.
Uninstalling applications
Tap →Uninstall, and then select an application to uninstall it.
Default applications that come with the device cannot be uninstalled.
Sharing applications
Share downloaded applications with other users via email, Bluetooth, or other methods.
Tap →Share app, select applications, tap Done, and then select a sharing method. The
next steps vary depending on the method selected.Basics
29
Entering text
Use the Samsung keyboard or the voice input feature to enter text.
Text entry is not supported in some languages. To enter text, you must change the
input language to one of the supported languages.
Changing the keyboard type
Tap any text field, open the notifications panel, tap Select input method, and then select the
type of keyboard to use.
Using the Samsung keyboard
Changing the keyboard layout
Tap →Portrait keyboard types, and then tap Qwerty keyboard or 3x4 keyboard.
On the 3x4 keyboard, a key has three or four characters. To enter a character, tap
repeatedly the key corresponding to the character.
Enter a space.
Break to the next line.
Delete a preceding character.
Enter numerals and punctuation
marks.
Enter uppercase.
Set options for the Samsung
keyboard.
Entering uppercase
Tap before entering a character. For all caps, tap it twice.
Changing language keyboards
Slide the space key left or right to change language keyboards.Basics
30
Entering text by voice
When Google voice typing is activated, the voice recognition screen appears. Speak a text
into the microphone. When you are done, tap to return to the text.
To change the text, tap the underlined and select a word or phrase among the dropdowns.
Copying and pasting
Tap and hold over text, drag or to select more or less text, and then tap to copy or
to cut. The selected text is copied to the clipboard.
To paste it into a text entry field, place the cursor at the point where it should be inserted, and
then tap →Paste.
Connecting to a Wi-Fi network
Connect the device to a Wi-Fi network to use the Internet or share media files with other
devices. (p. 78)
Turning Wi-Fi on and off
Open the notifications panel, and then tap Wi-Fi to turn it on or off.
Turn off Wi-Fi to save the battery when not in use.
Joining Wi-Fi networks
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Wi-Fi, and then drag the Wi-Fi switch to the right.
Select a network from the list of detected Wi-Fi networks, enter a password if necessary, and
then tap Connect. Networks that require a password appear with a lock icon. After the device
connects to a Wi-Fi network, the device will automatically connect to it any time it is available.Basics
31
Adding Wi-Fi networks
If the desired network does not appear in the networks list, tap Add Wi-Fi network at the
bottom of the networks list. Enter the network name in Network SSID, select the security
type and enter the password if it is not an open network, and then tap Save.
Forgetting Wi-Fi networks
Any network that has ever been used, including the current network, can be forgotten so the
device will not automatically connect to it. Select the network in the networks list, and then
tap Forget.
Setting up accounts
Google applications, such as Play Store, require a Google account, and Samsung Apps
requires a Samsung account. Create Google and Samsung accounts to have the best
experience with the device.
Adding accounts
Follow the instructions that appear when opening a Google application without signing in to
set up a Google account.
To sign in with or sign up for a Google account, on the Applications screen, tap Settings
→Accounts and sync→Add account→Google. After that, tap New to sign up, or tap
Existing, and then follow on-screen instructions to complete the account setup. More than
one Google account can be used on the device.
Set up a Samsung account as well.
Removing accounts
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Accounts and sync, select the account to
remove, and then tap Remove account.Basics
32
Transferring files
Move audio, video, image, or other types of files from the device to the computer, or vice
versa.
The following file formats are supported by some applications. Some file formats are
not supported depending on the version of the device’s software.
• Music: mp3, m4a, mp4, 3gp, 3ga, wma, ogg, oga, aac, and flac
• Image: bmp, gif, jpg, and png
• Video: 3gp, mp4, webm, and mkv
• Document: doc, docx, docm, dot, dotx, dotm, xls, xlsx, xlsm, xla, xlam, xlt, xltm, xltx,
ppt, pptx, pot, potx, potm, pptm, ppsx, ppsm, pdf, and txt
Connecting with Samsung Kies
Samsung Kies is a computer application that manages media libraries, contacts, and
calendars, and syncs them with Samsung devices. Download the latest Samsung Kies from
the Samsung website.
1 Connect the device to the computer using the USB cable.
Samsung Kies launches on the computer automatically. If Samsung Kies does not launch,
double-click the Samsung Kies icon on the computer.
2 Transfer files between your device and the computer.
Refer to the Samsung Kies help for more information.
Connecting as a media device
1 Connect the device to the computer using the USB cable.
2 Open the notifications panel, tap Connected as a media device→Media device (MTP).
Tap Camera (PTP) if your computer does not support Media Transfer Protocol (MTP) or
not have any appropriate driver installed.
3 Transfer files between your device and the computer.Basics
33
Securing the device
Prevent others from using or accessing personal data and information stored in the device by
using the security features. The device requires a preset pattern, PIN, or password whenever
unlocking it.
Setting a pattern
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Security→Screen lock→Pattern.
Draw a pattern by connecting four dots or more, and then draw the pattern again to verify it.
Set a backup unlock PIN to unlock the screen when you forget the pattern.
Setting a PIN
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Security→Screen lock→PIN.
Enter at least four numbers, and then enter the password again to verify it.
Setting a password
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Security→Screen lock→Password.
Enter at least four characters including numbers and symbols, and then enter the password
again to verify it.Basics
34
Unlocking the device
Turn on the screen by pressing the Power button or the Home button, and enter the pattern,
PIN, or password.
If the unlock code is forgotten, take the device to a Samsung Service Centre to reset it.
Upgrading the device
The device can be upgraded to the latest software.
This feature may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Upgrading with Samsung Kies
Launch Samsung Kies and connect the device to the computer. Samsung Kies automatically
recognises the device and shows available updates in a dialogue box, if any. Click the Update
button in the dialogue box to start upgrading. Refer to the Samsung Kies help for details on
how to upgrade.
• Do not turn off the computer or disconnect the USB cable while the device is
upgrading.
• While upgrading the device, do not connect other media devices to the computer.
Doing so may interfere with the update process.
Upgrading over the air
The device can be directly upgraded to the latest software by the firmware over-the-air
(FOTA) service.
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→About device→Software update→Update.35
Communication
Phone
Use this application to make or answer a call.
Tap Phone on the Applications screen.
Making calls
Making a call
Use one of the following methods:
• Keypad: Enter the number using the keypad, and then tap .
• Logs: Make a call from the history of incoming and outgoing calls and messages.
• Favourites: Make a call from the list of favourite contacts.
• Contacts: Make a call from the contacts list.
Speed dial numbers
For speed dial numbers, tap and hold the corresponding digit.
Number prediction
When entering numbers on the keypad, automatic predictions appear. Select one of these to
make a call.Communication
36
Finding contacts
Enter a name, phone number, or email address to find a contact in the contacts list. As
characters are entered, predicted contacts appear. Select one to place a call to it.
Making an international call
Tap and hold 0 until the + sign appears. Enter the country code, area code, and phone
number, and then tap .
During a call
The following actions are available:
• Hold: Hold a call. Tap Unhold to retrieve the held call.
• Add call: Dial a second call.
• Swap: Switch between two calls.
• Keypad: Open the keypad.
• Speaker: Activate the speakerphone. Keep the device away from your ears when using
the speakerphone.
• Mute: Turn off the microphone so that the other party cannot hear you.
• Headset: Switch to a Bluetooth headset if it is connected to the device.
• Merge: Make a multiparty call when connected to two calls. Repeat this to add more
parties. This feature is available only if the multiparty call service is active.
• →Contacts: Open the contacts list.
• →Memo: Create a memo.
• →Transfer: Connect the first party to the second party. This disconnects you from
the conversation.Communication
37
Adding contacts
To add a phone number to the contacts list from the keypad, enter the number and tap Add
to contacts.
Sending a message
Tap to send a message to the number on display.
Viewing call logs
Tap Logs to view the history of incoming and outgoing calls.
To filter a call log, tap →View by, and then select an option.
Fixed dialling number
The device can be set to restrict outgoing calls only to numbers with specified prefixes. Those
prefixes are stored in the SIM or USIM card.
Tap →Call settings→Additional settings→Fixed dialling numbers→Enable FDN,
and then enter the PIN2 supplied with the SIM or USIM card. Tap FDN list and add numbers.
Call barring
The device can be set to prevent certain calls from being made. For example, international
calling can be disabled.
Tap →Call settings→Additional settings→Call barring, select a call type, select a call
barring option, and then enter a password.
Receiving calls
Answering a call
When a call comes in, drag outside the circle, or press the headset button.
If the call waiting service is active, another call can be made. When the second call is
answered, the first call is put on hold.Communication
38
Rejecting a call
When a call comes in, drag outside the circle, or press and hold the headset button.
To send a message when rejecting an incoming call, tap Reject call with message. To create
the rejection message, tap →Call settings→Set reject messages.
Automatically rejecting calls from unwanted numbers
Tap →Call settings→Call rejection, drag the Auto reject mode switch to the right, and
then tap Auto reject list. Tap Create, enter a number, assign a category, and then tap Save.
Missed calls
If a call is missed, appears on the status bar. Open the notifications panel to view the list of
missed calls.
Call waiting
Call waiting is a service provided by the service provider. A user can use this service to
suspend a current call and switch to an incoming call.
To make use of this service, tap →Call settings→Additional settings→Call waiting.
Call forwarding
The device can be set to send incoming calls to a specified number.
Tap →Call settings→Call forwarding, and then select a call type and condition. Enter a
number and tap Enable.
Ending a call
Tap to end a call. Or press the headset button.Communication
39
Contacts
Use this application to manage contacts, including phone numbers, email addresses, and
others.
Tap Contacts on the Applications screen.
Managing contacts
Creating a contact
Tap and enter contact information.
• : Add an image.
• / : Add or delete a contact field.
Editing a contact
Select a contact to edit, and then tap .
Deleting a contact
Tap →Delete.
Setting a speed dial number
Tap →Speed dial setting, select a speed dial number, and then select a contact for it. To
remove a speed dial number, tap →Speed dial setting→ →Remove.Communication
40
Searching for contacts
Use one of the following search methods:
• Scroll up or down the contacts list.
• Use the index at the right side of the contacts list for quick scrolling, by dragging a finger
along it.
• Tap the search field at the top of the contacts list and enter search criteria.
Once a contact is selected, take one of the following actions.
• : Add to favourite contacts.
• : Make a call.
• : Compose a message.
• : Compose an email.
Importing and exporting contacts
Syncing with Google Contacts
Tap →Merge with Google→OK.
Contacts synced with Google Contacts appear with in the contacts list.
If a contact is added or deleted on the device, it is also added to or deleted from Google
Contacts, and vice versa.
Syncing with social network sites
Tap →Accounts, select an SNS account, and then tick Sync Contacts.
Importing contacts
Tap →Import/Export→Import from SIM card, Import from SD card, or Import from
USB storage.Communication
41
Exporting contacts
Tap →Import/Export→Export to SIM card, Export to SD card, or Export to USB
storage.
Sharing contacts
Tap →Import/Export→Share namecard via, select contacts, tap Done, and then select
a sharing method.
Favourite contacts
Tap , and then take one of the following actions:
• Search: Search for contacts.
• Add to Favourites: Add contacts to favourites.
• Remove from Favourites: Remove contacts from favourites.
• Grid view / List view: View contacts in grid or list form.
Contact groups
Adding contacts to a group
Select a group, and then tap . Select contacts to add, and then tap Done.
Managing groups
Tap , and then take one of the following actions:
• Create: Make a new group.
• Search: Search for contacts.
• Change order: Tap and hold next to the group name, drag it up or down to another
position, and then tap Done.
• Delete: Select user-added groups, and then tap Delete. Default groups cannot be
deleted.Communication
42
Sending a message or email to a group’s members
Select a group, tap →Send message or Send email, select members, and then tap Done.
Business card
Create a business card and send it to others.
Tap Set up my profile, enter details, such as phone number, email address, and postal
address, and then tap Save. If user information has been saved when you set up the device,
select the business card in ME, and then tap to edit.
Tap →Share namecard via, and then select a sharing method.
Messaging
Use this application to send text messages (SMS) or multimedia messages (MMS).
Tap Messaging on the Applications screen.
You may incur additional charges for sending or receiving messages while you are
outside your home service area. For details, contact your service provider.
Sending messages
Tap , add recipients, enter a message, and then tap .
• Enter a phone number.
• Tap , select contacts, and then tap Done.
Use the following methods to make a multimedia message:
• Tap , and attach images, videos, contacts, memos, events, and others.
• Tap →Insert smiley to insert emoticons.
• Tap →Add subject to enter a subject.Communication
43
Viewing incoming messages
Incoming messages are grouped into message threads by contact.
Select a contact to view the person’s message.
Listening to a voice message
Tap and hold 1 on the keypad, and then follow the instructions from your service provider.
Email
Use this application to send or view email messages.
Tap Email on the Applications screen.
Setting up email accounts
Set up an email account when opening Email for the first time.
Enter the email address and password. Tap Next for a private email account, such as Google
Mail, or tap Manual setup for a company email account. After that, follow on-screen
instructions to complete the setup.
To set up another email account, tap →Settings→ .
Sending messages
Tap the email account to use, and then tap at the top of the screen. Enter recipients,
subject, and message, and then tap .
Tap to add a recipient from the contacts list.
Tap →Add Cc/Bcc to add more recipients.
Tap to attach images, videos, contacts, memos, events, and others.
Tap to insert images, events, contacts, and information location into the message.Communication
44
Reading messages
Select an email account to use, and new messages are retrieved. To manually retrieve new
messages, tap .
Tap a message to read.
Open attachments.
Delete the message.
Reply to the message. Forward the message.
Mark the message as a reminder.
Tap the attachment tab to open attachments, and then tap next to an attachment to save
it.
Google Mail
Use this application to quickly and directly access the Google Mail service.
Tap Google Mail on the Applications screen.
• This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
• This application may be labelled differently depending on the region or service
provider.Communication
45
Sending messages
In any mailbox, tap , enter recipients, a subject, and a message, and then tap .
Tap →Attach file to attach images.
Tap →Add Cc/Bcc to add more recipients.
Tap →Save draft to save the message for later delivery.
Tap →Discard to start over.
Reading messages
Reply to all recipients or forward
this message to others.
Download attachment.
Mark the message as unread.
Add a label to this message.
Reply to this message.
Preview attachment.
Mark the message as a reminder.
Keep this message for long-term
storage.
Add this email address to the
contacts list.
Delete this message.
Labels
Google Mail does not use actual folders, but uses labels instead. When Google Mail is
launched, it displays messages labelled Inbox.
Tap to view messages in other labels.
To add a label to a message, select the message, tap , and then select the label to assign.Communication
46
Talk
Use this application to chat with others via Google Talk.
Tap Talk on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Public profile
Tap the account ID at the top of the friends list to change the availability status, image, or
status message.
Adding friends
Tap , enter the email address of the friend to add, and then tap DONE.
Chatting with friends
Select a friend from the friends list, enter a message in the field at the bottom of the screen,
and then tap .
To add a friend to chat, tap →Add to chat.
To end the chat, tap →End chat.
Switching between chats
Scroll left or right.
Deleting chat history
Chats are automatically saved. To delete chat history, tap →Clear chat history.Communication
47
Google+
Use this application to stay connected with people via Google’s social network service.
Tap Google+ on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Tap All circles to change the category, and then scroll up or down to view posts from your
circles.
Messenger
Use this application to chat with others via Google+ instant messaging service.
Tap Messenger on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Select a friend from the friends list, enter a message in the field at the bottom of the screen,
and then tap .
ChatON
Use this application to chat with any device that has a mobile phone number.
Tap ChatON on the Applications screen.
Create the buddies list by entering phone numbers or email addresses of Samsung accounts,
or selecting buddies from the list of suggest.
Select a buddy to start chatting.
To sync contacts on the device with ChatON, tap Settings→Sync contacts.48
Web & network
Internet
Use this application to browse the Internet.
Tap Internet on the Applications screen.
Viewing webpages
Tap the address field, enter the web address, and then tap Go.
Tap to share, save, or print the current webpage while viewing a webpage.
Opening a new page
Tap →New window.
To go to another webpage, tap , scroll left or right, and tap the page to select it.
Searching the web by voice
Tap the address field, tap , speak a keyword, and then select one of the suggested keywords
that appear.
This feature may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Bookmarks
To bookmark the current webpage, tap →Add bookmark.
To open a bookmarked webpage, tap
,
and then select one.
History
Tap →History to open a webpage from the list of recently-visited webpages. To clear the
history, tap →Clear history.
Tap →History→Most visited to open a webpage from the list of most visited webpages.Web & network
49
Saved pages
To view saved webpages, tap →Saved pages.
Links
Tap and hold a link on the webpage to open it in a new page, save, or copy.
To view saved links, tap →Downloads.
Sharing webpages
To share a webpage address with others, tap →Share page.
To share a part of a webpage, tap and hold the desired text, and then tap .
Bluetooth
Bluetooth creates a direct wireless connection between two devices over short distances. Use
Bluetooth to exchange data or media files with other devices.
• Samsung is not responsible for the loss, interception, or misuse of data sent or
received via the Bluetooth feature.
• Always ensure that you share and receive data with devices that are trusted
and properly secured. If there are obstacles between the devices, the operating
distance may be reduced.
• Some devices, especially those that are not tested or approved by the Bluetooth
SIG, may be incompatible with your device.
• Do not use the Bluetooth feature for illegal purposes (for example, pirating copies
of files or illegally tapping communications for commercial purposes).
Samsung is not responsible for the repercussion of illegal use of the Bluetooth
feature.
To activate Bluetooth, on the Applications screen, tap Settings→Bluetooth, and then drag
the Bluetooth switch to the right.Web & network
50
Pairing with other Bluetooth devices
On the Applications screen, tap Settings→Bluetooth→Scan, and detected devices are
listed. Select the device you want to pair with, and then accept the auto-generated passkey
on both devices to confirm.
Sending and receiving data
Many applications support data transfer via Bluetooth. An example is Gallery. Open Gallery,
select an image, tap →Bluetooth, and then select one of the paired Bluetooth devices.
After that, accept the Bluetooth authorisation request on the other device to receive the
image. The transferred file is saved in the Bluetooth folder. If a contact is received, it is added
to the contacts list automatically.51
Media
Music Player
Use this application to listen to music.
Tap Music Player on the Applications screen.
• Some file formats are not supported depending on the device’s software version.
• Some files may not play properly depending on the encoding used.
Playing music
Select a music category, and then select a song to play.
Open Music square.
Open the playlist.
Adjust the volume.
Restart the currently-playing
song or skip to the previous
song. Tap and hold to move
backwards quickly.
Skip to the next song. Tap and
hold to move forwards quickly.
Turn on shue.
Change the repeat mode.
Select a sound eect.
Pause and resume playback.
Play music on DLNA-enabled
devices.
• SRS CS Headphone™ delivers a 5.1 surround sound experience over standard
headphones or earbuds when listening to multichannel content, such as DVD
movies.
• SRS WOW HDx™ significantly improves the playback quality of audio, delivering a
dynamic entertainment experience with deeper, richer bass, a wider sound stage
and greater high frequency clarity for crisp details.Media
52
Setting a song as ringtone
To use the currently-playing song as ringtone, tap →Set as→Phone ringtone.
Creating playlists
Make an own selection of songs.
Tap Playlists, and then tap →Create playlist. Enter a title and tap OK. Tap Add music,
select songs to include, and then tap Done.
To add the currently-playing song to a playlist, tap →Add to playlist.
Playing music by mood
Play music grouped by mood. The playlist is automatically created by the device. When a new
song is added, tap Music square→ →Library update.
Tap Music square and select a cell of mood.
Camera
Use this application to take photos or videos.
Use Gallery to view photos and videos taken with the device’s camera. (p. 57)
Tap Camera on the Applications screen.
The camera automatically shuts off when unused.
Camera etiquette
• Do not take photos or videos of other people without their permission.
• Do not take photos or videos where legally prohibited.
• Do not take photos or videos in places where you may violate other people’s privacy.Media
53
Taking photos
Taking a photo
Tap to take the photo.
Change the shooting
mode.
Select among various
eects that are available.
Change the camera
settings.
Adjust the brightness.
Indicates which storage is
in use.
Switch between still and
video mode.
Open the image viewer to
display photos.
Scene mode
Predefined settings make point-and-shoot photos easier to take.
Tap →Scene mode.
• Landscape: Use this setting for a wider view.
• Night: Use this setting for images taken in darker conditions.
• Sports: Use this setting for fast-moving subjects.
• Party/Indoor: Use this setting for well-lit indoor scenes.
• Sunset: Use this setting for richer colours and sharper contrasts.
• Dawn: Use this setting for very subtle colours.
• Fall colour: Use this setting for red-shifted background scenery.
• Candlelight: Use this setting for images of bright light against a dark background.
• Backlight: Use this setting for subjects with bright lights behind them.Media
54
Shooting mode
Several photo effects are available, such as cartoon rendering.
Tap →Shooting mode.
• Single shot: Take a single photo.
• Smile shot: Take a photo while the camera waits for a subject to smile.
• Panorama: Take a photo composed of many photos strung together.
• Share shot: Send a photo directly to another device via Wi-Fi Direct.
Panoramic photos
A panoramic photo is a wide landscape image consisting of multiple shots.
Tap →Shooting mode→Panorama.
Tap and move the camera in any direction. When the blue frame aligns with the
viewfinder, the camera automatically takes another shot in a panoramic sequence. To stop
shooting, tap again.
Taking videos
Taking a video
Slide the still-video switch to the video icon, and then tap to take a video. To stop
recording, tap .
The zoom function may not be available when recording at the highest resolution.Media
55
Recording mode
Change recording mode.
Select among various
eects that are available.
Change the camera
settings.
Adjust the brightness.
Indicates which storage is
in use.
Switch between still and
video mode.
Open the video player to
play videos.
Tap to change recording mode.
• Normal: Use this mode for normal quality.
• Limit for MMS: Use this mode to lower quality for sending via messaging.
Zooming in and out
Use one of the following methods:
• Use the Volume button to zoom in or out.
• Spread two fingers apart on the screen to zoom in, and pinch to zoom out.
• The zoom function may not be available when shooting at the highest resolution.
• The zoom in/out effect is available when using the zoom feature while shooting
video.Media
56
Configuring settings for Camera
Tap to configure settings for Camera. Not all of the following options are available in both
still camera and video camera modes. The available options vary depending on the mode
used.
• Edit shortcuts: Reorganise shortcuts to frequently-used options.
• Shooting mode: Change the shooting mode.
• Recording mode: Change recording mode.
• Scene mode: Change the scene mode.
• Exposure value: This determines how much light the camera’s sensor receives. For lowlight situations, use a higher exposure.
• Timer: Use this for delayed-time shots.
• Effects: Select among various photo effects that are available.
• Resolution: Select a resolution. Use higher resolution for higher quality. But it takes up
more memory.
• White balance: Select an appropriate white balance, so images have a true-to-life colour
range. The settings are designed for specific lighting situations. These settings are similar
to the heat range for white-balance exposure in professional cameras.
• Metering: Select a metering method. This determines how light values are calculated.
Centre-weighted measures background light in the centre of the scene. Spot measures
the light value at a specific location. Matrix averages the entire scene.
• Guidelines: Display viewfinder guides to help composition when selecting subjects.
• Image quality: Higher quality images require more storage space.
• Video quality: Set the quality level for videos.
• GPS tag: Attach a GPS location tag to the photo.
• To improve GPS signals, avoid shooting in locations where the signal may be
obstructed, such as between buildings or in low-lying areas, or in poor weather
conditions.
• Your location may appear on your photos when you upload them to the Internet.
To avoid this, deactivate the GPS tag setting.
• Storage: Select the memory location for storage.
• Reset: Reset the camera settings.Media
57
Shortcuts
Reorganise shortcuts for easy access to the camera’s various options.
Tap →Edit shortcuts.
Tap and hold an option and drag it to a slot at the left of the screen. The other icons can be
moved within the list by tapping and dragging them.
Gallery
Use this application to view images and videos.
Tap Gallery on the Applications screen.
• Some file formats are not supported depending on the software installed on the
device.
• Some files may not play properly depending on how they are encoded.
Viewing images
Launching Gallery displays available folders. When another application, such as Email, saves
an image, the download folder is automatically created to contain the image. Likewise,
capturing a screenshot automatically creates the Screenshots folder. Select a folder to open
it.
In a folder, images are displayed by creation date. Select an image to view it in full screen.
Scroll left or right to view the next or previous image.
Zooming in and out
Use one of the following methods to zoom in an image:
• Double-tap anywhere to zoom in.
• Spread two fingers apart on any place to zoom in. Pinch to zoom out, or double-tap to
return.Media
58
Playing videos
Video files show the icon on the preview. Select a video to watch it and tap , and Video
Player launches.
Editing images
When viewing an image, tap and use the following functions:
• Delete: Delete the image.
• Copy to clipboard: Copy to clipboard.
• Rotate left: Rotate anticlockwise.
• Rotate right: Rotate clockwise.
• Crop: Resize the orange frame to crop and save the image in it.
• Set as: Set the image as a wallpaper or a contact image.
• Print: Print via a USB or Wi-Fi connection. The device is only compatible with some
Samsung printers.
• Rename: Rename the file.
• Scan for nearby devices: Search for devices that have media sharing activated.
• Details: View image details.
Deleting images
Use one of the following methods:
• In a folder, tap →Select item, select images, and then tap →Delete.
• When viewing an image, tap →Delete.
Sharing images
Use one of the following methods:
• In a folder, tap →Select item, select images, and then tap to send them to others.
• When viewing an image, tap to send it to others or share it via social network services.Media
59
Setting as wallpaper
When viewing an image, tap →Set as to set the image as wallpaper or to assign it to a
contact.
Video Player
Use this application to play video files.
Tap Video Player on the Applications screen.
• Some file formats are not supported depending on the device's software.
• Some files may not play properly depending on how they are encoded.
Playing videos
Select a video to play.
Move forwards or
backwards by dragging the
bar.
Change screen ratio.
Restart the current video or
skip to the previous video.
Tap and hold to move
backwards quickly.
Adjust the volume.
Skip to the next video. Tap
and hold to move forwards
quickly.
Pause and resume
playback. Media
60
Deleting videos
Tap →Delete, select videos by ticking, and then tap Delete.
Sharing videos
Tap →Share via, select a sharing method, select videos by ticking, and then tap Done.
YouTube
Use this application to watch videos from the YouTube website.
Tap YouTube on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Watching videos
Tap , and then enter a keyword. Select one of the returned search results to watch a video.
Rotate the device to landscape orientation to display full screen.
Pause or resume playback.
Move forwards or
backwards by dragging the
bar.
Change display quality.
Add the video to the
playlist.
Send the URL to others.
Search for videos.
Rotate the screen to
portrait orientation.Media
61
Sharing videos
Select the video to view, tap , and then select a sharing method.
Uploading videos
Select your account, tap , select a video, enter information for the video, and then tap
Upload.
To take a video for uploading to YouTube, tap at the top of the screen.
FM Radio
Listen to music and news on the FM radio.
Tap FM Radio on the Applications screen.
Listening to the FM radio
The FM radio scans and saves available stations automatically when running for the
first time.
Tap to turn on the FM radio. Select the radio station you want from the stations list and tap
to return to the FM radio screen.
Add the current radio station to
the favourites list.
Adjust the volume.
Search for an available radio
station.
Turn the FM radio on or o.
Access services for the current
station.
Record a song from the FM radio.Media
62
Scanning radio stations
Tap →Scan, and then select a scan option. The FM radio scans and saves available
stations automatically.
Select the radio station you want from the stations list and tap to return to the FM radio
screen.
Adding stations to the favourites list
Select to a radio station, and then tap to add the station to the favourites list.63
Application & media stores
Play Store
Use this application to purchase and download applications and games that are able to run
on the device.
Tap Play Store on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Installing applications
Browse applications by category, or tap to search with a keyword.
Select an application to view information. To download it, tap Install. If there is a charge for
the application, tap the price, and follow on-screen instructions to complete the purchase
process.
• When a new version is available for any installed application, an update icon
appears at the top of the screen to alert you to the update. Open the notifications
panel and tap the icon to update the application.
• To install applications that you downloaded from other sources, on the
Applications screen, tap Settings→Security→Unknown sources.
Uninstalling applications
Uninstall the applications purchased from Play Store.
Tap →My Apps, select an application to delete in the list of installed applications, and
then tap Uninstall.Application & media stores
64
Samsung Apps
Use this application to purchase and download dedicated Samsung applications. For more
information, visit www.samsungapps.com.
Tap Samsung Apps on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
If a Samsung account is not registered, follow on-screen instructions to create a Samsung
account. To complete the subscription process, read the terms and conditions, and then tap
Accept to agree to them.
Installing applications
Browse applications by category. Tap to select a category.
To search for an application, tap at the top of the screen, and then enter a keyword in the
search field.
Select an application to view information. To download it, tap Get.
When a new version is available for any installed application, an update icon appears
at the top of the screen to alert you to the update. Open the notifications panel and
tap the icon to update the application.
Game Hub
Use this application to access featured Samsung games.
Tap Game Hub on the Applications screen.
Select a game service and follow on-screen instructions to complete the purchase process.Application & media stores
65
Music Hub
Use this application to purchase and download songs.
Tap Music Hub on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Tap the search field, and then enter a keyword to search for. Select one from the list of search
results.
To buy an album, select the price tag, and then follow on-screen instructions to complete the
purchase process.
Play Books
Use this application to read and download book files.
Tap Play Books on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Select a book file by scrolling left or right. While reading a book file, tap to access
additional options.
To purchase book files, tap .66
Utilities
Memo
Use this application to record important information to save and view at a later date.
Tap Memo on the Applications screen.
Composing memos
Tap , enter a memo, and then tap Save.
To change the background colour, tap → .
To lock the memo so that others cannot view it, tap → .
Browsing memos
Browse memo thumbnails by scrolling up or down.
To edit the memo, tap .
To search for a memo, tap →Search.
To delete memos, tap →Delete.
To send memos to others, tap →Send.
To sort memos by date or colors, tap →Sort by.
To sync memos with a Google account, tap →Sync.
To set a PIN to lock or unlock a memo, tap →PIN lock.
Viewing a memo
Tap the memo to open it. Scroll left or right to see more memos.
Tap and use the following:
• : Delete the memo.
• : Change the background colour.
• : Lock the memo so that others cannot view it.
• : Print the memo via a USB or Wi-Fi connection. The device is only compatible with
some Samsung printers.Utilities
67
S Planner
Use this application to manage events and tasks.
Tap S Planner on the Applications screen.
Creating events or tasks
Tap , and then use one of the following methods:
• Quick add: Create an event or task from a memo. This feature is available only for English
and Korean.
• Add event: Enter an event with an optional repeat setting.
• Add task: Enter a task with an optional priority setting.
To add an event or task more briefly, tap a date to select it and tap it again.
Enter a title and specify which calendar to use or sync with. Then tap Edit event details or
Edit task details to add more details, such as how often the event repeats, when it has an
advance alert, or where it takes place.
Invite others to the event by sending an email. Enter the email address to the Participants
field, or tap to open the contacts list.Utilities
68
Attach a map showing the location of the event. Enter the location in the Location field, tap
next to the field, and then pinpoint the precise location by tapping and holding on the
map that appears.
Attach an image. Tap Images, and then take a photo or select one of the existing images.
Syncing with Google Calendar
Tap →Settings→Sync Event/Task, select the Google account, and then tick Sync
Calendar. To manually sync for updating, tap →Sync.
Changing calendar type
Tap the top left of the screen, and then select one from among different types of calendars
including month, week, and others. A pinch gesture can be used to change calendar type.
For example, pinch to change from the weekly calendar to the monthly calendar, and spread
apart to change monthly calendar back to weekly calendar.
Searching for events
Tap →Search, and then enter a keyword to search for.
To view today’s events, tap Today at the top of the screen.
Deleting events
Select a date or event, and then tap →Delete.
Sharing events
Select an event, tap →Share via, and then select a sharing method.Utilities
69
Quickoffice
Use this application to view documents in various formats, including spreadsheets and
presentations.
Tap Quickoffice on the Applications screen.
Reading documents
Select a Quickoffice program →Internal Storage or Recent Documents→ a document.
Searching documents
Tap Search and then enter search criteria.
Clock
Use this application to set alarms, check the time in any location in the world, measure the
duration of an event, set a timer, or use as the desk clock.
Tap Clock on the Applications screen.
Turn this alarm on or off.Utilities
70
Alarm
Setting alarms
Tap Create alarm, set a time for the alarm to go off, select days for the alarm to repeat, and
then tap Save.
• Snooze: Set an interval and the number of times for the alarm to repeat after the preset
time.
• Smart alarm: Set a time for the alarm to go off before the preset time.
Stopping alarms
Drag outside the large circle to stop an alarm. Drag outside the large circle to repeat
the alarm after a specified length of time.
Deleting alarms
Tap and hold an alarm, and then tap Delete.
World clock
Creating clocks
Tap Add city, and then enter a city name or select a city from the cities list.
To apply summer time, tap and hold a clock, and then tap DST settings.
Deleting clocks
Tap →Delete, select clocks, and then tap Delete.Utilities
71
Stopwatch
Tap Start to time an event. Tap Lap to record lap times.
Tap Reset to clear lap time records.
Timer
Set the duration, and then tap Start.
Drag outside the large circle when the timer goes off.
Desk clock
Tap to view in full screen.
Calculator
Use this application for simple or complex calculations.
Tap Calculator on the Applications screen.
Rotate the device to landscape orientation and tap to display the scientific calculator. If
Screen rotation is disabled, tap →Scientific calculator.
To see calculation history, tap to hide the keypad.
To clear history, tap →Clear history.
To change the character size for history, tap →Text size.Utilities
72
Voice Recorder
Use this application to record or play voice memos.
Tap Voice Recorder on the Applications screen.
Recording voice memos
Tap to start recording. Speak into the microphone at the bottom of the device. Tap to
pause recording. Tap to finish recording.
Display the list of voice memos.
Recording elapsed time
Start recording.
Playing voice memos
Select a voice memo to play.
• : Trim the voice memo.
• : Adjust the volume by dragging the volume bar.
• : Stop playback.
• : Pause playback.
To send a voice memo to others, tap →Share via, and then select a sharing method.Utilities
73
Managing voice memos
In the list of voice memos, tap and select one of the following:
• Share via: Select a sharing method, and then select voice memos to send.
• Delete: Select voice memos to delete.
• Settings: Change the voice recorder settings.
• End: Close the voice recorder.
Search
Use this application to search not only the Internet, but also applications and their contents
on the device as well.
Tap Search on the Applications screen.
Searching the device
Tap the search field, and then enter a keyword. Alternatively, tap , speak a keyword, and
then select one of the suggested keywords that appear.
If no results are returned from the applications, the web browser appears, displaying the
search results.
Search scope
To select what applications to search, tap →Settings→Searchable items, and then tick
the items to search for.Utilities
74
My Files
Use this application to access all kinds of files stored in the device, including images, videos,
songs, and sound clips.
Tap My Files on the Applications screen.
Select a folder to open it. To go back to the parent folder, tap . To return to the root
directory, tap .
In a folder, tap , and then use one of the following options:
• Create folder: Create a folder.
• Delete: Delete files or folders.
• Search: Search for files.
• View by: Change the view mode.
• Sort by: Sort files or folders.
• Share via: Send a file to others.
• Move: Move files or folders to another file folder.
• Copy: Copy files or folders to another file folder.
• Rename: Rename a file or folder.
• Settings: Change the file manager settings.
Downloads
Use this application to see what files are downloaded through the applications.
Tap Downloads on the Applications screen.
To see the files downloaded from the Internet, tap Internet downloads, otherwise, tap Other
downloads to see the files downloaded from other applications, such as Email.
Select a file to open it with an appropriate application.75
Travel & local
Maps
Use this application to pinpoint the location of the device, search for places, or get directions.
Tap Maps on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Searching for locations
Tap , enter an address, and then tap . Select a location to view the detailed location
information. To search for nearby locations, tap .
On the map view, use the following methods:
To clear the map, tap →Clear Map.
To save the map of a specified area to view it offline, tap →Make available offline.
To overlay multiple layers including satellite images, traffic information, and more, tap →
Layers.
To change the map settings, tap →Settings.
To view current location, tap .
To zoom in or out the map, spread two fingers apart on the screen to zoom in, and pinch to
zoom out.Travel & local
76
Getting directions for a destination
1 Tap .
2 Tap , and then select a method to enter starting and ending locations:
• My current location: Use current location for starting location.
• Contacts: Select from the contacts list.
• Point on map: Pinpoint by tapping on the map.
• My Places: Select from the list of favourite places.
3 Select a travel method, such as driving, public transit, or walking, and then tap GET
DIRECTIONS.
4 Select one of the routes that appear, and then tap MAP VIEW to view details.
Local
Use this application to search for nearby restaurants, banks, bus stops, and more.
Tap Local on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Select a place category, and then select a place from the list of search results.
• Map: Pinpoint the place on the map.
• Directions: Search for a route to the place.
• Call: Call the place’s phone number.
To add a place category, tap →Add a search on the category list, and then enter a
keyword to search into the text field.Travel & local
77
Latitude
Use this application to share location information with friends.
Tap Latitude on the Applications screen.
This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
To add a friend with whom location information is shared, tap →Select from Contacts or
Add via email address. Select one from contacts or enter an email address, and then tap Add
friends to send an invitation. Once the invitation is accepted, either party can know where
the other party is located.
Navigation
Use this application to search for a route to a destination.
Tap Navigation on the Applications screen.
• Navigation maps, your current location, and other navigational data may differ
from actual location information. You should always pay attention to road
conditions, traffic, and any other factors that may affect your driving. Follow all
safety warnings and regulations while driving.
• This application may not be available depending on the region or service provider.
Specify the destination by using one of the following methods:
• Speak the destination address.
• Enter the destination address.
• Select the destination address from the contacts list.
• Select the destination from the list of starred places.
Once a route is found, follow on-screen instructions to navigate to the destination.78
Settings
About Settings
Use this application to configure the device, set application options, and add accounts.
Tap Settings on the Applications screen.
Wi-Fi
Activate the Wi-Fi feature to connect to a Wi-Fi AP and access the Internet or other network
devices.
Bluetooth
Activate the Bluetooth feature to exchange information over short distances.
Data usage
Keep track of your data usage amount, and customise the settings for the limitation.
• Mobile data: Set to use data connections on any mobile network.
• Set mobile data limit: Set a limit for the mobile data usage.
• Data usage cycle: Enter monthly reset date to monitor your data usage.
To use more options, tap .
• Data roaming: Set to use data connections when you are roaming.
• Restrict background data: Set to disable synchronisation in the background while using
a mobile network.
• Show Wi-Fi usage: Set to show your data usage via Wi-Fi.Settings
79
More settings
Customise settings to control connections with other devices or networks.
Flight mode
This disables all wireless functions on your device. You can use only non-network services.
Mobile networks
• Mobile data: Use to allow packet switching data networks for network services.
• Data roaming: Use the device to connect to another network when you are roaming or
your home network is not available.
• Access Point Names: Set up access point names (APNs).
• Network mode: Select a network type.
• Network operators: Search for available networks and select a network for roaming.
Tethering and portable hotspot
• Portable Wi-Fi hotspot: Use the portable Wi-Fi hotspot to share the device’s mobile
network connection with computers or other devices through the Wi-Fi network.
• USB tethering: Use USB tethering to share the device’s mobile network connection with
a computer via USB. When connected to a computer, the device is used as a wireless
modem for the computer.
• Bluetooth tethering: Use the Bluetooth tethering to share the device’s mobile network
connection with computers via Bluetooth.
• Help: Learn more about USB, Wi-Fi, and Bluetooth tethering.Settings
80
Wi-Fi Direct
Wi-Fi Direct connects two devices directly without requiring an access point.
VPN
Set up and connect to virtual private networks (VPNs).
Sound
Change settings for various sounds on the device.
• Sound profiles: Activate silent mode to make your device vibrate or mute all sounds,
except for media sounds and alarm ringtones.
• Volume: Adjust the volume level for call ringtones, music and videos, system sounds, and
notifications.
• Device ringtone: Select a ringtone to alert you to incoming calls and notifications.
• Default notifications: Select a ringtone for events, such as incoming messages, missed
calls, and alarms.
• Sound and vibration: Set the device to vibrate and play a ringtone for incoming calls.
• Keytones: Set the device to sound when tapping the buttons on the keypad.
• Touch sounds: Set the device to sound when selecting an application or option on the
touch screen.
• Screen lock sound: Set the device to sound when locking or unlocking the touch screen.Settings
81
Display
Change the settings for the display.
• Brightness: Set the brightness of the display.
• Screen timeout: Set the length of time the device waits before turning off the display’s
backlight.
• Auto-rotate screen: Set the content to rotate automatically when the device is turned.
• Font style: Change the font type for display text.
• Font size: Change the font size.
Wallpaper
Change the wallpaper settings.
• Home screen: Select a background image for the Home screen.
• Lock screen: Select a background image for the locked screen.
• Home and lock screens: Select a background image for the Home screen and the locked
screen.
Motion
Activate motion recognition feature and change the settings that control motion recognition
on your device.
• Shake to update: Set the device to search for Bluetooth devices by shaking it.
• Turn over to mute/pause: Set to mute incoming calls, alarms, music, and the FM radio by
placing the device face down.
• Learn about motions: View the tutorial for controlling motions.Settings
82
Storage
View memory information for your device and memory card, or format a memory card.
Formatting a memory card permanently deletes all data from it.
The actual available capacity of the internal memory is less than the specified
capacity because the operating system and default applications occupy part of the
memory.
Battery
View the amount of battery power consumed by your device.
Applications manager
View and manage the applications on your device.
Accounts and sync
Change settings for the auto sync feature or manage accounts for synchronisation.
Location services
Change settings for GPS functionality.
• Use wireless networks: Set to use Wi-Fi and/or mobile networks for finding the current
location.
• Use GPS satellites: Set to use the GPS satellite for finding the current location.
• Location and Google search: Set to use your current location for Google search and
other Google services.Settings
83
Security
Change settings for securing the device and the SIM or USIM card.
• Screen lock: Activate the screen lock feature.
• Lock screen options: Change the settings for the locked screen. These settings are
applied only when you set the swipe lock option.
– Shortcuts: Set to show and edit application shortcuts on the locked screen.
– Clock: Set to show the clock on the locked screen.
– Dual clock: Set to show the dual clock on the locked screen.
– Weather: Set to show the weather information and change the settings for the
weather display.
– Help text: Set to show the help text on the locked screen.
• Owner information: Enter your information that is shown on the locked screen.
• Encrypt device: Set a password to encrypt data saved on the device. You must enter the
password each time you turn on the device.
Charge the battery before enabling this setting because it may take more than an
hour to encrypt your data.
• Encrypt external SD card:
– Encrypt external SD card: Set to encrypt files when you save them to a memory card.
– Full encryption: Set to encrypt all files on a memory card.
– Exclude multimedia files: Set to encrypt all files on a memory card, except for media
files.
If you reset your device to the factory defaults with this setting enabled, the device
will not be able to read your encrypted files. Disable this setting before resetting the
device.Settings
84
• Remote controls: Set to allow control of your lost or stolen device remotely via the
Internet. To use this feature, you must sign in to your Samsung and Google accounts.
– Add account: Add or view your Samsung and Google accounts.
– Use wireless networks: Set to allow location data collection and to determine the
location of your lost or stolen device via Wi-Fi and mobile networks.
• SIM Change Alert: Activate the Find my mobile feature.
• SamsungDive web page: Access the SamsungDive website (www.samsungdive.com).
You can track and control your lost or stolen device on the SamsungDive website.
• Set up SIM card lock:
– Lock SIM card: Activate or deactivate the PIN lock feature to require the PIN before
using the device.
– Change SIM PIN: Change the PIN used to access SIM or USIM data.
• Make passwords visible: By default, the device hides passwords for security. Set the
device to display passwords as they are entered.
• Device administrators: View device administrators installed on the device. You can allow
device administrators to apply new policies to the device.
• Unknown sources: Choose to download applications from any source. If not chosen,
download applications only from Play Store.
• Trusted credentials: Use certificates and credentials to ensure secure use of various
applications.
• Install from device storage: Install encrypted certificates stored on the USB storage.
• Clear credentials: Erase the credential contents from the device and reset the password.Settings
85
Language and input
Change the settings for text input.
Language
Select a display language for all menus and applications.
Default
Select a default keyboard type for text input.
Google voice typing
To change the voice input settings, tap .
• Select input languages: Select input languages for text input.
• Block offensive words: Set to prevent the device from recognising offensive words in
voice inputs.
Samsung keyboard
To change the Samsung keyboard settings, tap .
• Portrait keyboard types: Change the keyboard layout.
• Input language: Select languages for text input.
• Predictive text: Activate predictive text mode to predict words based on your input and
show word suggestions. You can also customise the word prediction settings.
• Continuous input: Set to enter text by sweeping on the keyboard.
• Keyboard swipe: Set to switch text input modes by sweeping your finger left or right
across the keyboard.
• Handwriting: Activate handwriting mode. You can also change the settings for
handwriting mode, such as recognition time, pen thickness, or pen colour.Settings
86
• Voice input: Activate the voice input feature to enter text by voice on the Samsung
keyboard.
• Auto capitalisation: Set the device to automatically capitalise the first character after a
final punctuation mark, such as a full stop, question mark, or exclamation mark.
• Auto-punctuate: Set the device to insert a full stop when you double-tap the space bar.
• Character preview: Set the device to display a large image of each character tapped.
• Key-tap sound: Set the device to sound when a key is touched.
• Tutorial: Learn how to enter text with the Samsung keyboard.
• Reset settings: Reset Samsung keyboard settings.
Voice search
• Language: Select a language for voice recognition.
• SafeSearch: Set the device to filter explicit text and images from voice search results.
• Block offensive words: Hide offensive words from voice search results.
Text-to-speech output
• Preferred TTS engine: Select a speech synthesis engine. To change the settings for
speech synthesis engines, tap .
• Speech rate: Select a speed for the text-to-speech feature.
• Listen to an example: Listen to the spoken text for an example.
• Driving mode: Activate driving mode to set the device to read contents aloud.
Pointer speed
Adjust the pointer speed for the mouse or trackpad connected to your device.Settings
87
Back up and reset
Change the settings for managing settings and data.
• Back up my data: Set to back up settings and application data to the Google server.
• Backup account: Set up or edit your Google backup account.
• Automatic restore: Set to restore settings and application data when the applications are
reinstalled on the device.
• Factory data reset: Reset settings to the factory default values and delete all data.
Date and time
Access and alter the following settings to control how the device displays the time and date.
If the battery remains fully discharged or removed from the device, the time and date
is reset.
• Automatic date and time: Automatically update the time when moving across time
zones.
• Set date: Set the current date manually.
• Set time: Set the current time manually.
• Automatic time zone: Set to receive time zone information from the network when you
move across time zones.
• Select time zone: Set the home time zone.
• Use 24-hour format: Display time in 24-hour format.
• Select date format: Select a date format.Settings
88
Accessibility
Accessibility services are special features for those with certain physical disabilities. Access
and alert the following settings to improve accessibility to the device.
• Auto-rotate screen: Set the interface to rotate automatically when you rotate the device.
• Speak passwords: Set the device to read aloud passwords you enter with Talkback.
• Call answering/ending:
– Answering key: Set the device to answer an incoming call when pressing the Home
button.
– The power key ends calls: Set the device to end a call when pressing the Power
button.
• Accessibility shortcut: Add a shortcut to Accessibility on the quick menu that appears
when you press and hold the Power button.
• Screen timeout: Set the length of time the device waits before turning off the display’s
backlight.
• TalkBack: Activate Talkback, which provides voice feedback.
• Install web scripts: Set applications to install web scripts to make their web content
more accessible.
• Font size: Change the font size.
• Mono audio: Enable mono sound when you listen to audio with one earbud.
• Turn off all sounds: Mute all device sounds.
• Tap and hold delay: Set the recognition time for tapping and holding the screen.Settings
89
Developer options
Change the settings for application development.
• USB debugging: Activate USB debugging mode to connect your device to a computer
with a USB cable.
• Development device ID: View your device’s development ID.
• Allow mock locations: Allow mock locations and service information to be sent to a
Location Manager service for testing.
• Desktop backup password: Set a password to secure your backup data.
• Strict mode: Set the device to flash the screen when applications perform long
operations.
• Show pointer location: Set to show the coordinates and traces of the pointer when you
touch the screen.
• Show touches: Set to show the pointer when you touch the screen.
• Show screen updates: Set to flash areas of the screen when they are updated.
• Show CPU usage: Set to list all active processes.
• Force GPU rendering: Set to use 2D hardware acceleration to improve graphic
performance.
• Window animation scale: Select a speed for opening and closing pop-up windows.
• Transition animation scale: Select a speed for switching between screens.
• Do not keep activities: Set to end a running application when you launch a new
application.
• Limit background processes: Set to limit the number of processes that can run in the
background.
• Show all ANRs: Set the device to alert you to unresponsive applications that are running
in the background.
About device
Access device information and update device software.90
Troubleshooting
When you turn on your device or while you are using the device, it
prompts you to enter one of the following codes:
• Password: When the device lock feature is enabled, you must enter the password you set
for the device.
• PIN: When using the device for the first time or when the PIN requirement is enabled, you
must enter the PIN supplied with the SIM or USIM card. You can disable this feature by
using the Lock SIM card menu.
• PUK: Your SIM or USIM card is blocked, usually as a result of entering your PIN incorrectly
several times. You must enter the PUK supplied by your service provider.
• PIN2: When you access a menu requiring the PIN2, you must enter the PIN2 supplied with
the SIM or USIM card. For details, contact your service provider.
Your device displays network or service error messages
• When you are in areas with weak signals or poor reception, you may lose reception. Move
to another area and try again.
• You cannot access some options without a subscription. Contact your service provider for
more details.
The touch screen responds slowly or improperly
If your device has a touch screen and the touch screen is not responding properly, try the
following:
• Remove any protective covers from the touch screen. Protective covers may prevent the
device from recognising your inputs and are not recommended for touch screen devices.
• Ensure that your hands are clean and dry when tapping the touch screen.
• Restart your device to clear any temporary software bugs.
• Ensure that your device software is upgraded to the latest version.
• If the touch screen is scratched or damaged, take it to your local Samsung Service Centre.Troubleshooting
91
Your device freezes or has fatal errors
If your device freezes or hangs, you may need to close programs or reset the device to regain
functionality. If your device is frozen and unresponsive, press and hold the Power button for
8-10 seconds. The device reboots automatically.
If this does not solve the problem, perform a factory data reset. On the Applications
screen, tap Settings→Back up and reset→Factory data reset→Reset device→Erase
everything.
Calls are being dropped
When you are in areas with weak signals or poor reception, you may lose your connection to
the network. Move to another area and try again.
Outgoing calls are not connected
• Ensure that you have pressed the Dial key.
• Ensure that you have accessed the right cellular network.
• Ensure that you have not set call barring for the phone number you are dialling.
Incoming calls are not connected
• Ensure that your device is turned on.
• Ensure that you have accessed the right cellular network.
• Ensure that you have not set call barring for the incoming phone number.
Others cannot hear you speaking on a call
• Ensure that you are not covering the built-in microphone.
• Ensure that the microphone is close to your mouth.
• If using a headset, ensure that it is properly connected.Troubleshooting
92
Audio quality is poor
• Ensure that you are not blocking the device’s internal antenna.
• When you are in areas with weak signals or poor reception, you may lose reception. Move
to another area and try again.
When dialling from contacts, the call is not connected
• Ensure that the correct number is stored in the contact list.
• Re-enter and save the number, if necessary.
• Ensure that you have not set call barring for the contact’s phone number.
The device beeps and the battery icon is empty
Your battery is low. Recharge or replace the battery to continue using the device.
The battery does not charge properly or the device turns off
• The battery terminals may be dirty. Wipe both gold-coloured contacts with a clean, soft
cloth and try charging the battery again.
• If the battery no longer charges completely, dispose of the old battery properly
and replace it with a new battery (refer to your local ordinances for proper disposal
instructions).
Your device is hot to the touch
When you use applications that require more power or use applications on your device for an
extended period of time, your device may feel hot to the touch. This is normal and should not
affect your device’s lifespan or performance.Troubleshooting
93
Error messages appear when launching the camera
Your Samsung device must have sufficient available memory and battery power to operate
the camera application. If you receive error messages when launching the camera, try the
following:
• Charge the battery or replace it with a battery that is fully charged.
• Free some memory by transferring files to a computer or deleting files from your device.
• Restart the device. If you are still having trouble with the camera application after trying
these tips, contact a Samsung Service Centre.
Error messages appear when opening music files
Some music files may not play on your Samsung device for a variety of reasons. If you receive
error messages when opening music files on your device, try the following:
• Free some memory by transferring files to a computer or deleting files from your device.
• Ensure that the music file is not Digital Rights Management (DRM)-protected. If the file is
DRM-protected, ensure that you have the appropriate licence or key to play the file.
• Ensure that your device supports the file type.
Another Bluetooth device is not located
• Ensure that the Bluetooth wireless feature is activated on your device.
• Ensure that the Bluetooth wireless feature is activated on the device you wish to connect
to, if necessary.
• Ensure that your device and the other Bluetooth device are within the maximum
Bluetooth range (10 m).
If the tips above do not solve the problem, contact a Samsung Service Centre.Troubleshooting
94
A connection is not established when you connect the device to a
computer
• Ensure that the USB cable you are using is compatible with your device.
• Ensure that you have the proper drivers installed and updated on your computer.
• If you are a Windows XP user, ensure that you have Windows XP Service Pack 3 or higher
installed on your computer.
• Ensure that you have Samsung Kies 2.0 or Windows Media Player 10 or higher installed
on your computer.
A small gap appears around the outside of the device case
• This gap is a necessary manufacturing feature and some minor rocking or vibration of
parts may occur.
• Over time, friction between parts may cause this gap to expand slightly.English (EU). 11/2012. Rev. 1.0
Some content may differ from your device depending on the region or service provider.
www.samsung.com
Washing Machine
user manual
imagine the possibilities
Thank you for purchasing a Samsung
product.
To receive a more complete service, please
register your product at
www.samsung.com/register
WA10W9
WA12W9
WA11WP
This manual is made with 100% recycled paper.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 1 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:252_features safety instructions_3
features
• Water Saving program
This is a specially designed program that enables you to wash laundry effectively with the
minimum amount of water.
• Last Settings Feature
This option loads the previous course settings.
The Last Settings feature automatically remembers the last course that was run, making it
possible to use the same settings as the last time the washer was used without having to
manually select all the settings.
• Diamond Drum
The diamond shaped drum creates a high water pressure, removing dirt from the laundry
effectively. The diamond drum minimizes fabric damage extending the lifetime of the fabric.
The glittering inner tube is both beautiful and powerful in the wash effect it creates.
• Fuzzy Control
Fuzzy control operates with best washing program by sensing the washload like artificial
intelligence.
• Tempered Transparent Door
Lets you observe while the washer is operating. Check on your laundry’s progress at any
time.
• Eco Storm
A giant pulsator creates a powerful water current, which is further accelerated by a tilted
center pulsator spinning at 360°. The resulting waterfall effect speeds up the circulation
of the water to achieve a cleaner wash using just a small amount of water. (A better wash
performance is achieved.)
• Wobble
Conventional top loading automatic washing machines rotate the laundry clockwise or
counter clockwise in 2 dimensions but Wobble Technology™ rotates the laundry by throwing
it around in 3 dimensions.
Since Wobble Technology™ moves the laundry horizontally and vertically at the same time,
the rotating water stream may seem different from that of other washing machines.
One of the features of the 3 dimensional wash function of Wobble Technology™ is washing
at multiple water levels and this may include a wash period performed at a low water level.
• Magic Filter
This unique Magic Filter ensures that all the lint inside the tub is captured for top quality
filtering results to deliver consistently effective cleaning results.
• CHILD-LOCK Function
This is a device to protect children from being accidentally hurt while playing with the washer.
(For more information, see page 10, 14.)
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 2 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:252_features safety instructions_3
safety instructions
Please note that the following precautions for safety intend to prevent unpredictable danger and damage by
helping the proper use in safety.
When using hot water in washing, please make sure that the water should not exceed 50°C.
• Plastic parts may be deformed or damaged, and an electric shock or a fire may take place.
WARNING
There might be serious injury or fatal accident when you violate this instruction.
• If the plug (power supply cord) is damaged, it must be replaced by the manufacturer or its
service agent or a similarly qualified person in order to avoid a hazard.
• Do not pull the cord off or touch it with moist hands.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not bend the power supply cord by force or press it with heavy things.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not install the washer nearby electric implement or don’t put a candle light or cigarette
light on the washer.
− A fire may take place.
• During operation, do not put your hands or metal materials under the washer.
− You may be hurt by spinning board beneath the washer.
• Stay away from the washer when the bottom of the washer sinks into the water.
− There might be an electric shock. Please wait until the water drains out completely.
• Do not put laundry stained with gasoline, benzene, or alcohol in the washer, and keep the
materials away from the washer.
− An explosion or a fire may take place.
• During spinning, don’t put your hand in the spinning tub.
− It may hurt your hands. If it does not stop within 15 seconds after you open the lid, call
service agent immediately.
• This appliance is not intended for use by young children or infirm persons unless they
have been adequately supervised by a responsible person to ensure that they can use the
appliance safely.
Young children should be supervised to ensure that they do not play with the appliance.
• This appliance has to be connected to the plug endurable to proper power consumption.
• This appliance has to be positioned so that the plug is accessible after installation.
• No user-serviceable parts inside. Refer any servicing to qualified service personnel.
− Otherwise this may cause a mechanical error, electric shock, fire or physical damage.
− The product warranty does not cover problems resulting from disassembling the product.
• Do not use this product for business purposes.
• For washing machines with ventilation openings in the base, that a carpet must not obstruct
the openings.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 3 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:254_safety instructions contents_5
safety instructions
CAUTIONS
There might be a slight injury or damage when you violate this instruction.
• Don’t install it in the area with moisture or outdoor where it has rain or snow.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Please unplug the power supply cord when you do not use it.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• If there is dust or water on the power supply plug and its connected part, please remove it
completely.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not make your kids look into the inside of the washer.
− If your kid falls into the washer, his life could be in danger.
• Ventilate immediately without touching the power plug if gas is leaking.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place if it catches flame.
• If the washer makes strange noise, smell or smoke, unplug it promptly and call service agent.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• When cleaning, don’t spray water to the parts of the washer directly.
− It may make its life span shorten.
Also an electric shock or fire may take place.
• Don’t use several appliances together with an outlet.
− A fire may take place due to unusual heat.
• Don’t press the button with an awl or pin.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Use the new hose-sets and old hose-sets should not be reused.
• If the damage is found on the current cord in use, it should be replaced by manufacturer,
service center or authorized person in order to avoid the risk.
• Connect the grounding wire to the shell plate, and bury it under at least 25cm of
earth:alternatively, connect the ground wire to the appropriate pin on a properly grounded power
receptacle. Never connect the wire to a telephone line, lightning rod, or gas pipe.
• The product you have purchased is designed for domestic use only.
The use for business purposes qualifi es as product misuse. In this case, the product will not be
covered by the standard warranty provided by Samsung and no responsibility can be attributed
to Samsung for malfunctions or damages resulting from such misuse.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 4 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:264_safety instructions contents_5
contents
seTTing up your washer
6
6 Description of part
9 How to wash automatically depends on the
laundry
10 Control Panel
manual funcTions
15
15 Manual functions
insTallaTion & mainTenance
16
16 Environment
16 Levelling
16 Connecting the water supply hose
18 Assembling the rat protection panel (option)
18 How to connect the drain hose
21 Adding detergent
21 Adding fabric softener
22 Water supply connector filter
22 Cleaning the filter
23 Cleaning the pump filter (option)
23 Cleaning the detergent compartment
TroubleshooTing
24
24 Troubleshooting
washing machine won’T work?
25
25 Washing machine won’t work?
specificaTion
26
27 Specification
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 5 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:266_setting up your washer setting up your washer_7
setting up your washer
DeSCRIPTION Of PART
The User’s Manual is for common use.
Make use of the User’s Manual depending upon your washing machine model.
water supply
hose (cold)
water
supply hose
(cold)
fabric softener
dispenser
Detergent box
power cord
water drain hose
front control
panel
adjustable legs
Adjust the length
of the legs when
installing the
washer.
lid
Be sure to keep the lid closed
during washing and spinning.
Lint will be collected in the filter
during washing.
filter
rat protection panel
ground lead
When the water pipe is
metal, make sure to cover
the end of the ground wire.
water supply hose (hot)
water supply
hose (hot)
spin basket
Drain hose
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 6 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:266_setting up your washer setting up your washer_7
CHECKIng bEFOrE WaSHIng anD CarIng FOr garMEnTS
Must follow the checkpoints in order to avoid machine problems or damages on garments.
• If the below problems are caused by customer’s faults, separate service fee will be charged.
checkpoints before starting washing
Check if the clothes are bleaching or not.
• Add liquid detergent to a white towel and the garment where you can’t notice well. Then, rub
together strongly. Check if the color transferred to the towel.
• Be careful for scarves and imported clothes since they are easily discoloring.
• Check for stains or partial dirt.
• If stains are found, use the towel wet with detergents to rub on in a single direction.
• Before washing, the sleeves, collar, dress hem and pockets are pre-treated by brushing with
detergents.
The wrinkle-processed clothes made of wool are specially treated by fixing them with threads
before washing. The threads shall be removed after the clothes are dried.
not washable laundry
Clothes those are easily transformable even by soaking in water.
• Even by soaking in water, neckties, brassieres, jackets, suits and coats can be easily
transformed like shrinking and discoloring on the garment surfaces because they are mostly
made of rayon, polynosic, cuff and their blend fabrics.
• The wrinkle-processed, embossed, or resin processed products are easy to transform even
by soaking in water.
• Easily discoloring products made of cotton and wool, wrinkled silk, leather products, leather
accessory, leather ornamented clothes and its accessory.
• Don’t wash those clothes without handling guideline or material indication tag.
about Detergent
• When detergents are not dissolving well, use warm water (about 40°C) to dissolve the
detergent.
• Use an appropriate amount.
• Even if excess amount of detergent is used, there is not much difference in washing
result. It may cause damages to the garments because rinsing is not enough.
• The bleaching agent may cause damages to garments since it is strong alkali.
• Do sufficient rinsing because the powder detergent is easily remained on the garments
causing bad odors.
• If too much detergent is used or cold water is used, it doesn’t dissolve completely and
remain on the garments, hose or spin basket, causing contamination on clothes.
• In case of reserved washing, detergents must be put in the detergent box. If the powder
detergents are spread on laundry directly, it may cause discoloration.
CAUTION
01 SETTIng up yOur WaSHEr
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 7 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:268_setting up your washer setting up your washer_9
setting up your washer
CARING fOR CLOTHeS BefORe WASHING
Take out personal belongings from pockets.
• Caution, Check the pockets! Hairpins and coins cause damages to
clothes and washing machine. They make noise and problems to
the machine. Must check the pocket.
if pants zippers are open while washing, the spin basket may be
damaged. The zipper should be closed and fixed with a string
before washing.
• Metal on the clothing may cause damage to the clothes and the tub.
• Turn clothing with buttons and embroidered clothes inside out before
washing them.
• Clothing with long strings may become entangled with other clothes,
and may cause damage to the clothing. Be sure to fix the strings
before washing.
waterproof clothes (ski wear, Diaper covers, footboards) are not
allowed for washing.
• This may cause the laundry to be ejected or cause the washing machine to vibrate
abnormally, which may result in personal injury or damage the washing machine, the floor
or the clothing. (Diapers, waterproof clothing, raincoats, umbrella covers, skiwear, car cover
sheets, and sleeping bags, etc.).
• When the tub rotates, water may become trapped in the waterproof clothing or fabric and
can collect in a corner, causing abnormal vibrations. In addition, the laundry rises and may be
ejected and cause personal injury.
shake the dirt or soils from clothes.
• Soil and sands may rub delicate garments to cause damages and the washing result may be
unsatisfactory.
Do pre-washing for white socks, sleeves, and collars before the main washing.
• For stains and dirt on collars, sleeves, hems, and pockets, apply some detergent to them
and apply it lightly with a brush before washing.
• Use powdered or liquid detergent. Do not use soap as the tub may become dirty from the
dirt on it.
Turn inside out for those nappy clothes before washing.
• If clothes have too much foreign matter, separate them for washing.
Other clothes may pick up those dirty matters (dirt, thread).
• Wash black colored clothes and cotton towels separately. If they are
washed together, towels may pick up dirty matters. Check before
washing.
cashmilon and those garments having big volume and lightweight
(eg. lasedecorated clothes, lingerie, nylon stocking, synthetic
fabrics etc.) may rise and cause damages to the clothes and
problems to the machine. use the laundry net or wash them
separately.
• Must put those long stringed clothes, lase-worked clothes, bed cover
sheet, wool clothes into a laundry net before washing.
• Put delicate clothes in the laundry net.
• Use only those commercial laundry net for washing.
curtains, floating garments or blue jeans shall be pressed not to
float on the water.
• If they are floated on the water, press Start/Pause button to stop and press them to sock in
the water. If the washing goes on with clothes floating on the water, it may cause damages to
the clothes and the washing machine as well as unsatisfactory washing result.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 8 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:268_setting up your washer setting up your washer_9
HOW TO WASH AUTOmATICALLy DePeNDS ON THe LAUNDRy
before starting washing, check the following;
• Connect the water supply hose to the water tap. Leave a tap open. Plug the power cord in. Make sure
to lay down the drain hose.
Washing for the first time
Before washing clothes for the first time, you must run a complete cycle without clothes.
To do this:
1. Press the power button.
2. Open the detergent drawer and insert a little detergent.
3. Turn on the water supply to the washing machine.
4. Press the start/pause button.
This will remove any water from the manufacturer’s test run remaining in the machine.
Special notes!
automatic sensing function
• According to the selected program, the amount of laundry is automatically sensed and then
the appropriate water level, wash time, rinse cycle, and spinning time are automatically
selected for the automatic wash.
• After the power is on, a program is selected and Start/Pause button is pressed. Then,
the washing board starts spinning without water. This action senses how much laundry is
in the washing basket, not a machine problem. After this sensing process, water supplies
automatically.
adding Detergent and softener
• It senses the amount of laundry and indicates the water level and amount of detergent. Then,
it starts water supply right away.
• During the water supply, it is possible to open the detergent box and add detergent.
However, it is better to press Start/Pause button to stop water supply and add detergent.
Close the lid and press Start/Pause button again. This way is much more convenient.
• If the softener is inserted in the softener dispenser, it automatically adds in at the last rinsing
cycle.
put the laundry into the washer and add detergent, too.
• Be careful not to overload. Use right detergent for the fabrics you are washing.
• If the lid is open while running, the washing machine is stopped automatically for safety.
(Except, water supply continues while the lid is open.)
• When hot water is selected, both cold and hot water are supplied for the first 20
seconds in order to protect the clothes.
• Possible to control the washing time, rinsing cycle, and spinning time at every program
during the washing.
01 SETTIng up yOur WaSHEr
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 9 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2710_setting up your washer setting up your washer_11
setting up your washer
CONTROL PANeL
For more details, see control panel of your washing machine.
power buTTon
Press this button once to operate.
Press it again to turn the power off.
sTarT/pause
buTTon
Use to pause and restart the operation.
To change the washing procedure during an operation,
press this button to stop, and again to restart after changing the procedure.
program
selecT buTTon
Each time the button is pressed, the washing program changes;
Fuzzy Blanket Delicate Quick Super Clean Water Saving
Tub Clean Air Turbo
wash buTTon
Press this button to perform a wash only or to adjust the washing time.
You can set the wash time from between 4 to 30 minutes.
spin buTTon
Press this button to perform a spin cycle only or to adjust the spin time.
You can set the spin time from between 0 to 9 minutes.
When only a spin is selected, the spin time will be different from the total
remaining time. This is because the total remaining time includes the actual
spin time and the times for water draining and stopping.
rinse buTTon
Press this button to perform a rinse only or to adjust the rinse count.
You can set the rinse count up to five times.
Tub check
funcTion
/
If the Tub Check indicator on the display blinks (it blinks for 3 minutes), run
the Tub Clean course.
The Tub Clean function removes dirt from the tub to keep the laundry clean.
chilD-lock
funcTion
/
This is a device to protect children from being accidentally hurt while playing
with the washer.
• How to start the Child-Lock function:
- Press the “Power” button to go to an initial washing mode.
- By pressing “start/pause” button, you start washing and in case Child Lock
function is needed during the laundry
- Press both the “Rinse” and “Spin” buttons at the same times.(for 3 seconds)
(Note: You cannot perform the function without the “Power” button on.)
• To release the function of Child-Lock: In case the “Child-Lock” is
programmed, press both the “Rinse” and “Spin” buttons at the same time.
3
2
1
8
6
7
5
4
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 10 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2710_setting up your washer setting up your washer_11
remaining Time,
Delay sTarT
Time, error
Display
Displays the remaining wash time.
Displays the reserved delay start time.
Displays the error state if a problem occurs in the washing machine so that
you can take action.
soak buTTon
Press this button to perform a soak wash.
You can set the soak time from between 10 to 60 minutes.
Delay sTarT
buTTon
Press this button to finish the wash at a specified time.
Turn off your washing machine to cancel a reserved delay start.
You can set the delay start time from between 3 to 19 hours.
lasT seTTing
Press this button to load the settings for the last course.
Perform a wash course using the last used settings without having to enter
them manually again.
Your choices are automatically saved when you press the Start/Hold button.
To use a memorized course, press the Last Settings button and then press
the Start/Hold button.
- The memorized functions will be displayed on the panel.
The Delay start and Water level settings are not automatically saved
and will be reset after the wash.
waTer leVel
buTTon
The water level is automatically adjusted. However, you can select the water
level manually by pressing this button.
01 SETTIng up yOur WaSHEr
10
11
12
13
9
CAUTION
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 11 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2712_setting up your washer setting up your washer_13
setting up your washer
fUZZy PROGRAm
Selects the best washing program automatically.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the start/pause button.
Water level is selected automatically. Washing rinsing, and spinning follow.
If you want to pause, press the start/pause button again. You can change the program
when paused.
3. Close the lid.
BLANKeT PROGRAm
(Big volume laundry like blanket and bed cover sheets)
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button once.
3. Press the start/pause button.
Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to pause, press the start/pause button
again. You can change the program when paused.
4. Close the lid.
• Fold those big volume laundry (blanket and
bed cover sheets) in the following way before
adding into the spin basket.
• Do not wash the electric blanket and carpets.
• Get a laundry net for those light and big
volume laundry (eg. Cashmeres) because they
might rise in the water and get damaged.
When you wash unwieldy laundry items (e.g. blankets, winter clothes, etc.) add the
detergent before you add the laundry to utilize the up, down, left and right 3D 4-directional
stereo wash provided by Wobble Technology™ for a better result.
DeLICATe PROGRAm
Washable sweater, cardigan, delicate clothes etc.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button two times
3. Press the start/pause button.
Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to pause, press the start/pause button
again. You can change the course when paused.
4. Close the lid.
- You can only select cold water.
- The last spin operates lightly to prevent wrinkles.
- Use the detergent indicated in the laundry.
QUICK PROGRAm
If you want to wash those frequently used towels or less dirty laundry time.
Because washing is speedy, it is good for light or less stained laundry.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button three times.
3. Press the start/pasue button.
Water level is selected automatically. Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to
pause, press the start/pasue button again. You can change the program when paused.
4. Close the lid.
CAUTION
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 12 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2712_setting up your washer setting up your washer_13
SUPeR CLeAN PROGRAm
Use for cleaner washing.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button four times.
3. Press the start/pause button and put the proper amount of detergent into tub.
Water level is selected automatically.
4. Close the lid.
WATeR SAVING PROGRAm
This is a specially designed program that enables you to wash laundry effectively with the
minimum amount of water.
1. Press the power button to “On”.
2. Press the program select button to select Water Saving program.
3. Press the water level button to display level “6”
4. Press the start/pause button.
If you want to pause, press the start/pause button again. You can change the course when
paused.
5. Close the lid.
TUB CLeAN PROGRAm
Use this program to clean the tub. It will keep the tub clean and sanitary.
1. Press the power button to turn the washer “On”.
2. Press the program selection button six times.
3. Press the start/pause button.
4. Add a delicated detergent and close the lid
• Never place laundry in the tub when cleaning inside the tub, as this can cause
discoloration or damage to the laundry.
• When doing the laundry after cleaning the tub, you may find some impurities. These are just
detergent residues and impurities after the tub cleaning. Perform the rinse cycle two to three times.
• The water level is set to Mid early on and then changed to High during the rinse.
AIR TURBO PROGRAm
This course saves you valuable time, ensuring that your clothes dry faster than from line drying.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button seven times.
3. Close the lid.
4. Press the start/pause button.
• Select this when you want to half-dry the laundry.
KeePING THe TUB CLeAN
When using the machine under humid conditions for an extended time, various bacteria from the
air may stick to the tub and form black dirt (fungi), causing damage to the human body.
To keep the tub clean and hygienic at all times, it is recommended detergents to clean the tub
regularly at least once every one to three months.
- The Eco Tub Clean course even works without detergent.
- For this function, do not put laundry into the tub. This may cause the laundry to be
damaged or the product to malfunction.
- Make sure to use only detergent for cleaning the wash tub when using detergent for
this course.
01 SETTIng up yOur WaSHEr
CAUTION
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 13 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2714_setting up your washer manual functions_15
setting up your washer
DeLAy START
How to reserve washing?
Select this program when you have to go out or do something else.
1. Press the power button to “On”.
2. Press the Delay start button once.
You may change the delay start time with use the Delay start button. (from 3 hours to 19
hours)
3. Press the start/pause button and put the proper amount of detergent into tub.
4. Close the lid.
The washing finishes by the time you reserved. Add detergent and softener in proportion to
the water level. Then, close the lid.
• Must add the detergent in the detergent box.
• If the detergent is spread on the laundry directly, some clothes may get discolored as
the start delays.
• If the Delay Start needs to be canceled, press the Power button.
• The reserved finish time may be changed depends on the water pressure.
CHILD LOCK
This function is for protecting children, the elderly and the frail.
1. Press the Power button.
2. To activate the Child Lock function, press and hold both the Rinse and Spin buttons down
simultaneously for 3 seconds. (If the Child Lock function is activated, the Child Lock icon blinks.)
3. Operations after activating the Child Lock function.
• Even if the Child Lock function is activated, every button works until the door opens.
• When you open the door during the Child Lock is being activated, the alarm sounds
and an error message appears. In 30 seconds, draining begins automatically. However,
if you close the door within 30 seconds, water will not be drained. (Displayed error
message “ CL”, “ dE ”).
• To add laundry after activating the Child Lock function, you must deactivate the Child
Lock function.
4. To deactivate the Child Lock function, press and hold both the Rinse and Spin buttons simultaneously
for 3 seconds again. (If the Child Lock function is deactivated, the Child Lock icon is turned off.)
5. To clear “CL” display, after draining is complete, close the door of the washing turn the
power off and then on.
- This function is for preventing injury and malfunction of the product because of
inappropriate operations or actions by children, the elderly or the frail.
- If the door opens when the Child Lock function is activated, the water is drained by
force to prevent children from drowning.
- To add laundry after activating the Child Lock function, you must deactivate the Child Lock.
- Even if the power is turned off and then on when the Click Lock is activated, the Child
Lock remains activated.
- Once Child Lock is activated, even when the power is turned off, if the door is
opened, water is automatically drained in 30 seconds.
- The Child Lock function cannot be deactivated when CL is displayed. (However, the
Child Lock function can be deactivated when the dE error is displayed.)
CAUTION
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 14 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2714_setting up your washer manual functions_15
manual functions
Possible to select the function for each program.
(Example) For a simple washing as the little dirt program :
Power Select the little dirt program Wash Start/Pause
wash only
Press the power button.
Press the wash button.
Press the start/pause button.
Washing goes on for 1 time.
When the wash button is pressed during washing, the wash time
can be changed to between 4 and 30 minutes in duration.
rinse only
Press the rinse button.
Press the start/pause button.
Rinsing goes on for 1 times.
When the rinse button is pressed, the rinse times can be changed
to between 1 to 5 times in duration.
spin only
Press the spin button.
Press the start/pause button.
Spin drying goes on for 4 minutes.
When the spin button is pressed, the spin time can be changed to
from 0 to 9 minutes.
If 0 minutes is selected, the cycle is terminated after a drain cycle
only without the spin cycle being performed.
wash anD rinse
Press the wash and rinse button.
Press the start/pause button once.
Detects the amount of laundry, and determines wash and rinse time
period automatically.
When the wash and rinse button is pressed, wash time period is
determined between 4 and 30 minutes, and rinse time is determined
between 1 and 5 times.
rinse anD spin
Press the rinse and spin button.
Press the start/pause button once.
Rinsing and spin drying follow.
When the rinse and spin button is pressed, the number of rinse
times is determined between 1 and 5, and spin time period for
drying is determined between 0 and 9 minutes.
wash, rinse anD spin Press the wash, rinse and spin button.
Press the start/pause button once.
wash, rinse and spin is performed.
02 ManuaL FunCTIOnS
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 15 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2816_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_17
installation & maintenance
The User’s Manual is for common use.
Make use of the User’s Manual depending upon your washing machine model.
eNVIRONmeNT
leave some space
Maintain at least 10cm between the washer and the wall.
place the washer on a sturdy flat surface.
If the washer is placed on an uneven or weak surface, noise or vibration occurs. (Allowable is 1˚)
adjust the legs for even placement.
never install the washer near water.
Do not place the washer in steamy rooms or where the washer is directly exposed to rain. Moisture may
destroy the electrical insulation causing an electrical shock hazard.
avoid direct sunlight or heaters.
As plastic an electrical components are affected by direct heat, never place the washer near furnaces,
boilers, etc. Do not place under direct sunlight.
LeVeLLING
• If the washer is not leveled with the ground, it makes the machine tremble more or be out of order. So,
make sure that the washer is leveled properly.
see if The machine is placeD leVel by checking
The posiTion of The washing Tub.
• Open the lid of the machine, pour water into the tub up
to the level just below the pulsator, and adjust the legs so
that the pulsator is positioned at the center of the water as
shown in the figure.
• Place the machine more than 10cm away from the wall.
• Adjust the legs on feet for levelling.
CONNeCTING THe WATeR SUPPLy HOSe
1. Remove the adaptor from the water supply hose.
2. First, using a “+” type screw driver, loosen the four screws
on the adaptor. Next, take the adaptor and turn part(b)
following the arrow for gap about 5 mm between them.
3. Connect adaptor to the water tap by tightening the screws
firmly. Then, turn part(b) following the arrow and put (a) and
(b) together.
Water
LOOSEN LOCK
a
b
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 16 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2916_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_17
4. Connect the water supply hose to the adaptor. Pull down
the part (c) of the water supply hose. When the part (c)
is released, the hose is automatically connected to the
adaptor making a ‘click’ sound.
5. Connect the other end of the water supply hose to the
inlet water valve at the back of the washer. Screw the hose
clockwise all the way in.
5-1. Connect the other end of the water supply hose to
the inlet water valve at the top of the washer. Screw the
hose clockwise all the way in.
• If the water tap is a screw type, assemble a water supply
hose that fits to the tap as shown. After completing
connection, if water leaks from the hose, then repeat the
same steps.
After completing connection, if water leaks from the hose, then repeat the same steps.
Use the most conventional type of faucet for water supply.
In case the faucet is square or too big, remove the spacing ring before inserting the faucet
into the adaptor.
c
03 InSTaLLaTIOn & Ma nI TEnanCE
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 17 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:2918_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_19
installation & maintenance
ASSemBLING THe RAT PROTeCTION PANeL (OPTION)
Tilt the washer a little and lift up the panel until it clicks, finally fix the panel with screw
to the base as shown in the figure.
1. Insert the rat protection panel to the
assembling hole on back side to the end.
2. If you have difficulty inserting the panel lift
up the washer a little and insert it.
HOW TO CONNeCT THe DRAIN HOSe
IN CASe Of PUmP-DRAINeD WASHeR (OPTION)
cap-hose
Take out the cap-hose and connect the
outlet-hose.
Be sure to join tightly the drain hose into the
drainoutlet on the back of the machine.
90~100cm
Be sure to join tightly the drain hose into
the drain-outlet on the side of the machine.
Install the drain hose in the position of about
90~100cm above the ground.
Rear-side
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 18 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3018_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_19
IN CASe Of GeNeRAL WASHeR
1. After pressing the joint ring, insert to the drain hose.
2. After directing the drain hose to a drain, join to the
drainoutlet of the washing machine.
3. Be sure to join them tightly by pressing the joint ring and
pushing it into the drain-outlet.
• The length of drain hose is adjustable so that you can
extend the length appropriately.
HOW TO CHANGe THe DRAIN HOSe DIReCTION
• The handle of joint ring is pressed to pull out the drain hose.
Change the direction of the drain hose and follow the above
guideline again.
CAUTIONS WHeN INSeRTING THe DRAIN HOSe
Less than 3 m
1. Don’t exceed more than 3m when the
drain hose is used by connecting with
other hoses.
2. Be careful to drain water out at the end of
the drain hose.
Less than 3 m
Less than
5 cm
3. The doorsill shoudn’t be more than 5cm. 4. Don’t install the drain hose underneath the
wash machine.
03 InSTaLLaTIOn & Ma nI TEnanCE
drain-outlet
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 19 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3020_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_21
installation & maintenance
Adjusting the height of the washer
Make sure your washer is level by adjusting the leveling legs.
Beware of catching your hands under the legs.
1. Pull the handles located at the right and left front of the
washer and slide them off.
2. Adjust the height of the washer upwards or downwards.
3. When you have finished adjusting the height, push the
handles back to fix the adjusting legs in place.
waterdrop mark cause how to level
The front of the washer
is lower
Level the washer by adjusting the legs.
The back of the washer
is lower
Adjust the height by using the props at the
back.
The left of the washer
is lower
Adjust the left side by using the adjustable legs
at the front and props at the back.
The right of the washer
is lower
Adjust the left side by using the adjustable legs
at the front and props at the back.
Leveling your washer with the leveling screws (Optional)
1. Gently lift up the washer and turn the adjustable legs
to the left to find the optimal balance.
2. When done, return the washer to its original position.
3. After adjusting the legs, do not forget to lock the nut for
safety reasons. (Failing to do so may cause it to become
loose and and move out of position.)
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 20 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3120_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_21
ADDING DeTeRGeNT
1. Open the detergent drawer and then add the powder
detergent into the detergent compartment.
2. Add detergent evenly so that it doesn’t brim over the edge
of the drawer.
• Use a reasonable amount of detergent.
If you use more detergent than the standard quantity
or the water temperature is too low and the detergent
does not dissolve in the water completely causing it
to remain on the laundry and in the hose and tub, it may cause damage such as dirtying
and discoloring the laundry.
• If you use a powder detergent and it remains on the laundry, it may cause a bad odor.
Rinse the laundry sufficiently in fresh water.
If you spread a powder detergent over the laundry directly, it may result in discoloration.
Make sure to insert it into the detergent compartment.
If the water pressure is low, the detergent may remain in the detergent compartment.
ADDING fABRIC SOfTeNeR
1. When the proper amount (one time dose) of fabric softener is stored in the softener inlet, it is
automatically added during the last rinse cycle.
2. Do not add detergent, bleach or starch into the softener inlet.
3. Using too much softener may produce unsatisfactory results.
4. Do not open the lid during the Spin cycle. If added too early, its effectiveness will decrease.
5. Do not leave the softener in the softener dispenser for a long time as it may congeal.
If the water pressure is low, the fabric softener may remain in the softener compartment. In
this case, put the fabric softener into the tub directly.
CAUTION
03 InSTaLLaTIOn & Ma nI TEnanCE
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 21 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3222_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_23
installation & maintenance
WATeR SUPPLy CONNeCTOR fILTeR
1. Pull out the filter and wash well.
2. Pull in the filter and connect the hose to the inlet water
valve tightly.
3. Check if there is a leakage.
Note to tighten up the connector.
CLeANING THe fILTeR
Clean the filter net often to keep the washer clean.
1. Push the upper part of the Hygiene filter and pull in.
2. Open the cover as shown in the figure.
3. Clean the Hygiene filter.
4. Close the cover and insert the lower part of the filter
in the basket first and then push the filter with “click”
sound.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 22 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3222_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_23
CLeANING THe PUmP fILTeR (OPTION)
1. Place a rag or towel under the wash filter to avoid wetting the floor, and rotate the filter counterclockwise
and pull it out.
2. Remove any dirt from the filter.
3. Return the filter to its place by rotating the filter clockwise until it locks into position.
CLeANING THe DeTeRGeNT COmPARTmeNT
1. Separate the detergent compartment from the washer.
2. Separate and clean the Rinse-Cap from the detergent compartment.
3. Assemble the Rinse-Cap and insert the detergent compartment into the washer.
1 2 3
03 InSTaLLaTIOn & Ma nI TEnanCE
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 23 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3324_installation & maintenance troubleshooting_25
troubleshooting
prObLEM CHECK
Washing machine won’t work • Is the water tap opened?
• Is the washer plugged in?
• Is the power cut off?
• Is there enough water?
Water dose not drain • Is the drain hose down?(No pump)
• Is the drain hose frozen?
• Is the drain hose clogged?
• If the water dose not drain in 30 minutes, a buzzer will sound, and the
remaining time indicator will show “5E”.
Water is not supplied • Is the water tap opened?
• Is the water cut off?
• Is the water supply hose or hose connection clogged?
• Is the water tap frozen?
• If the water supply is not finished in 1 hour or there is no change in the
water level 10 minutes after the water supply has started, the buzzer
rings and “4E” is displayed on the remaining time indicator.
Spinning does not work • Is the laundry spread out evenly in the washer?
• In the washer set on a sturdy flat surface?
Water is overflowed • Restart after spinning.
• If the error sign still indicates, call agency.
This indicates that a Child Lock
error occurred
• The error message blinks at a 1 second interval and the water is
drained with an alarm sound.
(Displayed message: “ CL” or “ dE ”)
• This function is to prevent children from drowning when falling into
the wash tub. When draining is complete and you turn the power off
and then on, the washing machine will operate normally.
• To clear “CL” display, after draining is complete, close the door of
the washing machine, turn the power off and then on.
Water leakage error • Check if the end of the drain hose is placed on the floor. (The hose
should be hung over the pump - hose guide.)
• Check if the drain hose is clogged by any foreign substances.
• If the error remains, call the service center.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 24 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3324_installation & maintenance troubleshooting_25
washing machine won’t work?
problem check
The power is cut off. Is the electric voltage normal?
Is the washer plugged in? Plug in the electric cord.
Water does not drain.
Is the drain hose down? Put the drain hose down.
Is the drain hose folded? Unfold the drain hose.
Is the drain hose outlet clogged? Remove the waste cleanly.
Washing machine won’t work. Is the washer lid open? Close the lid.
Is the Pause button on?
Press the Start/Pause button one more time and check if the
washer starts.
Is enough water filled to the water level?
If the water pressure is low, it takes a long time to start washing.
Is the faucet closed? Open the faucet to supply water.
If the drain hose and spin basket are
frozen, do as follows.
• Add hot water to the frozen water tap and remove the drain
hose. Soak into hot water.
• Pour hot water into the spin basket for about 10 minutes.
• Put a hot water towel on the drain hose connector.
• If the drain hose defrosts, connect again and check for proper
water draining.
The water drains out immediately. • The drain is clogged with coins or pins. The drain hose is
hung over the drain hose hook. Half fill the spin basket with
water and try for spinning again.
The water leaks at the water supply
hose connector.
If the faucet connecting part is loose, water may leak.
Repeat the assembling steps again. (Refer to “Connecting the
water supply hose”)
Check if the rubber packing of water supply hose is in the right position.
Screw tightly again.
Is the water supply hose folded? Unfold the hose.
If the water supply is too strong, water may leak.
Close the faucet a little.
Is water leaking from the faucet itself?
Fix the faucet. Water is not supplied.
The water leaks at the water supply
hose connector.
Did you press the Start/Pause button after selecting the water supply?
If the Start/Pause button is not pressed, water is not
supplied. Press the Start/Pause button.
Is the faucet closed? Turn on the faucet.
Is the filter net at the water supply hose connector clogged with
dirty matters?
Clean the filter net by brushing with a toothbrush.
Is the water supply cut off?
If the water supply is suspended, turn off the faucet and power off.
Spinning makes loud noises and
vibrations.
Check if the laundry is spread evenly in the washer.
Spread out the laundry evenly and start again.
Check if the washing machine levels on a sturdy flat floor.
Set the machine at level.
Is the handle for leveling legs loose?
Adjust the legs on the feet for leveling.
Is around the washing machine filled with unnecessary stuffs?
Remove those unnecessary things away from the wash machine.
04 TrOubLESHOOTIng
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 25 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3326_specification
specification
wa10w9, wa11wp
MAX. MASS OF
DRY CLOTH IN kg
WA10W9 8.0 kg
STANDARD
WATER
LEVEL
7 74ℓ
5 58ℓ
WA11WP 9.0 kg
POWER
CONSUMPTION
WASH 470 W
3 50ℓ
SPIN 280 W
DIMENSIONS(mm)
W602XL670XH973(LOW BASE)
W602XL670XH996(HIGH BASE)
1 38ℓ
WEIGHT 44 kg
WATER PRESSURE
0.05~0.78 MPa
(0.5 ~ 8.0 kg
.
f/cm2
)
WATER USAGE 216ℓ
WASHING TYPE Stirring Type SPIN SPEED 720 rpm
wa12w9
MAX. MASS OF
DRY CLOTH IN kg
WA12W9 10.0 kg
STANDARD
WATER
LEVEL
7 78ℓ
POWER
CONSUMPTION
WASH 470 W 5 58ℓ
SPIN 280 W
3 50ℓ
DIMENSIONS(mm)
W602XL670XH973(LOW BASE)
W602XL670XH996(HIGH BASE)
WEIGHT 44 kg 1 38ℓ
WATER PRESSURE
0.05~0.78 MPa
(0.5 ~ 8.0 kg
.
f/cm2
)
WATER USAGE 218ℓ
WASHING TYPE Stirring Type SPIN SPEED 720 rpm
1. Water Saving program + Water Level “6” is recommended for a normally soiled load.
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 26 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:3326_specification
note
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 27 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:33QUESTIONS OR COMMENTS?
country call or VisiT us online aT
SINGAPORE 1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
Code No. DC68-02961L_EN
WA10W9-02961L_EN_20120601.indd 28 2012-06-01 �� 4:46:33
Washing Machine
user manual
imagine the possibilities
Thank you for purchasing a Samsung
product.
To receive a more complete service, please
register your product at
www.samsung.com/register
WA95WP
This manual is made with 100% recycled paper.
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 1 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:432_features safety instructions_3
features
• Water Saving program
This is a specially designed program that enables you to wash laundry effectively with the
minimum amount of water.
• Last Settings Feature
This option loads the previous course settings.
The Last Settings feature automatically remembers the last course that was run, making it
possible to use the same settings as the last time the washer was used without having to
manually select all the settings.
• Diamond Drum
The diamond shaped drum creates a high water pressure, removing dirt from the laundry
effectively. The diamond drum minimizes fabric damage extending the lifetime of the fabric.
The glittering inner tube is both beautiful and powerful in the wash effect it creates.
• Fuzzy Control
Fuzzy control operates with best washing program by sensing the washload like artificial
intelligence.
• Tempered Transparent Door
Lets you observe while the washer is operating. Check on your laundry’s progress at any
time.
• Eco Storm
A giant pulsator creates a powerful water current, which is further accelerated by a tilted
center pulsator spinning at 360°. The resulting waterfall effect speeds up the circulation
of the water to achieve a cleaner wash using just a small amount of water. (A better wash
performance is achieved.)
• Wobble
Conventional top loading automatic washing machines rotate the laundry clockwise or
counter clockwise in 2 dimensions but Wobble Technology™ rotates the laundry by throwing
it around in 3 dimensions.
Since Wobble Technology™ moves the laundry horizontally and vertically at the same time,
the rotating water stream may seem different from that of other washing machines.
One of the features of the 3 dimensional wash function of Wobble Technology™ is washing
at multiple water levels and this may include a wash period performed at a low water level.
• Magic Filter
This unique Magic Filter ensures that all the lint inside the tub is captured for top quality
filtering results to deliver consistently effective cleaning results.
• CHILD-LOCK Function
This is a device to protect children from being accidentally hurt while playing with the washer.
(For more information, see page 11, 14.)
• Tub clean
Use this program to clean the tub. It will keep the tub clean and sanitary.
When using the machine under humid conditions for an extended time, various bacteria from
the air may stick to the tub and form black dirt (fungi), causing damage to the human body.
To keep the tub clean and hygienic at all times, it is recommended detergents to clean the
tub regularly at least once every one to three months.
• Aqua preserve
Samsung’s Aqua Preserve reduced waste of water by reusing last rinsed out water. After
rinsing the clothes lastly, the washing machine keeps the water before final spin-dry and use
it again to save water and your money!
(This function is only available to use when you select twice of rinsing)
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 2 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:432_features safety instructions_3
safety instructions
Please note that the following precautions for safety intend to prevent unpredictable danger and damage by
helping the proper use in safety.
When using hot water in washing, please make sure that the water should not exceed 50°C.
• Plastic parts may be deformed or damaged, and an electric shock or a fire may take place.
WARNING
There might be serious injury or fatal accident when you violate this instruction.
• If the plug (power supply cord) is damaged, it must be replaced by the manufacturer or its
service agent or a similarly qualified person in order to avoid a hazard.
• Do not pull the cord off or touch it with moist hands.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not bend the power supply cord by force or press it with heavy things.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not install the washer nearby electric implement or don’t put a candle light or cigarette
light on the washer.
− A fire may take place.
• During operation, do not put your hands or metal materials under the washer.
− You may be hurt by spinning board beneath the washer.
• Stay away from the washer when the bottom of the washer sinks into the water.
− There might be an electric shock. Please wait until the water drains out completely.
• Do not put laundry stained with gasoline, benzene, or alcohol in the washer, and keep the
materials away from the washer.
− An explosion or a fire may take place.
• During spinning, don’t put your hand in the spinning tub.
− It may hurt your hands. If it does not stop within 15 seconds after you open the lid, call
service agent immediately.
• This appliance is not intended for use by young children or infirm persons unless they
have been adequately supervised by a responsible person to ensure that they can use the
appliance safely.
Young children should be supervised to ensure that they do not play with the appliance.
• This appliance has to be connected to the plug endurable to proper power consumption.
• This appliance has to be positioned so that the plug is accessible after installation.
• No user-serviceable parts inside. Refer any servicing to qualified service personnel.
− Otherwise this may cause a mechanical error, electric shock, fire or physical damage.
− The product warranty does not cover problems resulting from disassembling the product.
• Do not use this product for business purposes.
• For washing machines with ventilation openings in the base, that a carpet must not obstruct
the openings.
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 3 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:434_safety instructions contents_5
safety instructions
CAUTIONS
There might be a slight injury or damage when you violate this instruction.
• Don’t install it in the area with moisture or outdoor where it has rain or snow.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Please unplug the power supply cord when you do not use it.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• If there is dust or water on the power supply plug and its connected part, please remove it
completely.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Do not make your kids look into the inside of the washer.
− If your kid falls into the washer, his life could be in danger.
• Ventilate immediately without touching the power plug if gas is leaking.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place if it catches flame.
• If the washer makes strange noise, smell or smoke, unplug it promptly and call service agent.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• When cleaning, don’t spray water to the parts of the washer directly.
− It may make its life span shorten.
Also an electric shock or fire may take place.
• Don’t use several appliances together with an outlet.
− A fire may take place due to unusual heat.
• Don’t press the button with an awl or pin.
− An electric shock or a fire may take place.
• Use the new hose-sets and old hose-sets should not be reused.
• If the damage is found on the current cord in use, it should be replaced by manufacturer,
service center or authorized person in order to avoid the risk.
• Connect the grounding wire to the shell plate, and bury it under at least 25cm of earth:
alternatively, connect the ground wire to the appropriate pin on a properly grounded power
receptacle. Never connect the w ire to a telephone line, lightning rod, or gas pipe.
• The product you have purchased is designed for domestic use only.
The use for business purposes qualifies as product misuse. In this case, the product will not
be covered by the standard warranty provided by Samsung and no responsibility can be
attributed to Samsung for malfunctions or damages resulting from such misuse.
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 4 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:434_safety instructions contents_5
contents
seTTing up your washer
6
6 Description of part
9 How to wash automatically depends on the
laundry
10 Control Panel
manual funcTions
15
15 Manual functions
insTallaTion & mainTenance
16
16 Environment
16 Levelling
16 Connecting the water supply hose
17 Assembling the rat protection panel (option)
18 How to connect the drain hose
19 Adding detergent
19 Adding fabric softener
20 Water supply connector filter
20 Cleaning the filter
20 Cleaning the pump filter (option)
20 Cleaning the detergent compartment
TroubleshooTing
21
21 Troubleshooting
washing machine won’T work?
22
22 Washing machine won’t work?
specificaTion
23
23 Specification
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 5 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:436_setting up your washer setting up your washer_7
setting up your washer
DeSCRIPTION OF PART
The User’s Manual is for common use.
Make use of the User’s Manual depending upon your washing machine model.
water supply hose (hot)(option)
water supply hose
(cold)
Detergent box
fabric softener
dispenser(option)
power cord
water drain hose
front control
panel
Drain hose (pump)
(optional)
adjustable legs
Adjust the length
of the legs when
installing the
washer.
lid
Be sure to keep the lid closed
during washing and spinning.
Lint will be collected in
the filter during washing.
filter
rat protection panel(option)
ground lead(option)
When the water pipe is
metal, make sure to cover
the end of the ground wire.
spin basket
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 6 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:436_setting up your washer setting up your washer_7
ChECking bEForE WAShing AnD CAring For gArMEnTS
Must follow the checkpoints in order to avoid machine problems or damages on garments.
• If the below problems are caused by customer’s faults, separate service fee will be charged.
checkpoints before starting washing
Check if the clothes are bleaching or not.
• Add liquid detergent to a white towel and the garment where you can’t notice well. Then, rub
together strongly. Check if the color transferred to the towel.
• Be careful for scarves and imported clothes since they are easily discoloring.
• Check for stains or partial dirt.
• If stains are found, use the towel wet with detergents to rub on in a single direction.
• Before washing, the sleeves, collar, dress hem and pockets are pre-treated by brushing with
detergents.
The wrinkle-processed clothes made of wool are specially treated by fixing them with threads
before washing. The threads shall be removed after the clothes are dried.
not washable laundry
Clothes those are easily transformable even by soaking in water.
• Even by soaking in water, neckties, brassieres, jackets, suits and coats can be easily
transformed like shrinking and discoloring on the garment surfaces because they are mostly
made of rayon, polynosic, cuff and their blend fabrics.
• The wrinkle-processed, embossed, or resin processed products are easy to transform even
by soaking in water.
• Easily discoloring products made of cotton and wool, wrinkled silk, leather products, leather
accessory, leather ornamented clothes and its accessory.
• Don’t wash those clothes without handling guideline or material indication tag.
about Detergent
• When detergents are not dissolving well, use warm water (about 40°C) to dissolve the
detergent.
• Use an appropriate amount.
• Even if excess amount of detergent is used, there is not much difference in washing
result. It may cause damages to the garments because rinsing is not enough.
• The bleaching agent may cause damages to garments since it is strong alkali.
• Do sufficient rinsing because the powder detergent is easily remained on the garments
causing bad odors.
• If too much detergent is used or cold water is used, it doesn’t dissolve completely and
remain on the garments, hose or spin basket, causing contamination on clothes.
• In case of reserved washing, detergents must be put in the detergent box. If the powder
detergents are spread on laundry directly, it may cause discoloration.
CAUTION
01 SETTing up your WAShEr
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 7 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:438_setting up your washer setting up your washer_9
setting up your washer
CARING FOR CLOTHeS BeFORe WASHING
Take out personal belongings from pockets.
• Caution, Check the pockets! Hairpins and coins cause damages to
clothes and washing machine. They make noise and problems to
the machine. Must check the pocket.
if pants zippers are open while washing, the spin basket may be
damaged. The zipper should be closed and fixed with a string
before washing.
• Metal on the clothing may cause damage to the clothes and the tub.
• Turn clothing with buttons and embroidered clothes inside out the
before washing them.
• Clothing with long strings may become entangled with other clothes,
and may cause damage to the clothing. Be sure to fix the strings
before washing.
waterproof clothes (ski wear, Diaper covers, footboards) are not
allowed for washing.
• This may cause the laundry to be ejected or cause the washing machine to vibrate
abnormally, which may result in personal injury or damage the washing machine, the floor
or the clothing. (Diapers, waterproof clothing, raincoats, umbrella covers, skiwear, car cover
sheets, and sleeping bags, etc.).
• When the tub rotates, water may become trapped in the waterproof clothing or fabric and
can collect in a corner, causing abnormal vibrations. In addition, the laundry rises and may be
ejected and cause personal injury.
shake the dirt or soils from clothes.
• Soil and sands may rub delicate garments to cause damages and the washing result may be
unsatisfactory.
Do pre-washing for white socks, sleeves, and collars before the main washing.
• For stains and dirt on collars, sleeves, hems, and pockets, apply some detergent to them
and apply it lightly with a brush before washing.
• Use powdered or liquid detergent. Do not use soap as the tub may become dirty from the
dirt on it.
Turn inside out for those nappy clothes before washing.
• If clothes have too much foreign matter, separate them for washing.
Other clothes may pick up those dirty matters (dirt, thread).
• Wash black colored clothes and cotton towels separately. If they are
washed together, towels may pick up dirty matters. Check before
washing.
cashmilon and those garments having big volume and lightweight
(eg. lasedecorated clothes, lingerie, nylon stocking, synthetic
fabrics etc.) may rise and cause damages to the clothes and
problems to the machine. use the laundry net or wash them
separately.
• Must put those long stringed clothes, lase-worked clothes, bed cover
sheet, wool clothes into a laundry net before washing.
• Put delicate clothes in the laundry net.
• Use only those commercial laundry net for washing.
curtains, floating garments or blue jeans shall be pressed not to
float on the water.
• If they are floated on the water, press Start/Pause button to stop and press them to sock in
the water. If the washing goes on with clothes floating on the water, it may cause damages to
the clothes and the washing machine as well as unsatisfactory washing result.
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 8 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:448_setting up your washer setting up your washer_9
HOW TO WASH AUTOmATICALLy DePeNDS ON THe LAUNDRy
before starting washing, check the following;
• Connect the water supply hose to the water tap. Leave a tap open. Plug the power cord in. Make sure
to lay down the drain hose.
Washing for the first time
Before washing clothes for the first time, you must run a complete cycle without clothes.
To do this:
1. Press the power button.
2. Open the detergent drawer and insert a little detergent.
3. Turn on the water supply to the washing machine.
4. Press the start/pause button.
This will remove any water from the manufacturer’s test run remaining in the machine.
Special notes!
automatic sensing function
• According to the selected program, the amount of laundry is automatically sensed and then
the appropriate water level, wash time, rinse cycle, and spinning time are automatically
selected for the automatic wash.
• After the power is on, a program is selected and Start/Pause button is pressed. Then,
the washing board starts spinning without water. This action senses how much laundry is
in the washing basket, not a machine problem. After this sensing process, water supplies
automatically.
adding Detergent and softener
• It senses the amount of laundry and indicates the water level and amount of detergent. Then,
it starts water supply right away.
• During the water supply, it is possible to open the detergent box and add detergent.
However, it is better to press Start/Pause button to stop water supply and add detergent.
Close the lid and press Start/Pause button again. This way is much more convenient.
• If the softener is inserted in the softener dispenser, it automatically adds in at the last rinsing
cycle.
put the laundry into the washer and add detergent, too.
• Be careful not to overload. Use right detergent for the fabrics you are washing.
• If the lid is open while running, the washing machine is stopped automatically for safety.
(Except, water supply continues while the lid is open.)
• When hot water is selected, both cold and hot water are supplied for the first 20
seconds in order to protect the clothes.
• Possible to control the washing time, rinsing cycle, and spinning time at every program
during the washing.
01 SETTing up your WAShEr
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 9 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4410_setting up your washer setting up your washer_11
setting up your washer
CONTROL PANeL
For more details, see control panel of your washing machine.
power buTTon
Press this button once to operate.
Press it again to turn the power off.
sTarT/pause
buTTon
Use to pause and restart the operation.
To change the washing procedure during an operation,
press this button to stop, and again to restart after changing the procedure.
program
selecT buTTon
Each time the button is pressed, the washing program changes;
Fuzzy Blanket Delicate Quick Super Clean Water Saving
Aqua Preserve Air Turbo
wash buTTon
Press this button to perform a wash only or to adjust the washing time.
You can set the wash time from between 4 to 30 minutes.
spin buTTon
Press this button to perform a spin cycle only or to adjust the spin time.
You can set the spin time from between 1 to 9 minutes.
When only a spin is selected, the spin time will be different from the total
remaining time. This is because the total remaining time includes the actual
spin time and the times for water draining and stopping.
rinse buTTon
Press this button to perform a rinse only or to adjust the rinse count.
You can set the rinse count up to five times.
Tub check
funcTion
If the Tub Check indicator on the display blinks (it blinks for 3 minutes), run
the Tub Clean course.
The Tub Clean function removes dirt from the tub to keep the laundry clean.
chilD-lock
funcTion
This is a device to protect children from being accidentally hurt while playing
with the washer.
• How to start the Child-Lock function:
- Press the “Power” button to go to an initial washing mode.
- By pressing “start/pause” button, you start washing and in case Child
Lock function is needed during the laundry
- Press both the “Rinse” and “Spin” buttons at the same times. (for 3 seconds)
(Note: You cannot perform the function without the “Power” button on.)
• To release the function of Child-Lock: In case the “Child-Lock” is
programmed, press both the “Rinse” and “Spin” buttons at the same time.
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 10 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4410_setting up your washer setting up your washer_11
remaining Time,
Delay sTarT
Time, error
Display
Displays the remaining wash time.
Displays the reserved delay start time.
Displays the error state if a problem occurs in the washing machine so that
you can take action.
soak buTTon
Press this button to perform a soak wash.
You can set the soak time from between 10 to 60 minutes.
Delay sTarT
buTTon
Press this button to finish the wash at a specified time.
Turn off your washing machine to cancel a reserved delay start.
You can set the delay start time from between 3 to 18 hours.
lasT seTTing
Press this button to load the settings for the last course.
Perform a wash course using the last used settings without having to enter
them manually again.
Your choices are automatically saved when you press the Start/Hold button.
To use a memorized course, press the Last Settings button and then press
the Start/Hold button.
- The memorized functions will be displayed on the panel.
The Delay start and Water level settings are not automatically saved
and will be reset after the wash.
Tub clean
buTTon
Use this program to clean the tub, it will keep the tub clean and sanitary.
The TUB CHECK LED is turned on to notify the user that it is time to clean
the tub.
waTer leVel
buTTon
The water level is automatically adjusted. However, you can select the water
level manually by pressing this button.
9
10
11
12
13
14
01 SETTing up your WAShEr
CAUTION
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 11 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4412_setting up your washer setting up your washer_13
setting up your washer
FUZZy PROGRAm
Selects the best washing program automatically.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the start/pause button.
Water level is selected automatically. Washing rinsing, and spinning follow.
If you want to pause, press the start/pause button again. You can change the program
when paused.
3. Close the lid.
BLANKeT PROGRAm
(Big volume laundry like blanket and bed cover sheets)
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button once.
3. Press the start/pause button.
Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to pause, press the start/pause button
again. You can change the program when paused.
4. Close the lid.
• Fold those big volume laundry (blanket and
bed cover sheets) in the following way before
adding into the spin basket.
• Do not wash the electric blanket and carpets.
• Get a laundry net for those light and big
volume laundry (eg. Cashmeres) because they
might rise in the water and get damaged.
When you wash unwieldy laundry items (e.g. blankets, winter clothes, etc.) add the
detergent before you add the laundry to utilize the up, down, left and right 3D 4-directional
stereo wash provided by Wobble Technology™ for a better result.
DeLICATe PROGRAm
Washable sweater, cardigan, delicate clothes etc.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button two times
3. Press the start/pause button.
Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to pause, press the start/pause button
again. You can change the course when paused.
4. Close the lid.
- You can only select cold water.
- The last spin operates lightly to prevent wrinkles.
- Use the detergent indicated in the laundry.
QUICK PROGRAm
If you want to wash those frequently used towels or less dirty laundry time.
Because washing is speedy, it is good for light or less stained laundry.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button three times.
3. Press the start/pasue button.
Water level is selected automatically. Washing, rinsing, and spinning follow. If you want to
pause, press the start/pasue button again. You can change the program when paused.
4. Close the lid.
CAUTION
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 12 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4412_setting up your washer setting up your washer_13
SUPeR CLeAN PROGRAm
Use for cleaner washing.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button four times.
3. Press the start/pause button and put the proper amount of detergent into tub.
Water level is selected automatically.
4. Close the lid.
WATeR SAVING PROGRAm
This is a specially designed program that enables you to wash laundry effectively with the
minimum amount of water.
1. Press the power button to “On”.
2. Press the program select button to select Water Saving program.
3. Press the water level button to display level “5”
4. Press the start/pause button.
If you want to pause, press the Start/Pause button again. You can change the course when
paused.
5. Close the lid.
AQUA PReSeRVe PROGRAm
Select this course if you wish to reuse the remaining water from the rinse cycle.
This option helps save the amount of water used.
1. Press the power button to turn the washer “On”.
2. Press the program selection button six times.
3. Press the start/pause button.
4. Close the lid.
You can use the water remaining after the rinse cycle for the next wash.
AIR TURBO PROGRAm
This course saves you valuable time, ensuring that your clothes dry faster than from line drying.
1. Press the power button to “on”.
2. Press the program select button seven times.
3. Close the lid.
4. Press the start/pause button.
• Select this when you want to half-dry the laundry.
KeePING THe TUB CLeAN
When using the machine under humid conditions for an extended time, various bacteria from the
air may stick to the tub and form black dirt (fungi), causing damage to the human body.
To keep the tub clean and hygienic at all times, it is recommended detergents to clean the tub
regularly at least once every one to three months.
01 SETTing up your WAShEr
CAUTION
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 13 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4414_setting up your washer manual functions_15
setting up your washer
DeLAy START
How to reserve washing?
Select this program when you have to go out or do something else.
1. Press the power button to “On”.
2. Press the Delay start button once.
You may change the delay start time with use the Delay start button. (from 3 hours to 18
hours)
3. Press the start/pause button and put the proper amount of detergent into tub.
4. Close the lid.
The washing finishes by the time you reserved. Add detergent and softener in proportion to
the water level. Then, close the lid.
• Must add the detergent in the detergent box.
• If the detergent is spread on the laundry directly, some clothes may get discolored as
the start delays.
• If the Delay Start needs to be canceled, press the Power button.
• The reserved finish time may be changed depends on the water pressure.
CHILD LOCK
This function is for protecting children, the elderly and the frail.
1. Press the Power button.
2. To activate the Child Lock function, press and hold both the Rinse and Spin buttons down
simultaneously for 3 seconds. (If the Child Lock function is activated, the Child Lock icon blinks.)
3. Operations after activating the Child Lock function.
• Even if the Child Lock function is activated, every button works until the door opens.
• When you open the door during the Child Lock is being activated, the alarm sounds
and an error message appears. In 30 seconds, draining begins automatically. However,
if you close the door within 30 seconds, water will not be drained. (Displayed error
message “ CL”, “ dE ”).
• To add laundry after activating the Child Lock function, you must deactivate the Child
Lock function.
4. To deactivate the Child Lock function, press and hold both the Rinse and Spin buttons simultaneously
for 3 seconds again. (If the Child Lock function is deactivated, the Child Lock icon is turned off.)
5. To clear “CL” display, after draining is complete, close the door of the washing turn the
power off and then on.
- This function is for preventing injury and malfunction of the product because of
inappropriate operations or actions by children, the elderly or the frail.
- If the door opens when the Child Lock function is activated, the water is drained by
force to prevent children from drowning.
- To add laundry after activating the Child Lock function, you must deactivate the Child Lock.
- Even if the power is turned off and then on when the Click Lock is activated, the Child
Lock remains activated.
- Once Child Lock is activated, even when the power is turned off, if the door is
opened, water is automatically drained in 30 seconds.
- The Child Lock function cannot be deactivated when CL is displayed. (However, the
Child Lock function can be deactivated when the dE error is displayed.)
CAUTION
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 14 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4414_setting up your washer manual functions_15
manual functions
Possible to select the function for each program.
(Example) For a simple washing as the little dirt program :
Power Select the little dirt program Wash Start/Pause
wash only
Press the power button.
Press the wash button.
Press the start/pause button.
Washing goes on for 1 time.
When the wash button is pressed during washing, the wash time
can be changed to between 4 and 30 minutes in duration.
rinse only
Press the rinse button.
Press the start/pause button.
Rinsing goes on for 1 times.
When the rinse button is pressed, the rinse times can be changed
to between 1 to 5 times in duration.
spin only
Press the spin button.
Press the start/pause button.
Spin drying goes on for 4 minutes.
When the spin button is pressed, the spin time can be changed to
from 0 to 9 minutes.
If 0 minutes is selected, the cycle is terminated after a drain cycle
only without the spin cycle being performed.
wash anD rinse
Press the wash and rinse button.
Press the start/pause button once.
Detects the amount of laundry, and determines wash and rinse time
period automatically.
When the wash and rinse button is pressed, wash time period is
determined between 4 and 30 minutes, and rinse time is determined
between 1 and 5 times.
rinse anD spin
Press the rinse and spin button.
Press the start/pause button once.
Rinsing and spin drying follow.
When the rinse and spin button is pressed, the number of rinse
times is determined between 1 and 5, and spin time period for
drying is determined between 0 and 9 minutes.
wash, rinse anD spin Press the wash, rinse and spin button.
Press the start/pause button once.
wash, rinse and spin is performed.
02 MAnuAl FunCTionS
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 15 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4516_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_17
installation & maintenance
The User’s Manual is for common use.
Make use of the User’s Manual depending upon your washing machine model.
eNVIRONmeNT
leave some space
Maintain at least 10cm between the washer and the wall.
place the washer on a sturdy flat surface.
If the washer is placed on an uneven or weak surface, noise or vibration occurs. (Allowable is 1˚)
adjust the legs for even placement.
never install the washer near water.
Do not place the washer in steamy rooms or where the washer is directly exposed to rain. Moisture may
destroy the electrical insulation causing an electrical shock hazard.
avoid direct sunlight or heaters.
As plastic an electrical components are affected by direct heat, never place the washer near furnaces,
boilers, etc. Do not place under direct sunlight.
LeVeLLING
• If the washer is not leveled with the ground, it makes the machine tremble more or be out of order. So,
make sure that the washer is leveled properly.
see if The machine is placeD leVel by checking
The posiTion of The washing Tub.
• Open the lid of the machine, pour water into the tub up
to the level just below the pulsator, and adjust the legs so
that the pulsator is positioned at the center of the water as
shown in the figure.
• Place the machine more than 10cm away from the wall.
• Adjust the legs on feet for levelling.
CONNeCTING THe WATeR SUPPLy HOSe
1. Remove the adaptor from the water supply hose.
2. First, using a “+” type screw driver, loosen the four screws
on the adaptor. Next, take the adaptor and turn part(b)
following the arrow for gap about 5 mm between them.
3. Connect adaptor to the water tap by tightening the screws
firmly. Then, turn part(b) following the arrow and put (a) and
(b) together.
Water
LOOSEN LOCK
a
b
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 16 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4516_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_17
4. Connect the water supply hose to the adaptor. Pull down
the part (c) of the water supply hose. When the part (c)
is released, the hose is automatically connected to the
adaptor making a ‘click’ sound.
5. Connect the other end of the water supply hose to the
inlet water valve at the back of the washer. Screw the hose
clockwise all the way in.
5-1. Connect the other end of the water supply hose to
the inlet water valve at the top of the washer. Screw the
hose clockwise all the way in.
• If the water tap is a screw type, assemble a water supply
hose that fits to the tap as shown. After completing
connection, if water leaks from the hose, then repeat the
same steps.
After completing connection, if water leaks from the hose, then repeat the same steps.
Use the most conventional type of faucet for water supply.
In case the faucet is square or too big, remove the spacing ring before inserting the faucet
into the adaptor.
ASSemBLING THe RAT PROTeCTION PANeL (OPTION)
Tilt the washer a little and lift up the panel until it clicks, finally fix the panel with screw
to the base as shown in the figure.
1. Insert the rat protection panel to the
assembling hole on back side to the end.
2. If you have difficulty inserting the panel lift
up the washer a little and insert it.
c
Rear-side
03 inSTAllATion & MAinTEnAnCE
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 17 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4618_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_19
installation & maintenance
HOW TO CONNeCT THe DRAIN HOSe
IN CASe OF PUmP-DRAINeD WASHeR (OPTION)
cap-hose
Take out the cap-hose and connect the
outlet-hose.
Be sure to join tightly the drain hose into the
drainoutlet on the back of the machine.
90~100cm
Be sure to join tightly the drain hose into the
drain-outlet on the side of the machine.
Install the drain hose in the position of about
90~100cm above the ground.
IN CASe OF GeNeRAL WASHeR
1. After pressing the joint ring, insert to the drain hose.
2. After directing the drain hose to a drain, join to the
drainoutlet of the washing machine.
3. Be sure to join them tightly by pressing the joint ring and
pushing it into the drain-outlet.
• The length of drain hose is adjustable so that you can
extend the length appropriately.
HOW TO CHANGe THe DRAIN HOSe DIReCTION
• The handle of joint ring is pressed to pull out the drain hose.
Change the direction of the drain hose and follow the above
guideline again.
drain-outlet
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 18 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4718_installation & maintenance installation & maintenance_19
CAUTIONS WHeN INSeRTING THe DRAIN HOSe
Less than 3 m
1. Don’t exceed more than 3m when the
drain hose is used by connecting with
other hoses.
2. Be careful to drain water out at the end of
the drain hose.
Less than 3 m
Less than
5 cm
3. The doorsill shoudn’t be more than 5cm. 4. Don’t install the drain hose underneath the
wash machine.
ADDING DeTeRGeNT
1. Open the detergent drawer and then add the powder detergent into the detergent compartment.
2. Add detergent evenly so that it doesn’t brim over the edge of the drawer.
• Use a reasonable amount of detergent.
If you use more detergent than the standard
quantity or the water temperature is too low and the
detergent does not dissolve in the water completely
causing it to remain on the laundry and in the hose
and tub, it may cause damage such as dirtying and
discoloring the laundry.
• If you use a powder detergent and it remains on the
laundry, it may cause a bad odor. Rinse the laundry
sufficiently in fresh water.
• If you spread a powder detergent over the laundry directly, it may result in discoloration.
Make sure to insert it into the detergent compartment.
If you spread a powder detergent over the laundry directly, it may result in discoloration.
Make sure to insert it into the detergent compartment.
If the water pressure is low, the detergent may remain in the detergent compartment.
ADDING FABRIC SOFTeNeR
1. When the proper amount (one time dose) of fabric softener is stored in the softener inlet, it is
automatically added during the last rinse cycle.
2. Do not add detergent, bleach or starch into the softener inlet.
3. Using too much softener may produce unsatisfactory results.
4. Do not open the lid during the Spin cycle. If added too early, its effectiveness will decrease.
5. Do not leave the softener in the softener dispenser for a long time as it may congeal.
If the water pressure is low, the fabric softener may remain in the
softener compartment. In this case, put the fabric softener into the tub
directly.
Slide and open the cover in the direction of the arrow, insert the rinse
detergent, and slide and close it in the reverse direction.
03 inSTAllATion & MAinTEnAnCE
CAUTION
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 19 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4720_installation & maintenance troubleshooting_21
installation & maintenance
WATeR SUPPLy CONNeCTOR FILTeR
1. Pull out the filter and wash well.
2. Pull in the filter and connect the hose to the inlet water valve
tightly.
3. Check if there is a leakage.
Note to tighten up the connector.
CLeANING THe FILTeR
Clean the filter net often to keep the washer clean.
1. Push the upper part of the Hygiene filter
and pull in.
2. Open the cover as shown in the figure.
3. Clean the Hygiene filter. 4. Close the cover and insert the lower part of
the filter in the basket first and then push
the filter with “click” sound.
CLeANING THe PUmP FILTeR (OPTION)
1. Place a rag or towel under the wash filter to avoid wetting the floor, and rotate the filter counterclockwise
and pull it out.
2. Remove any dirt from the filter.
3. Return the filter to its place by rotating the filter clockwise until it locks into position.
CLeANING THe DeTeRGeNT COmPARTmeNT
1. Separate the detergent compartment from the washer.
2. Separate and clean the Rinse-Cap from the detergent compartment.
3. Assemble the Rinse-Cap and insert the detergent compartment into the washer.
1 2 3
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 20 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4820_installation & maintenance troubleshooting_21
troubleshooting
problEM ChECk
Washing machine won’t work • Is the water tap opened?
• Is the washer plugged in?
• Is the power cut off?
• Is there enough water?
Water dose not drain • Is the drain hose down?(No pump)
• Is the drain hose frozen?
• Is the drain hose clogged?
• If the water dose not drain in 30 minutes, a buzzer will sound, and the
remaining time indicator will show “5E”.
Water is not supplied • Is the water tap opened?
• Is the water cut off?
• Is the water supply hose or hose connection clogged?
• Is the water tap frozen?
• If the water supply is not finished in 1 hour or there is no change in the
water level 10 minutes after the water supply has started, the buzzer
rings and “4E” is displayed on the remaining time indicator.
Spinning does not work • Is the laundry spread out evenly in the washer?
• In the washer set on a sturdy flat surface?
Water is overflowed • Restart after spinning.
• If the error sign still indicates, call agency.
This indicates that a Child Lock
error occurred
• The error message blinks at a 1 second interval and the water is
drained with an alarm sound.
(Displayed message: “ CL” or “ dE ”)
• This function is to prevent children from drowning when falling into
the wash tub. When draining is complete and you turn the power off
and then on, the washing machine will operate normally.
• To clear “CL” display, after draining is complete, close the door of
the washing machine, turn the power off and then on.
Water leakage error • Check if the end of the drain hose is placed on the floor. (The hose
should be hung over the pump - hose guide.)
• Check if the drain hose is clogged by any foreign substances.
• If the error remains, call the service center.
04 TroublEShooTing
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 21 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4922_washing machine won’t work? specification_23
washing machine won’t work?
problem check
The power is cut off. Is the electric voltage normal?
Is the washer plugged in? Plug in the electric cord.
Water does not drain.
Is the drain hose down? Put the drain hose down.
Is the drain hose folded? Unfold the drain hose.
Is the drain hose outlet clogged? Remove the waste cleanly.
Washing machine won’t work. Is the washer lid open?
Close the lid.
Is the Pause button on?
Press the Start/Pause button one more time and check if the
washer starts.
Is enough water filled to the water level?
If the water pressure is low, it takes a long time to start
washing.
Is the faucet closed?
Open the faucet to supply water.
If the drain hose and spin basket are
frozen, do as follows.
• Add hot water to the frozen water tap and remove the drain
hose. Soak into hot water.
• Pour hot water into the spin basket for about 10 minutes.
• Put a hot water towel on the drain hose connector.
• If the drain hose defrosts, connect again and check for proper
water draining.
The water drains out immediately. • The drain is clogged with coins or pins. The drain hose is
hung over the drain hose hook. Half fill the spin basket with
water and try for spinning again.
The water leaks at the water supply
hose connector.
If the faucet connecting part is loose, water may leak.
Repeat the assembling steps again. (Refer to “Connecting the
water supply hose”)
Check if the rubber packing of water supply hose is in the right
position.
Screw tightly again.
Is the water supply hose folded?
Unfold the hose.
If the water supply is too strong, water may leak.
Close the faucet a little.
Is water leaking from the faucet itself?
Fix the faucet. Water is not supplied.
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 22 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:4922_washing machine won’t work? specification_23
problem check
The water leaks at the water supply
hose connector.
Did you press the Start/Pause button after selecting the water supply?
If the Start/Pause button is not pressed, water is not
supplied. Press the Start/Pause button.
Is the faucet closed?
Turn on the faucet.
Is the filter net at the water supply hose connector clogged with
dirty matters?
Clean the filter net by brushing with a toothbrush.
Is the water supply cut off?
If the water supply is suspended, turn off the faucet and power off.
Spinning makes loud noises and
vibrations.
Check if the laundry is spread evenly in the washer.
Spread out the laundry evenly and start again.
Check if the washing machine levels on a sturdy flat floor.
Set the machine at level.
Is the handle for leveling legs loose?
Adjust the legs on the feet for leveling.
Is around the washing machine filled with unnecessary stuffs?
Remove those unnecessary things away from the wash machine.
specification
wa95wp
MAX. MASS OF DRY
CLOTH IN kg
WA95WP 7.5 KG
STANDARD
WATER
LEVEL
8 60 l
POWER
CONSUMPTION
WASH 330 W
6 44 l
SPIN 240 W
DIMENSIONS(mm)
W540XL590XH888 (LOW BASE)
W540XL590XH940 (HIGH BASE)
4 36 l
WEIGHT 32 kg 2 25 l
WATER PRESSURE
0.05~0.78 MPa
(0.5 ~ 8.0 kg
.
f/cm2
)
WATER USAGE 160 l
WASHING TYPE Stirring Type SPIN SPEED 720 rpm
1. Water Saving program + Water Level “5” is recommended for a normally soiled load.
06 SpEC Fi CAT i ion
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 23 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:49QUESTIONS OR COMMENTS?
country call or VisiT us online aT
SINGAPORE 1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com
Code No. DC68-02899L_EN
WA95WP-02899L_EN_20120601.indd 24 2012-06-01 �� 4:47:49
Wasmachine
gebruiksaanwijzing
imagine… ongekende
mogelijkheden
Dank u voor het aanschaffen van dit Samsung-product.
Voor een uitgebreide service kunt u uw product registreren op
www.samsung.com/register
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
Deze handleiding is gemaakt van 100% gerecycled papier.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 1 2012-4-16 13:09:542_ de mogelijkheden van uw nieuwe samsung-wasmachine
de mogelijkheden van uw
nieuwe samsung-wasmachine
Met uw nieuwe wasmachine verandert uw kijk op de was volkomen. Uw Samsungwasmachine heeft alle eigenschappen – van de enorm grote capaciteit tot de
energiezuinigheid – om een alledaags karwei te veranderen in een aangename
bezigheid.
• Energiebesparing
Met de speciale bubbelgenerator en Samsung invertermotor biedt dit model een meer
efficiënt energiegebruik vergeleken met een standaard A-label wasmachine.
• Minder lawaai & trillingen
De Samsung wasmachine functioneert op een zeer rustige wijze. Lawaai en trillingen worden
dankzij de smart-regeltechnologie gereduceerd. Wegens minimale trillingen blijft de trommel
perfect in evenwicht.
• Kort programma
Geen tijd te verliezen? Met ons Kort programma van 15 minuten kunt u snel kleine wasjes
doen.Ons Snelwas kan u helpen bij uw drukke leven. Nu neemt het wassen van uw favoriete
kleding (tot 2 kg) slechts 15 minuten in beslag!
• Eco trommelreiniging
De functie Eco trommelreiniging helpt u de wasmachine schoon te houden, zonder
chemische reinigings- of bleekmiddelen. Met dit speciale reinigingsprogramma houd de
trommel schoon en reukloos.
• Babykleding
Uw Samsung-wasmachine heeft wasprogramma’s die bescherming geven aan de kleding van
kinderen met een gevoelige huid.
Deze programma’s minimaliseren huidirritatie bij kinderen door wasmiddelrestanten tot een
minimum terug te brengen. Daarbij plaatsen deze programma’s de was in verschillende
categorieën en worden wasprogramma’s uitgevoerd volgens de kenmerken van elke
categorie.
• Handwas
U kunt uw fijne was extra goed behandelen door het instellen van de juiste temperatuur, een
zachte wasactie en de correcte hoeveelheid water.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 2 2012-4-16 13:09:54de mogelijkheden van uw nieuwe samsung-wasmachine _3
• Kinderslot
Met het kinderslot kunnen onderzoekende kleine handjes uit de wasmachine worden
gehouden.
Deze beveiligingsfunctie voorkomt dat uw kinderen met de bediening van uw wasmachine
spelen en waarschuwt u wanneer deze wordt geactiveerd.
• Uitgesteld einde
U kunt een wasprogramma tot 19 uur uitstellen, in stappen van een uur. Handig wanneer u de
deur uit moet!
• Grafisch digitaal display
Het grafisch digitale bedieningspaneel display is duidelijk en eenvoudig te gebruiken
zonder gedoe of enig probleem. En terwijl het eenvoudig te bedienen is, maakt het grafisch
digitale display het mogelijk om snel en accuraat instellingen te kiezen voor uitstekende
wasresultaten.
• Aqua Hose en lekkagesensor (geselecteerde modellen)
Het slim ontworpen waterbeveiligingssysteem voor Samsung-wasmachines bevat een
intelligente slang voor het stoppen van waterlekkages aan de bron en een lekkagesensor
aan de onderkant. Als de slang breekt of als waterlekken worden gedetecteerd, wordt een
inwendige spons geactiveerd om water uit de tapkraan te blokkeren.
Deze gebruiksaanwijzing bevat belangrijke informatie over de installatie, het gebruik en het
onderhoud van uw nieuwe wasmachine van Samsung. Gebruik de gebruiksaanwijzing voor
beschrijvingen van het bedieningspaneel, instructies voor het gebruik van de wasmachine en
voor tips over hoe u het beste gebruikmaakt van de hoogstaande mogelijkheden en functies. Het
gedeelte “Problemen oplossen en foutcodes” op pagina 35 helpt u wanneer er iets verkeerd
gaat met uw nieuwe wasmachine.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 3 2012-4-16 13:09:544_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
veiligheidsvoorschriften
Gefeliciteerd met uw nieuwe Samsung ActivFresh™ wasmachine. Deze
Gebruiksaanwijzing bevat belangrijke informatie over installatie, gebruik en onderhoud
van uw apparaat. Neem even de tijd om deze Gebruiksaanwijzing te lezen zodat u
volop profijt hebt van de vele voordelen en mogelijkheden van uw wasmachine.
WAt U ovEr vEiliGHEidsvoorscHriftEn MoEt WEtEn
Lees deze Gebruiksaanwijzing zorgvuldig door zodat u zeker weet hoe u de uitgebreide mogelijkheden en functionaliteit
van uw nieuwe apparaat veilig en efficiënt kunt bedienen.Bewaar deze Gebruiksaanwijzing op een veilige plaats in de
nabijheid van de wasmachine zodat u hem later nog eens kunt raadplegen. Gebruik het apparaat uitsluitend voor het
doel.waarvoor het gemaakt is zoals in deze Gebruiksaanwijzing is beschreven.
Waarschuwingen en belangrijke veiligheidsinstructies in deze Gebruiksaanwijzing omvatten niet alle mogelijke
omstandigheden en situaties die zich kunnen voordoen. Het is uw verantwoordelijkheid om uw gezonde verstand
te gebruiken, voorzichtig te zijn en zorgvuldig te werk te gaan bij het installeren, onderhouden en bedienen van uw
wasmachine.
Omdat deze gebruiksaanwijzing betrekking heeft op verschillende modellen, kunnen de kenmerken van uw wasmachine
iets afwijken van de in dit handboek beschrevene en mogelijk zijn niet alle waarschuwingssymbolen op uw machine van
toepassing. Indien u nog vragen hebt of problemen neem dan contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum of
zoek online hulp en informatief op www.samsung.com.
BElAnGrijKE vEiliGHEidssyMBolEn En
voorzorGsMAAtrEGElEn
de betekenis van de symbolen en tekens in deze
gebruiksaanwijzing:
WAARSCHUWING
Gevaren of onveilige werkwijzen als gevolg waarvan dodelijk of ernstig
persoonlijk letsel en/of materiële schade kan ontstaan.
VOORZICHTIG
Gevaren of onveilige werkwijzen als gevolg waarvan persoonlijk letsel
en/of materiële schade kan ontstaan.
VOORZICHTIG
Houdt u aan onderstaande voorzorgsmaatregelen voor de veiligheid,
om het risico van brand, explosie, elektrische schok of persoonlijk letsel
tijdens het gebruik van uw wasmachine te beperken:
NIET.proberen.
NIET demonteren.
NIET aanraken.
Houdt u nadrukkelijk aan de aanwijzingen.
Trek de netstekker uit de wandcontactdoos.
Zorg ervoor dat de machine is geaard om een elektrische schok te
vermijden.
Vraag de servicedienst om hulp.
Opmerking
deze waarschuwingstekens staan er om letsel bij uzelf en bij anderen te voorkomen.
Houdt u er alstublieft nadrukkelijk aan.
Bewaar dit hoofdstuk na het lezen op een veilige plaats om het later nog eens te kunnen
raadplegen.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 4 2012-4-16 13:09:58veiligheidsvoorschriften _5
Lees alle instructies voordat u het apparaat in gebruik neemt.
Net als bij alle andere elektrische apparatuur met bewegende delen, bestaan er altijd
mogelijke risico’s. Om het apparaat veilig te kunnen gebruiken moet de manier waarop het
werkt u vertrouwd zijn en moet u altijd voorzichtig zijn wanneer u het gebruikt.
Laat kinderen (of huisdieren) nooit op of in het apparaat spelen. De deur van de wasmachine gaat van
binnenuit niet open en kinderen kunnen ernstig verwond raken wanneer ze opgesloten worden.
Personen (hier worden ook kinderen onder verstaan) die beperkte fysieke, zintuiglijke of geestelijke
mogelijkheden hebben, of die het ontbreekt aan ervaring en/of kennis, mogen het apparaat niet
gebruiken, tenzij zij onder toezicht staan van iemand die verantwoordelijk is voor hun veiligheid, of
tenzij deze persoon ze heeft geïnstrueerd over het gebruik van het apparaat.
Kinderen moeten onder toezicht staan zodat zeker is dat zij niet met het apparaat spelen.
Indien de stekker (of het snoer) is beschadigd moet, om risico te vermijden, de fabrikant of diens
servicemonteur of een gelijkwaardig gekwalificeerde het vervangen.
Het apparaat moet zo worden geplaatst dat het snoer voldoende lang is om een wandcontactdoos te
bereiken en dat de wateraansluiting en de afvoer binnen bereik zijn.
Bij wasmachines die aan de onderzijde ventilatieopeningen hebben, moet erop worden gelet dat deze
niet worden versperd door vloerkleden of andere obstakels.
Gebruik de nieuwe slangen. Oude slangen moeten niet worden hergebruikt.
instrUctiEs ovEr MiliEUvriEndElijKE vUilAfvoEr
De juiste wijze van afvoeren van dit product (Afvoer van elektrische en
elektronische apparatuur)
(van toepassing in de Europese Gemeenschap en andere Europese landen met
gescheiden afvalinzamelingssystemen)
De markering op dit product, het toebehoren of de documentatie geeft aan dat het product en
zijn elektronische toebehoren (bijvoorbeeld. laadapparaat, hoofdtelefoon, USB -kabel) na de
gebruiksduur niet met het gewone huisvuil mag worden afgevoerd. Om mogelijke schade aan
het milieu of de volksgezondheid te voorkomen door illegale afvoer, deze voorwerpen apart
houden van andere soorten afval en laat ze op verantwoorde wijze recyclen voor een duurzaam
hergebruik van grondstoffen.
Voor nadere informatie over locaties waar en over hoe deze artikelen moeten worden ingeleverd
om milieuveilig te worden gerecycled, moeten particuliere gebruikers contact opnemen met de
winkelier waar ze het artikel hebben gekocht, of met het kantoor van de plaatselijke overheid.
Zakelijke gebruikers moeten contact opnemen met hun leverancier en de bepalingen en de
voorwaarden in het verkoopcontract erop naslaan. Dit product en zijn elektronische toebehoren
moeten bij het afvoeren niet met ander bedrijfsafval worden gemengd.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 5 2012-4-16 13:09:586_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij instAllAtiE
De installatie van dit apparaat moet door een gekwalificeerd(e) technicus of servicebedrijf
worden uitgevoerd.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
Het apparaat is zwaar. Wees voorzichtig wanneer u het optilt.
Steek de stekker van het snoer in een 220V/50Hz/15A (of hoger) wisselstroom
wandcontactdoos. Gebruik de contactdoos uitsluitend voor het aansluiten van dit apparaat.
Gebruik ook geen verlengsnoer.
- Het delen van de wandcontactdoos met andere toestellen, door een verdeelstopcontact,
of het aansluiten van een verlengsnoer, kan tot een elektrische schok of brand leiden.
- Zorg ervoor dat de spanning, frequentie en de stroomsoort hetzelfde zijn als die in de
productspecificaties zijn vermeld. Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of
brand het gevolg zijn. Steek de netstekker goed in de wandcontactdoos.
Verwijder regelmatig alle vreemde substanties zoals stof en water met behulp van een
droge doek uit de elektrische contactdozen.
- Trek de stekker uit de wandcontactdoos en maak hem met een droge doek schoon.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Steek de stekker in de juiste richting in de wandcontactdoos, zodat het snoer naar
beneden loopt.
- Als u de netstekker andersom in de wandcontactdoos steekt kunnen de elektrische
draden binnenin het snoer worden beschadigd waardoor een elektrisch schok of brand
kan ontstaan.
Houdt al het verpakkingsmateriaal buiten bereik van kinderen omdat het voor kinderen
gevaarlijk kan zijn.
- Als een kind een zak over zijn hoofd trekt kan dat tot verstikking leiden.
Neem bij beschadigingen aan het apparaat of de stekker of het snoer, contact op met het
dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
Dit apparaat moet op de juiste manier worden geaard.
Aard het apparaat niet op een gasleiding, plastic waterleiding of een telefoonleiding.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
- Stop nooit een stekker in een wandcontactdoos die niet op de goede manier is geaard
en verzeker u ervan dat het in overeenstemming met de lokale en nationale normen is
uitgevoerd.
Installeer het apparaat niet in de nabijheid van een verwarming of brandbaar materiaal.
Installeer het apparaat niet op een vochtige, vettige of stoffige locatie, op een locatie die
blootgesteld is aan direct zonlicht of aan water (regendruppels).
Installeer het apparaat niet op een locatie met lage temperaturen
- Bij vorst kunnen de buizen barsten
Installeer het apparaat niet op een locatie waar gas kan lekken.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Gebruik geen elektrische transformator.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 6 2012-4-16 13:09:58veiligheidsvoorschriften _7
Gebruik geen beschadigde netstekker, een beschadigd snoer of een niet goed vastzittende
wandcontactdoos.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Trek niet aan, of buig het snoer niet bovenmatig.
Het snoer niet in elkaar draaien en er geen knoop inleggen.
Haak het elektrische snoer niet achter een metalen voorwerp. Plaats er geen zware
voorwerpen op.Zet het niet klem tussen twee voorwerpen en duw het niet in de ruimte
achter het apparaat.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Trek de stekker niet aan het snoer uit het stopcontact.
- Houdt bij het uit het stopcontact trekken de stekker vast.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Leg geen snoeren en slangen op plaatsen waar u erover zou kunnen struikelen.
WAArscHUWinGEn Bij instAllAtiE
Dit apparaat moet op een zodanige wijze worden geplaatst dat de contactdoos goed
bereikbaar is.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand door het lekken van elektriciteit
het gevolg zijn.
Installeer uw apparaat op een horizontale, vlakke en harde vloer die het gewicht kan
dragen.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot abnormale trillingen, “wandelen”,
lawaai of problemen met het product.
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij GEBrUiK
Sluit, als het apparaat is overgelopen, de watertoevoer en de elektriciteit onmiddellijk af en
neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Raak de stekker niet met natte handen aan
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok het gevolg zijn
Trek onmiddellijk de stekker uit het stopcontact als het apparaat een vreemd geluid maakt
en/of u een brandlucht of rook bemerkt en neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde
servicecentrum.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
In het geval van een gaslek (zoals propaangas, LPG, et cetera.), onmiddellijk ventileren
zonder dat u de stekker aanraakt. Raak het apparaat of het snoer niet aan.
- Gebruik geen ventilator.
- Een vonk kan een explosie of brand veroorzaken.
Sta niet toe dat kinderen in of op de wasmachine spelen. Verwijder bovendien, bij het
afvoeren van het apparaat, de handel van de deur van de wasmachine.
- Als een kind opgesloten raakt binnenin de machine kan dat tot dodelijke verstikking
leiden.
Verzekert u ervan dat u de verpakking (schuimplastic, piepschuim) die aan de bodem van
de wasmachine is bevestigd, voor gebruik verwijdert.
WAArscHUWinG
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 7 2012-4-16 13:09:588_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
Was geen stukken die verontreinigd zijn met diesel, benzine, verfverdunner, alcohol of
andere brandbare of explosieve stoffen.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok, brand of explosie.
Open tijdens de wasgang, de deur van de wasmachine niet met geweld (hoge temperatuur
bij het wassen/ drogen/centrifugeren).
- Uitstromend water kan brandwonden veroorzaken of de vloer kan er glad door worden.
Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
- Door de deur met geweld te openen kan het product worden beschadigd of kan er letsel
ontstaan.
Steek uw hand niet onder de wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
Raak de stekker niet met natte handen aan.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok.
Schakel het apparaat niet uit of in door de stekker uit het stopcontact te trekken terwijl de
machine aan het wassen is.
- Bij het weer in het stopcontact stoppen van de stekker kan een vonk ontstaan, met als
gevolg een elektrische schok of brandt.
Kinderen of personen met beperkingen mogen de wasmachine niet zonder toezicht
gebruiken. Sta niet toe dat kinderen in het apparaat klimmen.
- Doet u dat wel, dan kunnen een elektrische schok, brandwonden of ander letsel.het
gevolg zijn.
Steek uw hand of een metalen voorwerp niet onder de wasmachine tijdens het wassen.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
Haal de stekker van het apparaat niet uit de wandcontactdoos door aan het snoer te
trekken.Houdt de stekker altijd stevig vast en trek hem rechtstreeks uit de contactdoos.
- Beschadiging van het snoer kan sluiting brand en/of een elektrische schok veroorzaken
Probeer het apparaat niet eigenhandig te repareren, te demonteren, of te modificeren.
- Gebruik geen zekeringen (zoals koper, staaldraad, enzovoort) behalve de
standaardzekering.
- Indien het apparaat moet worden gerepareerd of geïnstalleerd, neem dan contact op
met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Wordt dit niet gedaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
Zou een vreemde stof zoals water in het apparaat zijn gekomen, trek dan de stekker uit het
stopcontact en neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Als de waterslang is losgeraakt van de kraan en water over het apparaat loopt de stekker
uit het stopcontact trekken.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Trek de stekker uit het stopcontact als het apparaat gedurende langere tijd niet wordt
gebruikt of tijdens onweer/ bliksem.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 8 2012-4-16 13:09:59veiligheidsvoorschriften _9
WAArscHUWinGstEKEns Bij GEBrUiK
Is de wasmachine verontreinigd door een vreemde stof zoals wasmiddel, vuil, etensresten
en dergelijke, neem dan de stekker uit het stopcontact en maak de wasmachine met
behulp van een zachte, vochtige, doek.
- Doet u dat niet, dan kunnen verkleuring, vervorming, beschadiging of roest het gevolg
zijn.
Het glas aan de voorzijde kan door een heftige slag breken. Wees voorzichtig bij het
gebruik van de wasmachine.
- Een gebroken vensterglas kan letsel veroorzaken.
Na een probleem met de watertoevoer of bij het opnieuw aansluiten van de slang voor de
watertoevoer, de kraan langzaam openen.
De kraan nadat hij lange tijd niet is gebruikt langzaam openen.
- De luchtdruk in de slang van de watertoevoer kan schade veroorzaken aan onderdelen
of tot lekkage leiden.
Als er tijdens het wassen een afvoerfout ontstaat, controleer dan eerst of er geen probleem
is met de afvoer.
- Gebruik van de wasmachine nadat deze is overgelopen door een probleem met de
afvoer, kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand als gevolg van het weglekken van
elektriciteit.
Leg het wasgoed helemaal in de machine zodat het wasgoed niet tussen de deur kan
komen.
- Als er wasgoed tussen de deur zit kan dat schade aan het wasgoed of de wasmachine,
of lekkage tot gevolg hebben.
Zorg ervoor dat de kraan dicht is wanneer de wasmachine niet in gebruik is.
- Verzeker u ervan dat de schroef op de aansluiting van de slang van de watertoevoer
goed vast is aangedraaid.
- Is dat niet het geval, dan kunnen materiële schade of letsel het gevolg zijn.
Controleer of de rubberen dichting niet verontreinigd is door vreemde stoffen (vuil, draadjes
en dergelijke).
- Als de deur niet volledig is gesloten kan dat tot lekkage leiden.
Open de kraan en controleer of de aansluiting van de waterslang goed is aangedraaid en of
er geen lekkage is, voordat u het product in gebruik neemt.
- Als de schroeven van de aansluiting van de slang voor de watertoevoer los zitten kan dat
lekkage tot gevolg hebben.
Het product dat u hebt aangeschaft, is uitsluitend bedoeld voor huishoudelijk gebruik.
Het gebruik van dit product voor zakelijke doeleinden wordt gezien als verkeerd gebruik van
het product.
In dat geval komt de standaardgarantie die Samsung biedt, te vervallen en kan Samsung
niet verantwoordelijk worden gesteld voor storingen of schade als gevolg van het verkeerd
gebruik.
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 9 2012-4-16 13:09:5910_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
Ga niet bovenop het apparaat staan of plaats er geen voorwerpen op (zoals wasgoed,
brandende kaarsen, brandende sigaretten, borden, chemicaliën, metalen voorwerpen
enzovoort).
- Dit kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, problemen met het product, of letsel.
Spuit geen vluchtige stoffen zoals insecticide op het oppervlak van het apparaat.
- Behalve dat deze toxisch zijn voor mensen, kan dat ook leiden tot elektrische schok,
brand, of problemen met het product.
Plaats geen voorwerp dat een elektromagnetisch veld genereert in de buurt van de
wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan als gevolg van storing in de werking.
Het water dat wordt afgevoerd tijdens een was bij hoge temperaturen of een droogcyclus is
heet. Raak het dus niet aan.
- Hierdoor kunnen brandwonden of ander letsel ontstaan.
Was, centrifugeer of droog geen waterbestendige kussens, matten of kleding (*) tenzij uw
apparaat een speciaal programma heeft voor het wassen van dergelijke stukken.
- Was geen dikke, harde matten, ook niet als het wassymbool op het wasetiket staat.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan of zouden de wasmachine, muren, vloer of kleding als
gevolg van abnormale trillingen kunnen worden beschadigd.
* Wollen beddengoed, regenhoezen, visvesten, skibroeken, slaapzakken, luierbroekjes,
sweat suits en fiets-, motorfiets-en autohoezen enzovoort.
Gebruik de wasmachine niet zonder dat het wasmiddelbakje aanwezig is.
- Door dat toch te doen kan een elektrische schok of letsel door het lekken van water het
gevolg zijn.
Raak de binnenkant van de kuip niet aan tijdens of direct na het drogen, want die is heet.
- Hierdoor kunnen brandwonden ontstaan.
Steek uw hand na opening niet in het wasmiddelbakje.
- Dit kan tot letsel leiden omdat uw hand kan worden gegrepen door het
invoermechanisme voor het wasmiddel. Plaats geen andere dingen (zoals schoenen,
etensresten, dieren) dan wasgoed. in de wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan de wasmachine worden beschadigd, of in het geval van huisdieren kunnen
deze worden gedood of gewond door de abnormale trillingen.
De knoppen niet met scherpe voorwerpen zoals naalden, messen, spijkers en dergelijke
indrukken.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of letsel.
Was geen wasgoed dat verontreinigd is met oliën, crèmes of lotions zoals die in
schoonheidssalons of massagepraktijken worden gebruikt.
- Door dat toch te doen kan de rubber dichting worden vervormd en kan er lekkage
ontstaan.
Laat geen metalen voorwerpen zoals veiligheidsspelden of haarspelden of bleekmiddel voor
langere tijd in de kuip liggen.
- Hierdoor kan de kuip gaan roesten.
- Als er roest op het oppervlak van de kuip verschijnt, brengt u een schoonmaakmiddel
(neutraal) op het oppervlak aan, en maakt dat met behulp van een sponsje schoon.
Gebruik nooit een metalen borstel.
Niet rechtstreeks een middel voor chemisch reinigen gebruiken en met chemisch
reinigingsmiddel verontreinigd wasgoed niet wassen, spoelen of centrifugeren.
- Hierdoor kan spontaan een explosie optreden of brand ontstaan als gevolg van de hitte
door oxidatie van de olie.
Gebruik geen water uit koel- of verwarmingstoestellen.
- Hierdoor kunnen zich problemen met de wasmachine voordoen.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 10 2012-4-16 13:09:59veiligheidsvoorschriften _11
Gebruik voor de wasmachine geen natuurlijke zeep die bedoeld is voor het handen wassen.
- Als deze stolt en zich in de wasmachine ophoopt, kan de wasmachine problemen
veroorzaken of kunnen verkleuring, roest of onaangename geuren optreden.
Was geen grote stukken wasgoed zoals beddengoed in het wasnet.
- Doe sokken en bh’s in het wasnet en was het samen met ander wasgoed.
- Doet u dat niet, dan kan dat leiden tot letsel of abnormale trillingen.
Gebruik geen gehard wasmiddel.
- Als dit zich in de wasmachine ophoopt kan er waterlekkage ontstaan.
Bij wasmachines die aan de onderzijde ventilatieopeningen hebben, moet erop worden
gelet dat deze niet worden versperd door vloerkleden of andere obstakels.
Zorg ervoor dat de zakken van alle te wassen kledingstukken leeg zijn.
- Harde, scherpe voorwerpen zoals muntstukken, veiligheidsspelden, spijkers, schroeven
of stenen kunnen ernstige schade aan het apparaat veroorzaken.
Was geen kleding met grote gespen, knopen of andere zware metalen versieringen.
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij rEiniGinG
Het apparaat niet reinigen door het rechtstreeks met water af te spuiten.
Gebruik geen benzeen, thinner of alcohol voor reiniging van het apparaat.
- Dit kan leiden tot verkleuring, vervorming, schade, een elektrische schok of brand.
- Dit kan leiden tot verkleuring, vervorming, schade, een elektrische schok of brand.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 11 2012-4-16 13:09:5912_ inhoud
inhoud
INSTAllATIE VAN UW WASmACHINE
13
13 De onderdelen controleren
14 Installatievereisten
14 Elektrische toevoer en aarding
14 Watertoevoer
15 Afvoer
15 Ondergrond
15 Omgevingstemperatuur
15 Installatie in een nis of kast
15 Uw wasmachine installeren
DE WAS DOEN
21
21 Voor het eerst wassen
21 Basisaanwijzingen
22 Het bedieningspaneel gebruiken
25 Kinderslot
25 Geluid uit
25 Uitgesteld einde
26 Mijn programma
26 Kleding wassen met behulp van de
programmakeuzeknop
27 Kleding handmatig wassen
27 Wasvoorschriften
28 Informatie over wasmiddelen en toevoegingen
28 Over het te gebruiken wasmiddel
29 Wasmiddellade
29 Vloeibaar wasmiddel (geselecteerde modellen)
REINIGING EN ONDERHOUD VAN UW
WASmACHINE
30
30 Eco trommelreiniging
31 De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een
noodgeval
32 De wasmiddellade en de uitsparing reinigen
33 Het vuilfilter reinigen
33 De buitenkant reinigen
34 Het filter van de waterslang reinigen
34 Een bevroren wasmachine repareren
34 De wasmachine opslaan
pROblEmEN OplOSSEN EN
fOUTCODES
35
35 Controleer deze punten bij problemen met uw
wasmachine
36 Foutcodes
pROGRAmmAOVERZICHT
37
37 Programmaoverzicht
AppENDIx
38
38 Wasvoorschriften
38 Zorg voor het milieu
38 Verklaring van conformiteit
39 Overzicht huishoudelijke wasmachines
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 12 2012-4-16 13:09:59installatie van uw wasmachine _13
01 Installat eI
installatie van uw wasmachine
Zorg ervoor dat de installateur deze instructies nauwkeurig opvolgt, zodat uw
nieuwe wasmachine correct werkt en u geen risico loopt op letsel bij het doen van
de was.
dE ondErdElEn controlErEn
Pak uw wasmachine zorgvuldig uit en kijk goed of u alle onderstaande onderdelen hebt ontvangen. Neem
contact op met het servicecentrum van Samsung of de leverancier wanneer uw wasmachine is beschadigd
tijdens het vervoer of wanneer er onderdelen ontbreken.
steeksleutel doppen
voor de
boutgaten
Koudwatertoevoerslang
Warmwatertoevoerslang
(geselecteerde
model)
slanggeleider dopbevestiging
vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje
(geselecteerd
model)
Watertoevoerslang
* doppen voor de boutgaten : Het aantal boutgaten dopjes hangt af van het model (3 ~ 5 dopjes).
Afvoerslang
vuilfilter
Afvoer voor
noodgevallen
filterklep
Wasmiddellade
Bedieningspaneel
deur
verstelbare poten
trommel
vergrendeling Werkoppervlak
stekker
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 13 2012-4-16 13:10:0314_ installatie van uw wasmachine
installatie van uw wasmachine
instAllAtiEvErEistEn
Elektrische toevoer en aarding
Om onnodig risico op brand, elektrische schokken of persoonlijk letsel te voorkomen, moet alle
bedrading en aarding uitgevoerd worden in overeenstemming met de laatste herziening van
de regels in de National Electrical Code ANSI/FNPA, No. 70. Neem tevens plaatselijke codes
en regelgeving in acht. Het is de verantwoordelijkheid van de eigenaar van het apparaat om te
zorgen voor afdoende elektrisch onderhoud aan het apparaat.
Gebruik nooit een verlengsnoer.
Gebruik alleen het snoer dat bij uw wasmachine geleverd werd.
Zorg er bij de installatie voor dat de stroomtoevoer aan de volgende punten voldoet:
• AC 220-240V / 50Hz, zekering of installatieautomaat
• Een eigen groep voor alleen uw wasmachine
Uw wasmachine moet correct geaard zijn. Als de wasmachine niet goed werkt of uitvalt, wordt
met aarding de kans op een elektrische schok verminderd doordat de elektrische stroom weg
kan vloeien.
De wasmachine heeft een snoer met een geaarde stekker voor gebruik in een correct
aangesloten en geaard stopcontact.
Sluit de aardedraad nooit aan op plastic buizen, gasleidingen of buizen voor warm water.
Het onjuist aansluiten van de aardgeleider kan een elektrische schok tot gevolg hebben.
Raadpleeg een bevoegde elektricien of onderhoudstechnicus wanneer u niet zeker weet of de
wasmachine goed geaard is. Breng geen aanpassingen aan in de stekker van de wasmachine.
Indien de stekker niet in het stopcontact past, dient u een correct stopcontact te laten installeren
door een bevoegd elektricien.
Watertoevoer
De wasmachine wordt goed gevuld wanneer de waterdruk tussen de 0,5 en 8 Bar ligt. Een
waterdruk onder de 0,5 Bar kan leiden tot het onjuist functioneren van de waterkraan waardoor
deze niet helemaal gesloten kan worden. Het kan ook tot gevolg hebben dat de wasmachine
er langer over doet om gevuld te worden dan toegestaan waardoor de machine uitgeschakeld
wordt. (De wasmachine heeft een limiet op de vultijd om overstromingen te voorkomen wanneer
er binnenin een slang los raakt.)
De kraan moet binnen 120 cm van de achterkant van uw wasmachine zitten om te zorgen dat
de bijgeleverde toevoerslangen de wasmachine kunnen bereiken.
Veel onderdelenwinkels verkopen toevoerslangen van lengtes tot 305 cm.
U kunt het risico van lekkage en waterschade verminderen door:
• De kranen makkelijk toegankelijk te maken.
• De kraan dicht te doen wanneer de wasmachine niet gebruikt wordt.
• Regelmatig te controleren op lekkage bij de aansluitingen van de toevoerslang.
Controleer de kraan en buizen op lekken voordat u de wasmachine voor het eerst gebruikt.
WAArscHUWinG
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 14 2012-4-16 13:10:03installatie van uw wasmachine _15
01 Installat eI
Afvoer
Samsung raadt het gebruik van een 65cm hoge verticale afvoerbuis aan. De afvoerslang moet
in de slanggeleider in de afvoerbuis worden aangesloten. De afvoerbuis moet breed genoeg zijn,
zodat de afvoerslang er goed in past. De afvoerslang is in de fabriek bevestigd.
ondergrond
Voor het beste resultaat moet de wasmachine op een stevig geconstrueerde vloer geplaatst
worden. Houten vloeren moeten verstevigd worden om trilling beperkt te houden en
onevenwichtige ladingen tegen te gaan. Vloerbedekking en zachte tegelvloeren dragen bij aan
de trilling en het bewegen van de wasmachine tijdens het centrifugeren.
Plaats de wasmachine nooit op een verhoging of onstevige ondergrond.
omgevingstemperatuur
Plaats de wasmachine niet op plekken waar het water kan bevriezen.Uw wasmachine bevat altijd
wat water in de toevoerkraan, pomp en slangen. IJs in de leidingen kan schade veroorzaken aan
de drijfriemen, de pomp of andere onderdelen.
installatie in een nis of kast
Voor veilig en correct gebruik heeft de wasmachine minimaal de volgende ruimte nodig:
Zijkanten – 25 mm Achterkant – 50 mm
Bovenkant – 25 mm Voorkant: 465 mm
Wanneer de wasmachine samen met een droger wordt geïnstalleerd, is aan de voorkant een
ruimte nodig van minimaal 465 mm voor ventilatie. De wasmachine alleen heeft geen specifieke
ventilatieruimte nodig.
UW WAsMAcHinE instAllErEn
STAp 1
Een plaats uitzoeken
Let voor installatie van de wasmachine op de volgende punten:
• Zorg voor een harde vlakke ondergrond zonder vloerbedekking of andere
ventilatiebelemmeringen
• Vermijd direct zonlicht
• Zorg voor voldoende ventilatie
• Het mag er niet vriezen (onder 0 ˚C)
• Vermijd hittebronnen zoals olie of gas
• Zorg voor genoeg ruimte, zodat de wasmachine niet op zijn eigen snoer staat
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 15 2012-4-16 13:10:0316_ installatie van uw wasmachine
STAp 2
de transportbouten verwijderen
Verwijder voordat u de wasmachine installeert de vijf transportbouten uit de achterzijde van het
apparaat.
1. Draai alle bouten los met de bijgeleverde steeksleutel.
2. Houd de bout met de sleutel vast en trek deze uit het gat.
Doe dit met elke bout.
3. Bedek de gaten met de meegeleverde plastic doppen.
4. Berg de transportbouten veilig op voor wanneer u de wasmachine in de toekomst moet
vervoeren.
Verpakkingsmateriaal kan gevaarlijk zijn voor kinderen. Houd al het verpakkingsmateriaal
(plastic zakken, piepschuim, enzovoort) buiten bereik van kinderen.
Steek het onderdeel om het deksel vast
te zetten (één van de toebehoren in de
kunststof verpakking) in de uitsparing
aan de achterzijde van de wasmachine,
nadat u het elektriciteitssnoer er uit hebt
genomen
installatie van uw wasmachine
WAArscHUWinG
optie
optie
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 16 2012-4-16 13:10:05installatie van uw wasmachine _17
01 Installat eI
STAp 3
de stelpoten aanpassen
Zorg bij het plaatsen van uw wasmachine dat de stekker en de watertoevoer en -afvoer
makkelijk te bereiken zijn.
1. Schuif de wasmachine op zijn plek.
2. Zet de wasmachine
waterpas door de poten
handmatig naar binnen of
naar buiten te draaien.
3. Wanneer de wasmachine waterpas staat, draait u de moer
vast met de bijgeleverde sleutel.
STAp 4
de watertoevoer en -afvoer aansluiten
De watertoevoerslang aansluiten
1. Sluit de L-vormige fitting van de toevoerslang
voor koud water aan op het invoerpunt voor
koud water aan de achterzijde van de machine.
Draai deze met de hand vast.
De watertoevoerslang moet met het
ene uiteinde worden aangesloten op de
wasmachine en met het andere uiteinde op de
waterkraan. Rek de slang niet uit. Als de slang
te kort is, kunt u een langere hogedrukslang
gebruiken.
2. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de toevoerslang
voor koud water aan op de koudwaterkraan
en draai deze met de hand vast. Indien nodig
kunt u de hoek van de slang aan de kant van
de wasmachine veranderen door de fitting los
te draaien, de slang te draaien en de fitting
vervolgens weer vast te draaien.
voor geselecteerde modellen met een extra warm waterinname:
1. Sluit de L-vormige fitting van de toevoerslang voor warm water aan op het invoerpunt voor
warm water aan de achterzijde van de machine. Draai deze met de hand vast.
2. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de toevoerslang voor warm water aan op de warmwaterkraan
en draai deze met de hand vast.
3. Gebruik een Y-stuk als je uitsluitend koud water wilt gebruiken.
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 17 2012-4-16 13:10:0718_ installatie van uw wasmachine
installatie van uw wasmachine
Aansluiten van de watertoevoerslang (geselecteerde modellen)
1. Verwijder de adapter van de watertoevoerslang.
2. Gebruik eerst een '+' type schroevendraaier om de vier
schroeven op de adapter los te draaien. Neem vervolgens
de adapter en draai deel (2) in de richting van de pijl totdat
er een kloof van 5 mm ontstaat.
3. Sluit de adapter aan op de waterkraan door het stevig
vastdraaien van de schroeven, terwijl u de adapter omhoog
tilt.
Draai deel (2) in de richting van de pijl en verbind (1) en (2).
4. Sluit de watertoevoerslang aan op de adapter.
Als u onderdeel (3) loslaat, wordt de slang
automatisch verbonden met de adapter met een
hoorbaar 'klik' geluid.
Nadat u de watertoevoerslang met de adapter
heeft verbonden, zorgt u ervoor dat het goed
vastzit door benedenwaarts te trekken aan de
watertoevoerslang.
5. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de watertoevoerslang aan op
de water inlaatklep aan de achterkant op de wasmachine.
Schroef de slang helemaal tot het einde met de klok mee.
Adapter
Watertoevoerslang
1
2
5 mm
3
1
2
Watertap
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 18 2012-4-16 13:10:10installatie van uw wasmachine _19
01 Installat eI
6. Zet de watervoorziening aan en zorg ervoor dat er geen
water lekt van het waterklep, kraan of adapter. In geval van
waterlek, herhaalt u de voorafgaande stappen.
Gebruik uw wasmachine niet in het geval van een
waterlek. Dit kan een elektrische schok of letsel
veroorzaken.
• Als de kraan voorzien is van schroefdraad, sluit u de
watertoevoerslang aan zoals aangegeven op de afbeelding.
Gebruik een standaard type kraan voor de watertoevoer. Als u een vierkante kraan hebt,
of als uw kraan te groot is, verwijdert u de scheidring voordat u de kraan aansluit op de
adapter.
De Aqua Hose aansluiten (geselecteerde modellen)
De Aqua Hose is ontworpen om optimale bescherming tegen
lekkages te bieden.Het wordt aan de watertoevoerslang
bevestigd en sluit automatisch de watertoevoer af als de slang
beschadigd raakt. Tevens wordt een waarschuwingsindicator
weergegeven.
• Sluit de watertoevoerslang aan zoals aangegeven op de
afbeelding.
✗
✗ WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 19 2012-4-16 13:10:1120_ installatie van uw wasmachine
De afvoerslang aansluiten
Het uiteinde van de afvoerslang kan op drie manieren worden geplaatst:
1. Over de rand van de gootsteen: de afvoerslang moet op een hoogte van 60 tot 90 cm
worden geplaatst. Gebruik de meegeleverde plastic slanggeleider om het uiteinde gebogen
te houden. Bevestig de geleider met een haak aan de muur of met een touwtje aan de kraan
zodat deze op zijn plaats blijft.
2. In een aftakking van de gootsteenafvoer: de aftakking moet hoger zijn dan de zwanenhals
van de gootsteen, zodat het uiteinde van de slang zich ten minste 60 cm boven de grond
bevindt.
3. In een afvoerbuis: we raden het gebruik van een 65 cm hoge verticale buis aan. De buis
mag niet korter dan 60 cm en niet langer dan 90 cm zijn.
Eisen aan de vaste afvoerpijp:
• Minimale diameter 5 cm
• Minimale afvoercapaciteit 60 liter per minuut
STAp 5
de wasmachine aansluiten op de elektriciteit
Steek het snoer in een stopcontact van 220 V-240V/50Hz beschermd door een zekering of
installatieautomaat. (Kijk op pagina 14 voor meer informatie over de vereisten voor elektriciteit en
aarding.)
STAp 6
Kalibratiemodus
De Samsung-wasmachine detecteert automatisch het gewicht van de was. Voor een nog
nauwkeurigere gewichtsbepaling, voert u na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit. Voer de
onderstaand stappen uit om de kalibratiemodus uit te voeren.
1. Verwijder wasgoed of andere inhoud uit de machine en schakel de machine uit.
2. Druk de knoppen Temperatuur en Uitgesteld einde tegelijkertijd in en druk tevens op de
knop Aan/Uit. Vervolgens wordt de machine ingeschakeld.
3. Druk op de knop Start om “Kalibratiemodus” te activeren.
4. De wastrommel draait ongeveer 3 minuten lang rechtsom en linksom.
5. Als “Kalibratiemodus” is voltooid, wordt “End (En)” weergegeven op het display en wordt de
machine automatisch uitgeschakeld. De wasmachine is nu gereed voor gebruik.
installatie van uw wasmachine
Afvoerslang
slanggeleider
60 ~ 90 cm
60 ~ 90 cm
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 20 2012-4-16 13:10:13de was doen _21
02 De was Doen
de was doen
Het moeilijkste van de was doen met uw nieuwe wasmachine van Samsung is
bepalen welke was u het eerste wilt doen.
voor HEt EErst WAssEn
Laat voordat u kleding gaat wassen de wasmachine eenmaal een volledig programma draaien
zonder inhoud (dus zonder wasgoed).
1. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
2. Stop wat wasmiddel in het vakje in de wasmiddellade
3. Draai de watertoevoer naar de wasmachine open.
4. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
Al het water dat in de machine is achtergebleven na het
proefdraaien in de fabriek wordt nu afgevoerd.
vakje : Voorwasmiddel of stijfsel.
vakje : Hoofdwasmiddel, waterverzachter, voorweekmiddel, bleek en vlekverwijderaars.
Als u vloeibaar wasmiddel wilt gebruiken, gebruikt u het vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel
(raadpleeg pagina 29 van de gebruiksaanwijzing voor het corresponderende model). Stop
geen wasmiddel in poedervorm in het vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel.
vakje : Toevoegingen, bijvoorbeeld wasverzachter (maximaal tot de onderste rand (MAX) van
A vullen).
BAsisAAnWijzinGEn
1. Doe de was in de wasmachine.
Stop niet te veel in de wasmachine. Bepaal de laadcapaciteit voor elk type wasgoed aan de
hand van het schema op pagina 28.
• Zorg dat er geen was tussen de deur komt, hierdoor kan water gaan lekken.
• Er kan na het wassen wasmiddel achterblijven in het voorste rubber van de wasmachine.
Verwijder eventuele restanten omdat deze kunnen leiden tot lekkage.
• Was geen waterbestendige stukken.
2. Doe de deur dicht tot deze dicht klikt.
3. Zet de machine aan.
4. Stop wasmiddel en toevoegingen in de wasmiddellade.
5. Kies het geschikte programma en de opties voor de was.
Het wasindicatielampje gaat aan en de geschatte tijd voor het programma verschijnt op het
display.
6. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 21 2012-4-16 13:10:1522_ de was doen
HEt BEdiEninGspAnEEl GEBrUiKEn
DIGITAAl GRAfISCH
DISplAY
Weergave van de resterende tijd voor het wasprogramma, alle
wasinformatie en foutmeldingen.
pROGRAmmAKEUZEKNOp
Kies het gewenste wasprogramma en de centrifugeersnelheid.
Kijk voor meer informatie in het gedeelte “Kleding wassen met
behulp van de programmakeuzeknop” (zie pagina 26).
Katoen - voor normaal of licht bevuilde katoenen kleding, beddengoed,
tafellinnen, ondergoed, handdoeken, overhemden, enz.
synthetisch - voor normaal of licht bevuilde blouses, overhemden, enz.
van polyester (diolen, trevira), polyamide (perlon, nylon) en dergelijke
combinaties.
jeans - voor een hoger waterniveau tijdens de hoofdwas en een keer
extra spoelen om te voorkomen dat er waspoedervlekken achterblijven
op uw kleding.
Beddengoed - Voor bedspreien, hoeslakens, dekbedovertrekken, enz.
Gebruik voor het beste resultaat slechts 1 soort beddengoed en
overschrijd de 2 kg niet.
donkere kleding - Extra spoelbeurten en verminderd centrifugeren
zorgt ervoor dat uw favoriete donkere kleding voorzichtig gewassen
worden en zorgvuldig worden gespoeld.
dagelijkse was - Gebruik voor alledaagse onderdelen zoals ondergoed
en hemden. Snelprogramma voor testinstituten.
Eco trommelreiniging - Voor het reinigen van de trommel. Hiermee
ontdoet u de trommel van vuil en bacteriën. Regelmatig gebruik (na elke
40 wasbeurten) aanbevolen. Er is geen reinigings- of bleekmiddel nodig.
Babykleding- voor wassen op hoge temperatuur en extra spoelen om
te zorgen dat er geen wasmiddelvlekken achterblijven op uw dunne
kleding.
sportkleding - Voor waterdichte of anders behandelde kleding zodat
deze er mooi uit blijft zien en fris blijft voelen.
de was doen
2 1 3 4 5 6 7 10 9 8 12 11 13
1
2
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 22 2012-4-16 13:10:17de was doen _23
02 De was Doen
Handwas - Een zeer lichte wascyclus. Net zo zacht als het wassen met
de hand.
Wol- alleen voor in de machine wasbare wol. Was niet meer dan 2,0 kg.
• Bij het wolprogramma wordt het wollen wasgoed gewassen door
middel van rustige bewegingen van de machine. Door deze rustige
bewegingen en het weekproces wordt uw wollen wasgoed optimaal
beschermd tegen krimpen en vervormen en toch heel schoon.
• Voor wol wordt een neutraal wasmiddel aanbevolen. Dit geeft betere
wasresultaten en beschermt de wollen vezels.
Afvoer - voor het wegpompen van water uit de wasmachine zonder te
centrifugeren.
centrifugeren- voor een keer extra centrifugeren om nog meer water te
verwijderen.
spoelen + centrifugeren - voor een was die alleen gespoeld hoeft
te worden, of voor het toevoegen van wasverzachter die tijdens het
spoelen moet worden toegevoegd.
SElECTIEKNOp
TEmpERATUUR
Druk meermalen op deze knop om een van de beschikbare
temperaturen te selecteren:
( (Koud: Alle indicatielampjes uit), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C , 60 ˚C en 95 ˚C).
SpOElEN
SElECTIEKNOp
Druk op deze knop om extra spoelbeurten toe te voegen. U kunt
maximaal vijf spoelbeurten instellen.
CENTRIfUGEREN
SElECTIEKNOp
Druk meermalen op de knop om een van de beschikbare
centrifugesnelheden te selecteren.
WF710 / WF712
Alle indicatielampjes uit, , 400, 800, 1200, 1400
toeren/min
“Niet centrifugeren ”: na het leegpompen wordt de was in de trommel
niet gecentrifugeerd.
“Spoelwater vasthouden(Alle indicatielampjes uit) ”: het laatste
spoelwater blijft in de machine. Voordat u de was uit de machine
kunt halen moet u altijd eerst de machine leegpompen of de was
centrifugeren.
SElECTIEKNOp
OpTIES
Druk meermalen op deze knop om een van de beschikbare wasopties te
selecteren:
(Weken) (Intensief) (Voorwas) (Weken) +
(Intensief) (Weken) + (Voorwas) (Intensief) + (Voorwas)
(Weken) + (Intensief) + (Voorwas) (uit)
“Voorwas”: Druk op deze knop om voorwas te selecteren. Voorwassen
is alleen beschikbaar bij: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed,
Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was, Babykleding, Sportkleding.
“Intensief ”: druk op deze knop wanneer de was sterk bevuild is en
intensief gewassen moet worden. Elke cyclus van het programma wordt
verlengd.
“Weken”: gebruik deze optie om vlekken beter te verwijderen door de
was te laten weken.
• De weekfunctie wordt na 13 minuten wassen uitgevoerd.
• De weekfunctie duurt 30 minuten in zes fasen. Elke fase bestaat uit
een minuut draaien en vier minuten stilstaand weken.
• De weekfunctie is alleen beschikbaar in combinatie met de volgende
programma’s: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed, Dagelijkse
was, Babykleding, Sportkleding.
5
3
4
6
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 23 2012-4-16 13:10:1924_ de was doen
GElUID UIT
SElECTIEKNOp
Het geluid tijdens het programma kan worden uitgeschakeld. Wanneer
deze functie is geselecteerd, wordt het geluid van het hele programma
uitgeschakeld.
• Wanneer het geluid is uitgeschakeld, licht de knop Geluid uit op en
wordt de indicator Geluid uit weergegeven op het bedieningspaneel.
• Wanneer het geluid weer wordt ingeschakeld, klinkt er een zoemer
en gaan de knop en de indicator Geluid uit op het bedieningspaneel
weer uit.
SElECTIEKNOp
UITGESTElD EINDE
Druk meermalen op deze knop om de beschikbare tijden voor uitstel
van de Uitgesteld einde te doorlopen (van 3 tot 19 uur, per heel uur
instelbaar).
Het display geeft aan over hoeveel uur het programma klaar is.
SElECTIEKNOp
KORT pROGRAmmA
Voor het snel wassen van licht bevuilde weefsels en minder dan 2kg
wasgoed. Dit programma neemt minimaal ongeveer 15 minuten in
beslag, maar kan variëren afhankelijk van waterdruk, hardheid van het
water, temperatuur van toegevoerd water, kamertemperatuur, type en
hoeveelheid wasgoed en ernst van de vervuiling, gebruikt wasmiddel,
onevenwichtige lading, schommelingen in de elektriciteitsvoorziening en
extra geselecteerde opties.
• Druk meermalen op deze knop om de tijd voor het wasprogramma
te kiezen: 15min 20min 30min 40min 50min 60min
Uit
Er moet minder dan 20 gram wasmiddel in poedervorm/vloeibaar
wasmiddel (bij een lading van 2 kg) worden gebruikt, anders blijft er
wasmiddel achter op de kleding.
SElECTIEKNOp
KREUKVRIJ
Druk op deze knop om de functie Kreukvrij te selecteren. Gebruik
deze optie om uw wasgoed voor te bereiden, zodat het eenvoudig kan
worden gestreken.
KNOp mIJN
pROGRAmmA
Kies uw favoriete programma, inclusief temperatuur, centrifugeren, ernst
van vervuiling, optie, enz.
SElECTIEKNOp
START/pAUSE
Druk op deze knop om het wasprogramma te starten of te pauzeren.
AAN/UIT-KNOp
Druk eenmaal op deze knop om de wasmachine in te schakelen. Druk
nogmaals op de knop om de wasmachine uit te schakelen.
Als de wasmachine langer dan 10 minuten ingeschakeld is zonder
dat er op knoppen wordt gedrukt, wordt de machine automatisch
uitgeschakeld.
de was doen
10
WAArscHUWinG
11
9
7
8
12
13
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 24 2012-4-16 13:10:20de was doen _25
02 De was Doen
Kinderslot
Met het kinderslot kunt u de knoppen vergrendelen zodat het gekozen wasprogramma niet kan
worden gewijzigd.
In- en uitschakelen
Wanneer u het kinderslot wilt in- of uitschakelen, drukt u
tegelijkertijd gedurende tenminste 3 seconden op de knoppen
Temperatuur en Spoelen. Het indicatielampje “Kinderslot “
licht op wanneer het kinderslot is ingeschakeld.
Wanneer het kinderslot is ingeschakeld, werkt alleen de
Aan/Uit-knop. Het kinderslot blijft ingeschakeld, zelfs
wanneer de machine uit en aan is gezet of wanneer het
snoer wordt losgekoppeld.
Geluid uit
U kunt het geluid tijdens alle programma’s uitschakelen. Wanneer deze functie is geselecteerd,
wordt het geluid van het hele programma uitgeschakeld. Zelfs wanneer de machine herhaaldelijk
uit en aan wordt gezet, blijft het geluid uit.
In- en uitschakelen
Wanneer u het geluid wilt in- of uitschakelen drukt u op de knop Geluid uit. De indicator “Geluid
uit ” op het bedieningspaneel en de knop Geluid uit gaan branden wanneer deze functie is
geactiveerd.
Uitgesteld einde
U kunt de wasmachine zo instellen dat de was automatisch op een later tijdstip klaar is. De
startvertraging is per heel uur instelbaar van 3 tot 19 uur. Het display geeft aan over hoeveel uur
het programma klaar is.
1. Stel de wasmachine handmatig of automatisch in op het gewenste wasprogramma.
2. Druk meermalen op de knop Uitgesteld einde om de vertragingstijd in te stellen.
3. Druk op de knop Start/pause. Het indicatielampje “Uitgesteld einde “ gaat branden en
de klok begint af te tellen tot de ingestelde tijd.
4. Om de functie Uitgesteld einde te annuleren drukt u op de Aan/Uit-knop en zet u de
wasmachine weer aan.
3 sEc.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 25 2012-4-16 13:10:2326_ de was doen
de was doen
Mijn programma
Hiermee kunt u met één druk op de knop uw eigen wasprogramma instellen (temperatuur,
centrifugeren, ernst van vervuiling, enz.).
Door op de knop mijn programma te drukken, laadt en gebruikt u de opgeslagen opties onder
Mijn programma. Het indicatielampje "Mijn programma" gaat branden om aan te geven dat deze
functie is ingeschakeld. Tevens knipperen de gekozen programma- en optielampjes.
U kunt als volgt alle opties voor Mijn programma instellen.
1. Schakel de watertoevoer in.
2. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
3. Selecteer het programma met de programmakeuzeknop.
4. Nadat u het programma hebt geselecteerd, stelt u de verschillende opties in.
Raadpleeg het "Programmaoverzicht" op pagina 37 voor beschikbare opties bij elk
programma.
5. U kunt vervolgens het geselecteerde programma en de bijbehorende opties opslaan door
de knop mijn programma langer dan 3 seconden ingedrukt te houden in de modus Mijn
programma. Het programma en de opties die u hebt geselecteerd, worden de volgende keer
dat u de functie Mijn programma kiest, opnieuw weergegeven.
U kunt de instellingen voor Mijn programma wijzigen door het bovenstaande proces te
herhalen. De meest recente instellingen worden weergegeven wanneer u opnieuw de
functie Mijn programma selecteert.
Als u op Mijn programma drukt en deze knop binnen 3 seconden weer loslaat, worden
het eerder opgeslagen programma met bijbehorende opties weergegeven. Als u Mijn
programma langer dan 3 seconden ingedrukt houdt, wordt het momenteel ingestelde
programma met bijbehorende opties opgeslagen en knippert de LED gedurende 3
seconden.
Kleding wassen met behulp van de programmakeuzeknop
Met het automatische controlesysteem “Fuzzy Control” van Samsung maakt uw nieuwe
wasmachine wassen heel eenvoudig. Wanneer u een wasprogramma selecteert, stelt de
machine automatisch de juiste temperatuur, wastijd en snelheid in.
1. Draai de kraan open.
2. Druk op de Aan/uit-knop van de wasmachine.
3. Open de deur.
4. Plaats de te wassen voorwerpen één voor één losjes in de trommel. Doe de trommel niet te vol.
5. Sluit de deur.
6. Stop wasmiddel en indien gewenst wasverzachter of voorwasmiddel in de juiste vakjes.
Voorwas is alleen beschikbaar in combinatie met de programma’s Katoen, Synthetisch,
Jeans, Beddengoed, Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was, Babykleding en Sportkleding.
Voorwassen is alleen nodig als de kleding erg vuil is.
7. Gebruik de programmakeuzeknop om het geschikte programma voor de was te
kiezen: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed, Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was,
Eco trommelreiniging, Babykleding, Sportkleding, Handwas, Wol. De bijbehorende
indicatielampjes op het bedieningspaneel gaan aan.
8. Nu kunt u door op de juiste knoppen te drukken de wastemperatuur, het aantal keer
spoelen, de centrifugesnelheid en de starttijd instellen.
9. Druk op de knop Start/pause om het wasprogramma te beginnen. Het
procesindicatielampje gaat branden en de resterende tijd voor het programma wordt
weergegeven in het display.
pauzeren
Binnen 5 minuten na het beginnen van een was, kan er was toegevoegd of uit de trommel
gehaald worden.
1. Druk op de knop Start/pause om de deur te ontgrendelen.
De deur kan niet geopend worden wanneer het water te HEET is of wanneer het
waterniveau te HOOG is.
2. Druk na het sluiten van de deur weer op Start/pause om het wassen voort te zetten.
Als het programma is afgelopen:
Als het gehele wasprogramma is afgelopen, wordt de wasmachine automatisch uitgeschakeld.
1. Open de deur.
2. Haal het wasgoed uit de trommel.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 26 2012-4-16 13:10:23de was doen _27
02 De was Doen
Kleding handmatig wassen
U kunt kleding handmatig wassen zonder een programma te kiezen.
1. Schakel de watertoevoer in.
2. Druk op de Aan/uit-knop van de wasmachine.
3. Open de deur.
4. Plaats de te wassen voorwerpen één voor één losjes in de trommel. Doe de trommel niet te
vol.
5. Sluit de deur.
6. Stop wasmiddel en indien gewenst wasverzachter of voorwasmiddel in de juiste vakjes.
7. Druk op de knop Temperatuur om de gewenste temperatuur te selecteren. ( (Koud: Alle
indicatielampjes uit), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C, 60 ˚C, 95 ˚C)
8. Druk op de knop Spoelen om het gewenste aantal spoelbeurten te selecteren.
U kunt maximaal vijf spoelbeurten instellen.
Met elke spoelbeurt neemt de wastijd toe.
9. Druk op de knop Toerental centrifugeren om de centrifugesnelheid te selecteren.
( : Niet centrifugeren, Alle indicatielampjes uit : Spoelwater vasthouden)
10. Druk meermalen op de knop Uitgesteld einde om de beschikbare tijden voor
startvertraging te doorlopen (van 3 tot 19 uur, per heel uur instelbaar). Het display geeft aan
over hoeveel uur het programma klaar is.
11. Na een druk op de knop Start/pause begint het wasprogramma.
WAsvoorscHriftEn
Volg deze simpele aanwijzingen voor de schoonste en efficiëntste was.
Kijk voor het wassen altijd op het waslabel van uw kleding.
sorteer en was uw wasgoed aan de hand van de volgende criteria:
• Waslabel: sorteer het wasgoed in katoen, gemengde weefsels, synthetisch, zijde, wol en
viscose (lingerie).
• Kleur: scheid witte was van bonte was. Was nieuwe gekleurde kledingstukken apart.
• Formaat: e wasprestaties worden verbeterd als u wasgoed van verschillend formaat samen
wast.
• Kwetsbaarheid: was fijn wasgoed apart, zoals zuiver scheerwol, vitrages en zijde, met
het wasprogramma Fijne was. Controleer de waslabels in elk kledingstuk of raadpleeg de
wasvoorschriften in de appendix.
zakken leeghalen
Haal voor elke was de zakken van alle kledingstukken leeg. Kleine, ongewoon gevormde,
harde voorwerpen zoals munten, messen, spelden en paperclips kunnen uw wasmachine
beschadigen. Was geen kleding met grote gespen, knopen of andere zware metalen voorwerpen
in de wasmachine.
Kleding met metalen voorwerpen kan uw kleding en de trommel beschadigen. Keer kleding met
knopen en borduursel voor het wassen binnenstebuiten. Wanneer ritsen van broeken of jassen
tijdens het wassen open staan, kan de trommel beschadigen. Ritsen moeten voor het wassen
dicht zijn en met een touwtje vastgemaakt worden.
Kleding met lange koorden kan met andere kleding in de knoop raken en deze beschadigen.
Maak de koorden vast voor het wassen.
Katoen voorwassen
Uw nieuwe wasmachine zorgt samen met de hedendaagse wasmiddelen voor perfecte
wasresultaten waardoor minder energie, tijd, water en wasmiddel nodig zijn. Als uw katoenen
kleding echter erg vuil is, kunt u een voorwas doen met een reinigingsmiddel op enzymenbasis.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 27 2012-4-16 13:10:2328_ de was doen
de laadcapaciteit bepalen
Als u de wasmachine te vol stopt, wordt de was mogelijk niet goed schoon. Aan de hand
van het schema hieronder kunt u de laadcapaciteit bepalen voor het type wasgoed dat u wilt
wassen.
materiaal laadcapaciteit
Model WF710 / WF712
Katoen
- normaal/licht bevuild
- zwaar bevuild
7,0 kg
synthetisch 2,5 kg
jeans 3,0 kg
Beddengoed 2,0 kg
sportkleding 2,5 kg
Wol 2,0 kg
• Wanneer het wasgoed onevenwichtig is verdeeld (“UE” gaat branden in het display),
moet u het opnieuw verdelen.
Bij een onevenwichtige lading gaat het effect van centrifugeren achteruit.
• Wanneer u beddengoed of dekbedden wast, kan de wastijd langer zijn dan normaal.Het
centrifugeren kan tevens minder effectief zijn.
• De laadcapaciteit voor beddengoed of dekbedden is ten hoogste 2,0 kg.
Stop (in water wasbare) beha’s in een waszak (apart te
verkrijgen).
• De metalen onderdelen van beha’s kunnen door het materiaal
heen komen en de was beschadigen. Stop ze daarom in een fijne
waszak.
• Kleine lichte kleding zoals sokken, handschoenen, kousen en
zakdoeken kunnen rond de deur vast komen te zitten. Stop ze in
een fijne waszak.
Gebruik geen wasmiddel dat hard geworden is of is gaan klonteren. Dit kan tijdens het
spoelen achterblijven. Daardoor spoelt de wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of het kan
ervoor zorgen dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
inforMAtiE ovEr WAsMiddElEn En toEvoEGinGEn
over het te gebruiken wasmiddel
Het type wasmiddel dat u moet gebruiken is afhankelijk van het materiaal (katoen, synthetisch,
fijne was, wol), de kleur, de wastemperatuur en hoe vuil het wasgoed is. Gebruik altijd een
wasmiddel dat weinig schuimt en speciaal is ontwikkeld voor wasmachines.
Volg de aanbevelingen van de wasmiddelfabrikant op basis van het gewicht van het wasgoed,
hoe vuil het wasgoed is en de waterhardheid in uw gebied. Als u niet weet hoe hard het water in
uw gebied is, kunt u dit navragen bij uw waterbedrijf.
Gebruik geen wasmiddel dat hard geworden is of is gaan klonteren. Daardoor spoelt de
wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of het kan ervoor zorgen dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
Graag op het volgende letten bij het gebruik van het Wolprogramma.
• Gebruik een neutraal vloeibaar wasmiddel dat uitsluitend voor wol is bestemd.
• Bij gebruik van waspoeder kan dit op het wasgoed achterblijven en het weefsel (wol)
beschadigen.
de was doen
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 28 2012-4-16 13:10:24de was doen _29
02 De was Doen
Wasmiddellade
De wasmachine heeft verschillende vakjes voor wasmiddel en wasverzachters. Doe alle middelen
in het juiste vakje voor u de wasmachine start.
Maak de wasmiddellade niet open terwijl uw wasmachine draait. Anders kunt u heet water
of stoom over u heen krijgen.
1. Trek de wasmiddellade links van het bedieningspaneel open.
2. Doe de aanbevolen hoeveelheid wasmiddel in het wasmiddelvakje voordat u de
wasmachine start.
Als u vloeibaar wasmiddel wilt gebruiken, gebruikt u het
vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel (raadpleeg de sectie
"Vloeibaar wasmiddel" voor het corresponderende
model).
• Stop geen wasmiddel in poedervorm in het vakje voor
vloeibaar wasmiddel.
3. Voeg indien nodig de aanbevolen hoeveelheid
wasverzachter toe in het wasverzachtervakje . VUL HET
VAKJE niet tot boven de MAXIMALE VULLIJN ( ).
Doe GEEN extra poeder/ vloeibaar wasmiddel in het
bakje voor de wasverzachter ( ).
4. Wanneer u een voorwas doet, voegt u de aanbevolen
hoeveelheid wasmiddel toe in het voorwasvakje .
Gebruik bij het wassen van grote stukken wasgoed GEEN
van de volgende soorten wasmiddel.
• Wasmiddelen in de vorm van tabletten of capsules
• Wasmiddelen in een wasbol of netje
Verdun geconcentreerde of dikke wasverzachter met een
beetje water voordat u deze in het vakje giet. Zo voorkomt u dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
Zorg ervoor dat, nadat u wasverzachter in het wasverzachterbakje heeft gedaan, de
wasverzachter bij het sluiten van het wasmiddelbakje niet overstroomt.
vloeibaar wasmiddel (geselecteerde modellen)
Om vloeibaar wasmiddel te gebruiken, plaatst u het vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje in het hoofdwasgedeelte van de wasmiddellade
en giet vloeibaar wasmiddel in het vloeibaar wasmiddelbakje.
• Niet boven de MAX-lijn vullen.
• Bij gebruik van poederwasmiddel, haalt u het bakje
voor vloeibare wasmiddelen uit de wasmiddellade.
Poederwasmiddel zal niet terechtkomen in het vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje.
• Na een wasbeurt, kan wat vloeistof in de wasmiddellade
achterblijven.
MAX
vakje voor
vloeibaar
wasmiddel
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 29 2012-4-16 13:10:2630_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
Door de wasmachine schoon te houden levert deze betere prestaties, voorkomt u
onnodige reparaties en wordt de levensduur verlengd.
Eco troMMElrEiniGinG
Dit is een automatisch reinigingsprogramma waarmee de schimmelvorming die
mogelijk in de wasmachine is ontstaan, wordt verwijderd.
1. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
2. Draai de programmakeuzeknop naar het programma Eco
trommelreiniging.
• U kunt alleen de vertragingsfunctie Uitgesteld einde
gebruiken.
• De watertemperatuur voor het programma Eco
trommelreiniging is ingesteld op 70 ˚C.
Vanwege de functies van de wasmachine, staat de
watertemperatuur ingesteld op 70 ˚C tijdens de cyclus Eco trommelreiniging, maar het
display op het bedieningspaneel kan slechts 60 ˚C weergeven.
U kunt de temperatuur niet wijzigen.
• Het zal automatisch instellen op midden waterpeil katoenprogramma 30 ˚C wanneer er
kleding in wordt gelegd.
3. Gebruik de juiste hoeveelheid schoonmaakmiddel in
het wasmiddelvakje en sluit het vakje (wanneer u de
trommel reinigt met een reinigingsmiddel).
• Gebruik het aanbevolen reinigingsmiddel om de trommel
te reinigen.
• Er zijn waspoeders en vloeibare wasmiddelen. Het
vloeibare reinigingsmiddel werkt alleen in het vakje voor
vloeibaar wasmiddel (optie).
4. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
• Als u op de knop Start/pause drukt, wordt het programma Eco trommelreiniging gestart.
• Als u het programma Eco trommelreiniging gebruikt, kunt u de trommel reinigen zonder een
reinigingsmiddel.
• Gebruik het programma Eco trommelreiniging nooit wanneer er zich wasgoed in de
wasmachine bevindt. Dit kan leiden tot schade aan het weefsel of problemen met de
wasmachine.
• Gebruik nooit normaal wasmiddel tijdens het programma Eco trommelreiniging.
• Gebruik voor het reinigen van de trommel slechts 1/10 van de hoeveelheid die door
de fabrikant van het schoonmaakmiddel wordt aanbevolen.
• Aangezien chloorhoudende bleekmiddelen verkleuring van het product kunnen veroorzaken,
kunt u het beste alleen zuurstofhoudende bleekmiddelen gebruiken.
• Reinigingsmiddelen in poedervorm: Gebruik alleen [bleekmiddelen in poedervorm] of een
[speciaal reinigingsmiddel voor het reinigen van de trommel].
• Vloeibare reinigingsmiddelen: Gebruik alleen [bleekmiddelen in vloeibare vorm] of een
[speciaal reinigingsmiddel voor het reinigen van de trommel].
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 30 2012-4-16 13:10:28reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine _31
03 Reiniging en ondeRhoud
de automatische alarmfunctie voor Eco trommelreiniging
• Als de “Trommel reinigen” indicator op het display branden
zijn na een wasbeurt, betekent dit dat kuip (trommel)
reiniging vereist is. In dat geval haalt u het wasgoed uit de
machine, schakelt u het apparaat in en reinigt u de trommel
door het programma Eco trommelreiniging uit te voeren.
• Als u niet het programma Trommel reinigen uitvoert,
staan de “Trommel reinigen” indicator op het display
uit. Na twee wasbeurten gaat echter zowel het
indicatielampje 'Eco trommelreiniging' als het lampje op de
programmakeuzeknop weer branden. Dit leidt echter niet
tot problemen met het product.
• Hoewel de automatische alarmlampjes voor het
programma Eco trommelreiniging doorgaans één keer per
maand zullen branden, is de frequentie afhankelijk van het aantal keer dat de wasmachine
wordt gebruikt.
• Als het alarm afgaat, reinigt u tevens het vuilfilter (raadpleeg de sectie "Het vuilfilter
reinigen" op pagina 33). Anders gaat mogelijk de bellenfunctie minder goed werken.
dE WAsMAcHinE lAtEn lEEGlopEn in EEn noodGEvAl
1. Haal de stekker van de wasmachine uit het stopcontact.
2. Open de filterklep met behulp van een muntstuk of een
sleutel.
3. Draai de dop van de afvoer voor noodgevallen linksom los.
4. Verwijder het dopje waarmee de afvoer voor noodgevallen
is afgesloten.
5. Laat het water in een bak lopen.
Mogelijk is er meer water achtergebleven dan u had
verwacht. Houd een grotere bak bij de hand.
6. Plaats het dopje terug op de afvoer voor noodgevallen en
maak deze vast aan de bevestigingshaak.
7. Doe de filterklep weer dicht.
filterklep
Afvoer voor
noodgevallen
dop van
afvoer voor
noodgevallen
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 31 2012-4-16 13:10:3032_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
dE WAsMiddEllAdE En dE UitspArinG rEiniGEn
1. Druk de vergrendeling binnen in de
wasmiddellade in en trek deze naar buiten.
2. Haal de verdeler voor vloeibare wasmiddelen
uit de wasmiddellade.
3. Was alle onderdelen onder stromend water.
4. Reinig de uitsparing met een oude tandenborstel.
5. Plaats de verdeler voor vloeibare wasmiddelen terug in de
lade door deze stevig vast te drukken.
6. Duw de lade terug op zijn plaats.
7. Laat de wasmachine een keer spoelen met een lege
trommel om eventuele wasmiddelresten te verwijderen.
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
vergrendeling
vloeibaar wasmiddelbakje
(geselecteerd model)
verdeler voor vloeibare
wasmiddelen
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 32 2012-4-16 13:10:32reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine _33
03 Reiniging en ondeRhoud
HEt vUilfiltEr rEiniGEn
We raden aan om het vuilfilter 5 à 6 keer per jaar te reinigen, of wanneer de foutmelding “5E” wordt
weergegeven. (Lees ook “De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een noodgeval” op de vorige pagina.)
Trek altijd, voordat u het afvoerfilter schoonmaakt, de stekker uit het stopcontact.
1. Verwijder eerst het achtergebleven water ( raadpleeg
daarvoor “De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een
noodgeval” op bladzijde 31.)
Als u de filter eruit neemt zonder het achtergebleven
water weg te laten lopen, kan dit eruit druppelen.
2. Open de afdekplaat van het filter met behulp van een
muntstuk of een sleutel.
3. Draai het deksel van de afvoer voor noodgevallen linksom
los en laat al het water weglopen.
4. Draai de dop van het vuilfilter los.
5. Spoel vuil en ander materiaal van het filter. Zorg dat de
propeller van de afvoerpomp achter het filter niet wordt
geblokkeerd.
6. Plaats de dop van het filter terug.
7. Doe de filterklep weer dicht.
Open het deksel van de gruisfilter niet terwijl de wasmachine aan
staat omdat het water er dan uit kan stromen.
• Zorg ervoor dat het filterdeksel wordt teruggeplaatst nadat u de filter schoongemaakt hebt. Als het
filter niet aanwezig is functioneert de wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of lekt er water uit.
• Na het schoonmaken moet de filter weer volledig in elkaar worden gezet.
dE BUitEnKAnt rEiniGEn
1. U kunt de oppervlakken van de wasmachine, ook het bedieningspaneel, afnemen met een
zachte doek en niet-schurende reinigingsmiddelen voor huishoudelijk gebruik.
2. Droog de oppervlakken af met een zachte doek.
3. Giet geen water op de wasmachine.
dop van
vuilfilter
voorzicHtiG
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 33 2012-4-16 13:10:3334_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
HEt filtEr vAn dE WAtErslAnG rEiniGEn
U dient het filter van de waterslang minimaal eens per jaar te reinigen, of wanneer de foutmelding “4E”
wordt weergegeven.
1. Draai de watertoevoer naar de wasmachine dicht.
2. Schroef de slang aan de achterkant van de wasmachine los. Houd een doekje op de slang
om te voorkomen dat er door de druk water uit de slang stroomt.
3. Trek het filter voorzichtig met een tangetje uit het uiteinde van de slang en spoel het onder de
kraan schoon. Reinig ook de binnen- en buitenkant van het draadverbindingsstuk.
4. Duw het filter terug op zijn plaats.
5. Schroef de slang weer vast aan de wasmachine.
6. Draai de kraan open en controleer of de verbindingen waterdicht zijn.
EEn BEvrorEn WAsMAcHinE rEpArErEn
Als de temperatuur zakt tot onder het vriespunt en uw wasmachine bevriest, doet u het volgende:
1. Haal de stekker van de wasmachine uit het stopcontact.
2. Giet warm water over de kraan om de toevoerslang los te maken.
3. Verwijder de watertoevoerslang en laat deze in warm water weken.
4. Giet warm water in de wastrommel en laat dit 10 minuten staan.
5. Sluit de watertoevoerslang weer aan op de kraan en controleer of de watertoevoer en afvoer
normaal functioneren.
dE WAsMAcHinE opslAAn
Als u uw wasmachine langere tijd moet opslaan, is het beter om deze leeg te laten lopen en los te
koppelen van de elektriciteit. Wasmachines kunnen beschadigen wanneer er water in de slangen en interne
onderdelen blijft staan tijdens de opslag.
1. Selecteer het Kort programma 15 min en doe bleekmiddel in het bleekmiddelvakje. Laat uw
wasmachine het programma leeg uitvoeren.
2. Draai de kranen dicht en koppel de toevoerslangen los.
3. Koppel de wasmachine los van het stopcontact en laat de deur van de wasmachine open
staan zodat de trommel kan ventileren.
Laat voordat u de wasmachine weer in gebruik neemt het achtergebleven water ontdooien
wanneer de wasmachine is opgeslagen op een plek met vorst.
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 34 2012-4-16 13:10:33problemen oplossen en foutcodes _35
04 Problemen oPlossen
problemen oplossen en
foutcodes
controlEEr dEzE pUntEn Bij proBlEMEn MEt UW
WAsMAcHinE
pROblEEm OplOSSING
de machine wil niet starten • Controleer of de stekker in het stopcontact zit.
• Controleer of de deur goed gesloten is.
• Controleer of de waterkraan open is.
• Druk op de knop Start/Pause.
Er is geen of niet genoeg
water
• Draai de kraan volledig open.
• Controleer of de toevoerslang niet bevroren is.
• Leg de toevoerslang recht.
• Reinig het filter in de watertoevoerslang.
na voltooiing van het
wasprogramma is
wasmiddel achtergebleven
in de wasmiddellade
• Controleer of de wasmachine met voldoende waterdruk werkt.
• Let erop dat het wasmiddel midden in de wasmiddellade wordt
gestopt.
de wasmachine schudt of
maakt te veel geluid.
• Controleer of de machine op een vlakke ondergrond staat. Als dit niet
het geval is, stelt u de poten van de wasmachine in om hem waterpas
te zetten.
• Controleer of de transportbouten zijn verwijderd.
• Controleer of de wasmachine geen contact maakt met een ander
voorwerp.
• Controleer of het wasgoed gelijkmatig verdeeld is in de trommel.
de wasmachine voert geen
water af en/of centrifugeert
niet
• Leg de afvoerslang recht. Vermijd geknikte slangen.
• Controleer of het vuilfilter niet verstopt is.
de deur zit dicht en kan niet
geopend worden.
• Al het water uit de wastrommel moet zijn afgepompt.
• Het controlelampje voor het deurslot moet uit zijn. Het controlelampje
voor het deurslot gaat uit zodra het water is afgepompt.
de afvoerpomp genereert
een vreemd geluid.
• Controleer dat de afvoerpomp niet geblokkeerd is door afval of
viezigheid. Reinig het afvalfilter om geluid te reduceren.
Neem contact op met de klantenservice van Samsung wanneer het probleem zich blijft voordoen.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 35 2012-4-16 13:10:3336_ problemen oplossen en foutcodes
foUtcodEs
Bij problemen met uw wasmachine wordt er mogelijk een foutcode weergegeven in het display. Kijk in deze
tabel en probeer de voorgestelde oplossing voor u de klantenservice belt.
CODE OplOSSING
dE
• Controleer of de deur goed gesloten is.
• Zorg dat er geen was tussen de deur komt.
4E
• Controleer of de waterkraan open is.
• Controleer de waterdruk.
5E
• Reinig het vuilfilter.
• Controleer of de afvoerslang goed geïnstalleerd is.
UE
• Het wasgoed is onevenwichtig verdeeld. Verdeel het opnieuw. Als u
slechts één voorwerp wast, bijvoorbeeld een badjas of spijkerbroek,
is het mogelijk dat de laatste centrifugeronde niet goed verloopt. De
foutmelding “UE” wordt dan in het display weergegeven.
cE/3E • Bel de klantenservice.
Sud
• Dit verschijnt als een teveel aan schuim wordt geconstateerd. Het
wordt ook weergegeven tijdens het verwijderen van het schuim.
Nadat het verwijderen van het schuim is beëindigd, wordt het normale
wasprogramma hervat. (Dit is één van een aantal normale processen).
Het is een foutmelding om andere dan door de sensor geconstateerde
fouten te voorkomen.)
Uc
• Wanneer het voltage van de geleverde elektriciteit instabiel is,
wordt de wasmachine stilgezet om de elektrische voorzieningen te
beschermen.
• Wordt het juiste voltage weer geleverd dan word het wasprogramma
automatisch hervat.
Bel het servicecentrum van Samsung of uw plaatselijke Samsung-dealer wanneer er een code verschijnt die
hier niet vermeld is, of wanneer de voorgestelde oplossing niet werkt.
problemen oplossen en
foutcodes
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 36 2012-4-16 13:10:34programmaoverzicht _37
05 Overzicht van wasprOgramma’s
programmaoverzicht
proGrAMMAovErzicHt
( gebruikersoptie)
pROGRAmmA
max. lading (kg) Wasmiddel
max. temp.
(˚C)
Centrifugesnelheid
(max.) toeren/min
Wf710/Wf712 Voorwas Hoofdwas Wasverzachter Wf710/Wf712
Katoen 7,0 ja 95 1400
synthetisch 2,5 ja 60 1200
jeans 3,0 ja 60 800
Beddengoed 2,0 ja 40 800
donkere kleding 3,0 ja 40 1200
dagelijkse was 2,0 ja 60 1400
Eco trommelreiniging - - ja - 70 400
Babykleding 3,0 ja 95 1400
sportkleding 2,5 ja 60 1200
Handwas 2,0 - ja 40 400
Wol 2,0 - ja 40 800
pROGRAmmA Voorwas Intensief Weken Uitgesteld einde
Kort
programma
Kreukvrij
Katoen
synthetisch -
jeans -
Beddengoed -
donkere kleding - -
dagelijkse was -
Eco trommelreiniging - - - - -
Babykleding -
sportkleding -
Handwas - - - - -
Wol - - - - -
1. Een programma met voorwas duurt ongeveer 18 minuten langer.
2. De gegevens met betrekking tot de duur van wasprogramma’s zijn gemeten onder de omstandigheden
die in de standaard IEC 60456 / EN 60456 zijn aangegeven.
Voer na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit (zie pagina 20).
3. Uw verbruik kan afwijken van de in het schema weergegeven waarden als gevolg van verschillen in
waterdruk en -temperatuur, de lading en het soort wasgoed.
4. Wanneer de functie Intensief wassen is geselecteerd, wordt elke cyclus van het programma verlengd.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 37 2012-4-16 13:10:3438_ appendix
appendix
WAsvoorscHriftEn
De volgende symbolen worden gebruikt in wasvoorschriften. Op waslabels staan vier symbolen in deze
volgorde: wassen, bleken, drogen en strijken.Indien nodig staat er ook informatie over stomen.
Deze symbolen zorgen voor overeenstemming voor kleding van verschillende fabrikanten. Volg de
aanwijzingen op het waslabel op zodat de kleding zo lang mogelijk meegaat en om problemen bij het
wassen te voorkomen.
Sterk materiaal
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
100 ˚C
Kwetsbaar materiaal Niet strijken
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
95 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – alle
gebruikelijke solventen
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
60 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – alle solventen
behalve trichloretheen
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
40 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – uitsluitend
petroleum-solventen en R113
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
30 ˚C
Alleen chemisch reinigen
Handwas Liggend drogen
Niet wassen Hangend drogen
Kan in koud water worden gebleekt Drogen aan kledinghanger
Niet bleken
Kan in de wasdroger, normale
temperatuur
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
200 ˚C
Kan in de wasdroger, lage
temperatuur
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
150 ˚C
Kan niet in de wasdroger
zorG voor HEt MiliEU
• Dit apparaat is gemaakt van recyclebare materialen. Houdt u zich bij het wegdoen van dit apparaat aan
de plaatselijke wetten met betrekking tot afvalverwerking. Snijd het snoer door zodat het apparaat niet
meer kan worden aangesloten op een stroombron. Verwijder de deur zodat dieren en kleine kinderen
zich niet in het apparaat kunnen opsluiten.
• Gebruik niet meer wasmiddel dan aanbevolen in de instructies van de wasmiddelfabrikant.
• Gebruik alleen vlekkenverwijderaars en bleekmiddelen als dit echt nodig is.
• Bespaar water en elektriciteit door alleen volle trommels te wassen (de precieze hoeveelheid is
afhankelijk van het gebruikte wasprogramma).
vErKlArinG vAn conforMitEit
Dit apparaat voldoet aan de Europese veiligheidsnormen, EU-richtlijn 93/68 en EN-standaard 60335.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 38 2012-4-16 13:10:43appendix _39
06 Appendix
ovErzicHt HUisHoUdElijKE WAsMAcHinEs
Volgens EU-verordening nr. 1061/2010
samsung
Modelnaam
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
capaciteit kg 7
Energierendement
A+++ (meest efficiënt) tot d (minst efficiënt) A+++
Energieverbruik
jaarlijks energieverbruik (AE_c)
1)
kWh/jr 175
Energieverbruik (E_t.60) ‘Katoen 60ºc’ bij volledige lading kWh 0,85
Energieverbruik (E_t.60.1/2) ‘Katoen 60 ºc’ met gedeeltelijke lading kWh 0,86
Energieverbruik (E_t.40.1/2) 'Katoen 40 ºc' met gedeeltelijke lading kWh 0,59
Gewogen vermogen uit-modus (p_o) W 0,45
Gewogen vermogen in aan-modus (p_l) W 5
jaarlijkse waterconsumptie (AW_c)
2)
L/yr 9400
Efficiëntieklasse centrifugering
3)
A (meest efficiënt) tot G (minst efficiënt) B
Maximale centrifugeringssnelheid rpm 1400
restvocht % 53
programma’s waarop de informatie op het etiket en het overzicht van toepassing is Katoen 60 ºC en 40 ºC + Intensief
4)
programmaduur van het standaardprogramma
'Katoen 60 ºc' bij volledige lading minuten 225
‘Katoen 60 ºc’ bij gedeeltelijke lading minuten 205
'Katoen 40 ºc' bij gedeeltelijke lading minuten 185
Gewogen vermogen in aan-modus minuten 2
Uitstoot van luchtgeluid
Wassen dB (A) re 1 pW 50
centrifugeren dB (A) re 1 pW 74
Afmetingen
Afmetingen eenheid
Hoogte mm 850
Breedte mm 600
Diepte
5) mm 550
nettogewicht kg 62
Brutogewicht kg 64
Gewicht (verpakt) kg 2
Waterdruk kPa 50-800
Elektrische verbinding
voltage V 220-240
Energieverbruik W 2000-2400
frequentie Hz 50
naam van de leverancier Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
1. Het jaarlijkse energieverbruik is gebaseerd op 220 standaardwasbeurten voor katoenprogramma's
op 60 °C en 40 °C met volle en gedeeltelijke lading, en het verbruik van de uit- en aan-modi. Het
werkelijke energieverbruik hangt af van de manier waarop het apparaat wordt gebruikt.
2. Het jaarlijkse waterverbruik is gebaseerd op 220 standaardwasbeurten voor katoenprogramma's
op 60 °C en 40 °C met volle en gedeeltelijke lading. Het werkelijke waterverbruik hangt af van de
manier waarop het apparaat wordt gebruikt.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 39 2012-4-16 13:10:4340_ appendix
appendix
3. Restwater is erg belangrijk wanneer u een droger gebruikt om uw kleren te drogen.
De energiekosten voor drogen zijn veel hoger dan die voor wassen.
Bij wassen met hoge centrifugeersnelheid wordt meer energie bespaard dan bij het drogen van
kleren in een droger.
4. Het standaardkatoenprogramma 60 °C en het standaardkatoenprogramma 40 °C, die u kunt
selecteren door de optie Intensief toe te voegen aan het katoenprogramma 60 °C en het
katoenprogramma 40 °C, zijn geschikt voor het reinigen van normaal bevuild katoenwasgoed.
Deze programma’s zijn de efficiëntste (wat betreft water- en energieverbruik) voor dit type
wasgoed.
Voer na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit (zie pagina 20).
In deze wasprogramma’s kan de werkelijke temperatuur van het water afwijken van de aangegeven
temperatuur.
5. Afstand van de wand tot de eenheid is niet opgenomen in de afmeting van de diepte.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 40 2012-4-16 13:10:43memo
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 41 2012-4-16 13:10:43WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 42 2012-4-16 13:10:43WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 43 2012-4-16 13:10:43VRAGEN OF OPMERKINGEN?
land bEl Of bEZOEK ONZE WEbSITE
NEDERLAND 0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864) (€ 0,10/Min) www.samsung.com
BELGIË 02-201-24-18
www.samsung.com/be (Dutch)
www.samsung.com/be_fr (French)
Codenr. DC68-03149H_NL
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 44 2012-4-16 13:10:44Lave-linge
Manuel d’utilisation
Un monde de possibilités
Nous vous remercions d’avoir choisi ce produit Samsung.
Afin de bénéficier d’un service plus complet, veuillez
enregistrer votre produit à l’adresse suivante :
www.samsung.com/register
Ce manuel est fait avec du papier recyclé à 100%.
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 1 2012-4-16 13:08:062_ Caractéristiques de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung
Caractéristiques de votre
nouveau lave-linge Samsung
Avec ce nouveau lave-linge, faire une lessive prend un tout autre sens. Capacité
XXL, économies d’énergie...Le lave-linge Samsung possède toutes les
caractéristiques nécessaires pour transformer une tâche désagréable en un vrai
moment de plaisir.
• Économies d’énergie
Ce modèle permet une utilisation plus économique par comparaison aux machines classées «
A » grâce au système de générateur spécial Bubble et au moteur à inverseur Samsung.
• Moins de bruit et de vibrations
Ce lave-linge Samsung fonctionne en silence, en réduisant le bruit et les vibrations grâce à la
technologie de contrôle intelligente, qui lui permet de conserver les vibrations les plus faibles
possibles. Ainsi le tambour garde un équilibre parfait.
• Lavage express
Pas de temps à perdre ! Nos 15 minutes de lavage express vous permettront de laver et de
poursuivre vos activités.Notre programme de lavage express est destiné à ceux qui n'ont pas
le temps - maintenant vous pouvez laver vos vêtements préférés (jusqu'à 2 kg) en seulement
15 minutes !
• Lavage du tambour
La fonction Lavage du tambour permet d'entretenir la propreté du lave-linge, sans ajouter
de nettoyant chimique ni d'eau de Javel. Ce programme de nettoyage spécial vous donne
l'assurance d'avoir toujours un tambour propre et sans odeur.
• Cycle bébé
Votre lave-linge Samsung propose des programmes spéciaux pour protéger les vêtements
des enfants à la peau sensible.
Ils réduisent les irritations de la peau des enfants en diminuant les résidus de lessive. Ces
programmes permettent en outre de classer le linge en différents types ; le lavage est donc
effectué selon les caractéristiques de chaque type.Les enfants ressentent ainsi une agréable
sensation de propreté lorsqu’ils mettent leurs vêtements.
• Lavage à la main
Pour laver tout en douceur vos vêtements les plus fragiles, il convient de choisir la
température, le cycle de lavage et la quantité d’eau appropriés.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 2 2012-4-16 13:08:07Caractéristiques de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung _3
• Sécurité enfant
La fonction Sécurité enfant empêche les plus jeunes de jouer avec le lave-linge.
Cette fonction de sécurité empêche non seulement les enfants de jouer avec les fonctions du
lave-linge, mais elle vous avertit aussi lorsqu’elle est activée.
• Arrêt différé
Ce lave-linge vous permet de différer le départ d’un programme de 19 heures, par tranches
d’une heure - pour un confort d’utilisation optimal.
• Affichage Numérique
Le panneau de configuration Affichage Numérique est clair et facile à utiliser pour un minimum
de manipulations sans tracas. Et en plus d'être facile à utiliser, l'affichage numérique vous
permet de faire à votre lessive des ajustements rapides et précis pour d'excellents résultats
de lavage.
• Tuyaux aquastop & détecteur de fuite (sur certains modèles)
Le système de sécurité d'eau intelligemment conçus pour les machines à laver Samsung
comprend un tuyau intelligent pour stopper les fuites d'eau à la source et un détecteur de
fuite à la base. Si des ruptures du tuyau ou des fuites d'eau sont détectées, une éponge
interne se dilatera pour bloquer l'eau du robinet.
Ce manuel contient de précieuses informations relatives à l’installation, à l’utilisation et à
l’entretien de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung. Reportez-vous aux descriptions du panneau
de commande, aux consignes d’utilisation du lave-linge, ainsi qu’aux conseils pratiques pour
profiter pleinement des caractéristiques et fonctions de pointe de votre machine. La section
« Codes d’erreur et de dépannage » de la page 35 vous explique ce qu’il y a lieu de faire en cas
de problème avec votre nouveau lave-linge.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 3 2012-4-16 13:08:074_ Consignes de sécurité
Consignes de sécurité
Félicitations pour l’achat de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung ActivFresh™.
Ce manuel contient des informations importantes sur l’installation, l’utilisation et
l’entretien de votre appareil. Prenez le temps de lire ce manuel afin de pouvoir
profiter pleinement des nombreux avantages et fonctions de votre lave-linge.
Ce que vouS devez SAvoir à propoS deS CoNSigNeS de
SÉCuriTÉ
Veuillez lire attentivement ce manuel pour vous assurer que vous savez comment utiliser efficacement toutes les
caractéristiques et fonctions de votre nouvel appareil en toute sécurité ; conservez-le dans un endroit sûr à proximité de
l’appareil pour vous y référer ultérieurement. Utilisez uniquement cet appareil pour son usage prévu, tel que décrit dans
ce manuel d’utilisation.
Les avertissements et les consignes de sécurité importantes cités dans ce manuel ne couvrent pas toutes les
conditions et les situations susceptibles de se produire. Il est de votre responsabilité de faire preuve de bon sens, de
prudence et de discernement lors de l’installation, de l’entretien et de l’utilisation de votre lave-linge.
Parce que les consignes d’utilisation suivantes concernent plusieurs modèles, les caractéristiques de votre lave-linge
sont peut-être légèrement différentes de celles décrites dans ce manuel et l’ensemble des symboles d’avertissement
peuvent ne pas s’appliquer à vous. Pour toute question ou renseignement, contactez le service après-vente le plus
proche ou recherchez des informations et consultez l’aide en ligne sur www.samsung.com.
SyMboLeS eT prÉCAuTioNS de SÉCuriTÉ iMporTANTS
Signification des icônes et des symboles utilisés dans ce manuel:
AVERTISSEMENT
Risques ou pratiques dangereuses susceptibles de provoquer des
blessures corporelles graves, le décès et/ou des dommages
matériels.
ATTENTION
Risques ou pratiques dangereuses susceptibles de provoquer des
blessures corporelles graves et/ou des dommages matériels.
ATTENTION
Pour réduire le risque d’incendie, d’explosion, de choc électrique ou
de blessure corporelle lors de l’utilisation de votre lave-linge, suivez ces
précautions de base:
Ne PAS essayer.
Ne PAS démonter.
Ne PAS toucher.
Suivre les consignes scrupuleusement.
Débrancher la prise d’alimentation de la prise murale.
Vérifier que le lave-linge est mis à la terre pour éviter tout choc électrique.
Appeler le service après-vente pour obtenir de l’aide.
Note
Ces symboles d’avertissement sont présents pour prévenir toute blessure, à vous-même
ou à d’autres personnes.
veuillez les respecter scrupuleusement.
Après avoir lu cette section, conservez-la dans un endroit sûr pour vous y référer
ultérieurement.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 4 2012-4-16 13:08:11Consignes de sécurité _5
Lisez l’ensemble des consignes avant d’utiliser l’appareil.
Comme pour tout appareil électrique comportant des parties mobiles, des risques existent.
Pour utiliser cet appareil en toute sécurité, familiarisez-vous avec son fonctionnement et
faites preuve de prudence lorsque vous l’utilisez.
Ne laissez pas les enfants (ou les animaux) jouer sur ou à l’intérieur de votre lave-linge. La porte du
lave-linge ne s’ouvre pas facilement de l’intérieur, et il existe un risque de blessure grave si un enfant
est enfermé à l’intérieur.
Cet appareil n’est pas prévu pour être utilisé par des personnes (y compris les enfants) dont les
capacités physiques, sensorielles ou mentales sont réduites ou des personnes dénuées d’expérience
ou de connaissance, sauf si elles ont pu bénéficier, par l’intermédiaire d’une personne responsable de
leur sécurité, d’une surveillance ou d’instructions préalables concernant l’utilisation de l’appareil.
Les enfants doivent être surveillés afin qu’ils ne jouent pas avec l’appareil.
Si la prise (cordon d’alimentation) est endommagée, elle doit être remplacée par le fabricant, son
service après-vente ou une personne qualifiée afin de prévenir tout risque.
Cet appareil doit être placé de manière à ce que l’on puisse facilement accéder à la prise
d’alimentation, aux robinets d’arrivée d’eau et aux tuyaux d’évacuation.
Pour les lave-linge équipés de ventilations à la base, assurez-vous que l’ouverture ne soit pas obstruée
par un tapis ou tout autre obstacle.
Utilisez les nouveaux tuyaux fournis, les anciens tuyaux ne doivent pas être réutilisés.
iNSTruCTioNS CoNCerNANT LA MArque deee
Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets
d’équipements électriques et électroniques)
(Applicable dans les pays de l’Union Européenne et dans d’autres pays européens
pratiquant le tri sélectif)
Ce symbole sur le produit, ses accessoires ou sa documentation indique que ni le produit, ni
ses accessoires électroniques usagés (chargeur, casque audio, câble USB, etc.) ne peuvent être
jetés avec les autres déchets ménagers. La mise au rebut incontrôlée des déchets présentant
des risques environnementaux et de santé publique, veuillez séparer vos produits et accessoires
usagés des autres déchets. Vous favoriserez ainsi le recyclage de la matière qui les compose
dans le cadre d’un développement durable.
Les particuliers sont invités à contacter le magasin leur ayant vendu le produit ou à se renseigner
auprès des autorités locales pour connaître les procédures et les points de collecte de ces
produits en vue de leur recyclage.
Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les
conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit et ses accessoires ne peuvent être jetés avec les
autres déchets professionnels et commerciaux.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 5 2012-4-16 13:08:126_ Consignes de sécurité
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour
L’iNSTALLATioN
Cet appareil doit être installé par un technicien qualifié ou par une entreprise spécialisée.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie,
une explosion, des problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
L’appareil est lourd, soyez donc prudent lorsque vous le soulevez.
Branchez le cordon d'alimentation dans une prise murale, AC de 220V/50Hz/15A une
prise de courant approuvé et protégée par un fusible ou un disjoncteur. N’utilisez pas de
rallonge.
- Partager une prise murale avec d’autres appareils via une multiprise ou brancher une
rallonge au cordon d’alimentation pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
- Assurez-vous que la tension d’alimentation, la fréquence et le courant correspondent
aux spécifications du produit. Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un
choc électrique ou un incendie. Enfoncez fermement la prise d’alimentation dans la prise
murale.
Essuyer régulièrement les bornes et les points de contact de la prise d’alimentation à l’aide
d’un chiffon sec afin d’en retirer toute substance étrangère, telle que de la poussière ou de
l’eau.
- Débranchez la prise d’alimentation et nettoyez-la à l’aide d’un chiffon sec.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Branchez la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale dans le bon sens, de manière à ce
que le cordon soit orienté vers le sol.
- Si vous branchez la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale dans le sens opposé, les
fils électriques du cordon d’alimentation risquent d’être endommagés et cela pourrait
provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Conservez tous les éléments d’emballage hors de portée des enfants, car ils présentent un
danger pour les enfants.
- Un enfant pourrait s’étouffer s’il met sa tête dans un sac.
Lorsque l’appareil, la prise d’alimentation ou le cordon d’alimentation sont endommagés,
contactez votre service après-vente.
Cet appareil doit être correctement mis à la terre.
Ne mettez pas l’appareil à la terre avec un tuyau de gaz, un tuyau d’eau en plastique ou
une ligne téléphonique.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie, une explosion ou des
problèmes avec le produit
- Ne branchez jamais le cordon d’alimentation dans une prise qui n’est pas correctement
mise à la terre et assurez-vous qu’elle soit conforme aux codes de votre région et de
votre pays.
N’installez pas cet appareil à proximité d’un appareil de chauffage ou de matériaux
inflammables.
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit humide, gras, poussiéreux, directement exposé
à la lumière du jour ou à de l’eau (gouttes de pluie).
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit à basses températures
- Le gel pourrait provoquer la rupture des tuyaux
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit où une fuite de gaz pourrait survenir.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Consignes de sécurité
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 6 2012-4-16 13:08:12Consignes de sécurité _7
N’utilisez pas de transformateur électrique.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
N’utilisez pas une prise d’alimentation qui est endommagée, un cordon d’alimentation
endommagée ou une prise murale mal scellée.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne tirez pas sur le cordon d’alimentation, ne pliez pas le cordon d’alimentation.
Ne tordez pas le cordon d’alimentation, n’y faites pas de nœud.
Ne faites pas passer le cordon d’alimentation sur un objet métallique, ne placez pas d’objet
lourd sur le cordon d’alimentation, ne glissez pas le cordon d’alimentation entre des objets,
ne poussez pas le cordon d’alimentation dans l’espace qui se trouve derrière l’appareil.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne tirez pas sur le cordon d’alimentation lorsque vous débranchez la prise d’alimentation.
- Débranchez le cordon d’alimentation en tenant la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne placez pas le cordon d’alimentation et les tuyaux là où ils pourraient vous faire chuter.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS pour L’iNSTALLATioN
Cet appareil doit être placé de façon à laisser libre accès à la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie
dû à une fuite électrique.
Installez votre appareil sur un sol plat et dur qui pourra supporter son poids.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer des vibrations, déplacements et
bruits anormaux ou provoquer des problèmes avec le produit.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour
L’uTiLiSATioN
En cas de dégât des eaux, coupez immédiatement l’arrivée d’eau et l’alimentation
électrique et contactez le service après-vente le plus proche.
- Ne touchez pas la prise d’alimentation avec des mains humides ou mouillées
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique
Si l’appareil émet un bruit étrange, qu’il s’en dégage une odeur de brûlé ou de la fumée,
débranchez immédiatement la prise d’alimentation et contactez votre service après-vente.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
En cas de fuite de gaz (propane, GPL, etc.), aérez immédiatement sans toucher la prise
d’alimentation. Ne touchez ni l’appareil, ni le cordon d’alimentation.
- N’utilisez pas de ventilateur.
- Une étincelle pourrait provoquer une explosion ou un incendie.
Ne laissez pas les enfants jouer sur ou à l’intérieur du lave-linge. Lors de l’élimination de
l’appareil, pensez à retirer le levier de la porte.
- Si l’enfant est enfermé à l’intérieur, il pourrait mourir asphyxié.
Veillez à enlever tous les éléments d’emballage (polystyrène, mousse) accrochés au bas de
l’appareil avant de l’utiliser.
AverTiSSeMeNT
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 7 2012-4-16 13:08:128_ Consignes de sécurité
Ne lavez pas le linge contaminé par de l’essence, du kérosène, du benzène, du diluant
pour peinture, de l’alcool ou toute autre substance inflammable ou explosive.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie ou une explosion.
N’ouvrez pas la porte du lave-linge de force pendant qu’il fonctionne (lavage / séchage /
essorage à haute température).
- L’eau éjectée du lave-linge pourrait provoquer des brûlures ou rendre le sol glissant.
Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
- Ouvrir la porte de force pourrait endommager le produit ou provoquer des blessures.
Ne passez pas vos mains sous le lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Ne touchez pas le cordon d’alimentation avec des mains humides ou mouillées.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique.
N’éteignez pas l’appareil en débranchant la prise d’alimentation pendant qu’une opération
est en cours.
- Rebrancher la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale pourrait provoquer une étincelle,
ce qui risquerait de provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne laissez pas les enfants ou les personnes infirmes utiliser ce lave-linge sans surveillance.
Ne laissez pas les enfants grimper dans l’appareil.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, des brûlures ou
des blessures.
Ne passez pas vos mains ou un objet métallique sous le lave-linge pendant qu’il fonctionne.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Ne débranchez pas l’appareil en tirant sur le cordon d’alimentation, saisissez toujours
fermement la prise d’alimentation et tirez en la maintenant au même niveau que la prise
murale.
- L’endommagement du cordon d’alimentation pourrait provoquer un court-circuit, un
incendie et/ou un choc électrique
N’essayez pas de réparer, de démonter ou de modifier l’appareil vous-même.
- N’utilisez pas de fusibles (comme un fil de cuivre ou d’acier, etc.) autres que les fusibles
standards.
- Lorsqu’il est nécessaire de réparer ou de réinstaller l’appareil, contactez votre service
après-vente.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie,
des problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
Si une substance étrangère telle que de l’eau s’est infiltrée dans l’appareil, débranchez la
prise d’alimentation et contactez votre service après-vente.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Si le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau se détache du robinet et que de l’eau asperge l’appareil,
débranchez la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Débranchez la prise d’alimentation lorsque l’appareil n’est pas utilisé pendant longtemps ou
lorsqu’il y a de l’orage.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Consignes de sécurité
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 8 2012-4-16 13:08:13Consignes de sécurité _9
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS pour L’uTiLiSATioN
Lorsque le lave-linge est contaminé par une substance étrangère telle que de la lessive, de
la saleté, des résidus alimentaires, etc., débranchez la prise d’alimentation et nettoyez le
lave-linge avec un chiffon doux humide.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer une décoloration, une déformation,
une détérioration ou l’apparition de rouille au niveau de l’appareil.
La partie en verre de la face avant de l’appareil est susceptible de se briser suite à un
impact fort. Soyez prudent lorsque vous utilisez le lave-linge.
- Le bris du verre pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Après une coupure d’eau ou lorsque vous rebranchez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau, ouvrez le
robinet doucement.
Ouvrez le robinet doucement après une longue période sans utilisation.
- La pression de l’air dans le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau ou dans le tuyau d’eau pourrait
endommager un élément de l’appareil ou provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Si une erreur de vidange survient pendant une opération, vérifiez s’il y a un problème avec
l’évacuation de l’eau.
- Si le lave-linge est utilisé alors qu’il est victime d’un dégât des eaux résultant d’un
problème de vidange, cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie dû à
une fuite électrique.
Placez le linge entièrement dans le lave-linge afin qu’il ne se coince pas dans la porte.
- Si du linge se coince dans la porte, cela pourrait endommager le linge, le lave-linge, ou
provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Assurez-vous que le robinet soit bien éteint lorsque l’eau n’est pas utilisée.
- Assurez-vous que la vis du raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau soit bien serrée.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer des dommages matériels ou des
blessures.
Vérifiez que le joint en caoutchouc n’est pas contaminé par des substances étrangères
(résidus, fils, etc.).
- Si la porte n’est pas complètement fermée, cela pourrait provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Ouvrez le robinet et assurez-vous que le raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau soit bien serré et
qu’il n’y a pas de fuite d’eau avant d’utiliser le produit.
- Si les vis du raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sont mal serrées, cela pourrait provoquer
une fuite d’eau.
Le produit que vous avez acheté est prévu pour une utilisation domestique uniquement.
L’utilisation à des fins professionnelles est considérée comme une utilisation non conforme
du produit.
Dans ce cas, le produit ne sera pas couvert par la garantie standard prévue par
Samsung et Samsung ne saura en aucun cas être tenu pour responsable en cas de
dysfonctionnements ou dommages résultant d’une utilisation non conforme.
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 9 2012-4-16 13:08:1310_ Consignes de sécurité
Ne montez pas sur l’appareil, ne placez pas d’objets (linge, bougies allumées, cigarettes allumées,
vaisselle, produits chimiques, objets métalliques, etc.) sur l’appareil.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie, des
problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
Ne vaporisez pas de matériaux volatiles, tels que des insecticides, sur la surface de l’appareil.
- En plus d’être potentiellement dangereux pour l’homme, cela pourrait également provoquer un
choc électrique, un incendie ou des problèmes avec le produit.
Ne placez pas d’objets générant un champ électromagnétique à proximité du lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures résultant d’un dysfonctionnement.
L’eau vidangée pendant un lavage / séchage à haute température est chaude, ne touchez pas l’eau.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des brûlures ou des blessures.
Ne lavez pas, n’essorez pas et ne séchez pas de sièges, tapis ou vêtements imperméables (*) sauf si
votre appareil possède un programme spécifique pour laver ces articles.
- Ne lavez pas de tapis épais et raides même si l’étiquette comporte un symbole de lavage en
machine.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une blessure corporelle ou des dommages au niveau du lave-linge, des
murs, du sol ou des vêtements résultant de vibrations anormales.
* La literie en laine, les protections contre la pluie, les cirés, les pantalons de ski, les sacs de
couchage, les protège-couches, les vêtements de sudation, les protections pour vélo, moto,
voiture, etc.
Ne faites pas fonctionner le lave-linge lorsque le compartiment à lessive a été retiré.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou des blessures résultants d’une fuite d’eau.
Ne touchez pas l’intérieur du tambour pendant ou juste après un séchage car il est chaud.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des brûlures.
Ne passez pas votre main dans le compartiment à lessive après l’avoir ouvert.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures si votre main était coincée par le mécanisme d’insertion de
lessive. Ne mettez aucun objet (tel que chaussures, résidus alimentaires, animaux) autres que du
linge dans le lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait endommager le lave-linge ou provoquer des blessures ou le décès de l’animal,
résultant des vibrations anormales.
N’appuyez pas sur les boutons à l’aide d’objets pointus comme des aiguilles, couteaux, ongles, etc.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou des blessures.
Ne lavez pas de linge contaminé par des huiles, des crèmes ou des lotions habituellement présentes
dans des instituts de soins de la peau ou des instituts de massage.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une déformation du joint en caoutchouc et une fuite d’eau.
Ne laissez pas d’objets métalliques tels que des épingles à nourrice ou des barrettes, ou de la javel,
dans le tambour pendant une longue période de temps.
- Cela pourrait provoquer la rouille du tambour.
- Si de la rouille commence à apparaître sur la surface du tambour, appliquez un nettoyant (neutre)
sur la surface et utilisez une éponge pour le nettoyer. N’utilisez jamais de brosse métallique.
N’utilisez pas de nettoyant à sec directement, ne lavez pas, ne rincez pas et n’essorez pas de linge
contaminé par un nettoyant à sec.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une combustion spontanée due à la chaleur générée par l’oxydation de
l’huile.
N’utilisez pas d’eau chaude provenant d’appareils de refroidissement/chauffage de l’eau.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des problèmes au niveau du lave-linge.
Consignes de sécurité
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 10 2012-4-16 13:08:13Consignes de sécurité _11
N’utilisez pas de savon naturel pour le lavage à la main dans le lave-linge.
- S’il durcit et s’accumule dans le lave-linge, cela pourrait provoquer des problèmes avec
le produit, une décoloration, de la rouille ou des mauvaises odeurs.
N’utilisez pas le filet de lavage pour laver de grandes pièces de linge telles que de la literie.
- Mettez les chaussettes et les soutien-gorge dans le filet de lavage et mettez-le avec le
reste du linge.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer des blessures résultant des
vibrations anormales.
N’utilisez pas de nettoyant solide.
- S’il s’accumule à l’intérieur du lave-linge, cela pourrait provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Pour les lave-linge équipés de ventilations à la base, assurez-vous que l’ouverture ne soit
pas obstruée par un tapis ou tout autre obstacle.
Assurez-vous que toutes les poches des vêtements à laver soient vides.
- Les objets durs ou pointus tels que les pièces de monnaie, les épingles à nourrice, les
ongles, les vis ou les cailloux sont susceptibles de gravement endommager l’appareil.
Ne lavez pas de vêtements avec un gros ceinturon, des gros boutons ou d’autres métaux
lourds.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour Le
NeTToyAge
Ne nettoyez pas l’appareil en y aspergeant de l’eau directement à l’intérieur.
N’utilisez pas de benzène, de diluant ou d’alcool pour nettoyer l’appareil.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une décoloration, une déformation, un choc électrique, un
incendie ou des dommages.
Avant de nettoyer ou d’effectuer toute opération d’entretien, débranchez l’appareil de la
prise murale.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 11 2012-4-16 13:08:1312_ Sommaire
Sommaire
INSTALLER LE LAVE-LINgE
13
13 Vérification des pièces
14 Respect des conditions d’installation
14 Alimentation électrique et mise à la terre
14 Arrivée d’eau
15 Vidange
15 Plancher
15 Température ambiante
15 Installation dans une niche ou une armoire
15 Installer votre lave-linge
EffECTUER UN LAVAgE
21
21 Premier lavage
21 Consignes élémentaires
22 Panneau de commande
25 Sécurité enfant
25 Arrêt son
25 Arrêt différé
26 Mon cycle
26 Laver du linge à l’aide du sélecteur de
programme
27 Laver du linge en mode manuel
27 Instructions de lavage
28 Informations sur la lessive et les additifs
28 Quelle lessive utiliser ?
29 Tiroir à lessive
29 Lessive liquide (sur certains modèles)
NETTOyAgE ET ENTRETIEN DE
VOTRE LAVE-LINgE
30
30 Lavage du tambour
31 Vidanger le lave-linge en urgence
32 Nettoyage du tiroir à lessive et du logement du
tiroir
33 Nettoyage du filtre à impuretés
33 Nettoyer l’extérieur du lave-linge
34 Nettoyer le filtre à maille du tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau
34 Réparer un lave-linge qui a gelé
34 Entreposer le lave-linge
CODES D’ERREUR ET DE
DépANNAgE
35
35 Vérifiez les points suivants si...
36 Codes d’erreur
TAbLEAU DES pROgRAMMES
37
37 Tableau des programmes
ANNExE
38
38 Tableau des symboles d’entretien des textiles
38 Protection de l’environnement
38 Déclaration de conformité
39 Fiche technique des lave-linge domestiques
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 12 2012-4-16 13:08:14Installer le lave-linge _13
01 Installat on I
Installer le lave-linge
Assurez-vous que l’installateur a suivi ces instructions à la lettre afin que votre
nouveau lave-linge fonctionne correctement et que vous ne soyez exposé à aucun
risque lorsque vous faites une lessive.
vÉrifiCATioN deS pièCeS
Déballez soigneusement votre lave-linge et vérifiez que vous disposez bien de toutes les pièces illustrées
ci-dessous. Si vous constatez que le lave-linge a été endommagé pendant le transport ou qu’il manque des
pièces, contactez le service clientèle de Samsung ou votre revendeur Samsung.
Clé Caches
pour les
trous des
vis
froide
Chaude (sur
certains modèles)
guide-tuyau fixation
d’embout
Compartiment
à lessive
liquide (sur
certains
modèles)
Tuyau d’arrivée d’eau
* Caches pour les trous des vis: Le nombre de caches pour les trous des vis dépend du modèle (3 ~
5 caches).
Tuyau de
vidange
filtre à impuretés
Tuyau de vidange
d’urgence
Capot du filtre
Tiroir à lessive
panneau de
commande
Hublot
pieds réglables
Tambour
Manette d’ouverture plan de travail
prise
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 13 2012-4-16 13:08:1814_ Installer le lave-linge
Installer le lave-linge
reSpeCT deS CoNdiTioNS d’iNSTALLATioN
Alimentation électrique et mise à la terre
Afin d’éviter tout risque d’incendie, d’électrocution ou de blessure, il est essentiel que le câblage
et la mise à la terre soient réalisés conformément aux spécifications de la dernière révision
du Code national de l’électricité (NEC) ANSI/FNPA n° 70 ainsi qu’aux réglementations et
ordonnances locales en vigueur. L’utilisation d’une alimentation électrique adaptée à cet appareil
relève de la responsabilité de son propriétaire.
N’utilisez jamais de rallonge.
Utilisez uniquement le cordon d’alimentation fourni avec votre lave-linge.
En préparation de l’installation, assurez-vous que l’alimentation électrique réunit les conditions
suivantes :
• Fusible ou coupe-circuit 220 V~240 V 50 Hz
• Circuit de dérivation distinct, réservé uniquement à votre lave-linge
Votre lave-linge doit être mis à la terre. En cas de panne ou de défaillance du lave-linge, la mise à
la terre réduira le risque de surtension électrique en fournissant au courant électrique un chemin
de moindre résistance.
Votre lave-linge est équipé d’un cordon doté d’une prise à 3 broches avec conducteur de terre
destinée à être branchée sur une prise murale correctement installée et reliée à la terre.
Ne reliez jamais un conducteur de terre à une conduite de plomberie en plastique, une
conduite de gaz ou une conduite d’eau chaude.
Un branchement incorrect du conducteur de terre peut provoquer une surtension électrique.
Demandez conseil à un électricien ou à un réparateur agréé si vous avez des doutes quant à la
mise à la terre correcte du lave-linge. Ne modifiez pas la fiche fournie avec le lave-linge. Si elle
n’est pas adaptée à la prise murale, faites appel à un électricien qualifié pour installer une prise
appropriée.
Arrivée d’eau
Pour un remplissage correct du lave-linge, la pression d’eau doit être comprise entre 50 kPa (0,5
Bar) et 800 kPa (8 Bar). Si la pression d’eau est inférieure à 50 kPa (0,5 Bar), la vanne d’arrivée
d’eau risque de ne plus se fermer correctement et la durée de remplissage risque d’augmenter
au-delà de la limite autorisée par le contrôleur, entraînant ainsi l’arrêt du lave-linge (Un limiteur de
durée de remplissage est intégré au contrôleur de l’appareil afin d’éviter tout trop-plein ou toute
inondation en cas de défaillance d’un tuyau interne.).
Les robinets d’arrivée d’eau doivent se trouver à moins de 120cm de l’arrière de votre lave-linge
afin que les tuyaux fournis puissent être reliés à l’appareil.
La plupart des magasins de fournitures de plomberie proposent des tuyaux d’alimentation
en eau de différentes longueurs (jusqu’à 305 cm).
Voici quelques conseils pour réduire les risques de fuite et de dégât des eaux :
• Faites en sorte que les robinets d’arrivée d’eau soient facilement accessibles.
• Fermez les robinets d’arrivée d’eau lorsque vous n’utilisez pas le lave-linge.
• Vérifiez régulièrement l’absence de fuites au niveau des raccords des tuyaux
d’alimentation en eau.
Avant d’utiliser votre lave-linge pour la première fois, vérifiez l’absence de fuites au niveau
des raccords avec la vanne d’arrivée d’eau et les robinets. AverTiSSeMeNT
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 14 2012-4-16 13:08:18Installer le lave-linge _15
01 Installat on I
vidange
Samsung recommande de placer le tuyau d’évacuation mural à une hauteur de 65cm. Le
tuyau de vidange doit être accroché à la pince prévue à cette effet, puis introduit dans le tuyau
d’évacuation mural. Le tuyau d’évacuation mural doit être suffisamment large pour qu’il soit
possible d’y insérer le tuyau de vidange du lave-linge. Le tuyau de vidange est fixé en usine.
plancher
Pour un fonctionnement optimal, votre lave-linge doit être installé sur un sol stable. Si le sol est
en bois, il est possible qu’il doive être renforcé afin de réduire les vibrations et les problèmes de
déséquilibre. La présence de moquette ou de surfaces molles contribue aux vibrations et/ou à la
tendance de votre lave-linge à se déplacer durant l’essorage.
N’installez jamais votre lave-linge sur une plate-forme ou sur une structure dont le soutien est
insuffisant.
Température ambiante
N’installez pas votre lave-linge dans une zone où l’eau peut geler :en effet, il subsistera
toujours une certaine quantité d’eau dans le robinet de prise d’eau, la pompe ou les tuyaux. La
présence d’eau gelée dans les conduites peut endommager les courroies, la pompe et d’autres
composants.
installation dans une niche ou une armoire
Pour garantir un fonctionnement correct et sûr de votre nouveau lave-linge, il convient de
respecter les exigences suivantes en termes de dégagement :
Côtés – 25 mm Arrière – 50 mm
Haut – 25 mm Avant – 465 mm
Si le lave-linge et un sèche-linge sont installés ensemble, il doit y avoir une aération d’au moins
465 mm sans obstacle à l’avant de la niche ou de l’armoire. Installé seul, votre lave-linge ne
nécessite pas d’aération spécifique.
iNSTALLer voTre LAve-LiNge
ETApE 1
Choisir un emplacement
Avant d’installer votre lave-linge, vérifiez que l’emplacement choisi :
• Possède une surface dure et de niveau, sans moquette ou autre revêtement de sol
susceptible d’obstruer l’aération.
• N’est pas exposé à la lumière directe du soleil
• Dispose d’une ventilation adaptée
• Ne risque pas de geler (température inférieure à 0 °C)
• Ne se trouve pas à proximité d’une source de chaleur, telle qu’un chauffage
• Dispose de suffisamment d’espace, de sorte que votre lave-linge ne repose pas sur son
cordon d’alimentation
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 15 2012-4-16 13:08:1916_ Installer le lave-linge
ETApE 2
enlever les vis de transport
Avant d’installer le lave-linge, vous devez enlever les cinq vis de transport à l’arrière de l’appareil.
1. Desserrez toutes les vis à l’aide de la clé fournie.
2. Maintenez la vis avec la clé et faites-la passer dans la partie
large du trou. Répétez l’opération pour chaque vis.
3. Bouchez les trous avec les caches en plastique fournis.
4. Rangez les vis de transport dans un endroit sûr, au cas où vous devriez déplacer le lave-linge
ultérieurement.
Les matériaux d’emballage peuvent être dangereux pour les enfants.Tenez tous les
emballages (sacs plastique, polystyrène, etc.) hors de leur portée.
Insérez la fixation d’embout (accessoire
fourni dans le sac en vinyle) dans le
trou duquel vous avez retiré le cordon
d’alimentation à l’arrière de l’appareil.
Installer le lave-linge
AverTiSSeMeNT
option
option
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 16 2012-4-16 13:08:20Installer le lave-linge _17
01 Installat on I
ETApE 3
Ajuster les pieds réglables
Lorsque vous installez le lave-linge, assurez-vous que la prise de courant, l’arrivée d’eau et
l’évacuation sont facilement accessibles.
1. Mettez le lave-linge en place en le faisant glisser.
2. Mettez votre lave-linge de
niveau en faisant tourner
les pieds vers la gauche
ou la droite manuellement.
3. Lorsque le lave-linge est de niveau, serrez les écrous à
l’aide de la clé fournie.
ETApE 4
raccordement de l’arrivée d’eau et de l’évacuation
Raccorder le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau
1. Prenez le raccord en L correspondant au tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau froide et raccordez-le à l’arrivée
d’eau froide, à l’arrière de la machine. Serrez à la
main.
Le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau doit être raccordé au
lave-linge à une extrémité et au robinet d’eau
à l’autre extrémité. Ne tendez pas le tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau. Si le tuyau est trop court,
remplacez-le par un tuyau haute pression plus
long.
2. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau froide au robinet d’eau froide et serrez-la à
la main. Si nécessaire, vous pouvez repositionner
le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sur le lave-linge en
desserrant le raccord, en faisant tourner le tuyau
et en resserrant le raccord.
pour les modèles équipés d’une arrivée d’eau chaude supplémentaire :
1. Prenez le raccord en L rouge correspondant au tuyau d’arrivée d’eau chaude et raccordez-le
à l’arrivée d’eau chaude située à l’arrière de la machine. Serrez à la main.
2. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau chaude au robinet d’eau chaude de
votre lavabo et serrez-la à la main.
3. Utilisez un raccord en Y si vous souhaitez utiliser uniquement l’eau froide.
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 17 2012-4-16 13:08:2318_ Installer le lave-linge
Installer le lave-linge
Raccorder le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau (sur certains modèles)
1. Enlevez l’adaptateur du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
2. À l’aide d’un tournevis cruciforme, commencez par
desserrer les quatre vis de l’adaptateur. Prenez ensuite
l’adaptateur et tournez la partie (2) dans le sens de la
flèche, jusqu’à obtenir un écart de 5 mm.
3. Raccordez l’adaptateur au robinet en serrant fermement
les vis et en levant l’adaptateur vers le haut.
Tournez la partie (2) dans le sens de la flèche, puis
raccordez (1) et (2).
4. Raccordez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à l’adaptateur.
Lorsque vous lâchez la partie (3), le tuyau se
raccorde automatiquement à l’adaptateur en
émettant un petit clic d’enclenchement.
Après avoir raccordé le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à
l’adaptateur, vérifiez que le branchement a été
correctement effectué en tirant le tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau vers le bas.
5. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à la
vanne d’alimentation en eau située à l’arrière du lave-linge.
Vissez le tuyau à fond dans le sens des aiguilles d’une
montre.
Adaptateur
Tuyau
d’arrivée
d’eau
1
2
5 mm
3
1
2
robinet
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 18 2012-4-16 13:08:26Installer le lave-linge _19
01 Installat on I
6. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau et vérifiez l’absence de fuite au
niveau de la vanne d’arrivée d’eau, du robinet ou de
l’adaptateur. En cas de fuite d’eau, répétez les étapes
précédentes.
N’utilisez pas le lave-linge si une fuite d’eau a été
détectée. Cela pourrait en effet provoquer des blessures
ou un choc électrique.
• Si le robinet est doté d’un pas de vis, raccordez le tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau au robinet comme indiqué ci-contre.
Utilisez un robinet standard pour l’arrivée d’eau. Si le robinet est à angle droit ou s’il est trop
gros, retirez la bague d’écartement avant d’insérer le robinet dans l’adaptateur.
Raccordement de l'Aqua Hose (sur certains modèles)
L'Aqua Hose a été conçu pour assurer une protection parfaite
contre les fuites.Relié au tuyau d'arrivée d'eau, il coupe
automatiquement la circulation d'eau lorsque ce tuyau est
endommagé. Il affiche également un voyant d'avertissement.
• Raccordez le tuyau d'arrivée d'eau au robinet comme
indiqué sur l'image.
✗
✗
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 19 2012-4-16 13:08:2920_ Installer le lave-linge
Raccordement du tuyau de vidange
L’extrémité du tuyau de vidange peut être positionnée de trois façons différentes :
1. Sur le bord d’un lavabo : le tuyau de vidange doit être positionné à une hauteur comprise
entre 60 et 90 cm.Pour que le bout du tuyau reste coudé, utilisez le guide-tuyau en plastique
fourni. Fixez le guide au mur avec un crochet ou au robinet avec un lien, afin que le tuyau de
vidange ne bouge pas.
2. Raccordé au tuyau d’évacuation du lavabo : le tuyau d’évacuation doit être situé au-dessus
du siphon du lavabo, afin que son extrémité soit au moins à 60 cm du sol.
3. Sur un tuyau d’évacuation : il est conseillé d’utiliser un tuyau vertical de 65 cm (sa longueur
doit être comprise entre 60 cm et 90 cm).
Le tuyau d'évacuation nécessite :
• un diamètre minimum de 5 cm.
• un capacité minimum de vidange de 60 litres par
minute.
ETApE 5
Mettre votre lave-linge sous tension
Branchez le cordon d'alimentation dans une prise murale, AC de 220-240V / 50Hz une prise de
courant approuvé et protégée par un fusible ou un disjoncteur. (Pour obtenir plus d’informations
sur les exigences électriques et de mise à la terre, reportez-vous à la page 14.)
ETApE 6
Mode de calibrage
Le lave-linge Samsung détecte le poids du linge automatiquement. Pour une détection plus
précise du poids, exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation. Pour exécuter le mode de
calibrage, suivez les étapes ci-dessous.
1. Retirez le linge de la machine et éteignez-la.
2. Appuyez simultanément sur les boutons Température et Arrêt différé, puis appuyez
également sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt. La machine s'allume.
3. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ pour activer le Mode de calibrage.
4. Le tambour tourne dans le sens horaire et anti-horaire pendant environ 3 minutes.
5. Lorsque le «Mode de calibrage» est terminé, «End(En)» (Fin) apparaît à l'écran, et la mach
ine s'éteint automatiquement. Le lave-linge est maintenant prêt à être utilisé.
Installer le lave-linge
Tuyau de vidange
guide-tuyau
60 ~ 90 cm
60 ~ 90 cm
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 20 2012-4-16 13:08:33Effectuer un lavage _21
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Effectuer un lavage
Avec le nouveau lave-linge Samsung, le plus difficile consiste à décider quelle
catégorie de linge laver en premier.
preMier LAvAge
Avant de laver du linge pour la première fois, vous devez effectuer un cycle complet à vide (c’est-
à-dire sans charger de linge dans le tambour).
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
2. Versez votre dose de lessive dans le bac prévu à cet effet
du tiroir à lessive.
3. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau du lave-linge.
4. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
Cette opération permet de vidanger l’eau qui aurait pu
rester dans le lave-linge après le test du fabricant.
bac : lessive pour le prélavage ou amidon.
bac : lessive pour le lavage principal, adoucissant, agent de prétrempage, produit
blanchissant et détachant.
Pour employer de la lessive liquide, utilisez le compartiment à lessive liquide (reportez-vous
en page 29 du manuel pour voir le modèle correspondant). Ne versez pas de lessive en
poudre dans le compartiment à lessive liquide.
bac : additifs, de l’assouplissant par exemple (ne pas dépasser le bord inférieur MAX du bac
« A »).
CoNSigNeS ÉLÉMeNTAireS
1. Chargez votre linge dans le tambour.
Ne surchargez pas le lave-linge. Pour déterminer la capacité correspondant à chaque type
de linge, reportez-vous au tableau de la page 28.
• Assurez-vous que le linge n’est pas pris dans la porte, car cela risquerait de provoquer
une fuite d’eau.
• Après un cycle de lavage, il se peut que de la lessive subsiste dans la partie avant en
caoutchouc du lave-linge. Si tel est le cas, retirez ces résidus afin d’éviter toute fuite
d’eau.
• Ne lavez pas les vêtements imperméables.
2. Fermez le hublot jusqu’à ce qu’il s’enclenche.
3. Mettez l’appareil sous tension.
4. Versez de la lessive et les éventuels additifs dans le distributeur.
5. Sélectionnez les options et le programme appropriés à la charge de linge.
Le voyant du lave-linge s’allume et une estimation de la durée du programme apparaît alors
sur l’afficheur.
6. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 21 2012-4-16 13:08:3522_ Effectuer un lavage
pANNeAu de CoMMANde
AffICHAgE
NUMéRIQUE
Affiche le temps restant du cycle de lavage, toutes les informations
relatives au programme et les messages d’erreur.
SéLECTEUR DE
pROgRAMME
Sélectionnez le schéma de rotation et la vitesse d’essorage du
programme.
Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à la section « Laver du linge
à l’aide du sélecteur de programme » (voir page 26).
Coton - Cotons, draps, linge de table, sous-vêtements, serviettes,
chemises, etc. peu ou moyennement sales.
Synthétiques - Chemisiers, chemises, etc., peu ou moyennement sales,
en polyester (Diolen, Trevira), polyamide (Perlon, Nylon) ou autre matière
similaire.
Jeans - Un niveau d’eau plus élevé pour le lavage principal et un rinçage
supplémentaire garantissent l’élimination totale de la lessive, ce qui
permet d’éviter l’apparition de marques sur vos vêtements.
Literie - Draps, draps-housses, housses de couette, etc.
Lavez au maximum 2 kg de linge de lit du même type pour obtenir
de meilleurs résultats.
vêtements noirs - Grâce à des cycles de rinçage supplémentaires
et à un essorage réduit, vos vêtements sombres favoris sont lavés
délicatement et parfaitement rincés.
Lavage quotidien - Ce programme est destiné au lavage des vêtements
de tous les jours, tels que les sous-vêtements et les chemises.
Programme court pour les instituts de contrôle.
Lavage du tambour - Permet de nettoyer le tambour. Élimine la saleté
et les bactéries dans le tambour. Une utilisation régulière (toutes les 40
lessives) est recommandée. Aucun produit de nettoyage ou agent de
blanchiment n'est nécessaire.
Cycle bébé - Le lavage à haute température et les rinçages
supplémentaires permettent d’éliminer totalement les résidus de lessive
afin de préserver les textiles délicats.
vêtements de sport - Destiné aux vêtements résistants et
imperméables, ce programme conserve l’aspect de votre linge et lui
redonne toute sa fraîcheur.
Effectuer un lavage
2 1 3 4 5 6 7 10 9 8 12 11 13
1
2
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 22 2012-4-16 13:08:36Effectuer un lavage _23
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Lavage à la main - Programme de lavage très léger, aussi délicat qu’un
lavage à la main.
Laine - Uniquement pour les lainages lavables en machine. La charge
de vêtements doit être inférieure à 2 kg.
• Pendant le lavage, le doux bercement et le trempage du linge
continuent pour protéger les fibres de laine de tout rétrécissement
/ déformation et pour un nettoyage extrêmement délicat. L’arrêt de
cette opération ne pose aucun problème.
• Il est conseillé d’utiliser de la lessive neutre avec le programme laine afin
d’obtenir un meilleur résultat de lavage et pour un meilleur soin des fibres
de laine.
vidange - Vidange simplement l’eau du lave-linge sans essorer.
essorage - Effectue un cycle d’essorage supplémentaire afin d’éliminer
le plus d’eau possible du linge.
rinçage+essorage - Utilisez ce programme pour le linge qui n’a besoin
que d’un rinçage ou pour ajouter un adoucissant à une lessive.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE LA
TEMpéRATURE
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes températures disponibles :
( (Eau froide: Tous les voyants sont éteints), 20˚C, 30˚C, 40˚C , 60˚C en 95˚C).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
RINÇAgE
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour ajouter des cycles de rinçage. (cinq cycles
au maximum).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE
L’ESSORAgE
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes vitesses d’essorage disponibles.
WF710 / WF712
Tous les voyants sont éteints, , 400, 800, 1200,
1400 tr/min
«Sans essorage » - le linge reste dans le tambour et aucun essorage
n’est effectué après la dernière vidange.
«Arrêt cuve pleine (Tous les voyants sont éteints)» - le linge trempe
dans la dernière eau de rinçage. Avant de pouvoir décharger le linge, un
cycle « Vidange » ou « Essorage » doit être effectué.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION OpTION
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes options de lavage :
(Trempage) (Intensif) (Prélavage) (Trempage) +
(Intensif) (Trempage) + (Prélavage) (Intensif) +
(Prélavage) (Trempage) + (Intensif) + (Prélavage) (arrêt)
“Prélavage”: Appuyez sur ce bouton pour sélectionner un prélavage. La
fonction de prélavage est disponible uniquement avec les programmes
suivants : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Literie, Vêtements noirs, Lavage
quotidien, Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport.
«Intensif »: appuyez sur ce bouton lorsque le linge est très sale et qu’un
lavage intensif s’avère nécessaire. Cela a pour effet d’augmenter la durée
de chaque cycle de lavage.
«Trempage»: utilisez cette option pour enlever efficacement les tachesde
votre linge en le faisant tremper.
• 13 minutes du cycle de lavage sont consacrées à la fonction
Trempage.
• La fonction Trempage continue pendant 30 minutes avec six cycles,
où les cycles de trempage durent 1 minute et se répètent toutes les
4 minutes.
• La fonction Trempage est disponible uniquement pour les
programmes de lavage suivants : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Literie,
Lavage quotidien, Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport.
5
3
4
6
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 23 2012-4-16 13:08:3924_ Effectuer un lavage
bOUTON ARRÊT
SON
Le son peut être désactivé pour tous les programmes. Lorsque cette
fonction est active, le son est coupé pour tous les cycles.
• Lorsque la fonction Arrêt son est activée, un signal sonore retentit
et le voyant du bouton Arrêt son et le témoin « Arrêt son » sur
l’afficheur sont allumés.
• Lorsque la fonction Arrêt son est désactivée, un signal sonore retentit
et le voyant du bouton ainsi que le témoin « Arrêt son » sur l’afficheur
sont éteints.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
ARRÊT DIfféRé
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes options de arrêt différé (de 3 à 19 heures, par tranches d’une
heure).
L’heure affichée est celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
LAVAgE ExpRESS
Pour le linge peu sale (2 kg maximum) dont vous avez besoin
rapidement. Ce programme dure environ 15 minutes, mais peut différer
des valeurs indiquées en fonction de la pression, de la dureté et dela
température de l'eau, de la température ambiante, du type et de la
quantité de linge à laver et de son degré de salissure, de la lessive
utilisée, de l'équilibrage de la charge, des variations de tension et des
options sélectionnées.
• Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour sélectionner la
durée du programme : 15min 20min 30min 40min 50min
60min Arrêt
La quantité de lessive en poudre ou liquide doit être inférieure à 20
g (pour une charge de 2 kg) ; à défaut, le linge pourra comporter
des traces de lessive.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE
REpASSAgE fACILE
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour sélectionner un Repassage facile. utilisez
cette option pour préparer votre linge afin qu’il puisse être repassé
facilement.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION MON
CyCLE
Permet de programmer votre cycle préféré (température, essorage,
degré de salissure, option, etc.).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DépART/
pAUSE
Ce bouton permet d’interrompre et de relancer un cycle.
bOUTON MARCHE/
ARRÊT
Si vous appuyez une première fois sur ce bouton, le lave-linge se mettra
en marche ; appuyez une deuxième fois et il s’arrêtera.
Si le lave-linge reste allumé plus de 10 minutes sans que l’on appuie sur
aucun bouton, il s’éteindra automatiquement.
Effectuer un lavage
10
AverTiSSeMeNT
11
9
7
8
12
13
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 24 2012-4-16 13:08:40Effectuer un lavage _25
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Sécurité enfant
La fonction Sécurité enfant vous permet de verrouiller les boutons afin que le cycle de lavage
que vous avez choisi ne puisse être modifié.
Activation/Désactivation
Pour activer/désactiver la fonction Sécurité enfant, appuyez
simultanément sur les boutons Température et Rinçage
pendant 3 secondes. Le témoin « Sécurité enfant » est allumé
lorsque cette fonction est activée.
Lorsque la fonction Sécurité enfant est activée, seul le
bouton Marche/Arrêt fonctionne. Cette fonction reste
active même après que le lave-linge a été éteint et rallumé
ou débranché et rebranché.
Arrêt son
La fonction Son désactivé peut être sélectionnée dans tous les programmes. Lorsqu’elle est
active, le son est coupé dans tous les programmes. Le réglage reste en vigueur même si vous
éteignez et allumez l’appareil à plusieurs reprises.
Activation/Désactivation
Pour activer/désactiver la fonction Arrêt son, appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt son. Le témoin « Arrêt
son » et le voyant du bouton Arrêt son sont allumés lorsque cette fonction est activée.
Arrêt différé
Vous pouvez programmer votre lave-linge pour que le cycle de lavage se termine
automatiquement plus tard, en choisissant un arrêt différé de 3 à 19 heures (par tranches d’une
heure). L’heure affichée correspond à celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
1. Programmez manuellement ou automatiquement votre lave-linge en fonction du type de linge
à laver.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt différé à plusieurs reprises jusqu’à obtenir le arrêt différé
souhaité.
3. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause. Le témoin « Arrêt différé » s’allume et l’horloge
commence le compte à rebours jusqu’à atteindre l’heure définie.
4. Pour annuler la fonction Arrêt différé, appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt puis remettez le
lave-linge en marche.
3 SeC.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 25 2012-4-16 13:08:4226_ Effectuer un lavage
Effectuer un lavage
Mon cycle
Permet d'activer votre programme de lavage personnalisé (température, essorage, souillure, etc.) à l'aide
d'un seul bouton.
Appuyez sur le bouton Mon cycle pour charger et utiliser les options Mon cycle enregistrées. Le voyant
« Mon cycle » indique que ce mode est activé. Les voyants du programme et des options sélectionnés
clignotent.
Vous pouvez régler toutes les options en mode Mon cycle comme suit.
1. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
3. Sélectionnez le programme souhaité à l'aide du Sélecteur de programme.
4. Définissez ensuite les options de votre choix.
Voir le Tableau des programmes en page 37 pour connaître les options possibles pour chaque
programme.
5. Vous pouvez ensuite enregistrer le programme et les options sélectionnés en appuyant sur le bouton
Mon cycle pendant plus de 3 secondes, en mode Mon cycle préféré. Le programme et les options
que vous sélectionnez s’afficheront la prochaine fois que vous sélectionnerez Mon cycle.
Vous pouvez modifier la configuration du programme Mon cycle en répétant la procédure indiquée
ci-dessus. La dernière configuration défi nie s'affichera la prochaine fois que vous utiliserez le
programme Mon cycle.
Si vous relâchez le bouton avant les 3 secondes, le programme et les options précédemment
enregistrés s'affichent. Si vous appuyez sur le bouton Mon cycle pendant 3 secondes ou plus, le
programme et les options actuellement sélectionnés sont enregistrés et la DEL clignote pendant 3
secondes.
Laver du linge à l’aide du sélecteur de programme
Votre nouveau lave-linge vous simplifie la tâche grâce au système de contrôle automatique « Fuzzy
Control » de Samsung. Lorsque vous choisissez un programme, le lave-linge définit les options appropriées
en matière de température, de temps et de vitesse de lavage.
1. Ouvrez le robinet de votre lavabo.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt du lave-linge.
3. Ouvrez le hublot.
4. Chargez les articles un par un dans le tambour, sans les tasser ni surcharger le lave-linge.
5. Fermez le hublot.
6. Ajoutez de la lessive et, si nécessaire, de l’adoucissant ou du liquide de prélavage dans les bacs
appropriés.
La fonction de prélavage n’est disponible qu’avec les programmes Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans,
Délicat, Vêtements noirs, Lavage quotidien, Cycle bébé et Vêtements de sport. Effectuez un cycle de
prélavage uniquement si le linge à laver est très sale.
7. Utilisez le Sélecteur de programme pour sélectionner le programme approprié en fonction du type
de linge : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Délicat, Vêtements noirs, Lavage quotidien, Lavage du tambour,
Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport, Lavage à la main, Laine. Le voyant correspondant au programme
sélectionné s’allume sur le panneau de commande.
8. À ce stade, vous pouvez contrôler la température de lavage, le nombre de cycles de rinçage, la vitesse
d’essorage et le délai de arrêt différé en appuyant sur le bouton correspondant.
9. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour lancer le cycle de lavage. L’indicateur de progression
s’allume et le temps de lavage restant apparaît à l’écran.
Option pause
Il est possible d’ajouter ou de retirer du linge dans les 5 minutes qui suivent le début du cycle de lavage.
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour déverrouiller le hublot.
Le hublot est bloqué si l’eau est trop CHAUDE ou son niveau trop ÉLEVÉ.
2. Après avoir refermé le hublot, appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour redémarrer le cycle de
lavage.
Lorsque le programme est terminé :
À la fin du programme, le lave-linge s’arrête automatiquement.
1. Ouvrez le hublot.
2. Sortez le linge.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 26 2012-4-16 13:08:43Effectuer un lavage _27
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Laver du linge en mode manuel
Vous pouvez laver des vêtements en fonction manuelle, sans utiliser le sélecteur de programme.
1. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt du lave-linge.
3. Ouvrez le hublot.
4. Chargez les articles un par un dans le tambour, sans les tasser ni surcharger le lave-linge.
5. Fermez le hublot.
6. Ajoutez de la lessive et, si nécessaire, de l’adoucissant ou du liquide de prélavage dans les
bacs appropriés.
7. Appuyez sur le bouton Température pour choisir la température. ( (Eau froide: Tous les
voyants sont éteints), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C, 60 ˚C, 95 ˚C)
8. Appuyez sur le bouton Rinçage pour choisir le nombre de cycles de rinçage
(cinq cycles au maximum).
La durée du lavage augmente en conséquence.
9. Appuyez sur le bouton Essorage pour choisir la vitesse d’essorage.
( : Sans essorage, Tous les voyants sont éteints : Arrêt cuve pleine)
10. Appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt différé à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les différentes
options disponibles (de 3 à 19 heures, par tranches d’une heure). L’heure affichée
correspond à celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
11. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour lancer le cycle de lavage.
iNSTruCTioNS de LAvAge
Suivez ces instructions afin d’obtenir un linge parfaitement propre et d’utiliser votre lave-linge de la manière
la plus efficace qui soit.
Vérifiez toujours le symbole textile sur le vêtement avant de procéder au lavage.
Triez et lavez votre linge en fonction des critères suivants :
• Symbole textile : séparez le coton, les fibres mélangées, les synthétiques, la soie, la laine et
les rayonnes.
• Couleurs : séparez le blanc et les couleurs. Lavez les vêtements de couleur neufs
séparément.
• Taille : placer des vêtements de tailles différentes dans la même charge améliore l’action du
lavage.
• Sensibilité : lavez les articles délicats séparément, en utilisant le cycle de lavage Délicats pour
les articles neufs en laine vierge et en soie, ainsi que pour les rideaux. Vérifiez les étiquettes
des articles que vous lavez ou reportez-vous au tableau des symboles textile en annexe.
vider les poches
Avant chaque lessive, videz toutes les poches des vêtements à laver. Les petits objets durs
de forme irrégulière comme les pièces, couteaux, punaises ou trombones risquent en effet
d’endommager votre lave-linge. Évitez de laver des vêtements comportant de grandes boucles,
des boutons ou d’autres accessoires en métal lourd.
Toute pièce métallique présente sur un vêtement risque d’endommager le linge et le tambour.
Mettez les vêtements pourvus de boutons ou de broderies sur l’envers avant de les laver.
Veillez à fermer les fermetures à glissière des pantalons et vestes afin de ne pas endommager
le tambour. Les fermetures à glissière doivent être maintenues fermées à l’aide d’un fil avant le
lavage.
Les vêtements pourvus de lanières peuvent s’emmêler avec d’autres vêtements, ce qui risque
de les abîmer. Veillez à attacher ensemble les lanières avant de lancer le cycle de lavage.
prélaver du coton
Lorsqu’il est associé aux lessives modernes, votre nouveau lave-linge donne de parfaits résultats
tout en permettant d’économiser de l’énergie, du temps, de l’eau et de la lessive. Toutefois, si
vos cotons sont particulièrement sales, utilisez un programme de prélavage avec une lessive
protéinique.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 27 2012-4-16 13:08:4328_ Effectuer un lavage
Évaluer la capacité de chargement
Ne surchargez pas le lave-linge, sans quoi votre linge ne sera pas lavé correctement. Utilisez
le tableau ci-dessous afin de déterminer la charge maximale autorisée en fonction du type de
textile.
Type de textile Capacité
Modèle WF710 / WF712
Coton
- légèrement/moyennement sale
- très sale
7,0 kg
Synthétiques 2,5 kg
Jeans 3,0 kg
Literie 2,0 kg
vêtements de sport 2,5 kg
Laine 2,0 kg
• Si la charge de linge n’est pas équilibrée (le message «UE» s’affiche), rééquilibrez-la.
Un mauvais équilibrage de la charge risque de réduire l’efficacité de l’essorage.
• Lorsque vous lavez des draps ou des couettes, il se peut que la durée de lavage soit
allongée ou que l’efficacité de l’essorage soit moindre.
• Pour ce type d’article, la capacité maximale conseillée est de 2,0 kg.
Assurez-vous de placer les soutien-gorge (lavables à l’eau) dans un sac à linge (à
acheter séparément).
• Les parties métalliques de la structure peuvent en effet sortir du
soutien-gorge et endommager le linge. Il est donc conseillé de les
insérer dans un sac à linge fin.
• Les vêtements légers et de petite taille, tels que les chaussettes,
gants, bas et mouchoirs, peuvent se coincer entre le hublot et la
paroi du lave-linge. Placez-les dans un sac à linge fin.
Ne lavez pas le sac à linge seul, sans linge. Ceci pourrait provoquer des vibrations
anormales susceptibles d’entraîner des déplacements intempestifs de la machine ou des
accidents impliquant des blessures.
iNforMATioNS Sur LA LeSSive eT LeS AddiTifS
quelle lessive utiliser ?
La lessive à utiliser dépend du type de tissu (coton, synthétiques, vêtements délicats, laine), de
la couleur, de la température de lavage et du degré de salissure. Utilisez toujours une lessive qui
mousse peu, prévue pour les lave-linge automatiques.
Respectez les recommandations du fabricant de la lessive ; celles-ci ont été élaborées en
fonction du poids du linge, du degré de salissure et de la dureté de l’eau de votre région. Si vous
ne connaissez pas le degré de dureté de l’eau de votre région, renseignez-vous auprès des
autorités locales.
N’utilisez pas de lessive qui a durci ou s’est solidifiée, car elle risque de ne pas se dissoudre
complètement avant le cycle de rinçage. Par conséquent, le rinçage ne s’effectuera pas
correctement ou le trop-plein risque de se bloquer.
veuillez prendre note des éléments suivants lors de l’utilisation du programme laine.
• Utilisez une lessive liquide neutre pour laine.
• Lorsque vous utilisez de la lessive en poudre, il pourrait rester des résidus de lessive
dans le linge pouvant alors abimer la matière (laine).
Effectuer un lavage
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 28 2012-4-16 13:08:44Effectuer un lavage _29
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Tiroir à lessive
Votre lave-linge dispose de bacs séparés (pour la lessive et pour l’adoucissant). Répartissez tous
les additifs de lavage dans leurs bacs respectifs avant de démarrer votre lave-linge.
N'ouvrez pas le tiroir à lessive pendant que votre lave-linge effectue un cycle : de l'eau ou
de la vapeur brûlante risque de s'en dégager.
1. Ouvrez le tiroir à lessive situé sur le côté gauche du panneau de commande.
2. Ajoutez la quantité recommandée de lessive directement dans le bac à lessive avant de
démarrer votre lave-linge.
Si vous souhaitez utiliser de la lessive liquide, utilisez le
compartiment prévu à cet effet (reportez-vous à la section
« Lessive liquide » pour voir le modèle correspondant).
• Ne versez pas de lessive en poudre dans le compartiment
à lessive liquide.
3. Le cas échéant, ajoutez la quantité recommandée
d’adoucissant dans le bac à adoucissant . NE
DÉPASSEZ PAS le trait de remplissage maximum ( ).
Ne mettez JAMAIS de lessive liquide ou en poudre dans
le compartiment réservé à l'adoucissant ( ).
4. Si vous utilisez l’option de prélavage, ajoutez la quantité
recommandée de lessive dans le bac de prélavage .
N’utilisez PAS les types de lessive suivants lorsque vous
lavez des articles volumineux :
• Lessives en tablettes ou en capsules
• Lessives nécessitant une boule doseuse et un filet
Si l’assouplissant est sous forme concentrée ou épaisse,
diluez-le dans un peu d’eau avant de le verser dans le
bac afin d’empêcher le blocage du trop-plein.
Veillez à ce que l’assouplissant ne déborde pas lorsque vous fermez le tiroir à lessive après
avoir ajouté de l’assouplissant dans le compartiment à lessive de rinçage.
Lessive liquide (sur certains modèles)
Si vous souhaitez utiliser de la lessive liquide, placez le compartiment à lessive liquide dans
la partie lavage principal du tiroir à lessive et versez-y la lessive
liquide.
• NE DÉPASSEZ PAS le trait de remplissage maximum.
• Si vous utilisez une lessive en poudre, retirez le
compartiment à lessive liquide du tiroir à lessive. Les
lessives en poudre ne seront pas absorbées si vous les
placez dans le compartiment à lessive liquide.
• Après le lavage, il se peut qu'il y ait encore un peu de
liquide dans le tiroir à lessive.
MAX
Compartiment
à lessive
liquide
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 29 2012-4-16 13:08:4630_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
Il est essentiel de bien entretenir votre lave-linge pour en améliorer ses
performances, éviter les réparations inutiles et allonger sa durée de vie.
LAvAge du TAMbour
Ce programme de nettoyage automatique permet d'éliminer les moisissures
pouvant se former à l'intérieur du lave-linge.
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
2. Positionnez le Sélecteur de programme sur le programme
Lavage du tambour.
• Vous pouvez utiliser uniquement la fonction Arrêt différé.
• La température de l'eau lors du programme Lavage du
tambour est réglée sur 70 ˚C.
Selon les caractéristiques de la machine à laver, la
température de l'eau est fixée à 70 ˚C au cours du cycle Lavage du tambour, mais l'écran ne
peut afficher que 60 ˚ C sur le panneau de contrôle.
La température ne peut pas être modifiée.
• Il sera automatiquement fixé en coton à 30 ˚ C du programme niveau d'eau lorsque le
vêtement est mis en dedans.
3. Placez la quantité de produit de nettoyage appropriée dans
le bac à lessive , puis refermez le tiroir (dans le cas où un
produit de nettoyage est utilisé pour nettoyer le tambour).
• Veillez à utiliser un produit de nettoyage recommandé
pour le nettoyage du tambour.
• Il existe des produits de nettoyage de tambour sous
forme poudre ou liquide. Les produits nettoyants
sous forme liquide ne doivent être utilisées qu'avec le
compartiment à lessive liquide (en option).
4. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
• Lorsque vous appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause, le programme Lavage du tambour
démarre.
• Avec ce programme, vous pouvez tout à fait nettoyer le tambour sans utiliser de produit de
nettoyage.
• Ne lancez jamais le programme Lavage du tambour si du linge est présent dans le tambour.
Cela risquerait d'endommager le linge ou la machine.
• N'utilisez jamais de produit nettoyant standard avec le programme Lavage du
tambour.
• Utilisez uniquement 1/10 de la quantité de produit de nettoyage de tambour
recommandée par le fabriquant du produit.
• L'utilisation d'un produit de blanchiment chloré risque de décolorer la machine ; utilisez
uniquement un produit de blanchiment à l'eau oxygénée.
• Produit de nettoyage en poudre: utilisez un produit de blanchiment en poudre ou un produit
de nettoyage spécial tambour uniquement.
• Produit de nettoyage liquide : utilisez un produit de blanchiment liquide à l'eau oxygénée ou
un produit de nettoyage spécial tambour uniquement.
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 30 2012-4-16 13:08:48Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge _31
03 Nettoyage et eNtretieN
Message d'avertissement automatique de Lavage du tambour
• Si l’indicateur «Lavage du tambour» sur l’écran restent
allumés après un lavage, ceci signifie qu’un nettoyage du
bac (tambour) est nécessaire. Dans ce cas, retirez le linge de
la machine, allumez la machine puis nettoyez le tambour en
lançant le programme Lavage du tambour.
• Si vous n’effectuez pas le mode Lavage du tambour,
l’indicateur «Lavage du tambour» sur l’écran seront
éteints. Cependant, l'indicateur «Nettoyage tambour» sur
l'écran et la lampe sur le Sélecteur de programme restent
de nouveau allumés après deux lavages effectués. Cela
n'entraînera cependant aucun problème avec le lave-linge.
• Bien que généralement, le signal d'alarme automatique de
nettoyage du tambour s'affiche environ une fois par mois,
il est possible que son apparition varie en fonction de la fréquence d'utilisation du lave-linge.
• Lorsque cette alarme se déclenche, nettoyez également le filtre à impuretés
(reportez-vous à la section « Nettoyage du fi ltre à impuretés » en page 33). Dans le
cas contraire la performance de la fonction bulle peut être réduite.
vidANger Le LAve-LiNge eN urgeNCe
1. Débranchez le lave-linge de l’alimentation électrique.
2. Ouvrez le capot du filtre en utilisant une pièce de monnaie
ou une clé.
3. Tirez le le tuyau de vidange d’urgence afin de le détacher
de son guide.
4. Retirez le bouchon de vidange d’urgence obturant le tuyau
de vidange d’urgence.
5. Laissez l’eau s’écouler dans un récipient.
Il pourrait rester plus d’eau que vous ne le pensez.
Préparez une cuvette plus grande.
6. Remettez le bouchon sur le tuyau de vidange
d’urgence,puis fixez le tuyau sur son guide.
7. Remettez le capot du filtre en place.
Capot du
filtre
Tuyau de
vidange
d’urgence
bouchon
de vidange
d’urgence
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 31 2012-4-16 13:08:5032_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
NeTToyAge du Tiroir à LeSSive eT du LogeMeNT du Tiroir
1. Appuyez sur la manette d’ouverture située à
l’intérieur du tiroir à lessive et retirez ce dernier.
2. Sortez le séparateur de lessive liquide du tiroir
à lessive.
3. Lavez tous les éléments à l’eau claire.
4. Nettoyez le logement du tiroir à l’aide d’une vieille brosse à
dents.
5. Replacez le séparateur de lessive liquide dans le tiroir en
appuyant fermement dessus.
6. Remettez le tiroir en place.
7. Pour enlever tout résidu de lessive, lancez un programme
de rinçage sans mettre de linge dans le tambour.
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
Manette d’ouverture
Compartiment à
lessive liquide (sur
certains modèles)
Séparateur de lessive
liquide
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 32 2012-4-16 13:08:52Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge _33
03 Nettoyage et eNtretieN
NeTToyAge du fiLTre à iMpureTÉS
Il est conseillé de nettoyer le filtre à impuretés 5 à 6 fois par an ou lorsque le message d’erreur « 5E »
s’affiche. (Reportez-vous à la section « Vidanger le lave-linge en urgence » en page précédente.)
Avant de nettoyer le filtre à résidus, veillez à débrancher le cordon d’alimentation.
1. Enlevez d’abord le reste de l’eau (consultez « Vidanger le
lave-linge en urgence » page 31).
Si vous séparez le filtre sans vidanger l’eau, celle-ci
pourrait s’écouler de l’appareil.
2. Ouvrez le capot du filtre en utilisant une pièce de monnaie
ou une clé.
3. Dévissez le bouchon de vidange d’urgence en tournant
vers la gauche et vidangez toute l’eau.
4. Dévissez le bouchon du filtre à impuretés.
5. Retirez toute impureté et autre corps étranger pris dans
le filtre et nettoyez ce dernier. Assurez-vous que l’hélice
de la pompe de vidange située derrière le filtre n’est pas
bloquée.
6. Remettez en place le bouchon du filtre à impuretés.
7. Remettez le capot du filtre en place.
N’ouvrez pas le couvercle du filtre à résidus pendant que la machine
fonctionne car de l’eau chaude pourrait en être expulsée.
• Pensez à remettre le couvercle du filtre après avoir nettoyé le filtre. Si le filtre n’est pas dans la
machine, votre lave-linge pourrait ne pas fonctionner correctement ou une fuite d’eau pourrait
survenir.
• Le filtre doit être entièrement remonté après nettoyage.
NeTToyer L’exTÉrieur du LAve-LiNge
1. Essuyez les surfaces extérieures du lave-linge, y compris le panneau de commande, à l’aide
d’un chiffon doux et d’un produit d’entretien ménager non abrasif.
2. Utilisez un chiffon doux pour sécher les surfaces.
3. Ne versez pas d’eau sur le lave-linge.
bouchon
du filtre à
impuretés
ATTeNTioN
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 33 2012-4-16 13:08:5334_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
NeTToyer Le fiLTre à MAiLLe du TuyAu d’ArrivÉe d’eAu
Vous devez nettoyer le filtre à maille du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau au moins une fois par an ou lorsque le
message d’erreur « 4E » s’affiche :
1. Coupez l’alimentation en eau du lave-linge.
2. Dévissez le tuyau situé à l’arrière du lave-linge. Pour éviter les projections d’eau dues à l’air
sous pression contenu dans le tuyau, recouvrez ce dernier d’un linge.
3. À l’aide d’une pince, sortez doucement le filtre à maille du tuyau et rincez-le sous l’eau
jusqu’à ce qu’il soit propre. Nettoyez également l’intérieur et l’extérieur du raccord fileté.
4. Remettez le filtre en place.
5. Revissez le tuyau sur le lave-linge.
6. Assurez-vous que les raccords sont étanches et ouvrez le robinet.
rÉpArer uN LAve-LiNge qui A geLÉ
Si la température est descendue en dessous de 0 °C et que votre lave-linge a gelé :
1. Débranchez le lave-linge.
2. Versez de l’eau chaude sur le robinet pour assouplir le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
3. Retirez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau et immergez-le dans de l’eau chaude.
4. Versez de l’eau chaude dans le tambour du lave-linge et laissez agir 10 minutes.
5. Rebranchez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sur le robinet et vérifiez que l’arrivée d’eau et la vidange
fonctionnent normalement.
eNTrepoSer Le LAve-LiNge
Si vous devez entreposer votre lave-linge pendant une période prolongée, il est préférable de le vidanger
et de le débrancher. Les lave-linge peuvent être endommagés s’il reste de l’eau dans les tuyaux et les
composants internes avant l’entreposage.
1. Sélectionnez le cycle Express et versez un agent de blanchiment dans le bac d’agent de
blanchiment. Lancez un cycle complet à vide.
2. Fermez les robinets d’eau et débranchez les tuyaux d’alimentation.
3. Débranchez votre lave-linge de l’alimentation électrique et laissez le hublot ouvert pour laisser
l’air circuler à l’intérieur du tambour.
Si votre lave-linge a été entreposé à des températures inférieures au point de congélation,
attendez que l’eau gelée à l’intérieur dégèle avant de l’utiliser à nouveau.
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 34 2012-4-16 13:08:54Codes d’erreur et de dépannage _35
04 Dépannage
Codes d’erreur et de
dépannage
vÉrifiez LeS poiNTS SuivANTS Si...
pRObLÈME SOLUTION
votre lave-linge ne démarre
pas.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge est branché.
• Assurez-vous que le hublot est correctement fermé.
• Assurez-vous que le ou les robinets d’arrivée d’eau sont ouverts.
• Assurez-vous d’avoir appuyé sur le bouton Départ/Pause.
l’eau n’arrive pas ou le débit
est insuffisant.
• Ouvrez le robinet d’arrivée d’eau à fond.
• Assurez-vous que le tuyau d’eau n’est pas gelé.
• Démêlez les tuyaux d’arrivée d’eau.
• Nettoyez le filtre du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
il reste de la lessive dans
le tiroir à lessive à la fin du
programme de lavage.
• Assurez-vous que la pression d’eau est suffisante pour faire
fonctionner le lave-linge.
• Assurez-vous que de la lessive a été ajoutée dans le bac central du
tiroir à lessive.
votre lave-linge vibre ou est
trop bruyant.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge est installé sur une surface plane. Si
la surface n’est pas plane, ajustez les pieds réglables pour mettre le
lave-linge à niveau.
• Assurez-vous que les vis de transport ont été retirées.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge n’est en contact avec aucun autre
objet.
• Assurez-vous que la charge de linge est bien équilibrée.
le lave-linge ne vidange et/
ou n’essore pas.
• Démêlez tous les tuyaux. Vérifiez que les tuyaux ne sont pas emmêlés.
• Assurez-vous que le filtre à impuretés n’est pas bouché.
le hublot est verrouillé ou ne
s’ouvre pas.
• Assurez-vous que toute l’eau a été vidangée avant d’ouvrir le hublot.
• Assurez-vous que le hublot avant l’extinction du témoin de
verrouillage. Une fois le vidange terminé, le témoin de verrouillage du
hublot s’éteint.
La pompe de vidange
génère un bruit étrange.
• Vérifiez si la pompe de vidange est bloquée par des bourres de laine
ou de la saleté. Nettoyez le filtre à impuretés pour réduire le bruit.
Si le problème persiste, contactez le service clientèle de Samsung le plus proche.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 35 2012-4-16 13:08:5436_ Codes d’erreur et de dépannage
CodeS d’erreur
En cas de dysfonctionnement de votre lave-linge, un code peut apparaître sur l’afficheur. Si tel est le cas,
consultez le tableau ci-dessous et essayez la solution proposée avant de contacter le service clientèle de
Samsung.
CODE D’ERREUR SOLUTION
dE
• Assurez-vous que le hublot est correctement fermé.
• Assurez-vous que le linge n’est pas pris dans la porte.
4E
• Assurez-vous que le robinet d’eau est ouvert.
• Vérifiez la pression de l’eau.
5E
• Nettoyez le filtre à impuretés.
• Assurez-vous que le tuyau de vidange est correctement installé.
UE
• La charge de linge n’est pas équilibrée. Rééquilibrez la charge. Si vous
souhaitez laver un seul vêtement, par exemple un peignoir de bain
ou un jean, il se peut que le résultat final de l’essorage ne soit pas
satisfaisant et que le message d’erreur « UE » apparaisse à l’écran.
cE/3E • Contactez le service après-vente.
Sud
• Cette erreur survient lorsqu’une trop grande quantité de mousse
est détectée. Elle s’affiche également pendant que la mousse est
évacuée. Lorsque la mousse a été évacuée, le cycle normal reprend
(c’est l’une des opérations normales. Il s’agit d’un message d’erreur
pour éviter les défaillances de non-détection).
Uc
• Si la tension électrique fournie est instable, le lave-linge se met en
pause pour protéger ses équipements électriques.
• Si la tension correcte est fournie, le cycle reprend automatiquement.
Si un code non répertorié dans ce tableau s’affiche ou si la solution suggérée ne résout pas le problème,
contactez le service clientèle de Samsung ou votre revendeur Samsung.
Codes d’erreur et de
dépannage
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 36 2012-4-16 13:08:54Tableau des programmes _37
05 Tableau des programmes
Tableau des programmes
TAbLeAu deS progrAMMeS
( au choix)
pROgRAMME
Charge maxi.
(kg)
Lessive
Température
maxi. (˚C)
Vitesse d’essorage maxi. (tr/
min)
Wf710/Wf712 prélavage Lavage Adoucissant Wf710/Wf712
Coton 7,0 oui 95 1400
Synthétiques 2,5 oui 60 1200
Jeans 3,0 oui 60 800
Literie 2,0 oui 40 800
vêtements noirs 3,0 oui 40 1200
Lavage quotidien 2,0 oui 60 1400
Lavage du tambour - - oui - 70 400
Cycle bébé 3,0 oui 95 1400
vêtements de sport 2,5 oui 60 1200
Lavage à la main 2,0 - oui 40 400
Laine 2,0 - oui 40 800
pROgRAMME prélavage Intensif Trempage Arrêt différé Express
Repassage
facile
Coton
Synthétiques -
Jeans -
Literie -
vêtements noirs - -
Lavage quotidien -
Lavage du tambour - - - - -
Cycle bébé -
vêtements de sport -
Lavage à la main - - - - -
Laine - - - - -
1. Un prélavage allonge la durée du programme d’environ 18 minutes.
2. La durée d’un programme a été calculée selon les conditions spécifiées par la norme CEI 60456/EN
60456.
Exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation (voir page 20).
3. La durée des programmes en foyer individuel peut différer des valeurs données dans le tableau en
fonction des variations de pression et de température de l’arrivée d’eau, de la charge et du type de
linge.
4. Lorsque la fonction de lavage Intensif est sélectionnée, la durée de chaque programme augmente.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 37 2012-4-16 13:08:5538_ Annexe
Annexe
TAbLeAu deS SyMboLeS d’eNTreTieN deS TexTiLeS
Les symboles suivants offrent des conseils sur l’entretien des vêtements. Les symboles textile sont au
nombre de quatre ; ils sont généralement énumérés dans l’ordre suivant : lavage, blanchiment, séchage et
repassage et, au besoin, nettoyage à sec.
L’utilisation de ces symboles garantit la cohérence des informations entre les fabricants de vêtements
(articles domestiques ou importés). Observez les consignes associées à chaque symbole textile pour
optimiser la durée de vie de votre linge et limiter les problèmes de lavage.
Textile résistant Repassage à 100 ˚C maximum
Textile délicat Repassage interdit
Lavage à 95 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec avec tous les
dissolvants habituels
Lavage à 60 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec au percloréthylène,
aux dissolvants fluorés ou aux
essences minérales uniquement
Lavage à 40 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec aux essences
minérales uniquement
Lavage à 30 ˚C Nettoyage à sec interdit
Lavage à la main uniquement Séchage à plat
Nettoyage à sec uniquement Séchage sur cintre, sans essorage
Chlorage dilué à froid Séchage sur cintre
Chlorage interdit
Séchage en machine possible,
température modérée
Repassage à 200 ˚C maximum
Séchage en machine possible,
température basse
Repassage à 150 ˚C maximum Séchage en machine interdit
proTeCTioN de L’eNviroNNeMeNT
• Cet appareil a été fabriqué à partir de matériaux recyclables. Si vous souhaitez vous en séparer, veuillez
respecter les normes locales en vigueur en matière de mise au rebut des déchets. Coupez le cordon
d’alimentation de façon à ce que l’appareil ne puisse plus être raccordé à une source électrique. Retirez
le hublot afin d’éviter que de jeunes enfants ou des animaux ne se retrouvent piégés dans l’appareil.
• Ne dépassez pas les quantités de lessive préconisées par le fabricant de la lessive.
• N’utilisez de produits détachants et blanchissants avant le cycle de lavage qu’en cas d’absolue
nécessité.
• Économisez de l’eau et de l’électricité en ne faisant tourner que des charges pleines (la charge varie en
fonction du programme utilisé).
dÉCLArATioN de CoNforMiTÉ
Cet appareil est conforme aux normes européennes de sécurité, à la directive 93/68/CE et à la norme
EN 60335.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 38 2012-4-16 13:09:04Annexe _39
06 Annexe
fiCHe TeCHNique deS LAve-LiNge doMeSTiqueS
selon la réglementation (UE) n° 1061/2010
Samsung
Nom du modèle
WF710
WF712
Capacité kg 7
Classe énergétique
A + + + (plus haute efficacité) à d (plus basse efficacité) A+++
Consommation énergétique
Consommation d'énergie annuelle (Ae_C)
1)
kWh/an 175
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.60) coton 60 ° C en charge pleine kWh 0,85
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.60.1/2) coton 60 ° C en demi-charge kWh 0,86
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.40.1/2) coton 40 ° C en demi-charge kWh 0,59
Consommation en mode Éteint (p_o) W 0,45
Consommation en mode veille (p_i) W 5
Consommation d'eau annuelle (AW_c)
2)
l/an 9400
Classe d'efficacité d'essorage
3)
A (efficace) à g (peu efficace) B
vitesse d'essorage maximale tr/min 1400
Taux d'humidité résiduelle % 53
programmes auxquels les informations sur l'étiquette et la fiche technique renvoient Coton 60 ºC et 40 ºC + Intensif
4)
durée d’un programme standard
Coton à 60°C, en charge pleine min 225
Coton à 60°C, en demi-charge min 205
Coton à 40°C, en demi-charge min 185
durée en mode veille min 2
Niveau sonore
Lavage dB (A) re 1 pW 50
essorage dB (A) re 1 pW 74
dimensions
dimensions de l'appareil
Hauteur mm 850
Largeur mm 600
Profondeur
5) mm 550
poids net kg 62
poids brut kg 64
poids de l'emballage kg 2
pression de l'eau kPa 50-800
raccordement électrique
puissance V 220-240
Consommation W 2000-2400
fréquence Hz 50
Nom du fournisseur Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
1. La consommation d'énergie annuelle est basée sur les 220 cycles de lavage standard pour
les programmes coton à 60 °C et à 40 °C en charge pleine et en demi-charge, et sur la
consommation des modes de mise sous et hors tension. La consommation d'énergie réelle
dépendra de la façon dont l'appareil est utilisé.
2. La consommation d'eau annuelle est basée sur les 220 cycles de lavage standard pour les
programmes coton à 60 °C et à 40 °C en charge pleine et en demi-charge. La consommation
d'eau réelle dépendra de la façon dont l'appareil est utilisé.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 39 2012-4-16 13:09:0440_ Annexe
Annexe
3. La teneur en eau après essorage est très importante si vous faites sécher vos vêtements au sèche-linge.
La consommation d'énergie est bien plus élevée au cours d'un cycle de séchage qu'au cours d'un cycle de
lavage.
Plus la vitesse d'essorage est élevée, plus vous économiserez de l'énergie lors du séchage en machine.
4. Le « standard cotton 60 °C program » (programme standard pour coton à 60 ºC) et le « standard cotton 40
°C program » (programme standard pour coton à 40 ºC) pouvant être sélectionnés en combinant la fonction
de lavage intensif aux programmes pour coton à 60 ºC et à 40 ºC, sont conçus pour laver le linge en coton
normalement sale et constituent les programmes les plus efficaces (en ce qui concerne la consommation
électrique et la consommation d’eau) pour ce type de lavage.
Exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation (voir page 20).
Dans ces programmes, la température de l'eau réelle peut être différente de la température déclarée.
5. L'espace à respecter entre le mur et l'appareil n'est pas compris dans la profondeur indiquée.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 40 2012-4-16 13:09:05Mémo
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 41 2012-4-16 13:09:05WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 42 2012-4-16 13:09:05WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 43 2012-4-16 13:09:05DES QUESTIONS OU DES COMMENTAIRES ?
pays TéLépHONE SITE INTERNET
PAYS-BAS 0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864) (€ 0,10/Min) www.samsung.com
BELGIQUE 02-201-24-18
www.samsung.com/be (Dutch)
www.samsung.com/be_fr (French)
N° de code:DC68-03149H_FR
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 44 2012-4-16 13:09:05
Wasmachine
gebruiksaanwijzing
imagine… ongekende
mogelijkheden
Dank u voor het aanschaffen van dit Samsung-product.
Voor een uitgebreide service kunt u uw product registreren op
www.samsung.com/register
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
Deze handleiding is gemaakt van 100% gerecycled papier.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 1 2012-4-16 13:09:542_ de mogelijkheden van uw nieuwe samsung-wasmachine
de mogelijkheden van uw
nieuwe samsung-wasmachine
Met uw nieuwe wasmachine verandert uw kijk op de was volkomen. Uw Samsungwasmachine heeft alle eigenschappen – van de enorm grote capaciteit tot de
energiezuinigheid – om een alledaags karwei te veranderen in een aangename
bezigheid.
• Energiebesparing
Met de speciale bubbelgenerator en Samsung invertermotor biedt dit model een meer
efficiënt energiegebruik vergeleken met een standaard A-label wasmachine.
• Minder lawaai & trillingen
De Samsung wasmachine functioneert op een zeer rustige wijze. Lawaai en trillingen worden
dankzij de smart-regeltechnologie gereduceerd. Wegens minimale trillingen blijft de trommel
perfect in evenwicht.
• Kort programma
Geen tijd te verliezen? Met ons Kort programma van 15 minuten kunt u snel kleine wasjes
doen.Ons Snelwas kan u helpen bij uw drukke leven. Nu neemt het wassen van uw favoriete
kleding (tot 2 kg) slechts 15 minuten in beslag!
• Eco trommelreiniging
De functie Eco trommelreiniging helpt u de wasmachine schoon te houden, zonder
chemische reinigings- of bleekmiddelen. Met dit speciale reinigingsprogramma houd de
trommel schoon en reukloos.
• Babykleding
Uw Samsung-wasmachine heeft wasprogramma’s die bescherming geven aan de kleding van
kinderen met een gevoelige huid.
Deze programma’s minimaliseren huidirritatie bij kinderen door wasmiddelrestanten tot een
minimum terug te brengen. Daarbij plaatsen deze programma’s de was in verschillende
categorieën en worden wasprogramma’s uitgevoerd volgens de kenmerken van elke
categorie.
• Handwas
U kunt uw fijne was extra goed behandelen door het instellen van de juiste temperatuur, een
zachte wasactie en de correcte hoeveelheid water.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 2 2012-4-16 13:09:54de mogelijkheden van uw nieuwe samsung-wasmachine _3
• Kinderslot
Met het kinderslot kunnen onderzoekende kleine handjes uit de wasmachine worden
gehouden.
Deze beveiligingsfunctie voorkomt dat uw kinderen met de bediening van uw wasmachine
spelen en waarschuwt u wanneer deze wordt geactiveerd.
• Uitgesteld einde
U kunt een wasprogramma tot 19 uur uitstellen, in stappen van een uur. Handig wanneer u de
deur uit moet!
• Grafisch digitaal display
Het grafisch digitale bedieningspaneel display is duidelijk en eenvoudig te gebruiken
zonder gedoe of enig probleem. En terwijl het eenvoudig te bedienen is, maakt het grafisch
digitale display het mogelijk om snel en accuraat instellingen te kiezen voor uitstekende
wasresultaten.
• Aqua Hose en lekkagesensor (geselecteerde modellen)
Het slim ontworpen waterbeveiligingssysteem voor Samsung-wasmachines bevat een
intelligente slang voor het stoppen van waterlekkages aan de bron en een lekkagesensor
aan de onderkant. Als de slang breekt of als waterlekken worden gedetecteerd, wordt een
inwendige spons geactiveerd om water uit de tapkraan te blokkeren.
Deze gebruiksaanwijzing bevat belangrijke informatie over de installatie, het gebruik en het
onderhoud van uw nieuwe wasmachine van Samsung. Gebruik de gebruiksaanwijzing voor
beschrijvingen van het bedieningspaneel, instructies voor het gebruik van de wasmachine en
voor tips over hoe u het beste gebruikmaakt van de hoogstaande mogelijkheden en functies. Het
gedeelte “Problemen oplossen en foutcodes” op pagina 35 helpt u wanneer er iets verkeerd
gaat met uw nieuwe wasmachine.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 3 2012-4-16 13:09:544_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
veiligheidsvoorschriften
Gefeliciteerd met uw nieuwe Samsung ActivFresh™ wasmachine. Deze
Gebruiksaanwijzing bevat belangrijke informatie over installatie, gebruik en onderhoud
van uw apparaat. Neem even de tijd om deze Gebruiksaanwijzing te lezen zodat u
volop profijt hebt van de vele voordelen en mogelijkheden van uw wasmachine.
WAt U ovEr vEiliGHEidsvoorscHriftEn MoEt WEtEn
Lees deze Gebruiksaanwijzing zorgvuldig door zodat u zeker weet hoe u de uitgebreide mogelijkheden en functionaliteit
van uw nieuwe apparaat veilig en efficiënt kunt bedienen.Bewaar deze Gebruiksaanwijzing op een veilige plaats in de
nabijheid van de wasmachine zodat u hem later nog eens kunt raadplegen. Gebruik het apparaat uitsluitend voor het
doel.waarvoor het gemaakt is zoals in deze Gebruiksaanwijzing is beschreven.
Waarschuwingen en belangrijke veiligheidsinstructies in deze Gebruiksaanwijzing omvatten niet alle mogelijke
omstandigheden en situaties die zich kunnen voordoen. Het is uw verantwoordelijkheid om uw gezonde verstand
te gebruiken, voorzichtig te zijn en zorgvuldig te werk te gaan bij het installeren, onderhouden en bedienen van uw
wasmachine.
Omdat deze gebruiksaanwijzing betrekking heeft op verschillende modellen, kunnen de kenmerken van uw wasmachine
iets afwijken van de in dit handboek beschrevene en mogelijk zijn niet alle waarschuwingssymbolen op uw machine van
toepassing. Indien u nog vragen hebt of problemen neem dan contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum of
zoek online hulp en informatief op www.samsung.com.
BElAnGrijKE vEiliGHEidssyMBolEn En
voorzorGsMAAtrEGElEn
de betekenis van de symbolen en tekens in deze
gebruiksaanwijzing:
WAARSCHUWING
Gevaren of onveilige werkwijzen als gevolg waarvan dodelijk of ernstig
persoonlijk letsel en/of materiële schade kan ontstaan.
VOORZICHTIG
Gevaren of onveilige werkwijzen als gevolg waarvan persoonlijk letsel
en/of materiële schade kan ontstaan.
VOORZICHTIG
Houdt u aan onderstaande voorzorgsmaatregelen voor de veiligheid,
om het risico van brand, explosie, elektrische schok of persoonlijk letsel
tijdens het gebruik van uw wasmachine te beperken:
NIET.proberen.
NIET demonteren.
NIET aanraken.
Houdt u nadrukkelijk aan de aanwijzingen.
Trek de netstekker uit de wandcontactdoos.
Zorg ervoor dat de machine is geaard om een elektrische schok te
vermijden.
Vraag de servicedienst om hulp.
Opmerking
deze waarschuwingstekens staan er om letsel bij uzelf en bij anderen te voorkomen.
Houdt u er alstublieft nadrukkelijk aan.
Bewaar dit hoofdstuk na het lezen op een veilige plaats om het later nog eens te kunnen
raadplegen.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 4 2012-4-16 13:09:58veiligheidsvoorschriften _5
Lees alle instructies voordat u het apparaat in gebruik neemt.
Net als bij alle andere elektrische apparatuur met bewegende delen, bestaan er altijd
mogelijke risico’s. Om het apparaat veilig te kunnen gebruiken moet de manier waarop het
werkt u vertrouwd zijn en moet u altijd voorzichtig zijn wanneer u het gebruikt.
Laat kinderen (of huisdieren) nooit op of in het apparaat spelen. De deur van de wasmachine gaat van
binnenuit niet open en kinderen kunnen ernstig verwond raken wanneer ze opgesloten worden.
Personen (hier worden ook kinderen onder verstaan) die beperkte fysieke, zintuiglijke of geestelijke
mogelijkheden hebben, of die het ontbreekt aan ervaring en/of kennis, mogen het apparaat niet
gebruiken, tenzij zij onder toezicht staan van iemand die verantwoordelijk is voor hun veiligheid, of
tenzij deze persoon ze heeft geïnstrueerd over het gebruik van het apparaat.
Kinderen moeten onder toezicht staan zodat zeker is dat zij niet met het apparaat spelen.
Indien de stekker (of het snoer) is beschadigd moet, om risico te vermijden, de fabrikant of diens
servicemonteur of een gelijkwaardig gekwalificeerde het vervangen.
Het apparaat moet zo worden geplaatst dat het snoer voldoende lang is om een wandcontactdoos te
bereiken en dat de wateraansluiting en de afvoer binnen bereik zijn.
Bij wasmachines die aan de onderzijde ventilatieopeningen hebben, moet erop worden gelet dat deze
niet worden versperd door vloerkleden of andere obstakels.
Gebruik de nieuwe slangen. Oude slangen moeten niet worden hergebruikt.
instrUctiEs ovEr MiliEUvriEndElijKE vUilAfvoEr
De juiste wijze van afvoeren van dit product (Afvoer van elektrische en
elektronische apparatuur)
(van toepassing in de Europese Gemeenschap en andere Europese landen met
gescheiden afvalinzamelingssystemen)
De markering op dit product, het toebehoren of de documentatie geeft aan dat het product en
zijn elektronische toebehoren (bijvoorbeeld. laadapparaat, hoofdtelefoon, USB -kabel) na de
gebruiksduur niet met het gewone huisvuil mag worden afgevoerd. Om mogelijke schade aan
het milieu of de volksgezondheid te voorkomen door illegale afvoer, deze voorwerpen apart
houden van andere soorten afval en laat ze op verantwoorde wijze recyclen voor een duurzaam
hergebruik van grondstoffen.
Voor nadere informatie over locaties waar en over hoe deze artikelen moeten worden ingeleverd
om milieuveilig te worden gerecycled, moeten particuliere gebruikers contact opnemen met de
winkelier waar ze het artikel hebben gekocht, of met het kantoor van de plaatselijke overheid.
Zakelijke gebruikers moeten contact opnemen met hun leverancier en de bepalingen en de
voorwaarden in het verkoopcontract erop naslaan. Dit product en zijn elektronische toebehoren
moeten bij het afvoeren niet met ander bedrijfsafval worden gemengd.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 5 2012-4-16 13:09:586_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij instAllAtiE
De installatie van dit apparaat moet door een gekwalificeerd(e) technicus of servicebedrijf
worden uitgevoerd.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
Het apparaat is zwaar. Wees voorzichtig wanneer u het optilt.
Steek de stekker van het snoer in een 220V/50Hz/15A (of hoger) wisselstroom
wandcontactdoos. Gebruik de contactdoos uitsluitend voor het aansluiten van dit apparaat.
Gebruik ook geen verlengsnoer.
- Het delen van de wandcontactdoos met andere toestellen, door een verdeelstopcontact,
of het aansluiten van een verlengsnoer, kan tot een elektrische schok of brand leiden.
- Zorg ervoor dat de spanning, frequentie en de stroomsoort hetzelfde zijn als die in de
productspecificaties zijn vermeld. Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of
brand het gevolg zijn. Steek de netstekker goed in de wandcontactdoos.
Verwijder regelmatig alle vreemde substanties zoals stof en water met behulp van een
droge doek uit de elektrische contactdozen.
- Trek de stekker uit de wandcontactdoos en maak hem met een droge doek schoon.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Steek de stekker in de juiste richting in de wandcontactdoos, zodat het snoer naar
beneden loopt.
- Als u de netstekker andersom in de wandcontactdoos steekt kunnen de elektrische
draden binnenin het snoer worden beschadigd waardoor een elektrisch schok of brand
kan ontstaan.
Houdt al het verpakkingsmateriaal buiten bereik van kinderen omdat het voor kinderen
gevaarlijk kan zijn.
- Als een kind een zak over zijn hoofd trekt kan dat tot verstikking leiden.
Neem bij beschadigingen aan het apparaat of de stekker of het snoer, contact op met het
dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
Dit apparaat moet op de juiste manier worden geaard.
Aard het apparaat niet op een gasleiding, plastic waterleiding of een telefoonleiding.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
- Stop nooit een stekker in een wandcontactdoos die niet op de goede manier is geaard
en verzeker u ervan dat het in overeenstemming met de lokale en nationale normen is
uitgevoerd.
Installeer het apparaat niet in de nabijheid van een verwarming of brandbaar materiaal.
Installeer het apparaat niet op een vochtige, vettige of stoffige locatie, op een locatie die
blootgesteld is aan direct zonlicht of aan water (regendruppels).
Installeer het apparaat niet op een locatie met lage temperaturen
- Bij vorst kunnen de buizen barsten
Installeer het apparaat niet op een locatie waar gas kan lekken.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Gebruik geen elektrische transformator.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 6 2012-4-16 13:09:58veiligheidsvoorschriften _7
Gebruik geen beschadigde netstekker, een beschadigd snoer of een niet goed vastzittende
wandcontactdoos.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Trek niet aan, of buig het snoer niet bovenmatig.
Het snoer niet in elkaar draaien en er geen knoop inleggen.
Haak het elektrische snoer niet achter een metalen voorwerp. Plaats er geen zware
voorwerpen op.Zet het niet klem tussen twee voorwerpen en duw het niet in de ruimte
achter het apparaat.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand.
Trek de stekker niet aan het snoer uit het stopcontact.
- Houdt bij het uit het stopcontact trekken de stekker vast.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Leg geen snoeren en slangen op plaatsen waar u erover zou kunnen struikelen.
WAArscHUWinGEn Bij instAllAtiE
Dit apparaat moet op een zodanige wijze worden geplaatst dat de contactdoos goed
bereikbaar is.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand door het lekken van elektriciteit
het gevolg zijn.
Installeer uw apparaat op een horizontale, vlakke en harde vloer die het gewicht kan
dragen.
- Wordt hieraan niet voldaan dan kan dat leiden tot abnormale trillingen, “wandelen”,
lawaai of problemen met het product.
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij GEBrUiK
Sluit, als het apparaat is overgelopen, de watertoevoer en de elektriciteit onmiddellijk af en
neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Raak de stekker niet met natte handen aan
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok het gevolg zijn
Trek onmiddellijk de stekker uit het stopcontact als het apparaat een vreemd geluid maakt
en/of u een brandlucht of rook bemerkt en neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde
servicecentrum.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
In het geval van een gaslek (zoals propaangas, LPG, et cetera.), onmiddellijk ventileren
zonder dat u de stekker aanraakt. Raak het apparaat of het snoer niet aan.
- Gebruik geen ventilator.
- Een vonk kan een explosie of brand veroorzaken.
Sta niet toe dat kinderen in of op de wasmachine spelen. Verwijder bovendien, bij het
afvoeren van het apparaat, de handel van de deur van de wasmachine.
- Als een kind opgesloten raakt binnenin de machine kan dat tot dodelijke verstikking
leiden.
Verzekert u ervan dat u de verpakking (schuimplastic, piepschuim) die aan de bodem van
de wasmachine is bevestigd, voor gebruik verwijdert.
WAArscHUWinG
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 7 2012-4-16 13:09:588_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
Was geen stukken die verontreinigd zijn met diesel, benzine, verfverdunner, alcohol of
andere brandbare of explosieve stoffen.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok, brand of explosie.
Open tijdens de wasgang, de deur van de wasmachine niet met geweld (hoge temperatuur
bij het wassen/ drogen/centrifugeren).
- Uitstromend water kan brandwonden veroorzaken of de vloer kan er glad door worden.
Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
- Door de deur met geweld te openen kan het product worden beschadigd of kan er letsel
ontstaan.
Steek uw hand niet onder de wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
Raak de stekker niet met natte handen aan.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok.
Schakel het apparaat niet uit of in door de stekker uit het stopcontact te trekken terwijl de
machine aan het wassen is.
- Bij het weer in het stopcontact stoppen van de stekker kan een vonk ontstaan, met als
gevolg een elektrische schok of brandt.
Kinderen of personen met beperkingen mogen de wasmachine niet zonder toezicht
gebruiken. Sta niet toe dat kinderen in het apparaat klimmen.
- Doet u dat wel, dan kunnen een elektrische schok, brandwonden of ander letsel.het
gevolg zijn.
Steek uw hand of een metalen voorwerp niet onder de wasmachine tijdens het wassen.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan.
Haal de stekker van het apparaat niet uit de wandcontactdoos door aan het snoer te
trekken.Houdt de stekker altijd stevig vast en trek hem rechtstreeks uit de contactdoos.
- Beschadiging van het snoer kan sluiting brand en/of een elektrische schok veroorzaken
Probeer het apparaat niet eigenhandig te repareren, te demonteren, of te modificeren.
- Gebruik geen zekeringen (zoals koper, staaldraad, enzovoort) behalve de
standaardzekering.
- Indien het apparaat moet worden gerepareerd of geïnstalleerd, neem dan contact op
met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Wordt dit niet gedaan dan kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, explosie,
problemen met het product, of letsel.
Zou een vreemde stof zoals water in het apparaat zijn gekomen, trek dan de stekker uit het
stopcontact en neem contact op met uw dichtstbijzijnde servicecentrum.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Als de waterslang is losgeraakt van de kraan en water over het apparaat loopt de stekker
uit het stopcontact trekken.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
Trek de stekker uit het stopcontact als het apparaat gedurende langere tijd niet wordt
gebruikt of tijdens onweer/ bliksem.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 8 2012-4-16 13:09:59veiligheidsvoorschriften _9
WAArscHUWinGstEKEns Bij GEBrUiK
Is de wasmachine verontreinigd door een vreemde stof zoals wasmiddel, vuil, etensresten
en dergelijke, neem dan de stekker uit het stopcontact en maak de wasmachine met
behulp van een zachte, vochtige, doek.
- Doet u dat niet, dan kunnen verkleuring, vervorming, beschadiging of roest het gevolg
zijn.
Het glas aan de voorzijde kan door een heftige slag breken. Wees voorzichtig bij het
gebruik van de wasmachine.
- Een gebroken vensterglas kan letsel veroorzaken.
Na een probleem met de watertoevoer of bij het opnieuw aansluiten van de slang voor de
watertoevoer, de kraan langzaam openen.
De kraan nadat hij lange tijd niet is gebruikt langzaam openen.
- De luchtdruk in de slang van de watertoevoer kan schade veroorzaken aan onderdelen
of tot lekkage leiden.
Als er tijdens het wassen een afvoerfout ontstaat, controleer dan eerst of er geen probleem
is met de afvoer.
- Gebruik van de wasmachine nadat deze is overgelopen door een probleem met de
afvoer, kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of brand als gevolg van het weglekken van
elektriciteit.
Leg het wasgoed helemaal in de machine zodat het wasgoed niet tussen de deur kan
komen.
- Als er wasgoed tussen de deur zit kan dat schade aan het wasgoed of de wasmachine,
of lekkage tot gevolg hebben.
Zorg ervoor dat de kraan dicht is wanneer de wasmachine niet in gebruik is.
- Verzeker u ervan dat de schroef op de aansluiting van de slang van de watertoevoer
goed vast is aangedraaid.
- Is dat niet het geval, dan kunnen materiële schade of letsel het gevolg zijn.
Controleer of de rubberen dichting niet verontreinigd is door vreemde stoffen (vuil, draadjes
en dergelijke).
- Als de deur niet volledig is gesloten kan dat tot lekkage leiden.
Open de kraan en controleer of de aansluiting van de waterslang goed is aangedraaid en of
er geen lekkage is, voordat u het product in gebruik neemt.
- Als de schroeven van de aansluiting van de slang voor de watertoevoer los zitten kan dat
lekkage tot gevolg hebben.
Het product dat u hebt aangeschaft, is uitsluitend bedoeld voor huishoudelijk gebruik.
Het gebruik van dit product voor zakelijke doeleinden wordt gezien als verkeerd gebruik van
het product.
In dat geval komt de standaardgarantie die Samsung biedt, te vervallen en kan Samsung
niet verantwoordelijk worden gesteld voor storingen of schade als gevolg van het verkeerd
gebruik.
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 9 2012-4-16 13:09:5910_ veiligheidsvoorschriften
Ga niet bovenop het apparaat staan of plaats er geen voorwerpen op (zoals wasgoed,
brandende kaarsen, brandende sigaretten, borden, chemicaliën, metalen voorwerpen
enzovoort).
- Dit kan dat leiden tot elektrische schok, brand, problemen met het product, of letsel.
Spuit geen vluchtige stoffen zoals insecticide op het oppervlak van het apparaat.
- Behalve dat deze toxisch zijn voor mensen, kan dat ook leiden tot elektrische schok,
brand, of problemen met het product.
Plaats geen voorwerp dat een elektromagnetisch veld genereert in de buurt van de
wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan als gevolg van storing in de werking.
Het water dat wordt afgevoerd tijdens een was bij hoge temperaturen of een droogcyclus is
heet. Raak het dus niet aan.
- Hierdoor kunnen brandwonden of ander letsel ontstaan.
Was, centrifugeer of droog geen waterbestendige kussens, matten of kleding (*) tenzij uw
apparaat een speciaal programma heeft voor het wassen van dergelijke stukken.
- Was geen dikke, harde matten, ook niet als het wassymbool op het wasetiket staat.
- Hierdoor kan letsel ontstaan of zouden de wasmachine, muren, vloer of kleding als
gevolg van abnormale trillingen kunnen worden beschadigd.
* Wollen beddengoed, regenhoezen, visvesten, skibroeken, slaapzakken, luierbroekjes,
sweat suits en fiets-, motorfiets-en autohoezen enzovoort.
Gebruik de wasmachine niet zonder dat het wasmiddelbakje aanwezig is.
- Door dat toch te doen kan een elektrische schok of letsel door het lekken van water het
gevolg zijn.
Raak de binnenkant van de kuip niet aan tijdens of direct na het drogen, want die is heet.
- Hierdoor kunnen brandwonden ontstaan.
Steek uw hand na opening niet in het wasmiddelbakje.
- Dit kan tot letsel leiden omdat uw hand kan worden gegrepen door het
invoermechanisme voor het wasmiddel. Plaats geen andere dingen (zoals schoenen,
etensresten, dieren) dan wasgoed. in de wasmachine.
- Hierdoor kan de wasmachine worden beschadigd, of in het geval van huisdieren kunnen
deze worden gedood of gewond door de abnormale trillingen.
De knoppen niet met scherpe voorwerpen zoals naalden, messen, spijkers en dergelijke
indrukken.
- Dit kan leiden tot een elektrische schok of letsel.
Was geen wasgoed dat verontreinigd is met oliën, crèmes of lotions zoals die in
schoonheidssalons of massagepraktijken worden gebruikt.
- Door dat toch te doen kan de rubber dichting worden vervormd en kan er lekkage
ontstaan.
Laat geen metalen voorwerpen zoals veiligheidsspelden of haarspelden of bleekmiddel voor
langere tijd in de kuip liggen.
- Hierdoor kan de kuip gaan roesten.
- Als er roest op het oppervlak van de kuip verschijnt, brengt u een schoonmaakmiddel
(neutraal) op het oppervlak aan, en maakt dat met behulp van een sponsje schoon.
Gebruik nooit een metalen borstel.
Niet rechtstreeks een middel voor chemisch reinigen gebruiken en met chemisch
reinigingsmiddel verontreinigd wasgoed niet wassen, spoelen of centrifugeren.
- Hierdoor kan spontaan een explosie optreden of brand ontstaan als gevolg van de hitte
door oxidatie van de olie.
Gebruik geen water uit koel- of verwarmingstoestellen.
- Hierdoor kunnen zich problemen met de wasmachine voordoen.
veiligheidsvoorschriften
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 10 2012-4-16 13:09:59veiligheidsvoorschriften _11
Gebruik voor de wasmachine geen natuurlijke zeep die bedoeld is voor het handen wassen.
- Als deze stolt en zich in de wasmachine ophoopt, kan de wasmachine problemen
veroorzaken of kunnen verkleuring, roest of onaangename geuren optreden.
Was geen grote stukken wasgoed zoals beddengoed in het wasnet.
- Doe sokken en bh’s in het wasnet en was het samen met ander wasgoed.
- Doet u dat niet, dan kan dat leiden tot letsel of abnormale trillingen.
Gebruik geen gehard wasmiddel.
- Als dit zich in de wasmachine ophoopt kan er waterlekkage ontstaan.
Bij wasmachines die aan de onderzijde ventilatieopeningen hebben, moet erop worden
gelet dat deze niet worden versperd door vloerkleden of andere obstakels.
Zorg ervoor dat de zakken van alle te wassen kledingstukken leeg zijn.
- Harde, scherpe voorwerpen zoals muntstukken, veiligheidsspelden, spijkers, schroeven
of stenen kunnen ernstige schade aan het apparaat veroorzaken.
Was geen kleding met grote gespen, knopen of andere zware metalen versieringen.
ErnstiGE WAArscHUWinGEn Bij rEiniGinG
Het apparaat niet reinigen door het rechtstreeks met water af te spuiten.
Gebruik geen benzeen, thinner of alcohol voor reiniging van het apparaat.
- Dit kan leiden tot verkleuring, vervorming, schade, een elektrische schok of brand.
- Dit kan leiden tot verkleuring, vervorming, schade, een elektrische schok of brand.
- Door dat niet te doen kan een elektrische schok of brand het gevolg zijn.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 11 2012-4-16 13:09:5912_ inhoud
inhoud
INSTAllATIE VAN UW WASmACHINE
13
13 De onderdelen controleren
14 Installatievereisten
14 Elektrische toevoer en aarding
14 Watertoevoer
15 Afvoer
15 Ondergrond
15 Omgevingstemperatuur
15 Installatie in een nis of kast
15 Uw wasmachine installeren
DE WAS DOEN
21
21 Voor het eerst wassen
21 Basisaanwijzingen
22 Het bedieningspaneel gebruiken
25 Kinderslot
25 Geluid uit
25 Uitgesteld einde
26 Mijn programma
26 Kleding wassen met behulp van de
programmakeuzeknop
27 Kleding handmatig wassen
27 Wasvoorschriften
28 Informatie over wasmiddelen en toevoegingen
28 Over het te gebruiken wasmiddel
29 Wasmiddellade
29 Vloeibaar wasmiddel (geselecteerde modellen)
REINIGING EN ONDERHOUD VAN UW
WASmACHINE
30
30 Eco trommelreiniging
31 De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een
noodgeval
32 De wasmiddellade en de uitsparing reinigen
33 Het vuilfilter reinigen
33 De buitenkant reinigen
34 Het filter van de waterslang reinigen
34 Een bevroren wasmachine repareren
34 De wasmachine opslaan
pROblEmEN OplOSSEN EN
fOUTCODES
35
35 Controleer deze punten bij problemen met uw
wasmachine
36 Foutcodes
pROGRAmmAOVERZICHT
37
37 Programmaoverzicht
AppENDIx
38
38 Wasvoorschriften
38 Zorg voor het milieu
38 Verklaring van conformiteit
39 Overzicht huishoudelijke wasmachines
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 12 2012-4-16 13:09:59installatie van uw wasmachine _13
01 Installat eI
installatie van uw wasmachine
Zorg ervoor dat de installateur deze instructies nauwkeurig opvolgt, zodat uw
nieuwe wasmachine correct werkt en u geen risico loopt op letsel bij het doen van
de was.
dE ondErdElEn controlErEn
Pak uw wasmachine zorgvuldig uit en kijk goed of u alle onderstaande onderdelen hebt ontvangen. Neem
contact op met het servicecentrum van Samsung of de leverancier wanneer uw wasmachine is beschadigd
tijdens het vervoer of wanneer er onderdelen ontbreken.
steeksleutel doppen
voor de
boutgaten
Koudwatertoevoerslang
Warmwatertoevoerslang
(geselecteerde
model)
slanggeleider dopbevestiging
vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje
(geselecteerd
model)
Watertoevoerslang
* doppen voor de boutgaten : Het aantal boutgaten dopjes hangt af van het model (3 ~ 5 dopjes).
Afvoerslang
vuilfilter
Afvoer voor
noodgevallen
filterklep
Wasmiddellade
Bedieningspaneel
deur
verstelbare poten
trommel
vergrendeling Werkoppervlak
stekker
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 13 2012-4-16 13:10:0314_ installatie van uw wasmachine
installatie van uw wasmachine
instAllAtiEvErEistEn
Elektrische toevoer en aarding
Om onnodig risico op brand, elektrische schokken of persoonlijk letsel te voorkomen, moet alle
bedrading en aarding uitgevoerd worden in overeenstemming met de laatste herziening van
de regels in de National Electrical Code ANSI/FNPA, No. 70. Neem tevens plaatselijke codes
en regelgeving in acht. Het is de verantwoordelijkheid van de eigenaar van het apparaat om te
zorgen voor afdoende elektrisch onderhoud aan het apparaat.
Gebruik nooit een verlengsnoer.
Gebruik alleen het snoer dat bij uw wasmachine geleverd werd.
Zorg er bij de installatie voor dat de stroomtoevoer aan de volgende punten voldoet:
• AC 220-240V / 50Hz, zekering of installatieautomaat
• Een eigen groep voor alleen uw wasmachine
Uw wasmachine moet correct geaard zijn. Als de wasmachine niet goed werkt of uitvalt, wordt
met aarding de kans op een elektrische schok verminderd doordat de elektrische stroom weg
kan vloeien.
De wasmachine heeft een snoer met een geaarde stekker voor gebruik in een correct
aangesloten en geaard stopcontact.
Sluit de aardedraad nooit aan op plastic buizen, gasleidingen of buizen voor warm water.
Het onjuist aansluiten van de aardgeleider kan een elektrische schok tot gevolg hebben.
Raadpleeg een bevoegde elektricien of onderhoudstechnicus wanneer u niet zeker weet of de
wasmachine goed geaard is. Breng geen aanpassingen aan in de stekker van de wasmachine.
Indien de stekker niet in het stopcontact past, dient u een correct stopcontact te laten installeren
door een bevoegd elektricien.
Watertoevoer
De wasmachine wordt goed gevuld wanneer de waterdruk tussen de 0,5 en 8 Bar ligt. Een
waterdruk onder de 0,5 Bar kan leiden tot het onjuist functioneren van de waterkraan waardoor
deze niet helemaal gesloten kan worden. Het kan ook tot gevolg hebben dat de wasmachine
er langer over doet om gevuld te worden dan toegestaan waardoor de machine uitgeschakeld
wordt. (De wasmachine heeft een limiet op de vultijd om overstromingen te voorkomen wanneer
er binnenin een slang los raakt.)
De kraan moet binnen 120 cm van de achterkant van uw wasmachine zitten om te zorgen dat
de bijgeleverde toevoerslangen de wasmachine kunnen bereiken.
Veel onderdelenwinkels verkopen toevoerslangen van lengtes tot 305 cm.
U kunt het risico van lekkage en waterschade verminderen door:
• De kranen makkelijk toegankelijk te maken.
• De kraan dicht te doen wanneer de wasmachine niet gebruikt wordt.
• Regelmatig te controleren op lekkage bij de aansluitingen van de toevoerslang.
Controleer de kraan en buizen op lekken voordat u de wasmachine voor het eerst gebruikt.
WAArscHUWinG
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 14 2012-4-16 13:10:03installatie van uw wasmachine _15
01 Installat eI
Afvoer
Samsung raadt het gebruik van een 65cm hoge verticale afvoerbuis aan. De afvoerslang moet
in de slanggeleider in de afvoerbuis worden aangesloten. De afvoerbuis moet breed genoeg zijn,
zodat de afvoerslang er goed in past. De afvoerslang is in de fabriek bevestigd.
ondergrond
Voor het beste resultaat moet de wasmachine op een stevig geconstrueerde vloer geplaatst
worden. Houten vloeren moeten verstevigd worden om trilling beperkt te houden en
onevenwichtige ladingen tegen te gaan. Vloerbedekking en zachte tegelvloeren dragen bij aan
de trilling en het bewegen van de wasmachine tijdens het centrifugeren.
Plaats de wasmachine nooit op een verhoging of onstevige ondergrond.
omgevingstemperatuur
Plaats de wasmachine niet op plekken waar het water kan bevriezen.Uw wasmachine bevat altijd
wat water in de toevoerkraan, pomp en slangen. IJs in de leidingen kan schade veroorzaken aan
de drijfriemen, de pomp of andere onderdelen.
installatie in een nis of kast
Voor veilig en correct gebruik heeft de wasmachine minimaal de volgende ruimte nodig:
Zijkanten – 25 mm Achterkant – 50 mm
Bovenkant – 25 mm Voorkant: 465 mm
Wanneer de wasmachine samen met een droger wordt geïnstalleerd, is aan de voorkant een
ruimte nodig van minimaal 465 mm voor ventilatie. De wasmachine alleen heeft geen specifieke
ventilatieruimte nodig.
UW WAsMAcHinE instAllErEn
STAp 1
Een plaats uitzoeken
Let voor installatie van de wasmachine op de volgende punten:
• Zorg voor een harde vlakke ondergrond zonder vloerbedekking of andere
ventilatiebelemmeringen
• Vermijd direct zonlicht
• Zorg voor voldoende ventilatie
• Het mag er niet vriezen (onder 0 ˚C)
• Vermijd hittebronnen zoals olie of gas
• Zorg voor genoeg ruimte, zodat de wasmachine niet op zijn eigen snoer staat
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 15 2012-4-16 13:10:0316_ installatie van uw wasmachine
STAp 2
de transportbouten verwijderen
Verwijder voordat u de wasmachine installeert de vijf transportbouten uit de achterzijde van het
apparaat.
1. Draai alle bouten los met de bijgeleverde steeksleutel.
2. Houd de bout met de sleutel vast en trek deze uit het gat.
Doe dit met elke bout.
3. Bedek de gaten met de meegeleverde plastic doppen.
4. Berg de transportbouten veilig op voor wanneer u de wasmachine in de toekomst moet
vervoeren.
Verpakkingsmateriaal kan gevaarlijk zijn voor kinderen. Houd al het verpakkingsmateriaal
(plastic zakken, piepschuim, enzovoort) buiten bereik van kinderen.
Steek het onderdeel om het deksel vast
te zetten (één van de toebehoren in de
kunststof verpakking) in de uitsparing
aan de achterzijde van de wasmachine,
nadat u het elektriciteitssnoer er uit hebt
genomen
installatie van uw wasmachine
WAArscHUWinG
optie
optie
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 16 2012-4-16 13:10:05installatie van uw wasmachine _17
01 Installat eI
STAp 3
de stelpoten aanpassen
Zorg bij het plaatsen van uw wasmachine dat de stekker en de watertoevoer en -afvoer
makkelijk te bereiken zijn.
1. Schuif de wasmachine op zijn plek.
2. Zet de wasmachine
waterpas door de poten
handmatig naar binnen of
naar buiten te draaien.
3. Wanneer de wasmachine waterpas staat, draait u de moer
vast met de bijgeleverde sleutel.
STAp 4
de watertoevoer en -afvoer aansluiten
De watertoevoerslang aansluiten
1. Sluit de L-vormige fitting van de toevoerslang
voor koud water aan op het invoerpunt voor
koud water aan de achterzijde van de machine.
Draai deze met de hand vast.
De watertoevoerslang moet met het
ene uiteinde worden aangesloten op de
wasmachine en met het andere uiteinde op de
waterkraan. Rek de slang niet uit. Als de slang
te kort is, kunt u een langere hogedrukslang
gebruiken.
2. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de toevoerslang
voor koud water aan op de koudwaterkraan
en draai deze met de hand vast. Indien nodig
kunt u de hoek van de slang aan de kant van
de wasmachine veranderen door de fitting los
te draaien, de slang te draaien en de fitting
vervolgens weer vast te draaien.
voor geselecteerde modellen met een extra warm waterinname:
1. Sluit de L-vormige fitting van de toevoerslang voor warm water aan op het invoerpunt voor
warm water aan de achterzijde van de machine. Draai deze met de hand vast.
2. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de toevoerslang voor warm water aan op de warmwaterkraan
en draai deze met de hand vast.
3. Gebruik een Y-stuk als je uitsluitend koud water wilt gebruiken.
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 17 2012-4-16 13:10:0718_ installatie van uw wasmachine
installatie van uw wasmachine
Aansluiten van de watertoevoerslang (geselecteerde modellen)
1. Verwijder de adapter van de watertoevoerslang.
2. Gebruik eerst een '+' type schroevendraaier om de vier
schroeven op de adapter los te draaien. Neem vervolgens
de adapter en draai deel (2) in de richting van de pijl totdat
er een kloof van 5 mm ontstaat.
3. Sluit de adapter aan op de waterkraan door het stevig
vastdraaien van de schroeven, terwijl u de adapter omhoog
tilt.
Draai deel (2) in de richting van de pijl en verbind (1) en (2).
4. Sluit de watertoevoerslang aan op de adapter.
Als u onderdeel (3) loslaat, wordt de slang
automatisch verbonden met de adapter met een
hoorbaar 'klik' geluid.
Nadat u de watertoevoerslang met de adapter
heeft verbonden, zorgt u ervoor dat het goed
vastzit door benedenwaarts te trekken aan de
watertoevoerslang.
5. Sluit het andere uiteinde van de watertoevoerslang aan op
de water inlaatklep aan de achterkant op de wasmachine.
Schroef de slang helemaal tot het einde met de klok mee.
Adapter
Watertoevoerslang
1
2
5 mm
3
1
2
Watertap
optie
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 18 2012-4-16 13:10:10installatie van uw wasmachine _19
01 Installat eI
6. Zet de watervoorziening aan en zorg ervoor dat er geen
water lekt van het waterklep, kraan of adapter. In geval van
waterlek, herhaalt u de voorafgaande stappen.
Gebruik uw wasmachine niet in het geval van een
waterlek. Dit kan een elektrische schok of letsel
veroorzaken.
• Als de kraan voorzien is van schroefdraad, sluit u de
watertoevoerslang aan zoals aangegeven op de afbeelding.
Gebruik een standaard type kraan voor de watertoevoer. Als u een vierkante kraan hebt,
of als uw kraan te groot is, verwijdert u de scheidring voordat u de kraan aansluit op de
adapter.
De Aqua Hose aansluiten (geselecteerde modellen)
De Aqua Hose is ontworpen om optimale bescherming tegen
lekkages te bieden.Het wordt aan de watertoevoerslang
bevestigd en sluit automatisch de watertoevoer af als de slang
beschadigd raakt. Tevens wordt een waarschuwingsindicator
weergegeven.
• Sluit de watertoevoerslang aan zoals aangegeven op de
afbeelding.
✗
✗ WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 19 2012-4-16 13:10:1120_ installatie van uw wasmachine
De afvoerslang aansluiten
Het uiteinde van de afvoerslang kan op drie manieren worden geplaatst:
1. Over de rand van de gootsteen: de afvoerslang moet op een hoogte van 60 tot 90 cm
worden geplaatst. Gebruik de meegeleverde plastic slanggeleider om het uiteinde gebogen
te houden. Bevestig de geleider met een haak aan de muur of met een touwtje aan de kraan
zodat deze op zijn plaats blijft.
2. In een aftakking van de gootsteenafvoer: de aftakking moet hoger zijn dan de zwanenhals
van de gootsteen, zodat het uiteinde van de slang zich ten minste 60 cm boven de grond
bevindt.
3. In een afvoerbuis: we raden het gebruik van een 65 cm hoge verticale buis aan. De buis
mag niet korter dan 60 cm en niet langer dan 90 cm zijn.
Eisen aan de vaste afvoerpijp:
• Minimale diameter 5 cm
• Minimale afvoercapaciteit 60 liter per minuut
STAp 5
de wasmachine aansluiten op de elektriciteit
Steek het snoer in een stopcontact van 220 V-240V/50Hz beschermd door een zekering of
installatieautomaat. (Kijk op pagina 14 voor meer informatie over de vereisten voor elektriciteit en
aarding.)
STAp 6
Kalibratiemodus
De Samsung-wasmachine detecteert automatisch het gewicht van de was. Voor een nog
nauwkeurigere gewichtsbepaling, voert u na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit. Voer de
onderstaand stappen uit om de kalibratiemodus uit te voeren.
1. Verwijder wasgoed of andere inhoud uit de machine en schakel de machine uit.
2. Druk de knoppen Temperatuur en Uitgesteld einde tegelijkertijd in en druk tevens op de
knop Aan/Uit. Vervolgens wordt de machine ingeschakeld.
3. Druk op de knop Start om “Kalibratiemodus” te activeren.
4. De wastrommel draait ongeveer 3 minuten lang rechtsom en linksom.
5. Als “Kalibratiemodus” is voltooid, wordt “End (En)” weergegeven op het display en wordt de
machine automatisch uitgeschakeld. De wasmachine is nu gereed voor gebruik.
installatie van uw wasmachine
Afvoerslang
slanggeleider
60 ~ 90 cm
60 ~ 90 cm
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 20 2012-4-16 13:10:13de was doen _21
02 De was Doen
de was doen
Het moeilijkste van de was doen met uw nieuwe wasmachine van Samsung is
bepalen welke was u het eerste wilt doen.
voor HEt EErst WAssEn
Laat voordat u kleding gaat wassen de wasmachine eenmaal een volledig programma draaien
zonder inhoud (dus zonder wasgoed).
1. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
2. Stop wat wasmiddel in het vakje in de wasmiddellade
3. Draai de watertoevoer naar de wasmachine open.
4. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
Al het water dat in de machine is achtergebleven na het
proefdraaien in de fabriek wordt nu afgevoerd.
vakje : Voorwasmiddel of stijfsel.
vakje : Hoofdwasmiddel, waterverzachter, voorweekmiddel, bleek en vlekverwijderaars.
Als u vloeibaar wasmiddel wilt gebruiken, gebruikt u het vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel
(raadpleeg pagina 29 van de gebruiksaanwijzing voor het corresponderende model). Stop
geen wasmiddel in poedervorm in het vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel.
vakje : Toevoegingen, bijvoorbeeld wasverzachter (maximaal tot de onderste rand (MAX) van
A vullen).
BAsisAAnWijzinGEn
1. Doe de was in de wasmachine.
Stop niet te veel in de wasmachine. Bepaal de laadcapaciteit voor elk type wasgoed aan de
hand van het schema op pagina 28.
• Zorg dat er geen was tussen de deur komt, hierdoor kan water gaan lekken.
• Er kan na het wassen wasmiddel achterblijven in het voorste rubber van de wasmachine.
Verwijder eventuele restanten omdat deze kunnen leiden tot lekkage.
• Was geen waterbestendige stukken.
2. Doe de deur dicht tot deze dicht klikt.
3. Zet de machine aan.
4. Stop wasmiddel en toevoegingen in de wasmiddellade.
5. Kies het geschikte programma en de opties voor de was.
Het wasindicatielampje gaat aan en de geschatte tijd voor het programma verschijnt op het
display.
6. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
WAArscHUWinG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 21 2012-4-16 13:10:1522_ de was doen
HEt BEdiEninGspAnEEl GEBrUiKEn
DIGITAAl GRAfISCH
DISplAY
Weergave van de resterende tijd voor het wasprogramma, alle
wasinformatie en foutmeldingen.
pROGRAmmAKEUZEKNOp
Kies het gewenste wasprogramma en de centrifugeersnelheid.
Kijk voor meer informatie in het gedeelte “Kleding wassen met
behulp van de programmakeuzeknop” (zie pagina 26).
Katoen - voor normaal of licht bevuilde katoenen kleding, beddengoed,
tafellinnen, ondergoed, handdoeken, overhemden, enz.
synthetisch - voor normaal of licht bevuilde blouses, overhemden, enz.
van polyester (diolen, trevira), polyamide (perlon, nylon) en dergelijke
combinaties.
jeans - voor een hoger waterniveau tijdens de hoofdwas en een keer
extra spoelen om te voorkomen dat er waspoedervlekken achterblijven
op uw kleding.
Beddengoed - Voor bedspreien, hoeslakens, dekbedovertrekken, enz.
Gebruik voor het beste resultaat slechts 1 soort beddengoed en
overschrijd de 2 kg niet.
donkere kleding - Extra spoelbeurten en verminderd centrifugeren
zorgt ervoor dat uw favoriete donkere kleding voorzichtig gewassen
worden en zorgvuldig worden gespoeld.
dagelijkse was - Gebruik voor alledaagse onderdelen zoals ondergoed
en hemden. Snelprogramma voor testinstituten.
Eco trommelreiniging - Voor het reinigen van de trommel. Hiermee
ontdoet u de trommel van vuil en bacteriën. Regelmatig gebruik (na elke
40 wasbeurten) aanbevolen. Er is geen reinigings- of bleekmiddel nodig.
Babykleding- voor wassen op hoge temperatuur en extra spoelen om
te zorgen dat er geen wasmiddelvlekken achterblijven op uw dunne
kleding.
sportkleding - Voor waterdichte of anders behandelde kleding zodat
deze er mooi uit blijft zien en fris blijft voelen.
de was doen
2 1 3 4 5 6 7 10 9 8 12 11 13
1
2
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 22 2012-4-16 13:10:17de was doen _23
02 De was Doen
Handwas - Een zeer lichte wascyclus. Net zo zacht als het wassen met
de hand.
Wol- alleen voor in de machine wasbare wol. Was niet meer dan 2,0 kg.
• Bij het wolprogramma wordt het wollen wasgoed gewassen door
middel van rustige bewegingen van de machine. Door deze rustige
bewegingen en het weekproces wordt uw wollen wasgoed optimaal
beschermd tegen krimpen en vervormen en toch heel schoon.
• Voor wol wordt een neutraal wasmiddel aanbevolen. Dit geeft betere
wasresultaten en beschermt de wollen vezels.
Afvoer - voor het wegpompen van water uit de wasmachine zonder te
centrifugeren.
centrifugeren- voor een keer extra centrifugeren om nog meer water te
verwijderen.
spoelen + centrifugeren - voor een was die alleen gespoeld hoeft
te worden, of voor het toevoegen van wasverzachter die tijdens het
spoelen moet worden toegevoegd.
SElECTIEKNOp
TEmpERATUUR
Druk meermalen op deze knop om een van de beschikbare
temperaturen te selecteren:
( (Koud: Alle indicatielampjes uit), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C , 60 ˚C en 95 ˚C).
SpOElEN
SElECTIEKNOp
Druk op deze knop om extra spoelbeurten toe te voegen. U kunt
maximaal vijf spoelbeurten instellen.
CENTRIfUGEREN
SElECTIEKNOp
Druk meermalen op de knop om een van de beschikbare
centrifugesnelheden te selecteren.
WF710 / WF712
Alle indicatielampjes uit, , 400, 800, 1200, 1400
toeren/min
“Niet centrifugeren ”: na het leegpompen wordt de was in de trommel
niet gecentrifugeerd.
“Spoelwater vasthouden(Alle indicatielampjes uit) ”: het laatste
spoelwater blijft in de machine. Voordat u de was uit de machine
kunt halen moet u altijd eerst de machine leegpompen of de was
centrifugeren.
SElECTIEKNOp
OpTIES
Druk meermalen op deze knop om een van de beschikbare wasopties te
selecteren:
(Weken) (Intensief) (Voorwas) (Weken) +
(Intensief) (Weken) + (Voorwas) (Intensief) + (Voorwas)
(Weken) + (Intensief) + (Voorwas) (uit)
“Voorwas”: Druk op deze knop om voorwas te selecteren. Voorwassen
is alleen beschikbaar bij: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed,
Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was, Babykleding, Sportkleding.
“Intensief ”: druk op deze knop wanneer de was sterk bevuild is en
intensief gewassen moet worden. Elke cyclus van het programma wordt
verlengd.
“Weken”: gebruik deze optie om vlekken beter te verwijderen door de
was te laten weken.
• De weekfunctie wordt na 13 minuten wassen uitgevoerd.
• De weekfunctie duurt 30 minuten in zes fasen. Elke fase bestaat uit
een minuut draaien en vier minuten stilstaand weken.
• De weekfunctie is alleen beschikbaar in combinatie met de volgende
programma’s: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed, Dagelijkse
was, Babykleding, Sportkleding.
5
3
4
6
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 23 2012-4-16 13:10:1924_ de was doen
GElUID UIT
SElECTIEKNOp
Het geluid tijdens het programma kan worden uitgeschakeld. Wanneer
deze functie is geselecteerd, wordt het geluid van het hele programma
uitgeschakeld.
• Wanneer het geluid is uitgeschakeld, licht de knop Geluid uit op en
wordt de indicator Geluid uit weergegeven op het bedieningspaneel.
• Wanneer het geluid weer wordt ingeschakeld, klinkt er een zoemer
en gaan de knop en de indicator Geluid uit op het bedieningspaneel
weer uit.
SElECTIEKNOp
UITGESTElD EINDE
Druk meermalen op deze knop om de beschikbare tijden voor uitstel
van de Uitgesteld einde te doorlopen (van 3 tot 19 uur, per heel uur
instelbaar).
Het display geeft aan over hoeveel uur het programma klaar is.
SElECTIEKNOp
KORT pROGRAmmA
Voor het snel wassen van licht bevuilde weefsels en minder dan 2kg
wasgoed. Dit programma neemt minimaal ongeveer 15 minuten in
beslag, maar kan variëren afhankelijk van waterdruk, hardheid van het
water, temperatuur van toegevoerd water, kamertemperatuur, type en
hoeveelheid wasgoed en ernst van de vervuiling, gebruikt wasmiddel,
onevenwichtige lading, schommelingen in de elektriciteitsvoorziening en
extra geselecteerde opties.
• Druk meermalen op deze knop om de tijd voor het wasprogramma
te kiezen: 15min 20min 30min 40min 50min 60min
Uit
Er moet minder dan 20 gram wasmiddel in poedervorm/vloeibaar
wasmiddel (bij een lading van 2 kg) worden gebruikt, anders blijft er
wasmiddel achter op de kleding.
SElECTIEKNOp
KREUKVRIJ
Druk op deze knop om de functie Kreukvrij te selecteren. Gebruik
deze optie om uw wasgoed voor te bereiden, zodat het eenvoudig kan
worden gestreken.
KNOp mIJN
pROGRAmmA
Kies uw favoriete programma, inclusief temperatuur, centrifugeren, ernst
van vervuiling, optie, enz.
SElECTIEKNOp
START/pAUSE
Druk op deze knop om het wasprogramma te starten of te pauzeren.
AAN/UIT-KNOp
Druk eenmaal op deze knop om de wasmachine in te schakelen. Druk
nogmaals op de knop om de wasmachine uit te schakelen.
Als de wasmachine langer dan 10 minuten ingeschakeld is zonder
dat er op knoppen wordt gedrukt, wordt de machine automatisch
uitgeschakeld.
de was doen
10
WAArscHUWinG
11
9
7
8
12
13
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 24 2012-4-16 13:10:20de was doen _25
02 De was Doen
Kinderslot
Met het kinderslot kunt u de knoppen vergrendelen zodat het gekozen wasprogramma niet kan
worden gewijzigd.
In- en uitschakelen
Wanneer u het kinderslot wilt in- of uitschakelen, drukt u
tegelijkertijd gedurende tenminste 3 seconden op de knoppen
Temperatuur en Spoelen. Het indicatielampje “Kinderslot “
licht op wanneer het kinderslot is ingeschakeld.
Wanneer het kinderslot is ingeschakeld, werkt alleen de
Aan/Uit-knop. Het kinderslot blijft ingeschakeld, zelfs
wanneer de machine uit en aan is gezet of wanneer het
snoer wordt losgekoppeld.
Geluid uit
U kunt het geluid tijdens alle programma’s uitschakelen. Wanneer deze functie is geselecteerd,
wordt het geluid van het hele programma uitgeschakeld. Zelfs wanneer de machine herhaaldelijk
uit en aan wordt gezet, blijft het geluid uit.
In- en uitschakelen
Wanneer u het geluid wilt in- of uitschakelen drukt u op de knop Geluid uit. De indicator “Geluid
uit ” op het bedieningspaneel en de knop Geluid uit gaan branden wanneer deze functie is
geactiveerd.
Uitgesteld einde
U kunt de wasmachine zo instellen dat de was automatisch op een later tijdstip klaar is. De
startvertraging is per heel uur instelbaar van 3 tot 19 uur. Het display geeft aan over hoeveel uur
het programma klaar is.
1. Stel de wasmachine handmatig of automatisch in op het gewenste wasprogramma.
2. Druk meermalen op de knop Uitgesteld einde om de vertragingstijd in te stellen.
3. Druk op de knop Start/pause. Het indicatielampje “Uitgesteld einde “ gaat branden en
de klok begint af te tellen tot de ingestelde tijd.
4. Om de functie Uitgesteld einde te annuleren drukt u op de Aan/Uit-knop en zet u de
wasmachine weer aan.
3 sEc.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 25 2012-4-16 13:10:2326_ de was doen
de was doen
Mijn programma
Hiermee kunt u met één druk op de knop uw eigen wasprogramma instellen (temperatuur,
centrifugeren, ernst van vervuiling, enz.).
Door op de knop mijn programma te drukken, laadt en gebruikt u de opgeslagen opties onder
Mijn programma. Het indicatielampje "Mijn programma" gaat branden om aan te geven dat deze
functie is ingeschakeld. Tevens knipperen de gekozen programma- en optielampjes.
U kunt als volgt alle opties voor Mijn programma instellen.
1. Schakel de watertoevoer in.
2. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
3. Selecteer het programma met de programmakeuzeknop.
4. Nadat u het programma hebt geselecteerd, stelt u de verschillende opties in.
Raadpleeg het "Programmaoverzicht" op pagina 37 voor beschikbare opties bij elk
programma.
5. U kunt vervolgens het geselecteerde programma en de bijbehorende opties opslaan door
de knop mijn programma langer dan 3 seconden ingedrukt te houden in de modus Mijn
programma. Het programma en de opties die u hebt geselecteerd, worden de volgende keer
dat u de functie Mijn programma kiest, opnieuw weergegeven.
U kunt de instellingen voor Mijn programma wijzigen door het bovenstaande proces te
herhalen. De meest recente instellingen worden weergegeven wanneer u opnieuw de
functie Mijn programma selecteert.
Als u op Mijn programma drukt en deze knop binnen 3 seconden weer loslaat, worden
het eerder opgeslagen programma met bijbehorende opties weergegeven. Als u Mijn
programma langer dan 3 seconden ingedrukt houdt, wordt het momenteel ingestelde
programma met bijbehorende opties opgeslagen en knippert de LED gedurende 3
seconden.
Kleding wassen met behulp van de programmakeuzeknop
Met het automatische controlesysteem “Fuzzy Control” van Samsung maakt uw nieuwe
wasmachine wassen heel eenvoudig. Wanneer u een wasprogramma selecteert, stelt de
machine automatisch de juiste temperatuur, wastijd en snelheid in.
1. Draai de kraan open.
2. Druk op de Aan/uit-knop van de wasmachine.
3. Open de deur.
4. Plaats de te wassen voorwerpen één voor één losjes in de trommel. Doe de trommel niet te vol.
5. Sluit de deur.
6. Stop wasmiddel en indien gewenst wasverzachter of voorwasmiddel in de juiste vakjes.
Voorwas is alleen beschikbaar in combinatie met de programma’s Katoen, Synthetisch,
Jeans, Beddengoed, Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was, Babykleding en Sportkleding.
Voorwassen is alleen nodig als de kleding erg vuil is.
7. Gebruik de programmakeuzeknop om het geschikte programma voor de was te
kiezen: Katoen, Synthetisch, Jeans, Beddengoed, Donkere kleding, Dagelijkse was,
Eco trommelreiniging, Babykleding, Sportkleding, Handwas, Wol. De bijbehorende
indicatielampjes op het bedieningspaneel gaan aan.
8. Nu kunt u door op de juiste knoppen te drukken de wastemperatuur, het aantal keer
spoelen, de centrifugesnelheid en de starttijd instellen.
9. Druk op de knop Start/pause om het wasprogramma te beginnen. Het
procesindicatielampje gaat branden en de resterende tijd voor het programma wordt
weergegeven in het display.
pauzeren
Binnen 5 minuten na het beginnen van een was, kan er was toegevoegd of uit de trommel
gehaald worden.
1. Druk op de knop Start/pause om de deur te ontgrendelen.
De deur kan niet geopend worden wanneer het water te HEET is of wanneer het
waterniveau te HOOG is.
2. Druk na het sluiten van de deur weer op Start/pause om het wassen voort te zetten.
Als het programma is afgelopen:
Als het gehele wasprogramma is afgelopen, wordt de wasmachine automatisch uitgeschakeld.
1. Open de deur.
2. Haal het wasgoed uit de trommel.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 26 2012-4-16 13:10:23de was doen _27
02 De was Doen
Kleding handmatig wassen
U kunt kleding handmatig wassen zonder een programma te kiezen.
1. Schakel de watertoevoer in.
2. Druk op de Aan/uit-knop van de wasmachine.
3. Open de deur.
4. Plaats de te wassen voorwerpen één voor één losjes in de trommel. Doe de trommel niet te
vol.
5. Sluit de deur.
6. Stop wasmiddel en indien gewenst wasverzachter of voorwasmiddel in de juiste vakjes.
7. Druk op de knop Temperatuur om de gewenste temperatuur te selecteren. ( (Koud: Alle
indicatielampjes uit), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C, 60 ˚C, 95 ˚C)
8. Druk op de knop Spoelen om het gewenste aantal spoelbeurten te selecteren.
U kunt maximaal vijf spoelbeurten instellen.
Met elke spoelbeurt neemt de wastijd toe.
9. Druk op de knop Toerental centrifugeren om de centrifugesnelheid te selecteren.
( : Niet centrifugeren, Alle indicatielampjes uit : Spoelwater vasthouden)
10. Druk meermalen op de knop Uitgesteld einde om de beschikbare tijden voor
startvertraging te doorlopen (van 3 tot 19 uur, per heel uur instelbaar). Het display geeft aan
over hoeveel uur het programma klaar is.
11. Na een druk op de knop Start/pause begint het wasprogramma.
WAsvoorscHriftEn
Volg deze simpele aanwijzingen voor de schoonste en efficiëntste was.
Kijk voor het wassen altijd op het waslabel van uw kleding.
sorteer en was uw wasgoed aan de hand van de volgende criteria:
• Waslabel: sorteer het wasgoed in katoen, gemengde weefsels, synthetisch, zijde, wol en
viscose (lingerie).
• Kleur: scheid witte was van bonte was. Was nieuwe gekleurde kledingstukken apart.
• Formaat: e wasprestaties worden verbeterd als u wasgoed van verschillend formaat samen
wast.
• Kwetsbaarheid: was fijn wasgoed apart, zoals zuiver scheerwol, vitrages en zijde, met
het wasprogramma Fijne was. Controleer de waslabels in elk kledingstuk of raadpleeg de
wasvoorschriften in de appendix.
zakken leeghalen
Haal voor elke was de zakken van alle kledingstukken leeg. Kleine, ongewoon gevormde,
harde voorwerpen zoals munten, messen, spelden en paperclips kunnen uw wasmachine
beschadigen. Was geen kleding met grote gespen, knopen of andere zware metalen voorwerpen
in de wasmachine.
Kleding met metalen voorwerpen kan uw kleding en de trommel beschadigen. Keer kleding met
knopen en borduursel voor het wassen binnenstebuiten. Wanneer ritsen van broeken of jassen
tijdens het wassen open staan, kan de trommel beschadigen. Ritsen moeten voor het wassen
dicht zijn en met een touwtje vastgemaakt worden.
Kleding met lange koorden kan met andere kleding in de knoop raken en deze beschadigen.
Maak de koorden vast voor het wassen.
Katoen voorwassen
Uw nieuwe wasmachine zorgt samen met de hedendaagse wasmiddelen voor perfecte
wasresultaten waardoor minder energie, tijd, water en wasmiddel nodig zijn. Als uw katoenen
kleding echter erg vuil is, kunt u een voorwas doen met een reinigingsmiddel op enzymenbasis.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 27 2012-4-16 13:10:2328_ de was doen
de laadcapaciteit bepalen
Als u de wasmachine te vol stopt, wordt de was mogelijk niet goed schoon. Aan de hand
van het schema hieronder kunt u de laadcapaciteit bepalen voor het type wasgoed dat u wilt
wassen.
materiaal laadcapaciteit
Model WF710 / WF712
Katoen
- normaal/licht bevuild
- zwaar bevuild
7,0 kg
synthetisch 2,5 kg
jeans 3,0 kg
Beddengoed 2,0 kg
sportkleding 2,5 kg
Wol 2,0 kg
• Wanneer het wasgoed onevenwichtig is verdeeld (“UE” gaat branden in het display),
moet u het opnieuw verdelen.
Bij een onevenwichtige lading gaat het effect van centrifugeren achteruit.
• Wanneer u beddengoed of dekbedden wast, kan de wastijd langer zijn dan normaal.Het
centrifugeren kan tevens minder effectief zijn.
• De laadcapaciteit voor beddengoed of dekbedden is ten hoogste 2,0 kg.
Stop (in water wasbare) beha’s in een waszak (apart te
verkrijgen).
• De metalen onderdelen van beha’s kunnen door het materiaal
heen komen en de was beschadigen. Stop ze daarom in een fijne
waszak.
• Kleine lichte kleding zoals sokken, handschoenen, kousen en
zakdoeken kunnen rond de deur vast komen te zitten. Stop ze in
een fijne waszak.
Gebruik geen wasmiddel dat hard geworden is of is gaan klonteren. Dit kan tijdens het
spoelen achterblijven. Daardoor spoelt de wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of het kan
ervoor zorgen dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
inforMAtiE ovEr WAsMiddElEn En toEvoEGinGEn
over het te gebruiken wasmiddel
Het type wasmiddel dat u moet gebruiken is afhankelijk van het materiaal (katoen, synthetisch,
fijne was, wol), de kleur, de wastemperatuur en hoe vuil het wasgoed is. Gebruik altijd een
wasmiddel dat weinig schuimt en speciaal is ontwikkeld voor wasmachines.
Volg de aanbevelingen van de wasmiddelfabrikant op basis van het gewicht van het wasgoed,
hoe vuil het wasgoed is en de waterhardheid in uw gebied. Als u niet weet hoe hard het water in
uw gebied is, kunt u dit navragen bij uw waterbedrijf.
Gebruik geen wasmiddel dat hard geworden is of is gaan klonteren. Daardoor spoelt de
wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of het kan ervoor zorgen dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
Graag op het volgende letten bij het gebruik van het Wolprogramma.
• Gebruik een neutraal vloeibaar wasmiddel dat uitsluitend voor wol is bestemd.
• Bij gebruik van waspoeder kan dit op het wasgoed achterblijven en het weefsel (wol)
beschadigen.
de was doen
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 28 2012-4-16 13:10:24de was doen _29
02 De was Doen
Wasmiddellade
De wasmachine heeft verschillende vakjes voor wasmiddel en wasverzachters. Doe alle middelen
in het juiste vakje voor u de wasmachine start.
Maak de wasmiddellade niet open terwijl uw wasmachine draait. Anders kunt u heet water
of stoom over u heen krijgen.
1. Trek de wasmiddellade links van het bedieningspaneel open.
2. Doe de aanbevolen hoeveelheid wasmiddel in het wasmiddelvakje voordat u de
wasmachine start.
Als u vloeibaar wasmiddel wilt gebruiken, gebruikt u het
vakje voor vloeibaar wasmiddel (raadpleeg de sectie
"Vloeibaar wasmiddel" voor het corresponderende
model).
• Stop geen wasmiddel in poedervorm in het vakje voor
vloeibaar wasmiddel.
3. Voeg indien nodig de aanbevolen hoeveelheid
wasverzachter toe in het wasverzachtervakje . VUL HET
VAKJE niet tot boven de MAXIMALE VULLIJN ( ).
Doe GEEN extra poeder/ vloeibaar wasmiddel in het
bakje voor de wasverzachter ( ).
4. Wanneer u een voorwas doet, voegt u de aanbevolen
hoeveelheid wasmiddel toe in het voorwasvakje .
Gebruik bij het wassen van grote stukken wasgoed GEEN
van de volgende soorten wasmiddel.
• Wasmiddelen in de vorm van tabletten of capsules
• Wasmiddelen in een wasbol of netje
Verdun geconcentreerde of dikke wasverzachter met een
beetje water voordat u deze in het vakje giet. Zo voorkomt u dat de overloop verstopt raakt.
Zorg ervoor dat, nadat u wasverzachter in het wasverzachterbakje heeft gedaan, de
wasverzachter bij het sluiten van het wasmiddelbakje niet overstroomt.
vloeibaar wasmiddel (geselecteerde modellen)
Om vloeibaar wasmiddel te gebruiken, plaatst u het vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje in het hoofdwasgedeelte van de wasmiddellade
en giet vloeibaar wasmiddel in het vloeibaar wasmiddelbakje.
• Niet boven de MAX-lijn vullen.
• Bij gebruik van poederwasmiddel, haalt u het bakje
voor vloeibare wasmiddelen uit de wasmiddellade.
Poederwasmiddel zal niet terechtkomen in het vloeibaar
wasmiddelbakje.
• Na een wasbeurt, kan wat vloeistof in de wasmiddellade
achterblijven.
MAX
vakje voor
vloeibaar
wasmiddel
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 29 2012-4-16 13:10:2630_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
Door de wasmachine schoon te houden levert deze betere prestaties, voorkomt u
onnodige reparaties en wordt de levensduur verlengd.
Eco troMMElrEiniGinG
Dit is een automatisch reinigingsprogramma waarmee de schimmelvorming die
mogelijk in de wasmachine is ontstaan, wordt verwijderd.
1. Druk op de Aan/Uit-knop.
2. Draai de programmakeuzeknop naar het programma Eco
trommelreiniging.
• U kunt alleen de vertragingsfunctie Uitgesteld einde
gebruiken.
• De watertemperatuur voor het programma Eco
trommelreiniging is ingesteld op 70 ˚C.
Vanwege de functies van de wasmachine, staat de
watertemperatuur ingesteld op 70 ˚C tijdens de cyclus Eco trommelreiniging, maar het
display op het bedieningspaneel kan slechts 60 ˚C weergeven.
U kunt de temperatuur niet wijzigen.
• Het zal automatisch instellen op midden waterpeil katoenprogramma 30 ˚C wanneer er
kleding in wordt gelegd.
3. Gebruik de juiste hoeveelheid schoonmaakmiddel in
het wasmiddelvakje en sluit het vakje (wanneer u de
trommel reinigt met een reinigingsmiddel).
• Gebruik het aanbevolen reinigingsmiddel om de trommel
te reinigen.
• Er zijn waspoeders en vloeibare wasmiddelen. Het
vloeibare reinigingsmiddel werkt alleen in het vakje voor
vloeibaar wasmiddel (optie).
4. Druk op de knop Start/pause.
• Als u op de knop Start/pause drukt, wordt het programma Eco trommelreiniging gestart.
• Als u het programma Eco trommelreiniging gebruikt, kunt u de trommel reinigen zonder een
reinigingsmiddel.
• Gebruik het programma Eco trommelreiniging nooit wanneer er zich wasgoed in de
wasmachine bevindt. Dit kan leiden tot schade aan het weefsel of problemen met de
wasmachine.
• Gebruik nooit normaal wasmiddel tijdens het programma Eco trommelreiniging.
• Gebruik voor het reinigen van de trommel slechts 1/10 van de hoeveelheid die door
de fabrikant van het schoonmaakmiddel wordt aanbevolen.
• Aangezien chloorhoudende bleekmiddelen verkleuring van het product kunnen veroorzaken,
kunt u het beste alleen zuurstofhoudende bleekmiddelen gebruiken.
• Reinigingsmiddelen in poedervorm: Gebruik alleen [bleekmiddelen in poedervorm] of een
[speciaal reinigingsmiddel voor het reinigen van de trommel].
• Vloeibare reinigingsmiddelen: Gebruik alleen [bleekmiddelen in vloeibare vorm] of een
[speciaal reinigingsmiddel voor het reinigen van de trommel].
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 30 2012-4-16 13:10:28reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine _31
03 Reiniging en ondeRhoud
de automatische alarmfunctie voor Eco trommelreiniging
• Als de “Trommel reinigen” indicator op het display branden
zijn na een wasbeurt, betekent dit dat kuip (trommel)
reiniging vereist is. In dat geval haalt u het wasgoed uit de
machine, schakelt u het apparaat in en reinigt u de trommel
door het programma Eco trommelreiniging uit te voeren.
• Als u niet het programma Trommel reinigen uitvoert,
staan de “Trommel reinigen” indicator op het display
uit. Na twee wasbeurten gaat echter zowel het
indicatielampje 'Eco trommelreiniging' als het lampje op de
programmakeuzeknop weer branden. Dit leidt echter niet
tot problemen met het product.
• Hoewel de automatische alarmlampjes voor het
programma Eco trommelreiniging doorgaans één keer per
maand zullen branden, is de frequentie afhankelijk van het aantal keer dat de wasmachine
wordt gebruikt.
• Als het alarm afgaat, reinigt u tevens het vuilfilter (raadpleeg de sectie "Het vuilfilter
reinigen" op pagina 33). Anders gaat mogelijk de bellenfunctie minder goed werken.
dE WAsMAcHinE lAtEn lEEGlopEn in EEn noodGEvAl
1. Haal de stekker van de wasmachine uit het stopcontact.
2. Open de filterklep met behulp van een muntstuk of een
sleutel.
3. Draai de dop van de afvoer voor noodgevallen linksom los.
4. Verwijder het dopje waarmee de afvoer voor noodgevallen
is afgesloten.
5. Laat het water in een bak lopen.
Mogelijk is er meer water achtergebleven dan u had
verwacht. Houd een grotere bak bij de hand.
6. Plaats het dopje terug op de afvoer voor noodgevallen en
maak deze vast aan de bevestigingshaak.
7. Doe de filterklep weer dicht.
filterklep
Afvoer voor
noodgevallen
dop van
afvoer voor
noodgevallen
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 31 2012-4-16 13:10:3032_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
dE WAsMiddEllAdE En dE UitspArinG rEiniGEn
1. Druk de vergrendeling binnen in de
wasmiddellade in en trek deze naar buiten.
2. Haal de verdeler voor vloeibare wasmiddelen
uit de wasmiddellade.
3. Was alle onderdelen onder stromend water.
4. Reinig de uitsparing met een oude tandenborstel.
5. Plaats de verdeler voor vloeibare wasmiddelen terug in de
lade door deze stevig vast te drukken.
6. Duw de lade terug op zijn plaats.
7. Laat de wasmachine een keer spoelen met een lege
trommel om eventuele wasmiddelresten te verwijderen.
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
vergrendeling
vloeibaar wasmiddelbakje
(geselecteerd model)
verdeler voor vloeibare
wasmiddelen
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 32 2012-4-16 13:10:32reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine _33
03 Reiniging en ondeRhoud
HEt vUilfiltEr rEiniGEn
We raden aan om het vuilfilter 5 à 6 keer per jaar te reinigen, of wanneer de foutmelding “5E” wordt
weergegeven. (Lees ook “De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een noodgeval” op de vorige pagina.)
Trek altijd, voordat u het afvoerfilter schoonmaakt, de stekker uit het stopcontact.
1. Verwijder eerst het achtergebleven water ( raadpleeg
daarvoor “De wasmachine laten leeglopen in een
noodgeval” op bladzijde 31.)
Als u de filter eruit neemt zonder het achtergebleven
water weg te laten lopen, kan dit eruit druppelen.
2. Open de afdekplaat van het filter met behulp van een
muntstuk of een sleutel.
3. Draai het deksel van de afvoer voor noodgevallen linksom
los en laat al het water weglopen.
4. Draai de dop van het vuilfilter los.
5. Spoel vuil en ander materiaal van het filter. Zorg dat de
propeller van de afvoerpomp achter het filter niet wordt
geblokkeerd.
6. Plaats de dop van het filter terug.
7. Doe de filterklep weer dicht.
Open het deksel van de gruisfilter niet terwijl de wasmachine aan
staat omdat het water er dan uit kan stromen.
• Zorg ervoor dat het filterdeksel wordt teruggeplaatst nadat u de filter schoongemaakt hebt. Als het
filter niet aanwezig is functioneert de wasmachine mogelijk niet goed of lekt er water uit.
• Na het schoonmaken moet de filter weer volledig in elkaar worden gezet.
dE BUitEnKAnt rEiniGEn
1. U kunt de oppervlakken van de wasmachine, ook het bedieningspaneel, afnemen met een
zachte doek en niet-schurende reinigingsmiddelen voor huishoudelijk gebruik.
2. Droog de oppervlakken af met een zachte doek.
3. Giet geen water op de wasmachine.
dop van
vuilfilter
voorzicHtiG
voorzicHtiG
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 33 2012-4-16 13:10:3334_ reiniging en onderhoud van uw wasmachine
HEt filtEr vAn dE WAtErslAnG rEiniGEn
U dient het filter van de waterslang minimaal eens per jaar te reinigen, of wanneer de foutmelding “4E”
wordt weergegeven.
1. Draai de watertoevoer naar de wasmachine dicht.
2. Schroef de slang aan de achterkant van de wasmachine los. Houd een doekje op de slang
om te voorkomen dat er door de druk water uit de slang stroomt.
3. Trek het filter voorzichtig met een tangetje uit het uiteinde van de slang en spoel het onder de
kraan schoon. Reinig ook de binnen- en buitenkant van het draadverbindingsstuk.
4. Duw het filter terug op zijn plaats.
5. Schroef de slang weer vast aan de wasmachine.
6. Draai de kraan open en controleer of de verbindingen waterdicht zijn.
EEn BEvrorEn WAsMAcHinE rEpArErEn
Als de temperatuur zakt tot onder het vriespunt en uw wasmachine bevriest, doet u het volgende:
1. Haal de stekker van de wasmachine uit het stopcontact.
2. Giet warm water over de kraan om de toevoerslang los te maken.
3. Verwijder de watertoevoerslang en laat deze in warm water weken.
4. Giet warm water in de wastrommel en laat dit 10 minuten staan.
5. Sluit de watertoevoerslang weer aan op de kraan en controleer of de watertoevoer en afvoer
normaal functioneren.
dE WAsMAcHinE opslAAn
Als u uw wasmachine langere tijd moet opslaan, is het beter om deze leeg te laten lopen en los te
koppelen van de elektriciteit. Wasmachines kunnen beschadigen wanneer er water in de slangen en interne
onderdelen blijft staan tijdens de opslag.
1. Selecteer het Kort programma 15 min en doe bleekmiddel in het bleekmiddelvakje. Laat uw
wasmachine het programma leeg uitvoeren.
2. Draai de kranen dicht en koppel de toevoerslangen los.
3. Koppel de wasmachine los van het stopcontact en laat de deur van de wasmachine open
staan zodat de trommel kan ventileren.
Laat voordat u de wasmachine weer in gebruik neemt het achtergebleven water ontdooien
wanneer de wasmachine is opgeslagen op een plek met vorst.
reiniging en onderhoud van uw
wasmachine
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 34 2012-4-16 13:10:33problemen oplossen en foutcodes _35
04 Problemen oPlossen
problemen oplossen en
foutcodes
controlEEr dEzE pUntEn Bij proBlEMEn MEt UW
WAsMAcHinE
pROblEEm OplOSSING
de machine wil niet starten • Controleer of de stekker in het stopcontact zit.
• Controleer of de deur goed gesloten is.
• Controleer of de waterkraan open is.
• Druk op de knop Start/Pause.
Er is geen of niet genoeg
water
• Draai de kraan volledig open.
• Controleer of de toevoerslang niet bevroren is.
• Leg de toevoerslang recht.
• Reinig het filter in de watertoevoerslang.
na voltooiing van het
wasprogramma is
wasmiddel achtergebleven
in de wasmiddellade
• Controleer of de wasmachine met voldoende waterdruk werkt.
• Let erop dat het wasmiddel midden in de wasmiddellade wordt
gestopt.
de wasmachine schudt of
maakt te veel geluid.
• Controleer of de machine op een vlakke ondergrond staat. Als dit niet
het geval is, stelt u de poten van de wasmachine in om hem waterpas
te zetten.
• Controleer of de transportbouten zijn verwijderd.
• Controleer of de wasmachine geen contact maakt met een ander
voorwerp.
• Controleer of het wasgoed gelijkmatig verdeeld is in de trommel.
de wasmachine voert geen
water af en/of centrifugeert
niet
• Leg de afvoerslang recht. Vermijd geknikte slangen.
• Controleer of het vuilfilter niet verstopt is.
de deur zit dicht en kan niet
geopend worden.
• Al het water uit de wastrommel moet zijn afgepompt.
• Het controlelampje voor het deurslot moet uit zijn. Het controlelampje
voor het deurslot gaat uit zodra het water is afgepompt.
de afvoerpomp genereert
een vreemd geluid.
• Controleer dat de afvoerpomp niet geblokkeerd is door afval of
viezigheid. Reinig het afvalfilter om geluid te reduceren.
Neem contact op met de klantenservice van Samsung wanneer het probleem zich blijft voordoen.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 35 2012-4-16 13:10:3336_ problemen oplossen en foutcodes
foUtcodEs
Bij problemen met uw wasmachine wordt er mogelijk een foutcode weergegeven in het display. Kijk in deze
tabel en probeer de voorgestelde oplossing voor u de klantenservice belt.
CODE OplOSSING
dE
• Controleer of de deur goed gesloten is.
• Zorg dat er geen was tussen de deur komt.
4E
• Controleer of de waterkraan open is.
• Controleer de waterdruk.
5E
• Reinig het vuilfilter.
• Controleer of de afvoerslang goed geïnstalleerd is.
UE
• Het wasgoed is onevenwichtig verdeeld. Verdeel het opnieuw. Als u
slechts één voorwerp wast, bijvoorbeeld een badjas of spijkerbroek,
is het mogelijk dat de laatste centrifugeronde niet goed verloopt. De
foutmelding “UE” wordt dan in het display weergegeven.
cE/3E • Bel de klantenservice.
Sud
• Dit verschijnt als een teveel aan schuim wordt geconstateerd. Het
wordt ook weergegeven tijdens het verwijderen van het schuim.
Nadat het verwijderen van het schuim is beëindigd, wordt het normale
wasprogramma hervat. (Dit is één van een aantal normale processen).
Het is een foutmelding om andere dan door de sensor geconstateerde
fouten te voorkomen.)
Uc
• Wanneer het voltage van de geleverde elektriciteit instabiel is,
wordt de wasmachine stilgezet om de elektrische voorzieningen te
beschermen.
• Wordt het juiste voltage weer geleverd dan word het wasprogramma
automatisch hervat.
Bel het servicecentrum van Samsung of uw plaatselijke Samsung-dealer wanneer er een code verschijnt die
hier niet vermeld is, of wanneer de voorgestelde oplossing niet werkt.
problemen oplossen en
foutcodes
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 36 2012-4-16 13:10:34programmaoverzicht _37
05 Overzicht van wasprOgramma’s
programmaoverzicht
proGrAMMAovErzicHt
( gebruikersoptie)
pROGRAmmA
max. lading (kg) Wasmiddel
max. temp.
(˚C)
Centrifugesnelheid
(max.) toeren/min
Wf710/Wf712 Voorwas Hoofdwas Wasverzachter Wf710/Wf712
Katoen 7,0 ja 95 1400
synthetisch 2,5 ja 60 1200
jeans 3,0 ja 60 800
Beddengoed 2,0 ja 40 800
donkere kleding 3,0 ja 40 1200
dagelijkse was 2,0 ja 60 1400
Eco trommelreiniging - - ja - 70 400
Babykleding 3,0 ja 95 1400
sportkleding 2,5 ja 60 1200
Handwas 2,0 - ja 40 400
Wol 2,0 - ja 40 800
pROGRAmmA Voorwas Intensief Weken Uitgesteld einde
Kort
programma
Kreukvrij
Katoen
synthetisch -
jeans -
Beddengoed -
donkere kleding - -
dagelijkse was -
Eco trommelreiniging - - - - -
Babykleding -
sportkleding -
Handwas - - - - -
Wol - - - - -
1. Een programma met voorwas duurt ongeveer 18 minuten langer.
2. De gegevens met betrekking tot de duur van wasprogramma’s zijn gemeten onder de omstandigheden
die in de standaard IEC 60456 / EN 60456 zijn aangegeven.
Voer na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit (zie pagina 20).
3. Uw verbruik kan afwijken van de in het schema weergegeven waarden als gevolg van verschillen in
waterdruk en -temperatuur, de lading en het soort wasgoed.
4. Wanneer de functie Intensief wassen is geselecteerd, wordt elke cyclus van het programma verlengd.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 37 2012-4-16 13:10:3438_ appendix
appendix
WAsvoorscHriftEn
De volgende symbolen worden gebruikt in wasvoorschriften. Op waslabels staan vier symbolen in deze
volgorde: wassen, bleken, drogen en strijken.Indien nodig staat er ook informatie over stomen.
Deze symbolen zorgen voor overeenstemming voor kleding van verschillende fabrikanten. Volg de
aanwijzingen op het waslabel op zodat de kleding zo lang mogelijk meegaat en om problemen bij het
wassen te voorkomen.
Sterk materiaal
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
100 ˚C
Kwetsbaar materiaal Niet strijken
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
95 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – alle
gebruikelijke solventen
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
60 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – alle solventen
behalve trichloretheen
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
40 ˚C
Chemisch reinigen – uitsluitend
petroleum-solventen en R113
Artikel kan worden gewassen op
30 ˚C
Alleen chemisch reinigen
Handwas Liggend drogen
Niet wassen Hangend drogen
Kan in koud water worden gebleekt Drogen aan kledinghanger
Niet bleken
Kan in de wasdroger, normale
temperatuur
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
200 ˚C
Kan in de wasdroger, lage
temperatuur
Kan worden gestreken op maximaal
150 ˚C
Kan niet in de wasdroger
zorG voor HEt MiliEU
• Dit apparaat is gemaakt van recyclebare materialen. Houdt u zich bij het wegdoen van dit apparaat aan
de plaatselijke wetten met betrekking tot afvalverwerking. Snijd het snoer door zodat het apparaat niet
meer kan worden aangesloten op een stroombron. Verwijder de deur zodat dieren en kleine kinderen
zich niet in het apparaat kunnen opsluiten.
• Gebruik niet meer wasmiddel dan aanbevolen in de instructies van de wasmiddelfabrikant.
• Gebruik alleen vlekkenverwijderaars en bleekmiddelen als dit echt nodig is.
• Bespaar water en elektriciteit door alleen volle trommels te wassen (de precieze hoeveelheid is
afhankelijk van het gebruikte wasprogramma).
vErKlArinG vAn conforMitEit
Dit apparaat voldoet aan de Europese veiligheidsnormen, EU-richtlijn 93/68 en EN-standaard 60335.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 38 2012-4-16 13:10:43appendix _39
06 Appendix
ovErzicHt HUisHoUdElijKE WAsMAcHinEs
Volgens EU-verordening nr. 1061/2010
samsung
Modelnaam
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
capaciteit kg 7
Energierendement
A+++ (meest efficiënt) tot d (minst efficiënt) A+++
Energieverbruik
jaarlijks energieverbruik (AE_c)
1)
kWh/jr 175
Energieverbruik (E_t.60) ‘Katoen 60ºc’ bij volledige lading kWh 0,85
Energieverbruik (E_t.60.1/2) ‘Katoen 60 ºc’ met gedeeltelijke lading kWh 0,86
Energieverbruik (E_t.40.1/2) 'Katoen 40 ºc' met gedeeltelijke lading kWh 0,59
Gewogen vermogen uit-modus (p_o) W 0,45
Gewogen vermogen in aan-modus (p_l) W 5
jaarlijkse waterconsumptie (AW_c)
2)
L/yr 9400
Efficiëntieklasse centrifugering
3)
A (meest efficiënt) tot G (minst efficiënt) B
Maximale centrifugeringssnelheid rpm 1400
restvocht % 53
programma’s waarop de informatie op het etiket en het overzicht van toepassing is Katoen 60 ºC en 40 ºC + Intensief
4)
programmaduur van het standaardprogramma
'Katoen 60 ºc' bij volledige lading minuten 225
‘Katoen 60 ºc’ bij gedeeltelijke lading minuten 205
'Katoen 40 ºc' bij gedeeltelijke lading minuten 185
Gewogen vermogen in aan-modus minuten 2
Uitstoot van luchtgeluid
Wassen dB (A) re 1 pW 50
centrifugeren dB (A) re 1 pW 74
Afmetingen
Afmetingen eenheid
Hoogte mm 850
Breedte mm 600
Diepte
5) mm 550
nettogewicht kg 62
Brutogewicht kg 64
Gewicht (verpakt) kg 2
Waterdruk kPa 50-800
Elektrische verbinding
voltage V 220-240
Energieverbruik W 2000-2400
frequentie Hz 50
naam van de leverancier Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
1. Het jaarlijkse energieverbruik is gebaseerd op 220 standaardwasbeurten voor katoenprogramma's
op 60 °C en 40 °C met volle en gedeeltelijke lading, en het verbruik van de uit- en aan-modi. Het
werkelijke energieverbruik hangt af van de manier waarop het apparaat wordt gebruikt.
2. Het jaarlijkse waterverbruik is gebaseerd op 220 standaardwasbeurten voor katoenprogramma's
op 60 °C en 40 °C met volle en gedeeltelijke lading. Het werkelijke waterverbruik hangt af van de
manier waarop het apparaat wordt gebruikt.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 39 2012-4-16 13:10:4340_ appendix
appendix
3. Restwater is erg belangrijk wanneer u een droger gebruikt om uw kleren te drogen.
De energiekosten voor drogen zijn veel hoger dan die voor wassen.
Bij wassen met hoge centrifugeersnelheid wordt meer energie bespaard dan bij het drogen van
kleren in een droger.
4. Het standaardkatoenprogramma 60 °C en het standaardkatoenprogramma 40 °C, die u kunt
selecteren door de optie Intensief toe te voegen aan het katoenprogramma 60 °C en het
katoenprogramma 40 °C, zijn geschikt voor het reinigen van normaal bevuild katoenwasgoed.
Deze programma’s zijn de efficiëntste (wat betreft water- en energieverbruik) voor dit type
wasgoed.
Voer na de installatie de kalibratiemodus uit (zie pagina 20).
In deze wasprogramma’s kan de werkelijke temperatuur van het water afwijken van de aangegeven
temperatuur.
5. Afstand van de wand tot de eenheid is niet opgenomen in de afmeting van de diepte.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 40 2012-4-16 13:10:43memo
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 41 2012-4-16 13:10:43WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 42 2012-4-16 13:10:43WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 43 2012-4-16 13:10:43VRAGEN OF OPMERKINGEN?
land bEl Of bEZOEK ONZE WEbSITE
NEDERLAND 0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864) (€ 0,10/Min) www.samsung.com
BELGIË 02-201-24-18
www.samsung.com/be (Dutch)
www.samsung.com/be_fr (French)
Codenr. DC68-03149H_NL
WF712Y4BK-03149H_NL.indd 44 2012-4-16 13:10:44Lave-linge
Manuel d’utilisation
Un monde de possibilités
Nous vous remercions d’avoir choisi ce produit Samsung.
Afin de bénéficier d’un service plus complet, veuillez
enregistrer votre produit à l’adresse suivante :
www.samsung.com/register
Ce manuel est fait avec du papier recyclé à 100%.
WF710Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK**
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 1 2012-4-16 13:08:062_ Caractéristiques de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung
Caractéristiques de votre
nouveau lave-linge Samsung
Avec ce nouveau lave-linge, faire une lessive prend un tout autre sens. Capacité
XXL, économies d’énergie...Le lave-linge Samsung possède toutes les
caractéristiques nécessaires pour transformer une tâche désagréable en un vrai
moment de plaisir.
• Économies d’énergie
Ce modèle permet une utilisation plus économique par comparaison aux machines classées «
A » grâce au système de générateur spécial Bubble et au moteur à inverseur Samsung.
• Moins de bruit et de vibrations
Ce lave-linge Samsung fonctionne en silence, en réduisant le bruit et les vibrations grâce à la
technologie de contrôle intelligente, qui lui permet de conserver les vibrations les plus faibles
possibles. Ainsi le tambour garde un équilibre parfait.
• Lavage express
Pas de temps à perdre ! Nos 15 minutes de lavage express vous permettront de laver et de
poursuivre vos activités.Notre programme de lavage express est destiné à ceux qui n'ont pas
le temps - maintenant vous pouvez laver vos vêtements préférés (jusqu'à 2 kg) en seulement
15 minutes !
• Lavage du tambour
La fonction Lavage du tambour permet d'entretenir la propreté du lave-linge, sans ajouter
de nettoyant chimique ni d'eau de Javel. Ce programme de nettoyage spécial vous donne
l'assurance d'avoir toujours un tambour propre et sans odeur.
• Cycle bébé
Votre lave-linge Samsung propose des programmes spéciaux pour protéger les vêtements
des enfants à la peau sensible.
Ils réduisent les irritations de la peau des enfants en diminuant les résidus de lessive. Ces
programmes permettent en outre de classer le linge en différents types ; le lavage est donc
effectué selon les caractéristiques de chaque type.Les enfants ressentent ainsi une agréable
sensation de propreté lorsqu’ils mettent leurs vêtements.
• Lavage à la main
Pour laver tout en douceur vos vêtements les plus fragiles, il convient de choisir la
température, le cycle de lavage et la quantité d’eau appropriés.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 2 2012-4-16 13:08:07Caractéristiques de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung _3
• Sécurité enfant
La fonction Sécurité enfant empêche les plus jeunes de jouer avec le lave-linge.
Cette fonction de sécurité empêche non seulement les enfants de jouer avec les fonctions du
lave-linge, mais elle vous avertit aussi lorsqu’elle est activée.
• Arrêt différé
Ce lave-linge vous permet de différer le départ d’un programme de 19 heures, par tranches
d’une heure - pour un confort d’utilisation optimal.
• Affichage Numérique
Le panneau de configuration Affichage Numérique est clair et facile à utiliser pour un minimum
de manipulations sans tracas. Et en plus d'être facile à utiliser, l'affichage numérique vous
permet de faire à votre lessive des ajustements rapides et précis pour d'excellents résultats
de lavage.
• Tuyaux aquastop & détecteur de fuite (sur certains modèles)
Le système de sécurité d'eau intelligemment conçus pour les machines à laver Samsung
comprend un tuyau intelligent pour stopper les fuites d'eau à la source et un détecteur de
fuite à la base. Si des ruptures du tuyau ou des fuites d'eau sont détectées, une éponge
interne se dilatera pour bloquer l'eau du robinet.
Ce manuel contient de précieuses informations relatives à l’installation, à l’utilisation et à
l’entretien de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung. Reportez-vous aux descriptions du panneau
de commande, aux consignes d’utilisation du lave-linge, ainsi qu’aux conseils pratiques pour
profiter pleinement des caractéristiques et fonctions de pointe de votre machine. La section
« Codes d’erreur et de dépannage » de la page 35 vous explique ce qu’il y a lieu de faire en cas
de problème avec votre nouveau lave-linge.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 3 2012-4-16 13:08:074_ Consignes de sécurité
Consignes de sécurité
Félicitations pour l’achat de votre nouveau lave-linge Samsung ActivFresh™.
Ce manuel contient des informations importantes sur l’installation, l’utilisation et
l’entretien de votre appareil. Prenez le temps de lire ce manuel afin de pouvoir
profiter pleinement des nombreux avantages et fonctions de votre lave-linge.
Ce que vouS devez SAvoir à propoS deS CoNSigNeS de
SÉCuriTÉ
Veuillez lire attentivement ce manuel pour vous assurer que vous savez comment utiliser efficacement toutes les
caractéristiques et fonctions de votre nouvel appareil en toute sécurité ; conservez-le dans un endroit sûr à proximité de
l’appareil pour vous y référer ultérieurement. Utilisez uniquement cet appareil pour son usage prévu, tel que décrit dans
ce manuel d’utilisation.
Les avertissements et les consignes de sécurité importantes cités dans ce manuel ne couvrent pas toutes les
conditions et les situations susceptibles de se produire. Il est de votre responsabilité de faire preuve de bon sens, de
prudence et de discernement lors de l’installation, de l’entretien et de l’utilisation de votre lave-linge.
Parce que les consignes d’utilisation suivantes concernent plusieurs modèles, les caractéristiques de votre lave-linge
sont peut-être légèrement différentes de celles décrites dans ce manuel et l’ensemble des symboles d’avertissement
peuvent ne pas s’appliquer à vous. Pour toute question ou renseignement, contactez le service après-vente le plus
proche ou recherchez des informations et consultez l’aide en ligne sur www.samsung.com.
SyMboLeS eT prÉCAuTioNS de SÉCuriTÉ iMporTANTS
Signification des icônes et des symboles utilisés dans ce manuel:
AVERTISSEMENT
Risques ou pratiques dangereuses susceptibles de provoquer des
blessures corporelles graves, le décès et/ou des dommages
matériels.
ATTENTION
Risques ou pratiques dangereuses susceptibles de provoquer des
blessures corporelles graves et/ou des dommages matériels.
ATTENTION
Pour réduire le risque d’incendie, d’explosion, de choc électrique ou
de blessure corporelle lors de l’utilisation de votre lave-linge, suivez ces
précautions de base:
Ne PAS essayer.
Ne PAS démonter.
Ne PAS toucher.
Suivre les consignes scrupuleusement.
Débrancher la prise d’alimentation de la prise murale.
Vérifier que le lave-linge est mis à la terre pour éviter tout choc électrique.
Appeler le service après-vente pour obtenir de l’aide.
Note
Ces symboles d’avertissement sont présents pour prévenir toute blessure, à vous-même
ou à d’autres personnes.
veuillez les respecter scrupuleusement.
Après avoir lu cette section, conservez-la dans un endroit sûr pour vous y référer
ultérieurement.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 4 2012-4-16 13:08:11Consignes de sécurité _5
Lisez l’ensemble des consignes avant d’utiliser l’appareil.
Comme pour tout appareil électrique comportant des parties mobiles, des risques existent.
Pour utiliser cet appareil en toute sécurité, familiarisez-vous avec son fonctionnement et
faites preuve de prudence lorsque vous l’utilisez.
Ne laissez pas les enfants (ou les animaux) jouer sur ou à l’intérieur de votre lave-linge. La porte du
lave-linge ne s’ouvre pas facilement de l’intérieur, et il existe un risque de blessure grave si un enfant
est enfermé à l’intérieur.
Cet appareil n’est pas prévu pour être utilisé par des personnes (y compris les enfants) dont les
capacités physiques, sensorielles ou mentales sont réduites ou des personnes dénuées d’expérience
ou de connaissance, sauf si elles ont pu bénéficier, par l’intermédiaire d’une personne responsable de
leur sécurité, d’une surveillance ou d’instructions préalables concernant l’utilisation de l’appareil.
Les enfants doivent être surveillés afin qu’ils ne jouent pas avec l’appareil.
Si la prise (cordon d’alimentation) est endommagée, elle doit être remplacée par le fabricant, son
service après-vente ou une personne qualifiée afin de prévenir tout risque.
Cet appareil doit être placé de manière à ce que l’on puisse facilement accéder à la prise
d’alimentation, aux robinets d’arrivée d’eau et aux tuyaux d’évacuation.
Pour les lave-linge équipés de ventilations à la base, assurez-vous que l’ouverture ne soit pas obstruée
par un tapis ou tout autre obstacle.
Utilisez les nouveaux tuyaux fournis, les anciens tuyaux ne doivent pas être réutilisés.
iNSTruCTioNS CoNCerNANT LA MArque deee
Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets
d’équipements électriques et électroniques)
(Applicable dans les pays de l’Union Européenne et dans d’autres pays européens
pratiquant le tri sélectif)
Ce symbole sur le produit, ses accessoires ou sa documentation indique que ni le produit, ni
ses accessoires électroniques usagés (chargeur, casque audio, câble USB, etc.) ne peuvent être
jetés avec les autres déchets ménagers. La mise au rebut incontrôlée des déchets présentant
des risques environnementaux et de santé publique, veuillez séparer vos produits et accessoires
usagés des autres déchets. Vous favoriserez ainsi le recyclage de la matière qui les compose
dans le cadre d’un développement durable.
Les particuliers sont invités à contacter le magasin leur ayant vendu le produit ou à se renseigner
auprès des autorités locales pour connaître les procédures et les points de collecte de ces
produits en vue de leur recyclage.
Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les
conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit et ses accessoires ne peuvent être jetés avec les
autres déchets professionnels et commerciaux.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 5 2012-4-16 13:08:126_ Consignes de sécurité
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour
L’iNSTALLATioN
Cet appareil doit être installé par un technicien qualifié ou par une entreprise spécialisée.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie,
une explosion, des problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
L’appareil est lourd, soyez donc prudent lorsque vous le soulevez.
Branchez le cordon d'alimentation dans une prise murale, AC de 220V/50Hz/15A une
prise de courant approuvé et protégée par un fusible ou un disjoncteur. N’utilisez pas de
rallonge.
- Partager une prise murale avec d’autres appareils via une multiprise ou brancher une
rallonge au cordon d’alimentation pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
- Assurez-vous que la tension d’alimentation, la fréquence et le courant correspondent
aux spécifications du produit. Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un
choc électrique ou un incendie. Enfoncez fermement la prise d’alimentation dans la prise
murale.
Essuyer régulièrement les bornes et les points de contact de la prise d’alimentation à l’aide
d’un chiffon sec afin d’en retirer toute substance étrangère, telle que de la poussière ou de
l’eau.
- Débranchez la prise d’alimentation et nettoyez-la à l’aide d’un chiffon sec.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Branchez la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale dans le bon sens, de manière à ce
que le cordon soit orienté vers le sol.
- Si vous branchez la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale dans le sens opposé, les
fils électriques du cordon d’alimentation risquent d’être endommagés et cela pourrait
provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Conservez tous les éléments d’emballage hors de portée des enfants, car ils présentent un
danger pour les enfants.
- Un enfant pourrait s’étouffer s’il met sa tête dans un sac.
Lorsque l’appareil, la prise d’alimentation ou le cordon d’alimentation sont endommagés,
contactez votre service après-vente.
Cet appareil doit être correctement mis à la terre.
Ne mettez pas l’appareil à la terre avec un tuyau de gaz, un tuyau d’eau en plastique ou
une ligne téléphonique.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie, une explosion ou des
problèmes avec le produit
- Ne branchez jamais le cordon d’alimentation dans une prise qui n’est pas correctement
mise à la terre et assurez-vous qu’elle soit conforme aux codes de votre région et de
votre pays.
N’installez pas cet appareil à proximité d’un appareil de chauffage ou de matériaux
inflammables.
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit humide, gras, poussiéreux, directement exposé
à la lumière du jour ou à de l’eau (gouttes de pluie).
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit à basses températures
- Le gel pourrait provoquer la rupture des tuyaux
N’installez pas cet appareil dans un endroit où une fuite de gaz pourrait survenir.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Consignes de sécurité
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 6 2012-4-16 13:08:12Consignes de sécurité _7
N’utilisez pas de transformateur électrique.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
N’utilisez pas une prise d’alimentation qui est endommagée, un cordon d’alimentation
endommagée ou une prise murale mal scellée.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne tirez pas sur le cordon d’alimentation, ne pliez pas le cordon d’alimentation.
Ne tordez pas le cordon d’alimentation, n’y faites pas de nœud.
Ne faites pas passer le cordon d’alimentation sur un objet métallique, ne placez pas d’objet
lourd sur le cordon d’alimentation, ne glissez pas le cordon d’alimentation entre des objets,
ne poussez pas le cordon d’alimentation dans l’espace qui se trouve derrière l’appareil.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne tirez pas sur le cordon d’alimentation lorsque vous débranchez la prise d’alimentation.
- Débranchez le cordon d’alimentation en tenant la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne placez pas le cordon d’alimentation et les tuyaux là où ils pourraient vous faire chuter.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS pour L’iNSTALLATioN
Cet appareil doit être placé de façon à laisser libre accès à la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie
dû à une fuite électrique.
Installez votre appareil sur un sol plat et dur qui pourra supporter son poids.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer des vibrations, déplacements et
bruits anormaux ou provoquer des problèmes avec le produit.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour
L’uTiLiSATioN
En cas de dégât des eaux, coupez immédiatement l’arrivée d’eau et l’alimentation
électrique et contactez le service après-vente le plus proche.
- Ne touchez pas la prise d’alimentation avec des mains humides ou mouillées
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique
Si l’appareil émet un bruit étrange, qu’il s’en dégage une odeur de brûlé ou de la fumée,
débranchez immédiatement la prise d’alimentation et contactez votre service après-vente.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
En cas de fuite de gaz (propane, GPL, etc.), aérez immédiatement sans toucher la prise
d’alimentation. Ne touchez ni l’appareil, ni le cordon d’alimentation.
- N’utilisez pas de ventilateur.
- Une étincelle pourrait provoquer une explosion ou un incendie.
Ne laissez pas les enfants jouer sur ou à l’intérieur du lave-linge. Lors de l’élimination de
l’appareil, pensez à retirer le levier de la porte.
- Si l’enfant est enfermé à l’intérieur, il pourrait mourir asphyxié.
Veillez à enlever tous les éléments d’emballage (polystyrène, mousse) accrochés au bas de
l’appareil avant de l’utiliser.
AverTiSSeMeNT
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 7 2012-4-16 13:08:128_ Consignes de sécurité
Ne lavez pas le linge contaminé par de l’essence, du kérosène, du benzène, du diluant
pour peinture, de l’alcool ou toute autre substance inflammable ou explosive.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie ou une explosion.
N’ouvrez pas la porte du lave-linge de force pendant qu’il fonctionne (lavage / séchage /
essorage à haute température).
- L’eau éjectée du lave-linge pourrait provoquer des brûlures ou rendre le sol glissant.
Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
- Ouvrir la porte de force pourrait endommager le produit ou provoquer des blessures.
Ne passez pas vos mains sous le lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Ne touchez pas le cordon d’alimentation avec des mains humides ou mouillées.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique.
N’éteignez pas l’appareil en débranchant la prise d’alimentation pendant qu’une opération
est en cours.
- Rebrancher la prise d’alimentation dans la prise murale pourrait provoquer une étincelle,
ce qui risquerait de provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Ne laissez pas les enfants ou les personnes infirmes utiliser ce lave-linge sans surveillance.
Ne laissez pas les enfants grimper dans l’appareil.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, des brûlures ou
des blessures.
Ne passez pas vos mains ou un objet métallique sous le lave-linge pendant qu’il fonctionne.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Ne débranchez pas l’appareil en tirant sur le cordon d’alimentation, saisissez toujours
fermement la prise d’alimentation et tirez en la maintenant au même niveau que la prise
murale.
- L’endommagement du cordon d’alimentation pourrait provoquer un court-circuit, un
incendie et/ou un choc électrique
N’essayez pas de réparer, de démonter ou de modifier l’appareil vous-même.
- N’utilisez pas de fusibles (comme un fil de cuivre ou d’acier, etc.) autres que les fusibles
standards.
- Lorsqu’il est nécessaire de réparer ou de réinstaller l’appareil, contactez votre service
après-vente.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie,
des problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
Si une substance étrangère telle que de l’eau s’est infiltrée dans l’appareil, débranchez la
prise d’alimentation et contactez votre service après-vente.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Si le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau se détache du robinet et que de l’eau asperge l’appareil,
débranchez la prise d’alimentation.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Débranchez la prise d’alimentation lorsque l’appareil n’est pas utilisé pendant longtemps ou
lorsqu’il y a de l’orage.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
Consignes de sécurité
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 8 2012-4-16 13:08:13Consignes de sécurité _9
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS pour L’uTiLiSATioN
Lorsque le lave-linge est contaminé par une substance étrangère telle que de la lessive, de
la saleté, des résidus alimentaires, etc., débranchez la prise d’alimentation et nettoyez le
lave-linge avec un chiffon doux humide.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer une décoloration, une déformation,
une détérioration ou l’apparition de rouille au niveau de l’appareil.
La partie en verre de la face avant de l’appareil est susceptible de se briser suite à un
impact fort. Soyez prudent lorsque vous utilisez le lave-linge.
- Le bris du verre pourrait provoquer des blessures.
Après une coupure d’eau ou lorsque vous rebranchez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau, ouvrez le
robinet doucement.
Ouvrez le robinet doucement après une longue période sans utilisation.
- La pression de l’air dans le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau ou dans le tuyau d’eau pourrait
endommager un élément de l’appareil ou provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Si une erreur de vidange survient pendant une opération, vérifiez s’il y a un problème avec
l’évacuation de l’eau.
- Si le lave-linge est utilisé alors qu’il est victime d’un dégât des eaux résultant d’un
problème de vidange, cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie dû à
une fuite électrique.
Placez le linge entièrement dans le lave-linge afin qu’il ne se coince pas dans la porte.
- Si du linge se coince dans la porte, cela pourrait endommager le linge, le lave-linge, ou
provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Assurez-vous que le robinet soit bien éteint lorsque l’eau n’est pas utilisée.
- Assurez-vous que la vis du raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau soit bien serrée.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer des dommages matériels ou des
blessures.
Vérifiez que le joint en caoutchouc n’est pas contaminé par des substances étrangères
(résidus, fils, etc.).
- Si la porte n’est pas complètement fermée, cela pourrait provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Ouvrez le robinet et assurez-vous que le raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau soit bien serré et
qu’il n’y a pas de fuite d’eau avant d’utiliser le produit.
- Si les vis du raccord du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sont mal serrées, cela pourrait provoquer
une fuite d’eau.
Le produit que vous avez acheté est prévu pour une utilisation domestique uniquement.
L’utilisation à des fins professionnelles est considérée comme une utilisation non conforme
du produit.
Dans ce cas, le produit ne sera pas couvert par la garantie standard prévue par
Samsung et Samsung ne saura en aucun cas être tenu pour responsable en cas de
dysfonctionnements ou dommages résultant d’une utilisation non conforme.
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 9 2012-4-16 13:08:1310_ Consignes de sécurité
Ne montez pas sur l’appareil, ne placez pas d’objets (linge, bougies allumées, cigarettes allumées,
vaisselle, produits chimiques, objets métalliques, etc.) sur l’appareil.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer un choc électrique, un incendie, des
problèmes avec le produit ou des blessures.
Ne vaporisez pas de matériaux volatiles, tels que des insecticides, sur la surface de l’appareil.
- En plus d’être potentiellement dangereux pour l’homme, cela pourrait également provoquer un
choc électrique, un incendie ou des problèmes avec le produit.
Ne placez pas d’objets générant un champ électromagnétique à proximité du lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures résultant d’un dysfonctionnement.
L’eau vidangée pendant un lavage / séchage à haute température est chaude, ne touchez pas l’eau.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des brûlures ou des blessures.
Ne lavez pas, n’essorez pas et ne séchez pas de sièges, tapis ou vêtements imperméables (*) sauf si
votre appareil possède un programme spécifique pour laver ces articles.
- Ne lavez pas de tapis épais et raides même si l’étiquette comporte un symbole de lavage en
machine.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une blessure corporelle ou des dommages au niveau du lave-linge, des
murs, du sol ou des vêtements résultant de vibrations anormales.
* La literie en laine, les protections contre la pluie, les cirés, les pantalons de ski, les sacs de
couchage, les protège-couches, les vêtements de sudation, les protections pour vélo, moto,
voiture, etc.
Ne faites pas fonctionner le lave-linge lorsque le compartiment à lessive a été retiré.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou des blessures résultants d’une fuite d’eau.
Ne touchez pas l’intérieur du tambour pendant ou juste après un séchage car il est chaud.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des brûlures.
Ne passez pas votre main dans le compartiment à lessive après l’avoir ouvert.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des blessures si votre main était coincée par le mécanisme d’insertion de
lessive. Ne mettez aucun objet (tel que chaussures, résidus alimentaires, animaux) autres que du
linge dans le lave-linge.
- Cela pourrait endommager le lave-linge ou provoquer des blessures ou le décès de l’animal,
résultant des vibrations anormales.
N’appuyez pas sur les boutons à l’aide d’objets pointus comme des aiguilles, couteaux, ongles, etc.
- Cela pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou des blessures.
Ne lavez pas de linge contaminé par des huiles, des crèmes ou des lotions habituellement présentes
dans des instituts de soins de la peau ou des instituts de massage.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une déformation du joint en caoutchouc et une fuite d’eau.
Ne laissez pas d’objets métalliques tels que des épingles à nourrice ou des barrettes, ou de la javel,
dans le tambour pendant une longue période de temps.
- Cela pourrait provoquer la rouille du tambour.
- Si de la rouille commence à apparaître sur la surface du tambour, appliquez un nettoyant (neutre)
sur la surface et utilisez une éponge pour le nettoyer. N’utilisez jamais de brosse métallique.
N’utilisez pas de nettoyant à sec directement, ne lavez pas, ne rincez pas et n’essorez pas de linge
contaminé par un nettoyant à sec.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une combustion spontanée due à la chaleur générée par l’oxydation de
l’huile.
N’utilisez pas d’eau chaude provenant d’appareils de refroidissement/chauffage de l’eau.
- Cela pourrait provoquer des problèmes au niveau du lave-linge.
Consignes de sécurité
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 10 2012-4-16 13:08:13Consignes de sécurité _11
N’utilisez pas de savon naturel pour le lavage à la main dans le lave-linge.
- S’il durcit et s’accumule dans le lave-linge, cela pourrait provoquer des problèmes avec
le produit, une décoloration, de la rouille ou des mauvaises odeurs.
N’utilisez pas le filet de lavage pour laver de grandes pièces de linge telles que de la literie.
- Mettez les chaussettes et les soutien-gorge dans le filet de lavage et mettez-le avec le
reste du linge.
- Le non-respect de ces consignes pourrait provoquer des blessures résultant des
vibrations anormales.
N’utilisez pas de nettoyant solide.
- S’il s’accumule à l’intérieur du lave-linge, cela pourrait provoquer une fuite d’eau.
Pour les lave-linge équipés de ventilations à la base, assurez-vous que l’ouverture ne soit
pas obstruée par un tapis ou tout autre obstacle.
Assurez-vous que toutes les poches des vêtements à laver soient vides.
- Les objets durs ou pointus tels que les pièces de monnaie, les épingles à nourrice, les
ongles, les vis ou les cailloux sont susceptibles de gravement endommager l’appareil.
Ne lavez pas de vêtements avec un gros ceinturon, des gros boutons ou d’autres métaux
lourds.
SyMboLeS d’AverTiSSeMeNTS iMporTANTS pour Le
NeTToyAge
Ne nettoyez pas l’appareil en y aspergeant de l’eau directement à l’intérieur.
N’utilisez pas de benzène, de diluant ou d’alcool pour nettoyer l’appareil.
- Cela pourrait provoquer une décoloration, une déformation, un choc électrique, un
incendie ou des dommages.
Avant de nettoyer ou d’effectuer toute opération d’entretien, débranchez l’appareil de la
prise murale.
- Le non-respect de cette consigne pourrait provoquer un choc électrique ou un incendie.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 11 2012-4-16 13:08:1312_ Sommaire
Sommaire
INSTALLER LE LAVE-LINgE
13
13 Vérification des pièces
14 Respect des conditions d’installation
14 Alimentation électrique et mise à la terre
14 Arrivée d’eau
15 Vidange
15 Plancher
15 Température ambiante
15 Installation dans une niche ou une armoire
15 Installer votre lave-linge
EffECTUER UN LAVAgE
21
21 Premier lavage
21 Consignes élémentaires
22 Panneau de commande
25 Sécurité enfant
25 Arrêt son
25 Arrêt différé
26 Mon cycle
26 Laver du linge à l’aide du sélecteur de
programme
27 Laver du linge en mode manuel
27 Instructions de lavage
28 Informations sur la lessive et les additifs
28 Quelle lessive utiliser ?
29 Tiroir à lessive
29 Lessive liquide (sur certains modèles)
NETTOyAgE ET ENTRETIEN DE
VOTRE LAVE-LINgE
30
30 Lavage du tambour
31 Vidanger le lave-linge en urgence
32 Nettoyage du tiroir à lessive et du logement du
tiroir
33 Nettoyage du filtre à impuretés
33 Nettoyer l’extérieur du lave-linge
34 Nettoyer le filtre à maille du tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau
34 Réparer un lave-linge qui a gelé
34 Entreposer le lave-linge
CODES D’ERREUR ET DE
DépANNAgE
35
35 Vérifiez les points suivants si...
36 Codes d’erreur
TAbLEAU DES pROgRAMMES
37
37 Tableau des programmes
ANNExE
38
38 Tableau des symboles d’entretien des textiles
38 Protection de l’environnement
38 Déclaration de conformité
39 Fiche technique des lave-linge domestiques
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 12 2012-4-16 13:08:14Installer le lave-linge _13
01 Installat on I
Installer le lave-linge
Assurez-vous que l’installateur a suivi ces instructions à la lettre afin que votre
nouveau lave-linge fonctionne correctement et que vous ne soyez exposé à aucun
risque lorsque vous faites une lessive.
vÉrifiCATioN deS pièCeS
Déballez soigneusement votre lave-linge et vérifiez que vous disposez bien de toutes les pièces illustrées
ci-dessous. Si vous constatez que le lave-linge a été endommagé pendant le transport ou qu’il manque des
pièces, contactez le service clientèle de Samsung ou votre revendeur Samsung.
Clé Caches
pour les
trous des
vis
froide
Chaude (sur
certains modèles)
guide-tuyau fixation
d’embout
Compartiment
à lessive
liquide (sur
certains
modèles)
Tuyau d’arrivée d’eau
* Caches pour les trous des vis: Le nombre de caches pour les trous des vis dépend du modèle (3 ~
5 caches).
Tuyau de
vidange
filtre à impuretés
Tuyau de vidange
d’urgence
Capot du filtre
Tiroir à lessive
panneau de
commande
Hublot
pieds réglables
Tambour
Manette d’ouverture plan de travail
prise
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 13 2012-4-16 13:08:1814_ Installer le lave-linge
Installer le lave-linge
reSpeCT deS CoNdiTioNS d’iNSTALLATioN
Alimentation électrique et mise à la terre
Afin d’éviter tout risque d’incendie, d’électrocution ou de blessure, il est essentiel que le câblage
et la mise à la terre soient réalisés conformément aux spécifications de la dernière révision
du Code national de l’électricité (NEC) ANSI/FNPA n° 70 ainsi qu’aux réglementations et
ordonnances locales en vigueur. L’utilisation d’une alimentation électrique adaptée à cet appareil
relève de la responsabilité de son propriétaire.
N’utilisez jamais de rallonge.
Utilisez uniquement le cordon d’alimentation fourni avec votre lave-linge.
En préparation de l’installation, assurez-vous que l’alimentation électrique réunit les conditions
suivantes :
• Fusible ou coupe-circuit 220 V~240 V 50 Hz
• Circuit de dérivation distinct, réservé uniquement à votre lave-linge
Votre lave-linge doit être mis à la terre. En cas de panne ou de défaillance du lave-linge, la mise à
la terre réduira le risque de surtension électrique en fournissant au courant électrique un chemin
de moindre résistance.
Votre lave-linge est équipé d’un cordon doté d’une prise à 3 broches avec conducteur de terre
destinée à être branchée sur une prise murale correctement installée et reliée à la terre.
Ne reliez jamais un conducteur de terre à une conduite de plomberie en plastique, une
conduite de gaz ou une conduite d’eau chaude.
Un branchement incorrect du conducteur de terre peut provoquer une surtension électrique.
Demandez conseil à un électricien ou à un réparateur agréé si vous avez des doutes quant à la
mise à la terre correcte du lave-linge. Ne modifiez pas la fiche fournie avec le lave-linge. Si elle
n’est pas adaptée à la prise murale, faites appel à un électricien qualifié pour installer une prise
appropriée.
Arrivée d’eau
Pour un remplissage correct du lave-linge, la pression d’eau doit être comprise entre 50 kPa (0,5
Bar) et 800 kPa (8 Bar). Si la pression d’eau est inférieure à 50 kPa (0,5 Bar), la vanne d’arrivée
d’eau risque de ne plus se fermer correctement et la durée de remplissage risque d’augmenter
au-delà de la limite autorisée par le contrôleur, entraînant ainsi l’arrêt du lave-linge (Un limiteur de
durée de remplissage est intégré au contrôleur de l’appareil afin d’éviter tout trop-plein ou toute
inondation en cas de défaillance d’un tuyau interne.).
Les robinets d’arrivée d’eau doivent se trouver à moins de 120cm de l’arrière de votre lave-linge
afin que les tuyaux fournis puissent être reliés à l’appareil.
La plupart des magasins de fournitures de plomberie proposent des tuyaux d’alimentation
en eau de différentes longueurs (jusqu’à 305 cm).
Voici quelques conseils pour réduire les risques de fuite et de dégât des eaux :
• Faites en sorte que les robinets d’arrivée d’eau soient facilement accessibles.
• Fermez les robinets d’arrivée d’eau lorsque vous n’utilisez pas le lave-linge.
• Vérifiez régulièrement l’absence de fuites au niveau des raccords des tuyaux
d’alimentation en eau.
Avant d’utiliser votre lave-linge pour la première fois, vérifiez l’absence de fuites au niveau
des raccords avec la vanne d’arrivée d’eau et les robinets. AverTiSSeMeNT
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 14 2012-4-16 13:08:18Installer le lave-linge _15
01 Installat on I
vidange
Samsung recommande de placer le tuyau d’évacuation mural à une hauteur de 65cm. Le
tuyau de vidange doit être accroché à la pince prévue à cette effet, puis introduit dans le tuyau
d’évacuation mural. Le tuyau d’évacuation mural doit être suffisamment large pour qu’il soit
possible d’y insérer le tuyau de vidange du lave-linge. Le tuyau de vidange est fixé en usine.
plancher
Pour un fonctionnement optimal, votre lave-linge doit être installé sur un sol stable. Si le sol est
en bois, il est possible qu’il doive être renforcé afin de réduire les vibrations et les problèmes de
déséquilibre. La présence de moquette ou de surfaces molles contribue aux vibrations et/ou à la
tendance de votre lave-linge à se déplacer durant l’essorage.
N’installez jamais votre lave-linge sur une plate-forme ou sur une structure dont le soutien est
insuffisant.
Température ambiante
N’installez pas votre lave-linge dans une zone où l’eau peut geler :en effet, il subsistera
toujours une certaine quantité d’eau dans le robinet de prise d’eau, la pompe ou les tuyaux. La
présence d’eau gelée dans les conduites peut endommager les courroies, la pompe et d’autres
composants.
installation dans une niche ou une armoire
Pour garantir un fonctionnement correct et sûr de votre nouveau lave-linge, il convient de
respecter les exigences suivantes en termes de dégagement :
Côtés – 25 mm Arrière – 50 mm
Haut – 25 mm Avant – 465 mm
Si le lave-linge et un sèche-linge sont installés ensemble, il doit y avoir une aération d’au moins
465 mm sans obstacle à l’avant de la niche ou de l’armoire. Installé seul, votre lave-linge ne
nécessite pas d’aération spécifique.
iNSTALLer voTre LAve-LiNge
ETApE 1
Choisir un emplacement
Avant d’installer votre lave-linge, vérifiez que l’emplacement choisi :
• Possède une surface dure et de niveau, sans moquette ou autre revêtement de sol
susceptible d’obstruer l’aération.
• N’est pas exposé à la lumière directe du soleil
• Dispose d’une ventilation adaptée
• Ne risque pas de geler (température inférieure à 0 °C)
• Ne se trouve pas à proximité d’une source de chaleur, telle qu’un chauffage
• Dispose de suffisamment d’espace, de sorte que votre lave-linge ne repose pas sur son
cordon d’alimentation
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 15 2012-4-16 13:08:1916_ Installer le lave-linge
ETApE 2
enlever les vis de transport
Avant d’installer le lave-linge, vous devez enlever les cinq vis de transport à l’arrière de l’appareil.
1. Desserrez toutes les vis à l’aide de la clé fournie.
2. Maintenez la vis avec la clé et faites-la passer dans la partie
large du trou. Répétez l’opération pour chaque vis.
3. Bouchez les trous avec les caches en plastique fournis.
4. Rangez les vis de transport dans un endroit sûr, au cas où vous devriez déplacer le lave-linge
ultérieurement.
Les matériaux d’emballage peuvent être dangereux pour les enfants.Tenez tous les
emballages (sacs plastique, polystyrène, etc.) hors de leur portée.
Insérez la fixation d’embout (accessoire
fourni dans le sac en vinyle) dans le
trou duquel vous avez retiré le cordon
d’alimentation à l’arrière de l’appareil.
Installer le lave-linge
AverTiSSeMeNT
option
option
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 16 2012-4-16 13:08:20Installer le lave-linge _17
01 Installat on I
ETApE 3
Ajuster les pieds réglables
Lorsque vous installez le lave-linge, assurez-vous que la prise de courant, l’arrivée d’eau et
l’évacuation sont facilement accessibles.
1. Mettez le lave-linge en place en le faisant glisser.
2. Mettez votre lave-linge de
niveau en faisant tourner
les pieds vers la gauche
ou la droite manuellement.
3. Lorsque le lave-linge est de niveau, serrez les écrous à
l’aide de la clé fournie.
ETApE 4
raccordement de l’arrivée d’eau et de l’évacuation
Raccorder le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau
1. Prenez le raccord en L correspondant au tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau froide et raccordez-le à l’arrivée
d’eau froide, à l’arrière de la machine. Serrez à la
main.
Le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau doit être raccordé au
lave-linge à une extrémité et au robinet d’eau
à l’autre extrémité. Ne tendez pas le tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau. Si le tuyau est trop court,
remplacez-le par un tuyau haute pression plus
long.
2. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau froide au robinet d’eau froide et serrez-la à
la main. Si nécessaire, vous pouvez repositionner
le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sur le lave-linge en
desserrant le raccord, en faisant tourner le tuyau
et en resserrant le raccord.
pour les modèles équipés d’une arrivée d’eau chaude supplémentaire :
1. Prenez le raccord en L rouge correspondant au tuyau d’arrivée d’eau chaude et raccordez-le
à l’arrivée d’eau chaude située à l’arrière de la machine. Serrez à la main.
2. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau chaude au robinet d’eau chaude de
votre lavabo et serrez-la à la main.
3. Utilisez un raccord en Y si vous souhaitez utiliser uniquement l’eau froide.
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 17 2012-4-16 13:08:2318_ Installer le lave-linge
Installer le lave-linge
Raccorder le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau (sur certains modèles)
1. Enlevez l’adaptateur du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
2. À l’aide d’un tournevis cruciforme, commencez par
desserrer les quatre vis de l’adaptateur. Prenez ensuite
l’adaptateur et tournez la partie (2) dans le sens de la
flèche, jusqu’à obtenir un écart de 5 mm.
3. Raccordez l’adaptateur au robinet en serrant fermement
les vis et en levant l’adaptateur vers le haut.
Tournez la partie (2) dans le sens de la flèche, puis
raccordez (1) et (2).
4. Raccordez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à l’adaptateur.
Lorsque vous lâchez la partie (3), le tuyau se
raccorde automatiquement à l’adaptateur en
émettant un petit clic d’enclenchement.
Après avoir raccordé le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à
l’adaptateur, vérifiez que le branchement a été
correctement effectué en tirant le tuyau d’arrivée
d’eau vers le bas.
5. Raccordez l’autre extrémité du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau à la
vanne d’alimentation en eau située à l’arrière du lave-linge.
Vissez le tuyau à fond dans le sens des aiguilles d’une
montre.
Adaptateur
Tuyau
d’arrivée
d’eau
1
2
5 mm
3
1
2
robinet
option
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 18 2012-4-16 13:08:26Installer le lave-linge _19
01 Installat on I
6. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau et vérifiez l’absence de fuite au
niveau de la vanne d’arrivée d’eau, du robinet ou de
l’adaptateur. En cas de fuite d’eau, répétez les étapes
précédentes.
N’utilisez pas le lave-linge si une fuite d’eau a été
détectée. Cela pourrait en effet provoquer des blessures
ou un choc électrique.
• Si le robinet est doté d’un pas de vis, raccordez le tuyau
d’arrivée d’eau au robinet comme indiqué ci-contre.
Utilisez un robinet standard pour l’arrivée d’eau. Si le robinet est à angle droit ou s’il est trop
gros, retirez la bague d’écartement avant d’insérer le robinet dans l’adaptateur.
Raccordement de l'Aqua Hose (sur certains modèles)
L'Aqua Hose a été conçu pour assurer une protection parfaite
contre les fuites.Relié au tuyau d'arrivée d'eau, il coupe
automatiquement la circulation d'eau lorsque ce tuyau est
endommagé. Il affiche également un voyant d'avertissement.
• Raccordez le tuyau d'arrivée d'eau au robinet comme
indiqué sur l'image.
✗
✗
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 19 2012-4-16 13:08:2920_ Installer le lave-linge
Raccordement du tuyau de vidange
L’extrémité du tuyau de vidange peut être positionnée de trois façons différentes :
1. Sur le bord d’un lavabo : le tuyau de vidange doit être positionné à une hauteur comprise
entre 60 et 90 cm.Pour que le bout du tuyau reste coudé, utilisez le guide-tuyau en plastique
fourni. Fixez le guide au mur avec un crochet ou au robinet avec un lien, afin que le tuyau de
vidange ne bouge pas.
2. Raccordé au tuyau d’évacuation du lavabo : le tuyau d’évacuation doit être situé au-dessus
du siphon du lavabo, afin que son extrémité soit au moins à 60 cm du sol.
3. Sur un tuyau d’évacuation : il est conseillé d’utiliser un tuyau vertical de 65 cm (sa longueur
doit être comprise entre 60 cm et 90 cm).
Le tuyau d'évacuation nécessite :
• un diamètre minimum de 5 cm.
• un capacité minimum de vidange de 60 litres par
minute.
ETApE 5
Mettre votre lave-linge sous tension
Branchez le cordon d'alimentation dans une prise murale, AC de 220-240V / 50Hz une prise de
courant approuvé et protégée par un fusible ou un disjoncteur. (Pour obtenir plus d’informations
sur les exigences électriques et de mise à la terre, reportez-vous à la page 14.)
ETApE 6
Mode de calibrage
Le lave-linge Samsung détecte le poids du linge automatiquement. Pour une détection plus
précise du poids, exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation. Pour exécuter le mode de
calibrage, suivez les étapes ci-dessous.
1. Retirez le linge de la machine et éteignez-la.
2. Appuyez simultanément sur les boutons Température et Arrêt différé, puis appuyez
également sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt. La machine s'allume.
3. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ pour activer le Mode de calibrage.
4. Le tambour tourne dans le sens horaire et anti-horaire pendant environ 3 minutes.
5. Lorsque le «Mode de calibrage» est terminé, «End(En)» (Fin) apparaît à l'écran, et la mach
ine s'éteint automatiquement. Le lave-linge est maintenant prêt à être utilisé.
Installer le lave-linge
Tuyau de vidange
guide-tuyau
60 ~ 90 cm
60 ~ 90 cm
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 20 2012-4-16 13:08:33Effectuer un lavage _21
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Effectuer un lavage
Avec le nouveau lave-linge Samsung, le plus difficile consiste à décider quelle
catégorie de linge laver en premier.
preMier LAvAge
Avant de laver du linge pour la première fois, vous devez effectuer un cycle complet à vide (c’est-
à-dire sans charger de linge dans le tambour).
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
2. Versez votre dose de lessive dans le bac prévu à cet effet
du tiroir à lessive.
3. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau du lave-linge.
4. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
Cette opération permet de vidanger l’eau qui aurait pu
rester dans le lave-linge après le test du fabricant.
bac : lessive pour le prélavage ou amidon.
bac : lessive pour le lavage principal, adoucissant, agent de prétrempage, produit
blanchissant et détachant.
Pour employer de la lessive liquide, utilisez le compartiment à lessive liquide (reportez-vous
en page 29 du manuel pour voir le modèle correspondant). Ne versez pas de lessive en
poudre dans le compartiment à lessive liquide.
bac : additifs, de l’assouplissant par exemple (ne pas dépasser le bord inférieur MAX du bac
« A »).
CoNSigNeS ÉLÉMeNTAireS
1. Chargez votre linge dans le tambour.
Ne surchargez pas le lave-linge. Pour déterminer la capacité correspondant à chaque type
de linge, reportez-vous au tableau de la page 28.
• Assurez-vous que le linge n’est pas pris dans la porte, car cela risquerait de provoquer
une fuite d’eau.
• Après un cycle de lavage, il se peut que de la lessive subsiste dans la partie avant en
caoutchouc du lave-linge. Si tel est le cas, retirez ces résidus afin d’éviter toute fuite
d’eau.
• Ne lavez pas les vêtements imperméables.
2. Fermez le hublot jusqu’à ce qu’il s’enclenche.
3. Mettez l’appareil sous tension.
4. Versez de la lessive et les éventuels additifs dans le distributeur.
5. Sélectionnez les options et le programme appropriés à la charge de linge.
Le voyant du lave-linge s’allume et une estimation de la durée du programme apparaît alors
sur l’afficheur.
6. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
AverTiSSeMeNT
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 21 2012-4-16 13:08:3522_ Effectuer un lavage
pANNeAu de CoMMANde
AffICHAgE
NUMéRIQUE
Affiche le temps restant du cycle de lavage, toutes les informations
relatives au programme et les messages d’erreur.
SéLECTEUR DE
pROgRAMME
Sélectionnez le schéma de rotation et la vitesse d’essorage du
programme.
Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à la section « Laver du linge
à l’aide du sélecteur de programme » (voir page 26).
Coton - Cotons, draps, linge de table, sous-vêtements, serviettes,
chemises, etc. peu ou moyennement sales.
Synthétiques - Chemisiers, chemises, etc., peu ou moyennement sales,
en polyester (Diolen, Trevira), polyamide (Perlon, Nylon) ou autre matière
similaire.
Jeans - Un niveau d’eau plus élevé pour le lavage principal et un rinçage
supplémentaire garantissent l’élimination totale de la lessive, ce qui
permet d’éviter l’apparition de marques sur vos vêtements.
Literie - Draps, draps-housses, housses de couette, etc.
Lavez au maximum 2 kg de linge de lit du même type pour obtenir
de meilleurs résultats.
vêtements noirs - Grâce à des cycles de rinçage supplémentaires
et à un essorage réduit, vos vêtements sombres favoris sont lavés
délicatement et parfaitement rincés.
Lavage quotidien - Ce programme est destiné au lavage des vêtements
de tous les jours, tels que les sous-vêtements et les chemises.
Programme court pour les instituts de contrôle.
Lavage du tambour - Permet de nettoyer le tambour. Élimine la saleté
et les bactéries dans le tambour. Une utilisation régulière (toutes les 40
lessives) est recommandée. Aucun produit de nettoyage ou agent de
blanchiment n'est nécessaire.
Cycle bébé - Le lavage à haute température et les rinçages
supplémentaires permettent d’éliminer totalement les résidus de lessive
afin de préserver les textiles délicats.
vêtements de sport - Destiné aux vêtements résistants et
imperméables, ce programme conserve l’aspect de votre linge et lui
redonne toute sa fraîcheur.
Effectuer un lavage
2 1 3 4 5 6 7 10 9 8 12 11 13
1
2
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 22 2012-4-16 13:08:36Effectuer un lavage _23
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Lavage à la main - Programme de lavage très léger, aussi délicat qu’un
lavage à la main.
Laine - Uniquement pour les lainages lavables en machine. La charge
de vêtements doit être inférieure à 2 kg.
• Pendant le lavage, le doux bercement et le trempage du linge
continuent pour protéger les fibres de laine de tout rétrécissement
/ déformation et pour un nettoyage extrêmement délicat. L’arrêt de
cette opération ne pose aucun problème.
• Il est conseillé d’utiliser de la lessive neutre avec le programme laine afin
d’obtenir un meilleur résultat de lavage et pour un meilleur soin des fibres
de laine.
vidange - Vidange simplement l’eau du lave-linge sans essorer.
essorage - Effectue un cycle d’essorage supplémentaire afin d’éliminer
le plus d’eau possible du linge.
rinçage+essorage - Utilisez ce programme pour le linge qui n’a besoin
que d’un rinçage ou pour ajouter un adoucissant à une lessive.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE LA
TEMpéRATURE
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes températures disponibles :
( (Eau froide: Tous les voyants sont éteints), 20˚C, 30˚C, 40˚C , 60˚C en 95˚C).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
RINÇAgE
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour ajouter des cycles de rinçage. (cinq cycles
au maximum).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE
L’ESSORAgE
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes vitesses d’essorage disponibles.
WF710 / WF712
Tous les voyants sont éteints, , 400, 800, 1200,
1400 tr/min
«Sans essorage » - le linge reste dans le tambour et aucun essorage
n’est effectué après la dernière vidange.
«Arrêt cuve pleine (Tous les voyants sont éteints)» - le linge trempe
dans la dernière eau de rinçage. Avant de pouvoir décharger le linge, un
cycle « Vidange » ou « Essorage » doit être effectué.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION OpTION
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes options de lavage :
(Trempage) (Intensif) (Prélavage) (Trempage) +
(Intensif) (Trempage) + (Prélavage) (Intensif) +
(Prélavage) (Trempage) + (Intensif) + (Prélavage) (arrêt)
“Prélavage”: Appuyez sur ce bouton pour sélectionner un prélavage. La
fonction de prélavage est disponible uniquement avec les programmes
suivants : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Literie, Vêtements noirs, Lavage
quotidien, Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport.
«Intensif »: appuyez sur ce bouton lorsque le linge est très sale et qu’un
lavage intensif s’avère nécessaire. Cela a pour effet d’augmenter la durée
de chaque cycle de lavage.
«Trempage»: utilisez cette option pour enlever efficacement les tachesde
votre linge en le faisant tremper.
• 13 minutes du cycle de lavage sont consacrées à la fonction
Trempage.
• La fonction Trempage continue pendant 30 minutes avec six cycles,
où les cycles de trempage durent 1 minute et se répètent toutes les
4 minutes.
• La fonction Trempage est disponible uniquement pour les
programmes de lavage suivants : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Literie,
Lavage quotidien, Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport.
5
3
4
6
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 23 2012-4-16 13:08:3924_ Effectuer un lavage
bOUTON ARRÊT
SON
Le son peut être désactivé pour tous les programmes. Lorsque cette
fonction est active, le son est coupé pour tous les cycles.
• Lorsque la fonction Arrêt son est activée, un signal sonore retentit
et le voyant du bouton Arrêt son et le témoin « Arrêt son » sur
l’afficheur sont allumés.
• Lorsque la fonction Arrêt son est désactivée, un signal sonore retentit
et le voyant du bouton ainsi que le témoin « Arrêt son » sur l’afficheur
sont éteints.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
ARRÊT DIfféRé
Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les
différentes options de arrêt différé (de 3 à 19 heures, par tranches d’une
heure).
L’heure affichée est celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DU
LAVAgE ExpRESS
Pour le linge peu sale (2 kg maximum) dont vous avez besoin
rapidement. Ce programme dure environ 15 minutes, mais peut différer
des valeurs indiquées en fonction de la pression, de la dureté et dela
température de l'eau, de la température ambiante, du type et de la
quantité de linge à laver et de son degré de salissure, de la lessive
utilisée, de l'équilibrage de la charge, des variations de tension et des
options sélectionnées.
• Appuyez sur ce bouton à plusieurs reprises pour sélectionner la
durée du programme : 15min 20min 30min 40min 50min
60min Arrêt
La quantité de lessive en poudre ou liquide doit être inférieure à 20
g (pour une charge de 2 kg) ; à défaut, le linge pourra comporter
des traces de lessive.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DE
REpASSAgE fACILE
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour sélectionner un Repassage facile. utilisez
cette option pour préparer votre linge afin qu’il puisse être repassé
facilement.
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION MON
CyCLE
Permet de programmer votre cycle préféré (température, essorage,
degré de salissure, option, etc.).
bOUTON DE
SéLECTION DépART/
pAUSE
Ce bouton permet d’interrompre et de relancer un cycle.
bOUTON MARCHE/
ARRÊT
Si vous appuyez une première fois sur ce bouton, le lave-linge se mettra
en marche ; appuyez une deuxième fois et il s’arrêtera.
Si le lave-linge reste allumé plus de 10 minutes sans que l’on appuie sur
aucun bouton, il s’éteindra automatiquement.
Effectuer un lavage
10
AverTiSSeMeNT
11
9
7
8
12
13
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 24 2012-4-16 13:08:40Effectuer un lavage _25
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Sécurité enfant
La fonction Sécurité enfant vous permet de verrouiller les boutons afin que le cycle de lavage
que vous avez choisi ne puisse être modifié.
Activation/Désactivation
Pour activer/désactiver la fonction Sécurité enfant, appuyez
simultanément sur les boutons Température et Rinçage
pendant 3 secondes. Le témoin « Sécurité enfant » est allumé
lorsque cette fonction est activée.
Lorsque la fonction Sécurité enfant est activée, seul le
bouton Marche/Arrêt fonctionne. Cette fonction reste
active même après que le lave-linge a été éteint et rallumé
ou débranché et rebranché.
Arrêt son
La fonction Son désactivé peut être sélectionnée dans tous les programmes. Lorsqu’elle est
active, le son est coupé dans tous les programmes. Le réglage reste en vigueur même si vous
éteignez et allumez l’appareil à plusieurs reprises.
Activation/Désactivation
Pour activer/désactiver la fonction Arrêt son, appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt son. Le témoin « Arrêt
son » et le voyant du bouton Arrêt son sont allumés lorsque cette fonction est activée.
Arrêt différé
Vous pouvez programmer votre lave-linge pour que le cycle de lavage se termine
automatiquement plus tard, en choisissant un arrêt différé de 3 à 19 heures (par tranches d’une
heure). L’heure affichée correspond à celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
1. Programmez manuellement ou automatiquement votre lave-linge en fonction du type de linge
à laver.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt différé à plusieurs reprises jusqu’à obtenir le arrêt différé
souhaité.
3. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause. Le témoin « Arrêt différé » s’allume et l’horloge
commence le compte à rebours jusqu’à atteindre l’heure définie.
4. Pour annuler la fonction Arrêt différé, appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt puis remettez le
lave-linge en marche.
3 SeC.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 25 2012-4-16 13:08:4226_ Effectuer un lavage
Effectuer un lavage
Mon cycle
Permet d'activer votre programme de lavage personnalisé (température, essorage, souillure, etc.) à l'aide
d'un seul bouton.
Appuyez sur le bouton Mon cycle pour charger et utiliser les options Mon cycle enregistrées. Le voyant
« Mon cycle » indique que ce mode est activé. Les voyants du programme et des options sélectionnés
clignotent.
Vous pouvez régler toutes les options en mode Mon cycle comme suit.
1. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
3. Sélectionnez le programme souhaité à l'aide du Sélecteur de programme.
4. Définissez ensuite les options de votre choix.
Voir le Tableau des programmes en page 37 pour connaître les options possibles pour chaque
programme.
5. Vous pouvez ensuite enregistrer le programme et les options sélectionnés en appuyant sur le bouton
Mon cycle pendant plus de 3 secondes, en mode Mon cycle préféré. Le programme et les options
que vous sélectionnez s’afficheront la prochaine fois que vous sélectionnerez Mon cycle.
Vous pouvez modifier la configuration du programme Mon cycle en répétant la procédure indiquée
ci-dessus. La dernière configuration défi nie s'affichera la prochaine fois que vous utiliserez le
programme Mon cycle.
Si vous relâchez le bouton avant les 3 secondes, le programme et les options précédemment
enregistrés s'affichent. Si vous appuyez sur le bouton Mon cycle pendant 3 secondes ou plus, le
programme et les options actuellement sélectionnés sont enregistrés et la DEL clignote pendant 3
secondes.
Laver du linge à l’aide du sélecteur de programme
Votre nouveau lave-linge vous simplifie la tâche grâce au système de contrôle automatique « Fuzzy
Control » de Samsung. Lorsque vous choisissez un programme, le lave-linge définit les options appropriées
en matière de température, de temps et de vitesse de lavage.
1. Ouvrez le robinet de votre lavabo.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt du lave-linge.
3. Ouvrez le hublot.
4. Chargez les articles un par un dans le tambour, sans les tasser ni surcharger le lave-linge.
5. Fermez le hublot.
6. Ajoutez de la lessive et, si nécessaire, de l’adoucissant ou du liquide de prélavage dans les bacs
appropriés.
La fonction de prélavage n’est disponible qu’avec les programmes Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans,
Délicat, Vêtements noirs, Lavage quotidien, Cycle bébé et Vêtements de sport. Effectuez un cycle de
prélavage uniquement si le linge à laver est très sale.
7. Utilisez le Sélecteur de programme pour sélectionner le programme approprié en fonction du type
de linge : Coton, Synthétiques, Jeans, Délicat, Vêtements noirs, Lavage quotidien, Lavage du tambour,
Cycle bébé, Vêtements de sport, Lavage à la main, Laine. Le voyant correspondant au programme
sélectionné s’allume sur le panneau de commande.
8. À ce stade, vous pouvez contrôler la température de lavage, le nombre de cycles de rinçage, la vitesse
d’essorage et le délai de arrêt différé en appuyant sur le bouton correspondant.
9. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour lancer le cycle de lavage. L’indicateur de progression
s’allume et le temps de lavage restant apparaît à l’écran.
Option pause
Il est possible d’ajouter ou de retirer du linge dans les 5 minutes qui suivent le début du cycle de lavage.
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour déverrouiller le hublot.
Le hublot est bloqué si l’eau est trop CHAUDE ou son niveau trop ÉLEVÉ.
2. Après avoir refermé le hublot, appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour redémarrer le cycle de
lavage.
Lorsque le programme est terminé :
À la fin du programme, le lave-linge s’arrête automatiquement.
1. Ouvrez le hublot.
2. Sortez le linge.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 26 2012-4-16 13:08:43Effectuer un lavage _27
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Laver du linge en mode manuel
Vous pouvez laver des vêtements en fonction manuelle, sans utiliser le sélecteur de programme.
1. Ouvrez l’arrivée d’eau.
2. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt du lave-linge.
3. Ouvrez le hublot.
4. Chargez les articles un par un dans le tambour, sans les tasser ni surcharger le lave-linge.
5. Fermez le hublot.
6. Ajoutez de la lessive et, si nécessaire, de l’adoucissant ou du liquide de prélavage dans les
bacs appropriés.
7. Appuyez sur le bouton Température pour choisir la température. ( (Eau froide: Tous les
voyants sont éteints), 20 ˚C, 30 ˚C, 40 ˚C, 60 ˚C, 95 ˚C)
8. Appuyez sur le bouton Rinçage pour choisir le nombre de cycles de rinçage
(cinq cycles au maximum).
La durée du lavage augmente en conséquence.
9. Appuyez sur le bouton Essorage pour choisir la vitesse d’essorage.
( : Sans essorage, Tous les voyants sont éteints : Arrêt cuve pleine)
10. Appuyez sur le bouton Arrêt différé à plusieurs reprises pour faire défiler les différentes
options disponibles (de 3 à 19 heures, par tranches d’une heure). L’heure affichée
correspond à celle à laquelle le cycle de lavage se terminera.
11. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause pour lancer le cycle de lavage.
iNSTruCTioNS de LAvAge
Suivez ces instructions afin d’obtenir un linge parfaitement propre et d’utiliser votre lave-linge de la manière
la plus efficace qui soit.
Vérifiez toujours le symbole textile sur le vêtement avant de procéder au lavage.
Triez et lavez votre linge en fonction des critères suivants :
• Symbole textile : séparez le coton, les fibres mélangées, les synthétiques, la soie, la laine et
les rayonnes.
• Couleurs : séparez le blanc et les couleurs. Lavez les vêtements de couleur neufs
séparément.
• Taille : placer des vêtements de tailles différentes dans la même charge améliore l’action du
lavage.
• Sensibilité : lavez les articles délicats séparément, en utilisant le cycle de lavage Délicats pour
les articles neufs en laine vierge et en soie, ainsi que pour les rideaux. Vérifiez les étiquettes
des articles que vous lavez ou reportez-vous au tableau des symboles textile en annexe.
vider les poches
Avant chaque lessive, videz toutes les poches des vêtements à laver. Les petits objets durs
de forme irrégulière comme les pièces, couteaux, punaises ou trombones risquent en effet
d’endommager votre lave-linge. Évitez de laver des vêtements comportant de grandes boucles,
des boutons ou d’autres accessoires en métal lourd.
Toute pièce métallique présente sur un vêtement risque d’endommager le linge et le tambour.
Mettez les vêtements pourvus de boutons ou de broderies sur l’envers avant de les laver.
Veillez à fermer les fermetures à glissière des pantalons et vestes afin de ne pas endommager
le tambour. Les fermetures à glissière doivent être maintenues fermées à l’aide d’un fil avant le
lavage.
Les vêtements pourvus de lanières peuvent s’emmêler avec d’autres vêtements, ce qui risque
de les abîmer. Veillez à attacher ensemble les lanières avant de lancer le cycle de lavage.
prélaver du coton
Lorsqu’il est associé aux lessives modernes, votre nouveau lave-linge donne de parfaits résultats
tout en permettant d’économiser de l’énergie, du temps, de l’eau et de la lessive. Toutefois, si
vos cotons sont particulièrement sales, utilisez un programme de prélavage avec une lessive
protéinique.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 27 2012-4-16 13:08:4328_ Effectuer un lavage
Évaluer la capacité de chargement
Ne surchargez pas le lave-linge, sans quoi votre linge ne sera pas lavé correctement. Utilisez
le tableau ci-dessous afin de déterminer la charge maximale autorisée en fonction du type de
textile.
Type de textile Capacité
Modèle WF710 / WF712
Coton
- légèrement/moyennement sale
- très sale
7,0 kg
Synthétiques 2,5 kg
Jeans 3,0 kg
Literie 2,0 kg
vêtements de sport 2,5 kg
Laine 2,0 kg
• Si la charge de linge n’est pas équilibrée (le message «UE» s’affiche), rééquilibrez-la.
Un mauvais équilibrage de la charge risque de réduire l’efficacité de l’essorage.
• Lorsque vous lavez des draps ou des couettes, il se peut que la durée de lavage soit
allongée ou que l’efficacité de l’essorage soit moindre.
• Pour ce type d’article, la capacité maximale conseillée est de 2,0 kg.
Assurez-vous de placer les soutien-gorge (lavables à l’eau) dans un sac à linge (à
acheter séparément).
• Les parties métalliques de la structure peuvent en effet sortir du
soutien-gorge et endommager le linge. Il est donc conseillé de les
insérer dans un sac à linge fin.
• Les vêtements légers et de petite taille, tels que les chaussettes,
gants, bas et mouchoirs, peuvent se coincer entre le hublot et la
paroi du lave-linge. Placez-les dans un sac à linge fin.
Ne lavez pas le sac à linge seul, sans linge. Ceci pourrait provoquer des vibrations
anormales susceptibles d’entraîner des déplacements intempestifs de la machine ou des
accidents impliquant des blessures.
iNforMATioNS Sur LA LeSSive eT LeS AddiTifS
quelle lessive utiliser ?
La lessive à utiliser dépend du type de tissu (coton, synthétiques, vêtements délicats, laine), de
la couleur, de la température de lavage et du degré de salissure. Utilisez toujours une lessive qui
mousse peu, prévue pour les lave-linge automatiques.
Respectez les recommandations du fabricant de la lessive ; celles-ci ont été élaborées en
fonction du poids du linge, du degré de salissure et de la dureté de l’eau de votre région. Si vous
ne connaissez pas le degré de dureté de l’eau de votre région, renseignez-vous auprès des
autorités locales.
N’utilisez pas de lessive qui a durci ou s’est solidifiée, car elle risque de ne pas se dissoudre
complètement avant le cycle de rinçage. Par conséquent, le rinçage ne s’effectuera pas
correctement ou le trop-plein risque de se bloquer.
veuillez prendre note des éléments suivants lors de l’utilisation du programme laine.
• Utilisez une lessive liquide neutre pour laine.
• Lorsque vous utilisez de la lessive en poudre, il pourrait rester des résidus de lessive
dans le linge pouvant alors abimer la matière (laine).
Effectuer un lavage
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 28 2012-4-16 13:08:44Effectuer un lavage _29
02 EffEctuEr un lavagE
Tiroir à lessive
Votre lave-linge dispose de bacs séparés (pour la lessive et pour l’adoucissant). Répartissez tous
les additifs de lavage dans leurs bacs respectifs avant de démarrer votre lave-linge.
N'ouvrez pas le tiroir à lessive pendant que votre lave-linge effectue un cycle : de l'eau ou
de la vapeur brûlante risque de s'en dégager.
1. Ouvrez le tiroir à lessive situé sur le côté gauche du panneau de commande.
2. Ajoutez la quantité recommandée de lessive directement dans le bac à lessive avant de
démarrer votre lave-linge.
Si vous souhaitez utiliser de la lessive liquide, utilisez le
compartiment prévu à cet effet (reportez-vous à la section
« Lessive liquide » pour voir le modèle correspondant).
• Ne versez pas de lessive en poudre dans le compartiment
à lessive liquide.
3. Le cas échéant, ajoutez la quantité recommandée
d’adoucissant dans le bac à adoucissant . NE
DÉPASSEZ PAS le trait de remplissage maximum ( ).
Ne mettez JAMAIS de lessive liquide ou en poudre dans
le compartiment réservé à l'adoucissant ( ).
4. Si vous utilisez l’option de prélavage, ajoutez la quantité
recommandée de lessive dans le bac de prélavage .
N’utilisez PAS les types de lessive suivants lorsque vous
lavez des articles volumineux :
• Lessives en tablettes ou en capsules
• Lessives nécessitant une boule doseuse et un filet
Si l’assouplissant est sous forme concentrée ou épaisse,
diluez-le dans un peu d’eau avant de le verser dans le
bac afin d’empêcher le blocage du trop-plein.
Veillez à ce que l’assouplissant ne déborde pas lorsque vous fermez le tiroir à lessive après
avoir ajouté de l’assouplissant dans le compartiment à lessive de rinçage.
Lessive liquide (sur certains modèles)
Si vous souhaitez utiliser de la lessive liquide, placez le compartiment à lessive liquide dans
la partie lavage principal du tiroir à lessive et versez-y la lessive
liquide.
• NE DÉPASSEZ PAS le trait de remplissage maximum.
• Si vous utilisez une lessive en poudre, retirez le
compartiment à lessive liquide du tiroir à lessive. Les
lessives en poudre ne seront pas absorbées si vous les
placez dans le compartiment à lessive liquide.
• Après le lavage, il se peut qu'il y ait encore un peu de
liquide dans le tiroir à lessive.
MAX
Compartiment
à lessive
liquide
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 29 2012-4-16 13:08:4630_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
Il est essentiel de bien entretenir votre lave-linge pour en améliorer ses
performances, éviter les réparations inutiles et allonger sa durée de vie.
LAvAge du TAMbour
Ce programme de nettoyage automatique permet d'éliminer les moisissures
pouvant se former à l'intérieur du lave-linge.
1. Appuyez sur le bouton Marche/Arrêt.
2. Positionnez le Sélecteur de programme sur le programme
Lavage du tambour.
• Vous pouvez utiliser uniquement la fonction Arrêt différé.
• La température de l'eau lors du programme Lavage du
tambour est réglée sur 70 ˚C.
Selon les caractéristiques de la machine à laver, la
température de l'eau est fixée à 70 ˚C au cours du cycle Lavage du tambour, mais l'écran ne
peut afficher que 60 ˚ C sur le panneau de contrôle.
La température ne peut pas être modifiée.
• Il sera automatiquement fixé en coton à 30 ˚ C du programme niveau d'eau lorsque le
vêtement est mis en dedans.
3. Placez la quantité de produit de nettoyage appropriée dans
le bac à lessive , puis refermez le tiroir (dans le cas où un
produit de nettoyage est utilisé pour nettoyer le tambour).
• Veillez à utiliser un produit de nettoyage recommandé
pour le nettoyage du tambour.
• Il existe des produits de nettoyage de tambour sous
forme poudre ou liquide. Les produits nettoyants
sous forme liquide ne doivent être utilisées qu'avec le
compartiment à lessive liquide (en option).
4. Appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause.
• Lorsque vous appuyez sur le bouton Départ/pause, le programme Lavage du tambour
démarre.
• Avec ce programme, vous pouvez tout à fait nettoyer le tambour sans utiliser de produit de
nettoyage.
• Ne lancez jamais le programme Lavage du tambour si du linge est présent dans le tambour.
Cela risquerait d'endommager le linge ou la machine.
• N'utilisez jamais de produit nettoyant standard avec le programme Lavage du
tambour.
• Utilisez uniquement 1/10 de la quantité de produit de nettoyage de tambour
recommandée par le fabriquant du produit.
• L'utilisation d'un produit de blanchiment chloré risque de décolorer la machine ; utilisez
uniquement un produit de blanchiment à l'eau oxygénée.
• Produit de nettoyage en poudre: utilisez un produit de blanchiment en poudre ou un produit
de nettoyage spécial tambour uniquement.
• Produit de nettoyage liquide : utilisez un produit de blanchiment liquide à l'eau oxygénée ou
un produit de nettoyage spécial tambour uniquement.
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 30 2012-4-16 13:08:48Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge _31
03 Nettoyage et eNtretieN
Message d'avertissement automatique de Lavage du tambour
• Si l’indicateur «Lavage du tambour» sur l’écran restent
allumés après un lavage, ceci signifie qu’un nettoyage du
bac (tambour) est nécessaire. Dans ce cas, retirez le linge de
la machine, allumez la machine puis nettoyez le tambour en
lançant le programme Lavage du tambour.
• Si vous n’effectuez pas le mode Lavage du tambour,
l’indicateur «Lavage du tambour» sur l’écran seront
éteints. Cependant, l'indicateur «Nettoyage tambour» sur
l'écran et la lampe sur le Sélecteur de programme restent
de nouveau allumés après deux lavages effectués. Cela
n'entraînera cependant aucun problème avec le lave-linge.
• Bien que généralement, le signal d'alarme automatique de
nettoyage du tambour s'affiche environ une fois par mois,
il est possible que son apparition varie en fonction de la fréquence d'utilisation du lave-linge.
• Lorsque cette alarme se déclenche, nettoyez également le filtre à impuretés
(reportez-vous à la section « Nettoyage du fi ltre à impuretés » en page 33). Dans le
cas contraire la performance de la fonction bulle peut être réduite.
vidANger Le LAve-LiNge eN urgeNCe
1. Débranchez le lave-linge de l’alimentation électrique.
2. Ouvrez le capot du filtre en utilisant une pièce de monnaie
ou une clé.
3. Tirez le le tuyau de vidange d’urgence afin de le détacher
de son guide.
4. Retirez le bouchon de vidange d’urgence obturant le tuyau
de vidange d’urgence.
5. Laissez l’eau s’écouler dans un récipient.
Il pourrait rester plus d’eau que vous ne le pensez.
Préparez une cuvette plus grande.
6. Remettez le bouchon sur le tuyau de vidange
d’urgence,puis fixez le tuyau sur son guide.
7. Remettez le capot du filtre en place.
Capot du
filtre
Tuyau de
vidange
d’urgence
bouchon
de vidange
d’urgence
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 31 2012-4-16 13:08:5032_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
NeTToyAge du Tiroir à LeSSive eT du LogeMeNT du Tiroir
1. Appuyez sur la manette d’ouverture située à
l’intérieur du tiroir à lessive et retirez ce dernier.
2. Sortez le séparateur de lessive liquide du tiroir
à lessive.
3. Lavez tous les éléments à l’eau claire.
4. Nettoyez le logement du tiroir à l’aide d’une vieille brosse à
dents.
5. Replacez le séparateur de lessive liquide dans le tiroir en
appuyant fermement dessus.
6. Remettez le tiroir en place.
7. Pour enlever tout résidu de lessive, lancez un programme
de rinçage sans mettre de linge dans le tambour.
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
Manette d’ouverture
Compartiment à
lessive liquide (sur
certains modèles)
Séparateur de lessive
liquide
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 32 2012-4-16 13:08:52Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge _33
03 Nettoyage et eNtretieN
NeTToyAge du fiLTre à iMpureTÉS
Il est conseillé de nettoyer le filtre à impuretés 5 à 6 fois par an ou lorsque le message d’erreur « 5E »
s’affiche. (Reportez-vous à la section « Vidanger le lave-linge en urgence » en page précédente.)
Avant de nettoyer le filtre à résidus, veillez à débrancher le cordon d’alimentation.
1. Enlevez d’abord le reste de l’eau (consultez « Vidanger le
lave-linge en urgence » page 31).
Si vous séparez le filtre sans vidanger l’eau, celle-ci
pourrait s’écouler de l’appareil.
2. Ouvrez le capot du filtre en utilisant une pièce de monnaie
ou une clé.
3. Dévissez le bouchon de vidange d’urgence en tournant
vers la gauche et vidangez toute l’eau.
4. Dévissez le bouchon du filtre à impuretés.
5. Retirez toute impureté et autre corps étranger pris dans
le filtre et nettoyez ce dernier. Assurez-vous que l’hélice
de la pompe de vidange située derrière le filtre n’est pas
bloquée.
6. Remettez en place le bouchon du filtre à impuretés.
7. Remettez le capot du filtre en place.
N’ouvrez pas le couvercle du filtre à résidus pendant que la machine
fonctionne car de l’eau chaude pourrait en être expulsée.
• Pensez à remettre le couvercle du filtre après avoir nettoyé le filtre. Si le filtre n’est pas dans la
machine, votre lave-linge pourrait ne pas fonctionner correctement ou une fuite d’eau pourrait
survenir.
• Le filtre doit être entièrement remonté après nettoyage.
NeTToyer L’exTÉrieur du LAve-LiNge
1. Essuyez les surfaces extérieures du lave-linge, y compris le panneau de commande, à l’aide
d’un chiffon doux et d’un produit d’entretien ménager non abrasif.
2. Utilisez un chiffon doux pour sécher les surfaces.
3. Ne versez pas d’eau sur le lave-linge.
bouchon
du filtre à
impuretés
ATTeNTioN
ATTeNTioN
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 33 2012-4-16 13:08:5334_ Nettoyage et entretien de votre lave-linge
NeTToyer Le fiLTre à MAiLLe du TuyAu d’ArrivÉe d’eAu
Vous devez nettoyer le filtre à maille du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau au moins une fois par an ou lorsque le
message d’erreur « 4E » s’affiche :
1. Coupez l’alimentation en eau du lave-linge.
2. Dévissez le tuyau situé à l’arrière du lave-linge. Pour éviter les projections d’eau dues à l’air
sous pression contenu dans le tuyau, recouvrez ce dernier d’un linge.
3. À l’aide d’une pince, sortez doucement le filtre à maille du tuyau et rincez-le sous l’eau
jusqu’à ce qu’il soit propre. Nettoyez également l’intérieur et l’extérieur du raccord fileté.
4. Remettez le filtre en place.
5. Revissez le tuyau sur le lave-linge.
6. Assurez-vous que les raccords sont étanches et ouvrez le robinet.
rÉpArer uN LAve-LiNge qui A geLÉ
Si la température est descendue en dessous de 0 °C et que votre lave-linge a gelé :
1. Débranchez le lave-linge.
2. Versez de l’eau chaude sur le robinet pour assouplir le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
3. Retirez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau et immergez-le dans de l’eau chaude.
4. Versez de l’eau chaude dans le tambour du lave-linge et laissez agir 10 minutes.
5. Rebranchez le tuyau d’arrivée d’eau sur le robinet et vérifiez que l’arrivée d’eau et la vidange
fonctionnent normalement.
eNTrepoSer Le LAve-LiNge
Si vous devez entreposer votre lave-linge pendant une période prolongée, il est préférable de le vidanger
et de le débrancher. Les lave-linge peuvent être endommagés s’il reste de l’eau dans les tuyaux et les
composants internes avant l’entreposage.
1. Sélectionnez le cycle Express et versez un agent de blanchiment dans le bac d’agent de
blanchiment. Lancez un cycle complet à vide.
2. Fermez les robinets d’eau et débranchez les tuyaux d’alimentation.
3. Débranchez votre lave-linge de l’alimentation électrique et laissez le hublot ouvert pour laisser
l’air circuler à l’intérieur du tambour.
Si votre lave-linge a été entreposé à des températures inférieures au point de congélation,
attendez que l’eau gelée à l’intérieur dégèle avant de l’utiliser à nouveau.
Nettoyage et entretien de votre
lave-linge
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 34 2012-4-16 13:08:54Codes d’erreur et de dépannage _35
04 Dépannage
Codes d’erreur et de
dépannage
vÉrifiez LeS poiNTS SuivANTS Si...
pRObLÈME SOLUTION
votre lave-linge ne démarre
pas.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge est branché.
• Assurez-vous que le hublot est correctement fermé.
• Assurez-vous que le ou les robinets d’arrivée d’eau sont ouverts.
• Assurez-vous d’avoir appuyé sur le bouton Départ/Pause.
l’eau n’arrive pas ou le débit
est insuffisant.
• Ouvrez le robinet d’arrivée d’eau à fond.
• Assurez-vous que le tuyau d’eau n’est pas gelé.
• Démêlez les tuyaux d’arrivée d’eau.
• Nettoyez le filtre du tuyau d’arrivée d’eau.
il reste de la lessive dans
le tiroir à lessive à la fin du
programme de lavage.
• Assurez-vous que la pression d’eau est suffisante pour faire
fonctionner le lave-linge.
• Assurez-vous que de la lessive a été ajoutée dans le bac central du
tiroir à lessive.
votre lave-linge vibre ou est
trop bruyant.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge est installé sur une surface plane. Si
la surface n’est pas plane, ajustez les pieds réglables pour mettre le
lave-linge à niveau.
• Assurez-vous que les vis de transport ont été retirées.
• Assurez-vous que le lave-linge n’est en contact avec aucun autre
objet.
• Assurez-vous que la charge de linge est bien équilibrée.
le lave-linge ne vidange et/
ou n’essore pas.
• Démêlez tous les tuyaux. Vérifiez que les tuyaux ne sont pas emmêlés.
• Assurez-vous que le filtre à impuretés n’est pas bouché.
le hublot est verrouillé ou ne
s’ouvre pas.
• Assurez-vous que toute l’eau a été vidangée avant d’ouvrir le hublot.
• Assurez-vous que le hublot avant l’extinction du témoin de
verrouillage. Une fois le vidange terminé, le témoin de verrouillage du
hublot s’éteint.
La pompe de vidange
génère un bruit étrange.
• Vérifiez si la pompe de vidange est bloquée par des bourres de laine
ou de la saleté. Nettoyez le filtre à impuretés pour réduire le bruit.
Si le problème persiste, contactez le service clientèle de Samsung le plus proche.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 35 2012-4-16 13:08:5436_ Codes d’erreur et de dépannage
CodeS d’erreur
En cas de dysfonctionnement de votre lave-linge, un code peut apparaître sur l’afficheur. Si tel est le cas,
consultez le tableau ci-dessous et essayez la solution proposée avant de contacter le service clientèle de
Samsung.
CODE D’ERREUR SOLUTION
dE
• Assurez-vous que le hublot est correctement fermé.
• Assurez-vous que le linge n’est pas pris dans la porte.
4E
• Assurez-vous que le robinet d’eau est ouvert.
• Vérifiez la pression de l’eau.
5E
• Nettoyez le filtre à impuretés.
• Assurez-vous que le tuyau de vidange est correctement installé.
UE
• La charge de linge n’est pas équilibrée. Rééquilibrez la charge. Si vous
souhaitez laver un seul vêtement, par exemple un peignoir de bain
ou un jean, il se peut que le résultat final de l’essorage ne soit pas
satisfaisant et que le message d’erreur « UE » apparaisse à l’écran.
cE/3E • Contactez le service après-vente.
Sud
• Cette erreur survient lorsqu’une trop grande quantité de mousse
est détectée. Elle s’affiche également pendant que la mousse est
évacuée. Lorsque la mousse a été évacuée, le cycle normal reprend
(c’est l’une des opérations normales. Il s’agit d’un message d’erreur
pour éviter les défaillances de non-détection).
Uc
• Si la tension électrique fournie est instable, le lave-linge se met en
pause pour protéger ses équipements électriques.
• Si la tension correcte est fournie, le cycle reprend automatiquement.
Si un code non répertorié dans ce tableau s’affiche ou si la solution suggérée ne résout pas le problème,
contactez le service clientèle de Samsung ou votre revendeur Samsung.
Codes d’erreur et de
dépannage
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 36 2012-4-16 13:08:54Tableau des programmes _37
05 Tableau des programmes
Tableau des programmes
TAbLeAu deS progrAMMeS
( au choix)
pROgRAMME
Charge maxi.
(kg)
Lessive
Température
maxi. (˚C)
Vitesse d’essorage maxi. (tr/
min)
Wf710/Wf712 prélavage Lavage Adoucissant Wf710/Wf712
Coton 7,0 oui 95 1400
Synthétiques 2,5 oui 60 1200
Jeans 3,0 oui 60 800
Literie 2,0 oui 40 800
vêtements noirs 3,0 oui 40 1200
Lavage quotidien 2,0 oui 60 1400
Lavage du tambour - - oui - 70 400
Cycle bébé 3,0 oui 95 1400
vêtements de sport 2,5 oui 60 1200
Lavage à la main 2,0 - oui 40 400
Laine 2,0 - oui 40 800
pROgRAMME prélavage Intensif Trempage Arrêt différé Express
Repassage
facile
Coton
Synthétiques -
Jeans -
Literie -
vêtements noirs - -
Lavage quotidien -
Lavage du tambour - - - - -
Cycle bébé -
vêtements de sport -
Lavage à la main - - - - -
Laine - - - - -
1. Un prélavage allonge la durée du programme d’environ 18 minutes.
2. La durée d’un programme a été calculée selon les conditions spécifiées par la norme CEI 60456/EN
60456.
Exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation (voir page 20).
3. La durée des programmes en foyer individuel peut différer des valeurs données dans le tableau en
fonction des variations de pression et de température de l’arrivée d’eau, de la charge et du type de
linge.
4. Lorsque la fonction de lavage Intensif est sélectionnée, la durée de chaque programme augmente.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 37 2012-4-16 13:08:5538_ Annexe
Annexe
TAbLeAu deS SyMboLeS d’eNTreTieN deS TexTiLeS
Les symboles suivants offrent des conseils sur l’entretien des vêtements. Les symboles textile sont au
nombre de quatre ; ils sont généralement énumérés dans l’ordre suivant : lavage, blanchiment, séchage et
repassage et, au besoin, nettoyage à sec.
L’utilisation de ces symboles garantit la cohérence des informations entre les fabricants de vêtements
(articles domestiques ou importés). Observez les consignes associées à chaque symbole textile pour
optimiser la durée de vie de votre linge et limiter les problèmes de lavage.
Textile résistant Repassage à 100 ˚C maximum
Textile délicat Repassage interdit
Lavage à 95 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec avec tous les
dissolvants habituels
Lavage à 60 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec au percloréthylène,
aux dissolvants fluorés ou aux
essences minérales uniquement
Lavage à 40 ˚C
Nettoyage à sec aux essences
minérales uniquement
Lavage à 30 ˚C Nettoyage à sec interdit
Lavage à la main uniquement Séchage à plat
Nettoyage à sec uniquement Séchage sur cintre, sans essorage
Chlorage dilué à froid Séchage sur cintre
Chlorage interdit
Séchage en machine possible,
température modérée
Repassage à 200 ˚C maximum
Séchage en machine possible,
température basse
Repassage à 150 ˚C maximum Séchage en machine interdit
proTeCTioN de L’eNviroNNeMeNT
• Cet appareil a été fabriqué à partir de matériaux recyclables. Si vous souhaitez vous en séparer, veuillez
respecter les normes locales en vigueur en matière de mise au rebut des déchets. Coupez le cordon
d’alimentation de façon à ce que l’appareil ne puisse plus être raccordé à une source électrique. Retirez
le hublot afin d’éviter que de jeunes enfants ou des animaux ne se retrouvent piégés dans l’appareil.
• Ne dépassez pas les quantités de lessive préconisées par le fabricant de la lessive.
• N’utilisez de produits détachants et blanchissants avant le cycle de lavage qu’en cas d’absolue
nécessité.
• Économisez de l’eau et de l’électricité en ne faisant tourner que des charges pleines (la charge varie en
fonction du programme utilisé).
dÉCLArATioN de CoNforMiTÉ
Cet appareil est conforme aux normes européennes de sécurité, à la directive 93/68/CE et à la norme
EN 60335.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 38 2012-4-16 13:09:04Annexe _39
06 Annexe
fiCHe TeCHNique deS LAve-LiNge doMeSTiqueS
selon la réglementation (UE) n° 1061/2010
Samsung
Nom du modèle
WF710
WF712
Capacité kg 7
Classe énergétique
A + + + (plus haute efficacité) à d (plus basse efficacité) A+++
Consommation énergétique
Consommation d'énergie annuelle (Ae_C)
1)
kWh/an 175
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.60) coton 60 ° C en charge pleine kWh 0,85
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.60.1/2) coton 60 ° C en demi-charge kWh 0,86
Consommation d'énergie (e_t.40.1/2) coton 40 ° C en demi-charge kWh 0,59
Consommation en mode Éteint (p_o) W 0,45
Consommation en mode veille (p_i) W 5
Consommation d'eau annuelle (AW_c)
2)
l/an 9400
Classe d'efficacité d'essorage
3)
A (efficace) à g (peu efficace) B
vitesse d'essorage maximale tr/min 1400
Taux d'humidité résiduelle % 53
programmes auxquels les informations sur l'étiquette et la fiche technique renvoient Coton 60 ºC et 40 ºC + Intensif
4)
durée d’un programme standard
Coton à 60°C, en charge pleine min 225
Coton à 60°C, en demi-charge min 205
Coton à 40°C, en demi-charge min 185
durée en mode veille min 2
Niveau sonore
Lavage dB (A) re 1 pW 50
essorage dB (A) re 1 pW 74
dimensions
dimensions de l'appareil
Hauteur mm 850
Largeur mm 600
Profondeur
5) mm 550
poids net kg 62
poids brut kg 64
poids de l'emballage kg 2
pression de l'eau kPa 50-800
raccordement électrique
puissance V 220-240
Consommation W 2000-2400
fréquence Hz 50
Nom du fournisseur Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
1. La consommation d'énergie annuelle est basée sur les 220 cycles de lavage standard pour
les programmes coton à 60 °C et à 40 °C en charge pleine et en demi-charge, et sur la
consommation des modes de mise sous et hors tension. La consommation d'énergie réelle
dépendra de la façon dont l'appareil est utilisé.
2. La consommation d'eau annuelle est basée sur les 220 cycles de lavage standard pour les
programmes coton à 60 °C et à 40 °C en charge pleine et en demi-charge. La consommation
d'eau réelle dépendra de la façon dont l'appareil est utilisé.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 39 2012-4-16 13:09:0440_ Annexe
Annexe
3. La teneur en eau après essorage est très importante si vous faites sécher vos vêtements au sèche-linge.
La consommation d'énergie est bien plus élevée au cours d'un cycle de séchage qu'au cours d'un cycle de
lavage.
Plus la vitesse d'essorage est élevée, plus vous économiserez de l'énergie lors du séchage en machine.
4. Le « standard cotton 60 °C program » (programme standard pour coton à 60 ºC) et le « standard cotton 40
°C program » (programme standard pour coton à 40 ºC) pouvant être sélectionnés en combinant la fonction
de lavage intensif aux programmes pour coton à 60 ºC et à 40 ºC, sont conçus pour laver le linge en coton
normalement sale et constituent les programmes les plus efficaces (en ce qui concerne la consommation
électrique et la consommation d’eau) pour ce type de lavage.
Exécutez le mode de calibrage après l’installation (voir page 20).
Dans ces programmes, la température de l'eau réelle peut être différente de la température déclarée.
5. L'espace à respecter entre le mur et l'appareil n'est pas compris dans la profondeur indiquée.
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 40 2012-4-16 13:09:05Mémo
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 41 2012-4-16 13:09:05WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 42 2012-4-16 13:09:05WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 43 2012-4-16 13:09:05DES QUESTIONS OU DES COMMENTAIRES ?
pays TéLépHONE SITE INTERNET
PAYS-BAS 0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864) (€ 0,10/Min) www.samsung.com
BELGIQUE 02-201-24-18
www.samsung.com/be (Dutch)
www.samsung.com/be_fr (French)
N° de code:DC68-03149H_FR
WF712Y4BK-03149H_FR.indd 44 2012-4-16 13:09:05
User manual
SyncMaster
S19C200NY S19C200N
S19C200NW S19C200BW
S19C200BR S19C200NR
S20C200B S22C200NY
S22C200N S22C200B
S22C200BW S23C200B
S24C200BL
The color and the appearance may differ depending on
the product, and the specifications are subject to
change without prior notice to improve the performance.
BN46-00293A-03Table Of Contents
2
Table Of Contents
BEFORE USING
THE PRODUCT
7 Copyright
7 Icons used in this manual
7 Symbols for safety precautions
8 Cleaning
8 Cleaning
9 Securing the Installation Space
9 Precautions for storage
10 Safety Precautions
10 Electricity and Safety
11 Installation and Safety
13 Operation and Safety
16 Correct posture to use the product
PREPARATIONS 17 Checking the Contents
17 Removing the Packaging
18 Checking the Components
19 Parts
19 Frontal Buttons
21 Reverse Side
22 Installation
22 Attaching the Stand
23 Adjusting the Product Tilt
24 Installing a Wall-mount Kit or Desktop Stand
25 Anti-theft Lock
CONNECTING AND
USING A SOURCE
DEVICE
26 Before Connecting
26 Pre-connection Checkpoints
26 Connecting the PowerTable Of Contents
Table Of Contents
3
27 Connecting and Using a PC
27 Connecting to a PC
28 Driver Installation
29 Setting Optimum Resolution
30 Changing the Resolution Using a PC
SCREEN SETUP 33 Brightness
33 Configuring Brightness
34 Contrast
34 Configuring Contrast
35 Sharpness
35 Configuring Sharpness
36 SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
36 Configuring SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
37 SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
37 Configuring SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
38 Image Size
38 Changing the Image Size
40 H-Position & V-Position
40 Configuring H-Position & V-Position
41 Coarse
41 Adjusting Coarse
42 Fine
42 Adjusting Fine
CONFIGURING
TINT
43 Red
43 Configuring Red
44 Green
44 Configuring GreenTable Of Contents
Table Of Contents
4
45 Blue
45 Configuring Blue
46 Color Tone
46 Configuring the Color Tone Settings
47 Gamma
47 Configuring Gamma
RESIZING OR
RELOCATING THE
SCREEN
48 Language
48 Changing the Language
49 Menu H-Position & Menu V-Position
49 Configuring Menu H-Position & Menu VPosition
50 Display Time
50 Configuring Display Time
51 Transparency
51 Changing Transparency
SETUP AND
RESET
52 Reset
52 Initializing Settings (Reset)
53 Eco Saving
53 Configuring Eco Saving
54 Off Timer
54 Configuring Off Timer
55 Turn Off After
55 Configuring Turn Off After
56 PC/AV Mode
56 Configuring PC/AV Mode
57 Key Repeat Time
57 Configuring Key Repeat TimeTable Of Contents
Table Of Contents
5
58 Source Detection
58 Configuring Source Detection
59 Customized Key
59 Configuring Customized Key
INFORMATION
MENU AND
OTHERS
60 INFORMATION
60 Displaying INFORMATION
61 Configuring Brightness and Contrast in
the Initial Screen
INSTALLING THE
SOFTWARE
62 Magic Tune
62 What is MagicTune?
62 Installing the Software
63 Removing the Software
64 MultiScreen
64 Installing the Software
65 Removing the Software
TROUBLESHOOTING
GUIDE
66 Requirements Before Contacting
Samsung Customer Service Center
66 Testing the Product
66 Checking the Resolution and Frequency
66 Check the following.
68 Q & A
SPECIFICATIONS 70 General
80 PowerSaver
82 Standard Signal Mode TableTable Of Contents
Table Of Contents
6
APPENDIX 95 Contact SAMSUNG WORLD WIDE
96 Responsibility for the Pay Service (Cost
to Customers)
96 Not a product defect
96 A Product damage caused by customer's fault
96 Others
97 Correct Disposal
97 Correct Disposal of This Product (Waste
Electrical & Electronic Equipment)
98 Terminology Before Using the Product
7
Before Using the Product
Copyright
The contents of this manual are subject to change without notice to improve quality.
© 2012 Samsung Electronics
Samsung Electronics owns the copyright for this manual.
Use or reproduction of this manual in parts or entirety without the authorization of Samsung Electronics is
prohibited.
The SAMSUNG and SyncMaster logos are registered trademarks of Samsung Electronics.
Microsoft, Windows and Windows NT are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
VESA, DPM and DDC are registered trademarks of the Video Electronics Standards Association.
Icons used in this manual
Symbols for safety precautions
The following images are for reference only. Real-life situations may
differ from what is shown in the images.
Warning A serious or fatal injury may result if instructions are not followed.
Caution
Personal injury or damage to properties may result if instructions are
not followed.
Activities marked by this symbol are prohibited.
Instructions marked by this symbol must be followed.8
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Cleaning
Cleaning
Exercise care when cleaning as the panel and exterior of advanced LCDs are easily scratched.
Take the following steps when cleaning.
1. Power off the monitor and computer.
2. Disconnect the power cord from the monitor.
Hold the power cable by the plug and do not touch the cable with wet
hands. Otherwise, an electric shock may result.
3. Wipe the monitor screen using a clean, soft and dry cloth.
z Do not apply a cleaning agent that contains alcohol,
solvent, or surfactant to the monitor.
z Do not spray water or detergent directly on the product.
4. Wet a soft and dry cloth in water and wring thoroughly to clean the
exterior of the monitor.
5. Connect the power cord to the product after cleaning the product.
6. Power on the monitor and computer.
!
!9
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Securing the Installation Space
z Ensure some space around the product for ventilation. An internal temperature rise may cause fire
and damage the product. Be sure to allow the amount of space as shown below or greater when
installing the product.
The exterior may differ depending on the product.
Precautions for storage
Be sure to contact Samsung Customer Service Center (page 95) if the inside of the monitor needs
cleaning. (Service fee will be charged.)
10 cm
10 cm 10 cm
10 cm
10 cm10
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Safety Precautions
Electricity and Safety
The following images are for reference only. Real-life situations may differ from what is shown in the
images.
Warning
Do not use a damaged power cord or plug, or a loose power socket.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Do not plug many products into the same power socket.
z Otherwise, the socket may overheat and cause a fire.
Do not touch the power plug with wet hands.
z Otherwise, an electric shock may result.
Insert the power plug all the way in so it is not loose.
z An unstable connection may cause a fire.
Ensure you connect the power plug to a grounded power socket. (type 1
insulated devices only).
z An electric shock or injury may result.
Do not bend or pull the power cord with force. Do not weigh the power cord
down with a heavy object.
z A damaged power cord may cause an electric shock or fire.
Do not place the power cord or product near heat sources.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Remove foreign substances such as dust around the plug pins and power socket
with a dry cloth.
z Otherwise, a fire may result.
!
!
!11
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Caution
Installation and Safety
Warning
Do not unplug the power cord when the product is in use.
z The product may become damaged by an electric shock.
Do not use the power cord for products other than authorized products supplied
by Samsung.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Keep the power socket where the power cord is connected unobstructed.
z If any problem occurs in the product, unplug the power cable to completely
cut the power to the product.
Power to the product cannot be completely cut off with the power button.
Hold the plug when disconnecting the power cord from the power socket.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
DO NOT PLACE CANDLES, INSECT REPELLANTS OR CIGARETTES ON TOP
OF THE PRODUCT. DO NOT INSTALL THE PRODUCT NEAR HEAT SOURCES.
z Otherwise, a fire may result.
Avoid installing the product in a narrow space with bad ventilation, such as a
bookshelf or wall closet.
z Otherwise, a fire may result due to an increased internal temperature.
Keep the plastic packaging bag for the product in a place that cannot be reached
by children.
z Children may suffocate.
!
!
!
!12
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Caution
Do not install the product on an unstable or vibrating surface (insecure shelf,
sloped surface, etc.).
z The product may fall and break or cause a personal injury.
z Using the product in an area with excess vibration may damage the product
or cause a fire.
Do not install the product in a vehicle or a place exposed to dust, moisture (water
drips, etc.), oil, or smoke.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Do not expose the product to direct sunlight, heat, or a hot object such as a
stove.
z Otherwise, the product lifespan may be reduced, or a fire may result.
Do not install the product within the reach of young children.
z The product may fall and injure children.
Edible oil, such as soybean oil, can damage or deform the product. Do not install
the product in a kitchen or near a kitchen counter.
Take care not to drop the product when moving it.
z Otherwise, product failure or personal injury may result.
Do not set down the product on its front.
z The screen may become damaged.
When installing the product on a cabinet or shelf, make sure that the bottom
edge of the front of the product is not protruding.
z The product may fall and break or cause a personal injury.
z Install the product only on cabinets or shelves of the right size.
!
!13
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Operation and Safety
Warning
Put down the product carefully.
z The product may fall and break or cause a personal injury.
Installing the product in an unusual place (a place exposed to a lot of fine
particles, chemical substances or extreme temperatures, or an airport or train
station where the product should operate continuously for an extended period of
time) may seriously affect its performance.
z Be sure to consult Samsung Customer Service Center (page 95) before
installation if you want to install the product at such a place.
High voltage runs through the product. Do not attempt to disassemble, repair, or
modify the product on your own.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
z Contact Samsung Customer Service Center (page 95) for repair.
z Otherwise, the power cord may be damaged and a fire or electric shock may
result.
If the product generates a strange noise, a burning smell, or smoke, remove the
power cord immediately and contact Samsung Customer Service Center (page
95).
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Do not let children hang from the product or climb on top of it.
z The product may fall, and your child may become injured or seriously
harmed.
If the product falls or the exterior is damaged, power off the product, remove the
power cord, and contact Samsung Customer Service Center (page 95).
z Otherwise, an electric shock or fire may result.
!
!
!
SAMSUNG
!
Before moving the product, turn off the power switch and disconnect the power
cable and all other connected cables.14
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Do not put a heavy object, toy, or sweets on top of the product.
z The product or heavy objects may fall as children try to reach for the toy or
sweets resulting in a serious injury.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Do not drop objects on the product or apply impact.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
Do not move the product by pulling the power cord or any cable.
z Otherwise, the cable may be damaged and product failure, an electric shock
or fire may result.
If a gas leakage is found, do not touch the product or power plug. Also, ventilate
the area immediately.
z Sparks can cause an explosion or fire.
Do not lift or move the product by pulling the power cord or any cable.
z Otherwise, the cable may be damaged and product failure, an electric shock
or fire may result.
Do not use or keep combustible spray or an inflammable substance near the
product.
z An explosion or fire may result.
Ensure the vents are not blocked by tablecloths or curtains.
z Otherwise, a fire may result from an increased internal temperature.
!
!
!
GAS
!
During a lightning or thunderstorm, power off the product and remove the power
cable.15
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Caution
Do not insert a metallic object (a chopstick, coin, hair pin, etc.) or inflammable
object (paper, match, etc.) into the vent or ports of the product.
z If water or any foreign substance enters the product, be sure to power off the
product, remove the power cord, and contact Samsung Customer Service
Center (page 95).
z Product failure, an electric shock or fire may result.
Do not place objects containing liquid (vases, pots, bottles, etc) or metallic
objects on top of the product.
z If water or any foreign substance enters the product, be sure to power off the
product, remove the power cord, and contact Samsung Customer Service
Center (page 95).
z Product failure, an electric shock or fire may result.
Leaving the screen fixed on a stationary image for an extended period of time
may cause afterimage burn-in or defective pixels.
z If you are not going to use the product for an extended period of time,
activate power-saving mode or a moving-picture screen saver.
Disconnect the power cord from the power socket if you do not plan on using the
product for an extended period of time (vacation, etc.).
z Otherwise, a fire may result from accumulated dust, overheating, an electric
shock, or electric leakage.
Use the product at the recommended resolution and frequency.
Looking at the screen too close for an extended period of time can deteriorate
your eyesight.
Do not hold the monitor upside-down or move it by holding the stand.
z The product may fall and break or cause a personal injury.
Do not use humidifiers or stoves around the product.
z An electric shock or fire may result.
100
!
-_-
!
!
!
Otherwise,Your eyesight may deteriorate.16
Before Using the Product
Before Using the Product
Correct posture to use the product
Rest your eyes for more than 5 minutes for every 1 hour of product use.
z Eye fatigue will be relieved.
Do not touch the screen when the product has been turned on for an extended
period of time as it will become hot.
Store the small accessories used with the product out of reach of children.
Exercise caution when adjusting the product angle or stand height.
z Otherwise, children's fingers or hands may become stuck and injured.
z Tilting the product excessively may cause it to fall and result in personal
injury.
Do not place heavy objects on the product.
z Product failure or personal injure may result.
!
!
!
Use the product in the correct posture as follows.
z Straighten your back.
z Allow a distance of 45 to 50cm between your eye and the screen, and look slightly
downward at the screen.
Keep your eyes directly in front of the screen.
z Adjust the angle so light does not reflect on the screen.
z Keep your forearms perpendicular to your upper arms and level with the back of
your hands.
z Keep your elbows at about a right angle.
z Adjust the height of the product so you can keep your knees bent at 90 degrees or
more, your heels attached to the floor, and your arms lower than your heart.1 Preparations
17
1 Preparations
1.1 Checking the Contents
1.1.1 Removing the Packaging
1 Open the packaging box. Be careful not to damage the product when you open the packaging with
a sharp instrument.
2 Remove the styrofoam from the product.
3 Check the components and remove the styrofoam and plastic bag.
This image is for reference only.
4 Store the box in a dry area so that it can be used when moving the product in the future.18
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.1.2 Checking the Components
z Contact the dealer from whom you purchased the product if any item is missing.
z The appearance of the components and items sold separately may differ from the image shown.
Components
Components may vary depending on the country.
Quick setup guide
Warranty card
(Not available in some locations)
User manual
Power cable D-SUB cable (optional) DVI cable (optional)
Stand Stand Connector19
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.2 Parts
1.2.1 Frontal Buttons
The color and shape of parts may differ from what is shown. Specifications are subject to change
without notice to improve quality.
Icons Description
z Open or close the onscreen display (OSD) menu, or return to the
parent menu.
z OSD control lock: Maintain the current settings, or lock the OSD
control to prevent unintended changes to settings.
Enable: To lock the OSD control, press the [ ] button for 10
seconds.
Disable: To unlock the locked OSD control, press the [ ] button
for more than 10 seconds.
If the OSD control is locked,
z Brightness and Contrast can be adjusted, and INFORMATION
can be viewed.
z The Customized Key function can be used by pressing the [ ]
button. (The Customized Key is available even when the OSD
control is locked.)
Configure Customized Key and press [ ]. The following options will
be enabled.
Angle - Bright - Eco Saving - Image Size
To configure Customized Key, go to SETUP&RESET
Customized Key and select the mode you want.
Move to the upper or lower menu or adjust the value for an option on the
OSD menu.
Key Guide
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ANGLE
AUTO
MENU
MENU
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
→ 20
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
Use this button to control the brightness and contrast of the screen.
Confirm a menu selection.
Pressing the [ ] button when the OSD menu is not displayed will
change the input source (Analog/DVI). If you power on the product or
change the input source by pressing the [ ] button, a message that
shows the changed input source will appear at the top left corner of the
screen.
This function is not available for products with an Analog interface
only.
Press the [ ] button to automatically adjust the screen settings.
z Changing the resolution in Display Properties will activate the
Auto Adjustment function.
z This function is only available in Analog mode.
Turn the screen on or off.
Key Guide
When a control button on the product is pressed, the Key Guide will be
displayed before the onscreen menu opens. (The guide shows the
function of the button pressed.)
To access the onscreen menu when the guide is displayed, press the
corresponding button again.
The Key Guide may vary depending on the function or product model.
Refer to the actual product.
Icons Description
AUTO
AUTO21
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.2.2 Reverse Side
The color and shape of parts may differ from what is shown. Specifications are subject to change
without notice to improve quality.
Port Ports
Connect the power cord for your monitor to the POWER IN port on
the back of the product.
Connect to a PC using the DVI cable.
The [DVI IN] terminal is supplied for the digital (DVI)-dedicated
models only.
Connect to a PC using the D-SUB cable.
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN22
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.3 Installation
1.3.1 Attaching the Stand
Before assembling the product, place the product down on a flat and stable surface so that the screen
is facing downwards.
The color and shape of parts may differ from what is shown. Specifications are subject to change
without notice to improve quality.
Insert the Stand Connector into
the Stand in the direction shown
by the figure.
Check if the Stand Connector is
firmly connected.
Turn the connecting screw at the
bottom of the stand fully so that it
is completely fixed.
Place a soft cloth over the table
to protect the product and place
the product onto the cloth so
that the front of the product is
facing downwards.
Hold the main body of the
product with your hand as
shown by the figure.
Push the assembled stand into
the main body in the direction of
the arrow as shown in the figure.
- Caution
Do not hold the product upside
down only by the stand.23
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.3.2 Adjusting the Product Tilt
The color and shape of parts may differ from what is shown. Specifications are subject to change
without notice to improve quality.
z You can adjust the tilt of your monitor.
z Hold the lower part of the product and adjust the tilt carefully.
-1° (±2°) ~ 20° (±2°)24
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
1.3.3 Installing a Wall-mount Kit or Desktop Stand
Before Installation
Power the product off and remove the power cable from the power socket.
Align the grooves and tightly fasten the screws on the bracket on the product with the corresponding
parts on the wall-mount kit or desktop stand you want to attach.
Place a protective cloth or cushion on a flat
surface. Next, place the product with the face
down on top of the cloth or cushion.
Hold the main body of the product with your hand
as shown by the figure.
Pull the stand in the direction of the arrow as
shown in the figure to separate it.
Installing a Wall-mount Kit or Desktop Stand
Attach the wall-mount kit or desktop stand here
Bracket (sold separately)
1
A
2
3
B
4
A
B25
1 Preparations
1 Preparations
Notes
z Using a screw longer than the standard length can damage the internal components of the
product.
z The length of screws required for a wall mount that does not comply with the VESA standards may
vary depending on the specifications.
z Do not use screws that do not comply with the VESA standards. Do not attach the wall-mount kit
or desktop stand using excessive force. The product may get damaged or fall and cause personal
injury. Samsung shall not be held liable for any damage or injury caused by using improper screws
or attaching the wall-mount kit or desktop stand using excessive force.
z Samsung shall not be held liable for any product damage or personal injury caused by using a wallmount kit other than the one specified or from an attempt to install the wall-mount kit on your own.
z To mount the product on a wall, ensure you purchase a wall-mount kit that can be installed 10cm
or farther away from the wall.
z Be sure to use a wall-mount kit that complies with the standards.
1.3.4 Anti-theft Lock
An anti-theft lock allows you to use the product securely even in public places. The locking device shape
and locking method depend on the manufacturer. Refer to the user guide provided with your anti-theft
locking device for details. The lock device is sold separately.
The color and shape of parts may differ from what is shown. Specifications are subject to change
without notice to improve quality.
To lock an anti-theft locking device:
1 Fix the cable of your anti-theft locking device to a heavy object such as a desk.
2 Put one end of the cable through the loop on the other end.
3 Insert the locking device into the anti-theft lock slot at the back of the product.
4 Lock the locking device.
z An anti-theft locking device can be purchased separately.
z Refer to the user guide provided with your anti-theft locking device for details.
z Anti-theft locking devices can be purchased at electronics retailers or online.
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
26
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2.1 Before Connecting
2.1.1 Pre-connection Checkpoints
z Before connecting a source device, read the user manual provided with it.
The number and locations of ports on source devices may differ from device to device.
z Do not connect the power cable until all connections are completed.
Connecting the power cable during connection may damage the product.
z Check the types of ports at the back of the product you want to connect.
2.2 Connecting the Power
z To use the product, connect the power cable to a power outlet and the [POWER IN] port on the
product.(The input voltage is switched automatically.)
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
POWER IN 27
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2.3 Connecting and Using a PC
2.3.1 Connecting to a PC
z Select a connection method suitable for your PC.
Connecting parts may differ in different products.
Connection Using the D-SUB Cable (Analog Type)
Do not connect the power cable before connecting all other cables. Ensure you connect a source
device first before connecting the power cable.
1 Connect the D-SUB cable to the [RGB IN] port on the back of the product and the RGB port on the PC.
2 Press [ ] to change the input source to Analog.
This function is not available for products with an Analog interface only.
Connection Using the DVI Cable
Do not connect the power cable before connecting all other cables. Ensure you connect a source
device first before connecting the power cable.
1 Connect the DVI cable to the [DVI IN] port on the back of the product and the DVI port on the PC.
2 Press [ ] to change the input source to DVI.
The [DVI IN] terminal is supplied for the digital (DVI)-dedicated models only.
RGB IN
DVI IN28
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2.3.2 Driver Installation
z You can set the optimum resolution and frequency for this product by installing the corresponding
drivers.
z An installation driver is contained on the CD supplied with the product.
z If the file provided is faulty, visit the Samsung homepage (http://www.samsung.com) and
download the file.
1 Insert the user manual CD provided with the product into the CD-ROM drive.
2 Click "Windows Driver".
3 Follow the instructions given on the screen to proceed with installation.
4 Select your product model from the list of models.
5 Go to Display Properties and check that the resolution and refresh rate are appropriate.
Refer to your Windows OS manual for further details.29
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2.3.3 Setting Optimum Resolution
An information message about setting optimum resolution will appear if you power on the product for the
first time after purchase.
Select a language on the product and change the resolution on your PC to the optimum setting.
1 Press [ ] to move to the language you want and press [ ].
2 To hide the information message, press [ ].
z If the optimum resolution is not selected, the message will appear up to three times for a specified
time even when the product is turned off and on again.
z The optimum resolution can also be selected in Control Panel on your PC.
EXIT AUTO
The optimal resolution for this
monitor is as follows:
**** x **** **Hz
Use the above settings to set
the resolution on your PC.
English
MENU30
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2.3.4 Changing the Resolution Using a PC
z Adjust the resolution and refresh rate in Control Panel on your PC to obtain optimum picture
quality.
z The picture quality of TFT-LCDs may degrade if the optimum resolution is not selected.
Changing the Resolution on Windows XP
Go to Control Panel Display Settings and change the resolution.
1 2
3
**** ****
**********31
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
Changing the Resolution on Windows Vista
Go to Control Panel Personalization Display Settings and change the resolution.
1 2
3 4
***********
***********32
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
2 Connecting and Using a Source Device
Changing the Resolution on Windows 7
Go to Control Panel Display Screen Resolution and change the resolution.
1 2
3 43 Screen Setup
33
3 Screen Setup
Configure the screen settings such as brightness.
3.1 Brightness
You can adjust the general brightness of the picture. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will make the picture appear brighter.
z This menu is not available when Bright is set to Dynamic Contrast mode.
z This menu is unavailable when Eco Saving is set.
3.1.1 Configuring Brightness
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Brightness and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Adjust the Brightness using the [ ] buttons.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
AUTO
34
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.2 Contrast
Adjust the contrast between the objects and background. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will increase the contrast to make the object appear clearer.
This menu is not available when Bright is in Cinema or Dynamic Contrast mode.
3.2.1 Configuring Contrast
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Contrast and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Adjust the Contrast using the [ ] buttons.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
&XVWRP
2II
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
35
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.3 Sharpness
Make the outline of objects more clear or blurry. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will make the outline of objects clearer.
This menu is not available when Bright is in Cinema or Dynamic Contrast mode.
3.3.1 Configuring Sharpness
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Sharpness and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Adjust the Sharpness using the [ ] buttons.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
36
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.4 SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
This menu provides an optimum picture quality suitable for the environment where the product will be
used.
z This menu is unavailable when Eco Saving is set.
z This menu is not available when Angle is enabled.
You can customize the brightness to suit your preferences.
3.4.1 Configuring SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Bright and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z Custom: Customize the contrast and brightness as required.
z Standard: Obtain a picture quality suitable for editing documents or using Internet.
z Game: Obtain a picture quality suitable for playing games that involve many graphic effects and
dynamic movements.
z Cinema: Obtain the brightness and sharpness of TVs suitable for enjoying video and DVD
content.
z Dynamic Contrast: Obtain balanced brightness through automatic contrast adjustment.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright Custom
Standard
Game
Cinema
Dynamic Contrast
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
37
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.5 SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
Angle allows you to configure the settings to obtain the optimum picture quality according to your
viewing angle.
z This menu is not available when Bright is in Cinema or Dynamic Contrast mode.
z This menu is not available for S19C200NY and S22C200NY models.
You can customize the angle to suit your preferences.
3.5.1 Configuring SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Angle and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z Off : Select this option to view directly in front of the product.
z Lean Back Mode 1 : Select this option to view from a place slightly lower than the product.
z Lean Back Mode 2 : Select this option to view from a place lower than Lean Back Mode 1.
z Standing Mode : Select this option to view from a place higher than the product.
z Side Mode : Select this option to view from either side of the product.
z Group View: Select this option for more than one viewer to view from places , , and .
z Custom: Lean Back Mode 1 will be applied by default if Custom is selected.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Off
Lean Back Mode 1
Lean Back Mode 2
Standing Mode
Side Mode
Group View
Custom
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
4
2
3
1
1
5 5
①
②
③
④
⑤
① ④ ⑤38
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.6 Image Size
Change the picture size.
3.6.1 Changing the Image Size
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Image Size and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z Auto: Display the picture according to the aspect ratio of the input source.
z Wide: Display the picture in full screen regardless of the aspect ratio of the input source.
z 4:3: Display the picture with an aspect ratio of 4:3. Suitable for videos and standard broadcasts.
z 16:9: Display the picture with an aspect ratio of 16:9.
z Screen Fit: Display the picture with the original aspect ratio without cutting off.
MENU
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
$XWR
:LGH
AUTO
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
6FUHHQ)LW
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
:LGH
6FUHHQ)LW39
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
z 4:3: Display the picture with an aspect ratio of 4:3. Suitable for videos and standard broadcasts.
z Wide: Display the picture in full screen regardless of the aspect ratio of the input
source.(S19C200NW/S19C200BW/S22C200BW)
z Screen Fit: Display the picture with the original aspect ratio without cutting off.
Changing the screen size is available when the following conditions are satisfied,except
S19C200NR and S19C200BR models.
z A digital output device is connected using the DVI cable.
z The input signal is 480p, 576p, 720p, or 1080p and monitor can display normally(not every
model can support all of these signals ).
z This can only be set when the external input is connected through DVI and PC/AV Mode is
set to AV.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.40
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.7 H-Position & V-Position
H-Position: Move the screen to the left or right.
V-Position: Move the screen up or down.
z This menu is available in Analog mode.
z This menu is only available when Image Size is set to Screen Fit in AV Mode. When a 480P or
576P or 720P or 1080P signal is input in AV mode and the monitor can display normally ,select
Screen Fit to adjust horizontal position in 0-6 levels.
3.7.1 Configuring H-Position & V-Position
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to H-Position or V-Position, and press [ ]. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to configure H-Position or V-Position.
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
41
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.8 Coarse
Adjust the screen frequency.
This menu is available in Analog mode only.
3.8.1 Adjusting Coarse
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Coarse and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Adjust the Coarse using the [ ] buttons.
MENU
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
42
3 Screen Setup
3 Screen Setup
3.9 Fine
Fine-adjust the screen to obtain a vivid picture.
This menu is available in Analog mode only.
3.9.1 Adjusting Fine
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to PICTURE and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Fine and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will appear.
4 Adjust the Fine using the [ ] buttons.
MENU
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
4 Configuring Tint
43
4 Configuring Tint
Adjust the tint of the screen. This menu is not available when Bright is set to Cinema or
Dynamic Contrast mode.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
4.1 Red
Adjust the value of the color red in the picture. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will increase the intensity of the color.
4.1.1 Configuring Red
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to COLOR and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Red and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will appear.
4 Adjust the Red using the [ ] buttons.
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
:
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma Mode1
Normal
AUTO44
4 Configuring Tint
4 Configuring Tint
4.2 Green
Adjust the value of the color green in the picture. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will increase the intensity of the color.
4.2.1 Configuring Green
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to COLOR and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Green and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will appear.
4 Adjust the Green using the [ ] buttons.
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
:
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma Mode1
Normal
AUTO45
4 Configuring Tint
4 Configuring Tint
4.3 Blue
Adjust the value of the color blue in the picture. (Range: 0~100)
A higher value will increase the intensity of the color.
4.3.1 Configuring Blue
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to COLOR and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Blue and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will appear.
4 Adjust the Blue using the [ ] buttons.
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: Mode1
Normal
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO46
4 Configuring Tint
4 Configuring Tint
4.4 Color Tone
Adjust the general color tone of the picture.
This menu is not available when Angle is enabled.
4.4.1 Configuring the Color Tone Settings
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to COLOR and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Color Tone and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z Cool 2: Set the color temperature to be cooler than Cool 1.
z Cool 1: Set the color temperature to be cooler than Normal mode.
z Normal: Display the standard color tone.
z Warm 1: Set the color temperature to be warmer than Normal mode.
z Warm 2: Set the color temperature to be warmer than Warm 1.
z Custom: Customize the color tone.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
ࣱ
&RRO
&RRO
1RUPDO
:DUP
:DUP
&XVWRP
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO47
4 Configuring Tint
4 Configuring Tint
4.5 Gamma
Adjust the mid-range brightness (Gamma) of the picture.
This menu is not available when Angle is enabled.
4.5.1 Configuring Gamma
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to COLOR and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Gamma and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
Normal
Mode1
Mode2
Mode3
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
48
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5.1 Language
Set the menu language.
z A change to the language setting will only be applied to the onscreen menu display.
z It will not be applied to other functions on your PC.
5.1.1 Changing the Language
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to MENU SETTINGS and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Language and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the language you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
'HXWVFK
(QJOLVK
(VSDxRO
)UDQoDLV
,WDOLDQR
0DJ\DU
3ROVNL
3RUWXJXrV
ƧNJLjLjǁƿǀ
6YHQVND
7UNoH
ଞ˲߭
∝䇁
AUTO
ᣣᧄ⺆49
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5.2 Menu H-Position & Menu V-Position
Menu H-Position: Move the menu position to the left or right.
Menu V-Position: Move the menu position up or down.
5.2.1 Configuring Menu H-Position & Menu V-Position
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to MENU SETTINGS and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Menu H-Position or Menu V-Position, and press [ ]. The following
screen will appear.
4 Press [ ] to configure Menu H-Position or Menu V-Position.
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO50
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5.3 Display Time
Set the on-screen display (OSD) menu to automatically disappear if the menu is not used for a specified
period of time.
Display Time can be used to specify the time after which you want the OSD menu to disappear.
5.3.1 Configuring Display Time
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to MENU SETTINGS and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Display Time and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
VHF
VHF
VHF
VHF51
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5 Resizing or Relocating the Screen
5.4 Transparency
Set the transparency for the menu windows:
5.4.1 Changing Transparency
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to MENU SETTINGS and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Transparency and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
Off
On6 Setup and Reset
52
6 Setup and Reset
6.1 Reset
Return all the settings for the product to the default factory settings.
6.1.1 Initializing Settings (Reset)
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Reset and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
AUTO
Reset all settings?
Yes No
EXIT AUTO53
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.2 Eco Saving
The Eco Saving function reduces power consumption by controlling the electric current used by the
monitor panel.
This menu is not available when Bright is in Dynamic Contrast mode.
6.2.1 Configuring Eco Saving
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Eco Saving and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z 75% : Change the monitor power consumption to 75% of the default level.
z 50% : Change the monitor power consumption to 50% of the default level.
z Off: Deactivate the Eco Saving function.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
ࢿଥ
ଥࢿOff
AUTO54
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.3 Off Timer
You can set the product to automatically turn off.
6.3.1 Configuring Off Timer
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Off Timer and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
z Off: Deactivate the off timer so that the product does not power off automatically.
z On: Activate the off timer so that the product powers off automatically.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
AUTO
Off
On55
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.4 Turn Off After
The off timer can be set within a range of 1 to 23 hours. The product will automatically power off after the
specified number of hours.
This menu is available only when Off Timer is set to On.
6.4.1 Configuring Turn Off After
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Turn Off After and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to configure Turn Off After.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO56
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.5 PC/AV Mode
Set PC/AV Mode to AV. The picture size will be enlarged. This option is useful when you view a movie.
z This function does not support Analog mode.
z Supplied for the wide models only such as 16:9 or 16:10.
z If the monitor (when set to DVI) is in power saving mode or is displaying the message Check
Signal Cable, press the MENU button to display the On Screen Display (OSD). You can select PC
or AV.
6.5.1 Configuring PC/AV Mode
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to PC/AV Mode and press [ ] on the product. The following screen will
appear.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO
3&
$9
PC/AV Mode
'9,
AUTO57
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.6 Key Repeat Time
Control the response rate of a button when the button is pressed.
6.6.1 Configuring Key Repeat Time
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Key Repeat Time and press [ ] on the product. The following screen
will appear.
z Acceleration, 1 sec, or 2 sec can be selected. If No Repeat is selected, a command responds
only once when a button is pressed.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
Acceleration
1 sec
2 sec
No Repeat
AUTO58
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.7 Source Detection
You can activate Source Detection.
6.7.1 Configuring Source Detection
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Source Detection and press [ ] on the product. The following
screen will appear.
z Auto: The input source is automatically recognized.
z Manual: Manually select an input source.
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO
Auto
Manual59
6 Setup and Reset
6 Setup and Reset
6.8 Customized Key
You can customize Customized Key as follows.
6.8.1 Configuring Customized Key
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to SETUP&RESET and press [ ] on the product.
3 Press [ ] to move to Customized Key and press [ ] on the product. The following screen
will appear.
z Angle - Bright - Eco Saving - Image Size
4 Press [ ] to move to the option you want and press [ ].
5 The selected option will be applied.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Customized Key $FFHOHUDWLRQ
2Q
Eco Saving
Image Size
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
AUTO
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC7 INFORMATION Menu and Others
60
7
INFORMATION Menu and Others
7.1 INFORMATION
View the current input source, frequency and resolution.
7.1.1 Displaying INFORMATION
1 Press any button on the front of the product to display the Key Guide. Next, press [ ] to display
the corresponding menu screen.
2 Press [ ] to move to INFORMATION. The current input source, frequency and resolution will
appear.
The displayed menu items may vary depending on the model.
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Analog
**kHz **Hz NP
**** x ****
Optimal Mode
**** x **** **Hz
PICTURE
COLOR
MENU SETTINGS
INFORMATION
EXIT AUTO61
7 INFORMATION Menu and Others
7 INFORMATION Menu and Others
7.2 Configuring Brightness and Contrast in the Initial Screen
Adjust the Brightness or Contrast setting using the [ ] buttons in the initial screen (where no OSD
menu is displayed).
1 Press any button on the front of the product (when no menu screen is displayed) to display the Key
guide. Next, press [ ]. The following screen will appear.
2 Press the [ ] button to alternate between the Brightness and Contrast settings.
3 Adjust the Brightness or Contrast setting using the [ ] buttons.
Brightness
100
Contrast
75
EXIT8 Installing the Software
62
8
Installing the Software
8.1 Magic Tune
8.1.1 What is MagicTune?
MagicTune is a software program that helps with monitor adjustments by providing comprehensive
descriptions of monitor functions and easy-to-understand guidelines.
You can adjust the product with the mouse and the keyboard without using the operating buttons of the
product.
8.1.2 Installing the Software
1 Insert the installation CD into the CD-ROM drive.
2 Select the MagicTune setup program.
If the pop-up screen for the software installation does not appear on the main screen, find and
double-click the MagicTune setup file on the CD-ROM.
3 Select the installation language and click [Next].
4 Complete the remaining software installation steps according to the instructions displayed on the
screen.
z The software may not work properly if you do not restart the computer after the installation.
z The MagicTune icon may not appear depending on the computer system and the product
specifications.
z If the shortcut icon does not appear, press the F5 key.
Restrictions and Problems with the Installation (MagicTune™)
The installation of MagicTune™may be affected by the graphics card, motherboard and the networking
environment.
System Requirements
OS
z Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 763
8 Installing the Software
8 Installing the Software
8.1.3 Removing the Software
You can only remove MagicTune™ through [Add or Remove Programs] in Windows.
To remove MagicTune™, complete the following steps.
1 Click [Start] select [Settings], and select [Control Panel] from the menu.
For Windows XP, click [Start], and select [Control Panel] from the menu.
2 Double-click the [Add or Remove Programs] icon in the Control Panel.
3 In the [Add/Remove] window, find and select MagicTune™so that it is highlighted.
4 Click [Change or Remove Programs] to remove the software.
5 Select [Yes] to start removing MagicTune™.
6 Wait until a message box appears informing you that the software has been removed completely.
For technical support, the FAQ (frequently asked questions) or information about the software
upgrade for MagicTune™, please visit our website(http://www.samsung.com/us/consumer/
learningresources/monitor/magetune/pop_intro.html).6 4
8 Installing the Software
8 Installing the Software
8.2 MultiScreen
MultiScreen enables users to use the monitor by partitioning multiple sections.
8.2.1 Installing the Software
1 Insert the installation CD into the [CD-ROM drive].
2 Select the "MultiScreen" setup program.
If the pop-up screen for the software installation does not appear on the main screen, find and
double-click the "MultiScreen" setup file on the [CD-ROM].
3 When the Installation Wizard appears, click [Next].
4 Follow the instructions given on the screen to proceed with installation.
z The software may not work properly if you do not restart the computer after the installation.
z The "MultiScreen" icon may not appear depending on the computer system and the product
specifications.
z If the shortcut icon does not appear, press the "F5" key.
Restrictions and Problems with the Installation (MultiScreen)
The "MultiScreen" installation may be affected by the [Graphics card], [Motherboard] and the [Networking
environment].
Operating System
"OS"
z "Windows 2000"
z "Windows XP Home Edition"
z "Windows XP Professional"
z "Windows Vista 32bit"
z "Windows 7 32bit"
For "MultiScreen", the operating systems "Windows 2000" or later is recommended.
"Hardware"
z At least 32MB of memory
z At least 60MB of free space on the hard disk drive
MultiScreen
6465
8 Installing the Software
8 Installing the Software
8.2.2 Removing the Software
Click [Start], select [Settings]/[Control Panel], and then double-click [Add or Remove Programs].
Select "MultiScreen" from the program list and click the [Add/Delete] button.9 Troubleshooting Guide
66
9 Troubleshooting Guide
9.1 Requirements Before Contacting Samsung Customer
Service Center
9.1.1 Testing the Product
Before calling Samsung Customer Service Center, test your product as follows. If the problem persists,
contact Samsung Customer Service Center.
Check if your product is operating normally by using the product test function.
If the screen is turned off and the power indicator blinks even though the product is properly connected
to a PC, perform a self-diagnosis test.
1 Power off both the PC and product.
2 Disconnect the cables from the product.
3 Power on the product.
4 If the message "Check Signal Cable" appears, the product is working normally.
If the screen remains blank, check the PC system, video controller and cable.
9.1.2 Checking the Resolution and Frequency
For a mode that exceeds the supported resolution (refer to "10.3 Standard Signal Mode Table"), the
message "Not Optimum Mode" will appear for a short time.
9.1.3 Check the following.
Installation issue (PC mode)
The screen keeps switching on and off. Check the cable connection between the product
and PC, and ensure the connectors are locked.
(Refer to "2.3 Connecting and Using a PC")
Screen issue
The power LED is off. The screen will not switch
on.
Check that the power cable is connected
properly. (Refer to "2.3 Connecting and Using a
PC")
The message "Check Signal Cable" appears. Check that the cable is properly connected to the
product. (Refer to "2.3 Connecting and Using a
PC")
Check that the device connected to the product is
powered on.67
9 Troubleshooting Guide
9 Troubleshooting Guide
"Not Optimum Mode" is displayed. This message appears if the signal from the
graphics card exceeds the maximum resolution or
frequency for the product.
Change the maximum resolution and frequency to
suit the product performance, referring to
Standard Signal Mode Table (page 82).
The images on the screen look distorted. Check the cable connection to the product (Refer
to "2.3 Connecting and Using a PC")
The screen is not clear. The screen is blurry. Adjust Coarse (page 41) and Fine (page 42).
Remove any accessories (video extension cable,
etc.) and try again.
Set the resolution and frequency to the
recommended level. (Refer to "10.1 General")
The screen appears unstable and shaky. Check that the resolution and frequency for the
PC are within the range of resolution and
frequency compatible with the product. Next, if
required, change the settings, referring to
Standard Signal Mode Table (page 82) in this
manual and the INFORMATION menu on the
product.
There are shadows or ghost images left on the
screen.
The screen is too bright. The screen is too dark. Adjust Brightness (page 33) and Contrast (page
34).
Screen color is inconsistent. Change the COLOR settings.
(Refer to " Configuring Tint")
The colors on the screen have a shadow and are
distorted.
Change the COLOR settings.
(Refer to " Configuring Tint")
White does not really look white. Change the COLOR settings.
(Refer to " Configuring Tint")
There is no image on the screen and the power
LED blinks every 0.5 to 1 second.
The product is operating in power-saving mode.
Press any key on the keyboard or move the
mouse to return to normal operating mode.
Source device issue
A beeping sound is heard when my PC is booting. If a beeping sound is heard when your PC is
booting, have your PC serviced.
Screen issue68
9 Troubleshooting Guide
9 Troubleshooting Guide
9.2 Q & A
Question Answer
How can I change the
frequency?
Set the frequency on your graphics card.
z Windows XP: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Themes Display Settings Advanced Monitor,
and adjust Refresh rate under Monitor settings.
z Windows ME/2000: Go to Control Panel Display
Settings Advanced Monitor, and adjust Refresh rate
under Monitor settings.
z Windows Vista: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Personalization Personalization Display Settings
Advanced Settings Monitor, and adjust Refresh rate
under Monitor settings.
z Windows 7: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Personalization Display Screen Resolution
Advanced settings Monitor, and adjust Refresh rate under
Monitor settings.69
9 Troubleshooting Guide
9 Troubleshooting Guide
Refer to the user manual for your PC or graphics card for further instructions on adjustment.
How can I change the
resolution?
z Windows XP: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Themes Display Settings, and adjust the resolution.
z Windows ME/2000: Go to Control Panel Display
Settings, and adjust the resolution.
z Windows Vista: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Personalization Personalize Display Settings, and
adjust the resolution.
z Windows 7: Go to Control Panel Appearance and
Personalization Display Adjust Resolution, and adjust
the resolution.
How do I set power-saving
mode?
z Windows XP: Set power-saving mode in Control Panel
Appearance and Themes Display Screen Saver
Settings or BIOS SETUP on the PC.
z Windows ME/2000: Set power-saving mode in Control Panel
Display Screen Saver Settings or BIOS SETUP on the
PC.
z Windows Vista: Set power-saving mode in Control Panel
Appearance and Personalization Personalize Screen
Saver Settings or BIOS SETUP on the PC.
z Windows 7: Set power-saving mode in Control Panel
Appearance and Personalization Personalize Screen
Saver Settings or BIOS SETUP on the PC.
Question Answer10 Specifications
70
10 Specifications
10.1 General
Model Name S19C200NY S19C200N S19C200NW
Panel
Size 47 cm 47 cm 48 cm
Display area
409.8 mm (H) x
230.4 mm (V)
409.8 mm (H) x
230.4 mm (V)
408.24 mm (H) x
255.15 mm (V)
Pixel Pitch
0.300 mm (H) x
0.300 mm (V)
0.300 mm (H) x
0.300 mm (V)
0.2835 mm (H) x
0.2835 mm (V)
Synchronization
Horizontal
Frequency
30 ~ 81 kHz
Vertical
Frequency
56 ~ 75 Hz
Display Color 16.7M
Resolution
Optimum
Resolution
1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@60Hz
Maximum
Resolution
1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@75Hz
Maximum Pixel Clock 85MHz (Analog) 85MHz (Analog) 136MHz (Analog)
Power Supply
This product uses 100 to 240V.
Refer to the label at the back of the product as the standard voltage
can vary in different countries.
Signal connectors 15pin-to-15pin D-sub cable, Detachable
Dimensions (W x
H x D) / Weight
Without
Stand
441.4 x 266.6 x 76.8
mm
441.4 x 266.6 x 76.8
mm
439.4 x 289.9 x 76.2
mm
With Stand
441.4 x 348.8 x 170
mm / 2.8 kg
441.4 x 348.8 x 170
mm / 2.8 kg
439.4 x 373.6 x 170
mm / 3.1 kg
VESA Mounting Interface
100 mm x 100 mm
(For use with Specialty(Arm) Mounting hardware.)
Environmental
considerations
Operating
Temperature : 10°C – 40°C (50°F – 104°F)
Humidity : 10 % – 80 %, non-condensing
Storage
Temperature : -20°C – 45°C (-4°F – 113°F)
Humidity : 5 % – 95 %, non-condensing71
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Plug-and-Play
This monitor can be installed and used with any Plug-and-Play
compatible systems. Two-way data exchange between the monitor
and PC system optimizes the monitor settings. Monitor installation
takes place automatically. However, you can customize the
installation settings if desired.
Panel Dots (Pixels)
Due to the nature of the manufacturing of this product,
approximately 1 pixel per million (1ppm) may be brighter or darker on
the LCD panel. This does not affect product performance.
Model Name S19C200NY S19C200N S19C200NW72
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Model Name S19C200BW S19C200BR S19C200NR
Panel
Size 48 cm 48 cm 48 cm
Display area
408.24 mm (H) x
255.15 mm (V)
376.32 mm (H) x
301.06 mm (V)
376.32 mm (H) x
301.06 mm (V)
Pixel Pitch
0.2835 mm (H) x
0.2835 mm (V)
0.294 mm (H) x
0.294 mm (V)
0.294 mm (H) x
0.294 mm (V)
Synchronization
Horizontal
Frequency
30 ~ 81 kHz
Vertical
Frequency
56 ~ 75 Hz
Display Color 16.7M
Resolution
Optimum
Resolution
1440x900@60Hz 1280x1024@60Hz
Maximum
Resolution
1440x900@75Hz 1280x1024@75Hz
Maximum Pixel Clock
136MHz
(Analog,Digital)
135MHz
(Analog,Digital)
135MHz (Analog)
Power Supply
This product uses 100 to 240V.
Refer to the label at the back of the product as the standard voltage
can vary in different countries.
Signal connectors
15pin-to-15pin D-sub cable, Detachable
DVI-D to DVI-D connector, Detachable
15pin-to-15pin Dsub cable,
Detachable
Dimensions (W x
H x D) / Weight
Without
Stand
439.4 x 289.9 x 76.2
mm
407 x 336 x 77 mm 407 x 336 x 77 mm
With Stand
439.4 x 373.6 x 170
mm / 3.1 kg
407 x 419 x 170 mm
/ 3.25 kg
407 x 419 x 170 mm
/ 3.25 kg
VESA Mounting Interface
100 mm x 100 mm
(For use with Specialty(Arm) Mounting hardware.)
Environmental
considerations
Operating
Temperature :10°C – 40°C (50°F – 104°F)
Humidity : 10 % – 80 %, non-condensing
Storage
Temperature : -20°C – 45°C (-4°F – 113°F)
Humidity : 5 % – 95 %, non-condensing73
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Plug-and-Play
This monitor can be installed and used with any Plug-and-Play
compatible systems. Two-way data exchange between the monitor
and PC system optimizes the monitor settings. Monitor installation
takes place automatically. However, you can customize the
installation settings if desired.
Panel Dots (Pixels)
Due to the nature of the manufacturing of this product,
approximately 1 pixel per million (1ppm) may be brighter or darker on
the LCD panel. This does not affect product performance.
Model Name S19C200BW S19C200BR S19C200NR74
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Model Name S20C200B S22C200NY S22C200N
Panel
Size 50 cm 54 cm 54 cm
Display area
442.8 mm (H) x
249.08 mm (V)
476.64 mm (H) x
268.11 mm (V)
476.64 mm (H) x
268.11 mm (V)
Pixel Pitch
0.27675 mm (H) x
0.27675 mm (V)
0.24825 mm (H) x
0.24825 mm (V)
0.24825 mm (H) x
0.24825 mm (V)
Synchronization
Horizontal
Frequency
30 ~ 81 kHz
Vertical
Frequency
56 ~ 75 Hz
Display Color 16.7M
Resolution
Optimum
Resolution
1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum
Resolution
1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum Pixel Clock
136MHz
(Analog,Digital)
148MHz (Analog)
Power Supply
This product uses 100 to 240V.
Refer to the label at the back of the product as the standard voltage
can vary in different countries.
Signal connectors
15pin-to-15pin Dsub cable,
Detachable
DVI-D to DVI-D
connector,
Detachable
15pin-to-15pin D-sub cable, Detachable
Dimensions (W x
H x D) / Weight
Without
Stand
473.8 x 284 x 78.2
mm
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
mm
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
mm
With Stand
473.8 x 367.1 x 170
mm / 2.65 kg
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 mm / 3.5 kg
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 mm / 3.5 kg
VESA Mounting Interface
100 mm x 100 mm
(For use with Specialty(Arm) Mounting hardware.)
Environmental
considerations
Operating
Temperature : 10°C – 40°C (50°F – 104°F)
Humidity : 10 % – 80 %, non-condensing
Storage
Temperature : -20°C – 45°C (-4°F – 113°F)
Humidity : 5 % – 95 %, non-condensing75
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Plug-and-Play
This monitor can be installed and used with any Plug-and-Play
compatible systems. Two-way data exchange between the monitor
and PC system optimizes the monitor settings. Monitor installation
takes place automatically. However, you can customize the
installation settings if desired.
Panel Dots (Pixels)
Due to the nature of the manufacturing of this product,
approximately 1 pixel per million (1ppm) may be brighter or darker on
the LCD panel. This does not affect product performance.
Model Name S20C200B S22C200NY S22C200N76
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Model Name S22C200B S22C200BW S23C200B
Panel
Size 54 cm 55 cm 58 cm
Display area
476.64 mm (H) x
268.11 mm (V)
473.76 mm (H) x
296.1 mm (V)
509.76 mm (H) x
286.74 mm (V)
Pixel Pitch
0.24825 mm (H) x
0.24825 mm (V)
0.282 mm (H) x
0.282 mm (V)
0.2655 mm (H) x
0.2655 mm (V)
Synchronization
Horizontal
Frequency
30 ~ 81 kHz
Vertical
Frequency
56 ~ 75 Hz
Display Color 16.7M
Resolution
Optimum
Resolution
1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum
Resolution
1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum Pixel Clock
148MHz
(Analog,Digital)
146MHz
(Analog,Digital)
148MHz
(Analog,Digital)
Power Supply
This product uses 100 to 240V.
Refer to the label at the back of the product as the standard voltage
can vary in different countries.
Signal connectors
15pin-to-15pin D-sub cable, Detachable
DVI-D to DVI-D connector, Detachable
Dimensions (W x
H x D) / Weight
Without
Stand
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
mm
502.4 x 329.8 x 77.4
mm
542.9 x 321.4 x 76.3
mm
With Stand
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 mm / 3.5 kg
502.4 x 413.5 x 185
mm / 3.85 kg
542.9 x 404.65 x
185 mm / 3.25 kg
VESA Mounting Interface
100 mm x 100 mm
(For use with Specialty(Arm) Mounting hardware.)
Environmental
considerations
Operating
Temperature : 10°C – 40°C (50°F – 104°F)
Humidity : 10 % – 80 %, non-condensing
Storage
Temperature : -20°C – 45°C (-4°F – 113°F)
Humidity : 5 % – 95 %, non-condensing77
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
Plug-and-Play
This monitor can be installed and used with any Plug-and-Play
compatible systems. Two-way data exchange between the monitor
and PC system optimizes the monitor settings. Monitor installation
takes place automatically. However, you can customize the
installation settings if desired.
Panel Dots (Pixels)
Due to the nature of the manufacturing of this product,
approximately 1 pixel per million (1ppm) may be brighter or darker on
the LCD panel. This does not affect product performance.
Model Name S22C200B S22C200BW S23C200B78
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
The above specifications are subject to change without notice to improve quality.
Model Name S24C200BL
Panel
Size 59 cm
Display area 521.28 mm (H) x 293.22 mm (V)
Pixel Pitch 0.2715 mm (H) x 0.2715 mm (V)
Synchronization
Horizontal
Frequency
30 ~ 81 kHz
Vertical
Frequency
56 ~ 75 Hz
Display Color 16.7M
Resolution
Optimum
Resolution
1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum
Resolution
1920x1080@60Hz
Maximum Pixel Clock 148MHz (Analog,Digital)
Power Supply
This product uses 100 to 240V.
Refer to the label at the back of the product as the standard voltage
can vary in different countries.
Signal connectors
15pin-to-15pin D-sub cable, Detachable
DVI-D to DVI-D connector, Detachable
Dimensions (W x
H x D) / Weight
Without
Stand
554.6 x 330.5 x 78.2 mm
With Stand 554.6 x 412.35 x 185 mm / 4.1 kg
VESA Mounting Interface
100 mm x 100 mm
(For use with Specialty(Arm) Mounting hardware.)
Environmental
considerations
Operating
Temperature : 10°C – 40°C (50°F – 104°F)
Humidity : 10 % – 80 %, non-condensing
Storage
Temperature : -20°C – 45°C (-4°F – 113°F)
Humidity : 5 % – 95 %, non-condensing
Plug-and-Play
This monitor can be installed and used with any Plug-and-Play
compatible systems. Two-way data exchange between the monitor
and PC system optimizes the monitor settings. Monitor installation
takes place automatically. However, you can customize the
installation settings if desired.
Panel Dots (Pixels)
Due to the nature of the manufacturing of this product,
approximately 1 pixel per million (1ppm) may be brighter or darker on
the LCD panel. This does not affect product performance.79
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
This device is a Class B digital apparatus.80
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
10.2 PowerSaver
The power-saving function of this product reduces power consumption by switching off the screen and
changing the color of the power LED if the product is not used for a specified period of time. The power
is not turned off in power-saving mode. To switch the screen back on, press any key on the keyboard or
move the mouse. Power-saving mode functions only when the product is connected to a PC that has a
power-saving function.
PowerSaver
Normal operation
mode
Power saving mode
Power off
(Power button)
Power Indicator On Blinking Off
Power Consumption
(S19C200NY)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S19C200N)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S19C200NW)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S19C200BW)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S19C200BR)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S19C200NR)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S20C200B)
Typical 19 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S22C200NY)
Typical 24 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S22C200N)
Typical 24 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S22C200B)
Typical 24 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S22C200BW)
Typical 24 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)81
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
The power consumption level can vary in different operating conditions or when settings are
changed.(S**C200** Model Power saving mode / Power off (Power button) : Max 0.25watts )
To reduce the power consumption to 0 watts, turn off the power switch on the back of the product
or disconnect the power cable. Be sure to disconnect the power cable when you will not be using
the product for an extended period of time. To reduce the power consumption to 0 watts when the
power switch is not available, disconnect the power cable.
Power Consumption
(S23C200B)
Typical 25 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Power Consumption
(S24C200BL)
Typical 30 watts
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
Less than 0.1watts
(Analog input condition)
PowerSaver
Normal operation
mode
Power saving mode
Power off
(Power button)82
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
10.3 Standard Signal Mode Table
z This product can be set to only one resolution for each screen size to obtain the optimum picture
quality due to the nature of the panel. Therefore, a resolution other than the specified resolution
may degrade the picture quality. To avoid this, it is recommended that you select the optimum
resolution specified for the screen size of your product.
z Check the frequency when you exchange a CDT monitor (connected to a PC) for an LCD monitor.
If the LCD monitor does not support 85Hz, change the vertical frequency to 60Hz using the CDT
monitor before you exchange it with the LCD monitor.
If a signal that belongs to the following standard signal modes is transmitted from your PC, the screen will
automatically be adjusted. If the signal transmitted from the PC does not belong to the standard signal
modes, the screen may be blank even though the power LED turns on. In such a case, change the
settings according to the following table by referring to the graphics card user manual.
S19C200NY
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+83
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S19C200N
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+84
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S19C200NW
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+85
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S19C200BW
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+86
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S19C200BR
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+87
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S19C200NR
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+88
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S20C200B
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+89
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S22C200NY
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESA, 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+90
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S22C200N
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESA, 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+91
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S22C200B
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESA, 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+92
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S22C200BW
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+93
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S23C200B
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESA, 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+94
10 Specifications
10 Specifications
S24C200BL
z Horizontal Frequency
The time required to scan a single line from the left to the right side of the screen is called a
horizontal cycle. The reciprocal number of a horizontal cycle is called horizontal frequency.
Horizontal frequency is measured in kHz.
z Vertical Frequency
Repeating the same picture dozens of times per second allows you to view natural pictures. The
repeat frequency is called "vertical frequency" or "refresh rate" and is indicated in Hz.
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency
(kHz)
Vertical
Frequency
(Hz)
Pixel Clock
(MHz)
Sync Polarity
(H/V)
IBM, 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MAC, 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MAC, 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MAC, 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESA, 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESA, 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESA, 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESA, 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESA, 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESA, 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESA, 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESA, 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESA, 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESA, 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+ Appendix
95
Appendix
Contact SAMSUNG WORLD WIDE
If you have any questions or comments relating to Samsung products, please contact the SAMSUNG
customer care center.
INDIA 1800 1100 11
3030 8282
1800 3000 8282
1800 266 8282
http://www.samsung.com96
Appendix
Appendix
Responsibility for the Pay Service (Cost to Customers)
When the service is requested, in spite of in warranty, we may charge you for a visit from a service
technician in the following cases.
Not a product defect
Cleaning of the product, Adjustment, Explanation, Re-installation and etc.
z If a service technician gives instructions on how to use product or simply adjusts options without
disassembling productU
z If a defect is caused by external environmental factors (Internet, Antenna, Wired Signal, etc.)
z If a product is reinstalled or devices are connected additionally after installing the purchased product
for the first timeU
z If a product is reinstalled to move to a different spot or to move to a different houseU
z If customer requests instructions on how to use because of another company's productU
z If customer requests instructions on how to use the network or another company's programU
z If customer requests software installation and setup for the productU
z If a service technician removes/cleans dusts or foreign materials inside of the productU
z If customer requests an installation additionally after purchasing a product through home-shopping
or online.
A Product damage caused by customer's fault
Product damage caused by customer's mishandling or wrong repairU
If a product damage is caused by;
z external impact or drop U
z use of supplies or separatly sold product unspecified by SamsungU
z repair from a person besides an engineer of outsourcing service company or partner of Samsung
Electronics Co., Ltd.
z remodeling or repairing the product by customer.
z using it with incorrect voltage or non-authorised electrical connectionsU
z not following the "cautions" in User Manual.
Others
z If product fails by natural disaster (lightning, fire, earthquake, flood damage, etc) U
z If consumable components are all used up (Battery, Toner, Fluorescent lights, Head, Vibrator, Lamp,
Filter, Ribbon, etc.)
If customer requests a service in case the product has no defect, service fee may be charged. So
please read User Manual first.97
Appendix
Appendix
Correct Disposal
Correct Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment)
(Applicable in countries with separate collection systems)
This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its
electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of
with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to
the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate
these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the
sustainable reuse of material resources.
Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product,
or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take these items
for environmentally safe recycling.
Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the
purchase contract. This product and its electronic accessories should not be mixed with
other commercial wastes for disposal.
(India Only)
For more information on safe disposal and recycling visit our website www.samsung.com/in or
contact our Helpline numbers - 18002668282, 180030008282.98
Appendix
Appendix
Terminology
OSD(On Screen Display)
On screen display (OSD) allows you to configure on-screen settings to optimize the picture quality as
required. It allows you to change the screen brightness, tint, size and many other settings using
menus displayed on the screen.
Gamma
The Gamma menu adjusts the grey scale that represents middle tones on the screen. Adjusting the
brightness brightens the whole screen, but adjusting Gamma only brightens the medium brightness.
Grey scale
Scale refers to levels of color intensity that show variations of color change from darker areas to
brighter areas on the screen. Changes to the screen brightness are expressed with black and white
variation, and grey scale refers to the medium area between black and white. Changing the grey scale
through Gamma adjustment will change the medium brightness on the screen.
Scanning rate
Scanning rate, or refresh rate, refers to the frequency of screen refreshes. Screen data is transmitted
as it refreshes to display an image, although the refreshing is invisible to the naked eye. The number of
screen refreshes is called scanning rate and is measured in Hz. A scanning rate of 60Hz means that
the screen refreshes 60 times per second. The screen scanning rate depends on the performance of
the graphics cards in your PC and monitor.
Horizontal Frequency
Characters or images displayed on the monitor screen consist of numerous dots (pixels). Pixels are
transmitted in horizontal lines, which are then arranged vertically to create an image. The horizontal
frequency is measured in kHz and represents how many times horizontal lines per second are
transmitted and displayed on the monitor screen. A horizontal frequency of 85 means that the
horizontal lines that make up an image are transmitted 85 000 times per second, and the horizontal
frequency is indicated in 85kHz.
Vertical Frequency
One image is made of numerous horizontal lines. The vertical frequency is measured in Hz and
represents how many images can be created per second by those horizontal lines. A vertical
frequency of 60 means that an image is transmitted 60 times per second. The vertical frequency is
also called "refresh rate" and affects screen flicker.99
Appendix
Appendix
Resolution
Resolution is the number of horizontal pixels and vertical pixels that form a screen. It represents the
level of display detail.
A higher resolution displays a greater amount of information on the screen and is suitable for
performing multiple tasks at the same time.
E.g. A resolution of 1920 x 1080 consists of 1,920 horizontal pixels (horizontal frequency) and 1,080
vertical lines (vertical resolution).
Plug & Play
The Plug & Play feature allows the automatic exchange of information between a monitor and PC to
produce an optimum display environment.
The monitor uses VESA DDC (international standard) to execute Plug & Play.Index
100
Index
A
Appendix 95
B
Before Connecting 26
Blue 45
Brightness 33
C
Checking the Contents 17
Cleaning 8
Coarse 41
Color Tone 46
Connecting and Using a PC 27
Contact SAMSUNG WORLDWIDE 95
Contrast 34
Copyright 7
Correct Disposal 97
Correct posture to use the product 16
Customized Key 59
D
Display Time 50
E
Eco Saving 53
F
Fine 42
G
Gamma 47
General 70
Green 44
I
Image Size 38
INFORMATION 60
Installation 22
K
Key Repeat Time 57
L
Language 48
M
MultiScreen 64
O
Off Timer 54
P
Parts 19
PC/AV Mode 56
Q
Q & A 68
R
Red 43
Requirements Before Contacting Samsung
Customer Service Center 66
Reset 52
Responsibility for the Pay Service (Cost to
Customers) 96
S
Safety Precautions 10Index
Index
101
SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle 37
SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright 36
Sharpness 35
Source Detection 58
Standard Signal Mode Table 82
T
Transparency 51
Turn Off After 55
使用者手冊
SyncMaster
S19C200NY S19C200N
S19C200NW S19C200BW
S19C200BR S19C200NR
S20C200B S22C200NY
S22C200N S22C200B
S22C200BW S23C200B
S24C200BL
顏色和外觀可能因產品而異,產品規格可能由於產品效
能增強而有所變更,恕不事先通知。
BN46-00293A-03ᛀီؾᙕ 2
ᛀီؾᙕ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ 7 ठᦞ
قऱቹشࠌם֫ء 7
7 ڜ٤ࣹრࠃႈฤᇆ
8 堚ᑥ
8 堚ᑥ
9 অᢞڜ٤ऱڜᇘ़ၴ
9 ဿࣹژრࠃႈ
10 ڜ٤ࣹრࠃႈ
10 ሽڜ٤
11 ڜᇘ
13 ᖙ܂
16 شࠌขऱإᒔৎႨ
ᄷໂՠ܂ 17 ᛀփ୲ढ
ޗץՀ࠷ 17
18 ᛀցٙ
19 ຝٙ
19 إ૿ਊၨ
21 હ૿
22 ڜᇘ
22 ຑ൷֭ਮ
23 ᓳᖞᘛኟႜ৫
24 ڜᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮ
25 ࿋᠙
ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ 26 ၞ۩ຑ൷հছ
26 ຑ൷հছᛀរ
26 ຑ൷ሽᄭᛀီؾᙕ
ᛀီؾᙕ 3
27 ຑ൷֗شࠌሽᆰ
27 ຑ൷۟ሽᆰ
ڤᇘᦀ೯࿓ڜ 28
৫࣫ᇞࠋ່ࡳ 29
30 ش PC ޏޓᇞ࣫৫
ᘛኟࡳ 33 Brightness
33 ࡳ Brightness
34 Contrast
34 ࡳ Contrast
35 Sharpness
35 ࡳ Sharpness
36 SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
36 ࡳ SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
37 SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
37 ࡳ SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
38 Image Size
38 ᧢ޓ Image Size
40 H-Position ࡉ V-Position
40 ࡳ H-Position ࡉ V-Position
41 Coarse
41 ᓳᖞ Coarse
42 Fine
42 ᓳᖞ Fine
ۥࡳᖺ 43 Red
43 ࡳ Red
44 Green
44 ࡳ Greenᛀီؾᙕ
ᛀီؾᙕ 4
45 Blue
45 ࡳ Blue
46 Color Tone
46 ࡳ Color Tone ࡳ
47 Gamma
47 ࡳ Gamma
ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ 48 Language
48 ᧢ޓ Language
49 Menu H-Position ࡉ Menu V-Position
49 ࡳ Menu H-Position ࡉ Menu V-Position
50 Display Time
50 ࡳ Display Time
51 Transparency
51 ᧢ޓ Transparency
ࡉࡳૹ 52 Reset
52 ॣࡨ֏ࡳଖ (Reset)
53 Eco Saving
53 ࡳ Eco Saving
54 Off Timer
54 ࡳ Off Timer
55 Turn Off After
55 ࡳ Turn Off After
56 PC/AV Mode
56 ࡳ PC/AV Mode
57 Key Repeat Time
57 ࡳ Key Repeat Timeᛀီؾᙕ
ᛀီؾᙕ 5
58 Source Detection
58 ࡳ Source Detection
59 Customized Key
59 ࡳ Customized Key
פ INFORMATION
הࠡ֗౨।
60 INFORMATION
60 ᧩ق INFORMATION
ࡉ Brightness ࡳխ૿ࡨॣڇ 61
Contrast
ڜᇘຌ᧯ 62 Magic Tune
62 չᏖਢ MagicTuneΛ
62 ڜᇘຌ᧯
62 ฝೈຌ᧯
64 MultiScreen
64 ڜᇘຌ᧯
65 ฝೈຌ᧯
ጊᣄඈᇞਐত 66 ᜤ Samsung ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨ছؘႊ٣ၞ
۩ऱࠃႈ
66 ྒྷᇢข
66 ᛀᇞ࣫৫ࡉ᙮
66 ᛀՀ٨ႈؾΖ
68 ംᠲᇞ
69 ԫ
74 PowerSaver
76 ᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤ।ᛀီؾᙕ
ᛀီؾᙕ 6
ॵᙕ 89 ᜤ٤ SAMSUNG
95 ڶᚍፂଥ ΰড়ᖜ၄شαઌᣂຂٚ
95 ॺขਚᎽऱൣउ
95 ၄ृመ؈ທګऱਚᎽ
95 ࠡהൣउ
ش 96شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ 7
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
ठᦞ
वΖຏ۩Δஏլޓ᧢۩ၞ୲փם֫ء౨ᙟழኙױᔆΔ֒༽
© 2012 Samsung Electronics
ΖڶࢬऱठᦞԿਣሽם֫ء
آᆖԿਣሽᦞΔᣤᆃࢨشࠌૹ፹ء֫םऱຝٝࢨ٤ຝփ୲Ζ
SAMSUNG ֗ SyncMaster ᑑԿਣሽऱုםᑑΖ
MicrosoftΕWindows ֗ Windows NT Microsoft Corporation ऱုםᑑΖ
VESAΕDPM ֗ DDC Video Electronics Standards Association ऱုםᑑΖ
قऱቹشࠌם֫ء
ႈฤᇆࠃრࣹ٤ڜ
հणउΖقࢬׂቹܑ࣍ڶ౨ױቼൣΖటኔشհەࠎՀቹׂႛא
ܫᤞ
႞Ζჾࡎીࢨૹ౨ᖄીᣤױΔقਐښᙅآڕ
რࣹ
آڕᙅښਐقΔױ౨ᖄીଡԳ࠹႞ࢨತढჾᡏΖ
ᆃַൕࠃᑑڼڶฤᇆհ೯Ζ
ႊᙅښᑑڼڶฤᇆհਐقΖ8
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
堚ᑥ
堚ᑥ
ၸ LCD հ૿ࣨ֗؆ླྀ୲࣐ᔡࠩࠪ႞Δڼڂ堚ᑥழᓮ՛֨Ζ
堚ᑥழΔᓮᙅ༛אՀޡᨏΖ
1. ᣂຨီᕴፖሽᆰऱሽᄭΖ
2. ലီᕴऱሽᄭᒵࢸՀΖ
֫ሽᄭᒵऱ༺ᙰຝٝΖ֫ᑪᛘழᓮ֎ᅸᤛሽᄭᒵΖܡঞױ౨ᖄીᤛ
ሽΖ
3. شࠌᛟऱຌؒᚴ᧩قᕴΖ
z ᓮ֎ڇီᕴՂشࠌܶ壄Εᄫᕪࢨ૿ࢤᕪऱ堚ᑥ
ᕪΖ
z ᓮ֎ऴ൷ٻขᏴᦠֽࢨ堚ᑥᕪΖ
4. ലਫຌऱؒ࣋ԵֽխؚᛘΔݙ٤ᚳ৵٦ࠐشᚴီᕴ؆ླྀΖ
5. 堚ᑥݙฅ৵ᓮലሽᄭᒵຑ൷ࠩءขΖ
6. ؚၲီᕴፖሽᆰऱሽᄭΖ
!
!9
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
অᢞڜ٤ऱڜᇘ़ၴ
z ขࡌ೭ؘঅఎຝ։़ၴຏଅհشΖփຝᄵ৫֒ױ౨ᄎ֧࿇ࢨ߀־ທګขਚᎽΖڜᇘ
ขழ೭ؘቃఎ़ၴΔ़ၴՕ՛ڕՀࢨقࢬृޓՕΖ
؆ᨠױ౨ڂขۖฆΖ
ဿࣹژრࠃႈ
ڕᏁ堚ᑥီᕴփຝΔᓮ೭ؘᜤԿਣሽড়ࣚխ֨ ΰร89αΖΰല಼ࣚگ೭၄شαΖ
10 cm
10 cm 10 cm
10 cm
10 cm10
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
ႈࠃრࣹ٤ڜ
ሽڜ٤
հणउΖقࢬׂቹܑ࣍ڶ౨ױቼൣΖటኔشհەࠎՀቹׂႛא
ܫᤞ
ᓮ֎شࠌჾᡏऱሽᄭᒵࢨ༺ᙰΔࢨᠾๅऱሽᄭ༺ஆΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ലڍଡข༺Եٵԫଡ༺ஆΖ
z ܡঞ༺ஆױ౨መᑷ֧ۖ࿇߀־Ζ
ᠨ֫ᑪᛘழΔᓮ֎ᅸᤛሽᄭ༺ᙰΖ
z ܡঞױ౨ᖄીᤛሽΖ
ᓮല༺ᙰ༺ࠩࢍΔ܍אᠾๅΖ
z ૉآ൷ױ౨֧࿇߀־Ζ
ലሽᄭ༺ᙰຑ൷۟൷چऱሽᄭ༺ஆ ΰႛૻรԫᣊᒴᇘᆜαΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽ࠹ࢨ႞Ζ
ᓮ֎شԺމᦛވࢮࢨሽᄭᒵΖᓮ֎ലૹढڇ࣋ሽᄭᒵՂΖ
z ሽᄭᒵૉధჾΔױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ലሽᄭᒵࢨขᆜ࣍ᑷᄭॵ२Ζ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮشؒᚴװ༺ᙰ८᥆ׂࡉ༺ஆࡌऱฆढΔۊڕࠏቺΖ
z ܡঞױ౨֧࿇߀־Ζ
!
!
!11
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
რࣹ
ᇘڜ
ܫᤞ
ᓮ֎ڇขشࠌխழࢸՀሽᄭᒵΖ
z ขױ౨ڂሽᚰۖჾᡏΖ
ೈԿਣሽ༼ࠎऱٽข؆Δᓮ֎شࠌࠡהขऱሽᄭᒵΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ᨃढᖒ۰ຑ൷ሽᄭᒵऱሽᄭ༺ஆΖ
z ขנٚ۶ംᠲழᓮࢸՀሽᄭᒵΔݙא٤֊ឰሽᄭΖ
شࠌሽᄭਊၨྤऄݙ٤֊ឰขऱሽᄭΖ
ലሽᄭᒵൕሽᄭ༺ஆנࢸழΔᓮ༽۰༺ᙰΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ءڇขՂឭ࣋ᥣᛠΕᦀᕪࢨଉဈΖᓮ֎ڇᑷᄭॵ२ڜᇘءขΖ
z ܡঞױ౨֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮᝩڇ܍ຏଅլߜऱ՛़ၴփڜᇘءขΔڕࠏਮࢨᕻᡝΖ
z ܡঞױ౨ڂփຝᄵ৫֧֒ۖ࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮലขץᇘႿᓄڇ࣋ࠝ࿙ྤऄஞ࠷հΖ
z ܡঞױ౨ᖄીࠝ࿙พஒΖ
ᓮ֎ലءขڜᇘڇլࢨᔼ೯ऱ।૿ ΰլഒࡐऱਮΕ૿αΖ
z ขױ౨ᏼᆵధჾΔࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
z ૉڇᖿ௺ᔼ೯ءشࠌขΔױ౨ᖄીขჾᡏࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
!
!
!
!12
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
რࣹ
ᓮ֎ലءขڜᇘڇ߫փΔࢨਢۊڶቺΕᛘ ΰֽዠαΕईᄿऱچֱΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ᨃءขऴ൷࠹ֲࠩᅃڇࢨመᑷΕᄵढ᧯ॵ२ΔڕࠏΖ
z ܡঞءขऱኂࡎᄎᜍΔױࢨ౨֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ڇؔ࿙ױᤛ֗ऱᒤփڜᇘءขΖ
႞Ζ࠹࿙ࠝࠌࠀ౨ൾᆵױขء z
ଇشई ΰڕࠏՕߤईαױ౨ᄎჾᡏขࠌࢨࠡ᧢ݮΖᓮ֎ڇᐓࢪփࢨᐓࢪ
ॵ२ڜᇘءขΖ
ฝ೯ءขழᓮ՛֨֊֎ൾᆵΖ
z ܡঞขױ౨ჾᡏࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
ᓮ֎ലขऱإ૿ཛՀᆜ࣋Ζ
z ᘛኟױ౨ᄎ࠹ჾΖ
ലขڜᇘ۟ᡝ឵ࢨਮՂழΔᓮᒔᎁขإ૿ऱࢍຝᢰᒴآࠀડנᡝ឵ࢨਮ
Ζ
z ขױ౨ᏼᆵధჾΔࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
z ႛױലขڜᇘ࣍ᔞᅝ֡՚ऱᡝ឵ࢨਮՂΖ
࣋Հءขழᓮ೭ؘ՛֨Ζ
z ขױ౨ᏼᆵధჾΔࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
ᓮ֎ലءขڜᇘڇࢬ ΰᛩቼխڶՕၦ़პศΕ֏ᖂढᔆΕᄵ৫መ࣍
ᄕጤΔࢨᖲΕ߫ీຍᣊᏁ९ழၴຑᥛءشࠌขऱچֱαΔܡঞױ౨ᣤૹᐙ
ขࢤ౨Ζ
z ૉڇຍᣊڜࢬᇘءขΔᓮ೭ؘᐛᇬԿਣሽড়ࣚխ֨ ΰร89αऱრ
Ζߠ
!
!
!
SAMSUNG
!13
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
܂ᖙ
ܫᤞ
ءขփڶᚘሽΔᓮ֎۞۩࠵ࣈΕፂଥޏࢨᇘΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
z ڕᏁፂଥΔᓮᜤԿਣሽড়ࣚխ֨ ΰร89αΖ
ૉขႚࢡנᜢΕᗈྡྷࢨ࠺কᄿΔᓮمࠥࢸՀሽᄭᒵΔࠀᜤԿਣሽড়ࣚխ
֨ ΰร89αΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎࣋ٚࠝ࿙ٶڇขՀֱΔࢨᡙझ࣍ขհՂΖ
z ءขױ౨ᏼᆵΔທګࠝ࿙࠹ࠩ᎘ૹ႞Ζ
ૉขᏼᆵࢨ؆ླྀధჾΔᓮᣂຨขሽᄭΕࢸՀሽᄭᒵΔࠀᜤԿਣሽড়ࣚ
խ֨ ΰร89αΖ
z ܡঞױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ءڇขՂឭ࣋ૹढΕनࠠࢨกរΖ
z ࠝ࿙ᇢቹஞ࠷नࠠࢨกរழΔءขࢨՂ૿ऱૹढױ౨ᏼᆵΔທګࠝ࿙࠹
ࠩૹ႞Ζ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ᨃढൾᆵ࣍ขՂࢨղאૹᚰΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ވࢮאሽᄭᒵࢨٚ۶ᨱᒵऱֱڤฝ೯ءขΖ
z ܡঞሽᄭᒵױ౨࠹ჾΔທګขਚᎽΔױࠀ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
!
!
!
!
請在打雷或雷雨期間關閉產品的電源,並拔下電源線。
移動產品前,請關閉電源開關,並拔下電源線及所有其他連接纜線。
否則電源線可能受損,並可能引發火災或導致觸電。14
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
რࣹ
ૉ࿇᧯؆ਜ਼Δᓮ֎ᅸᤛขࢨሽᄭ༺ᙰΖڼ؆ΔᓮܛمᨃᇠຏଅΖ
z ־क़ױ౨ᖄીᡨ੦ࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ࢮא೯ሽᄭᒵࢨٚ۶ᨱᒵऱֱࣉڤದࢨฝ೯ءขΖ
z ܡঞሽᄭᒵױ౨࠹ჾΔທګขਚᎽΔױࠀ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ڇขॵ२࣐࣋ژࢨشࠌᗏࢤᏴᣆ࣐ࢨᗏढᔆΖ
z ױ౨࿇سᡨ੦Εದ־Ζ
ᓮᒔᎁཋᑷՑڶோդࢨኡങ۰Ζ
z ܡঞױ౨ڂփຝᄵ৫֧֒ۖ࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ല८᥆ढ ΰᆎΕ࿏ኞΕᕓ݈α࣐ࢨᗏढ ΰ്Ε־α༺Ե
ءขऱཋᑷՑࢨຑ൷കΖ
z ૉขၞֽڶࢨฆढൾԵΔᓮ೭ؘᣂຨขሽᄭΕࢸՀሽᄭᒵΔࠀᜤԿ
ਣሽড়ࣚխ֨ ΰร89αΖ
z ขױ౨ਚᎽΔױࠀ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮ֎ലܶڶ᧯ऱढ ΰक़Εઇ்Ε᧾αࢨ८᥆ढڇ࣋ขՂֱΖ
z ૉขၞֽڶࢨฆढൾԵΔᓮ೭ؘᣂຨขሽᄭΕࢸՀሽᄭᒵΔࠀᜤԿ
ਣሽড়ࣚխ֨ ΰร89αΖ
z ขױ౨ਚᎽΔױࠀ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
९ழၴല૿ڇࡳࡐᙩַᐙቝᄎທګྲྀᐙ௹ࢨٱቝైᅕชΖ
z ૉ९ழၴլءشࠌขΔᓮඔ೯ᆏ౨ᑓࢨڤ૿᧢೯ऱᘛኟঅᥨ࿓ڤΖ
ૉ९ழၴ ΰ৫ࢨࠡהαլءشࠌขΔᓮലሽᄭᒵൕሽᄭ༺ஆࢸՀΖ
z ܡঞױ౨ڂᗨቺመڍΕขመᑷΕሽᚰࢨዥሽ֧ۖ࿇߀־Ζ
ᓮࠉᅃ৬ᤜऱᇞ࣫৫֗᙮ءشࠌขΖ
!
GAS
!
100
!
-_-
!
!
否則您的視力可能退化。15
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌழ၏ᠦመ२९ழၴߍထᘛኟΔױ౨ᄎᖄી൞ऱီԺಯ֏Ζ
ᓮ֎א֫ഗஆऱֱڤՂՀᣌଙࢨჺ೯ီᕴΖ
z ขױ౨ᏼᆵధჾΔࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
ᓮ֎ڇขॵ२ףشࠌᛘᕴࢨࠠΖ
z ױ౨ᖄીᤛሽࢨ֧࿇߀־Ζ
ᨠᘛኟ 1 ՛ழᓮᨃณᅪٖஒ 5 ։ᤪאՂΖ
z ณᅪఒ໎ऱൣउലᛧငᒷΖ
९ழၴءشࠌข৵ᓮ֎ᤛᘛኟΔڂױ౨መᑷΖ
ᓮലขา՛ٙဿڜڇژ٤հΔᝩ܍ࠝ࿙ஞ࠷Ζ
ᓳᖞขߡ৫ࢨഗஆ৫ழᓮ؆՛֨Ζ
z ܡঞࠝ࿙ऱ֫ਐࢨ֫ױ౨۰࠹ࠀ႞Ζ
z ขႜߡ৫መՕழױ౨ᏼᆵΔڂۖᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
ᓮ֎ലૹढᆜڇ࣋ขհՂΖ
z ขױ౨ჾᡏࢨᖄીԳߪ႞୭Ζ
!
!
!
!16
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขছऱᄷໂࠃႈ
شࠌขऱإᒔৎႨ
شࠌขழᓮঅאՀإᒔৎႨΖ
z હຝؚऴΖ
z ณᅪፖᘛኟऱ၏ᠦঅڇ 45 ࠩ 50 ֆ։հၴΔီᒵპპٻՀΖ
ณᅪऴီᘛኟΖ
z ᓳᖞߡ৫Δᝩ܍ᘛኟ֘୴٠ᒵΖ
z ՂՀᜩঅিऴΔՀᜩፖ֫હٵڇԫऴᒵΖ
z ֫ߘᦛߡڴ৫অ൷२ऴߡΖ
z ᓳᖞข৫Δࠌᓃ።ᦛڴ 90 ৫אՂΕᆬᇿ൷ᤛچ૿Δ֫ᜩۯᆜ࣍܅֨Ζ1 ᄷໂՠ܂ 17
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.1 ᛀփ୲ढ
1.1.1 ࠷Հޗץ
႞Ζჾࠩ࠹ขءࠌ֎֨ᇘழΔᓮ՛ץၲࣈᔲढڞאᇘᒣΖץၲؚ 1
2 ࠷ՀঅᥨขشऱঅᣝᚊΖ
3 ᛀցٙࣈࠀೈऐःႿறࡉႿᓄΖ
Ζەࠎᐙቝႛڼ
4 ലᒣڇ࣋ژլᑪᛘऱΔࠎאֲ৵ჺሎขழشࠌΖ18
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.1.2 ᛀցٙ
z ૉ֟ٚ۶ढΔᓮഇءנขऱᆖᔭΖ
z ᗑᔭഇऱցٙࡉႈऱ؆ᨠױ౨ፖᐙቝقࢬլٵΖ
ցٙ
լچٵऱցٙױ౨ࢬڶฆΖ
αࠎ༽آ౨ױچࠄΰਬ ࡐਐত অࡳຒݶ
ሽᄭᒵ D-SUB ᨱᒵ (ױᙇ) DVI ᨱᒵ (ױᙇ)
֭ਮ ֭ਮຑ൷ᕴ
使用者手冊19
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.2 ຝٙ
1.2.1 إ૿ਊၨ
ሿٙऱۥፖݮणױ౨ፖقࢬլٵΖױ౨ᙟᔆऱ༼֒ۖࢬڶ᧢ޓΔஏլ۩ຏवΖ
ࣔᎅ قቹ
z ၲඔࢨᣂຨᘛኟ᧩ق (OSD) פ౨।ΔڃࢨࠩՂԫଡפ౨।Ζ
z OSD ൳ࠫႈ᠙ࡳΚፂؾছࡳଖΔࢨ᠙۰ OSD ൳ࠫΔᝩ܍რ
؆ޓ೯ࡳଖΖඔشΚૉ᠙ࡳ OSD ൳ࠫΔᓮਊ۰ [ ] ਊၨ
10 ઞᤪΖೖشΚૉല OSD ൳ࠫᇞ᠙Δᓮਊ۰ [ ] ਊၨ 10
ઞᤪאՂΖ
࣠ڕ OSD ൳ࠫႈ᠙ࡳΔ
z אױᓳᖞ Brightness ࡉ Contrast א֗ᛀီ INFORMATIONΖ
z ਊՀ [ ] ਊၨشࠌאױ Customized Key פ౨Ζ (
Customized Key ڇ OSD ൳ࠫ᠙ࡳழٍشױα
ࡳ Customized Key ٵழਊՀ [ ]Ζ༉ᄎඔشՀ٨ᙇႈΖ
Angle - Bright - Eco Saving - Image Size
ૉࡳ Customized KeyΔᓮฝ۟ SETUP&RESET
Customized KeyΔྥ৵ᙇᖗࢬᏁऱᑓڤΖ
ฝࠩՂֱࢨՀֱפ౨।Δࢨᓳᖞ OSD פ౨।ᙇႈऱᑇଖΖ
ڼشࠌਊၨ൳ࠫᘛኟऱॽ৫ࡉኙֺ৫Ζ
按鍵導覽
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ANGLE
AUTO
MENU
MENU
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
→ 20
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
ᒔᎁפ౨।ᙇᖗΖ
ڇ OSD פ౨।נآழਊՀ [ ] ਊၨΔঞᄎޏޓᙁԵಛᇆᄭ
(Analog/DVI)ΖૉၲඔขሽᄭאࢨਊՀ [ ] ਊၨऱֱޏޓڤᙁԵ
ಛᇆᄭΔঞᘛኟؐՂߡᄎנಛஒΔਐנբᆖޏޓᙁԵಛᇆᄭΖ
ኙ࣍ႛAnalogտ૿ऱขΔפڼ౨լشױΖ
ਊ [ ] ਊၨΔא۞೯ᓳᖞ૿ࡳΖ
z ڇ ψ᧩قփ୲ωխ᧢ޓᇞ࣫৫Δᄎඔش Auto Adjustment פ
౨Ζ
z פڼ౨ႛڇ Analog ᑓڤխشױΖ
ၲඔࢨᣂຨᘛኟΖ
ਊᖄᥦ
ਊՀขՂऱ൳ࠫਊၨհ৵Δਊᖄᥦᄎڇᘛኟפ౨।ၲඔհছ᧩قΖ
ΰਐতխᄎ᧩قբਊՀऱਊၨפ౨Ζα
ૉڇਐত᧩قழ࠷ژᘛኟפ౨।Δᓮ٦ਊઌᚨऱਊၨΖ
ਊᖄᥦױ౨פڂ౨ࢨขᖲীۖฆΖᓮኙᅃኔᎾขΖ
ࣔᎅ قቹ
AUTO
AUTO21
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.2.2 હ૿
ሿٙऱۥፖݮणױ౨ፖقࢬլٵΖױ౨ᙟᔆऱ༼֒ۖࢬڶ᧢ޓΔஏլ۩ຏवΖ
ຑ൷ക ຑ൷ക
ല᧩قᕴऱሽᄭᒵຑ൷۟ขહ૿ऱ POWER IN ຑ൷കΖ
شࠌ DVI ᨱᒵຑ൷۟ሽᆰΖ
[DVI IN] ጤڇᑇۯ (DVI) റشীᇆՂ༼ࠎΖ
ش D-SUB ᨱᒵຑ൷ࠩ PCΖ
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN22
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.3 ڜᇘ
1.3.1 ຑ൷֭ਮ
ิᇘছΔᓮലขᘛኟٻՀ࣋ᆜ࣍ؓᖞࡐऱ।૿Ζ
ሿٙऱۥፖݮणױ౨ፖقࢬլٵΖױ౨ᙟᔆऱ༼֒ۖࢬڶ᧢ޓΔஏլ۩ຏवΖ
ڕቹقࢬΔല֭ਮຑ൷ᕴൕٽᔞ
ֱٻ༺Ե֭ਮΖ
ᛀ֭ਮຑ൷ᕴਢܡຑ൷ݔΖ ඝ᠏֭ਮࢍຝऱຑ൷ᝅΔऴ۟
Ζۯࠩࡳࡐ٤ݙ
٣ڇோ૿Ղᔮړຌؒאঅᥨข
ຌڇᆜ࣋ཛՀ૿إΔ٦ലข
ؒՂΖ
ڕቹشقࢬ֫ਊ۰ขᖲߪΖ
٦ലิᇘړऱ֭ਮਊᅃቹխᒢᙰ
ΖߪංԵᖲٻֱقࢬ
რࣹ -
ᓮ֎אႛ༽۰֭ਮֱڤଙข
Ζ23
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.3.2 ᓳᖞᘛኟႜ৫
ሿٙऱۥፖݮणױ౨ፖقࢬլٵΖױ౨ᙟᔆऱ༼֒ۖࢬڶ᧢ޓΔஏլ۩ຏवΖ
z ൞ױᓳᖞီᕴऱႜ৫Ζ
z ༽۰ขࢍຝࠀ՛֨ᓳᖞႜ৫Ζ
-1° (±2°) ~ 20° (±2°)24
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1.3.3 ڜᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮ
ᇘছڜ
խឰขሽᄭΔࢸࠀೈሽᄭ༺ஆՂऱሽᄭᒵΖ
ലןᑒኙᏘڜᇘऱᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮՂኙᚨऱຝٙΔࠀ᠙ጹขڮਮՂऱᝅΖ
ڇؓࡖऱ।૿ᔮՂঅᥨؒறࢨቾΖ൷ထΔ٦ല
ขإ૿ཛՀڇ࣋ؒறࢨቾՂΖ
ڕቹشقࢬ֫ਊ۰ขᖲߪΖ
ਊᅃቹխᒢᙰقࢬֱٻല֭ਮൕᖲߪՂ࠷ՀΖ
ڜᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮ
ڜᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮڼ࣍
ڮਮ ΰᗑ၇α
1
A
2
3
B
4
A
B25
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
1 ᄷໂՠ܂
ု
z شࠌ၌መᑑᄷ९৫ऱᝅױ౨ᄎࠌขऱփຝցٙ࠹ჾΖ
z ኙ࣍լฤٽ VESA ᑑᄷऱᛥڜᇘࢬᏁऱᝅΔࠡ९৫ױ౨ࠉۖฆΖ
z ᓮ֎شࠌլฤٽ VESA ᑑᄷऱᝅΖڜᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮழΔլشԺመՕΖขױ
౨࠹ჾࢨᏼᆵࠀທګԳߪ႞୭ΖSamsung ኙشࠌ࣍լᅝᝅڜࢨᇘᛥٙࢨோ૿֭ਮழشڂ
Ժመᅝࢬທګऱჾᡏࢨ႞୭ᄗլຂΖ
z Samsung ኙشࠌ࣍ॺਐࡳհᛥٙΔࢨቫᇢ۞۩ڜᇘᛥٙࢬທګऱขჾᡏࢨԳߪ႞୭
ᄗլຂΖ
z ૉലขڜᇘࠩᛥՂΔᓮ೭ؘ၇౨ڜᇘڇ၏ᠦᛥ૿ 10 ֆ։ऱᛥٙΖ
z ೭ؘشࠌฤٽᑑᄷऱᛥٙΖ
1.3.4 ࿋᠙
࿋᠙ױᨃ൞ڇֆ٥ڜࢬ֨شࠌขΖ᠙ࡳᇘᆜऱ؆ীࡉ᠙ࡳֱࠉڤ፹ທۖฆΖڕᏁᇡาᇷಛΔ
ᓮᔹ൞ऱ࿋᠙ࡳᇘᆜᙟॵऱشࠌਐতΖ᠙ࡳᇘᆜᗑנഇհႈؾΖ
ሿٙऱۥፖݮणױ౨ፖقࢬլٵΖױ౨ᙟᔆऱ༼֒ۖࢬڶ᧢ޓΔஏլ۩ຏवΖ
ૉ᠙ࡳ࿋᠙ࡳᇘᆜΚ
1 ല࿋᠙ᨱᒵڇࡳࡐިૹऱढ᧯Ղ ΰڕோαΖ
2 ലᨱᒵऱԫጤઠመԫጤऱᛩഎΖ
3 ല᠙ࡳᇘᆜ༺Եข৵ֱऱ࿋᠙༺ᑒΖ
4 ᠙۰᠙ࡳᇘᆜΖ
z ࿋᠙ࡳᇘᆜױᗑ၇Ζ
z ڕᏁᇡาᇷಛΔᓮᔹ൞ऱ࿋᠙ࡳᇘᆜᙟॵऱشࠌਐতΖ
z ࿋᠙ࡳᇘᆜڇױሽሿഇࢨᒵՂࢋΖ
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ 26
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2.1 ၞ۩ຑ൷հছ
2.1.1 ຑ൷հছᛀរ
z ຑ൷ಛᇆᄭᇘᆜհছΔᓮ٣ᔹᇠᇘᆜᙟॵऱشࠌ֫םΖ
ಛᇆᄭᇘᆜՂऱຑ൷കᑇၦፖۯᆜױ౨ࠉᇘᆜۖฆΖ
z ګݙ٤ຝຑ൷հছΔᓮ֎༺ՂሽᄭᒵΖ
ၞ۩ຑ൷ழ༺Ղሽᄭᒵױ౨ᄎჾᡏขΖ
z ᛀࢬᏁຑ൷ข৵ֱऱຑ൷കᣊীΖ
2.2 ຑ൷ሽᄭ
z ૉشࠌขΔലሽᄭᒵຑ൷۟ሽᄭ༺ஆא֗ขऱ [POWER IN] ຑ൷കΖΰᙁԵሽᚘᄎ۞೯֊
ངΖα
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
POWER IN 27
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2.3 ຑ൷֗شࠌሽᆰ
2.3.1 ຑ൷۟ሽᆰ
z ᙇᖗԫጟᔞٽ൞ऱ PC ऱֱڤΖ
լٵขऱຑ൷ሿٙױ౨լጐઌٵΖ
ش D-SUB ᨱᒵ ΰᣊֺᣊীαຑ൷
ᓮ֎ڇຑ൷ڶࢬړࠡהᨱᒵհছ༺ՂሽᄭᒵΖଈ٣ᒔঅբຑ൷ړಛᇆࠐᄭᇘᆜΔྥ৵٦༺ՂሽᄭᒵΖ
1 א D-SUB ᨱᒵຑ൷ข৵ֱऱ [RGB IN] ຑ൷കፖሽᆰՂऱ RGB ຑ൷കΖ
2 ਊ [ ] ലᙁԵಛᇆᄭ᧢ޓ AnalogΖ
ኙ࣍ႛAnalogտ૿ऱขΔפڼ౨լشױΖ
شࠌ DVI ᨱᒵၞ۩ຑ൷
ᓮ֎ڇຑ൷ڶࢬړࠡהᨱᒵհছ༺ՂሽᄭᒵΖଈ٣ᒔঅբຑ൷ړಛᇆࠐᄭᇘᆜΔྥ৵٦༺ՂሽᄭᒵΖ
1 א DVI ᨱᒵຑ൷ข৵ֱऱ [DVI IN] ຑ൷കፖሽᆰՂऱ DVI ຑ൷കΖ
2 ਊ [ ] ലᙁԵಛᇆᄭ᧢ޓ DVIΖ
[DVI IN] ጤڇᑇۯ (DVI) റشীᇆՂ༼ࠎΖ
RGB IN
DVI IN28
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2.3.2 ڜᇘᦀ೯࿓ڤ
z ຘመڜᇘءขऱኙᚨᦀ೯࿓ڤΔױܛءࡳขऱ່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ࡉ᙮Ζ
z ڜᇘᦀ೯࿓ץڤܶڇขᙟॵऱ٠խΖ
z ૉᙟॵᚾூჾᡏΔᓮທԿਣሽଈ (http://www.samsung.com) ࠀՀሉᚾூΖ
1 ലขᙟॵऱشࠌ֫ם٠࣋Ե٠ᖲխΖ
2 ਊԫՀ "Windows Driver"Ζ
3 ᙅ༛ᘛኟ᧩قऱᎅࣔᤉᥛၞ۩ڜᇘΖ
4 ൕীᇆ堚խᙇᖗ൞ऱขীᇆΖ
5 ฝ۟ ψ᧩قփ୲ωΔࠀᛀᇞ࣫৫ፖޓᄅ᙮ਢܡᔞᅝΖ
ᓮᔹ൞ऱ Windows ܂ᄐߓอ֫םΔ࠷אᇡาᇷಛΖ29
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2.3.3 ࡳ່ࠋᇞ࣫৫
ૉ൞ڇ၇ข৵รԫڻؚၲሽᄭΔ૿Ղᄎנࡳ່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ऱᇷಛಛஒΖ
ڇขՂᙇᖗߢΔല PC ऱᇞ࣫৫᧢ޓ່ࠋࡳΖ
1 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟൞شࠌऱߢΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
2 ૉឆ៲ᇷಛಛஒΔᓮਊ [ ]Ζ
z ૉآᙇ࠷່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ΔࠌܛലءขሽᄭᣂຨԾૹᄅၲඔΔսᄎڇਐࡳழၴփ᧩ءقಛஒ່ڍԿ
Ζڻ
z ൞Ո౨ڇ PC ऱ൳൳ࠫխᙇ࠷່ࠋᇞ࣫৫Ζ
EXIT AUTO
The optimal resolution for this
monitor is as follows:
**** x **** **Hz
Use the above settings to set
the resolution on your PC.
English
MENU30
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2.3.4 ش PC ޏޓᇞ࣫৫
z ڇ PC ऱ ψ൳ࠫωխᓳᖞᇞ࣫৫ፖޓᄅ᙮Δ࠷א່ࠋᔆΖ
z آ࣠ڕᙇᖗ່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ΔTFT-LCD ऱᔆױ౨૾܅Ζ
᧢ޓ Windows XP ऱᇞ࣫৫
ᓮছ ψψ൳ࠫω ψ᧩قω ψࡳଖωΔྥ৵ޏޓᇞ࣫৫Ζ
1 2
3
**** ****
**********31
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
᧢ޓ Windows Vista ऱᇞ࣫৫
ᓮছ ψψ൳ࠫω ψଡԳ֏ω ψ᧩قࡳωΔྥ৵ޏޓᇞ࣫৫Ζ
1 2
3 4
***********
***********32
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
2 ຑ൷شࠌࡉಛᇆᄭᇘᆜ
᧢ޓ Windows 7 ऱᇞ࣫৫
ᓮছ ψψ൳ࠫω ψ᧩قω ψᘛኟᇞ࣫৫ωΔྥ৵ޏޓᇞ࣫৫Ζ
1 2
3 43 ᘛኟࡳ 33
3 ᘛኟࡳ
ॽ৫ΖڕࠏଖΔࡳᘛኟࡳ
3.1 Brightness
ᓳᖞቹቝऱԫॽ৫ΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ଖყࠌױቹቝყࣔॽΖ
z ᅝ Bright ࡳ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
z ૉբࡳ Eco SavingΔঞפڼ౨।ྤऄشࠌΖ
3.1.1 ࡳ Brightness
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ BrightnessΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ BrightnessΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
AUTO
34
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.2 Contrast
ᓳᖞढ᧯ፖહནհၴऱኙֺ৫ΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ଖყױലኙֺ৫༼Δࠌढ᧯ףޓ堚ཐΖ
ᅝ Bright ࣍ Cinema ࢨ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
3.2.1 ࡳ Contrast
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ ContrastΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ ContrastΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
&XVWRP
2II
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
35
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.3 Sharpness
ࠌढ᧯ᔚኢףޓ堚ཐࢨᑓᒫΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ଖყࠌױᔚኢყ堚ཐΖ
ᅝ Bright ࣍ Cinema ࢨ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
3.3.1 ࡳ Sharpness
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SharpnessΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ SharpnessΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
36
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.4 SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
ᛩቼΖشࠌขհءٽאᔆΔࠋ່ࠎ༽౨।פڼ
z ૉբࡳ Eco SavingΔঞפڼ౨।ྤऄشࠌΖ
z ඔش Angle ழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
ૡॽ৫Ζ۞ړᖕאױ൞
3.4.1 ࡳ SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ BrightΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Custom:ီᏁ۞ૡኙֺ৫ࡉॽ৫Ζ
z Standard:ᛧᔞٽᒳᙀ֮ٙࢨՂጻऱᔆΖ
z GameΚڇनڶՕၦᢄቹயࡉ࣠೯܂૿ऱሏᚭழΔᛧᔞᅝᔆΖ
z CinemaΚڇᨠᓾᐙׂࡉ DVD փ୲ழΔᛧᔞᅝऱሽီॽ৫ፖ堚ཐ৫Ζ
z Dynamic Contrast:شܓ۞೯ᓳᖞኙֺ৫פ౨Δࠌॽ৫ሒࠩؓᘝΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright Custom
Standard
Game
Cinema
Dynamic Contrast
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
37
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.5 SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
Angle ᨃ൞ࡳᙇႈΔאᖕᨠߡ৫ᛧ່ࠋᔆΖ
z ᅝ Bright ࣍ Cinema ࢨ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
z פڼ౨।լᔞ࣍ش S19C200NY ֗ S22C200NY ীᇆΖ
৫Ζߡૡ۞ړᖕאױ൞
3.5.1 ࡳ SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ AngleΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Off :ᙇء࠷ᙇႈڇױขऱإছֱऴ൷ᨠΖ
z Lean Back Mode 1 :ᙇء࠷ᙇႈױൕֺข࿑܅ऱۯᆜᨠΖ
z Lean Back Mode 2 :ᙇء࠷ᙇႈױൕֺ Lean Back Mode 1 ᑓڤᝫ܅ऱۯᆜᨠΖ
z Standing Mode :ᙇء࠷ᙇႈױൕֺขᝫऱۯᆜᨠΖ
z Side Mode :ᙇء࠷ᙇႈױൕขऱؐ׳ࠟೡᨠΖ
z Group View:ᙇء࠷ᙇႈױᨃشࠌټڍृൕ Ε Ε ऱۯᆜᨠΖ
z Custom:ૉᙇ࠷ CustomΔঞࠉቃᄎش Lean Back Mode 1Ζ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Off
Lean Back Mode 1
Lean Back Mode 2
Standing Mode
Side Mode
Group View
Custom
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
4
2
3
1
1
5 5
①
②
③
④
⑤
① ④ ⑤38
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.6 Image Size
᧢ޓቹቝ֡՚Ζ
3.6.1 ᧢ޓ Image Size
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Image SizeΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Auto:ᖕᙁԵಛᇆᄭऱ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿Ζ
z Wide:ྤᓵᙁԵಛᇆᄭऱ९ᐈֺ۶Δຟא٤ᘛኟ᧩ق૿Ζ
z 4:3: א 4:3 ऱ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿ΖᔞٽᐙׂࡉᑑᄷሽီᐖᐾΖ
z 16:9:א 16:9 ऱ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿Ζ
z Screen Fit:אࡨ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿ۖլဪ֊Ζ
z 4:3: א 4:3 ऱ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿ΖᔞٽᐙׂࡉᑑᄷሽီᐖᐾΖ
MENU
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
$XWR
:LGH
AUTO
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
6FUHHQ)LW
Custom
Off
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
:LGH
6FUHHQ)LW39
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
z Wide: ྤᓵᙁԵಛᇆᄭऱ९ᐈֺ۶Δຟא٤ᘛኟ᧩ق૿Ζ(S19C200NW/S19C200BW/
S22C200BW)
z Screen Fit:אࡨ९ᐈֺ᧩ق૿ۖլဪ֊Ζ
የߩՀ٨යٙழאױ᧢ޓᘛኟՕ՛ ΰS19C200NR ፖ S19C200BR ীᇆೈ؆αΖ
z ᑇۯᙁנᇘᆜشࠌ DVI ᨱᒵຑ൷Ζ
z ᙁԵಛᇆ 480pΕ576pΕ720p ࢨ 1080p ᧩قᕴإאױൄ᧩ق ΰࠀॺޢጟীᇆઃ֭གࢬ
ಛᇆαࠄຍڶ
z ຍႛڇຘመ DVI ຑ൷؆ຝᙁԵ PC/AV Mode ࡳ AV ழאױࡳΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ40
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.7 H-Position ࡉ V-Position
H-Position:ؐ׳ฝ೯ᘛኟΖ
V-Position:ՂՀฝ೯ᘛኟΖ
z פڼ౨।ڇ Analog ᑓڤՀشױΖ
z ڶᅝ Image Size ڇ AV ᑓڤխࡳ Screen Fit ழΔפڼ౨।թ౨شࠌΖڇ AV ᑓڤխᙁԵ
480PΕ576PΕ720P ࢨ 1080P ಛᇆ᧩قᕴإאױൄ᧩قழΔᙇ࠷ Screen Fit ױਊ 0-6 ్ᓳᖞ
ᆜΖۯֽؓ
3.7.1 ࡳ H-Position ࡉ V-Position
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ H-Position ࢨ V-PositionΔࠀਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊՀ [ ] אࡳ H-Position ࢨ V-PositionΖ
MENU
Custom
Off
Auto
PICTURE
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Image Size
H-Position
AUTO
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
41
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.8 Coarse
ᓳᖞᘛኟ᙮Ζ
ႛڇ Analog ᑓڤՀشױΖ
3.8.1 ᓳᖞ Coarse
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ CoarseΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ CoarseΖ
MENU
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
42
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3 ᘛኟࡳ
3.9 Fine
პᓳᘛኟΔࠌ૿ைைسڕΖ
ႛڇ Analog ᑓڤՀشױΖ
3.9.1 ᓳᖞ Fine
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PICTUREΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ FineΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ FineΖ
MENU
PICTURE
V-Position
Coarse
Fine
AUTO
4 ۥࡳᖺ 43
4 ۥࡳᖺ
ᓳᖞᘛኟۥᖺΖᅝ Bright ࡳ Cinema ࢨ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄࠌ
౨।Ζפءش
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
4.1 Red
ᓳᖞ૿խऱદۥଖΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ᑇଖ။Δۥ။ᖺΖ
4.1.1 ࡳ Red
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ COLORΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ RedΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ RedΖ
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
:
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma Mode1
Normal
AUTO44
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4.2 Green
ᓳᖞ૿խऱጸۥଖΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ᑇଖ။Δۥ။ᖺΖ
4.2.1 ࡳ Green
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ COLORΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ GreenΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ GreenΖ
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
:
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma Mode1
Normal
AUTO45
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4.3 Blue
ᓳᖞ૿խऱ៴ۥଖΖΰᒤΚ 0~100)
ᑇଖ။Δۥ။ᖺΖ
4.3.1 ࡳ Blue
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ COLORΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ BlueΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ش [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ BlueΖ
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: Mode1
Normal
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO46
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4.4 Color Tone
ᓳᖞቹቝऱԫۥᄵΖ
ඔش Angle ழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
4.4.1 ࡳColor Toneࡳ
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ COLORΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Color ToneΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Cool 2:ലۥᄵګࡳֺ Cool 1 ᝫܐΖ
z Cool 1:ലۥᄵګࡳֺ Normal ᑓڤᝫܐΖ
z Normal:᧩قᑑᄷۥᓳΖ
z Warm 1:ലۥᄵګࡳֺ Normal ᑓڤᝫᄊΖ
z Warm 2:ലۥᄵګࡳֺ Warm 1 ᝫᄊΖ
z Custom:۞ૡۥᓳΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
ࣱ
&RRO
&RRO
1RUPDO
:DUP
:DUP
&XVWRP
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO47
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4 ۥࡳᖺ
4.5 Gamma
ᓳᖞቹቝऱխၴᒤॽ৫ ΰGammaαΖ
ඔش Angle ழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
4.5.1 ࡳ Gamma
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ COLORΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ GammaΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
COLOR
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
Normal
Mode1
Mode2
Mode3
Red
Green
Blue
Color Tone
Gamma
AUTO5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ 48
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5.1 Language
Ζߢ౨।פࡳ
Ζق᧩౨।פᘛኟ࣍شᄎޓ᧢ऱࡳߢ z
z ۖլᄎ࣍ش PC ऱࠡפה౨Ζ
5.1.1 ᧢ޓ Language
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ MENU SETTINGSΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ LanguageΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟൞شࠌऱߢΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
'HXWVFK
(QJOLVK
(VSDxRO
)UDQoDLV
,WDOLDQR
0DJ\DU
3ROVNL
3RUWXJXrV
ƧNJLjLjǁƿǀ
6YHQVND
7UNoH
ଞ˲߭
∝䇁
AUTO
ᣣᧄ⺆49
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5.2 Menu H-Position ࡉ Menu V-Position
Menu H-Position:ؐ׳ฝ೯פ౨।ۯᆜΖ
Menu V-Position:ՂՀฝ೯פ౨।ۯᆜΖ
5.2.1 ࡳ Menu H-Position ࡉ Menu V-Position
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ MENU SETTINGSΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ Menu H-Position ࢨ Menu V-PositionΔࠀਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊՀ [ ] אࡳ Menu H-Position ࢨ Menu V-PositionΖ
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO50
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5.3 Display Time
ڇࡳਐࡳழၴփشࠌآᘛኟ᧩ق (OSD) פ౨।ழΔפ౨।༉۞೯؈Ζ
Display Time ࠐشױਐࡳ OSD פ౨।ؘႊڇ᧩ڍقՆ৵؈Ζ
5.3.1 ࡳ Display Time
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ MENU SETTINGSΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Display TimeΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
VHF
VHF
VHF
VHF51
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5 ᓳᖞᘛኟՕ՛ۯࢨᆜ
5.4 Transparency
פࡳ౨।ီ࿗ऱຘࣔ৫Κ
5.4.1 ᧢ޓ Transparency
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ MENU SETTINGSΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ TransparencyΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
English
20 sec
On
MENU SETTINGS
Language
Menu H-Position
Menu V-Position
Display Time
Transparency
AUTO
Off
On6 ࡉࡳૹ 52
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.1 Reset
ലขऱڶࢬࡳଖᝫנᐗቃଖΖ
6.1.1 ॣࡨ֏ࡳଖ (Reset)
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ ResetΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
AUTO
Reset all settings?
Yes No
EXIT AUTO53
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.2 Eco Saving
Eco Saving פ౨ᄎ൳ࠫ᧩قᕴ૿شࠌࣨऱሽੌࠐ྇֟ሽၦΖ
ᅝ Bright ࣍ Dynamic Contrast ᑓڤழΔྤऄפءشࠌ౨।Ζ
6.2.1 ࡳ Eco Saving
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Eco SavingΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z 75%Κല᧩قᕴሽၦ᧢ޓቃ్ऱ 75%Ζ
z 50%Κല᧩قᕴሽၦ᧢ޓቃ్ऱ 50%Ζ
z Off:ೖش Eco Saving פ౨Ζ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
ࢿଥ
ଥࢿOff
AUTO54
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.3 Off Timer
൞אױࡳข۞೯ᣂຨΖ
6.3.1 ࡳ Off Timer
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Off TimerΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Off:ೖࡳشழឰሽפ౨Δࠌᘛኟլᄎ۞೯ᣂຨሽᄭΖ
z On:ၲඔࡳழឰሽפ౨Δࠌᘛኟ۞೯ᣂຨሽᄭΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
AUTO
Off
On55
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.4 Turn Off After
ࡳழឰሽפ౨ऱࡳᒤڇױ 1 ۟ 23 ՛ழհၴΖءขᄎڇࠩሒਐࡳழᑇ৵۞೯ᣂຨሽᄭΖ
ڶᅝ Off Timer ࡳ On ழΔפء౨।թ౨شࠌΖ
6.4.1 ࡳ Turn Off After
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Turn Off AfterΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ࡳ Turn Off AfterΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO56
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.5 PC/AV Mode
ല PC/AV Mode AVΖቹቝ֡՚ലᄎ࣋ՕΖຍଡᙇႈڇ൞ᨠᓾሽᐙழᄎৰኔشΖ
z פڼ౨լ֭གᣊֺᑓڤΖ
z ڇ 16:9 ࢨ 16:10 հᣊऱᐈᘛኟীᇆՂ༼ࠎΖ
z ࣠ڕ᧩قᕴ ΰࡳ ψDVIωழαਢڇᆏ౨ᑓڤՀࢨृ᧩قထಛஒ Check Signal CableΔᓮਊ
MENU ਊၨ᧩ق ψᘛኟ᧩ق൳ࠫω (OSD)Ζ൞אױᙇᖗ PC ࢨ AVΖ
6.5.1 ࡳ PC/AV Mode
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ PC/AV ModeΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO
3&
$9
PC/AV Mode
'9,
AUTO57
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.6 Key Repeat Time
൳ࠫਊՀਊၨழऱ֘ᚨຒ৫Ζ
6.6.1 ࡳ Key Repeat Time
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Key Repeat TimeΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z ױᙇ࠷ AccelerationΕ1 sec ࢨ 2 secΖૉᙇ࠷ No RepeatΔঞڇਊՀਊၨழച۩ਐחԫ
Ζڻ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Manual
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
Acceleration
1 sec
2 sec
No Repeat
AUTO58
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.7 Source Detection
ඔ೯ Source DetectionΖ
6.7.1 ࡳ Source Detection
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Source DetectionΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Auto:ขᄎ۞೯ᙃܑᙁԵಛᇆᄭΖ
z Manual:֫೯ᙇ࠷ᙁԵಛᇆᄭΖ
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Off
Acceleration
Reset
Eco Saving
Off Timer
Turn Off After
PC/AV Mode
Key Repeat Time
Source Detection
On
10h
AUTO
Auto
Manual59
ૹࡉࡳ 6
ૹࡉࡳ 6
6.8 Customized Key
൞אױਊᅃאՀޡᨏ۞ૡ Customized KeyΖ
6.8.1 ࡳ Customized Key
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ SETUP&RESETΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
3 ਊءขՂऱ [ ] ฝ۟ Customized KeyΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟנܛΖ
z Angle - Bright - Eco Saving - Image Size
4 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ࢬᏁऱᙇႈΔྥ৵ਊ [ ]Ζ
5 ᙟܛشᙇࡳऱᙇႈΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Customized Key $FFHOHUDWLRQ
2Q
Eco Saving
Image Size
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Bright
SAMSUNG
MAGIC Angle
AUTO
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
SAMSUNG
MAGIC7 INFORMATION פ౨।֗ࠡה 60
7
הࠡ֗౨।פ INFORMATION
7.1 INFORMATION
ᛀီؾছऱᙁԵಛᇆᄭΕ᙮ፖᇞ࣫৫Ζ
7.1.1 ᧩ق INFORMATION
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨઃױ᧩قਊᖄᥦΖྥ৵ਊ [ ] ᧩قઌᚨऱפ౨।ᘛኟΖ
2 ਊ [ ] ฝ۟ INFORMATIONΖല᧩ؾقছऱᙁԵಛᇆᄭΕ᙮֗ᇞ࣫৫Ζ
᧩قऱפ౨।ႈױ౨ڂᖲীۖฆΖ
MENU
SETUP&RESET
Analog
**kHz **Hz NP
**** x ****
Optimal Mode
**** x **** **Hz
PICTURE
COLOR
MENU SETTINGS
INFORMATION
EXIT AUTO61
7 INFORMATION פ౨।֗ࠡה
7 INFORMATION פ౨।֗ࠡה
7.2 ڇॣࡨ૿խࡳ Brightness ࡉ Contrast
ڇॣࡨᘛኟ ΰڇࠡխլ᧩ق OSD פ౨।αխشࠌ [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ Brightness ࢨ Contrast ࡳΖ
1 ਊขছ૿ऱٚ۶ਊၨ ΰآ᧩פق౨।ᘛኟழαઃױ᧩ق Key GuideΖྥ৵ਊ [ ]ΖאՀ૿ᙟ
Ζנܛ
2 ਊ [ ] ਊၨΔڇא Brightness ࡉ Contrast ࡳհၴ֊ངΖ
3 شࠌ [ ] ਊၨᓳᖞ Brightness ࢨ Contrast ࡳΖ
Brightness
100
Contrast
75
EXIT8 ڜᇘຌ᧯ 62
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8.1 Magic Tune
8.1.1 չᏖਢ MagicTuneΛ
MagicTune ਢԫጟຌ᧯࿓ڤΔ،༼ࠎԱ٤૿ऱ᧩قᕴפ౨ᎅ࣐ࡉࣔᚩऱਐতΔشࠌ࣍ܗڶृᓳᖞ᧩ق
ᕴΖ
ྤᏁشࠌขऱᖙ܂ਊၨΔشࠌᄶቕࡉᒌױܛᓳᖞขΖ
8.1.2 ڜᇘຌ᧯
1 ലڜᇘ٠࣋Ե٠ᖲΖ
2 ᙇᖗMagicTuneࡳ࿓ڤΖ
ૉᘛኟՂآ᧩قຌ᧯ڜᇘऱݶ᧩ᘛኟΔঞᓮބࠩ٠ᖲՂऱ MagicTune ڜᇘᚾூࠀਊࠟՀΖ
3 ᙇᖗڜᇘࠀߢਊ [Հԫޡ]Ζ
4 ਊᅃᘛኟՂ᧩قऱᎅګݙࣔໍ塒ऱຌ᧯ڜᇘޡᨏΖ
z ڜᇘհ৵ؘႊૹᄅඔ೯ሽᆰΔຌ᧯թ౨إൄՠ܂Ζ
z MagicTuneቹױق౨լᄎנΔီሽᆰߓอࡉขۖࡳΖ
z ૉ൸உቹقլנΔঞਊ F5 Ζ
ڜᇘૻࠫࡉംᠲ (MagicTune™)
MagicTune™ ऱڜᇘױ౨࠹ቹݮΕᖲࡉࣨጻሁᛩቼऱᐙΖ
ޣอᏁߓ
อߓᄐ܂
z Windows XPΕWindows VistaΕWindows 7
8.1.3 ฝೈຌ᧯
ڇ Windows խΔ൞ႛױຘመ [ᄅᏺࢨฝೈ࿓ڤ] ฝೈ MagicTune™Ζ
ฝೈ MagicTune™ΔᓮאګݙՀޡᨏΖ63
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
1 ਊԫՀ [ၲࡨ]Δᙇᖗ [ࡳ]Δྥ৵ൕפ౨।խᙇᖗ [൳ࠫ]Ζ
ኙ࣍ Windows XPΔਊ [ၲࡨ]Δྥ৵ൕפ౨।խᙇᖗ [൳ࠫ]Ζ
2 ڇ൳ࠫխऱ [ᄅᏺ/ฝೈ࿓ڤ] ቹقՂਊࠟՀΖ
3 ڇ [ᄅᏺ/ฝೈ] ီ࿗խΔބࠩࠀᙇᖗ MagicTune™Δࠌࠡ֘ػ᧩قΖ
4 ਊ [᧢ࢨޓฝೈ࿓ڤ] ฝೈຌ᧯Ζ
5 ᙇᖗ [ਢ] ၲࡨฝೈ MagicTune™Ζ
6 ৱׂࠥΔऴࠩנಛஒֱჇΔຏव൞ᇠຌ᧯բᆖݙ٤ฝೈΖ
࠷ݾ֭གΕFAQ ΰൄߠംᠲαࢨMagicTune™ຌ᧯్֒ऱᇷಛΔᓮທݺଚऱጻీ(http:/
/www.samsung.com/us/consumer/learningresources/monitor/magetune/pop_intro.html)Ζ64
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8.2 MultiScreen
MultiScreen ױᨃشࠌृല᧩قᕴ։໊ڍګଡ᧩قΖ
8.2.1 ڜᇘຌ᧯
1 ലڜᇘ٠࣋Ե٠ᖲΖ
2 ᙇᖗ"MultiScreen"ࡳ࿓ڤΖ
ૉᘛኟՂآ᧩قຌ᧯ڜᇘऱݶ᧩ᘛኟΔঞᓮބࠩ٠ᖲՂऱ"MultiScreen"ڜᇘᚾூࠀਊࠟՀΖ
3 נڇ ψInstallation Wizardωΰڜᇘ壄ᨋαழΔਊ [Հԫޡ]Ζ
4 ᙅ༛ᘛኟ᧩قऱᎅࣔᤉᥛၞ۩ڜᇘΖ
z ڜᇘհ৵ؘႊૹᄅඔ೯ሽᆰΔຌ᧯թ౨إൄՠ܂Ζ
z "MultiScreen"ቹױق౨լᄎנΔီሽᆰߓอࡉขۖࡳΖ
z ૉ൸உቹقլנΔঞਊ "F5" Ζ
ڜᇘૻࠫࡉംᠲ (MultiScreen)
"MultiScreen"ڜᇘױ౨ᄎ࠹ቹݮΕᖲࡉࣨጻሁᛩቼऱᐙΖ
อߓᄐ܂
"อߓᄐ܂"
z "Windows 2000"
z "Windows XP Home Edition"
z "Windows XP Professional"
z "Windows Vista 32bit"
z "Windows 7 32bit"
ኙ࣍ "MultiScreen"Δ৬ᤜشࠌ "Windows 2000" ޓࢨठءऱ܂ᄐߓอΖ
"࿏᧯"
z ۟֟ 32MB ऱಖᖋ᧯
z ࿏ᖲՂ۟֟ڶ 60MB ऱشױ़ၴ
MultiScreen65
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8 ڜᇘຌ᧯
8.2.2 ฝೈຌ᧯
ਊԫՀ [ၲࡨ]Δᙇᖗ [ࡳ]/[൳ࠫ]Δྥ৵ਊࠟՀ [ᄅᏺࢨฝೈ࿓ڤ]Ζ
ൕ࿓ڤ堚խᙇᖗ "MultiScreen"Δྥ৵ਊ [ᄅᏺ/ฝೈ]ਊၨΖ9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত 66
9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত
9.1 ᜤ Samsung ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨ছؘႊ٣ၞ۩ऱࠃႈ
9.1.1 ྒྷᇢข
ીሽ Samsung ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨ছΔᓮ٣ਊᅃՀ٨ֱڤྒྷᇢขΖૉംᠲսྥڇژΔᓮᜤ Samsung
ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨Ζ
شࠌขྒྷᇢפ౨ᛀขਢإܡൄሎ܂Ζ
ૉᣂຨᘛኟ৵Δءࠌܛขբᆖፖ PC إൄຑ൷ΔሽᄭਐقᗉথࠉྥೂᡩΔᓮച۩۞ݺ်ឰྒྷᇢפ౨Ζ
1 ᣂຨ PC ࡉขሽᄭΖ
2 ലءขऱᨱᒵࢸՀΖ
3 ၲඔขऱሽᄭΖ
4 ૉנ Check Signal Cable ಛஒΔז।ءขפ౨إൄΖ
࣠ڕ૿սྥ़ػΔᓮᛀ൞ऱီಛ൳ࠫᕴࡉ PC ߓอΖ
9.1.2 ᛀᇞ࣫৫ࡉ᙮
ૉشࠌऱᑓڤ၌נ֭གᇞ࣫৫ ΰᔹ ψ10.3ᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤ।ωαΔঞ Not Optimum Mode ಛஒᄎ
ᑉנΖ
9.1.3 ᛀՀ٨ႈؾΖ
ڜᇘംᠲ ΰPC ᑓڤα
ᘛኟլឰၲඔࡉᣂຨΖ ᓮᛀءขፖ PC ऱ൷ᒵਢإܡൄΔۖ൷ᙰ
ਢܡ᠙ጹΖΰᔹ ψ2.3ຑ൷֗شࠌሽᆰωα
ᘛኟംᠲ
ሽᄭ LED ᣂຨΖᘛኟྤऄၲඔΖ ᛀሽᄭᒵਢܡբإᒔຑ൷ ΰᔹ ψ2.3ຑ൷֗
ሽᆰωαشࠌ
נ Check Signal Cable ಛஒΖ ᓮᛀᨱᒵਢܡፖءขإൄຑ൷Ζΰᔹ
ψ2.3ຑ൷֗شࠌሽᆰωα
ᛀຑ൷۟ขऱᇘᆜਢܡբᆖၲඔሽᄭΖ
" ψNot Optimum Modeωᙟܛ᧩قΖ ૉ᧩قಬנऱಛᇆ၌ءנขऱ່Օᇞ࣫৫ࢨ
່Օ᙮ΔঞലנءಛஒΖ
ᖕ ψᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤ।ωΰร76αޏޓ່Օᇞ࣫
৫ࢨ່Օ᙮Δאฤٽขࢤ౨Ζ67
9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত
9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত
ᘛኟՂऱᐙቝ࿇ڴށسΖ ᛀᨱᒵፖขၴऱຑ൷ ΰᔹ ψ2.3ຑ൷֗ࠌ
ሽᆰωαش
૿լ堚ཐΖ૿ᑓᒫΖ ᓳᖞ Coarse ΰร41αፖ Fine ΰร42αΖ
ฝೈڶࢬॵٙ ΰڕီಛ९ᨱᒵαΔྥ৵ૹ
ᇢΖ
ലᇞ࣫৫ࡉ᙮ࡳ৬ᤜ్Ζΰᔹ ψ10.1
ԫωα
૿լݽࠀࡳ೯Ζ ᛀሽᆰऱᇞ࣫৫ፖ᙮ਢܡڇࡳፖขઌ୲
ऱᇞ࣫৫ፖ᙮ᒤփΖ൷ထΔڶڕؘᓮᔹ
ขࡉ।ωΰร76αڤխऱ ψᑑᄷಛᇆᑓם֫ء
Ղऱ INFORMATION פ౨।Δ᧢ޓࡳΖ
ᘛኟؐᢰڶອᐙࢨᦤᐙΖ
ᘛኟ֜ॽΖᘛኟ֜ᄆΖ ᓳᖞ Brightness ΰร33αፖ Contrast ΰร
34αΖ
ᘛኟۥլԫીΖ ޏޓ COLOR ࡳଖΖΰᔹ ψۥࡳᖺ
ωα
ᘛኟՂऱۥڶອᐙࠀ࿇ڴށسΖ ޏޓ COLOR ࡳଖΖΰᔹ ψۥࡳᖺ
ωα
ۥػದࠐլ֜ቝۥػΖ ޏޓ COLOR ࡳଖΖΰᔹ ψۥࡳᖺ
ωα
ᘛኟآ᧩قٚ۶ᐙቝΔۖሽᄭ LED ޢሶ 0.5
ઞࠩ 1 ઞೂᡩԫڻΖ
ข࣍ᆏ౨ᑓڤΖ
ਊᒌՂऱٚრࢨฝ೯ᄶቕױܛ१ڃ٣ছऱ
૿Ζ
ಛᇆᄭᇘᆜംᠲ
PC ၲᖲழ࿇נቷᜢΖ ࣠ڕሽᆰඔ೯ழᦫࠩቷᜢΔᓮലሽᆰಬଥΖ
ᘛኟംᠲ68
9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত
9 ጊᣄඈᇞਐত
9.2 ംᠲᇞ
ᓮᔹ PC ࢨ᧩قऱشࠌ֫םΔᛵᇞᣂ࣍ᓳᖞऱᇡาᎅࣔΖ
ംᠲ ᇞ
ڕ۶᧢ޓ᙮Λ ᓮࡳቹݮऱ᙮Ζ
z Windows XPΚᙇ࠷ ψψ൳ࠫω ψ؆ᨠࡉᠲω ψ᧩
قω ψࡳଖω ψၞၸω ψီᕴωΔྥ৵ޏޓ
ψီᕴࡳωՀऱ ψψᘛኟޓᄅ᙮ωΖ
z Windows ME/2000Κฝ۟൳൳ࠫ ᧩ق ࡳଖ ၞၸ
ီᕴΔྥ৵ᓳᖞီᕴࡳՀऱᘛᘛኟޓᄅ᙮Ζ
z Windows VistaΚᙇ࠷ ψψ൳ࠫω ψ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ω
ψଡԳ֏ω ψ᧩قࡳω ψၞၸࡳω ψီᕴωΔ
ྥ৵ޏޓ ψψီᕴࡳωՀऱ ψψᘛኟޓᄅ᙮ωΖ
z Windows 7Κᙇ࠷ ψψ൳ࠫω ψ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ω ψ᧩
قω ψᘛኟᇞ࣫৫ω ψၞၸࡳω ψီᕴωΔྥ
৵ޏޓ ψψီᕴࡳωՀऱ ψψᘛኟޓᄅ᙮ωΖ
ڕ۶᧢ޓᇞ࣫৫Λ z Windows XPΚฝ۟൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠࡉᠲ ᧩ق ࡳଖΔ
৫Ζ࣫ᓳᖞᇞࠀ
z Windows ME/2000Κฝ۟൳൳ࠫ ᧩ق ࡳଖΔࠀᓳᖞᇞ
৫Ζ࣫
z Windows VistaΚฝ۟൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ ଡԳ֏ ᧩
৫Ζ࣫ᓳᖞᇞࠀଖΔࡳق
z Windows 7Κฝ۟൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ ᧩ق ᓳᖞᇞ
৫Ζ࣫ᓳᖞᇞࠀ৫Δ࣫
ڕ۶ࡳᆏ౨ᑓڤΛ z Windows XPΚڇ൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠࡉᠲ ᧩ق ᘛኟঅᥨᇘ
ᆜࢨ PC ऱ BIOS SETUP խࡳᆏ౨ᑓڤΖ
z Windows ME/2000Κڇ൳൳ࠫ ᧩ق ᘛኟঅᥨᇘᆜࢨ PC
ऱ BIOS SETUP խࡳᆏ౨ᑓڤΖ
z Windows VistaΚڇ൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ ଡԳ֏ ᘛኟ
অᥨᇘᆜࢨࡳ PC ऱ BIOS SETUP խࡳᆏ౨ᑓڤΖ
z Windows 7Κڇ൳൳ࠫ ؆ᨠ֗ଡԳ֏ ଡԳ֏ ᘛኟঅ
ᥨᇘᆜࢨࡳ PC ऱ BIOS SETUP խࡳᆏ౨ᑓڤΖ10 69
10
10.1 ԫ
ীᇆټጠ S19C200NY S19C200N S19C200NW
ࣨ૿
Օ՛ 18.5 ٹ (47 ֆ։) 18.5 ٹ (47 ֆ։) 19.0 ٹ (48 ֆ։)
ᗨ૿ီױ
409.8 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 230.4 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
409.8 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 230.4 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
408.24 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 255.15 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
រ၏
0.300 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 0.300 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
0.300 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 0.300 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
0.2835 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.2835 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
ޡٵ
ֽؓ᙮ 30 ~ 81 kHz
িऴ᙮ 56 ~ 75 Hz
᧩ۥقᑇ 16.7M
ᇞ࣫৫
່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ 1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@60Hz
່ᇞ࣫৫ 1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@75Hz
່Օቝైழ౧ 85MHz (ᣊֺ) 85MHz (ᣊֺ) 136MHz (ᣊֺ)
ሽᄭ
ءขشࠌሽᚘ 100 ۟ 240VΖ
ᓮᔹข৵ֱऱᑑ᧘Δլٵഏ୮چऱᑑᄷሽᚘլጐઌٵΖ
ಛᇆຑ൷ᕴ 15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub ᨱᒵΔڤࣈױ
֡՚ΰᐈ x x
α /ૹၦ
լ֭ਮ
441.4 x 266.6 x 76.8
ֆ᠖
441.4 x 266.6 x 76.8
ֆ᠖
439.4 x 289.9 x 76.2
ֆ᠖
֭ਮ
441.4 X 348.8 X 170
ֆ᠖ / 2.8 ֆְ
441.4 X 348.8 X 170
ֆ᠖ / 2.8 ֆְ
439.4 X 373.6 X 170
ֆ᠖ / 3.1 ֆְ
VESA ڜᇘտ૿
100 ֆ᠖ x 100 ֆ᠖
ΰፖറش μᜩणνڜᇘ࿏᧯شࠌٽΖα
ైڂᛩቼ
ՠ܂ ᄵ৫Κ10ÛC Ω 40ÛC (50ÛF Ω 104ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ10 % Ω 80 %Δྤܐᕩ
࣋ژ ᄵ৫Κ-20ÛC Ω 45ÛC (-4ÛF Ω 113ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ5 % Ω 95 %Δྤܐᕩ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ߓ ᕴፖ PCق᧩อΖߓ୲ઌشܛ༻۶ᙟٚ࣍شࠌ֗ᇘڜױᕴق᧩ڼ
อၴऱᠨٻᇷறٌངᄎല᧩قᕴࡳ່ࠋ֏Ζ᧩قᕴᄎ۞೯ၞ۩ڜ
ᇘΖլመΔૉڶؘΔ൞Ոאױ۞ૡڜᇘࡳΖ
૿ࣨ٠រ ΰቝైα
ء࣍طขऱ፹ທڂైΔLCD ૿ױࣨ౨ᄎڶՕપ 1 ۍᆄ։հԫቝై
ΰ1ppmαለॽࢨለᄆΖຍࠀլᐙขய౨Ζ70
10
10
ীᇆټጠ S19C200BW S19C200BR S19C200NR
ࣨ૿
Օ՛ 19.0 ٹ (48 ֆ։) 19.0 ٹ (48 ֆ։) 19.0 ٹ (48 ֆ։)
ᗨ૿ီױ
408.24 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 255.15 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
376.32 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 301.06 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
376.32 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 301.06 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
រ၏
0.2835 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.2835 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
0.294 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 0.294 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
0.294 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 0.294 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
ޡٵ
ֽؓ᙮ 30 ~ 81 kHz
িऴ᙮ 56 ~ 75 Hz
᧩ۥقᑇ 16.7M
ᇞ࣫৫
່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ 1440x900@60Hz 1280x1024@60Hz
່ᇞ࣫৫ 1440x900@75Hz 1280x1024@75Hz
່Օቝైழ౧
136MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
135MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
135MHz (ᣊֺ)
ሽᄭ
ءขشࠌሽᚘ 100 ۟ 240VΖ
ᓮᔹข৵ֱऱᑑ᧘Δլٵഏ୮چऱᑑᄷሽᚘլጐઌٵΖ
ಛᇆຑ൷ᕴ
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub ᨱᒵΔڤࣈױ
DVI-D ۟ DVI-D ຑ൷ᕴΔڤࣈױ
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub
ڤࣈױᨱᒵΔ
֡՚ΰᐈ x x
α /ૹၦ
լ֭ਮ
439.4 x 289.9 x 76.2
ֆ᠖
407 x 336 x 77 ֆ᠖ 407 x 336 x 77 ֆ᠖
֭ਮ
439.4 X 373.6 X 170
ֆ᠖ / 3.1 ֆְ
407 X 419 X 170 ֆ
᠖ / 3.25 ֆְ
407 X 419 X 170 ֆ
᠖ / 3.25 ֆְ
VESA ڜᇘտ૿
100 ֆ᠖ x 100 ֆ᠖
ΰፖറش μᜩणνڜᇘ࿏᧯شࠌٽΖα
ైڂᛩቼ
ՠ܂ ᄵ৫Κ10ÛC Ω 40ÛC (50ÛF Ω 104ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ10 % Ω 80 %Δྤܐᕩ
࣋ژ ᄵ৫Κ-20ÛC Ω 45ÛC (-4ÛF Ω 113ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ5 % Ω 95 %Δྤܐᕩ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ߓ ᕴፖ PCق᧩อΖߓ୲ઌشܛ༻۶ᙟٚ࣍شࠌ֗ᇘڜױᕴق᧩ڼ
อၴऱᠨٻᇷறٌངᄎല᧩قᕴࡳ່ࠋ֏Ζ᧩قᕴᄎ۞೯ၞ۩ڜ
ᇘΖլመΔૉڶؘΔ൞Ոאױ۞ૡڜᇘࡳΖ
૿ࣨ٠រ ΰቝైα
ء࣍طขऱ፹ທڂైΔLCD ૿ױࣨ౨ᄎڶՕપ 1 ۍᆄ։հԫቝై
ΰ1ppmαለॽࢨለᄆΖຍࠀլᐙขய౨Ζ71
10
10
ীᇆټጠ S20C200B S22C200NY S22C200N
ࣨ૿
Օ՛ 20.0 ٹ (50 ֆ։) 21.5 ٹ (54 ֆ։) 21.5 ٹ (54 ֆ։)
ᗨ૿ီױ
442.8 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 249.08 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
476.64 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 268.11 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
476.64 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 268.11 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
រ၏
0.27675 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.27675 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
0.24825 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.24825 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
0.24825 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.24825 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
ޡٵ
ֽؓ᙮ 30 ~ 81 kHz
িऴ᙮ 56 ~ 75 Hz
᧩ۥقᑇ 16.7M
ᇞ࣫৫
່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ 1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
່ᇞ࣫৫ 1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
່Օቝైழ౧
136MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
148MHz (ᣊֺ)
ሽᄭ
ءขشࠌሽᚘ 100 ۟ 240VΖ
ᓮᔹข৵ֱऱᑑ᧘Δլٵഏ୮چऱᑑᄷሽᚘլጐઌٵΖ
ಛᇆຑ൷ᕴ
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub
ڤࣈױᨱᒵΔ
DVI-D ۟ DVI-D ຑ
ڤࣈױᕴΔ൷
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub ᨱᒵΔڤࣈױ
֡՚ΰᐈ x x
α /ૹၦ
լ֭ਮ
473.8 x 284 x 78.2
ֆ᠖
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
ֆ᠖
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
ֆ᠖
֭ਮ
473.8 X 367.1 X 170
ֆ᠖ / 2.65 ֆְ
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 ֆ᠖ / 3.5 ֆ
ְ
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 ֆ᠖ / 3.5 ֆ
ְ
VESA ڜᇘտ૿
100 ֆ᠖ x 100 ֆ᠖
ΰፖറش μᜩणνڜᇘ࿏᧯شࠌٽΖα
ైڂᛩቼ
ՠ܂ ᄵ৫Κ10ÛC Ω 40ÛC (50ÛF Ω 104ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ10 % Ω 80 %Δྤܐᕩ
࣋ژ ᄵ৫Κ-20ÛC Ω 45ÛC (-4ÛF Ω 113ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ5 % Ω 95 %Δྤܐᕩ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ߓ ᕴፖ PCق᧩อΖߓ୲ઌشܛ༻۶ᙟٚ࣍شࠌ֗ᇘڜױᕴق᧩ڼ
อၴऱᠨٻᇷறٌངᄎല᧩قᕴࡳ່ࠋ֏Ζ᧩قᕴᄎ۞೯ၞ۩ڜ
ᇘΖլመΔૉڶؘΔ൞Ոאױ۞ૡڜᇘࡳΖ
૿ࣨ٠រ ΰቝైα
ء࣍طขऱ፹ທڂైΔLCD ૿ױࣨ౨ᄎڶՕપ 1 ۍᆄ։հԫቝై
ΰ1ppmαለॽࢨለᄆΖຍࠀլᐙขய౨Ζ72
10
10
ীᇆټጠ S22C200B S22C200BW S23C200B
ࣨ૿
Օ՛ 21.5 ٹ (54 ֆ։) 22.0 ٹ (55 ֆ։) 23.0 ٹ (58 ֆ։)
ᗨ૿ီױ
476.64 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 268.11 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
473.76 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 296.1 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
509.76 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα x 286.74 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
រ၏
0.24825 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.24825 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
0.282ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα
X 0.282 ֆ᠖ ΰি
ऴα
0.2655 ֆ᠖ ΰֽ
ؓα X 0.2655 ֆ᠖
ΰিऴα
ޡٵ
ֽؓ᙮ 30 ~ 81 kHz
িऴ᙮ 56 ~ 75 Hz
᧩ۥقᑇ 16.7M
ᇞ࣫৫
່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ 1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
່ᇞ࣫৫ 1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
່Օቝైழ౧
148MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
146MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
148MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇ
αۯ
ሽᄭ
ءขشࠌሽᚘ 100 ۟ 240VΖ
ᓮᔹข৵ֱऱᑑ᧘Δլٵഏ୮چऱᑑᄷሽᚘլጐઌٵΖ
ಛᇆຑ൷ᕴ
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub ᨱᒵΔڤࣈױ
DVI-D ۟ DVI-D ຑ൷ᕴΔڤࣈױ
֡՚ΰᐈ x x
α /ૹၦ
լ֭ਮ
504.3 x 301.9 x 77.6
ֆ᠖
502.4 x 329.8 x 77.4
ֆ᠖
542.9 x 321.4 x 76.3
ֆ᠖
֭ਮ
504.3 x 385.35 x
185.0 ֆ᠖ / 3.5 ֆ
ְ
502.4 x 413.5 x 185
ֆ᠖ / 3.85 ֆְ
542.9 x 404.65 x
185 ֆ᠖ / 3.25 ֆְ
VESA ڜᇘտ૿
100 ֆ᠖ x 100 ֆ᠖
ΰፖറش μᜩणνڜᇘ࿏᧯شࠌٽΖα
ైڂᛩቼ
ՠ܂ ᄵ৫Κ10ÛC Ω 40ÛC (50ÛF Ω 104ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ10 % Ω 80 %Δྤܐᕩ
࣋ژ ᄵ৫Κ-20ÛC Ω 45ÛC (-4ÛF Ω 113ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ5 % Ω 95 %Δྤܐᕩ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ߓ ᕴፖ PCق᧩อΖߓ୲ઌشܛ༻۶ᙟٚ࣍شࠌ֗ᇘڜױᕴق᧩ڼ
อၴऱᠨٻᇷறٌངᄎല᧩قᕴࡳ່ࠋ֏Ζ᧩قᕴᄎ۞೯ၞ۩ڜ
ᇘΖլመΔૉڶؘΔ൞Ոאױ۞ૡڜᇘࡳΖ
૿ࣨ٠រ ΰቝైα
ء࣍طขऱ፹ທڂైΔLCD ૿ױࣨ౨ᄎڶՕપ 1 ۍᆄ։հԫቝై
ΰ1ppmαለॽࢨለᄆΖຍࠀլᐙขய౨Ζ73
10
10
वΖຏ۩Δஏլޓ᧢ࢬڶۖ֒༽౨ᙟᔆऱױՂא
ڼᇘᆜ B ᣊᑇۯໂΖ
ীᇆټጠ S24C200BL
ࣨ૿
Օ՛ 23.6 ٹ (59 ֆ։)
ױီ૿ᗨ 521.28 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα X 293.22 ֆ᠖ ΰিऴα
រ၏ 0.2715 ֆ᠖ ΰֽؓα X 0.2715 ֆ᠖ ΰিऴα
ޡٵ
ֽؓ᙮ 30 ~ 81 kHz
িऴ᙮ 56 ~ 75 Hz
᧩ۥقᑇ 16.7M
ᇞ࣫৫
່ࠋᇞ࣫৫ 1920x1080@60Hz
່ᇞ࣫৫ 1920x1080@60Hz
່Օቝైழ౧ 148MHz ΰᣊֺΕᑇۯα
ሽᄭ
ءขشࠌሽᚘ 100 ۟ 240VΖ
ᓮᔹข৵ֱऱᑑ᧘Δլٵഏ୮چऱᑑᄷሽᚘլጐઌٵΖ
ಛᇆຑ൷ᕴ
15 ಾ۟ 15 ಾ D-sub ᨱᒵΔڤࣈױ
DVI-D ۟ DVI-D ຑ൷ᕴΔڤࣈױ
֡՚ΰᐈ x x
α /ૹၦ
լ֭ਮ 554.6 x 330.5 x 78.2 ֆ᠖
֭ਮ 554.6 x 412.35 x 185 ֆ᠖ / 4.1ֆְ
VESA ڜᇘտ૿
100 ֆ᠖ x 100 ֆ᠖
ΰፖറش μᜩणνڜᇘ࿏᧯شࠌٽΖα
ైڂᛩቼ
ՠ܂ ᄵ৫Κ10ÛC Ω 40ÛC (50ÛF Ω 104ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ10 % Ω 80 %Δྤܐᕩ
࣋ژ ᄵ৫Κ-20ÛC Ω 45ÛC (-4ÛF Ω 113ÛF) ᛘ৫Κ5 % Ω 95 %Δྤܐᕩ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ߓ ᕴፖ PCق᧩อΖߓ୲ઌشܛ༻۶ᙟٚ࣍شࠌ֗ᇘڜױᕴق᧩ڼ
อၴऱᠨٻᇷறٌངᄎല᧩قᕴࡳ່ࠋ֏Ζ᧩قᕴᄎ۞೯ၞ۩ڜ
ᇘΖլመΔૉڶؘΔ൞Ոאױ۞ૡڜᇘࡳΖ
૿ࣨ٠រ ΰቝైα
ء࣍طขऱ፹ທڂైΔLCD ૿ױࣨ౨ᄎڶՕપ 1 ۍᆄ։հԫቝై
ΰ1ppmαለॽࢨለᄆΖຍࠀլᐙขய౨Ζ74
10
10
10.2 PowerSaver
࣠ڕขၵᆜխመԫழၴΔءขऱᆏ౨פ౨ᄎᣂຨᘛኟࡉ᧢ޓሽᄭ LED ऱۥΔא૾܅ሽၦΖ
ڇᆏ౨ᑓڤՀΔլᄎᣂຨሽᄭΖૉ٦ڻၲඔ૿Δᓮਊᒌऱٚრࢨฝ೯ᄶቕΖڇڶขຑ൷
۟ࠠڶᆏ౨פ౨ऱ PC ழΔᆏ౨ᑓڤթᄎሎ܂Ζ
PowerSaver 正常作業模式 節能模式 關機 (電源按鈕)
電源指示燈 開啟 閃爍 關閉
耗電量
(S19C200NY)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S19C200N)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S19C200NW)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S19C200BW)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S19C200BR)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S19C200NR)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S20C200B)
典型值 19 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S22C200NY)
典型值 24 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S22C200N)
典型值 24 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S22C200B)
典型值 24 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S22C200BW)
典型值 24 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S23C200B)
典型值 25 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
耗電量
(S24C200BL)
典型值 30 W
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)
低於 0.1W (類比輸入
條件)75
10
10
在不同的操作條件下或設定變更時,顯示的耗電量也會有所不同。(S**C200** 機型 節能模式 /
關機 (電源按鈕) : 最高 0.25 瓦特 )
若要將耗電量降到 0 瓦,請按下產品背面的電源開關切斷電源,或拔下電源線。長時間不使用本
產品時,請務必拔下電源線。當電源開關無法使用而您又希望將耗電量減少至 0 瓦,請拔除電源
線。76
10
10
10.3 ᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤ।
z ࣍ط૿ߪءࣨऱڂైΔءข౨ಾኙٺଡ૿Օ՛ࡳԫጟᇞ࣫৫Δאሒ່ࠩࠋᔆΖڼڂૉ
شࠌਐࡳᇞ࣫৫א؆ऱᇞ࣫৫Δຟױ౨ࠌᔆ૾܅Ζᝩ܍ຍጟൣݮΔ৬ᤜ൞ᙇࢬ࠷၇ขᘛ
ኟՕ՛ऱ່ࠋਐࡳᇞ࣫৫Ζ
z ല CDT ᧩قᕴ ΰຑ൷۟ PCαޓང LCD ᧩قᕴழΔᓮᛀ᙮Ζ࣠ڕ LCD ᧩قᕴլ֭ག 85
HzΔᓮڇ൞ല CDT ᧩قᕴޓང LCD ᧩قᕴছΔشࠌ CDT ᧩قᕴലিऴ᙮ޓང 60 HzΖ
ૉ PC ႚಬ᥆א࣍ՀᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤऱಛᇆΔᘛኟ༉ᄎ۞೯ᓳᖞΖૉ PC ࢬႚᙁऱಛᇆլ᥆࣍ᑑᄷಛᇆᑓ
ڤΔঞᘛኟױ౨ܧ़ػۖᄭ LED սྥၲඔΖૉ࿇سຍጟൣउΔᓮᔹቹشࠌݮ֫םΔאᖕՀ।
Ζࡳޓ᧢
S19C200NY
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+77
10
10
S19C200N
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+78
10
10
S19C200NW
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+79
10
10
S19C200BW
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+80
10
10
S19C200BR
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+81
10
10
S19C200NR
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+82
10
10
S20C200B
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+83
10
10
S22C200NY
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAΔ1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+84
10
10
S22C200N
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAΔ1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+85
10
10
S22C200B
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAΔ1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+86
10
10
S22C200BW
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+87
10
10
S23C200B
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAΔ1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+88
10
10
S24C200BL
z ֽؓ᙮
ൕᘛኟؐᢰ۟׳ᢰൿ༴ԫයᒵࢬᏁऱழၴጠֽؓၜཚΖֽؓၜཚऱଙᑇጠֽؓ᙮Ζֽؓ᙮
Ζۯ Hz א
z িऴ᙮
૿ؘࣨႊޢאઞᑇԼڻऱ᙮ૹᓤ᧩قઌٵ૿Δۚณթ౨ࠩ۞ྥᐙቝΖຍଡૹᓤ᙮ጠ
ψিऴൿ༴ωࢨ ψޓᄅ᙮ωΔא Hz ۯΖ
ᇞ࣫৫
ֽؓ᙮
ΰkHzα
িऴ᙮
ΰHzα
ቝైழ౧
ΰMHzα
ֽؓΰ ࢤᄕޡٵ
/িऴα
IBMΔ720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACΔ640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACΔ832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACΔ1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAΔ800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAΔ800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAΔ1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAΔ1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAΔ1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAΔ1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAΔ1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAΔ1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAΔ1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+ॵᙕ 89
ॵᙕ
ᜤ٤ SAMSUNG
ૉ൞ڶٚ۶ፖ Samsung ขઌᣂऱംᠲࢨ৬ᤜΔᓮᜤ SAMSUNG ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨Ζ
NORTH AMERICA
U.S.A 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
CANADA 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com/ca
(English)
http://www.samsung.com/ca_fr
(French)
MEXICO 01-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
LATIN AMERICA
ARGENTINE 0800-333-3733 http://www.samsung.com
BOLIVIA 800-10-7260 http://www.samsung.com
BRAZIL 0800-124-421
4004-0000
http://www.samsung.com
CHILE 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
From mobile 02-482 82 00
http://www.samsung.com
COLOMBIA 01-8000112112 http://www.samsung.com
COSTA RICA 0-800-507-7267 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
DOMINICA 1-800-751-2676 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
ECUADOR 1-800-10-7267 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
EL SALVADOR 800-6225 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)90
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
GUATEMALA 1-800-299-0013 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
HONDURAS 800-27919267 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
JAMAICA 1-800-234-7267 http://www.samsung.com
NICARAGUA 00-1800-5077267 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
PANAMA 800-7267 http://www.samsung.com/latin
(Spanish)
http://www.samsung.com/latin_en
(English)
PERU 0-800-777-08 http://www.samsung.com
PUERTO RICO 1-800-682-3180 http://www.samsung.com
TRINIDAD & TOBAGO 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
VENEZUELA 0-800-100-5303 http://www.samsung.com
EUROPE
AUSTRIA 0810 - SAMSUNG
(7267864, 埖 0.07/min)
http://www.samsung.com
BELGIUM 02-201-24-18 http://www.samsung.com/be
(Dutch)
http://www.samsung.com/be_fr
(French)
BOSNIA 05 133 1999 http://www.samsung.com
BULGARIA 07001 33 11 , normal tariff http://www.samsung.com
CROATIA 062 SAMSUNG (062 726 7864) http://www.samsung.com
CYPRUS 8009 4000 only from landline
(+30) 210 6897691 from mobile
and land line
http://www.samsung.com
LATIN AMERICA91
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
CZECH 800 - SAMSUNG (800-726786) http://www.samsung.com
DENMARK 70 70 19 70 http://www.samsung.com
EIRE 0818 717100 http://www.samsung.com
ESTONIA 800-7267 http://www.samsung.com
FINLAND 09 85635050 http://www.samsung.com
FRANCE 01 48 63 00 00 http://www.samsung.com
GERMANY 0180 5 SAMSUNG bzw.
0180 5 7267864* (*0,14 埖/Min.
aus dem dt. Festnetz, aus dem
Mobilfunk max. 0,42 埖/Min.)
http://www.samsung.com
GREECE 80111-SAMSUNG (80111 726
7864) only from land line
(+30) 210 6897691 from mobile
and land line
http://www.samsung.com
HUNGARY 06-80-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
ITALIA 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
LATVIA 8000-7267 http://www.samsung.com
LITHUANIA 8-800-77777 http://www.samsung.com
LUXEMBURG 261 03 710 http://www.samsung.com
MACEDONIA 023 207 777 http://www.samsung.com
MONTENEGRO 020 405 888 http://www.samsung.com
NETHERLANDS 0900 - SAMSUNG
(0900-7267864) (埖 0,10/Min)
http://www.samsung.com
NORWAY 815 56480 http://www.samsung.com
POLAND 0 801-1SAMSUNG (172-678)
+48 22 607-93-33
http://www.samsung.com
PORTUGAL 808 20 - SAMSUNG (808 20
7267)
http://www.samsung.com
RUMANIA 08008 SAMSUNG (08008 726
7864)
TOLL FREE No.
http://www.samsung.com
SERBIA 0700 Samsung (0700 726 7864) http://www.samsung.com
EUROPE
Samsung Electronics Czech and Slovak, s.r.o.,
Oasis Florenc, Sokolovská 394/17, 180 00, Praha 892
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
SLOVAKIA 0800 - SAMSUNG (0800-726
786)
http://www.samsung.com
SPAIN 902 - 1 - SAMSUNG (902 172
678)
http://www.samsung.com
SWEDEN 0771 726 7864 (SAMSUNG) http://www.samsung.com
SWITZERLAND 0848-SAMSUNG
(7267864, CHF 0.08/min)
http://www.samsung.com/ch
(German)
http://www.samsung.com/ch_fr
(French)
U.K 0330 SAMSUNG (7267864) http://www.samsung.com
CIS
ARMENIA 0-800-05-555 http://www.samsung.com
AZERBAIJAN 088-55-55-555 http://www.samsung.com
BELARUS 810-800-500-55-500 http://www.samsung.com
GEORGIA 0-800-555-555 http://www.samsung.com
KAZAKHSTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500
(GSM: 7799)
http://www.samsung.com
KYRGYZSTAN 00-800-500-55-500 http://www.samsung.com
MOLDOVA 0-800-614-40 http://www.samsung.com
MONGOLIA +7-800-555-55-55 http://www.samsung.com
RUSSIA 8-800-555-55-55 http://www.samsung.com
TADJIKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 http://www.samsung.com
UKRAINE 0-800-502-000 http://www.samsung.com/ua
(Ukrainian)
http://www.samsung.com/ua_ru
(Russian)
UZBEKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 http://www.samsung.com
ASIA PACIFIC
AUSTRALIA 1300 362 603 http://www.samsung.com
CHINA 400-810-5858 http://www.samsung.com
HONG KONG (852) 3698 - 4698 http://www.samsung.com/hk
(Chinese)
http://www.samsung.com/hk_en
(English)
EUROPE93
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
INDIA 1800 1100 11
3030 8282
1800 3000 8282
1800 266 8282
http://www.samsung.com
INDONESIA 0800-112-8888
021-5699-7777
http://www.samsung.com
JAPAN 0120-327-527 http://www.samsung.com
MALAYSIA 1800-88-9999 http://www.samsung.com
NEW ZEALAND 0800 SAMSUNG (0800 726 786) http://www.samsung.com
PHILIPPINES 1-800-10-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
for PLDT
1-800-3-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
for Digitel
1-800-8-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
for Globe
02-5805777
http://www.samsung.com
SINGAPORE 1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
TAIWAN 0800-329-999
0266-026-066
http://www.samsung.com
THAILAND 1800-29-3232
02-689-3232
http://www.samsung.com
VIETNAM 1 800 588 889 http://www.samsung.com
MIDDlE EAST
BAHRAIN 8000-4726 http://www.samsung.com/ae
(English)
http://www.samsung.com/ae_ar
(Arabic)
EGYPT 08000-726786 http://www.samsung.com
IRAN 021-8255 http://www.samsung.com
JORDAN 800-22273
065777444
http://www.samsung.com
KUWAIT 183-2255 http://www.samsung.com/ae
(English)
http://www.samsung.com/ae_ar
(Arabic)
ASIA PACIFIC94
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
MOROCCO 080 100 2255 http://www.samsung.com
OMAN 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com/ae
(English)
http://www.samsung.com/ae_ar
(Arabic)
SAUDI ARABIA 9200-21230 http://www.samsung.com/ae
(English)
http://www.samsung.com/ae_ar
(Arabic)
TURKEY 444 77 11 http://www.samsung.com
U.A.E 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
AFRICA
ANGOLA 91-726-7864 http://www.samsung.com
BOTSWANA 0800-726-000 http://www.samsung.com
CAMEROON 7095- 0077 http://www.samsung.com
COTE D’ IVOIRE 8000 0077 http://www.samsung.com
GHANA 0800-10077
0302-200077
http://www.samsung.com
KENYA 0800 724 000 http://www.samsung.com
NAMIBIA 8197267864 http://www.samsung.com
NIGERIA 0800-726-7864 http://www.samsung.com
SENEGAL 800-00-0077 http://www.samsung.com
SOUTH AFRICA 0860-SAMSUNG (726-7864) http://www.samsung.com
TANZANIA 0685 88 99 00 http://www.samsung.com
UGANDA 0800 300 300 http://www.samsung.com
ZAMBIA 211350370 http://www.samsung.com
MIDDlE EAST95
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
ڶᚍፂଥ ΰড়ᖜ၄شαઌᣂຂٚ
ޣፂଥழ, Հ૿ऱൣउڇࠌܛྤᚍঅଥཚփ, Ոၞ۩ڶᚍፂଥ
ॺขਚᎽऱൣउ
ᖲٙ堚ੑ, ᓳᖞ, شࠌᎅࣔ,ڜᇘ
z ࣠ڕፂଥԳ༼ࠎขشࠌֱऄᎅࣔ, ࢨਢ១ᓳᖞᙇႈۖլၞ۩࠵ࣈΖ
z յᜤጻ, ֚ᒵ, ڶᒵॾᇆ؆ຝᛩቼᖄીऱംᠲ
z Եขॣཚڜᇘ৵, ຑ൷ॵףऱขࢨृ٦ຑ൷ऱൣउ
z ขऱฝ೯, ჺ୮ທګऱ٦ڜᇘऱൣउ
z ࠡהֆขᖄીऱΔᝮᓮشࠌᎅࣔᇞᤩऱൣउ
z ጻ ࡉ ࠡהֆขຑ൷ऱᝮᓮΕشࠌᎅࣔऱൣउ
z ขઌᣂຌٙڜᇘࢨࡳᝮᓮऱൣउ
z ขփຝۊቺࢨृឆ៲ढऱ堚ੑ֗ฆढװೈऱൣउ
z ຏመhome shopping, յᜤጻ၇ऱขಳףᝮᓮڜᇘऱൣउ
၄ृመ؈ທګऱਚᎽ
၄ृஞ࠷ழլࣹრࢨृॺറᄐଥທګਚᎽऱൣउ
၄ृஞ࠷ழլࣹრࢨृॺറᄐଥທګਚᎽऱൣउ
z ؆ຝᐳᚰࢨृၓᆵທګऱਚᎽჾ႞ऱൣउ
z شࠌآԿਣਐࡳऱΔᔄᖄીਚᎽ࿇سऱൣउ
z ॺԿਣሽֆࣚ೭ࡡಜీ֗࠰ԺषԳፂଥທګਚᎽ࿇سऱൣउ
z ড়ऴ൷ޏທΔଥ৵ທګਚᎽऱൣउ
z ࠎሽሽੌᙑᎄشࠌທګऱਚᎽ࿇سൣउ
z آਊᅃشࠌᎅࣔխऱ Ϙࣹრࠃႈϙၞ۩ᖙ܂ທګਚᎽऱൣउ
उൣהࠡ
z ֚߀(ሼሽ, ߀־, چᔼ, ੋֽ)ທګਚᎽऱൣउ
z ऱኂشࠌࡎࠩཚऱൣउ(ሽۃ,ጙృ, ೂ٠ᗉ, ᙰ, ᧢ངᕴ, ᗉጥᣊ, ᗴᛀ࿓ڤᣊ, ۥ )
ॺขਚᎽΔᝮᓮፂଥᏁ࠷گፂଥ၄شΔᓮ೭ؘᔹᦰشࠌᎅࣔ96
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
ش
OSD ΰᘛኟ᧩قα
൞ױຘመᘛኟ᧩ق (OSD) ၞ۩ᘛኟࡳΔࠉᅃᏁޣലᔆ່ࠋ֏Ζ൞شࠌױᘛኟՂ᧩قऱפ౨।Δ
Ζࡳהࠡڍ֗אᖺΕՕ՛ۥᘛኟऱॽ৫Εޓ᧢
Gamma
ψGammaωפ౨।ױᨃ൞ᓳᖞۊၸΔࠡז।ᘛኟऱխၴۥᓳΖᓳᖞॽ৫ᄎ༼ᘛኟऱᖞ᧯ॽ৫Δ܀
ᓳᖞ ψGammaωଖঞႛᄎ༼խၴۥᓳऱॽ৫Ζ
ၸۊ
ψၸωਢਐ৫ऱ్Δࠡࢬ᧩قऱਢᘛኟՂऱۥൕለᄆ᧢ለॽऱ᧢֏Ζᘛኟॽ৫հ
᧢ޓਢא႕ػ᧢֏ࠐ।قΔۖۊၸਢਐ႕ۥፖۥػհၴऱխၴΖຘመᓳᖞ Gamma ଖࠐ᧢ۊޓ
ၸΔലޏ᧢ᘛኟխၴۥᓳऱॽ৫Ζ
ൿጒ᙮
ൿጒ᙮ ΰࢨጠޓᄅ᙮αਢਐᘛኟޓᄅऱ᙮Ζᘛኟޓᄅא᧩قᐙቝழΔᄎႚಬᘛኟᇷறΔࠌ܀
شृྤऄޓߠᄅ܂ᄐΖᘛኟޓᄅऱڻᑇጠൿጒ᙮Δא Hz ૠၦۯΖ60Hz ऱൿጒ᙮।ق
ޢઞᤪᘛኟᄎޓᄅ 60 ڻΖᘛኟऱൿጒ᙮࠷ެ࣍ PC ֗ီᕴխ᧩قऱࢤ౨Ζ
ֽؓ᙮
ီᕴᘛኟՂ᧩قऱڗցࢨᐙቝΔਢطฒۥڍរ ΰቝైαࢬዌګΖቝైਢאֽؓᒵऱڤݮಬנΔ൷
ထലֽؓᒵিऴඈ٨ΔዌګᐙቝΖֽؓൿ༴א kHz ྒྷၦۯΔז।ڇီᕴᘛኟՂޢઞႚಬΕ
᧩قֽؓᒵऱڻᑇΖֽؓൿ༴࣠ڕਢ 85Δז।ޢઞႚಬ 85,000 ڻֽؓᒵאዌګᐙቝΔ।قऄ
85kHzΖ
িऴ᙮
ޢଡᐙቝຟਢطฒڍֽؓᒵዌګΖিऴൿ༴א Hz ྒྷၦۯΔז।ຍࠄֽؓᒵޢઞ౨ዌګ༓༏
ᐙቝΖিऴൿ༴࣠ڕਢ 60Δז।ޢઞႚಬ 60 ڻᐙቝΖিऴൿ༴Ծጠ ψޓᄅ᙮ωΔױᐙ
ᘛኟೂᡩ᙮Ζ
ᇞ࣫৫
ᇞ࣫৫ਢዌګᘛኟ૿ऱֽؓቝైፖিऴቝైᑇؾΔຍ।ق᧩قᕴาຝ᧩قऱ࿓৫Ζ
ᇞ࣫৫။Δᘛኟ᧩قऱᇷಛၦ။ՕΔᔞٵٽழച۩ڍႈՠ܂Ζ
ڕࠏ 1920 x 1080 ऱᇞ࣫৫Δ༉ץܶ 1,920 ଡֽؓቝై ΰֽؓൿ༴αࡉ 1,080 යিऴᒵ ΰিऴ
ᇞ࣫৫αΖ97
ॵᙕ
ॵᙕ
شܛ༻ᙟ
ᙟ༺פشܛ౨ױᨃီᕴፖ PC ۞೯ٌངᇷಛΔ໌ທ່ᚌߜऱ᧩قᛩቼΖ
᧩قᕴਢشࠌ VESA DDC ΰഏᎾᑑᄷαച۩ᙟ༺פشܛ౨Ζ֧ 98
֧
M
MultiScreen 64
P
PC/AV ᑓڤ 56
S
SAMSUNG MAGIC Angle 37
SAMSUNG MAGIC Bright 36
ԫ
ԫ 69
Կ
Հ٨ழၴ৵ᣂຨ 55
ք
ڜ٤ࣹრࠃႈ 10
ڜᇘ 22
ڶᚍፂଥ ΰড়ᖜ၄شαઌᣂຂٚ 95
۞ૡਊ 59
۞೯ᣂᖲࡳழᕴ 54
ۥᄵ 46
Ԯ
ۺጆ 47
Զ
شࠌขऱإᒔৎႨ 16
ࠐᄭೠྒྷ 58
ठᦞ 7
ॵᙕ 89
ॽ৫ 33
ਊૹᓤழၴ 57
ઊሽ 53
દۥ 43
ૹ 52
Լԫ
ംᠲᇞ 68
堚ཐ৫ 35
堚ᑥ 8
ษᓳ 41
ຑ൷֗شࠌሽᆰ 27
ຘࣔ৫ 51
ຝٙ 19
ԼԲ
ၞ۩ຑ൷հছ 26
ԼԿ
პᓳ 42
ᇷಛ 60
Լ
ኙֺ৫ 34
ጸۥ 44
48 ߢ
Լն
ᐙቝՕ՛ 38
ᑑᄷಛᇆᑓڤ। 76
ԼԮ
ᛀփ୲ढ 17֧
֧ 99
ᜤ Samsung ড়֪ࣚ೭խ֨ছؘႊ٣ၞ۩ऱ
ࠃႈ 66
ᜤ٤ SAMSUNG 89
ԼԶ
45 ۥ៴
ԲԼԿ
᧩قழၴ 50
用户手册
SyncMaster
S19C200NY S19C200N
S19C200NW S19C200BW
S19C200BR S19C200NR
S20C200B S22C200NY
S22C200N S22C200B
S22C200BW S23C200B
S24C200BL
颜色和外观可能根据产品的不同而有所变化。日后将出
于提高性能之目的更改规格,恕不另行通知。
BN46-00293A-03Ⳃᔩ 2
Ⳃᔩ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ 7 ⠜ᴗ
7 ᴀݠՓ⫼ⱘᷛ
7 ᅝܼ乘䰆ᮑⱘヺো
8 ⏙⋕
8 ⏙⋕
9 ⹂ֱᅝܼⱘᅝ㺙ぎ䯈
9 ᄬᬒ乘䰆ᮑ
10 ᅝܼ⊼ᛣџ乍
10 ⬉⇨ᅝܼ
11 ᅝ㺙
13 ᪡
16 Փ⫼ᴀѻકⱘℷ⹂࿓
ޚ 17 Ẕᶹࣙ㺙ݙ⠽ક
17 ᢚ䰸ࣙ㺙
18 Ẕᶹ䳊䚼ӊ
19 䳊ӊ
19 ℷ䴶ᣝ䪂
21 㚠䴶
22 ᅝ㺙
22 ᅝ㺙ᬃᶊ
23 䇗ᭈѻકؒ᭰ᑺ
24 ᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊ
25 䰆ⲫ䫕
䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒 26 䖲ࠡ
26 䖲ࠡẔᶹ⚍
26 䖲⬉⑤Ⳃᔩ
Ⳃᔩ 3
27 䖲ᑊՓ⫼ PC
27 䖲ࠄ PC
28 ᅝ㺙偅ࡼᑣ
29 䆒㕂᳔Շߚ䕼⥛
30 Փ⫼ PC ᬍߚ䕼⥛
ሣᐩ䆒㕂 33 ҂ᑺ
33 䜡㕂 ҂ᑺ
34 ᇍ↨ᑺ
34 䜡㕂ᇍᇍ↨ᑺ
35 ⏙᱄ᑺ
35 䜡㕂⏙⏙᱄ᑺ
36 ♉Ꮋᓣ
36 䜡㕂 ♉Ꮋᓣ
37 ♉ࡼ㾚㾦
37 䜡㕂 ♉ࡼ㾚㾦
38 ᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
38 ᬍᆑᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
40 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂
40 䜡㕂 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂
41 ㉫䇗
41 䇗ᭈ㉫㉫䇗
42 ᖂ䇗
42 䇗ᭈᖂᖂ䇗
䜡㕂㡆䇗 43 㑶
43 䜡㕂㑶㑶Ⳃᔩ
Ⳃᔩ 4
44 㓓
44 䜡㕂㓓㓓
45 㪱
45 䜡㕂㪱㪱
46 㡆⏽
46 䜡㕂㡆㡆⏽䆒㕂
47 ԑ偀
47 䜡㕂ԑԑ偀
ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ 48 䇁㿔
48 ᬍ䇁䇁㿔
49 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂
49 䜡㕂 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂
50 ᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈
50 䜡㕂ᰒᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈
51 䗣ᯢᑺ
51 ᬍ䗣䗣ᯢᑺ
䆒㕂䞡㕂 52 ԡ
52 ߱ྟ࣪䆒㕂 ˄ԡ˅
53 ♉ᚴ㡖㛑
53 䜡㕂 ♉ᚴ㡖㛑
54 ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼
54 䜡㕂 ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼
55 ҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁
55 䜡㕂 ҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁Ⳃᔩ
Ⳃᔩ 5
56 PC/AV ᓣ
56 䜡㕂 PC/AV ᓣ
57 ᣝ䬂䞡᭄
57 䜡㕂ᣝᣝ䬂䞡᭄
58 ⑤Ẕ⌟
58 䜡㕂 ⑤Ẕ⌟
59 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂
59 䜡㕂 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂
ֵᙃ㦰ऩঞ݊Ҫ 60 ֵᙃ
60 ᰒ⼎ֵֵᙃ
61 ߱ྟሣᐩ䜡㕂 ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ
ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ 62 Magic Tune
62 ҔМᰃ MagicTune˛
62 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
62 ߴ䰸䕃ӊ
64 MultiScreen
64 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
65 ߴ䰸䕃ӊ
ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ 66 㘨㋏ϝ᯳ᅶ᳡Ёᖗࠡⱘ㽕∖
66 Ẕ⌟ѻક
66 Ẕᶹߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛
66 Ẕᶹҹϟ乍DŽ
68 䯂ㄨ
㾘Ḑ 69 ᴀ㾘ḐⳂᔩ
Ⳃᔩ 6
74 㡖㛑ᓣ
76 ᷛޚֵোᓣ㸼
89 ROHS
䰘ᔩ 90 ϝ᯳ܼ⧗᳡ࡵ㔥
96 ᳝ٓ᳡ࡵᚙᔶ ˄⍜䌍㗙Ҭ䌍˅
96 䴲ѻક㔎䱋
96 ⬅Ѣᅶ᠋༅䇃ᇐ㟈ⱘѻકᤳണ
96 ݊Ҫ
97 ᴃ䇁Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ 7
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⠜ᴗ
Ўᦤ催䋼䞣ˈᴀݠⱘݙᆍབ᳝ᬍˈᘩϡ㸠䗮ⶹDŽ
© 2012 Samsung Electronics
Samsung Electronics ᢹ᳝ᴀݠⱘ⠜ᴗDŽ
㒣 Samsung Electronics ⱘᥜᴗˈ⽕ℶᇍᴀݠⱘ䚼ߚᅠᭈݙᆍ䖯㸠Փ⫼ࠊDŽ
SAMSUNG SyncMaster ᖑᷛᰃ Samsung Electronics ⱘ⊼ݠଚᷛDŽ
Microsoftǃ Windows Windows NT ᰃ Microsoft Corporation ⱘ⊼ݠଚᷛDŽ
VESAǃ DPM DDC ᰃ Video Electronics Standards Association ⱘ⊼ݠଚᷛDŽ
ᴀݠՓ⫼ⱘᷛ
ᅝܼ乘䰆ᮑⱘヺো
ҹϟڣҙկখ㗗DŽᅲ䰙ᚙމৃ㛑Ϣڣ᠔⼎᳝᠔ϡৠDŽ
䄺ਞ
བᵰϡ䙉ᅜᣛ⼎ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈Ϲ䞡㟈ੑӸᆇDŽ
⊼ᛣ
བᵰϡ䙉ᅜᣛ⼎ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈Ҏ䑿Ӹᆇ䋶ѻᤳ༅DŽ
⽕ℶᷛ䆄᳝ℸヺোⱘ⌏ࡼDŽ
ᖙ乏䙉ᕾᷛ䆄᳝ℸヺোⱘᣛ⼎DŽ
&&&ড়Ḑໄᯢ
ᱝ产ຠᩮᬃ)$)$
)$标准获ᓧ%%%认证8
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⏙⋕
⏙⋕
⏙⋕ᯊ䇋ࡵᖙᇣᖗˈЎ催㑻 LCD ⱘ䴶ᵓ㸼䴶ᕜᆍᯧߦࠂDŽ
⏙⋕ᯊ䇋ᠻ㸠ҹϟℹ偸DŽ
1. ݇䯁ᰒ⼎఼䅵ㅫᴎⱘ⬉⑤DŽ
2. ᢨϟᰒ⼎఼ⱘ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
ᡧԣ⬉⑤ᦦ༈ᴹᦦᢨ⬉⑤㒓ˈ䇋࣓⫼㾺ᩌ⬉⑤㒓DŽ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ
㟈㾺⬉DŽ
3. 䇋⫼ᶨ䕃ᑆޔⱘᑆᏗ᪺ᣁᰒ⼎఼ሣᐩDŽ
z 䇋࣓ᇚ䜦㊒ǃ⒊ࠖ㸼䴶⌏ᗻࠖⱘ⏙⋕ࠖࠄᰒ⼎఼
ϞDŽ
z 䇋࣓ᇚ∈⏙⋕ࠖⳈࠄᴀѻકϞDŽ
4. ᇚᶨ䕃ⱘᑆᏗ⍌∈ˈ✊ৢᅠܼᢻᑆˈ⏙⋕ᰒ⼎఼㸼䴶DŽ
5. ⏙⋕ᴀѻકৢˈᇚ⬉⑤㒓䖲ࠄᴀѻકDŽ
6. ᠧᓔᰒ⼎఼䅵ㅫᴎⱘ⬉⑤DŽ
!
!9
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⹂ֱᅝܼⱘᅝ㺙ぎ䯈
z 䇋⹂ֱѻક਼ೈ⬭᳝䎇ⱘ䗮亢ぎ䯈DŽݙ䚼⏽ᑺϞछৃ㛑ᓩ䍋☿♒ᑊᤳണѻકDŽᅝ㺙ѻકᯊˈ
䇋⹂ֱѻક਼ೈ㟇ᇥ⬭᳝བϟ᠔⼎ⱘぎ䯈DŽ
ѻકⱘ㾖ৃ㛑ԧѻક㗠ᓖDŽ
ᄬᬒ乘䰆ᮑ
བᵰ䳔㽕⏙⋕ᰒ⼎఼ݙ䚼ˈ䇋ࡵᖙϢ Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ˄ᇚᬊপ᳡ࡵ䌍DŽ˅
10 cm
10 cm 10 cm
10 cm
10 cm10
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
ᅝܼ⊼ᛣџ乍
⬉⇨ᅝܼ
ҹϟڣҙկখ㗗DŽᅲ䰙ᚙމৃ㛑Ϣڣ᠔⼎᳝᠔ϡৠDŽ
䄺ਞ
䇋࣓Փ⫼⸈ᤳⱘ⬉⑤㒓⬉⑤ᦦ༈ˈᵒࡼⱘ⬉⑤ᦦᑻDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚϾѻકⱘ⬉⑤ᦦ༈ᦦܹৠϔϾ⬉⑤ᦦᑻDŽ
z ৺߭ˈᦦᑻৃ㛑Ӯ䖛⛁ᑊᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓⫼ᦦᢨ⬉⑤ᦦ༈DŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉DŽ
䇋ᦦ㋻⬉⑤ᦦ༈DŽ
z ϡ〇ⱘ䖲ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
ᇚ⬉⑤ᦦ༈䖲ࠄഄⱘ⬉⑤ᦦᑻ ˄ҙ䰤 1 㑻㒱㓬㺙㕂˅DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
䇋࣓ᔎ㸠ᔃᡬᢝᡃ⬉⑤㒓ˈгϡ㽕ᇚ䞡⠽य़݊ϞDŽ
z ⬉⑤㒓ᤳണৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ⬉⑤㒓ѻકᬒ⛁⑤䰘䖥DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋⫼ᑆᏗ᪺ᣁ⬉⑤㒓ᦦ㛮⬉⑤ᦦᑻ਼ೈⱘ♄ᇬㄝᓖ⠽DŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
!
!
!11
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⊼ᛣ
ᅝ㺙
䄺ਞ
ѻકՓ⫼Ёᯊ䇋࣓ᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯ⬅Ѣ⬉ߏ㗠ᤳണDŽ
䇋࣓Փ⫼ Samsung ᦤկⱘᥜᴗѻકҹⱘѻક⬉⑤㒓DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓䅽⠽ԧᣵԣ䖲⬉⑤㒓ⱘ⬉⑤ᦦᑻDŽ
z བᵰᴀѻકߎ⦄ӏԩ䯂乬ˈ䇋ᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓ˈҹᕏᑩߛᮁᴀѻકⱘ⬉⑤DŽ
Փ⫼⬉⑤ᣝ䪂ϡ㛑ᕏᑩߛᮁᴀѻકⱘ⬉⑤DŽ
Ң⬉⑤ᦦᑻϞᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓ᯊˈ䇋ᡧԣ⬉⑤ᦦ༈DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ㳵⚯ǃ㱞佭佭⚳ᬒᴀѻકϞˈгϡৃ⛁⑤䰘䖥ᅝ㺙ᴀѻકDŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋䙓ܡᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙кᶰຕ⁅ㄝ䗮亢ϡ㡃ⱘ⣁ᇣഄᮍDŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑ӮЎݙ䚼⏽ᑺछ催㗠ᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋ᇚᴀѻકⱘล᭭ࣙ㺙㹟㕂Ѣܓス᮴⊩㾺ঞП໘DŽ
z བᵰܓス⥽㗡ࣙ㺙㹟ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈てᙃDŽ
䇋࣓ᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙ϡ〇ᆍᯧ䳛ࡼⱘ㸼䴶 ˄ᨛᰗⱘᶊᄤǃؒ᭰ⱘ㸼䴶
ㄝ˅DŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ঞᮁ㺖ˈ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
z བᵰᆍᯧ䳛ࡼⱘഄᮍՓ⫼ᴀѻકˈৃ㛑Ӯᤳണᴀѻકᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
!
!
!
!12
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⊼ᛣ
䇋࣓ᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙䔺䕚Ϟ᳝♄ᇬǃ⇨ ˄∈Ⓢㄝ˅ǃ⊍⚳ⱘഄᮍDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚᴀѻકᲈ䴆Ѣ䰇ܝⳈᇘǃ⛁⑤♝☿ㄝࡴ⛁఼ЁDŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯ㓽ⷁᴀѻકՓ⫼ᇓੑᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋ᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙ܓス㾺ᩌϡࠄⱘഄᮍDŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯᥝ㨑ˈ㗠䗴៤ܓスҎ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
亳⫼⊍ ˄՟བ䈚⊍˅ৃ㛑ӮᤳണᴀѻકՓ݊বᔶDŽ䇋࣓ॼ᠓ݙॼ᠓♊
ৄ䰘䖥ᅝ㺙ᴀѻકDŽ
ᨀ⿏ᴀѻકᯊᇣᖗϡ㽕Փᴀѻકഴ㨑DŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
䇋࣓ᇚᴀѻક䴶ᳱϟᬒ㕂DŽ
z ৃ㛑ӮᤳണሣᐩDŽ
ᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙ᶰᄤᶊᄤϞᯊˈ䇋⹂ֱᴀѻકⱘࠡ䚼ᑩ䖍≵᳝さߎᶰᄤᶊ
ᄤDŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ঞᮁ㺖ˈ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
z ҙᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙ሎᇌ䗖ড়ⱘᶰᄤᶊᄤϞDŽ
䇋䕏䕏ᬒϟᴀѻકDŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ঞᮁ㺖ˈ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
བᵰᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙⡍⅞എ᠔ ˄ᇬǃ᳝࣪ᄺ⠽䋼ǃ催⏽ⱘഎ᠔ᴀѻક
ᑨ䭓ᳳϡ䯈ᮁ䖤㸠ⱘᴎഎ☿䔺キ˅ˈৃ㛑ӮϹ䞡ᕅડ݊ᗻ㛑DŽ
z བᵰ㽕ᇚᴀѻકᅝ㺙ℸ㉏എ᠔ˈ䇋ࡵᖙ䆶 Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ
˄90˅DŽ
!
!
!
SAMSUNG
!!13
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
᪡
䄺ਞ
ᴀѻકݙ䚼᳝催य़DŽ࣓ߛᇱ䆩㞾㸠ᢚौǃ㓈ׂᬍ㺙ᴀѻકDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
z 㽕䖯㸠㓈ׂˈ䇋Ϣ Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ
z ৺߭ˈ⬉⑤㒓ৃ㛑Ӯᤳണˈᑊৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈䍋☿㾺⬉DŽ
བᵰᴀѻકথߎᓖᐌໄડǃᬷথ⛺ੇݦ⚳ˈ䇋ゟेᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓ˈᑊϢ
Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓䅽ܓスᣖᴀѻકϟᮍˈ㗙⠀ࠄᴀѻકϞDŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ˈ㗠ᇐ㟈ܓスফӸ⫮䞡ӸDŽ
བᵰᴀѻકഴ㨑ᤳണˈ䇋݇䯁ᴀѻક⬉⑤ˈᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓ˈ✊ৢϢ
Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ䞡⠽ǃ⥽㊪ᵰᬒ㕂ᴀѻકϞDŽ
z ܓス䆩ᣓࠄ䖭ѯ⥽㊪ᵰᯊˈᴀѻક䞡⠽ৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ˈ㗠ᇐ㟈ܓス
ফࠄ䞡ӸDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᴀѻકϞᠨᬒ⠽કᩲߏᴀѻકDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓䗮䖛ᢝ⬉⑤㒓ӏԩ㓚㒓ᴹ⿏ࡼᴀѻકDŽ
z ৺߭ˈ⬉⑤㒓ৃ㛑Ӯᤳണˈᑊৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰ǃ㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
!
!
!
!
如果出现打雷或闪电,请关闭产品电源并请拔下电源线。
SAMSUNG
!
在搬移本产品之前,请先关闭电源开关,并拔下电源线及所有其他连接的缆
线。14
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
⊼ᛣ
བᵰথ⦄⇨ԧ⊘ⓣˈ䇋࣓㾺ᩌᴀѻક⬉⑤ᦦ༈DŽℸˈ䇋ゟे䅽䆹ऎඳ䗮
亢DŽ
z ☿㢅ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈⟚⚌䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓䗮䖛ᢝ⬉⑤㒓ӏԩ㓚㒓ᴹᦤ䍋⿏ࡼᴀѻકDŽ
z ৺߭ˈ⬉⑤㒓ৃ㛑Ӯᤳണˈᑊৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰ǃ㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᴀѻક䰘䖥Փ⫼ᬒ㕂ᯧ➗ࠖᯧ➗⠽કDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈⟚⚌䍋☿DŽ
⹂ֱ䗮亢ᄨ㹿ḠᏗにᏬ䰏าDŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯݙ䚼⏽ᑺछ催㗠ᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ䞥ሲ⠽ԧ ˄ㅋᄤǃ⹀Ꮥǃথ།ㄝ˅ᯧ➗⠽ԧ ˄㒌ǃ☿᷈ㄝ˅ᦦܹᴀѻ
કⱘ䗮亢ᄨッষЁDŽ
z བᵰᴀѻક䖯∈᳝ӏԩᓖ⠽ᥝܹˈ䇋⹂ֱ݇䯁ᴀѻક⬉⑤ˈᢨϟ⬉⑤
㒓ˈ✊ৢϢ Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰ǃ㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ᳝⎆ԧⱘ⠽ԧ ˄㢅⫊ǃ㔤ǃ⫊ᄤㄝ˅䞥ሲ⠽ԧᬒ㕂ᴀѻકϞDŽ
z བᵰᴀѻક䖯∈᳝ӏԩᓖ⠽ᥝܹˈ䇋⹂ֱ݇䯁ᴀѻક⬉⑤ˈᢨϟ⬉⑤
㒓ˈ✊ৢϢ Samsung ᅶ᠋᳡ࡵЁᖗ㘨㋏ ˄90˅DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰ǃ㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
བᵰᰒ⼎఼䭓ᯊ䯈ᰒ⼎䴭ᗕᕅڣˈ߭ৃ㛑ᇐ㟈⅟ᕅ᳝㔎䱋ڣ㋴DŽ
z བᵰ䭓ᯊ䯈ϡՓ⫼ᴀѻકˈ䇋▔⌏㡖⬉ᓣࡼᗕڣሣᐩֱᡸᑣDŽ
བᵰᠧㅫ䭓ᯊ䯈ϡՓ⫼ᴀѻક ˄ӥ؛ㄝ˅ˈ䇋Ң⬉⑤ᦦᑻϞᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
z ৺߭ˈৃ㛑Ӯ⿃ᇬǃ䖛⛁ǃ⬉ߏⓣ⬉㗠ᇐ㟈䍋☿DŽ
䇋ᣝ✻ᓎ䆂ⱘߚ䕼⥛乥⥛Փ⫼ᴀѻકDŽ
!
GAS
!
100
!
-_-
!
!
否则,您的视力可能受损。15
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
䭓ᯊ䯈䖥䎱⾏ഄ㾖ⳟሣᐩৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾚ফᤳDŽ
䇋࣓ҙᦵԣᬃᶊ㗏䕀ᨀ⿏ᰒ⼎఼DŽ
z ᴀѻકৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ঞᮁ㺖ˈ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
䇋࣓ᴀѻક਼ೈՓ⫼ࡴ఼♝DŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈㾺⬉䍋☿DŽ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકᯊˈ䇋↣ᇣᯊ䅽ⴐӥᙃ 5 ߚ䩳ҹϞDŽ
z ৃҹޣ䕏ⴐ⮆ࢇDŽ
䭓ᯊ䯈Փ⫼ᴀѻકᯊˈᰒ⼎ሣӮব⛁ˈ䇋࣓㾺ᩌᰒ⼎ሣDŽ
䇋ᇚϢᴀѻક䜡ড়Փ⫼ⱘᇣ䰘ӊᬒܓス㾺ᩌϡࠄⱘഄᮍDŽ
䇗ᭈᴀѻક㾦ᑺᬃᶊ催ᑺᯊࡵᖙᇣᖗDŽ
z ৺߭ˈܓスⱘᣛৃ㛑Ӯ㹿वԣঞফӸDŽ
z བᵰᴀѻક䖛ᑺؒ᭰ˈৃ㛑Ӯഴ㨑ˈ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
䇋࣓ᇚ䞡⠽ᬒᴀѻકϞDŽ
z ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᬙ䱰Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽ
!
!
!
!16
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકࠡ
Փ⫼ᴀѻકⱘℷ⹂࿓
Փ⫼ᴀѻકᯊˈ䇋ֱᣕབϟ᠔䗄ⱘℷ⹂࿓DŽ
z 㚠䚼ᤎⳈDŽ
z ⴐϢሣᐩП䯈ⱘ䎱⾏ 45 ࠄ 50 ६㉇П䯈ˈ㾖ⳟሣᐩⱘ㾚㒓⬹ᖂϟDŽ
ⴐ䬰㽕Ⳉ㾚ሣᐩDŽ
z 䇗ᭈ㾦ᑺˈՓሣᐩϡӮথ⫳ডܝDŽ
z Փࠡ㞖ϢϞ㞖ൖⳈˈϨϢ㚠ֱᣕৠϔ∈ᑇDŽ
z 㙬䚼ਜⳈ㾦DŽ
z 䇗ᭈᴀѻકⱘ催ᑺˈՓ㝱䚼ᔃ᳆ 90 ᑺҹϞˈ㛮䎳ᑇᬒഄ䴶Ϟˈᑊֱᣕ㞖ԢѢ
ᖗ㛣ԡ㕂DŽ1 ޚ 17
ޚ 1
1.1 Ẕᶹࣙ㺙ݙ⠽ક
1.1.1 ᢚ䰸ࣙ㺙
1 ᠧᓔࣙ㺙ㆅDŽՓ⫼䫟߽Ꮉᠧᓔࣙ㺙ᯊˈᇣᖗϡ㽕ᤳണᴀѻકDŽ
2 এ䰸ᴀѻકⱘ⊵≿ล᭭DŽ
3 Ẕᶹ䳊䚼ӊˈপϟ⊵≿ล᭭㹟DŽ
⠛ҙկখ㗗DŽ
4 䇋ᇚࣙ㺙Ⲧᄬᬒᑆ➹ऎඳˈҹ֓ᇚᴹ⫼Ѣ⿏ࡼᴀѻકDŽ18
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.1.2 Ẕᶹ䳊䚼ӊ
z བᵰ㔎ᇥӏԩ⠽ӊˈ䇋Ϣᙼ݊䌁фᴀѻકⱘ㒣䫔ଚ㘨㋏DŽ
z 䳊䚼ӊऩ⣀ߎଂ⠽કⱘ㾖ˈৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽ
䳊䚼ӊ
ϡৠԡ㕂ⱘ䳊䚼ӊৃ㛑⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽ
ᖿ䗳ᅝ㺙ᣛफ ֱׂव ˄䚼ߚഄऎᦤկ˅ ⫼᠋ݠ
⬉⑤㒓 D-Sub 㓚㒓 (ৃ䗝) DVI 㓚㒓 ˄ৃ䗝˅
ᬃᶊ ᬃᶊ䖲఼19
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.2 䳊ӊ
1.2.1 ℷ䴶ᣝ䪂
䚼ӊⱘ买㡆ᔶ⢊ৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮
ⶹDŽ
ᷛ 䇈ᯢ
z ᠧᓔ݇䯁ሣᐩ㾚㋏㒳 (OSD) 㦰ऩˈ䖨ಲϞϔϾ㦰ऩDŽ
z OSD ࠊ䫕ᅮ:ֱᣕᔧࠡ䆒㕂ˈ䫕ᅮ OSD ࠊҹ䰆ℶᛣᬍ䆒
㕂DŽਃ⫼˖㽕䫕ᅮ OSD ࠊˈ䇋ᣝԣ [ ] ᣝ䪂 10 ⾦䩳DŽ⽕⫼˖
㽕ᇚ䫕ᅮⱘ OSD ࠊ㾷䫕ˈ䇋ᣝԣ [ ] ᣝ䪂 10 ⾦䩳ҹϞDŽ
བᵰ OSD ࠊ㹿䫕ᅮˈ
z ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ ৃҹ䇗㡖ˈᑊϨ ֵᙃ гৃҹᶹⳟDŽ
z ᣝϟ [ ] ᣝ䪂ৃՓ⫼ 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂 ࡳ㛑DŽ (㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂 ेՓ
OSD ࠊ㹿䫕ᅮᯊгৃ⫼˅
䜡㕂 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂 ᑊᣝϟ [ ]DŽҹϟ䗝乍ᇚ㹿▔⌏˖
♉ࡼ㾚㾦 - ♉Ꮋᓣ - ♉ᚴ㡖㛑 - ᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
㽕䜡㕂 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂ˈ䇋䖯ܹ 䆒㕂䞡㕂 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂ˈ✊ৢ䗝
ᢽᙼ䳔㽕ⱘᓣDŽ
⿏ࠄϞᮍϟᮍ㦰ऩˈ䇗ᭈ OSD 㦰ऩϞⱘ䗝乍ؐDŽ
Փ⫼ℸᣝ䪂ৃࠊሣᐩ҂ᑺᇍ↨ᑺDŽ
按键导引
SAMSUNG
MAGIC
ANGLE
AUTO
MENU
MENU
MENU
→ 20
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
⹂䅸㦰ऩ䗝ᢽDŽ
བᵰᰒ⼎ OSD 㦰ऩᯊᣝ [ ] ᣝ䪂ˈ߭Ӯᬍ䕧ֵܹো⑤ ˄
ᢳ/DVI˅DŽབᵰᠧᓔᴀѻકⱘ⬉⑤䗮䖛ᣝ [ ] ᣝ䪂ᬍ䕧ֵܹো
⑤ˈሣᐩᎺϞ㾦ᇚӮߎ⦄ϔ߭⍜ᙃˈᰒ⼎Ꮖᬍⱘ䕧ֵܹো⑤DŽ
ҙᢳষⱘѻક᮴ℸࡳ㛑DŽ
ᣝϟ [ ] ᣝ䪂ৃ㞾ࡼ䇗㡖ሣᐩ䆒㕂DŽ
z Āᰒ⼎ሲᗻāЁᬍߚ䕼⥛Ӯ▔⌏ 㞾ࡼ䇗ᭈ ࡳ㛑DŽ
z ℸࡳ㛑ҙᢳᓣЁৃ⫼DŽDŽ
ᠧᓔ݇䯁ሣᐩDŽ
ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩ
ᣝϟѻકϞⱘࠊᣝ䪂ৢˈᇚӮሣᐩ㦰ऩᠧᓔПࠡᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ
˄䆹ᣛफᰒ⼎ᣝ䪂ⱘࡳ㛑DŽ˅
㽕ᣛफᰒ⼎ৢ䆓䯂ሣᐩ㦰ऩˈ䇋ݡᣝⳌᑨⱘᣝ䪂DŽ
ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩৃ㛑ḍࡳ㛑ѻકൟো㗠᳝᠔ϡৠDŽ䇋খ㾕ᅲ䰙ѻકDŽ
ᷛ 䇈ᯢ
AUTO
AUTO21
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.2.2 㚠䴶
䚼ӊⱘ买㡆ᔶ⢊ৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮
ⶹDŽ
ッষ ッষ
ᇚᰒ⼎఼ⱘ⬉⑤㒓䖲㟇ᴀѻક㚠䴶ⱘ POWER IN ッষDŽ
Փ⫼ DVI 㓚㒓䖲ࠄ PCDŽ
[DVI IN] ッᄤҙЎ᭄ᄫ (DVI) ϧ⫼ൟোᦤկDŽ
Փ⫼ D-SUB 㓚㒓䖲ࠄ PCDŽ
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN22
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.3 ᅝ㺙
1.3.1 ᅝ㺙ᬃᶊ
㺙䜡ѻકПࠡˈᇚѻકሣᐩ䴶ᳱϟᬒ∈ᑇ〇ⱘ㸼䴶ϞDŽ
䚼ӊⱘ买㡆ᔶ⢊ৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮
ⶹDŽ
ᣝ✻བ᠔⼎ⱘᮍˈᇚᬃᶊᬃ
ᴚᦦܹᬃᶊDŽ
Ẕᶹᬃᶊᬃᴚᰃ৺䖲⠶DŽ ᢻ㋻ᬃᶊᑩ䚼ⱘ䖲㶎䩝ˈᇚᬃ
ᴚ⠶ᅮDŽ
Ḡ䴶Ϟᬒϔഫ䕃Ꮧൿⴔҹֱᡸ
ѻકˈᇚѻકℷ䴶ᳱϟᬒ䕃Ꮧ
ϞDŽ
བ᠔⼎ˈ⫼ᦵԣѻકⱘЏᴎ
䑿DŽ
ᣝ✻Ёㆁ༈᠔⼎ᮍᇚ㺙䜡ད
ⱘᬃᶊܹࠄЏᴎ䑿ЁDŽ
- ⊼ᛣ
䇋࣓ҙᦵԣᬃᶊᴹ㗏䕀ѻકDŽ23
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.3.2 䇗ᭈѻકؒ᭰ᑺ
䚼ӊⱘ买㡆ᔶ⢊ৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮
ⶹDŽ
z ᙼৃҹ䇗ᭈᰒ⼎఼ⱘؒ᭰ᑺDŽ
z ᠬԣѻકᑩ䚼ˈᇣᖗ䇗ᭈؒ᭰㾦ᑺDŽ
-1° (±2°) ~ 20° (±2°)24
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
1.3.3 ᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊ
ᅝ㺙Пࠡ
݇䯁ѻક⬉⑤ˈᑊҢᦦᑻϞᢨϟ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
ᇍ唤ߍῑˈ✊ৢᇚᙼᛇᅝ㺙ⱘຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊⱘⳌᑨ䚼ߚϢѻકᬃᶊϞⱘ㶎䩝ᢻ㋻DŽ
ᑇഺⱘ㸼䴶ᬒ㕂䍋ֱᡸ⫼ⱘᏗൿᄤDŽ✊
ৢˈᇚѻકℷ䴶ᳱϟᬒᏗൿᄤϞDŽ
བ᠔⼎ˈ⫼ᦵԣѻકⱘЏᴎ䑿DŽ
ᣝ✻Ёㆁ༈᠔⼎ᮍᢝࡼᬃᶊˈՓᬃᶊ㜅⾏ᴎ
䑿DŽ
ᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊ
ᇚຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊᅝ㺙ℸ໘
ᬃᶊ ˄ऩ⣀ߎଂ˅
1
A
2
3
B
4
A
B25
ޚ 1
ޚ 1
⊼
z Փ⫼↨ᷛޚ䭓ᑺ䭓ⱘ㶎䩝Ӯᤳണѻકⱘݙ䚼䚼ӊDŽ
z ϡヺড়㾚乥⬉ᄤᷛޚणӮ (VESA) ᷛޚⱘຕᣖᬃᶊ᠔䳔ⱘ㶎䩝䭓ᑺӮ㾘Ḑ㗠ᓖDŽ
z 䇋࣓Փ⫼ϡヺড় VESA ᷛޚⱘ㶎䩝DŽᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃᶊᯊϡৃ䖛ᑺ⫼DŽ䖭ৃ㛑
ᇐ㟈ѻકᤳണ䎠㨑ˈᑊ䗴៤Ҏ䑿ӸᆇDŽᇍѢՓ⫼ϡ䗖ᔧⱘ㶎䩝ᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊḠ䴶ᬃ
ᶊᯊ䖛ᑺ⫼᠔ᇐ㟈ⱘᤳണӸᆇˈϝ᯳ϡᡓᢙӏԩ䋷ӏDŽ
z Փ⫼䴲ᣛᅮ㾘Ḑⱘຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊ㞾㸠ᇱ䆩ᅝ㺙ຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊ᠔ᇐ㟈ⱘѻકᤳണҎ䑿Ӹᆇˈϝ
᯳ϡᡓᢙӏԩ䋷ӏDŽ
z ᇚѻકᅝ㺙ࠄຕᣖᬃᶊϞᯊˈ䇋⹂ֱᙼ䌁фⱘຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊ㛑ՓѻકϢຕֱᣕ 10cm 䖰ⱘ
䎱⾏DŽ
z 䇋⹂ֱՓ⫼ヺড়ᷛޚⱘຕᣖᬃᶊ༫ӊDŽ
1.3.4 䰆ⲫ䫕
᳝њ䰆ⲫ䫕ˈህৃҹ݀݅എ᠔ᅝܼഄՓ⫼ᴀѻકDŽ䫕ᅮ䆒ⱘᔶ⢊䫕ᅮᮍ⊩Ӯ⫳ѻଚⱘϡৠ㗠
᳝᠔ᏂᓖDŽ䆺㒚ֵᙃ䇋খ䯙䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂䱣䰘ⱘ⫼᠋ᣛफDŽ䫕ᅮ㺙㕂ऩ⣀ߎଂDŽ
䚼ӊⱘ买㡆ᔶ⢊ৃ㛑ϢЁ᠔⼎⬹᳝ᏂᓖDŽѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮
ⶹDŽ
㽕䫕ᅮ䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂˖
1 ᇚ䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂ⱘ㓚㒓ᅮ䞡⠽ˈ՟བࡲ݀ḠϞDŽ
2 ᇚ㓚㒓ⱘϔッこ䖛ϔッⱘ⦃ЁDŽ
3 ᇚ䫕ᅮ㺙㕂ᦦܹᴀѻક㚠䴶ⱘ䰆ⲫ䫕ᄨЁDŽ
4 䫕ᅮ㺙㕂DŽ
z 䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂ৃऩ⣀䌁фDŽ
z 䆺㒚ֵᙃ䇋খ䯙䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂䱣䰘ⱘ⫼᠋ᣛफDŽ
z 䰆ⲫ䫕㺙㕂ৃ⬉ᄤѻક䳊ଂᑫ㔥Ϟ䌁фDŽ
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒 26
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2.1 䖲ࠡ
2.1.1 䖲ࠡẔᶹ⚍
z 䖲ֵো⑤㺙㕂Пࠡˈ䇋䯙䇏䆒䱣䰘ⱘ⫼᠋ݠDŽ
ϡৠֵো⑤㺙㕂ⱘッষ᭄䞣ԡ㕂ৃ㛑ϡৠDŽ
z ᠔᳝䖲㒓䖲ᅠ↩ৢˈᮍৃ䖲⬉⑤㒓DŽ
䖲㒓ᳳ䯈䖲⬉⑤㒓ৃ㛑Ӯᇐ㟈ѻકᤳണDŽ
z ᶹⳟ㽕䖲ࠄѻક㚠䴶ⱘッষ㉏ൟDŽ
2.2 䖲⬉⑤
z 㽕Փ⫼ᴀѻકˈ䇋ᇚ⬉⑤㒓䖲㟇⬉⑤ᦦᑻᴀѻકϞⱘ [POWER IN] ᦦষDŽ˄䕧ܹ⬉य़Ӯ㞾ࡼ
˅ᤶDŽߛ
DVI IN RGB IN POWER IN
POWER IN 27
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2.3 䖲ᑊՓ⫼ PC
2.3.1 䖲ࠄ PC
z 䇋䗝ᢽ䗖ড়ᙼ PC ⱘ䖲ᮍᓣDŽ
ϡৠѻકЁⱘ䖲ӊৃ㛑ϡৠDŽ
Փ⫼ D-SUB 㓚㒓䖲 ˄ᢳ㉏ൟ˅
䇋࣓䖲ད᠔᳝݊Ҫ㓚㒓ПࠡᦦϞ⬉⑤㒓DŽ佪ܜ⹂ֱᏆ䖲⑤䆒ˈ✊ৢݡᦦϞ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
1 Փ⫼ D-Sub 㓚㒓䖲ѻક㚠䴶ⱘ [RGB IN] ッষ PC ⱘ RGB ッষDŽ
2 ᣝ [ ]ˈᇚ䕧ֵܹো⑤ᬍЎ ᢳDŽ
ҙᢳষⱘѻક᮴ℸࡳ㛑DŽ
Փ⫼ DVI 㓚㒓䖲
䇋࣓䖲ད᠔᳝݊Ҫ㓚㒓ПࠡᦦϞ⬉⑤㒓DŽ佪ܜ⹂ֱᏆ䖲⑤䆒ˈ✊ৢݡᦦϞ⬉⑤㒓DŽ
1 Փ⫼ DVI 㓚㒓䖲ѻક㚠䴶ⱘ [DVI IN] ッষ PC ⱘ DVI ッষDŽ
2 ᣝ [ ]ˈᇚ䕧ֵܹো⑤ᬍЎ DVIDŽ
[DVI IN] ッᄤҙЎ᭄ᄫ (DVI) ϧ⫼ൟোᦤկDŽ
RGB IN
DVI IN28
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2.3.2 ᅝ㺙偅ࡼᑣ
z ᅝ㺙ᴀѻકⱘ偅ࡼᑣᯊˈৃЎᴀѻક䆒㕂᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛DŽ
z ᴀѻક䱣䰘ⱘܝⲬϞᄬ᳝ᅝ㺙偅ࡼᑣDŽ
z བᵰᦤկⱘ᭛ӊߎ⦄䫭䇃ˈ䇋䆓䯂 Samsung Џ义 (http://www.samsung.com) ᑊϟ䕑᭛ӊDŽ
1 ᇚѻક䱣䰘ⱘ⫼᠋ܝݠⲬᦦܹ CD-ROM 偅ࡼ఼DŽ
2 ऩߏ "Windows Driver"DŽ
3 ձ✻ሣᐩ䇈ᯢ䖯㸠ᅝ㺙DŽ
4 Ңൟো߫㸼Ё䗝ᢽᙼⱘѻકൟোDŽ
5 䕀ࠄ Āᰒ⼎ሲᗻāˈᶹⳟߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛ᰃ৺ড়䗖DŽ
ֵᙃ䇋খ䯙ᙼⱘ Windows ᪡㋏㒳ݠDŽ29
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2.3.3 䆒㕂᳔Շߚ䕼⥛
䌁фᴀѻકৢϔᠧᓔ⬉⑤ᯊˈሣᐩϞᇚӮߎ⦄᳝݇䆒㕂᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ⱘֵᙃᗻ⍜ᙃDŽ
ѻકϞ䗝ᢽϔ⾡䇁㿔ˈᇚ PC ߚ䕼⥛ᬍЎ᳔Շ䆒㕂DŽ
1 ᣝ [ ] ⿏ࠄ᠔䳔䗝乍ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
2 㽕䱤㮣䆹ֵᙃᗻ⍜ᙃˈ䇋ᣝ [ ]DŽ
z བᵰ䗝ᢽ᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ˈ߭ᣛᅮⱘᯊ䯈ݙℸ⍜ᙃ᳔Ӯߎ⦄ϝˈेՓ݇䯁ᴀѻક⬉⑤✊ৢݡ
ᠧᓔᯊгᰃབℸDŽ
z ᙼгৃҹ PC ⱘ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓāЁ䗝ᢽ᳔Շߚ䕼⥛DŽ
适用于此显示器的最佳分辨率如下:
**** x **** **Hz
使用以上设置可设定 PC 的分辨率。
汉语
EXIT AUTO
MENU30
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2.3.4 Փ⫼ PC ᬍߚ䕼⥛
z PC ⱘࠊ䴶ᵓЁ䇗ᭈߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛ˈҹ㦋প᳔Շ⬏䋼DŽ
z བᵰ䗝ᢽ᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ˈ߭ TFT-LCD ⱘ⬏䋼ৃ㛑ϟ䰡DŽ
ᬍ Windows XP ⱘߚ䕼⥛
䕀ࠄ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā Āᰒ⼎ā Ā䆒㕂āˈ✊ৢᬍߚ䕼⥛DŽ
1 2
331
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
ᬍ Windows Vista Ϟⱘߚ䕼⥛
䕀ࠄ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā ĀϾᗻ࣪ā Āᰒ⼎䆒㕂āˈ✊ৢᬍߚ䕼⥛DŽ
1 2
3 432
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
2 䖲Փ⫼㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒
ᬍ Windows 7 Ϟⱘߚ䕼⥛
䕀ࠄ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā Āᰒ⼎ā Āሣᐩߚ䕼⥛āˈ✊ৢᬍߚ䕼⥛DŽ
1 2
3 43 ሣᐩ䆒㕂 33
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
䜡㕂҂ᑺㄝሣᐩ䆒㕂DŽ
3.1 ҂ᑺ
䇗ᭈڣⱘᭈԧ҂ᑺDŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
ؐ䍞ˈڣ҂ᑺ䍞催DŽ
z ♉Ꮋᓣ 䆒㕂Ў ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
z ᔧ䆒㕂њ ♉ᚴ㡖㛑 ᯊℸ㦰ऩϡৃ⫼DŽ
3.1.1 䜡㕂 ҂ᑺ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ҂ᑺˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ҂ᑺDŽ
MENU
个人设定
关
自动
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
AUTO
34
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.2 ᇍ↨ᑺ
䇗ᭈᇍ䈵㚠᱃П䯈ⱘᇍ↨ᑺDŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
ؐ䍞ǃᇍ↨ᑺ䍞催ˈڣᰒ⼎䍞⏙᱄DŽ
♉Ꮋᓣ ໘Ѣ ࠻എ ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
3.2.1 䜡㕂ᇍ↨ᑺ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ᇍ↨ᑺˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈᇍ↨ᑺDŽ
MENU
个人设定
关
自动
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
AUTO
35
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.3 ⏙᱄ᑺ
Փڣⱘ䕂ᒧࡴ⏙᱄㊞DŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
ؐ䍞ˈڣⱘ䕂ᒧ䍞⏙᱄DŽ
♉Ꮋᓣ ໘Ѣ ࠻എ ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
3.3.1 䜡㕂⏙᱄ᑺ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ⏙᱄ᑺˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ⏙᱄ᑺDŽ
MENU
个人设定
关
自动
AUTO
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置36
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.4 ♉Ꮋᓣ
ℸ㦰ऩᦤկњ䗖⫼ѢՓ⫼ᴀѻકⱘ⦃๗ⱘ᳔Շڣ䋼䞣DŽ
z ᔧ䆒㕂њ ♉ᚴ㡖㛑 ᯊℸ㦰ऩϡৃ⫼DŽ
z ♉ࡼ㾚㾦໘Ѣਃ⫼⢊ᗕᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
ᙼৃҹḍϾҎ୰ད㞾ᅮН҂ᑺDŽ
3.4.1 䜡㕂 ♉Ꮋᓣ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ♉Ꮋᓣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ϾҎ䆒ᅮ˖ḍ䳔㽕㞾ᅮНᇍ↨ᑺ҂ᑺDŽ
z ᷛޚ˖㦋প䗖ড়㓪䕥᭛ḷՓ⫼ Ѧ㘨㔥ⱘڣ䋼䞣DŽ
z ␌៣˖㦋প䗖ড়⥽᳝䆌ᔶᬜᵰࡼᗕ䖤ࡼⱘ␌៣ⱘڣ䋼䞣DŽ
z ࠻എ˖㦋প䗖ড়䌣㾚乥 DVD ݙᆍⱘ⬉㾚҂ᑺϢ⏙᱄ᑺDŽ
z ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ˖䗮䖛㞾ࡼ䇗ᭈᇍ↨ᑺ㦋পᑇ㸵ⱘ҂ᑺDŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
个人设定
标准
游戏
剧场
动态对比度
AUTO
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置37
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.5 ♉ࡼ㾚㾦
♉ࡼ㾚㾦 ৃ䅽ᙼ䜡㕂䆒㕂ˈҹ֓ḍᙼⱘ㾚㾦㦋প᳔Շڣ䋼䞣DŽ
z ♉Ꮋᓣ ໘Ѣ ࠻എ ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
z ℸ㦰ऩϡ䗖⫼Ѣ S19C200NY S22C200NY ൟোDŽ
ᙼৃҹḍϾҎ୰ད㞾ᅮН㾦ᑺDŽ
3.5.1 䜡㕂 ♉ࡼ㾚㾦
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ♉ࡼ㾚㾦ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ݇ :䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃⳈҢℷ䴶㾖ⳟᴀѻકDŽ
z ৢؒᓣ 1 :䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃҢԢѢᴀѻકⱘԡ㕂㾖ⳟDŽ
z ৢؒᓣ 2 :䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃҢԢѢ Āৢؒᓣ 1 āᓣⱘԡ㕂㾖ⳟDŽ
z キゟᓣ :䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃҢ催Ѣᴀѻકⱘԡ㕂㾖ⳟDŽ
z ջ䖍ᓣ :䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃҢᴀѻકⱘӏϔջ㾖ⳟDŽ
z 㒘㾚˖䗝ᢽℸ䗝乍ৃ䅽Ͼ㾖ⳟ㗙Ңԡ㕂 ǃ 㾖ⳟDŽ
z ϾҎ䆒ᅮ˖བᵰᏆ䗝ᢽϾҎ䆒ᅮˈ߭咬䅸ᚙމϟӮᑨ⫼ৢؒᓣ 1DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
ࢽ࣏ࡈی
ࢿଥ
关
后倾模式 1
后倾模式 2
站立模式
侧边模式
组视图
个人设定
AUTO
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
4
2
3
1
1
5 5
①
②
③
④
⑤
① ④ ⑤38
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.6 ᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
ᬍڣሎᇌDŽ
3.6.1 ᬍᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄᆑ᱂ݐᆍˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z 㞾ࡼ˖ḍ䕧ֵܹো⑤ⱘ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣDŽ
z ᆑሣ˖᮴䆎䕧ֵܹো⑤ⱘ㒉῾↨བԩˈ䛑ҹܼሣᰒ⼎ڣDŽ
z 4:3˖ҹ 4:3 ⱘ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣDŽ䗖⫼Ѣ㾚乥ᷛޚᑓ᪁DŽ
z 16:9˖ҹ 16:9 ⱘ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣDŽ
z ܼሣᰒ⼎˖ҹॳྟ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣˈ㗠ϡ䖯㸠㺕࠾DŽ
z 4:3˖ҹ 4:3 ⱘ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣDŽ䗖⫼Ѣ㾚乥ᷛޚᑓ᪁DŽ
MENU
个人设定
关
自动
宽屏
AUTO
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
个人设定
关
AUTO
全屏显示
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
个人设定
关
AUTO
宽屏
全屏显示
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置39
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
z ᆑሣ˖᮴䆎䕧ֵܹো⑤ⱘ㒉῾↨བԩˈ䛑ҹܼሣᰒ⼎ڣDŽ (S19C200NW/S19C200BW/
S22C200BW)
z ܼሣᰒ⼎˖ҹॳྟ㒉῾↨ᰒ⼎ڣˈ㗠ϡ䖯㸠㺕࠾DŽ
⒵䎇ϟᴵӊᯊৃҹᬍሣᐩᇣ ˄S19C200NR S19C200BR ൟো䰸˅DŽ
z ᭄ᄫ䕧ߎ䆒Փ⫼ DVI 㓚㒓䖲DŽ
z 䕧ֵܹোЎ 480pǃ 576pǃ 720p 1080pˈϨᰒ⼎఼ৃҹℷᐌᰒ⼎ ˄ᑊ䴲↣Ͼൟো䛑ᬃᣕ
᠔᳝䖭ѯֵো˅
z ҙᔧ䚼䕧ܹ⑤䗮䖛 DVI ッᄤ䖲Ϩ PC/AV ᓣ 㹿䆒㕂Ў AV ᯊˈҹϞ㦰ऩᠡৃ㹿䆒㕂DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ40
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.7 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂
∈ᑇԡ㕂:ᇚሣᐩ⿏ࠄᎺջেջDŽ
ൖⳈԡ㕂:Ϟϟ⿏ࡼሣᐩDŽ
z ℸ㦰ऩ ᢳᓣϟৃ⫼DŽ
z ℸ㦰ऩҙᔧ ᆑ᱂ݐᆍ AV ᓣЁ䆒㕂Ў ܼሣᰒ⼎ ᯊৃ⫼DŽ AV ᓣЁ䕧ܹ 480Pǃ 576Pǃ
720P 1080P ֵোϨᰒ⼎఼ৃҹℷᐌᰒ⼎ᯊˈ䗝ᢽ ܼሣᰒ⼎ ৃᣝ 0-6 㑻䇗ᭈ∈ᑇԡ㕂DŽ
3.7.1 䜡㕂 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ҹ䜡㕂 ∈ᑇԡ㕂 ൖⳈԡ㕂DŽ
MENU
个人设定
关
自动
AUTO
图像
亮度
对比度
清晰度
灵巧模式
灵动视角
宽普兼容
水平位置
图像
垂直位置
粗调
微调
AUTO
41
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.8 ㉫䇗
䇗ᭈሣᐩ乥⥛DŽ
ҙᢳᓣϟৃ⫼DŽ
3.8.1 䇗ᭈ㉫䇗
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ㉫䇗ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ㉫䇗DŽ
MENU
图像
垂直位置
粗调
微调
AUTO
42
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3 ሣᐩ䆒㕂
3.9 ᖂ䇗
ᖂ䇗ሣᐩҹ㦋ᕫ㡇БⱘڣDŽ
ҙᢳᓣϟৃ⫼DŽ
3.9.1 䇗ᭈᖂ䇗
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ڣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ᖂ䇗ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈᖂ䇗DŽ
MENU
图像
垂直位置
粗调
微调
AUTO
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗 43
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
䇗ᭈሣᐩⱘ㡆䇗DŽ♉Ꮋᓣ 䆒㕂Ў ࠻എ ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
4.1 㑶
䇗ᭈڣЁⱘ㑶㡆ؐDŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
䆹ؐ䍞ˈ㡆ᔽᔎᑺ䍞ᔎDŽ
4.1.1 䜡㕂㑶
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆ᔽˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㑶ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ㑶DŽ
MENU
色彩
:
:
:
:
:
红
绿
蓝
色温
伽马
模式1
正常
AUTO44
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4.2 㓓
䇗ᭈڣЁⱘ㓓㡆ؐDŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
䆹ؐ䍞ˈ㡆ᔽᔎᑺ䍞ᔎDŽ
4.2.1 䜡㕂㓓
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆ᔽˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㓓ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ㓓DŽ
MENU
色彩
:
:
:
:
:
红
绿
蓝
色温
伽马 模式1
正常
AUTO45
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4.3 㪱
䇗ᭈڣЁⱘ㪱㡆ؐDŽ˄㣗ೈ˖ 0~100)
䆹ؐ䍞ˈ㡆ᔽᔎᑺ䍞ᔎDŽ
4.3.1 䜡㕂㪱
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆ᔽˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㪱ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ㪱DŽ
MENU
色彩
:
:
:
:
: 模式1
正常
红
绿
蓝
色温
伽马
AUTO46
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4.4 㡆⏽
䇗ᭈڣⱘᭈԧ㡆䇗DŽ
♉ࡼ㾚㾦໘Ѣਃ⫼⢊ᗕᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
4.4.1 䜡㕂㡆⏽䆒㕂
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆ᔽˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆⏽ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ދ 2:ᇚ㡆⏽䆒㕂Ў↨ދ 1 ދDŽ
z ދ 1:ᇚ㡆⏽䆒㕂Ў↨ℷᐌᓣދDŽ
z ℷᐌ˖ᰒ⼎ᷛޚ㡆⏽DŽ
z ᱪ 1˖ᇚ㡆⏽䆒㕂Ў↨ℷᐌᓣᱪDŽ
z ᱪ 2˖ᇚ㡆⏽䆒㕂Ў↨ᱪ 1 ᱪDŽ
z ϾҎ䆒ᅮ˖㞾ᅮН㡆⏽DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
色彩
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
ࣱ
冷
冷
正常
暖
暖
个人设定
红
绿
蓝
色温
伽马
AUTO47
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4 䜡㕂㡆䇗
4.5 ԑ偀
䇗ᭈڣⱘЁ䯈҂ᑺ ˄ԑ偀˅DŽ
♉ࡼ㾚㾦໘Ѣਃ⫼⢊ᗕᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
4.5.1 䜡㕂ԑ偀
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㡆ᔽˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄԑ偀ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
色彩
:
:
:
:
: ֻҖ
正常
模式1
模式2
模式3
红
蓝
绿
色温
伽马
AUTO5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ 48
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5.1 䇁㿔
䆒㕂㦰ऩ䇁㿔DŽ
z ᇍ䇁㿔䆒㕂ⱘᬍাᑨ⫼ࠄሣᐩ㦰ऩᰒ⼎Ϟˈ
z ᮴⊩ᑨ⫼Ѣ PC Ϟⱘ݊Ҫࡳ㛑DŽ
5.1.1 ᬍ䇁㿔
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㦰ऩ䆒㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䇁㿔ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏ࠄ᠔䳔䗝乍ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
20 sec
On
菜单设置
语言
菜单水平位置
菜单垂直位置
显示时间
透明度
'HXWVFK
(QJOLVK
(VSDxRO
)UDQoDLV
,WDOLDQR
0DJ\DU
3ROVNL
3RUWXJXrV
ƧNJLjLjǁƿǀ
6YHQVND
7UNoH
ଞ˲߭
∝䇁
AUTO
ᣣᧄ⺆49
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5.2 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂
㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂:ᇚ㦰ऩԡ㕂⿏ࠄᎺջেջDŽ
㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂:Ϟϟ⿏ࡼ㦰ऩԡ㕂DŽ
5.2.1 䜡㕂 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㦰ऩ䆒㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ҹ䜡㕂 㦰ऩ∈ᑇԡ㕂 㦰ऩൖⳈԡ㕂DŽ
MENU
汉语
20 秒
开
菜单设置
语言
菜单水平位置
菜单垂直位置
显示时间
透明度
AUTO
汉语
20 秒
开
菜单设置
语言
菜单水平位置
菜单垂直位置
显示时间
透明度
AUTO50
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5.3 ᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈
ᇚሣᐩ㾚㋏㒳 (OSD) 㦰ऩ䆒㕂Ўᣛᅮᳳ䯈ϡՓ⫼ᯊ㞾ࡼ⍜༅DŽ
ᙼৃҹՓ⫼ᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈ᴹᣛᅮᏠᳯᶤϾᯊ䯈䖛ৢ OSD 㦰ऩ⍜༅DŽ
5.3.1 䜡㕂ᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㦰ऩ䆒㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄᰒ⼎ᯊ䯈ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
汉语
5 秒c
On
菜单设置
语言
菜单水平位置
菜单垂直位置
显示时间
透明度
AUTO
秒
秒
秒
秒51
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5 ᇍሣᐩ䇗ᭈᇣ䞡ᅮԡ
5.4 䗣ᯢᑺ
䆒㕂㦰ऩにষⱘ䗣ᯢᑺ˖
5.4.1 ᬍ䗣ᯢᑺ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㦰ऩ䆒㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䗣ᯢᑺˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
汉语
20 秒
On
菜单设置
语言
菜单水平位置
菜单垂直位置
显示时间
透明度
AUTO
关
开6 䆒㕂䞡㕂 52
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.1 ԡ
ᇚᴀѻકⱘ᠔᳝䆒㕂ᘶЎ咬䅸ߎॖ䆒㕂DŽ
6.1.1 ߱ྟ࣪䆒㕂 ˄ԡ˅
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄԡˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
关
加速
手动
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
AUTO
是否重设所有设置?
是 否
EXIT AUTO53
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.2 ♉ᚴ㡖㛑
♉ᚴ㡖㛑 ࡳ㛑ৃ䗮䖛ࠊᰒ⼎఼䴶ᵓՓ⫼ⱘ⬉⌕ᴹޣᇥ㛑㗫DŽ
♉Ꮋᓣ ໘Ѣ ࡼᗕᇍ↨ᑺ ᓣᯊˈ᮴⊩Փ⫼ℸ㦰ऩDŽ
6.2.1 䜡㕂 ♉ᚴ㡖㛑
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ ♉ᚴ㡖㛑ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z 75%˖ᇚᰒ⼎఼㛑㗫বЎ咬䅸∈ᑇⱘ 75%DŽ
z 50%˖ᇚᰒ⼎఼㛑㗫বЎ咬䅸∈ᑇⱘ 50%DŽ
z ݇:݇䯁 ♉ᚴ㡖㛑 ࡳ㛑DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
Off
Off
加速
手动
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
ࢿଥ
ଥࢿ关
AUTO54
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.3 ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼
ᙼৃҹᇚѻક䆒㕂Ў㞾ࡼ݇䯁DŽ
6.3.1 䜡㕂 ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ݇:ذ⫼ᅮᯊ݇ᴎҹՓᴀѻકϡӮ㞾ࡼ݇䯁⬉⑤DŽ
z ᓔ˖▔⌏ᅮᯊ݇ᴎҹՓᴀѻક㞾ࡼ݇䯁⬉⑤DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
加速
手动
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
AUTO
关
开55
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.4 ҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁
ᅮᯊ݇ᴎৃҹ䆒㕂 1 ࠄ 23 ᇣᯊ㣗ೈݙDŽᣛᅮᯊ䯈䖛ৢˈᴀѻકӮ㞾ࡼ݇䯁⬉⑤DŽ
ҙᔧ ݇ᴎᅮᯊ఼ 䆒㕂Ў ᓔ ᯊˈℸ㦰ऩৃ⫼DŽ
6.4.1 䜡㕂 ҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] 䜡㕂ҹϟᯊ䯈ৢ݇䯁DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
加速
手动
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
开
10小时
AUTO56
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.5 PC/AV ᓣ
ᇚ PC/AV ᓣ 䆒㕂Ў AVDŽڣሎᇌᇚᬒDŽℸ䗝乍㾖ⳟ⬉ᕅᯊᕜᅲ⫼DŽ
z ℸࡳ㛑ϡᬃᣕᢳᓣDŽ
z ҙ䗖⫼Ѣᆑሣൟোˈབ 16:9 16:10DŽ
z བᵰᰒ⼎఼ ˄䆒㕂Ў DVI ᯊ˅໘Ѣⳕ⬉ᓣᰒ⼎ Ẕ⌟ֵো㒓 ⍜ᙃˈᣝ MENU ᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ሣ
ᐩ㦰ऩ (OSD)DŽᙼৃҹ䗝ᢽ PC AVDŽ
6.5.1 䜡㕂 PC/AV ᓣ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ PC/AV ᓣˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
加速
手动
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
开
10小时
AUTO
3&
$9
PC/AV 模式
'9,
AUTO57
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.6 ᣝ䬂䞡᭄
ࠊᣝϟᣝ䪂ᯊᣝ䪂ⱘડᑨ䗳⥛DŽ
6.6.1 䜡㕂ᣝ䬂䞡᭄
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄᣝ䬂䞡᭄ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ᙼৃҹ䗝ᢽࡴ䗳ǃ 1 ⾦ 2 ⾦DŽབᵰ䗝ᢽ᮴䞡ˈ߭ᣝϟᣝ䪂ᯊੑҸҙડᑨϔDŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
Acceleration
Manual
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
开
10小时
加速
1 秒
2 秒
无重复
AUTO58
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.7 ⑤Ẕ⌟
▔⌏⑤Ẕ⌟DŽ
6.7.1 䜡㕂 ⑤Ẕ⌟
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ⑤Ẕ⌟ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z 㞾ࡼ˖ѻકӮ㞾ࡼ䆚߿䕧ֵܹো⑤DŽ
z ࡼ˖ࡼ䗝ᢽ䕧ֵܹো⑤DŽ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
关
加速
复位
灵惠节能
关机定时器
以下时间后关闭
PC/AV 模式
按键重复次数
源检测
开
10小时
AUTO
自动
手动59
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6 䆒㕂䞡㕂
6.8 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂
ᙼৃᣝབϟℹ偸㞾ᅮН 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂DŽ
6.8.1 䜡㕂 㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ䆒㕂䞡㕂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽ
3 ᣝᴀѻકϞⱘ [ ] ⿏ࠄ㞾ᅮНᣝ䬂ˈ✊ৢᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹϟ⬏䴶DŽ
z ♉ࡼ㾚㾦 - ♉Ꮋᓣ - ♉ᚴ㡖㛑 - ᆑ᱂ݐᆍ
4 ᣝ [ ] ⿏㟇᠔䳔䗝乍ˈᑊᣝ [ ]DŽ
5 ᇚᑨ⫼䗝ᅮ䗝乍DŽ
MENU
设置和重置
自定义按键 $FFHOHUDWLRQ
2Q
灵惠节能
宽普兼容
灵巧模式
灵动视角
AUTO7 ֵᙃ㦰ऩঞ݊Ҫ 60
7 ֵᙃ㦰ऩঞ݊Ҫ
7.1 ֵᙃ
ᶹⳟᔧࠡ䕧ֵܹো⑤ǃ乥⥛ߚ䕼⥛DŽ
7.1.1 ᰒ⼎ֵᙃ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂ৃᰒ⼎ᣝ䬂ᇐᓩDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ] ᰒ⼎ᇍᑨⱘ㦰ऩሣᐩDŽ
2 ᣝ [ ] ⿏ࠄֵᙃDŽᔧࠡ䕧ֵܹো⑤ǃ乥⥛ߚ䕼⥛ᇚӮᰒ⼎ߎᴹDŽ
ᰒ⼎ⱘ㦰ऩ乍ৃ㛑ḍൟো㗠᳝᠔ϡৠDŽ
MENU
设置和重置
模拟
**kHz **Hz NP
**** x ****
最佳模式
**** x **** **Hz
图像
色彩
菜单设置
信息
EXIT AUTO61
7 ֵᙃ㦰ऩঞ݊Ҫ
7 ֵᙃ㦰ऩঞ݊Ҫ
7.2 ߱ྟሣᐩ䜡㕂 ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ
≵᳝ᰒ⼎ OSD 㦰ऩⱘ߱ྟሣᐩЁˈՓ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ 䆒㕂DŽ
1 ᣝѻકࠡ䴶ⱘӏԩᣝ䪂 ˄ᔧ≵᳝㦰ऩሣᐩᰒ⼎ᯊ˅ᰒ⼎ Āᣝ䬂ᣛफāDŽ✊ৢˈᣝ [ ]DŽᇚߎ⦄ҹ
ϟ⬏䴶DŽ
2 ᣝ [ ] ᣝ䪂ҹ ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ 䆒㕂П䯈ߛᤶDŽ
3 Փ⫼ [ ] ᣝ䪂䇗ᭈ ҂ᑺ ᇍ↨ᑺ 䆒㕂DŽ
亮度
100
对比度
75
EXIT8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ 62
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8.1 Magic Tune
8.1.1 ҔМᰃ MagicTune˛
MagicTune ᰃϔϾৃᐂࡽ⫼᠋䇗㡖ᰒ⼎఼ⱘ䕃ӊᑣˈᅗᦤկњᅠᭈⱘᰒ⼎఼ࡳ㛑䇈ᯢҹঞ䗮֫ᯧព
ⱘ᪡ᣛफDŽ
ᙼ᮴䳔Փ⫼ѻકⱘ᪡ᣝ䪂ˈা䳔䗮䖛哴ᷛ䬂Ⲭ֓ৃ䇗㡖ᰒ⼎఼DŽ
8.1.2 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
1 ᇚᅝ㺙ܝⲬᦦܹ CD-ROM 偅ࡼ఼ЁDŽ
2 䗝ᢽ MagicTune ᅝ㺙ᑣDŽ
བᵰЏ⬏䴶Ёᔍߎ䕃ӊᅝ㺙⬏䴶ˈ߭䇋 CD-ROM Ёᡒࠄ MagicTune ⱘᅝ㺙᭛ӊˈᑊঠߏ䆹
᭛ӊDŽ
3 䗝ᢽᅝ㺙䇁㿔ᑊऩߏ[ϟϔℹ]DŽ
4 ḍ⬏䴶Ϟⱘᣛ⼎ᅠ៤ϟᴹⱘ䕃ӊᅝ㺙ℹ偸DŽ
z ᅝ㺙ᅠ↩ৢ㢹ϡ䞡ਃ䅵ㅫᴎˈ䕃ӊৃ㛑᮴⊩ℷᐌᎹDŽ
z ⬅Ѣ䅵ㅫᴎ㋏㒳ѻક㾘Ḑϡৠˈৃ㛑ϡӮߎ⦄ MagicTune ᷛDŽ
z བᵰߎ⦄ᖿ᥋ᮍᓣᷛˈৃᣝ F5 䬂DŽ
ᅝ㺙 MagicTune™ ⱘ䰤ࠊᴵӊ䯂乬
MagicTune™ ⱘᅝ㺙ৃ㛑ফࠄᰒवǃЏᵓ㔥㒰⦃๗ⱘᕅડDŽ
㋏㒳㽕∖
᪡㋏㒳
z Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7
8.1.3 ߴ䰸䕃ӊ
Windows ㋏㒳ݙˈҙৃ䗮䖛[⏏ࡴߴ䰸ᑣ ]ᴹߴ䰸 MagicTune™
བ㽕ߴ䰸 MagicTune™ˈ䇋ᅠ៤ҹϟℹ偸DŽ63
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
1 ऩߏ[ᓔྟ]ˈ䗝ᢽ [䆒㕂]ˈ✊ৢҢ㦰ऩЁ䗝ᢽ [ࠊ䴶ᵓ]DŽ
ᇍѢ Windows XPˈ䇋ऩߏ[ᓔྟ]ˈ✊ৢҢ㦰ऩЁ䗝ᢽ[ࠊ䴶ᵓ]DŽ
2 ঠߏࠊ䴶ᵓЁⱘ Ā⏏ࡴߴ䰸ᑣāᷛDŽ
3 [⏏ࡴ/ߴ䰸]にষЁˈᡒࠄᑊ䗝Ё MagicTune™ˈՓ݊催҂ᰒ⼎DŽ
4 ऩߏ[ᬍߴ䰸ᑣ]ˈߴ䰸䕃ӊDŽ
5 ऩߏ[ᰃ]ˈᓔྟߴ䰸 MagicTune™DŽ
6 ৢӮߎ⦄ϔϾ⍜ᙃḚˈਞ䆝ᙼ䕃ӊᏆᅠܼߴ䰸DŽ
བ䳔 MagicTune™Ⳍ݇ⱘᡔᴃᬃᣕǃFAQ˄ᐌ㾕䯂乬㾷ㄨ˅䕃ӊछ㑻ֵᙃˈ䇋䆓䯂៥Ӏⱘ 㔥
キDŽ64
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8.2 MultiScreen
䗮䖛 MultiScreenˈ⫼᠋ৃᇚᰒ⼎఼⬏䴶ࡆߚЎϾᰒ⼎ऎඳDŽ
8.2.1 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
1 ᇚᅝ㺙ܝⲬᦦܹ [CD-ROM] 偅ࡼ఼ЁDŽ
2 䗝ᢽ "MultiScreen" ᅝ㺙ᑣDŽ
བᵰЏ⬏䴶Ёᔍߎ䕃ӊᅝ㺙⬏䴶ˈ߭䇋 [CD-ROM] Ёᡒࠄ "MultiScreen" ⱘᅝ㺙᭛ӊˈᑊঠ
䆹᭛ӊDŽߏ
3 ߎ⦄ᅝ㺙ᇐৢˈऩߏ [ϟϔℹ]DŽ
4 ձ✻ሣᐩ䇈ᯢ䖯㸠ᅝ㺙DŽ
z ᅝ㺙ᅠ↩ৢ㢹ϡ䞡ਃ䅵ㅫᴎˈ䕃ӊৃ㛑᮴⊩ℷᐌᎹDŽ
z ⬅Ѣ䅵ㅫᴎ㋏㒳ѻક㾘Ḑϡৠˈৃ㛑ϡӮߎ⦄ "MultiScreen" ᷛDŽ
z བᵰߎ⦄ᖿ᥋ᮍᓣᷛˈৃᣝ "F5" 䬂DŽ
ᅝ㺙 MultiScreen ⱘ䰤ࠊᴵӊ䯂乬
"MultiScreen "ⱘᅝ㺙ৃ㛑ফࠄ[ᰒव]ǃ [Џᵓ][㔥㒰⦃๗]ⱘᕅડDŽ
᪡㋏㒳
"᪡㋏㒳"
z "Windows 2000"
z "Windows XP Home Edition"
z "Windows XP Professional"
z "Windows Vista 32bit"
z "Windows 7 32bit"
ᇍѢ "MultiScreen"ˈᓎ䆂Փ⫼ "Windows 2000" 催⠜ᴀⱘ᪡㋏㒳DŽ
"⹀ӊ"
z 㟇ᇥ 32MB ⱘݙᄬ
z 㟇ᇥ᳝ 60MB ⱘৃ⫼⹀Ⲭぎ䯈
MultiScreen65
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8 ᅝ㺙䕃ӊ
8.2.2 ߴ䰸䕃ӊ
ऩߏ[ᓔྟ]ˈ䗝ᢽ[䆒㕂]/[ࠊ䴶ᵓ]ˈ✊ৢঠߏ[⏏ࡴߴ䰸ᑣ]DŽ
ᑣ߫㸼Ё䗝ᢽ "MultiScreen "ˈ✊ৢऩߏ [⏏ࡴ/ߴ䰸]ᣝ䪂DŽ9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ 66
9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ
9.1 㘨㋏ϝ᯳ᅶ᳡Ёᖗࠡⱘ㽕∖
9.1.1 Ẕ⌟ѻક
㟈⬉ϝ᯳ᅶ᳡Ёᖗࠡˈ䇋ᣝ✻ҹϟ䇈ᯢẔ⌟ᙼⱘѻકDŽབᵰ䯂乬ձ✊ᄬˈ䇋㘨㋏ϝ᯳ᅶ᳡ЁᖗDŽ
Փ⫼ѻકẔ⌟ࡳ㛑Ẕᶹᙼⱘѻકᰃ৺ℷᐌᎹDŽ
བᵰ݇䯁ሣᐩ⬉⑤ৢ⬉⑤ᣛ⼎♃ҡ✊䮾⚕ˈेՓᴀѻકᏆℷ⹂䖲ࠄ PC ᯊгᰃབℸˈ䇋ᠻ㸠㞾䆞ᮁ
⌟䆩DŽ
1 ݇䯁 PC ѻકⱘ⬉⑤DŽ
2 ᢨϟᴀѻકⱘ㓚㒓DŽ
3 ᠧᓔᴀѻક⬉⑤DŽ
4 བᵰᰒ⼎Ẕ⌟ֵো㒓⍜ᙃˈ㸼⼎ᴀѻકℷᐌᎹDŽ
བᵰሣᐩҡ✊᮴ڣˈ䇋Ẕᶹ PC ㋏㒳ǃ㾚乥ࠊ఼㓚㒓DŽ
9.1.2 Ẕᶹߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛
ᇍѢ䍙䖛ᬃᣕߚ䕼⥛ⱘᓣ ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā10.3ᷛޚֵোᓣ㸼ā˅ˈ䴲᳔Շᓣ⍜ᙃӮⷁ᱖ᰒ⼎DŽ
9.1.3 Ẕᶹҹϟ乍DŽ
ᅝ㺙䯂乬 ˄PC ᓣ˅
ሣᐩϡᮁਃࡼ݇䯁DŽ Ẕᶹᴀѻક PC П䯈ᰃ৺Ꮖℷ⹂䖲㓚㒓ˈϨ
䖲఼Ꮖ〇䫕ᅮࠄԡDŽ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā2.3䖲ᑊ
Փ⫼ PCā˅
ሣᐩ䯂乬
⬉⑤ LED ϡ҂DŽሣᐩ᮴⊩ߛᤶDŽ Ẕᶹᰃ৺Ꮖℷ⹂䖲⬉⑤㒓DŽ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā2.3䖲
ᑊՓ⫼ PCā˅
ᰒ⼎Ẕ⌟ֵো㒓⍜ᙃDŽ Ẕᶹᰃ৺Ꮖℷ⹂䖲ᴀѻકⱘ㓚㒓DŽ˄䇋খ䯙
Ā2.3䖲ᑊՓ⫼ PCā˅
ẔᶹϢѻક䖲ⱘ䆒ᰃ৺䗮⬉DŽ
"䴲᳔ՇᓣāDŽ བᵰᴹ㞾ᰒ⼎वⱘֵো䍙䖛ᴀѻકⱘ᳔催ߚ䕼⥛
乥⥛ˈ߭Ӯᰒ⼎ℸ⍜ᙃDŽ
ḍ Āᷛޚֵোᓣ㸼ā˄76˅ᬍ᳔催ߚ䕼
⥛乥⥛ҹ⒵䎇ѻકᗻ㛑DŽ67
9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ
9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ
ሣᐩϞڣ༅ⳳDŽ Ẕᶹᴀѻકⱘ㓚㒓䖲 ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā2.3䖲ᑊՓ
⫼ PCā˅
ڣϡ⏙᱄DŽڣ㊞DŽ 䇗ᭈ㉫䇗 ˄41˅ᖂ䇗 ˄42˅DŽ
পϟ᠔᳝䰘ӊ ˄㾚乥ᓊ䭓㒓ㄝ˅ᑊ䞡䆩DŽ
ᇚߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛䆒㕂Ў㤤∈ᑇDŽ˄䇋খ䯙
Ā10.1ᴀ㾘Ḑā˅
ڣϡ〇ᅮˈѻ⫳ᡪࡼDŽ Ẕᶹ PC ⱘߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛ᰃ৺ᴀѻકݐᆍ
ⱘߚ䕼⥛ࠋᮄ乥⥛㣗ೈݙDŽϟϔℹˈབ᳝ᖙ
㽕ˈ䇋খ㗗ᴀݠЁⱘ Āᷛޚֵোᓣ㸼ā˄
76˅ҹঞѻકϞⱘ ֵᙃ 㦰ऩᬍ䆒㕂DŽ
ሣᐩϞߎ⦄䰈ᕅ儐ᕅDŽ
ሣᐩ䖛҂DŽሣᐩ䖛ᱫDŽ 䇗ᭈ҂ᑺ ˄33˅ᇍ↨ᑺ ˄34˅DŽ
ሣᐩ㡆ᔽᰒ⼎ϡഛࣔDŽ ᬍ㡆ᔽ䆒㕂DŽ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā䜡㕂㡆䇗ā˅
ሣᐩϞⱘ㡆ᔽߎ⦄䰈ᕅᑊϨ༅ⳳDŽ ᬍ㡆ᔽ䆒㕂DŽ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā䜡㕂㡆䇗ā˅
ⱑ㡆ⳟϞএϡⱑDŽ ᬍ㡆ᔽ䆒㕂DŽ˄䇋খ䯙 Ā䜡㕂㡆䇗ā˅
ሣᐩϞ᮴ڣˈᑊϨ⬉⑤ LED ↣ 0.5 㟇 1 ⾦䮾
⚕ϔDŽ
ѻક໘Ѣⳕ⬉ᓣDŽ
ᣝ䬂ⲬϞⱘӏᛣ䬂⿏ࡼ哴ᷛˈ䖨ಲࠄϞϔ⬏
䴶DŽ
㡖Ⳃ⑤䆒䯂乬
PC ਃࡼᯊˈࠄનໄDŽ བᵰ PC ਃࡼᯊথߎ㳖号ໄˈ䇋䖯㸠㓈ׂDŽ
ሣᐩ䯂乬68
9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ
9 ᬙ䱰ᥦ䰸ᣛफ
9.2 䯂ㄨ
᳝݇䇗ᭈⱘ䇈ᯢˈ䇋খ䯙 PC ᰒ⼎वⱘ⫼᠋ݠDŽ
䯂乬 ㄨḜ
བԩᬍࠋᮄ乥⥛˛ 䆒㕂ᰒवⱘࠋᮄ乥⥛DŽ
z Windows XP˖䗝ᢽ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā Ā㾖Џ乬ā Āᰒ
⼎ā Ā䆒㕂ā Ā催㑻ā Āⲥ㾚఼āˈ✊ৢ䇗ᭈ ĀĀⲥ
㾚఼䆒㕂āϟⱘ ĀĀࠋᮄ乥⥛āDŽ
z Windows ME/2000˖䗝ᢽ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā Āᰒ⼎ā Ā䆒
㕂ā Ā催㑻ā Āⲥ㾚఼āˈ✊ৢ䇗ᭈ ĀĀⲥ㾚఼䆒㕂āϟ
ⱘ ĀĀࠋᮄ乥⥛āDŽ
z Windows Vista˖䗝ᢽ Āࠊ䴶ᵓā Ā㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ā
ĀϾᗻ࣪ā Āᰒ⼎䆒㕂ā Ā催㑻䆒㕂ā Āⲥ㾚఼āˈ
✊ৢ䇗ᭈ ĀĀⲥ㾚఼䆒㕂āϟⱘ ĀĀࠋᮄ乥⥛āDŽ
z Windows 7˖䗝ᢽ ĀĀࠊ䴶ᵓā Ā㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ā
Āᰒ⼎ā Āሣᐩߚ䕼⥛ā Ā催㑻䆒㕂ā Āⲥ㾚఼āˈ
✊ৢ䇗ᭈ ĀĀⲥ㾚఼䆒㕂āϟⱘ ĀĀࠋᮄ乥⥛āDŽ
བԩᬍߚ䕼⥛˛ z Windows XP˖䕀㟇ࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Џ乬 ᰒ⼎ 䆒㕂ˈ
ᑊ䇗ᭈߚ䕼⥛DŽ
z Windows ME/2000˖䕀㟇ࠊ䴶ᵓ ᰒ⼎ 䆒㕂ˈᑊ䇗ᭈߚ
䕼⥛DŽ
z Windows Vista˖䕀㟇ࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ Ͼᗻ࣪
ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂ˈᑊ䇗ᭈߚ䕼⥛DŽ
z Windows 7˖䕀㟇ࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ ᰒ⼎ 䇗ᭈ
ߚ䕼⥛ˈᑊ䇗ᭈߚ䕼⥛DŽ
བԩ䆒㕂ⳕ⬉ᓣ˛ z Windows XP˖ PC ⱘࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Џ乬 ᰒ⼎ ሣ
ᐩֱᡸᑣ䆒㕂 ĀBIOS ᅝ㺙āϟ䆒㕂ⳕ⬉ᓣDŽ
z Windows ME/2000˖ PC ⱘࠊ䴶ᵓ ᰒ⼎ ሣᐩֱᡸ
ᑣ䆒㕂 ĀBIOS ᅝ㺙āϟ䆒㕂ⳕ⬉ᓣDŽ
z Windows Vista˖ PC ⱘࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ Ͼᗻ࣪
ሣᐩֱᡸᑣ䆒㕂 ĀBIOS ᅝ㺙āϟ䆒㕂ⳕ⬉ᓣDŽ
z Windows 7˖ PC ⱘࠊ䴶ᵓ 㾖Ͼᗻ࣪ Ͼᗻ࣪
ሣᐩֱᡸᑣ䆒㕂 ĀBIOS ᅝ㺙āϟ䆒㕂ⳕ⬉ᓣDŽ10 㾘Ḑ 69
10 㾘Ḑ
10.1 ᴀ㾘Ḑ
ൟোৡ⿄ S19C200NY S19C200N S19C200NW
䴶ᵓ
ᇣ 18.5 㣅ᇌ (47 ६㉇) 18.5 㣅ᇌ (47 ६㉇) 19.0 㣅ᇌ (48 ६㉇)
ᰒ⼎䴶⿃
40.98 ६㉇ ˄∈ᑇ˅
x 23.04 ६㉇ ˄ൖ
Ⳉ˅
40.98 ६㉇ ˄∈ᑇ˅
x 23.04 ६㉇ ˄ൖ
Ⳉ˅
40.824 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 25.515 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
㋴䯈䎱ڣ
0.0300 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.0300 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
0.0300 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.0300 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
0.02835 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.02835 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
ৠℹ
㸠乥 30 ~ 81 kHz
എ乥 56 ~ 75 Hz
ᰒ⼎买㡆 16.7M
⥛䕼ߚ
᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ 1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@60Hz
᳔ߚ䕼⥛ 1366x768@60Hz 1440x900@75Hz
᳔ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳 85MHz (ᢳ) 85MHz (ᢳ) 136MHz (ᢳ)
⬉⑤
ᴀѻકՓ⫼ 100 㟇 240V ⬉⑤DŽ
ϡৠᆊഄऎⱘᷛޚ⬉य़᳝᠔ϡৠˈ䇋খ䯙ѻક㚠䴶ⱘᷛㅒDŽ
ֵোষ 15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub 㓚㒓ˈৃߚ⾏
ሎᇌ ˄ᆑx催x
⏅˅ /䞡䞣
ϡᏺᬃᶊ
44.14 x 26.66 x 7.68
६㉇
44.14 x 26.66 x 7.68
६㉇
43.94 x 28.99 x 7.62
६㉇
ᏺᬃᶊ
44.14 x 34.88 x 17.0
६㉇ / 2.8 गܟ
44.14 x 34.88 x 17.0
६㉇ / 2.8 गܟ
43.94 x 37.36 x 17.0
६㉇ / 3.1 गܟ
VESA ᅝ㺙ষ
100 ↿㉇ x 100 ↿㉇
˄Ϣ⡍⅞(Arm)㺙䜡ӊ䜡ড়Փ⫼DŽ˅
⦃๗⊼ᛣџ乍
᪡
⏽ᑺ˖10ÛC ̢ 40ÛC (50ÛF ̢ 104ÛF ) ᑺ˖10 % ̢ 80 %ˈ䴲ދ
ޱ
ᄬټ ⏽ᑺ˖-20ÛC ̢ 45ÛC (-4ÛF ̢ 113ÛF) ᑺ˖5 % ̢ 95 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ेᦦे⫼
ᴀᰒ⼎఼ৃᅝ㺙ӏԩݐᆍेᦦे⫼ⱘ㋏㒳ϞᑊϢ݊ϔ䍋Փ⫼DŽᰒ
⼎఼Ϣ PC ㋏㒳П䯈᳝ϸ⾡᭄ѸᤶᮍᓣˈৃӬ࣪ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎఼ᅝ㺙Ӯ㞾ࡼ䖯㸠DŽϡ䖛ˈབ᳝ᖙ㽕ৃҹᅮࠊᅝ㺙䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎ሣڣ㋴⚍ ˄ڣ㋴˅
⬅Ѣᴀѻકⱘ⫳ѻ⡍ᗻˈ LCD ᰒ⼎ሣϞ㑺↣ⱒϛڣ㋴ ˄ⱒϛߚ
Пϔ˅Ӯߎ⦄↨ℷᐌڣ㋴҂ᱫⱘᚙމDŽ䖭ϡӮᕅડѻકᗻ
㛑DŽ70
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
ൟোৡ⿄ S19C200BW S19C200BR S19C200NR
䴶ᵓ
ᇣ 19.0 㣅ᇌ (48 ६㉇) 19.0 㣅ᇌ (48 ६㉇) 19.0 㣅ᇌ (48 ६㉇)
ᰒ⼎䴶⿃
40.824 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 25.515 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
37.632 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 30.106 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
37.632 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 30.106 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
㋴䯈䎱ڣ
0.02835 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.02835 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
0.0294 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.0294 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
0.0294 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.0294 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
ৠℹ
㸠乥 30 ~ 81 kHz
എ乥 56 ~ 75 Hz
ᰒ⼎买㡆 16.7M
⥛䕼ߚ
᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ 1440x900@60Hz 1280x1024@60Hz
᳔ߚ䕼⥛ 1440x900@75Hz 1280x1024@75Hz
᳔ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
136MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
135MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
135MHz (ᢳ)
⬉⑤
ᴀѻકՓ⫼ 100 㟇 240V ⬉⑤DŽ
ϡৠᆊഄऎⱘᷛޚ⬉य़᳝᠔ϡৠˈ䇋খ䯙ѻક㚠䴶ⱘᷛㅒDŽ
ֵোষ
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub 㓚㒓ˈৃߚ⾏
DVI-D 㟇 DVI-D 䖲఼ˈৃߚ⾏
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub
⾏ߚৃˈ㓚㒓
ሎᇌ ˄ᆑx催x
⏅˅ /䞡䞣
ϡᏺᬃᶊ
43.94 x 28.99 x 7.62
६㉇
40.7 x 33.6 x 7.7 ६
㉇
40.7 x 33.6 x 7.7 ६
㉇
ᏺᬃᶊ
43.94 x 37.36 x 17.0
६㉇ / 3.1 गܟ
40.7 x 41.9 x 17.0 ६
㉇ / 3.25 गܟ
40.7 x 41.9 x 17.0 ६
㉇ / 3.25 गܟ
VESA ᅝ㺙ষ
100 ↿㉇ x 100 ↿㉇
˄Ϣ⡍⅞(Arm)㺙䜡ӊ䜡ড়Փ⫼DŽ˅
⦃๗⊼ᛣџ乍
᪡ ⏽ᑺ˖10ÛC ̢ 40ÛC (50ÛF ̢ 104ÛF) ᑺ˖10 % ̢ 80 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ᄬټ ⏽ᑺ˖-20ÛC ̢ 45ÛC (-4ÛF ̢ 113ÛF) ᑺ˖5 % ̢ 95 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ेᦦे⫼
ᴀᰒ⼎఼ৃᅝ㺙ӏԩݐᆍेᦦे⫼ⱘ㋏㒳ϞᑊϢ݊ϔ䍋Փ⫼DŽᰒ
⼎఼Ϣ PC ㋏㒳П䯈᳝ϸ⾡᭄ѸᤶᮍᓣˈৃӬ࣪ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎఼ᅝ㺙Ӯ㞾ࡼ䖯㸠DŽϡ䖛ˈབ᳝ᖙ㽕ৃҹᅮࠊᅝ㺙䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎ሣڣ㋴⚍ ˄ڣ㋴˅
⬅Ѣᴀѻકⱘ⫳ѻ⡍ᗻˈ LCD ᰒ⼎ሣϞ㑺↣ⱒϛڣ㋴ ˄ⱒϛߚ
Пϔ˅Ӯߎ⦄↨ℷᐌڣ㋴҂ᱫⱘᚙމDŽ䖭ϡӮᕅડѻકᗻ
㛑DŽ71
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
ൟোৡ⿄ S20C200B S22C200NY S22C200N
䴶ᵓ
ᇣ 20.0 㣅ᇌ (50 ६㉇) 21.5 㣅ᇌ (54 ६㉇) 21.5 㣅ᇌ (54 ६㉇)
ᰒ⼎䴶⿃
44.28 ६㉇ ˄∈ᑇ˅
x 24.908 ६㉇ ˄ൖ
Ⳉ˅
47.664 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 26.811 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
47.664 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 26.811 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
㋴䯈䎱ڣ
0.027675 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.027675 ६
㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
0.024825 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.024825 ६
㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
0.024825 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.024825 ६
㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
ৠℹ
㸠乥 30 ~ 81 kHz
എ乥 56 ~ 75 Hz
ᰒ⼎买㡆 16.7M
⥛䕼ߚ
᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ 1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ߚ䕼⥛ 1600x900@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
136MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
148MHz (ᢳ)
⬉⑤
ᴀѻકՓ⫼ 100 㟇 240V ⬉⑤DŽ
ϡৠᆊഄऎⱘᷛޚ⬉य़᳝᠔ϡৠˈ䇋খ䯙ѻક㚠䴶ⱘᷛㅒDŽ
ֵোষ
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub
⾏ߚৃˈ㓚㒓
DVI-D 㟇 DVI-D 䖲
⾏ߚৃˈ఼
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub 㓚㒓ˈৃߚ⾏
ሎᇌ ˄ᆑx催x
⏅˅ /䞡䞣
ϡᏺᬃᶊ
47.38 x 28.4 x 7.82
६㉇
50.43 x 30.19 x 7.76
६㉇
50.43 x 30.19 x 7.76
६㉇
ᏺᬃᶊ
47.38 x 36.71 x 17.0
६㉇ / 2.65 गܟ
50.43 x 38.535 x
18.50 ६㉇ / 3.5 ग
ܟ
50.43 x 38.535 x
18.50 ६㉇ / 3.5 ग
ܟ
VESA ᅝ㺙ষ
100 ↿㉇ x 100 ↿㉇
˄Ϣ⡍⅞(Arm)㺙䜡ӊ䜡ড়Փ⫼DŽ˅
⦃๗⊼ᛣџ乍
᪡ ⏽ᑺ˖10ÛC ̢ 40ÛC (50ÛF ̢ 104ÛF) ᑺ˖10 % ̢ 80 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ᄬټ ⏽ᑺ˖-20ÛC ̢ 45ÛC (-4ÛF ̢ 113ÛF ) ᑺ˖5 % ̢ 95 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ेᦦे⫼
ᴀᰒ⼎఼ৃᅝ㺙ӏԩݐᆍेᦦे⫼ⱘ㋏㒳ϞᑊϢ݊ϔ䍋Փ⫼DŽᰒ
⼎఼Ϣ PC ㋏㒳П䯈᳝ϸ⾡᭄ѸᤶᮍᓣˈৃӬ࣪ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎఼ᅝ㺙Ӯ㞾ࡼ䖯㸠DŽϡ䖛ˈབ᳝ᖙ㽕ৃҹᅮࠊᅝ㺙䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎ሣڣ㋴⚍ ˄ڣ㋴˅
⬅Ѣᴀѻકⱘ⫳ѻ⡍ᗻˈ LCD ᰒ⼎ሣϞ㑺↣ⱒϛڣ㋴ ˄ⱒϛߚ
Пϔ˅Ӯߎ⦄↨ℷᐌڣ㋴҂ᱫⱘᚙމDŽ䖭ϡӮᕅડѻકᗻ
㛑DŽ72
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
ൟোৡ⿄ S22C200B S22C200BW S23C200B
䴶ᵓ
ᇣ 21.5 㣅ᇌ (54 ६㉇) 22.0 㣅ᇌ (55 ६㉇) 23.0 㣅ᇌ (58 ६㉇)
ᰒ⼎䴶⿃
47.664 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 26.811 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
47.376 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 29.61 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
50.976 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 28.674 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
㋴䯈䎱ڣ
0.024825 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.024825 ६
㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
0.0282 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.0282 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
0.02655 ६㉇ ˄∈
ᑇ˅ x 0.02655 ६㉇
˄ൖⳈ˅
ৠℹ
㸠乥 30 ~ 81 kHz
എ乥 56 ~ 75 Hz
ᰒ⼎买㡆 16.7M
⥛䕼ߚ
᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ 1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ߚ䕼⥛ 1920x1080@60Hz 1680x1050@60Hz 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
148MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
146MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
148MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄
ᄫ˅
⬉⑤
ᴀѻકՓ⫼ 100 㟇 240V ⬉⑤DŽ
ϡৠᆊഄऎⱘᷛޚ⬉य़᳝᠔ϡৠˈ䇋খ䯙ѻક㚠䴶ⱘᷛㅒDŽ
ֵোষ
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub 㓚㒓ˈৃߚ⾏
DVI-D 㟇 DVI-D 䖲఼ˈৃߚ⾏
ሎᇌ ˄ᆑx催x
⏅˅ /䞡䞣
ϡᏺᬃᶊ
50.43 x 30.19 x 7.76
६㉇
50.24 x 32.98 x 7.74
६㉇
54.29 x 32.14 x 7.63
६㉇
ᏺᬃᶊ
50.43 x 38.535 x
18.50 ६㉇ / 3.5 ग
ܟ
50.24 x 41.35 x 18.5
६㉇ / 3.85 गܟ
54.29 x 40.465 x
18.5 ६㉇ / 3.25 ग
ܟ
VESA ᅝ㺙ষ
100 ↿㉇ x 100 ↿㉇
˄Ϣ⡍⅞(Arm)㺙䜡ӊ䜡ড়Փ⫼DŽ˅
⦃๗⊼ᛣџ乍
᪡ ⏽ᑺ˖10ÛC ̢ 40ÛC (50ÛF ̢ 104ÛF) ᑺ˖10 % ̢ 80 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ᄬټ ⏽ᑺ˖-20ÛC ̢ 45ÛC (-4ÛF ̢ 113ÛF) ᑺ˖5 % ̢ 95 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ेᦦे⫼
ᴀᰒ⼎఼ৃᅝ㺙ӏԩݐᆍेᦦे⫼ⱘ㋏㒳ϞᑊϢ݊ϔ䍋Փ⫼DŽᰒ
⼎఼Ϣ PC ㋏㒳П䯈᳝ϸ⾡᭄ѸᤶᮍᓣˈৃӬ࣪ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎఼ᅝ㺙Ӯ㞾ࡼ䖯㸠DŽϡ䖛ˈབ᳝ᖙ㽕ৃҹᅮࠊᅝ㺙䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎ሣڣ㋴⚍ ˄ڣ㋴˅
⬅Ѣᴀѻકⱘ⫳ѻ⡍ᗻˈ LCD ᰒ⼎ሣϞ㑺↣ⱒϛڣ㋴ ˄ⱒϛߚ
Пϔ˅Ӯߎ⦄↨ℷᐌڣ㋴҂ᱫⱘᚙމDŽ䖭ϡӮᕅડѻકᗻ
㛑DŽ73
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
Ϟ䗄ѻક㾘Ḑৃ㛑Ӯᬍ䖯䋼䞣㗠᳝᠔ব࣪ˈᘩϡ㸠䗮ⶹDŽ
ᴀ䆒ᰃ B ㉏᭄ᄫ䆒DŽ
ൟোৡ⿄ S24C200BL
䴶ᵓ
ᇣ 23.6 㣅ᇌ (59 ६㉇)
ᰒ⼎䴶⿃ 52.128 ६㉇ ˄∈ᑇ˅ x 29.322 ६㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
ڣ㋴䯈䎱 0.02715 ६㉇ ˄∈ᑇ˅ x 0.02715 ६㉇ ˄ൖⳈ˅
ৠℹ
㸠乥 30 ~ 81 kHz
എ乥 56 ~ 75 Hz
ᰒ⼎买㡆 16.7M
⥛䕼ߚ
᳔Շߚ䕼⥛ 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ߚ䕼⥛ 1920x1080@60Hz
᳔ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳 148MHz ˄ᢳǃ᭄ᄫ˅
⬉⑤
ᴀѻકՓ⫼ 100 㟇 240V ⬉⑤DŽ
ϡৠᆊഄऎⱘᷛޚ⬉य़᳝᠔ϡৠˈ䇋খ䯙ѻક㚠䴶ⱘᷛㅒDŽ
ֵোষ
15 䩜㟇 15 䩜 D-sub 㓚㒓ˈৃߚ⾏
DVI-D 㟇 DVI-D 䖲఼ˈৃߚ⾏
ሎᇌ ˄ᆑx催x
⏅˅ /䞡䞣
ϡᏺᬃᶊ 55.46 x 33.05 x 7.82 ६㉇
ᏺᬃᶊ 55.46 x 41.235 x 18.5 ६㉇ / 4.1 गܟ
VESA ᅝ㺙ষ
100 ↿㉇ x 100 ↿㉇
˄Ϣ⡍⅞(Arm)㺙䜡ӊ䜡ড়Փ⫼DŽ˅
⦃๗⊼ᛣџ乍
᪡ ⏽ᑺ˖10ÛC ̢ 40ÛC (50ÛF ̢ 104ÛF) ᑺ˖10 % ̢ 80 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ᄬټ ⏽ᑺ˖-20ÛC ̢ 45ÛC (-4ÛF ̢ 113ÛF) ᑺ˖5 % ̢ 95 %ˈ䴲ޱދ
ेᦦे⫼
ᴀᰒ⼎఼ৃᅝ㺙ӏԩݐᆍेᦦे⫼ⱘ㋏㒳ϞᑊϢ݊ϔ䍋Փ⫼DŽᰒ
⼎఼Ϣ PC ㋏㒳П䯈᳝ϸ⾡᭄ѸᤶᮍᓣˈৃӬ࣪ᰒ⼎఼䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎఼ᅝ㺙Ӯ㞾ࡼ䖯㸠DŽϡ䖛ˈབ᳝ᖙ㽕ৃҹᅮࠊᅝ㺙䆒㕂DŽ
ᰒ⼎ሣڣ㋴⚍ ˄ڣ㋴˅
⬅Ѣᴀѻકⱘ⫳ѻ⡍ᗻˈ LCD ᰒ⼎ሣϞ㑺↣ⱒϛڣ㋴ ˄ⱒϛߚ
Пϔ˅Ӯߎ⦄↨ℷᐌڣ㋴҂ᱫⱘᚙމDŽ䖭ϡӮᕅડѻકᗻ
㛑DŽ74
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
10.2 㡖㛑ᓣ
བᵰᴀѻક⡍ᅮⱘϔ↉ᯊ䯈ݙ≵᳝Փ⫼ˈ߭ⳕ⬉ࡳ㛑Ӯ݇䯁ሣᐩᑊϨ⬉⑤ LED ♃䮾⚕DŽⳕ⬉ᓣ
ϟϡӮ݇䯁⬉⑤DŽ㽕䞡ᮄᓔਃሣᐩˈ䇋ᣝ䬂ⲬϞⱘӏᛣ䬂⿏ࡼ哴ᷛDŽা᳝ᇚᴀѻક䖲ࠄ᳝ⳕ⬉
ࡳ㛑ⱘ PCˈⳕ⬉ᓣᠡ㛑䖤㸠DŽ
节能模式 正常运行模式 省电模式
关闭电源 (电源按
钮)
电源指示灯 开启 闪烁 关闭
功耗
(S19C200NY)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S19C200N)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S19C200NW)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S19C200BW)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S19C200BR)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S19C200NR)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S20C200B)
典型值 19 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S22C200NY)
典型值 24 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S22C200N)
典型值 24 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S22C200B)
典型值 24 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S22C200BW)
典型值 24 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S23C200B)
典型值 25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
功耗
(S24C200BL)
典型值 30 瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦
典型值 0.1瓦
最高 0.25瓦75
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
由于不同的操作环境或设置的更改,此处标明的功耗水平可能有所不同。
要将电源消耗降低到0瓦,请拔下电源线。长时间不使用本产品时,请确保拔下电源线。电源开
关不可用时,要将功耗降至 0,请拔下电源线。76
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
10.3 ᷛޚֵোᓣ㸼
z ⬅Ѣᰒ⼎ሣⱘ⡍ᗻˈЎ㦋ᕫ᳔Շ⬏䴶䋼䞣ᴀѻકা㛑Ў↣⾡ሣᐩሎᇌ䆒㕂ϔ⾡ߚ䕼⥛DŽℸˈՓ
⫼䴲ᣛᅮߚ䕼⥛ৃ㛑Ӯ䰡Ԣڣ䋼䞣DŽЎ䙓ߎܡ⦄䖭⾡⦄䈵ˈᓎ䆂ᙼ䗝ᢽЎᙼѻકⱘሣᐩሎᇌᣛ
ᅮⱘ᳔Շߚ䕼⥛DŽ
z ᇚ䖲ࠄ PC ⱘ CDT ᰒ⼎఼ᤶ៤ LCD ᰒ⼎఼ᯊˈ䇋Ẕᶹᅗⱘࠋᮄ乥⥛DŽབᵰ LCD ᰒ⼎఼ϡᬃ
ᣕ 85Hzˈ߭ৃҹՓ⫼ CDT ᰒ⼎఼ᇚഎ乥ᬍЎ 60Hz ˈݡᇚ݊ᤶЎ LCD ᰒ⼎఼DŽ
བᵰҢ PC Ӵ䕧ⱘֵোሲѢҹϟᷛޚֵোᓣˈሣᐩᇚ㞾ࡼ䇗ᭈDŽབᵰ PC Ӵ䕧ⱘֵোϡሲѢᷛޚֵো
ᓣˈ䙷М㱑✊⬉⑤ LED ᓔਃˈԚሣᐩϞৃ㛑᮴⬏䴶ᰒ⼎DŽབᵰߎ⦄ℸᚙމˈ䇋খ䯙ᰒव⫼᠋ᣛफᑊ
ḍϟ㸼ᬍ䆒㕂DŽ
S19C200NY
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+77
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S19C200N
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1366 x 768 47.712 59.790 85.500 +/+78
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S19C200NW
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+79
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S19C200BW
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+80
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S19C200BR
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+81
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S19C200NR
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 960 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+82
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S20C200B
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 70.635 74.984 136.750 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+83
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S22C200NY
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAˈ 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+84
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S22C200N
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAˈ 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+85
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S22C200B
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAˈ 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+86
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S22C200BW
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+87
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S23C200B
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAˈ 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+88
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
S24C200BL
z 㸠乥
ҢሣᐩⱘᎺ䖍ࠄে䖍ᠿᦣϔᴵ㒓᠔䳔ⱘᯊ䯈⿄Ў∈ᑇ਼ᳳDŽ∈ᑇ਼ᳳⱘצ᭄⿄Ў㸠乥DŽ㸠乥ऩԡ
Ў kHzDŽ
z എ乥
䴶ᵓ↣⾦䞡ᰒ⼎Ⳍৠڣ᭄कˈᙼᠡ㛑ⳟࠄ㞾✊ⱘڣDŽ䆹䞡乥⥛⿄Ў ĀൖⳈ乥⥛ā
Āࠋᮄ乥⥛ā ,ҹ Hz 㸼⼎DŽ
ߚ䕼⥛ 㸠乥 (kHz) എ乥 (Hz)
ڣ㋴ᯊ䩳
(MHz)
ৠℹᵕᗻ ˄∈ᑇ
/ൖⳈ˅
IBMˈ 720 x 400 31.469 70.087 28.322 -/+
MACˈ 640 x 480 35.000 66.667 30.240 -/-
MACˈ 832 x 624 49.726 74.551 57.284 -/-
MACˈ 1152 x 870 68.681 75.062 100.000 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 31.469 59.940 25.175 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.861 72.809 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 640 x 480 37.500 75.000 31.500 -/-
VESAˈ 800 x 600 35.156 56.250 36.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 37.879 60.317 40.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 48.077 72.188 50.000 +/+
VESAˈ 800 x 600 46.875 75.000 49.500 +/+
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 48.363 60.004 65.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 56.476 70.069 75.000 -/-
VESAˈ 1024 x 768 60.023 75.029 78.750 +/+
VESAˈ 1152 x 864 67.500 75.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 720 45.000 60.000 74.250 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 800 49.702 59.810 83.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 63.981 60.020 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1280 x 1024 79.976 75.025 135.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1440 x 900 55.935 59.887 106.500 -/+
VESAˈ 1600 x 900 60.000 60.000 108.000 +/+
VESAˈ 1680 x 1050 65.290 59.954 146.250 -/+
VESAˈ 1920 x 1080 67.500 60.000 148.500 +/+89
10 㾘Ḑ
10 㾘Ḑ
10.4 ROHS
⦃๗ֱᡸᳳ䰤䗖⫼ᴵӊ
⦃๗⏽ᑺ˖aᑺ
⦃๗ᑺ˖a
䚼ӊৡ⿄
᳝↦᳝ᆇ⠽䋼ܗ㋴
䪙
˄3E˅
∲
˄+J˅
䬝
˄&G˅
݁Ӌ䫀
˄&U˅
⒈㘨㣃
˄3%%˅
⒈Ѡ㣃䝮
˄3%'(˅
䏃㒘ӊ⬉ࠋॄ
⬉㓚㒘ӊ
ล᭭㘮ড়⠽䚼ӊ
䞥ሲ䚼ӊ
⎆ሣ
䚼ӊৡ⿄
᳝↦᳝ᆇ⠽䋼ܗ㋴
䪙
˄3E˅
∲
˄+J˅
䬝
˄&G˅
݁Ӌ䫀
˄&U˅
⒈㘨㣃
˄3%%˅
⒈Ѡ㣃䝮
˄3%'(˅
䏃㒘ӊ⬉ࠋॄ
⬉㓚㒘ӊ
ล᭭㘮ড়⠽䚼ӊ
䞥ሲ䚼ӊ
⎆ሣ
/&'
/('
㸼⼎䆹᳝↦᳝ᆇ⠽䋼䆹䚼ӊ᠔᳝ഛ䋼ᴤ᭭Ёⱘ䞣ഛ6-7ᷛޚ㾘ᅮⱘ䰤䞣㽕∖ҹϟDŽ
㸼⼎䆹᳝↦᳝ᆇ⠽䋼㟇ᇥ䆹䚼ӊⱘᶤϔഛ䋼ᴤ᭭Ёⱘ䞣䍙ߎ6-7ᷛޚ㾘ᅮⱘ䰤䞣㽕∖DŽ
ᴀ㸼㸼⼎ᴀᴎ఼ݙ᳝ⱘ᳝ᆇ⠽䋼ᚙˈ䚼ક߿᳝ᆇ⠽䋼ᚙᰃ⬅կᑨଚᦤկⱘᚙݙ䚼Ẕᶹ㒧ᵰЎ⸔ࠊⱘDŽ
䚼ߚ䚼ક᳝ⱘ᳝ᆇ⠽䋼Ⳃࠡᡔᴃ∈ޚᴵӊϟᰃϡৃ㛑᳓ҷˈϝ᯳⬉ᄤЎњࠄخৃҹ᳓ҷℷϡវഄࡾⴔDŽ
៥Ӏᡓ䇎˖
ᬊ⍜䌍㗙ᆘಲⱘ䗕ಲⱘᑳѻકDŽ
ԧഄഔ䇋ᢼᠧ˖䖯㸠䆶DŽ
⊼˖⍜䌍㗙ᡓᢙ䚂ᆘˈᖿ䗦ㄝⳌ݇䌍⫼DŽ
ᴀѻકᏆ㒣পᕫЁ⦃ֱᷛᖫ䅸䆕DŽ
⦃๗ᷛᖫ㸼⼎ᴀѻકϢৠ㉏ѻકⳌ↨ˈ᳝Ԣ↦ᇥᆇˈ㡖㑺䌘⑤⦃๗ӬDŽ
ᇍֱᡸҎԧعᒋঞ⫳ᗕ⦃๗᳝ⲞDŽ
ᙼৃҹⱏ䰚ZZZVHSDJRYFQᶹ䆶Ё⦃๗ᷛᖫⳌֵ݇ᙃDŽ
www.samsung.com
دفترچه راهنمای کاربر
EK-GC1002
درباره این دفترچه راهنما
این محصول ارتباط موبایل و سرگرمی با کیفیت عالی را با استفاده از استانداردهای باالی سامسونگ و تخصص فنی
ارایه می کند. این دفترچه راهنمای کاربر به طور خاص برای ارایه اطالعات جزیی در زمینه عملکردها و قابلیت
های دستگاه طراحی شده است.
•لطفا قبل از استفاده از دستگاه خود برای اطمینان از استفاده ایمن و درست، این دفترچه راهنما را به دقت
بخوانید.
•شرح ها بر اساس تنظیمات پیش فرض دستگاه ارایه شده اند.
•عکس ها و تصاویر به کار رفته در این راهنما ممکن است بطور ظاهری با محصول واقعی تفاوت داشته باشند.
•محتویات ممکن است با محصول نهایی یا با نرم افزار ارایه شده توسط ارائه دهنده سرویس یا اپراتورها تفاوت
داشته باشد و مشمول تغییرات بدون اطالع قبلی می باشد. برای دریافت جدیدترین نسخه این دفترچه راهنما، به
وب سایت سامسونگ، www.samsung.com مراجعه کنید.
•ویژگی های موجود و خدمات جانبی ممکن است بسته به دستگاه، نرم افزار یا ارائه دهنده خدمات متفاوت باشد.
•برنامه ها و عملکردهای آنها ممکن است با توجه به کشور، منطقه یا مشخصات سخت افزار متفاوت باشند.
سامسونگ در قبال مشکالت عملکردی ناشی از برنامه های کاربردی تهیه کنندگانی بجز سامسونگ مسئولیتی
ندارد.
•سامسونگ مسئول مشکالت عملکردی یا ناسازگاری های ایجاد شده توسط تنظیمات رجیستری ویرایش شده
یا نرم افزار سیستم عامل تغییر یافته نیست. تالش برای شخصی سازی سیستم عامل ممکن است باعث شود تا
دستگاه یا برنامه ها بدرستی کار نکنند.
•نرم افزار، منابع صوتی، کاغذ دیواری ها، تصاویر و سایر رسانه های ارایه شده در این دستگاه برای استفاده
محدود مجوز دارد. خارج کردن و استفاده از این مطالب برای مقاصد تجاری و غیره نقض قوانین حق نسخه
برداری محسوب می شود. مسئولیت کامل استفاده غیرقانونی از رسانه بر عهده کاربران است.
•برای استفاده از سرویس های داده، از قبیل تبادل پیام، آپلود و دانلود، همگام سازی خودکار، یا استفاده از
سرویس های مکان ممکن است متحمل هزینه های اضافی شوید. برای اجتناب از هزینه های اضافی، یک طرح
تعرفه داده مناسب انتخاب کنید. برای جزییات با ارائه دهنده سرویس خود تماس بگیرید.
•این دستگاه اکثر شبکه ها را بجز شبکه های 2G را پشتیبانی می کند.
•برنامه های کاربردی پیش فرض که همراه دستگاه هستند، مشمول به روز رسانی بوده و ممکن است بدون
اطالع قبلی، دیگر پشتیبانی نشوند. اگر درباره برنامه های کاربردی ارایه شده همراه دستگاه سوالی دارد، با
مرکز خدمات سامسونگ تماس بگیرید. در مورد برنامه های نصب شده توسط کاربر، با ارائه دهندگان سرویس
تماس بگیرید.
•تغییر در سیستم عامل دستگاه یا نصب نرم افزارها از منابع غیررسمی، ممکن است باعث عملکرد نادرست
دستگاه یا مخدوش شدن و از دست رفتن داده ها شوند. این اقدامات توافقنامه مجوز سامسونگ را نقض می کند
و ضمانتنامه شما را باطل می کند.درباره این دفترچه راهنما
3
نمادهای دستورالعمل
اخطار: شرایطی که ممکن است باعث آسیب رساندن به شما یا سایرین شود
هشدار: شرایطی که باعث صدمه به دستگاه یا سایر تجهیزات می شود
نکته: نکات، ترفندهای استفاده یا سایر اطالعات
حق نسخه برداری
Copyright © 2012 Samsung Electronics
این راهنما تحت حفاظت قوانین بین المللی حق نسخه برداری می باشد.
هیچ بخشی از آن نمی تواند بدون اجازه کتبی قبلی از Samsung Electronics شکل و وسیله الکترونیکی یا
مکانیکی شامل فتوکپی، ضبط، یا ذخیره در حافظه های اطالعاتی و سیستم های بازیابی اطالعات منتقل شود.
عالیم تجاری
•سامسونگ و لوگوی سامسونگ عالیم تجاری ثبت شده Samsung Electronics هستند.
•لوگوی YouTube™ ،Google Mail™ ،Google Maps™ ،Google™ ،Android،
Google Play™ Store، و ™Google Talk عالئم تجاری شرکت .Google, Inc هستند.
•®Bluetooth عالمت تجاری ثبت شده .Bluetooth SIG, Inc در سراسر جهان است.
Windows Media Player عالمت تجاری ثبت شده Microsoft Corporation است.
•®
•HDMI، لوگوی HDMI و عبارت ”High Definition Multimedia Interface“ عالیم تجاری یا عالیم
تجاری ثبت شده HDMI Licensing LLC می باشند.
Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ ،Wi-Fi Direct™ ،Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ ،Wi-Fi، و
•®
لوگوی Wi-Fi عالیم تجاری ثبت شده Wi-Fi Alliance می باشند.
•سایر عالیم تجاری و حق نسخه برداری ها متعلق به صاحبان خود می باشند.4
آغاز به کار
7 نمای کلی دستگاه
8 دکمه ها
9 محتویات بسته
10 نصب سیم کارت یا USIM کارت و باتری
13 شارژ کردن باتری
15 وارد کردن کارت حافظه
17 روشن و خاموش کردن دستگاه
17 تنظیم میزان صدا
17 تغییر به حالت سکوت
دوربین
18 عملکردهای اولیه
27 عملکردهای پیشرفته
37 گزینه های تصویربرداری
45 تنظیمات پیکربندی برای دوربین
47 تمیز کردن دستگاه
مقدمات
48 نمادهای نشانگر
49 استفاده از صفحه لمسی
52 کنترل حرکات
55 اعالن ها
56 صفحه اصلی
58 استفاده از برنامه ها
58 صفحه برنامه ها
60 وارد کردن متن
61 اتصال به یک شبکه Wi-Fi
62 تنظیم اشتراک ها
63 انتقال فایلها
65 محافظت از دستگاه
66 ارتقا دستگاه
رسانه
67 گالری
Paper Artist 70
71 برنامه جادویی عکس
73 پخش کننده فیلم
74 ویرایشگر ویدئو
76 پخش موسیقی
YouTube 77
Instagram 78
ارتباطات
79 مخاطبین
82 پیام رسانی
83 ایمیل
Google Mail 85
Talk 86
ChatON 87
Google+ 88
88 مسنجر
فهرست مطالبفهرست مطالب
5
مسافرتی و محلی
Maps 107
Local 108
Latitude 109
109 ناوبری
تنظیمات
110 درباره تنظیمات
Wi-Fi 110
111 بلوتوث
111 استفاده از داده
112 تنظیمات بیشتر
114 حالت انسداد
114 صدا
114 صفحه نمایش
115 محل ذخیره
115 نیرو
116 باتری
116 مدیر برنامه
116 خدمات مکان
116 صفحه قفل
117 امنیت
119 زبان و ورودی
Cloud 122
122 تهیه نسخه پشتیبان و بازنشانی
123 افزودن حساب
123 حرکات
124 لوازم جانبی
وب و شبکه
89 اینترنت
Chrome 90
92 بلوتوث
AllShare Play 93
94 پخش گروهی
برنامه های کاربردی و حافظه های
ذخیره رسانه
95 فروشگاه Play
Samsung Apps 96
S Suggest 96
Game Hub 97
ابزارهای کمکی
98 تقویم
Dropbox 100
100 ساعت
102 ماشین حساب
S Voice 103
Google 104
105 جستجوی صوتی
105 مدیر وظیفه
106 فایلهای شخصی
106 دانلودهافهرست مطالب
6
124 تاریخ و ساعت
125 قابلیت دسترسی
126 گزینه های تهیه کننده
127 درباره دستگاه
عیب یابی7
آغاز به کار
نمای کلی دستگاه
ﺩﮐﻣﻪ ﺭﻭﺷﻥ-ﺧﺎﻣﻭﺵ
ﭼﺭﺍﻍ ﺩﺳﺗﻳﺎﺭ AF
ﻓﻼﺵ
ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻧﻧﺩﻩ ﻓﻼﺵ
ﻟﻧﺯ
ﺩﮐﻣﻪ ﺷﺎﺗﺭ
ﺩﮐﻣﻪ ﺯﻭﻡ
ﺁﻧﺗﻥ GPS
ﺁﻧﺗﻥ ﺍﺻﻠﯽ
ﺑﻠﻧﺩﮔﻭ
ﺩﺭ
ﻣﺣﻝ ﺳﻭﺍﺭ ﺷﺩﻥ
ﺭﻭی ﺳﻪ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ
ﭘﻭﺭﺕ HDMI
ﻣﻳﮑﺭﻭﻓﻭﻥ
ﻭﺭﻭﺩی ﻫﺩﺳﺕ
ﺟﮏ ﭼﻧﺩ ﻣﻧﻅﻭﺭﻩ
ﺻﻔﺣﻪ ﻟﻣﺳﯽآغاز به کار
8
میکروفون در باالی دستگاه فقط وقتی فعال است که از جستجوی صوتی استفاده می کنید یا فیلم می گیرید.
•از محافظ صفحه استفاده نکنید. این کار باعث عملکرد نادرست حسگر می شود.
•نگذارید آب با صفحه لمسی تماس پیدا کند. صفحه لمسی زمانی که در معرض آب یا محیط های مرطوب
قرار بگیرد ممکن است درست عمل نکند.
دکمه ها
دکمه عملکرد
روشن، خاموش
•فشار داده و نگه دارید تا دستگاه روشن یا خاموش شود.
•به مدت 8-6 ثانیه فشار داده و نگه دارید تا در صورت بروز خطاهای مهلک یا
هنگ کردن یا متوقف ماندن گوشی، آن را ریست کنید.
•برای قفل کردن یا باز کردن قفل دستگاه، فشار دهید. این دستگاه وقتی صفحه
لمسی خاموش می شود به حالت قفل می رود.
شاتر
•در برنامه دوربین، دکمه را تا نیمه فشار دهید تا روی سوژه فوکوس شود. وقتی
فوکوس بر روی سوژه است، قاب فوکوس سبز رنگ می شود. فشار دهید تا
عکس بگیرید.
•در صفحه اصلی، دکمه را فشار داده و نگه دارید تا دوربین روشن شود.
زوم
•در برنامه دوربین، برای زوم کردن به داخل یا بیرون به چپ یا راست
بچرخانید.
•برای تنظیم صدای دستگاه بچرخانید.آغاز به کار
9
محتویات بسته
جعبه محصول را بازبینی نمایید و مطمئن شوید اقالم زیر در آن موجود است:
•دستگاه
•باتری
•راهنمای شروع سریع
فقط از نرم افزار مورد تأیید سامسونگ استفاده کنید. نرم افزار غیرمجاز یا غیرقانونی ممکن است آسیب یا
عملکرد نادرست دستگاه را که تحت پوشش ضمانت نیست، موجب شود.
•اقالم ارایه شده همراه دستگاه و هر گونه لوازم جانبی ممکن است بسته با ناحیه یا ارائه دهنده سرویس
تفاوت کند.
•اقالم ارایه شده فقط برای استفاده با این دستگاه طراحی شده اند و ممکن است با دستگاه های دیگر
سازگار نباشند.
•ظاهر و مشخصات می توانند بدون اطالع قبلی تغییر کنند.
•می توانید لوازم جانبی بیشتر را از فروشگاه سامسونگ محلی خود خریداری کنید. قبل از خرید اطمینان
حاصل کنید که با دستگاه شما سازگار هستند.
•سایر لوازم جانبی ممکن است با دستگاه شما سازگار نباشند.
•فقط از لوازم جانبی مورد تایید سامسونگ استفاده کنید. عملکرد نادرست ناشی از استفاده از لوازم
جانبی تایید نشده، مشمول ضمانت نامه نمی شود.
•مهیا بودن همه لوازم جانبی کامال بسته به شرکت های سازنده، مشمول تغییرات است. برای اطالعات
بیتر درباره لوازم جانبی موجود، به وب سایت سامسونگ مراجعه کنید.
•بعضی تلویزیونها ممکن است به دلیل تفاوت مشخصات HDMI با دستگاه سازگار نباشند.آغاز به کار
10
نصب سیم کارت یا USIM کارت و باتری
سیم یا USIM کارت ارایه شده توسط ارائه دهنده سرویس تلفن همراه و باتری ضمیمه شده را وارد کنید.
دستگاه فقط با میکرو سیم کارت ها کار می کند.
1 چفت کشویی را بکشید و در را باز کنید.
2 سیم کارت یا USIM را در حالی که قسمت طالیی رنگ آن رو به باالست درون دستگاه قرار دهید.
•کارت حافظه را در شکاف سیم کارت وارد نکنید. در صورتی که کارت حافظه در شکاف سیم کارت
گیر کرد، باید دستگاه خود را به مرکز خدمات سامسونگ ببرید تا کارت حافظه را بردارند.
•مراقب باشید تا سیم کارت یا USIM کارت خود را گم نکرده یا در اختیار دیگران قرار ندهید.
سامسونگ مسئول هیچ آسیب یا مزاحمت ناشی از سیم کارت های گمشده یا دزدیده شده نیست.آغاز به کار
11
3 سیم کارت یا USIM کارت را درون شکاف کارت حافظه فشار دهید تا در جای خود محکم شود.
4 باتری را وارد کنید.
5 در را عوض کنید و چفت را بکشید.آغاز به کار
12
درآوردن سیم کارت یا USIM کارت و باتری
1 چفت کشویی را بکشید و در را باز کنید.
2 باتری را بیرون بکشید.
3 سیم کارت یا USIM کارت را فشار دهید تا کارت از دستگاه آزاد شود، و سپس آن را بیرون بکشید.آغاز به کار
13
شارژ کردن باتری
قبل از اولین استفاده، باتری را شارژ کنید. برای شارژ باتری از شارژر استفاده کنید. می توان با استفاده از رایانه با
اتصال از طریق کابل USB، دستگاه را شارژ کرد.
فقط از شارژرها و باتری ها و کابل های مورد تایید سامسونگ استفاده کنید. شارژرها یا کابل های تایید
نشده ممکن است باعث انفجار باتری یا آسیب رساندن به دستگاه شوند.
•وقتی باتری دستگاه ضعیف باشد، دستگاه صدای هشداری پخش کرده و پیامی مبنی بر ضعیف بودن
باتری نشان می دهد.
•اگر باتری بطور کامل تخلیه شود، دستگاه نمی تواند بالفاصله پس از اتصال شارژر روشن شود. قبل از
روشن کردن دستگاه، اجازه بدهید تا باتری تخلیه شده، چند دقیقه شارژ شود.
شارژ کردن با شارژر
سر کوچکتر شارژر را داخل ورودی چندمنظوره دستگاه کرده و سر بزرگتر شارژر را وارد سوکت برق کنید.
اتصال نادرست شارژر می تواند باعث آسیب رساندن جدی به دستگاه شود. هرگونه صدمه ناشی از استفاده
نادرست مشمول ضمانت نمی شود.
•وقتی دستگاه در حال شارژ شدن است، می توانید از آن استفاده کنید، اما ممکن است شارژ شدن کامل
باتری، مدت زمان بیشتری طول بکشد.
•اگر هنگام شارژ شدن دستگاه تامین برق با ناپایداری مواجه شد، صفحه لمسی ممکن است کار نکند. در
صورت بروز این مشکل، شارژر را از دستگاه جدا کنید.
•هنگام شارژ کردن، ممکن است دستگاه گرم شود. این وضعیت عادی است و نباید تأثیری بر طول عمر
یا کارکرد دستگاه شما داشته باشد. اگر باتری بیشتر از حد معمول گرم شد، ممکن است شارژر، شارژ
کردن را متوقف کند.
•اگر دستگاه شما درست شارژ نمی شود، دستگاه و شارژر خود را به مرکز خدمات سامسونگ ببرید.آغاز به کار